summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
-rw-r--r--43876-0.txt (renamed from 43876.txt)2106
-rw-r--r--43876-8.txt8043
-rw-r--r--43876-8.zipbin129067 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--43876-h.zipbin1661677 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--43876-h/43876-h.htm2120
-rw-r--r--43876.zipbin128794 -> 0 bytes
6 files changed, 1708 insertions, 10561 deletions
diff --git a/43876.txt b/43876-0.txt
index 946e46f..0454ef2 100644
--- a/43876.txt
+++ b/43876-0.txt
@@ -1,37 +1,4 @@
-Project Gutenberg's California Athabascan Groups, by Martin A. Baumhoff
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
-almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
-re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
-with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org/license
-
-
-Title: California Athabascan Groups
-
-Author: Martin A. Baumhoff
-
-Release Date: October 3, 2013 [EBook #43876]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: ASCII
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK CALIFORNIA ATHABASCAN GROUPS ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by Colin Bell, Richard Tonsing, Joseph Cooper and
-the Online Distributed Proofreading Team at
-http://www.pgdp.net
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
+*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 43876 ***
CALIFORNIA ATHABASCAN
GROUPS
@@ -110,7 +77,7 @@ aboriginal situation that can now be arrived at.
The Department of Anthropology hopes to be able to continue the work of
studying and publishing the Merriam data on tribal distributions. It
-takes this opportunity to express its appreciation of the cooeperation of
+takes this opportunity to express its appreciation of the coöperation of
the Smithsonian Institution in this undertaking.
A. L. Kroeber
@@ -295,8 +262,8 @@ cards, on each of which is typed the name, location, and any other
pertinent data for a single village. Some of the lists are accompanied
by maps, showing precise location of the villages. In the lists for
which there are no maps but only verbal descriptions of the sites,
-the township, range, and quarter section cooerdinates are given. The
-township and range cooerdinates have been changed since Goddard's time,
+the township, range, and quarter section coördinates are given. The
+township and range coördinates have been changed since Goddard's time,
in accordance with the more accurate surveys of the last thirty years,
but county maps of the appropriate period provide a perfectly adequate
way of locating Goddard's sites within a few hundred yards.
@@ -320,8 +287,8 @@ little about their way of life, except what can be gained by inference
from the surrounding groups.
The author's thanks are due to Dr. A. L. Kroeber and Dr. R. F. Heizer,
-who gave their full cooeperation throughout the preparation of the
-present paper. Dr. Henry Sheffe was kind enough to advise on the
+who gave their full coöperation throughout the preparation of the
+present paper. Dr. Henry Sheffé was kind enough to advise on the
statistics used in the section on population.
@@ -709,7 +676,7 @@ There is no disagreement on the western boundary of the Hupa. It
runs north and south along Bald Hills Ridge, dividing the drainages
of Redwood Creek and the Trinity River. Merriam gives the Hupa
two divisions--the Tin-nung-hen-na-o, or Hupa proper, and the
-Ts'[)a]-nung-wh[)a], or Southern Hupa. The line dividing these two
+Ts´[)a]-nung-wh[)a], or Southern Hupa. The line dividing these two
groups lies just north of the main Trinity to the east of South Fork and
along Madden Creek to the west of South Fork. Kroeber (1925_a_, p. 129)
and Goddard (1903_a_, p. 7) do not give any support for a linguistic
@@ -993,44 +960,44 @@ was already between sixty and sixty-five years old (Goddard, 1909, p.
The Merriam notes contain, in addition to several village names, a few
place and tribal names which I present herewith.
- Kato: to-chil'-pe ke'-ah-hahng
+ Kato: to-chil´-pe ke´-ah-hahng
- Jackson V. people (inc. Branscom): sin'-k[=o]k ke'-ah-hahng
+ Jackson V. people (inc. Branscom): sin´-k[=o]k ke´-ah-hahng
- Wailaki: we'-tah^ch
+ Wailaki: we´-tah^ch
- Yuki of Round V.: chinch'
+ Yuki of Round V.: chinch´
- Coast Yuki: bahng'-ke'-ah-hahng
+ Coast Yuki: bahng´-ke´-ah-hahng
- Southern Sinkyone: ketch'-ing ke'-ah-hahng
+ Southern Sinkyone: ketch´-ing ke´-ah-hahng
Tribe on the N side of Rattlesnake Cr. and E of South Fork Eel
- division of Wailaki (?): tek' ke'-ah-hahng
+ division of Wailaki (?): tek´ ke´-ah-hahng
Long V.: kin-t[)e]^{hl}-pe
Laytonville: ten-tah^{ch}-tung
- Cahto Pond (now drained): to-chil'-pa
+ Cahto Pond (now drained): to-chil´-pa
- Long V. Cr.: shah'-nah
+ Long V. Cr.: shah´-nah
- South Fork Eel R.: nahs-ling'-che
+ South Fork Eel R.: nahs-ling´-che
- Rattlesnake Cr.: tal-tl[=o]l'-kwit
+ Rattlesnake Cr.: tal-tl[=o]l´-kwit
- Main Eel R.: tah-ke'-kwit
+ Main Eel R.: tah-ke´-kwit
- Blue Rock: seng-chah'-tung
+ Blue Rock: seng-chah´-tung
Bell Springs: s[)e]^{ch}-pis
Round V.: kun-tel-ch[=o]-pe
- Jackson V.: kus'-cho-che'-pe; kas-tos' cheek'-be
+ Jackson V.: kus´-cho-che´-pe; kas-tos´ cheek´-be
- Branscomb Mt.: k[=i]k; ch[=i]s'-naw
+ Branscomb Mt.: k[=i]k; ch[=i]s´-naw
VILLAGES
@@ -1040,60 +1007,60 @@ The villages of this group are mostly taken from Barrett (1908, pp.
distinguished by (M). The information given with each of the villages is
sometimes a direct quotation but most often is paraphrased.
- 1. netce'l[=i]gut (B). At a point about 9 mi. nearly due W of
+ 1. netce'l[=i]gût (B). At a point about 9 mi. nearly due W of
the town of Laytonville and about 3 mi. SE of the confluence of the
E fork of the South Fork of Eel R. with the South Fork of Eel R.
This village is on top of the ridge separating these two streams
and is on the property of Mr. Jacob Lamb.
- 2. yictciLti'nkut, "wolf something-lying-down creek" (B). On
+ 2. yictciLti'ñkût, "wolf something-lying-down creek" (B). On
the S bank of Ten Mile Cr. at a point about 5 mi. WNW of the town
of Laytonville.
- 3. sentca'[=u]kut, "rock big creek"; or kave'mato (Northern
+ 3. sentca'[=u]kût, "rock big creek"; or kave'mato (Northern
Pomo dialect name), "rock big" (B). On Big Rock Cr. at a point
about 1-1/2 mi. from its confluence with Ten Mile Cr., or about
5-1/2 mi. nearly due W of the town of Laytonville.
- sen-chow'-ten (M). Kato name for their village at Big Rock,
+ sen-chow´-ten (M). Kato name for their village at Big Rock,
about 4 mi. N of their present rancheria in Long V.
4. ka'ibi, "nuts in" (B). On the NE bank of Ten Mile Cr. at a
point about 3 mi. downstream from the town of Laytonville.
- 5. neb[=o]'c[=e]gut, "ground hump on-top" (B). On what is
+ 5. neb[=o]'c[=e]gût, "ground hump on-top" (B). On what is
known as the Wilson ranch at a point about 1 mi. W of Laytonville.
6. seLgaitceli'nda, "rock white run-out" (B). About 300 yds. E
of the house on what is known as the "old" John Reed ranch about 1
mi. N of Laytonville.
- 7. buntcn[=o]ndi'lyi, "fly settle-upon under" (B). Just NW of
+ 7. bûntcn[=o]ndi'lyi, "fly settle-upon under" (B). Just NW of
Laytonville and but a short distance from the place now occupied by
the Indians near Laytonville.
8. ko'cbi, "blackberry there" (B). About 1-1/2 mi. WSW of
Laytonville and on the SW bank of the Ten Mile Cr.
- 9. tc[=i]b[=e]'takut, "fir tips creek" (B). About a mile SW of
+ 9. tc[=i]b[=e]'takût, "fir tips creek" (B). About a mile SW of
the town of Laytonville and about 1/2 mi. up the creek which drains
Cahto V. from its confluence with Ten Mile Cr.
che-pa-tah-kut (M). A former village in the northern part of
Long V. on the James White place.
- 10. dist[=e]gu'ts[=i][=u], "madrona crooked under" (B). On the
+ 10. dist[=e]gû'ts[=i][=u], "madrona crooked under" (B). On the
western side of Long V. at a point about 2 mi. SSE of Laytonville.
11. t[=o]dji'Lbi, "water? ... in" (B). At the site now
occupied by the Indians at Cahto. This site is on the W bank of the
small creek running from Cahto into Ten Mile Cr.
- 12. buntcten[=o]ndi'lkut, "fly low settle-upon creek" (B). On
+ 12. bûntcten[=o]ndi'lkût, "fly low settle-upon creek" (B). On
the N bank of the northern branch of the head of the South Fork of
the Eel R. at a point about a mile SSW of Cahto.
- 13. kucy[=i]'[=u]yet[=o]kut, "alder under water creek" (B). On
+ 13. kûcy[=i]'[=u]yet[=o]kût, "alder under water creek" (B). On
the N bank of the South Fork of Eel R. at a point about 3 mi. SW of
Cahto. This site is about 1/2 mi. E of the ranch house on the Clark
ranch.
@@ -1102,17 +1069,17 @@ sometimes a direct quotation but most often is paraphrased.
the village was situated under a projecting ridge. On the S bank of
the South Fork of Eel R. at a point about 3 mi. S of Branscomb.
- 15. s[=e]ne'tckut, "rock gravel creek" (B). On the NW bank
+ 15. s[=e]ne'tckût, "rock gravel creek" (B). On the NW bank
of the small stream known as Mud Springs Cr., which is tributary
to the South Fork of Eel R. This site is about 3 mi. a little S
of E of Branscomb. There are on this creek, and not far from this
village site, several springs which flow a very thin blueish mud,
thus giving the creek its name.
- 16. tontce'kut, "water bad creek" (B). About 1/4 mi. W of the
+ 16. tontce'kût, "water bad creek" (B). About 1/4 mi. W of the
South Fork of Eel R. and about 1 mi. SW of Branscomb.
- 17. senansa'^{n}kut, "rock hang-down creek" (B). On the E bank
+ 17. senansa'^{n}kût, "rock hang-down creek" (B). On the E bank
of the South Fork of Eel R. at a point about 1-1/2 mi. downstream
from Branscomb.
@@ -1147,7 +1114,7 @@ seyuhuchetsdung, "old stone house place"
The second source is the notes of Goddard, who did extensive work in
the area in 1906 (Goddard, 1909), though mostly on language and myth.
His notes contain information on two villages, neither of which can be
-located because the township and range cooerdinates have been changed
+located because the township and range coördinates have been changed
since the time of recording and also because the name of the creek
mentioned does not appear on maps in my possession. The two cards
bearing the information have the penciled notations 51 and 52 written
@@ -1162,10 +1129,10 @@ _Goddard List (Goddard, Notes)_
R. 15 W. On a flat 200 yds. N of Blue Hill Cr. and 150 yds. W of
the river. There are 3 deep pits on the eastern edge of the higher
flat. Bill thought there were 3 others 100 yds. S where a white
- man's house had stood, ne'^{[-l]}s[=o]k[=i] k[=i]yahun.
+ man's house had stood, ne'^{[-l]}s[=o]k[=i] k[=i]yahûn.
t'un[-l]tcintcki, "leaves black tail" W sec. 26, T. 22 N., R.
- 15 W. On the higher bank 50 yds. N of tun[-l]tcintckw[=o]t, the
+ 15 W. On the higher bank 50 yds. N of tûn[-l]tcintckw[=o]t, the
next creek N of Blue Hill Cr. and 400 yds. W of the river. There is
timber W. Dr. Wilson used to live there. The site has been plowed.
Bill counted six places where he thought houses had been.
@@ -1276,7 +1243,7 @@ _Goddard's Wailaki Phonology_
Spirants +--------------------+-----------------------------------
| voiced |
-------------+--------------------+-----------------------------------
- Nasals | | n n
+ Nasals | | n ñ
-------------+--------------------+-----------------------------------
Semivowels | | w y
-------------+--------------------+-----------------------------------
@@ -1321,7 +1288,7 @@ _Comparison of Orthographies_
m n (Goddard says n sometimes becomes m by assimilation.
Evidently it is n phonemically)
n n (occasionally ng, once not recorded at all)
- n ng (occasionally n, twice not recorded at all)
+ ñ ng (occasionally n, twice not recorded at all)
o o (occasionally u)
s s
t t
@@ -1351,24 +1318,24 @@ which Kroeber noted at the time (p. 257). Goddard says (1923_a_, p. 95):
I. There is close agreement on the boundaries of the northernmost
Wailaki tribelet on the western side of the Eel. Merriam gives the
-names kun-nun'-dung ke'-ah-hahng, ki'-kot-ke-ah-hahng, ki-ketch-e
-k[=a]-ah-hahng, and ki-ke'-che ke'-ah-hahng as designations for the
+names kun-nun´-dung ke´-ah-hahng, ki´-kot-ke-ah-hahng, ki-ketch-e
+k[=a]-ah-hahng, and ki-ke´-che ke´-ah-hahng as designations for the
group. He says the territory of this group runs from Chamise Creek
in the north to Pine Creek in the south. Goddard gives the same name
(rendered kaikitcEkaiya) and the same boundaries for the group.
The territory north of Chamise Creek on the west side of the river is
-assigned by Merriam to the taht'-so ke'ah tribelet of the Lassik. This
+assigned by Merriam to the taht´-so ke´ah tribelet of the Lassik. This
attribution would seem to indicate that Merriam has put his northern
Wailaki boundary too far north, that it should hit the Eel at Chamise
Creek rather than at Kekawaka Creek. Goddard calls these people the
da[-l]sokaiya, "blue ground people," which no doubt corresponds to
-taht'-so ke'ah. He says, "It is doubtful that they should be counted as
+taht´-so ke´ah. He says, "It is doubtful that they should be counted as
Wailaki, but they were not Lassik and probably spoke the same dialect as
the Wailaki."
-II. This tribelet is called s[)e]-tah'-be ke'-ah-hahng or
-s[=a]-tah'-ke-ahng by Merriam. In one place his notes say that the
+II. This tribelet is called s[)e]-tah´-be ke´-ah-hahng or
+s[=a]-tah´-ke-ahng by Merriam. In one place his notes say that the
territory includes land on both sides of the Eel, running south of
Indian Creek on the western side. This is clearly not so, for he refers
several times to a different tribelet occupying that area. That the
@@ -1380,19 +1347,19 @@ III. Goddard says that there was a tribelet on the west side of the Eel
whose territory was bounded on the north by Natoikot Creek and extended
south to a point opposite the mouth of North Fork. His name for this
group is taticcokaiya. Merriam's name for the group in this general area
-is tah-chis'-tin ke-ah-hahng. He does not give any boundaries for them.
+is tah-chis´-tin ke-ah-hahng. He does not give any boundaries for them.
IV. and V. Merriam gives the following names for the tribelet occupying
-the territory around Blue Rock and Bell Springs Creeks: tsi-to'-ting
-ke'-ah, from the name of Bell Springs Mountain; sen-chah'-ke'-ah;
-s[)e]-so ke'-ah-hahng, "Blue Rock Band"; then'-chah-tung k[=a]'-ah,
+the territory around Blue Rock and Bell Springs Creeks: tsi-to´-ting
+ke´-ah, from the name of Bell Springs Mountain; sen-chah´-ke´-ah;
+s[)e]-so ke´-ah-hahng, "Blue Rock Band"; then´-chah-tung k[=a]´-ah,
"Blue Rock Band." On the other hand, he gives the following names for
the people who occupied the west bank of the Eel for a mile or more
south of the mouth of North Fork: nin-ken-n[=e]tch k[=a]-ah-hahng;
-nung-ken-ne-tse' ke'-ah; n[)e]-tahs' ke-ah-hahng. Goddard says that the
+nung-ken-ne-tse´ ke´-ah; n[)e]-tahs´ ke-ah-hahng. Goddard says that the
entire stretch from the mouth of North Fork south to Blue Rock Creek
on the west bank of the river was occupied by a single tribelet called
-nInkannitckaiya, a name clearly corresponding to Merriam's names for the
+nIñkannitckaiya, a name clearly corresponding to Merriam's names for the
people on the west bank of the Eel, south of North Fork. I am inclined
to think that Merriam is correct and that there were two tribelets in
this area. Merriam's notes include five different references to the
@@ -1402,36 +1369,36 @@ division line no doubt falls a mile or two north of Bell Springs Creek.
VI. On the eastern side of the river Merriam gives two names for the
tribelet holding the land south from Kekawaka Creek. He says the
-yu-e-yet'-te ke'-ah was the tribelet north of Chamise Creek. Their
-southernmost village, called sko'-teng, was on the east side of the
-river a half-mile or a mile south of Kekawaka Creek. The sko'-den ke'-ah
+yu-e-yet´-te ke´-ah was the tribelet north of Chamise Creek. Their
+southernmost village, called sko´-teng, was on the east side of the
+river a half-mile or a mile south of Kekawaka Creek. The sko´-den ke´-ah
Merriam gives as the name of the tribelet on the east side of the Eel
River and about a half-mile south of Kekawaka Creek. Goddard gives
-i[-l]kodAnkaiya, corresponding to Merriam's sko'-den ke'-ah, as the
+i[-l]kodAñkaiya, corresponding to Merriam's sko´-den ke´-ah, as the
name of the group extending from about two miles south of the mouth of
Chamise Creek nearly to the mouth of Kekawaka Creek. Both Merriam and
Goddard indicate some doubt whether these people were Wailaki.
VII. Merriam gives the names ch[=e]s-kot k[=e]-ah-hahng,
-chis'-ko-ke'-ah, and t[=o]s-ahng'-kut for the tribelet living in
+chis´-ko-ke´-ah, and t[=o]s-ahng´-kut for the tribelet living in
Horseshoe Bend. The first two names come from the word chis-kot, the
name for Copper Mine Creek. Goddard also gives these last two names for
-the group (written tciskokaiya and tosAnkaiya, "water stands people"),
+the group (written tciskokaiya and tosAñkaiya, "water stands people"),
and he says their territory includes the land between Copper Mine Creek
on the south and a point a mile or two south of Chamise Creek on the
north.
-VIII. Goddard says that a tribelet named slakaiya or sEyadAnkaiya
+VIII. Goddard says that a tribelet named slakaiya or sEyadAñkaiya
occupied the territory between Copper Mine Creek in the north and Willow
-Creek in the south. Merriam gives the name nung-ken-ne-tse' ke'-ah to
+Creek in the south. Merriam gives the name nung-ken-ne-tse´ ke´-ah to
this group, which he locates on the east side of the Eel River at Island
Mountain. He gives no boundaries for the group.
IX. Merriam gives two names for the tribelet occupying the Indian Creek
-region. The chen-nes'-no-ke'-ah was the band on chen-nes-no'-kot Creek
+region. The chen-nes´-no-ke´-ah was the band on chen-nes-no´-kot Creek
(Indian Cr.) from Lake Mountain to the Eel River; he also writes this
name ken-nis-no-kut ke-ah-hahng. His other name for the group has the
-variants bas-k[=a]'-ah-hahng, bas-ki'-yah, bus-k[=a]-ah-hahng. This
+variants bas-k[=a]´-ah-hahng, bas-ki´-yah, bus-k[=a]-ah-hahng. This
group is said to have been on the east side of the Eel River a mile
or two north of Indian Creek (in the Fenton Range country). Goddard
gives the name bAskaiya, "slide people," corresponding to the last of
@@ -1444,23 +1411,23 @@ Creek south to the mouth of North Fork. Goddard says the region was
occupied by a tribelet called sE[-l]tchikyokaiya, "rock red large
people."
-XI. Merriam says the s[=a]'-tan-do'-che ke'-ah-hahng was the name of
+XI. Merriam says the s[=a]´-tan-do´-che ke´-ah-hahng was the name of
a tribelet on the north side of North Fork and about a half-mile from
its junction with the main Eel. The name means "rock reaching into the
-water." Goddard's name for this same group is sEtandonkiyahAn, a clear
+water." Goddard's name for this same group is sEtandoñkiyahAñ, a clear
correspondence, and he indicates that their land was on about the last
mile of North Fork.
XII. According to Merriam the next group up North Fork was named
-s[)e]-cho ke'-ah-hahng. Its land was on the north side of North Fork a
+s[)e]-cho ke´-ah-hahng. Its land was on the north side of North Fork a
mile or more above its mouth. Goddard has the same name for the group,
-sEtcokiyahAn; he says the people occupied both the north and south sides
+sEtcokiyahAñ; he says the people occupied both the north and south sides
of a one-mile stretch of North Fork beginning a little way below the
mouth of Wilson Creek and extending downstream from there.
-XIII. Merriam says ki'-ye ke'-ah-hahng was the name of the tribelet on
+XIII. Merriam says ki´-ye ke´-ah-hahng was the name of the tribelet on
both sides of North Fork at the mouth of Wilson Creek. This is in accord
-with Goddard's data. He gives the name as kAiyEkiyahAn. Neither Goddard
+with Goddard's data. He gives the name as kAiyEkiyahAñ. Neither Goddard
nor Merriam gives the limits of this group up North Fork. Presumably
they coincide with the tribal boundary.
@@ -1504,7 +1471,7 @@ _Villages on West Side of the Eel_
of the wife of Wylakki Tip so there is no doubt that they are
referring to the same village.]
- 2. kun-tes-che'-kut (M). Said to have been a Wailaki village
+ 2. kun-tes-che´-kut (M). Said to have been a Wailaki village
on the W side of the Eel R. a half-mile N of Horseshoe Bend Tunnel,
probably nearly opposite Horseshoe Bend Cr. (Tip).
@@ -1512,43 +1479,43 @@ _Villages on West Side of the Eel_
Bend. Horseshoe Bend Cr. appears to enter the Eel from the E about
a mile S of Boulder Cr. If Goddard's kAntEltcEk'At is really
kAntE[-l]tcEk'At, with the bar on the "l" dropped in error, then
- these names are nearly the same. If so, kun-tes-che'-kut might
+ these names are nearly the same. If so, kun-tes-che´-kut might
be the name of village no. 1 even though the location differs
slightly.]
3. basEtcE[-l]galk'At, "throw stone outside on" (G). On the
western side of the Eel, just N of the mouth of Pine Cr.
- 4. sEdAkk'andAn, "rock ridge place" (G). On the point of the
+ 4. sEdAkk'añdAñ, "rock ridge place" (G). On the point of the
ridge around which the Eel turns toward the W at Horseshoe Bend.
- 5. kit-te-ken-n[)e]'-din (Tip), kit-ken-n[)e]-tung (Maj) (M).
+ 5. kit-te-ken-n[)e]´-din (Tip), kit-ken-n[)e]-tung (Maj) (M).
At or near the S end of Horseshoe Bend Tunnel. It was the biggest
village of the tribelet and was said to have been the native
village of the father of Wylakki Tip.
- s[)e]-tah'-be (M). A large village on the W side of the Eel
+ s[)e]-tah´-be (M). A large village on the W side of the Eel
River just S of Horseshoe Bend Tunnel near Island Mt. Station. It
was nearly opposite the mouth of Copper Mine Cr.
- tcInnagantcEdai, "eye closed door" (G). At the base of the
+ tcInnagañtcEdai, "eye closed door" (G). At the base of the
ridge described in no. 4. It was said to have been the home of
Captain Jim.
[These names may or may not refer to the same village. If
- they do, it is likely that Merriam's kit-te-ken-n[)e]'-din is the
- correct one. His s[)e]-tah'-be evidently refers to the name of
+ they do, it is likely that Merriam's kit-te-ken-n[)e]´-din is the
+ correct one. His s[)e]-tah´-be evidently refers to the name of
the tribelet, sEtakaiya, given by both him and Goddard. Goddard's
designation looks as though it might very well refer to the tunnel
and thus would be very modern.]
- 6. lacE[-l]kotcEdAn, "buckeye small hole place" (G). This
+ 6. lacE[-l]kotcEdAñ, "buckeye small hole place" (G). This
seems to have been only a few hundred yards S of Horseshoe Bend.
7. kaigAntcik'At, "wind blows up on" (G). A big winter camp
about 1/4 mi. S of Horseshoe Bend.
- 8. sait'otcEdadAn, "sand point on" (G). Also about 1/4 mi. S
+ 8. sait'otcEdadAñ, "sand point on" (G). Also about 1/4 mi. S
of Horseshoe Bend but was about 500 ft. above the river near a big
spring.
@@ -1567,13 +1534,13 @@ _Villages on West Side of the Eel_
this creek. It was the home of the father of the wife of Wylakki
Tip.
- 12. IsgaidadAbbInlai (G). N of the creek mentioned in no. 11
+ 12. IsgaidadAbbIñlai (G). N of the creek mentioned in no. 11
but on higher ground away from the river.
13. [-l]tAgtcEbi', "black oaks in" (G). About a mile N of
Natoikot Cr. on a flat above the river.
- 14. sEnagatcEdAn, "stones walk around place" (G). About 200
+ 14. sEnagatcEdAñ, "stones walk around place" (G). About 200
yds. N of no. 15.
15. sE[-l]sokyok'At, "stone blue large on" (G). About 1/2 mi.
@@ -1590,16 +1557,16 @@ _Villages on West Side of the Eel_
the mouth of Cottonwood Cr. It was close to a fishing place that
the tribelet shared with the bAskaiya tribelet.
- 18. tah-t[=e]s-cho'-tung, tah-t[=e]s-cho'-ting, tah-chis'-ting
+ 18. tah-t[=e]s-cho´-tung, tah-t[=e]s-cho´-ting, tah-chis´-ting
(M). 1/2 mi. or more N of the mouth of North Fork on the W side of
the main Eel.
- taticcodAn (G). In a grove of oaks about 1/4 mi. downstream
+ taticcodAñ (G). In a grove of oaks about 1/4 mi. downstream
from the mouth of North Fork on the W side of the Eel.
- 19. ne'-tahs, ning-ken-ne'-tset (M). Ne'-tahs is the name of
+ 19. ne´-tahs, ning-ken-ne´-tset (M). Ne´-tahs is the name of
the town on a rocky stretch of the river. The town ran for a mile
- or more S of the mouth of North Fork (Maj). Ning-ken-ne'-tset was
+ or more S of the mouth of North Fork (Maj). Ning-ken-ne´-tset was
the name of the village which was at the fishing place opposite the
mouth of North Fork and extending S. It was also called "fishtown."
Tip's mother lived there (Tip).
@@ -1615,9 +1582,9 @@ _Villages on West Side of the Eel_
21. tco[-l]Attcik'At, "graveyard on" (G). A large village on
the western side of the river a few hundred yards downstream from
- the mouth of djonkot.
+ the mouth of djoñkot.
- [The stream that Goddard calls djonkot seems to be the one
+ [The stream that Goddard calls djoñkot seems to be the one
that appears on the modern maps as Cinch Cr.; that is the only one
in the vicinity. On his map it is shown entering the Eel about
a mile downstream from the mouth of Bell Springs Cr. but it is
@@ -1626,7 +1593,7 @@ _Villages on West Side of the Eel_
Cr. is, in fact, the stream that Goddard meant to indicate I have
moved the village about a mile to the S.]
- 22. sa'kAntE[-l]dAn, "beaver valley place" (G). About midway
+ 22. sa'kAntE[-l]dAñ, "beaver valley place" (G). About midway
between the mouth of Blue Rock Cr. and Bell Springs Cr. on a fine
large flat.
@@ -1635,36 +1602,36 @@ _Villages on East Side of the Eel_
23. sE[-l]kaibi, "make a noise in the throat" (G). Opposite
the mouth of Chamise Cr.
- 24. tcadEtokInnEdAn (G). Located only approximately--in
+ 24. tcadEtokInnEdAñ (G). Located only approximately--in
Horseshoe Bend at the point where the river turns toward the NE.
- 25. k'AcsAndAn, "alder stands place" (G). About a mile
+ 25. k'AcsAndAñ, "alder stands place" (G). About a mile
downstream from the point where the river turns W at Horseshoe Bend.
- 26. sEtcokInnEdAn, "rock large its base place" (G). About 1/2
+ 26. sEtcokInnEdAñ, "rock large its base place" (G). About 1/2
mi. downstream from the point where the river turns toward the W at
Horseshoe Bend.
- 27. nEtcEdEtcAnk'At, "ground rolling on" (G). A short distance
+ 27. nEtcEdEtcAñk'At, "ground rolling on" (G). A short distance
W of the mouth of Copper Mine Cr. (Tunnel Cr.).
28. dAndaitcAmbi, "flint hole in" (G). On the downstream side
of the mouth of Copper Mine Cr. (Tunnel Cr.).
29. taht-aht (M). On the E side of the Eel R. at Horseshoe
- Bend and opposite s[)e]-tah'-be. It was a big town (Tip).
+ Bend and opposite s[)e]-tah´-be. It was a big town (Tip).
- kaitcIlIntadAn, "Christmas berries among place" (G). There
+ kaitcIlIñtadAñ, "Christmas berries among place" (G). There
was a graveyard about 1/4 mi. N of the village and just beyond the
graveyard was Copper Mine Cr.
- 30. to-ch[)e]'-ting (M). A big village on the E side of the
- Eel R. at Horseshoe Bend (opposite s[)e]-tah'-be), only a short
+ 30. to-ch[)e]´-ting (M). A big village on the E side of the
+ Eel R. at Horseshoe Bend (opposite s[)e]-tah´-be), only a short
distance S of taht-aht (Tip). It was probably less than 1/4 mi. S
of Island Mt. Station on the opposite side of the river.
- kaslInkyodAn. "spring large place" (G). On the E bank of the
- river about 300 yds. S of kaitcIlIntadAn, or about 1/2 mi. S of
+ kaslInkyodAñ. "spring large place" (G). On the E bank of the
+ river about 300 yds. S of kaitcIlIñtadAñ, or about 1/2 mi. S of
Copper Mine Cr.
[The names of these two villages are not the same at all and
@@ -1672,11 +1639,11 @@ _Villages on East Side of the Eel_
are good that the names do not represent the same village.]
31. kaslInkyobi, "spring large in" (G). A rock shelter near
- Goddard's kaslInkyodAn. A family used to spend the winter here.
+ Goddard's kaslInkyodAñ. A family used to spend the winter here.
Captain Jim's father-in-law was left here to die after he had been
wounded by the whites.
- 32. skEtcE[-l]kascanAn, "mush thrown away sunny place" (G).
+ 32. skEtcE[-l]kascanAñ, "mush thrown away sunny place" (G).
Evidently situated about a mile S of Copper Mine Cr., where the
river makes a slight turn toward the N. Here there is a flat 50 ft.
higher than the river and 150 ft. from it, in which 17 house pits
@@ -1686,10 +1653,10 @@ _Villages on East Side of the Eel_
the deposit is supposed to indicate the abundance of the year's
acorn crop.
- 33. ah-chahng'-ket (M). On the E side of the Eel a mile or two
+ 33. ah-chahng´-ket (M). On the E side of the Eel a mile or two
S of Horseshoe Bend. It was more than a mile S of to-che-ting (Tip).
- akyank'At, "right here on" (G). Some distance N of Willow Cr.
+ akyañk'At, "right here on" (G). Some distance N of Willow Cr.
and on the river.
[These two names doubtless represent the same village but
@@ -1697,23 +1664,23 @@ _Villages on East Side of the Eel_
34. slAsyanbi', "squirrels they eat in" (G). Only a
short distance S of Willow Cr. and back from the river near
- nE[-l]tcAnk'At. slAsyankot was an alternate name for Willow Cr. and
+ nE[-l]tcAñk'At. slAsyañkot was an alternate name for Willow Cr. and
the name of the village was derived from this.
- 35. n[)e]-chung-ket' (M). On the E side of the river about
- 1/2 mi. S of ah-chahng'-ket (Tip). The inhabitants were called
- n[)e]'-chung ke-ah-hahng (Maj and Tip).
+ 35. n[)e]-chung-ket´ (M). On the E side of the river about
+ 1/2 mi. S of ah-chahng´-ket (Tip). The inhabitants were called
+ n[)e]´-chung ke-ah-hahng (Maj and Tip).
- nE[-l]tcAnk'At, "ground black on" (G). Said to have been the
+ nE[-l]tcAñk'At, "ground black on" (G). Said to have been the
second one S of Willow Cr.
[It is evident that both Merriam and Goddard have the same
name here. Goddard's location is more precise and thus has been
accepted.]
- 36. dabAstci'Andan, "ants' nest place" (G). A little way S
+ 36. dabAstci'Añdañ, "ants' nest place" (G). A little way S
of the mouth of Willow Cr. The name comes from the name of Willow
- Cr.--dabActci'Ankot.
+ Cr.--dabActci'Añkot.
37. dAstatcElai, "string (?) point" (G). Evidently only a
short distance above Indian Cr. It was said to have been a large
@@ -1728,14 +1695,14 @@ _Villages on East Side of the Eel_
of the NW corner of sec. 36, T. 5 S., R 6 E. Its inhabitants were
exterminated by mixed bands of white men and Kekawaka Indians.
- 40. tah-bus-che-sahng'-tung (M). A small village in the hills
+ 40. tah-bus-che-sahng´-tung (M). A small village in the hills
1 mi. E of the Eel R. and 1 mile S of Indian Cr. (Maj).
41. sE[-l]tcikyok'At, "red rock large on" (G). 1/4 mi. N of
the first creek downstream from North Fork on the E bank of the
main Eel.
- 42. chug'-ge'-tah (M). A small village on the E side of the
+ 42. chug´-ge´-tah (M). A small village on the E side of the
Eel N of the mouth of North Fork (Maj). It was about 2 mi. S of
Indian Cr.
@@ -1747,11 +1714,11 @@ _Villages on East Side of the Eel_
same place but Merriam's location is so indefinite that their
identity is uncertain.]
- 43. kai[-l]tcitadAn, "redbud place" (G). A short distance N
+ 43. kai[-l]tcitadAñ, "redbud place" (G). A short distance N
of the mouth of North Fork a ridge runs down to the river. On the
northern side of the ridge a village was situated.
- 44. t[=o]n-klan'-be-ko-cho'-be (M). On the E side of the Eel
+ 44. t[=o]n-klan´-be-ko-cho´-be (M). On the E side of the Eel
on the northern side of the mouth of North Fork (Tip).
ton[-l]Embi', "streams come together in" (G). Situated on a
@@ -1762,11 +1729,11 @@ _Villages on East Side of the Eel_
[These two sites are evidently the same, since both the names
and the locations match.]
- 45. s[=a]'-tan-do'-che ke'-ah-hahng (M). In a rocky stretch on
+ 45. s[=a]´-tan-do´-che ke´-ah-hahng (M). In a rocky stretch on
the N side of the North Fork about 1/2 mi. above its junction with
the main Eel. The name means "rock reaching into water."
- sEtandontci, "rock runs to the water" (G). On the N bank of
+ sEtandoñtci, "rock runs to the water" (G). On the N bank of
North Fork about 1/2 mi. above the mouth.
46. sEntciyE, "rock large under" (G). About 3/4 mi. above the
@@ -1774,7 +1741,7 @@ _Villages on East Side of the Eel_
spruce tree, stands opposite the village site, on the S side of the
stream.
- 47. s[)e]-cho-ke'-ah-hahng (M). A village and band at
+ 47. s[)e]-cho-ke´-ah-hahng (M). A village and band at
s[)e]-cho, "big rock," on the N side of the North Fork of the Eel
a mile or more above its mouth. "Thousands of Indians killed here"
(Maj).
@@ -1804,22 +1771,22 @@ _Villages on East Side of the Eel_
51. totAkk'At, "between water" (G). Summer camp a little way
below the mouth of Wilson Cr. on the N side of North Fork.
- 52. se[-l]tcidadAn, "stone red mouth place" (G). An old
+ 52. se[-l]tcidadAñ, "stone red mouth place" (G). An old
village, occupied before the whites came. It stood between no. 11
and the mouth of Wilson Cr.
- 53. nolEtcotadAn, "water falls large among" (G). On the N side
+ 53. nolEtcotadAñ, "water falls large among" (G). On the N side
of North Fork about 1/2 mi. below Wilson Cr. It was on two levels;
one near the stream, the other on a terrace some yards N.
- 54. ki'-ye ke'-ah-hahng (M). On North Fork at the mouth of
+ 54. ki´-ye ke´-ah-hahng (M). On North Fork at the mouth of
Wilson Cr. and covering both sides of North Fork and Wilson Cr.
(Maj).
[This name is evidently the same as Goddard's name for the
- tribelet on North Fork above Wilson Cr.--kAiyEkiyahAn.]
+ tribelet on North Fork above Wilson Cr.--kAiyEkiyahAñ.]
- 55. sEnEsbInnAnkai, "rock tall its slope" (G). On the northern
+ 55. sEnEsbInnAñkai, "rock tall its slope" (G). On the northern
side of North Fork and about midway E and W of sec. 12, T. 24
N., R. 14 W. is a tall rock called sEnEs. Just W of this was the
village.
@@ -1829,14 +1796,14 @@ _Villages on East Side of the Eel_
informant said his uncle remembered the building of the dance house
when he was a small boy.
- 57. s[=a]'-yahs kun'-dung (M). A fishing camp for drying
+ 57. s[=a]´-yahs kun´-dung (M). A fishing camp for drying
salmon at Fishtown Spring or Upgraff fishery on North Fork about 5
mi. up, "march till creek dries up."
[Upgraff must be an error for Updegraff; the latter is a local
place name whereas the former is not, so far as I can see.]
- 58. sEnEstconatAnkai, "rock tall large crossing" (G). A small
+ 58. sEnEstconatAñkai, "rock tall large crossing" (G). A small
stream comes into North Fork about 1-1/2 mi. above Wilson Cr. The
village of this name was situated 1/2 mi. S of North Fork and just
to the W of this tributary. The village had not been occupied in
@@ -1846,18 +1813,18 @@ _Villages on East Side of the Eel_
situated on the S side of North Fork just above the mouth of the
stream mentioned in no. 58 (G).
- 60. s[=a]h-gah'-ket, se-kah'-ke-ah-ahng, se-ki'-ah-hahng (M).
+ 60. s[=a]h-gah´-ket, se-kah´-ke-ah-ahng, se-ki´-ah-hahng (M).
A rancheria on the E side of the Eel R. on the S side of the mouth
- of North Fork (named for s[=a]-gah-nah'-ting, the name of the land
+ of North Fork (named for s[=a]-gah-nah´-ting, the name of the land
on the S side of the mouth of North Fork in the angle between the
two rivers) (Tip).
- kai[-l]tcitadAn, "redbud place" (G). This was apparently near
- Merriam's s[=a]h-gah'-ket.
+ kai[-l]tcitadAñ, "redbud place" (G). This was apparently near
+ Merriam's s[=a]h-gah´-ket.
[These different names may not represent the same village. If
these were two villages, they were very close together. Goddard
- gives kai[-l]tcitadAn as the name of another village N of North
+ gives kai[-l]tcitadAñ as the name of another village N of North
Fork (no. 43) so it may be an error here (see pl. 11, b for a view
of this region).]
@@ -1865,9 +1832,9 @@ _Villages on East Side of the Eel_
the river a short distance above McDonald Cr. The Indians lived
here in the winter.
- 62. ne-che'-cho-ket (M). On the E side of the Eel about a mile
+ 62. ne-che´-cho-ket (M). On the E side of the Eel about a mile
S of the mouth of North Fork. It was apparently opposite part of
- the elongate village ning-ken-ne'-tset (no. 19). "Salmon stop here;
+ the elongate village ning-ken-ne´-tset (no. 19). "Salmon stop here;
great fishing; rocky place; Red Hill ground" (Tip).
nE[-l]tcikyok'at, "ground red large on" (G). On a point of
@@ -1880,25 +1847,25 @@ _Villages on East Side of the Eel_
of the river. This place is called nEtacbi', 'land slide in,' and
seems to have been a noted fishing place."]
- 63. sah-nah'-chung-kut, sah-nah-chin'-che ke'-ah-hahng (M).
+ 63. sah-nah´-chung-kut, sah-nah-chin´-che ke´-ah-hahng (M).
On the E side of the Eel R. 1-1/2 or 2 mi. S of the mouth of North
Fork and near McDonald Cr. (Tip).
- 64. sel-di'-kot (M). On the E side of the Eel R. S of Bell
+ 64. sel-di´-kot (M). On the E side of the Eel R. S of Bell
Springs Cr. (Maj).
- 65. s[)e]-ski'-cho-ding (M). Claimed as a Wailaki village
+ 65. s[)e]-ski´-cho-ding (M). Claimed as a Wailaki village
on the E side of the Eel R. at White Rock near Big Bend. On the
opposite side of the river from Bell Springs Station (Tip).
- se[-l]GaitcodAn (G). On a flat on the E side of the river.
+ se[-l]GaitcodAñ (G). On a flat on the E side of the river.
"The east and west section line dividing sections 84 and 85 of T.
24 N., R. 14 W. was noted as passing through this flat."
[These two names doubtless represent the same village; the
names are similar and the locations are the same.]
- 66. chin-to'-bin-nung (M). On the upper part of McDonald Cr.,
+ 66. chin-to´-bin-nung (M). On the upper part of McDonald Cr.,
about 3 mi. up from the Eel (Maj).
67. chus-nah-teg-gul-lah chen-ne-tung (M). An old village
@@ -1916,38 +1883,38 @@ the appropriate United States Geological Survey (USGS) quadrangle
but they are not shown on the map. For this area the quadrangles are
Alderpoint (1951), Hoaglin (1935), Leggett (1952), and Spyrock (1952).
- Asbill Cr.--djonot (G).
+ Asbill Cr.--djoñot (G).
- Bell Springs Cr.--sAlt'okot (G).
+ Bell Springs Cr.--sAlt´okot (G).
- Bell Springs Mt.--tsi-to'-ting; si-to'-ting (M). This is the
+ Bell Springs Mt.--tsi-to´-ting; si-to´-ting (M). This is the
mountain cut through by Bell Springs Cr.
Bell Springs Station (native name for the site of the
- station)--sah'-ten'-t[)e]'-te; sah-ten-t[)e]^{hl}-t[)e] (M). Bell
+ station)--sah´-ten´-t[)e]´-te; sah-ten-t[)e]^{hl}-t[)e] (M). Bell
Springs Station is on the W side of the Eel about halfway between
Blue Rock Cr. and Bell Springs Cr., about the same place as village
22. In fact, Merriam's names for this site may correspond to
- Goddard's name for village 22, sa'kAntE[-l]dAn.
+ Goddard's name for village 22, sa'kAntE[-l]dAñ.
Big Bend Cr.--dAndaikot (G).
- Blue Rock--sen-chah'-tung (M). Evidently this is near Blue
+ Blue Rock--sen-chah´-tung (M). Evidently this is near Blue
Rock Cr.
- Chamise Cr.--sah-nah'-ting; shah-nah-ting (M); canAndAnkot (G).
+ Chamise Cr.--sah-nah´-ting; shah-nah-ting (M); canAndAñkot (G).
- Chamise Cr. crossing--ses-ki'-be (M).
+ Chamise Cr. crossing--ses-ki´-be (M).
- Chamise Cr., mouth of--sun-ti'-che, soon-di'-che (M).
+ Chamise Cr., mouth of--sun-ti´-che, soon-di´-che (M).
- Cinch Cr.--djonkot (G). Goddard evidently has this creek
+ Cinch Cr.--djoñkot (G). Goddard evidently has this creek
placed incorrectly on his map. If I understand his description, it
should be a tributary of Bell Springs Cr. rather than of the Eel R.
directly.
Copper Mine Cr. (Tunnel Cr. on the more recent
- maps)--chis'-kot, ch[=e]s-kot (M); tciskot (G). Both Merriam and
+ maps)--chis´-kot, ch[=e]s-kot (M); tciskot (G). Both Merriam and
Goddard say that this name refers to red paint and was probably
suggested by the color of the water in the creek. This is also
responsible for the English name.
@@ -1955,10 +1922,10 @@ Alderpoint (1951), Hoaglin (1935), Leggett (1952), and Spyrock (1952).
Cottonwood Cr.--tgActcEkot (G). The English name is a
translation of the Wailaki name. The creek is unnamed on USGS maps.
- Dawson Flat--choo'-e-kun-tes'-te (M). This flat was W of Lake
+ Dawson Flat--choo´-e-kun-tes´-te (M). This flat was W of Lake
Mt. between Horse Ranch and Fenton Ranch.
- Eel R.--tan'-cho-kut (M). Eel R. valley--bus'-be (M). This
+ Eel R.--tan´-cho-kut (M). Eel R. valley--bus´-be (M). This
name refers to a part of the valley of the main Eel R., especially
the E side, between Horseshoe Bend and North Fork.
@@ -1967,96 +1934,96 @@ Alderpoint (1951), Hoaglin (1935), Leggett (1952), and Spyrock (1952).
Eel R., Middle Fork--tahng-cho-skus (M). The junction of the
Middle Fork with the main Eel was called t[=o]s-kahs-k[=a].
- Eel R., North Fork--bah'-ne-kut (M); banikot (G).
+ Eel R., North Fork--bah´-ne-kut (M); banikot (G).
- Eel R.-North Fork junction--ch[=a]-lin'-ding, kl[=a]-lin-ding
+ Eel R.-North Fork junction--ch[=a]-lin´-ding, kl[=a]-lin-ding
(M).
- Harris region--tah-sahn-ting', tahs-ahng (M). Harris is a
+ Harris region--tah-sahn-ting´, tahs-ahng (M). Harris is a
small town about 8 mi. W of the main Eel R. in the territory of the
Lassik (according to Merriam's boundaries).
- Hettenshaw Valley--ken-tes'-tung (M). This valley is in Lassik
+ Hettenshaw Valley--ken-tes´-tung (M). This valley is in Lassik
territory about 12 mi. N of the Wailaki boundary. It lies between
the headwaters of the North Fork of the Eel and the headwaters of
the Van Duzen R.
- Horse Ranch Cr.--kus'-ken-tes'-be (M); canAntcakot (G). These
+ Horse Ranch Cr.--kus´-ken-tes´-be (M); canAñtcakot (G). These
are clearly not the same names but sometimes streams have alternate
names. Cf. Willow Cr. below.
Horseshoe Bend--ch[=e]s (M). The bend is named for the red
- copper spring of Copper Mine Cr. ki'-ke-che (M) is the name for
- the western part of the loop of Horseshoe Bend, to-sahng'-kut,
+ copper spring of Copper Mine Cr. ki´-ke-che (M) is the name for
+ the western part of the loop of Horseshoe Bend, to-sahng´-kut,
t[=o]s-ahng-kut (M) is the name of the part of Horseshoe Bend N of
Island Mt. Horseshoe Bend is the big switchback curve in the Eel R.
about 6 mi. N of the mouth of North Fork.
- Indian Cr.--chen-nes-no'-kut, ken'-nis-no'-kut (M). The name
+ Indian Cr.--chen-nes-no´-kut, ken´-nis-no´-kut (M). The name
Indian Cr. does not appear on any of the USGS maps but it is the
name used by Merriam.
- Island Mt.--bahng-kut, bahn-kut (M); bank'At (G). Island Mt.
+ Island Mt.--bahng-kut, bahn-kut (M); bañk'At (G). Island Mt.
is a range of hills bordered on the E by the Eel R. and extending
from the mouth of North Fork in the S to beyond Horseshoe Bend in
the N.
- Jewett Cr.--sel-di'-kot (M); dAsk'Ekot (G).
+ Jewett Cr.--sel-di´-kot (M); dAsk'Ekot (G).
- Kekawaka Cr.--kas-n[=a]'-kot, kahs'-ne-kot (M); kasnaikot (G).
+ Kekawaka Cr.--kas-n[=a]´-kot, kahs´-ne-kot (M); kasnaikot (G).
- Lake Mt.--s[=a]-kahn-den, se-kahn'-ting (M). Lake Mt. is about
+ Lake Mt.--s[=a]-kahn-den, se-kahn´-ting (M). Lake Mt. is about
3 mi. E of the Eel and 3 mi. N of North Fork.
- McDonald Cr.--sah'-nah-chin-che (M); canAntcIntci (G).
+ McDonald Cr.--sah´-nah-chin-che (M); canAñtcIntci (G).
- Middle Trail--be-ten-na'-be (M). This trail was in the hills E
+ Middle Trail--be-ten-na´-be (M). This trail was in the hills E
of the Eel R. about a mile south of Indian Cr.
- Mina--to-les' cho'-be (M). Mina is a modern place name for a
+ Mina--to-les´ cho´-be (M). Mina is a modern place name for a
town about 2 mi. N of North Fork and 5 mi. E of the main Eel R.
- Natoikot Cr.--no-toi'-kut (M); natoikot (G). I have given this
+ Natoikot Cr.--no-toi´-kut (M); natoikot (G). I have given this
creek its Wailaki name because it has no English name and is not,
in fact, located on modern maps. It is said to have run into the
Eel R. about 1-1/2 mi. S of Island Mt. Station, which is on the
southern side of Horseshoe Bend. It has been placed on the map in
accordance with the topography shown on USGS Hoaglin Quadrangle.
- Pine Cr.--ten-di'-kot (M); lacEtcikot (G). Merriam was not
+ Pine Cr.--ten-di´-kot (M); lacEtcikot (G). Merriam was not
certain that his name was correct.
- Pipe Cr.--taht-so'-kut (M).
+ Pipe Cr.--taht-so´-kut (M).
- Poonkinny Ridge--nel-kis'-te (M). Merriam says this is the
+ Poonkinny Ridge--nel-kis´-te (M). Merriam says this is the
name of the open ridge between the main Eel R. and the northern
part of Round V. That area is marked Poonkinny Ridge on the USGS
Spyrock Quadrangle. It is in Yuki territory.
- Rattlesnake Cr.--to-nah'-ling (M). This creek is a tributary
+ Rattlesnake Cr.--to-nah´-ling (M). This creek is a tributary
of the South Fork of the Eel R. and forms a part of the southern
boundary of the Eel River Wailaki, according to Merriam.
- Rockpile Mt.--sen'-ning ah'-kut (M). This mountain is said to
+ Rockpile Mt.--sen´-ning ah´-kut (M). This mountain is said to
be on the E side of the Eel R. S of Alder Point, but the name does
not appear on modern maps.
- Round V.--ken'-tes-cho'-be (M). The inhabitants of Round V.
- were called ken'-tes cho'-be ke'-ah, a locative rather than a
+ Round V.--ken´-tes-cho´-be (M). The inhabitants of Round V.
+ were called ken´-tes cho´-be ke´-ah, a locative rather than a
tribal name.
- Summit V.--ken-tes'[-l]-be (M). Summit V. lies about 2 mi. SE
+ Summit V.--ken-tes´[-l]-be (M). Summit V. lies about 2 mi. SE
of the bend of North Fork and seems to have marked the southeastern
limit of North Fork Wailaki territory. It is said that there was
once much camass there.
- Willow Cr.--dabActci'Ankot, slAsyankot (G). The latter was
+ Willow Cr.--dabActci'Añkot, slAsyañkot (G). The latter was
used occasionally for the stream.
Wilson Cr.--dat'olkot (G).
-ETHNOZOOeLOGY AND ETHNOBOTANY
+ETHNOZOÖLOGY AND ETHNOBOTANY
The following notes are from Merriam's records.
@@ -2185,8 +2152,8 @@ TRIBELETS
The rest of the information on the Pitch Wailaki presented here concerns
tribelet and village organization and is taken from Goddard (1924). He
lists four tribelets among the Pitch Wailaki (Roman numerals, map 6).:
-I, t'odAnnAn kiyahAn; II, t'okya kiyahAn; III, tc'i'ankot kiyahAn; IV,
-tcokot kiyahAn.
+I, t'odAnnAñ kiyahAñ; II, t'okya kiyahAñ; III, tc'i'añkot kiyahAñ; IV,
+tcokot kiyahAñ.
VILLAGES
@@ -2194,34 +2161,34 @@ VILLAGES
The villages belonging to each of these tribelets are listed below
(Arabic number, map 6). All are from Goddard's lists.
-I. _t'odAnnAn kiyahAn_
+I. _t'odAnnAñ kiyahAñ_
- 1. t'otcadAn. On the N side of North Fork not far below the
+ 1. t'otcadAñ. On the N side of North Fork not far below the
mouth of Hulls Creek. The site was sheltered by ridges on the E and
W and by the main mountainside on the N. Four pits were counted.
This was the only site visited but the names of other villages
of the group were obtained. In their order downstream from Hulls
- Creek they are AntcAnyacbAnnAn, "pepperwood slope;" sEtcAmmi';
- nE[-l]=g=indAn; lawasonk'ait; t'AntcankyodAn. At this last there
+ Creek they are AntcAnyacbAnnAñ, "pepperwood slope;" sEtcAmmi';
+ nE[-l]=g=indAñ; lawasonk'ait; t'AntcankyodAñ. At this last there
is said to have been a large conical earth-covered lodge and many
dwellings.
-II. _t'okya kiyahAn_
+II. _t'okya kiyahAñ_
- 2. [-l]Elinkyobi', "streams flow together large in." On the
+ 2. [-l]Eliñkyobi', "streams flow together large in." On the
W side of North Fork just upstream from the mouth of Hulls Creek,
situated close to the hillside on a bench about 50 ft. higher than
the river. The site is divided by a gulch on the upstream side of
which, it was said, there had once been houses. Four distinct pits
and 3 less distinct ones were seen there.
- 3. tAntcInyasbAnnAn. Nearly opposite nando'ndAn on a point
+ 3. tAntcInyasbAnnAñ. Nearly opposite nando'ndAñ on a point
of land running toward the SW. About 75 ft. above the stream 2
pits, one above the other, were seen. No more could well have been
accommodated.
- 4. nando'ndAn. On the E side of the river and about 1/4 mi.
+ 4. nando'ndAñ. On the E side of the river and about 1/4 mi.
above the mouth of Hulls Creek, 30 ft. above the bed of North Fork.
Four house pits were counted there, one of which was 15 ft. in
diameter and 5 ft. deep. This was the village of Goodboy Jack's
@@ -2229,7 +2196,7 @@ II. _t'okya kiyahAn_
5. kAllata. Named for a big jagged rock standing N of the
village site. It was on the W side of the river 1/4 mi. N of
- tAntcInyasbAnnAn and 300 ft. higher than the river. A grove of oaks
+ tAntcInyasbAnnAñ and 300 ft. higher than the river. A grove of oaks
stands on a rounded point where 3 house pits were seen. A gulch on
the southern side furnished water in winter.
@@ -2238,7 +2205,7 @@ II. _t'okya kiyahAn_
with oaks and pepperwood trees. There is a sheer rock on the
opposite side of the river. Three pits were seen here.
- 7. tAltcAskIn. Named from a knoll, tAltcAs. Situated on the
+ 7. tAltcAskIñ. Named from a knoll, tAltcAs. Situated on the
slope of a large ridge around the end of which North Fork swings,
from flowing SE, to S. It was about 500 ft. higher than the stream
and distant from it about 1/8 mi. Here once stood an earth lodge,
@@ -2249,34 +2216,34 @@ II. _t'okya kiyahAn_
two days' travel and Indians from the main Eel R. and from the
north were present.
- 8. sAn'AnyE. Named from a very large rock standing on the
+ 8. sAñ'AnyE. Named from a very large rock standing on the
E side of the river. The village was on the W side a little
downstream from this rock. On a bench 30 ft. above the river bed
were seen 5 house pits and above were 6 more, one above the other,
on the slope. In this village lived tAntcAnyacta', who had charge
- of the earth lodge at tAltcAskIn, and si'idonta, who was "boss" of
- all the villages of the t'okya kiyahAn, especially when they camped
+ of the earth lodge at tAltcAskIñ, and si'idonta, who was "boss" of
+ all the villages of the t'okya kiyahAñ, especially when they camped
together in summertime.
[Illustration: Map 6. Villages and tribelets of the Pitch
Wailaki. Roman numerals indicate tribelets according to Goddard
(1929); arabic numerals mark village sites.]
- 9. t'AntcAntantE[-l]dAn, "pepperwood flat." About 100 yds. S
+ 9. t'AntcAntantE[-l]dAñ, "pepperwood flat." About 100 yds. S
of the large rock called kai[-l]tsotci on a small bench on the
mountainside about 1,000 ft. above North Fork. Three pits were
found. A rock shelter higher on the hillside and to the S was
pointed out. At this village, shortly before the coming of white
people, lived dA=g=a'tco, "large beard," chief of this village
- and of annEnE'tcAn, of all the t'okya kiyahAn, in fact. He was
+ and of annEnE'tcAñ, of all the t'okya kiyahAñ, in fact. He was
succeeded by his son kissEkE', who was killed by the whites.
- 10. kai[-l]tsotci canAndAn. Named for the large rock
+ 10. kai[-l]tsotci canAndAñ. Named for the large rock
kai[-l]tsotci, under the shelter of which the village stood. Four
pits were seen here and N of a small ridge were 3 others.
- 11. annEnE'tcAn. On the NE side of the river stand two huge
- rocks, the upstream one called sE[-l]tcAnnAn, the downstream one
+ 11. annEnE'tcAñ. On the NE side of the river stand two huge
+ rocks, the upstream one called sE[-l]tcAnnAñ, the downstream one
sAnAn. Between these two rocks flows a creek and on its N side, 75
ft. below the summit of the rocks, were 3 house pits in a hollow.
A little S and 100 ft. higher were found in succession 3, 2, and 5
@@ -2286,25 +2253,25 @@ II. _t'okya kiyahAn_
ravine and about 900 ft. higher than the bed of North Fork. Four
pits were found.
- 13. mIstco'ca'nAndAn. Up the hill from no. 12. It was not
+ 13. mIstco'ca'nAndAñ. Up the hill from no. 12. It was not
visited.
- 14. sE[-l]tcAnnAnt'a. Named for a high rock, sE[-l]tcAnnAn, on
+ 14. sE[-l]tcAnnAnt'a. Named for a high rock, sE[-l]tcAnnAñ, on
the S side of which there are 5 pits and, 100 yds. below, 6 more.
The site is about 700 ft. above North Fork and has a wonderful
outlook on the valley of that stream.
- 15. k'AckAntE[-l]dAn, "alder flat." On the W side of the river
+ 15. k'AckAntE[-l]dAñ, "alder flat." On the W side of the river
on a curving bench. Two pits were found close to the hillside, and
2 nearer to the stream. Downstream on a little bench there were
also 2 indistinct ones, said by Jack to have been used long ago.
- 16. sE[-l]tcAnnAn yE. At the base of the rock mentioned in no.
+ 16. sE[-l]tcAnnAñ yE. At the base of the rock mentioned in no.
14. Three pits were found on a small bench.
-III. _tc'i'ankot kiyahAn_
+III. _tc'i'añkot kiyahAñ_
- 17. lonbAstEdAn. On a flat on the S side of Casoose Cr. a
+ 17. lonbAstEdAñ. On a flat on the S side of Casoose Cr. a
short way above its mouth. There were some unoccupied buildings
there at the time of Goddard's visit. The place was seen from the
trail on the N side of the creek.
@@ -2315,7 +2282,7 @@ III. _tc'i'ankot kiyahAn_
19. Goddard gives no name or other information for this
village but it is shown on his map.
- 20. sEttcitcikItdatdAn, Named for a rock, settci. It was at
+ 20. sEttcitcikItdatdAñ, Named for a rock, settci. It was at
the base of a mountain on the N side of the creek and just above
the flood waters. It had a good SE exposure. Three pits in a row
were found.
@@ -2329,42 +2296,42 @@ III. _tc'i'ankot kiyahAn_
22. kIlkokyodAn. On the S side of the butte mentioned in no.
23 and about 100 yds. distant. Four large pits were noticed.
- 23. kIkokyokInnEdAn. Named for the bushy butte at the base of
+ 23. kIkokyokInnEdAñ. Named for the bushy butte at the base of
which the village stood. The site is 100 ft. higher than the creek,
on its NW side just below a canyon. Three pits were seen.
- 24. mAnk'AtdAn. Named from a small pond, near which are
+ 24. mAñk'AtdAñ. Named from a small pond, near which are
deserted buildings and an old orchard. A hundred yards NE of this
pond, back against the hill, 4 pits were found in a row, 2 more
above them, and 2 others near by, making 8 altogether. The last
- chief of this village was named tcAsnainInaita'.
+ chief of this village was named tcAsnainIñaita'.
25. I[-l]t'Aktcibi'. Named from black oaks. It is nearer the
creek than no. 24. The number of pits was not recorded but signs of
a village there were unmistakable.
- 26. t'AntcigIt'tcAn. On the W side of the creek nearly
+ 26. t'AntcigIt'tcAñ. On the W side of the creek nearly
opposite no. 27. It was N of a small creek with running water and
of a ridge which runs down to the main creek and terminates in a
great, nearly sheer cliff. The village site is about 500 ft. higher
than the stream. Eight pits in two rows were counted.
- 27. k'aickontE[-l]dAn. On the E side of Casoose Cr. on a flat
+ 27. k'aickontE[-l]dAñ. On the E side of Casoose Cr. on a flat
100 ft. higher than the creek, which flows just below it. The
village site is near a post which marked the old boundary between
Trinity and Mendocino counties. Two pits were seen.
- 28. tc'ianmiyE. On the E side of and 100 ft. higher than
+ 28. tc'iañmiyE. On the E side of and 100 ft. higher than
Casoose Cr. It was 100 yds. downstream from the beginning of the
canyon. Five pits were counted.
-IV. _tcokot kiyahAn_
+IV. _tcokot kiyahAñ_
The winter villages of this group were on Red Mountain Cr. Goodboy Jack
said that he did not know the village names. The impression had been
received that Salt Creek V. was inhabited but Jack said it was too cold
to live there in the winter. Presumably it was the hunting ground of the
-tcokot kiyahAn.
+tcokot kiyahAñ.
LASSIK
@@ -2471,7 +2438,7 @@ below) cannot be located, hence they have not been placed on the map.
There is some ambiguity in Merriam's notes on the status of the Lassik
living in the western part of their territory near the South Fork of
the Eel. The Sinkyone George Burt told Merriam that a group called the
-To-kub'-be ke'ah or To'-kah-be held the land on the east side of South
+To-kub´-be ke´ah or To´-kah-be held the land on the east side of South
Fork from Rocky Glen Creek south to above Garberville. This tribe was
said to be centered on the east branch of South Fork and in the Harris
region and to be a different tribe from the one on the main Eel River
@@ -2490,33 +2457,33 @@ correct name may not be assigned to each site.
_Goddard's Lassik Villages_
- 1. gastc[=i]kdun
- 2. k[=o]nte^{l}tc[=i]dun
- 3. satcin[=i]tc[=i]dun
+ 1. gastc[=i]kdûñ
+ 2. k[=o]nte^{l}tc[=i]dûñ
+ 3. satcin[=i]tc[=i]dûñ
4. naslintce
- 5. ist'etatc[=i]dun
+ 5. ist'etatc[=i]dûñ
6. t[=o]kseye
- 7. kink'utek[=o]nte^{l}dun
- 8. k'uct[=o]t[=o]dun
- 9. d[=i]y[=i]ckuk
- 10. nundukkatundun
- 11. k[=o]nte^{l}tc[=i]dun
- 12. g[=o]sn[=o]lindun
- 13. t[=o]tcadun
+ 7. kiñk'ûtek[=o]nte^{l}dûñ
+ 8. k'ûct[=o]t[=o]dûñ
+ 9. d[=i]y[=i]ckûk
+ 10. nûndûkkatûndûñ
+ 11. k[=o]nte^{l}tc[=i]dûñ
+ 12. g[=o]sn[=o]lindûñ
+ 13. t[=o]tcadûñ
14. sait[=o]tc[=i]
- 15. nunsun^{l}tc[=i]kkinne^{=e=}dun
- 16. y[=i]stcuttcadun
+ 15. nûnsûn^{l}tc[=i]kkinne^{=e=}dûñ
+ 16. y[=i]stcûttcadûñ
17. tois[=i]b[=i]
- 18. lesbatc[=i]tdun
- 19. k'ustc[=i]kdun
- 20. tcuggustatc[=i]^{=e=}
+ 18. lesbatc[=i]tdûñ
+ 19. k'ûstc[=i]kdûñ
+ 20. tcûggûstatc[=i]^{=e=}
21. lesbaitc[=i]^{=e=}
22. setatc[=i]^{=e=}
- 23. kast[=o]ntc[=i]^{=e=}dun
+ 23. kast[=o]ntc[=i]^{=e=}dûñ
Goddard lists other names, presumably for the Lassik villages, as
-follows: seku[-l]ne, tectatalindun, dultc[=i]kyacdun, t'o-todun,
-k'usnesdun, ne ga b[=i], kuttantc[=i]tc[=o]dun. The sites corresponding
+follows: sekû[-l]ne, tectatalindûñ, dûltc[=i]kyacdûñ, t'o-todûñ,
+k'ûsnesdûñ, ne ga b[=i], kûttantc[=i]tc[=o]dûñ. The sites corresponding
to these names cannot be located.
[Illustration: Map 7. Presumed Nongatl villages in the Bridgeville
@@ -2552,18 +2519,18 @@ Round Valley on the south, thus including the Athapaskan Wilakke." In
anthropological literature, however, especially in the work of Kroeber
and Goddard, this name has come to be used for the group living between
Iaqua Buttes and Mad River on the north and Dobbyn Creek on the south.
-Merriam's name for this group is Kit-tel'. He does not seem to have
+Merriam's name for this group is Kit-tel´. He does not seem to have
obtained any information from them although one of his notes mentions
the fact that the wife of George Burt, his Lolangkok Sinkyone informant,
-was a Kit-tel' woman.
+was a Kit-tel´ woman.
At times Merriam seems to have confused the Nongatl with the Lassik. In
his general statement on the Nongatl, which follows, he lists them as
-Lassik although the area in which he places them marks them as Kit-tel'
+Lassik although the area in which he places them marks them as Kit-tel´
or Nongatl.
- Las'sik ... Name (from Chief Lassik, now dead) in common use
- for a Non-ga'h^{hl} tribe occupying a rather large area, extending
+ Las´sik ... Name (from Chief Lassik, now dead) in common use
+ for a Non-ga´h^{hl} tribe occupying a rather large area, extending
from Iaqua Butte in the latitude of the mouth of Eel River,
southerly to Dobbyn Creek and to the head of Van Duzen River, and
from the eastern boundary of the Lolahnkok of Bull Creek and South
@@ -2575,12 +2542,12 @@ or Nongatl.
Larrabee Creek.
There is doubt as to the northern boundary of the so-called
- Las'sik for the reason that I have not been able to obtain the
+ Las´sik for the reason that I have not been able to obtain the
necessary vocabularies for comparison. Goddard's information points
to a division south of the Bridgeville region but I have been told
- by both the Nek'-kan-ni' of Bear River and the Lolahnk[=o]k of Bull
+ by both the Nek´-kan-ni´ of Bear River and the Lolahnk[=o]k of Bull
Creek and South Fork Eel that the language is exactly the same from
- Iaqua Butte southerly and that the languages of the Nek'-kan-ni'
+ Iaqua Butte southerly and that the languages of the Nek´-kan-ni´
and Lo-lahn-k[=o]k do not differ essentially from that of the
Larrabee Creek region.
@@ -2591,8 +2558,8 @@ or Nongatl.
However, since the entire drainage basin of Larrabee Creek is
included in their territory, it may be desirable to adopt the term
- Kos'-ten ke'-ah, by which term the Larrabee Creek band was known to
- neighbors on the south--the Set-ten-bi'-den ke-ah.
+ Kos´-ten ke´-ah, by which term the Larrabee Creek band was known to
+ neighbors on the south--the Set-ten-bi´-den ke-ah.
SUBGROUPS
@@ -2608,28 +2575,28 @@ preyed on all the neighboring peoples.
Goddard's village data indicate six other groups but do not give
boundaries. These were as follows.
- busk[=o]tk[=i]ya. In the neighborhood of Indian Cr. in the
+ bûsk[=o]tk[=i]ya. In the neighborhood of Indian Cr. in the
upper part of the drainage of Yager Cr. (map 9).
- tcillundun. On the upper reaches of North Yager Cr. (map 9).
+ tcillûndûñ. On the upper reaches of North Yager Cr. (map 9).
- bustc[=o]b[=i]k[=i]ya. In the vicinity of the junction of
+ bûstc[=o]b[=i]k[=i]ya. In the vicinity of the junction of
North and Middle Yager creeks. The language of this group was said
to be the same as that of the tcittelk[=i]ya (map 9).
- senunka. On upper Larabee Cr. in the vicinity of Blocksburg
+ senûñka. On upper Larabee Cr. in the vicinity of Blocksburg
(pl. 10, _e_, _f_). This no doubt is the same as Essene's
Kuskatundun, which was the Lassik name for the group (map 10).
tcittelk[=i]ya. On the Van Duzen R. above Bridgeville. Appears
- to be the same name as Merriam's Kit-tel'.
+ to be the same name as Merriam's Kit-tel´.
na'aitcik[=i]ya. On the Van Duzen above the tcittelk[=i]ya
group. This name appears on the Goddard map from which map 1 was
taken but is not otherwise recorded. This is evidently the same as
Essene's Nai'aitci.
- k[=o]sdunk[=i]ya. On the South Fork of the Van Duzen,
+ k[=o]sdûñk[=i]ya. On the South Fork of the Van Duzen,
including Larabee V.
@@ -2640,7 +2607,7 @@ unpublished notes (maps 7, 9, 10). This is evidently far from a complete
count but it is clear that there were about as many villages in the area
covered by these maps as in other parts of the Athabascan area.
-_busk[=o]tk[=i]ya group (1-7, map 9)_
+_bûsk[=o]tk[=i]ya group (1-7, map 9)_
1. In the swag of a large ridge running toward the SSE to the
junction of the main components of Indian Cr., perhaps a mile from
@@ -2657,7 +2624,7 @@ _busk[=o]tk[=i]ya group (1-7, map 9)_
[Illustration: Map 10. Nongatl villages in the Blocksburg
region.]
- 3. k'onuseb[=i]'. On a point running down SSW toward Indian
+ 3. k'onûseb[=i]'. On a point running down SSW toward Indian
Cr. There were two pits near the creek and two more 200 ft. up the
hill. A few large and small oaks were growing there. Water was to
be had a few yards E. Pete saw a house there when he was a boy.
@@ -2683,7 +2650,7 @@ _busk[=o]tk[=i]ya group (1-7, map 9)_
but it was pointed out by Pete as W of a big Douglas spruce tree
and a large rock. Goddard described it as above.
-_tcillundun group (8-12, map 9)_
+_tcillûndûñ group (8-12, map 9)_
8. On the slope N of North Yager Cr. close to the county road
and about 100 yds. from the bridge. There are 2 pits close to the
@@ -2705,7 +2672,7 @@ _tcillundun group (8-12, map 9)_
Pete saw 2 large deep pits. They were about 1/4 mi. downstream from
the branch where village 10 was found.
- 12. tse'duttc^{l}butta'dun. A half-mile N of North Yager Cr.
+ 12. tse'dûttc^{l}bûtta'dûñ. A half-mile N of North Yager Cr.
at the edge of Douglas spruce and tanbark oak timber. Stones used
by the Indians were lying near the water and 2 pits were found
there. To the W, on the crest of the ridge, there were 5 pits at
@@ -2715,15 +2682,15 @@ Goddard lists five more sites found in this vicinity on North Yager
Creek but they are not named and their locations are indefinite so they
will not be given here.
-_bustc[=o]b[=i]k[=i]ya group (13-18, map 9)_
+_bûstc[=o]b[=i]k[=i]ya group (13-18, map 9)_
- 13. senindusc[=i]m[=i]. On the W bank of North Yager Cr. 1/4
+ 13. senindûsc[=i]m[=i]. On the W bank of North Yager Cr. 1/4
mi. below a waterfall of the same name. Two pits were located 100
ft. above the creek in brush and timber. On the same side of the
creek but 1/4 mi. downstream were 4 more pits, in one of which a
sekal lay.
- 14. nakat[=o]dun. On the E side of North Yager Cr., on a flat
+ 14. nakat[=o]dûñ. On the E side of North Yager Cr., on a flat
now covered with huckleberry brush. Pete found 2 pits here. On the
W side of the creek, a little downstream, were 2 more pits. The
flat had been badly washed away by freshets.
@@ -2735,7 +2702,7 @@ _bustc[=o]b[=i]k[=i]ya group (13-18, map 9)_
the timber on a point running down toward Middle Yager Cr. were 4
pits.
- 17. k[=o]ntc[=o]wetc[=i]kinnedun. About 1/4 mi. N of Middle
+ 17. k[=o]ntc[=o]wetc[=i]kinnedûñ. About 1/4 mi. N of Middle
Yager Cr. On a small flat on a hillside, facing SW in open timber
above a small stream. There were 7 pits here. Pete had heard that
there used to be a village so situated.
@@ -2743,12 +2710,12 @@ _bustc[=o]b[=i]k[=i]ya group (13-18, map 9)_
18. An overhanging rock on the N side of Middle Yager Cr.
shows signs of occupation and there is a pit near by.
-_senunka group (19-35, map 10)_
+_senûñka group (19-35, map 10)_
19. On a little point 200 yds. N of Curless' house. There is
one pit. Charlie Taylor's grandmother was born here, according to
Curless, who showed the site to Goddard. This was the most northern
- village of the senunka on Larabee Cr.
+ village of the senûñka on Larabee Cr.
20. t'[=o]kintcab[=i]'. On the hillside on either side of the
stream which crosses the road about a mile S of Curless' place.
@@ -2768,7 +2735,7 @@ _senunka group (19-35, map 10)_
large plowed flat 1/4 mi. W, near Larabee Cr. Andrew's wife told
Pete of such a place where there used to be many Indians.
- 22. k'ucna'aidun (?). In a swag on the W side of a gulch lined
+ 22. k'ûcna'aidûñ (?). In a swag on the W side of a gulch lined
with Douglas spruce and tanbark oak timber with exposure toward the
S. There are 5 distinct pits.
@@ -2791,7 +2758,7 @@ _senunka group (19-35, map 10)_
27. On the N side of a large branch of Larabee Cr. from the E,
200 yds. N of where it is joined by a stream from the N. The stream
- from the E is bustadunk[=o]t. There were 3 pits among the Douglas
+ from the E is bûstadûñk[=o]t. There were 3 pits among the Douglas
spruce and black oaks.
28. On the E side of the Eel R. about 3/4 mi. N of the mouth
@@ -2823,7 +2790,7 @@ _senunka group (19-35, map 10)_
34. On the E side of the Eel R. N of the mouth of Mill Cr.
just S of a big rock. There were 2 pits.
- 35. nadaitcun. This name was supplied by Charlie in 1908 as
+ 35. nadaitcûñ. This name was supplied by Charlie in 1908 as
belonging to the village at the mouth of a large creek on the E
side of the Eel R. above Coleman Cr.
@@ -2863,13 +2830,13 @@ The Merriam notes contain a comparatively large amount of material on
the Lolangkok Sinkyone. The following general statement on that group is
taken verbatim from that source.
- The Lo-lahn'-k[=o]k. Information is from George Burt, a member
+ The Lo-lahn´-k[=o]k. Information is from George Burt, a member
of the tribe, who was raised on Bull Creek at the rancheria called
- Kahs-cho'-chin-net'-tah about seven miles upstream from Dyerville,
+ Kahs-cho´-chin-net´-tah about seven miles upstream from Dyerville,
at a place now known as Schoolhouse Flat, and who now lives near
Fortuna (1922).
- The territory of the Lo-lahn'-k[=o]k began on the north at
+ The territory of the Lo-lahn´-k[=o]k began on the north at
Shively and covered a narrow strip on the east side of the main Eel
River to Dyerville, and a much broader area on the west side, and
continued southerly on the west side of South Fork Eel River nearly
@@ -2896,14 +2863,14 @@ _a_, _b_. Whilkut women, _c_. Bear River woman from a sketch made by
Merriam in 1921. _d_. From a sketch made by Merriam of the Shelter Cove
woman named Sally Bell.]
- To'-cho'-be ke'ah is their own name and the Lolahnkok name
+ To´-cho´-be ke´ah is their own name and the Lolahnkok name
for the tribe (and village) in the Briceland region (between the
South Fork of the Eel and the coast). It is used also in a larger
sense for all bands speaking the same dialect from the west side of
the South Fork of the Eel River (in the Garberville region) to the
- coast. The Set'tenbi'den [Lassik] call this group Yis-sing'-kun-ne.
- The name of the group is pronounced To-cho'-be ke'ah by the
- Lolahn'k[=o]k and Taw-chaw'-be-ke'ah by themselves.
+ coast. The Set´tenbi´den [Lassik] call this group Yis-sing´-kun-ne.
+ The name of the group is pronounced To-cho´-be ke´ah by the
+ Lolahn´k[=o]k and Taw-chaw´-be-ke´ah by themselves.
TRIBELETS
@@ -2916,7 +2883,7 @@ village names." These names are no doubt those of tribelets.
chi-chin-kah ke-ah (Merriam). This is the name for the
tribelet between the upper waters of Bull Cr. and Elk Ridge.
- Nomland gives the name chacingu'k for the group in the ridge N of
+ Nomland gives the name chacingu´k for the group in the ridge N of
Briceland, which is evidently Elk Ridge.
yese'kuk (Nomland). This is given as the Mattole R. area,
@@ -2995,51 +2962,51 @@ in locating the sites, but I have omitted his notations because they
are no longer accurate; the maps have been changed since the time of
Goddard's original work.
- 1. lah-s[=a]-se'-te (M). At Shively on the main Eel R.
+ 1. lah-s[=a]-se´-te (M). At Shively on the main Eel R.
- 2. kah'-li-cho'-be, "growing flat" (M). At a place now called
+ 2. kah´-li-cho´-be, "growing flat" (M). At a place now called
Englewood, a small settlement 9 mi. E of Scotia bridge. The name is
said to refer to things growing up there.
- 3. seustcelindun (G). On the S bank of the main Eel not far
+ 3. seûstcelindûñ (G). On the S bank of the main Eel not far
downstream from Dyerville.
- 4. t[=o]nesdadun (G). On the NE bank of the Eel directly
- across from seustcelindun.
+ 4. t[=o]nesdadûñ (G). On the NE bank of the Eel directly
+ across from seûstcelindûñ.
5. tetcinne (G). On the E side of the Eel upstream from
- t[=o]nesdadun. A big rock, pointing downstream, is said to project
+ t[=o]nesdadûñ. A big rock, pointing downstream, is said to project
into the river there.
- 6. tuggustc[=o] dasanke (G). On the E side of the Eel S of
+ 6. tûggûstc[=o] dasañke (G). On the E side of the Eel S of
tetcinne. A large rancheria in an open place.
- 7. naltcunka (G). On the W side of Eel R. S of tuggustc[=o]
- dasanke. There is a big slide there. It is below Camp Grant on the
+ 7. naltcûñka (G). On the W side of Eel R. S of tûggûstc[=o]
+ dasañke. There is a big slide there. It is below Camp Grant on the
S side, according to Charlie, 1903.
- nahl-tsin'-kah (M). Camp Grant.
+ nahl-tsin´-kah (M). Camp Grant.
- 8. t[=o][-l]tcinyasta' (G). On the E side of the Eel about 1
- mi. above naltcunka. A large rock stands back of the village site.
+ 8. t[=o][-l]tciñyasta' (G). On the E side of the Eel about 1
+ mi. above naltcûñka. A large rock stands back of the village site.
- 9. taduttc[=i]' (G). On the E side of the Eel not far above
- t[=o][-l]tcinyasta', at the mouth of a large creek in which salmon
+ 9. tadûttc[=i]' (G). On the E side of the Eel not far above
+ t[=o][-l]tciñyasta', at the mouth of a large creek in which salmon
run (tadak[=o]k, Thompson Cr.?). Above Camp Grant.
- 10. tcillundun (G). On the E side of the Eel 1/4 mi.
- above taduttc[=i]'. An open place without a creek. (Given as
- k[=i]lundunk[=i]a by Charlie in 1903.)
+ 10. tcillûñdûñ (G). On the E side of the Eel 1/4 mi.
+ above tadûttc[=i]'. An open place without a creek. (Given as
+ k[=i]lûndûñk[=i]a by Charlie in 1903.)
11. ne'gakak, "moss"? (G). On the W side of the Eel opposite
- tcillundun.
+ tcillûñdûñ.
12. ne'tcink[=o]k (G). At the mouth of a creek on the W side
of the Eel some way above ne'gakak.
13. gactc[=o]bi', "redwoods in" (G). In a large open flat
among the redwoods on the E side of the Eel above ne'tcink[=o]k.
- Given by Charlie in 1903 as kuctc[=o]bek[=i]a on the S side.
+ Given by Charlie in 1903 as kûctc[=o]bek[=i]a on the S side.
14. On the E side of the Eel just S of a creek which flows
down a steep rough bed on a rather high bench are 4 pits. The
@@ -3048,24 +3015,24 @@ Goddard's original work.
the mouth of the creek on the N. A great timbered butte seems to
occupy the E bank of the river for several miles.
- 15. seda'dun, "rock mouth place" (G). On the E side (W also?),
+ 15. seda'dûn, "rock mouth place" (G). On the E side (W also?),
where the river flows out between rocks. A small creek is there.
About 2 mi. above gactc[=o]bi'.
_Lolangkok Sinkyone villages on South Fork (map 11)._--
- 16. [-l]tcunta'dun (G). Said to have been on the W side of
+ 16. [-l]tcûnta'dûñ (G). Said to have been on the W side of
South Fork and the S side of the Eel R., where the store and saloon
of Dyerville now stand.
- chin-tah'-tah (M). The flat occupied by Dyerville; this is no
+ chin-tah´-tah (M). The flat occupied by Dyerville; this is no
doubt the same as the name given by Goddard.
- 17. kahs-cho'-chin-net'-tah (M). A large village on Bull Cr.
+ 17. kahs-cho´-chin-net´-tah (M). A large village on Bull Cr.
about 7 mi. upstream from Dyerville. The place is now known as
Schoolhouse Flat.
- 18. [-l][=o]lunk[=i]' (G). On the S bank of Bull Cr. at its
+ 18. [-l][=o]lûñk[=i]' (G). On the S bank of Bull Cr. at its
mouth, in large redwood timber. There were 10 pits along the bank
of South Fork and the pit of a yitco', 8 paces across, about 200
yds. W of the mouth of Bull Cr. A large redwood, hollowed by
@@ -3078,29 +3045,29 @@ _Lolangkok Sinkyone villages on South Fork (map 11)._--
of one of the Indians, built a fire, cooked it, and ate it. The
best man of the Indians escaped.
- lo-lahn'-k[=o]k (M). Bull Cr. Merriam does not mention a
+ lo-lahn´-k[=o]k (M). Bull Cr. Merriam does not mention a
village at its mouth.
- 19. [-l][=o]lunk[=o]k y[=i]ban (G). On the E bank of South
+ 19. [-l][=o]lûñk[=o]k y[=i]bañ (G). On the E bank of South
Fork opposite and N of the mouth of Bull Cr. Two pits were seen
directly across from Bull Cr. and 2 about 100 yds. downstream. They
are in heavy redwood timber, but receive a good deal of sun because
they are close to the river, which flows NW at this point.
- 20. s[=o]snoibundun (G). On the E bank of South Fork about a
+ 20. s[=o]snoibûndûñ (G). On the E bank of South Fork about a
mile S of the mouth of Bull Cr. Five pits were counted in small
redwood timber, where there is a spring which supplied the village.
There used to be a yitco' here, in which Charlie remembered dancing
when he was a small boy.
- 21. nunsuntc[=o]tc[=i]', "butte large mouth" (G). On both
+ 21. nûnsûntc[=o]tc[=i]', "butte large mouth" (G). On both
sides of the mouth of Brush Cr. (Canoe Cr.) in large redwood
timber. On the N side are 6 pits, 5 of them in a row back about 30
yds. There are seven pits on the S side of the creek, some of them
much plainer than others. The father of Albert's wife, Sally, came
from this village.
- nahn'-sin-cho'-ke (M). See Place Names.
+ nahn´-sin-cho´-ke (M). See Place Names.
22. sedj[=o]cb[=i]' (G). On the E bank of South Fork, which
flows toward the W at this point. A stream from the E (Feese Cr.)
@@ -3108,70 +3075,70 @@ _Lolangkok Sinkyone villages on South Fork (map 11)._--
growing near by, which Charlie suggested were the reason for the
village's being located here. Seven pits could be distinguished;
the clearing away of timber may have obscured some others. The name
- setc[=o]sdin was also given by Charlie. Tc[=o]s means vagina, "what
+ setc[=o]sdiñ was also given by Charlie. Tc[=o]s means vagina, "what
woman has."
s[=a]-ch[=o]s-te (M). See Place Names.
- 23. gutta'bundun, named from a deep hole in the stream (G). On
+ 23. gûtta'bûndûñ, named from a deep hole in the stream (G). On
the W side of South Fork, where it flows toward the NE just below
Myer's. The site has been completely washed away. Charlie's father
belonged here and Charlie lived here when a boy. Jack, Charlie's
half-brother, was born at this village. There used to be a yitco'
and a large hollow tree in which a family used to spend the winter.
- kah-tah'-be (M). See Place Names.
+ kah-tah´-be (M). See Place Names.
- 24. tantanaik[=i]' bundun (G). On the E side of South Fork.
+ 24. tantañaik[=i]' bûndûñ (G). On the E side of South Fork.
A creek, along which are many tanbark oaks, flows into South Fork
on the opposite side and a little above. The name of the creek is
- tantanaik[=o]k (Coon Cr.). The site is just below a garden. The
+ tantañaik[=o]k (Coon Cr.). The site is just below a garden. The
place was so grown up with brakes it was impossible to count the
pits.
- 25. t[=o]dunni', "water sings" (G). On the NW corner of Myer's
+ 25. t[=o]dûnni', "water sings" (G). On the NW corner of Myer's
Flat on the right bank of South Fork, where it completes its course
toward the W and turns toward the NE. The site has been washed
away. There used to be large peppernut trees growing there. A few
- are still left. The name of Myer's Flat is kunteltc[=o]b[=i]. It is
+ are still left. The name of Myer's Flat is kûnteltc[=o]b[=i]. It is
also mentioned as kontelky[=o]b[=i].
- ken'-tes-cho'-be (M). See Place Names.
+ ken´-tes-cho´-be (M). See Place Names.
- 26. sestcicbandun (G). On the right bank of South Fork on a
+ 26. sestcicbandûñ (G). On the right bank of South Fork on a
narrow bench between the hill and that stream. There is an eddy
in the river just above, which furnished good fishing, and many
oaks are on the hills. The site received plenty of sun because the
river flows W at this point. Four pits were seen. Also given as
- sustc[=i]cb[=i], "rough like a rasp."
+ sûstc[=i]cb[=i], "rough like a rasp."
- ses-che'-is-ke (M). See Place Names.
+ ses-che´-is-ke (M). See Place Names.
- 27. sebuggunna', "rock around" (G). On the right side and
+ 27. sebûggûnna', "rock around" (G). On the right side and
close to South Fork just downstream from a rocky point around which
the river changes its direction from S to NW. Fourteen or fifteen
pits could be distinguished, most of them quite distinct.
- s[=a]-bug'-gah-nah' (M). See Place Names.
+ s[=a]-bug´-gah-nah´ (M). See Place Names.
- 28. sek[=o]ntc[=o]bandun (G). On the left side of South Fork
- nearly opposite sebuggunna'. The sandy bench is covered with
+ 28. sek[=o]ntc[=o]bandûñ (G). On the left side of South Fork
+ nearly opposite sebûggûnna'. The sandy bench is covered with
brakes. Five pits were made out. Charlie lived here for four
years after he came back from the reservation. Also mentioned as
- tanaib[=i].
+ tañaib[=i].
- 29. s[=o]ldek[=o]k bukk[=i]'d[=u]n (G). On a small flat
+ 29. s[=o]ldek[=o]k bûkk[=i]'d[=u]ñ (G). On a small flat
covered with large redwood timber on the N side of South Fork and
on the W side of Elk Creek (s[=o]ldek[=o]k), which flows into it
from the N. Seven pits were counted along the banks of the river
and the creek.
- s[=o]l'-te-che (M). See Place Names.
+ s[=o]l´-te-che (M). See Place Names.
- 30. sente[-l]tcelindun, "rock flat flows out place" (G).
+ 30. sente[-l]tcelindûñ, "rock flat flows out place" (G).
Close to the W bank of South Fork near a deep fishing place. There
are three pits between the county road and the river. Also called
- senteldun.
+ sentelduñ.
sen-t[)e]^{ch}-be (M). See Place Names.
@@ -3179,16 +3146,16 @@ _Lolangkok Sinkyone villages on South Fork (map 11)._--
Fork 100 yds. N of the mouth of Salmon Cr., in large redwoods.
The river has washed the soil away so no evidence of occupation
remains. Willow brush is now growing there. Also called
- natonank[=o]k buttc[=i]'dun.
+ natonank[=o]k bûttc[=i]'dûñ.
- sah-nah'-k[=o]k (M). Name for Salmon Cr. See Place Names.
+ sah-nah´-k[=o]k (M). Name for Salmon Cr. See Place Names.
32. tc[=i]stc[=i]bi' (G). On the E bank of South Fork opposite
the mouth of Salmon Cr. It is on the end of a ridge. Charlie had a
ne'y[=i]k' here after returning from the reservation (village site
not visited). This village was mentioned by Sam as his birthplace.
His mother may have been from here. Also referred to by Charlie as
- canak[=i]' and tcustc[=e]k[=o]ok.
+ canak[=i]' and tcûstc[=e]k[=o]ok.
33. nant'[=o]' (G). On the N side of Salmon Cr. in a bend.
Large redwoods fill the valley of the creek as well as the
@@ -3201,10 +3168,10 @@ _Lolangkok Sinkyone villages on South Fork (map 11)._--
near where Tomlinson's barn now stands. There is a spring there
near a pepperwood tree. This flat is now in peach orchard.
- 35. kaslintc[=o]'dun, "riffle large place" (G). On the N side
+ 35. kaslintc[=o]'dûñ, "riffle large place" (G). On the N side
of Salmon Cr. about 400 yds. upstream from k[=o]nte[-l]b[=i]'.
- 36. setcinnabatse tcelindun (G). On the N side of Salmon Cr.
+ 36. setcinnabatse tcelindûn (G). On the N side of Salmon Cr.
in a basin-like flat. Four pits were seen near the creek and 4 in a
row back about 50 yds. against the base of the hill. There were 2
more pits in front of the last 4, making 10 in all. There is heavy
@@ -3212,38 +3179,38 @@ _Lolangkok Sinkyone villages on South Fork (map 11)._--
creek. About 200 yds. upstream is a waterfall, which provided fine
fishing, since large salmon could not jump the falls.
- 37. bandun (G). On the end of a ridge, W of a small run lined
- with peppernut trees. About 200 yds. NE of se[-l]tcindun. There
+ 37. bandûñ (G). On the end of a ridge, W of a small run lined
+ with peppernut trees. About 200 yds. NE of se[-l]tcindûñ. There
were 5 pits, 2 of which were very large.
38. setcinnabatse (G). On a flattened end of the ridge E of
- se[-l]tcindun, 300 yds. S and a little W of it. Two pits were
+ se[-l]tcindûñ, 300 yds. S and a little W of it. Two pits were
certain.
- 39. se[-l]tcindun (G). On the E side of a gulch, in which
+ 39. se[-l]tcindûñ (G). On the E side of a gulch, in which
there was flowing water in July, about 300 yds. N of Salmon Cr.
There were 4 or 5 pits. The ground is strewn with black stones.
- 40. tcebanedun (G). On the flattened portion of a ridge, with
+ 40. tcebanedûñ (G). On the flattened portion of a ridge, with
southern exposure. Black oaks and buckeyes are growing there.
Seven pits were to be seen with black stones lying in them. Great
broken rocks lie in a gulch to the west. About 350 yds. NNW of
- se[-l]tcindun.
+ se[-l]tcindûñ.
41. setc[=o]'seye (G). A large rock, with the overhanging side
facing SE. A rim of earth showed where the house wall used to be on
the W. The E was left open. About 1/4 mi. W of the falls of Salmon
Cr.
- 42. t[=o][-l]elindun, "water flows together place" (G). On the
+ 42. t[=o][-l]elindûñ, "water flows together place" (G). On the
flat W of Salmon Cr. and W of a large creek flowing into it from
the S (South Fork Salmon Cr.). Four pits are close to the bank of
Salmon Cr. and a fifth was partly caved in. One was seen on the
lower part of the flat to the S.
- 43. nesdai'dun (G). Said to be on a side hill.
+ 43. nesdai'dûñ (G). Said to be on a side hill.
- 44. to[-l]elindun, "water comes together place" (G). Said to
+ 44. to[-l]elindûñ, "water comes together place" (G). Said to
be where three creeks join, forming the South Fork of Salmon Cr.,
about 5 mi. from its mouth. Distinguished from the village at the
mouth of the same creek by being called "small."
@@ -3251,16 +3218,16 @@ _Lolangkok Sinkyone villages on South Fork (map 11)._--
45. ses[=o]sye' (G). At the end of a ridge running down to
Salmon Cr. from the E. So close to the bank of the stream that
one pit has been undermined. Four remain. About 1/2 mi. NW of
- to[-l]elindun.
+ to[-l]elindûñ.
- 46. ne'kank[=i]' (G). In the saucer-shaped end of a ridge,
+ 46. ne'kañk[=i]' (G). In the saucer-shaped end of a ridge,
close to the E bank of Salmon Cr. and facing a little S of W.
- Opposite, a large creek, called ne'kank[=o]k, flows in from the W.
+ Opposite, a large creek, called ne'kañk[=o]k, flows in from the W.
There are 9 pits, which may still be seen. Five of them, situated
close to the base of the hill, are very large and deep. Black oaks
grow there.
- 47. ne'i[-l]ga[-l]dun, "land shinny-playing place" (G). On a
+ 47. ne'i[-l]ga[-l]dûñ, "land shinny-playing place" (G). On a
flat close to the E side of Salmon Cr., which swings around it. A
gulch heads in the cedar grove N of the Hunter ranch buildings.
Twelve or 13 pits were counted, 5 of which were quite distinct.
@@ -3271,23 +3238,23 @@ _Lolangkok Sinkyone villages on South Fork (map 11)._--
is a gulch 100 ft. S of the row of pits. Cedars, black oaks, and
buckeyes grow there. A small pond of water is E of the site.
- 49. munkkasaik[=o]k (G). On the W side of a branch of Salmon
+ 49. mûñkkasaik[=o]k (G). On the W side of a branch of Salmon
Cr. which flows from the N about 1/2 mi. W of the Burnell ranch
house. Two pits are close to the stream and 4 or 5 are 10 or 15
ft. higher. The higher ones have good sun in the winter. The trail
crosses the creek at this place.
- 50. setc'unt[=o]dun (G). On the W side of the South Fork of
- the Eel about 1/4 mi. above the mouth of Butte Cr. (nunsunk[=o]k),
+ 50. setc'ûnt[=o]dûñ (G). On the W side of the South Fork of
+ the Eel about 1/4 mi. above the mouth of Butte Cr. (nûnsûnk[=o]k),
which provided desirable fishing. A large rock stands there close
to the river. There are said to have been four houses. This site
- was not visited. It was mentioned by Charlie as sesunt[=o]; he said
+ was not visited. It was mentioned by Charlie as sesuñt[=o]; he said
it was the most southerly village of his people. Sam called it
- senuns[=i]mkuk and said it belonged in Charlie's territory.
+ senûns[=i]mkûk and said it belonged in Charlie's territory.
The first name given by Goddard is evidently related to
- Merriam's s[=a]'-chen-to'-te, "water against rock," which was said
- to be a place in the river near Goddard's setc'unt[=o]dun. See
+ Merriam's s[=a]´-chen-to´-te, "water against rock," which was said
+ to be a place in the river near Goddard's setc'ûnt[=o]dûñ. See
Place Names.
_Shelter Cove Sinkyone villages (map 12)._--The following list of
@@ -3304,14 +3271,14 @@ the last Lolangkok Sinkyone.
of Phillipsville stood here. According to Sam (1903), this was the
most northern village of his people.
- k[)a]-kes'-k[=o]k (M). Fish Cr.
+ k[)a]-kes´-k[=o]k (M). Fish Cr.
- 2. kutduntelb[=i]', "flat in" (G). At the NW part of the
+ 2. kûtdûntelb[=i]', "flat in" (G). At the NW part of the
Phillipsville flat. It is said to have been a large village. There
is fishing in an eddy just upstream. The site has been washed away
and therefore was not visited.
- ket'-tin-tel'-be (M). At a place called Phillipsville, 18 mi.
+ ket´-tin-tel´-be (M). At a place called Phillipsville, 18 mi.
S of Dyerville. The site is in an orchard on a ranch and has a fine
redwood grove and a good camping place.
@@ -3322,33 +3289,33 @@ the last Lolangkok Sinkyone.
southern sun. Large redwoods occupy the left bank of the stream. A
deep place here provided fishing.
- s[)a]-be-y[)e]' (M). The flat on the E side of South Fork, S
+ s[)a]-be-y[)e]´ (M). The flat on the E side of South Fork, S
of Phillipsville. See Place Names.
- 4. tcingulge[-l]dun (name of a tree) (G). On the right bank
+ 4. tcingûlge[-l]dûñ (name of a tree) (G). On the right bank
of South Fork just below a turn to the E. Between the road and the
river two pits were seen. There is a schoolhouse on the E side of
the road. Many eels were caught near this village.
- chig-gel'-e-yes'-ke (M). A place 1.9 mi. S of Phillipsville.
+ chig-gel´-e-yes´-ke (M). A place 1.9 mi. S of Phillipsville.
See Place Names.
- 5. da[-l]tcimmundun (G). On the right (S) bank of South Fork,
+ 5. da[-l]tcimmûndûñ (G). On the right (S) bank of South Fork,
where it flows W around a long ridge sloping down from the E.
Seven pits were counted between the county road and the river,
which may have carried others away. A large creek, seyekok (Rocky
Glen Cr.), empties N of this place. This village was mentioned as
- t'altcimmundun by Albert in 1907.
+ t'altcimmûndûñ by Albert in 1907.
[Illustration: Map 12. Villages of the Shelter Cove Sinkyone.]
- s[)e]-tes'-k[=o]k (M). Rocky Glen Cr. See Place Names.
+ s[)e]-tes´-k[=o]k (M). Rocky Glen Cr. See Place Names.
- 6. tca'lunk[=i]' (G). On the E bank of South Fork. A small
+ 6. tca'lûñk[=i]' (G). On the E bank of South Fork. A small
stream flows down from the E. Three pits were found on the N side
of it and two on the S side. The place had been plowed. Charlie
said there used to be many houses there. This village was given by
- Albert as tca'luntc[=i].
+ Albert as tca'lûntc[=i].
7. da[-l]kaik[=o]k (G). On a flat 50 yds. E of the county
bridge across Buhne Cr. (now called Dean Cr.), along both sides of
@@ -3357,8 +3324,8 @@ the last Lolangkok Sinkyone.
number. This village was mentioned by Sam in 1903 as a settlement
of his people.
- tahs-ki'-ke (M). Merriam attributes this village to the
- to-kub'-be people, who ranged E from here.
+ tahs-ki´-ke (M). Merriam attributes this village to the
+ to-kub´-be people, who ranged E from here.
8. da[-l]kaik[=i]' (G). On the W side of South Fork, opposite
the mouth of Dean Cr. Albert said there used to be a village there.
@@ -3366,12 +3333,12 @@ the last Lolangkok Sinkyone.
This is evidently the village Merriam refers to in the
paragraph above on village 7.
- 9. [-l]tuggan[=o]b[=i]' (G). On a flat on the E side of South
+ 9. [-l]tûggan[=o]b[=i]' (G). On a flat on the E side of South
Fork about 1/4 mi. above the mouth of Redwood Cr. Goddard noted
that the place had a favorable location, but did not find the pits.
Albert said there used to be a village there.
- stuk'-kan-no'-be (M). Name for the flat at this place. See
+ stuk´-kan-no´-be (M). Name for the flat at this place. See
Place Names.
10. k[=o]sc[=i]k[=i] (G). A short way below Garberville,
@@ -3379,13 +3346,13 @@ the last Lolangkok Sinkyone.
or k[=o]setc[=i]' and that it was just below Garberville on the E
side of the river. There used to be a store there.
- 11. seb[=i]yedadun, "rocks under..?... place" (G). A village
+ 11. seb[=i]yedadûñ, "rocks under..?... place" (G). A village
at Garberville.
- 12. kunte[-l]tc[=o]b[=i]', "flat large in" (G). On a flat
+ 12. kûnte[-l]tc[=o]b[=i]', "flat large in" (G). On a flat
above Garberville.
- ken-tes'-che tahng-ah'-te (M). A beautiful deep valley on
+ ken-tes´-che tahng-ah´-te (M). A beautiful deep valley on
South Fork just SW of Garberville.
13. Usal (not necessarily the native name). Not mentioned by
@@ -3395,19 +3362,19 @@ the last Lolangkok Sinkyone.
Following are a number of Shelter Cove Sinkyone villages which I have
not been able to locate precisely.
- kahs'-cho-so'-be (M). A village of the Briceland Sinkyone
+ kahs´-cho-so´-be (M). A village of the Briceland Sinkyone
on South Fork about 4 mi. S of Garberville and not in sight from
the present highway. It may not actually be one of the Briceland
Sinkyone villages.
- kaicankuk (G). On a ridge below Garberville. Information from
+ kaicañkûk (G). On a ridge below Garberville. Information from
Sam, 1903.
- [-l]tc[=i]kuk (G). On a ridge below seyadun on South Fork.
+ [-l]tc[=i]kûk (G). On a ridge below seyadûñ on South Fork.
Information from Sam, 1903.
- t[=o]kubb[=i] (G). On a ridge above Garberville. Information
- from Sam, 1903. seya(e)dun (G). On a ridge on the E side of South
+ t[=o]kûbb[=i] (G). On a ridge above Garberville. Information
+ from Sam, 1903. seya(e)dûñ (G). On a ridge on the E side of South
Fork, probably below Garberville.
@@ -3421,156 +3388,156 @@ from maps and it would even be difficult to identify them on the spot.
Merriam seems to have driven by auto from Scotia to Garberville, marking
locations in tenths of miles.
- tah'-cho. Main Eel R.
+ tah´-cho. Main Eel R.
- hah'-tin cho'-be. A stretch of land on the S side of the main
+ hah´-tin cho´-be. A stretch of land on the S side of the main
Eel extending from Scotia Bridge E at least to Brown's Mill, and S
from the river to the top of the ridge.
- kahn-so'-ti-y[)e]', "under maple trees." A big loop of the
+ kahn-so´-ti-y[)e]´, "under maple trees." A big loop of the
river 2 mi. E from Scotia Bridge.
- hah'-ting-k[=o]k. Jordan Cr., 2.2 mi. E of Scotia Bridge.
+ hah´-ting-k[=o]k. Jordan Cr., 2.2 mi. E of Scotia Bridge.
- hah'-tin cho'-be. The prairie on top of the ridge S of Jordan
+ hah´-tin cho´-be. The prairie on top of the ridge S of Jordan
Cr. An old Indian trail goes up there. [Harrow Prairie. Merriam
gives the same name for the prairie and the stretch of land above.
The stretch of land is probably a village named for the prairie.]
- ahn'-sin ken-tes'-be, "Pepperwood Flat." A flat on the S side
+ ahn´-sin ken-tes´-be, "Pepperwood Flat." A flat on the S side
of the Eel, 3 mi. E of Scotia Bridge. [Pepperwood.]
- lah'-sa tal'-k[=o]k, "Buckeye Creek." Bear Cr., nearly 6 mi. E
+ lah´-sa tal´-k[=o]k, "Buckeye Creek." Bear Cr., nearly 6 mi. E
of Scotia Bridge. "Used to be lots of salmon there."
- lah-s[=a]-se'-te. The present town of Shively.
+ lah-s[=a]-se´-te. The present town of Shively.
- bis'-kahl chum'-me. A bluff on Eel R. where the river makes a
+ bis´-kahl chum´-me. A bluff on Eel R. where the river makes a
loop to the S. About 6.3 mi. from Scotia Bridge.
- s[=a]-tahs' ch[=a]-lin'-te. An extensive gravel flat on the N
+ s[=a]-tahs´ ch[=a]-lin´-te. An extensive gravel flat on the N
side of the Eel in the curve of a big loop in the river, 6.5 mi.
from Scotia Bridge.
- s[=a]-tahs'-be. A bluff on the N side of the Eel at the
+ s[=a]-tahs´-be. A bluff on the N side of the Eel at the
railroad tunnel 6-3/4 or 7 mi. E from Scotia Bridge. Said to be a
rough place.
- ahn-sin'-tah'-be, "Pepperwood Flat." A flat on the S side of
+ ahn-sin´-tah´-be, "Pepperwood Flat." A flat on the S side of
the river 7.5 mi. E from Scotia Bridge. Place now called Pepperwood.
- ahn-sin-tah'-k[=o]k, "Pepperwood Creek." A small creek closely
+ ahn-sin-tah´-k[=o]k, "Pepperwood Creek." A small creek closely
followed by the highway, about 7.5 to 8 mi. E from Scotia Bridge.
[Evidently Chadd Cr.]
- kahs-tes'-be. Holmes' lumber camp, on S side of Eel about 7.5
+ kahs-tes´-be. Holmes' lumber camp, on S side of Eel about 7.5
mi. E of Scotia Bridge.
- slahn'-k[=o]. Larabee Creek, entering the Eel from the E.
+ slahn´-k[=o]. Larabee Creek, entering the Eel from the E.
- kah'-li-cho'-be, "growing flat." At a place called Englewood,
+ kah´-li-cho´-be, "growing flat." At a place called Englewood,
a small settlement 9 mi. E of Scotia Bridge and continuing to
Englewood Roadhouse at 9.8 mi. The name is said to refer to things
"growing up" there.
- tan'-k[=o]s tah'-te (tan'-k[=o]s means _Equisitum_). A long
+ tan´-k[=o]s tah´-te (tan´-k[=o]s means _Equisitum_). A long
ford 10.5 mi. E of Scotia Bridge. It is a long gravel bar on the
N side of the river. It is named for the abundance of Horsetail
(_Equisitum_) found there.
- s[=a]' cho'-te (sa means "rock"). A big rock projecting into
+ s[=a]´ cho´-te (sa means "rock"). A big rock projecting into
the river from the S side, 11.5 mi. from Scotia Bridge. [It appears
to be what is now called High Rock.]
- s[=a]-tah'-ting. A redwood forest and flat near the rock sa
+ s[=a]-tah´-ting. A redwood forest and flat near the rock sa
cho-te and named for that rock.
- chin-tah'-tah. An extensive flat on the S side of the Eel from
+ chin-tah´-tah. An extensive flat on the S side of the Eel from
the mouth of South Fork W, including Dyerville, 13 mi. from Scotia
Bridge.
- ts[)a]-vel'-be. An area on the S side of the Eel immediately W
- of and adjoining chin-tah'-tah.
+ ts[)a]-vel´-be. An area on the S side of the Eel immediately W
+ of and adjoining chin-tah´-tah.
- lel'-lin teg'-o-be. The junction of South Fork with the main
+ lel´-lin teg´-o-be. The junction of South Fork with the main
Eel R.
- sin'-ke-k[=o]k. The South Fork of the Eel R.
+ sin´-ke-k[=o]k. The South Fork of the Eel R.
- tah'-tung-i'-kut. South Fork railroad station.
+ tah´-tung-i´-kut. South Fork railroad station.
- nahl-tsin'-kah (nahl-tsuk'-kah). Old Camp Grant.
+ nahl-tsin´-kah (nahl-tsuk´-kah). Old Camp Grant.
- .hles-yah'-kah (les-yah'-kah). Fruitland in Elk Prairie.
+ ·hles-yah´-kah (les-yah´-kah). Fruitland in Elk Prairie.
- s[=a]-tah'-be. Eel Rock, about 12 mi. up the Eel from its
+ s[=a]-tah´-be. Eel Rock, about 12 mi. up the Eel from its
junction with South Fork.
- tah'-cho. The main Eel R.
+ tah´-cho. The main Eel R.
- nah-tah'-ting i-k[=a]. Dyerville Redwood Flat in the point
+ nah-tah´-ting i-k[=a]. Dyerville Redwood Flat in the point
between the main Eel and South Fork. The name means "pointed out,"
a descriptive term suggested by the geographical feature.
- lo-lahn'-k[=o]k. Bull Cr.
+ lo-lahn´-k[=o]k. Bull Cr.
- kahs-cho' chi-net'-tah. Schoolhouse Flat, 7 mi. up Bull Cr.
+ kahs-cho´ chi-net´-tah. Schoolhouse Flat, 7 mi. up Bull Cr.
- s[=a]'-es-ch[=a]-lin'-te, "rock run out." On the E side of
+ s[=a]´-es-ch[=a]-lin´-te, "rock run out." On the E side of
South Fork 1/2 or 3/4 mi. S of Dyerville.
- sit'-se-tahl'-ko. A small creek on the W side of South Fork
+ sit´-se-tahl´-ko. A small creek on the W side of South Fork
about 1/2 mi. S of Bull Cr. [Evidently Decker Cr.]
- s[=a]'-es'-kuk, "on top rock." A hill on the E side of South
+ s[=a]´-es´-kuk, "on top rock." A hill on the E side of South
Fork 0.9 mi. S of Dyerville.
- lah'-s[=a]-cho'-te. A straight shoot of South Fork beginning
- at s[=a]'-es'-kuk Hill 0.9 mi. S of Dyerville. Lots of eels there
+ lah´-s[=a]-cho´-te. A straight shoot of South Fork beginning
+ at s[=a]´-es´-kuk Hill 0.9 mi. S of Dyerville. Lots of eels there
in the spring.
- to-be'-ah. Schelling Camp Flat (lumber camp, garden, and
+ to-be´-ah. Schelling Camp Flat (lumber camp, garden, and
orchard) on the E side of South Fork beginning 2.2 mi. and
extending about 1/2 mi. to the S. [Evidently this is the present
town of Weott.]
[Illustration: Map 13. Place names of the Lolangkok Sinkyone.]
- nahn'-sin-cho'-ke. The big hill to be seen on the E side of
+ nahn´-sin-cho´-ke. The big hill to be seen on the E side of
South Fork 3 mi. S of Dyerville.
s[=a]-ch[=o]s-te (s[=a]-cho-st[)a]), "vulva rock." A long
gravel bar along both sides of the river and including a redwood
flat 4 mi. S of Dyerville. Named for a mark on a rock resembling a
- woman's vulva, cho'-s[=a].
+ woman's vulva, cho´-s[=a].
- che-[=o]s-cho'-te. A stretch of river 4.75 mi. S of Dyerville,
+ che-[=o]s-cho´-te. A stretch of river 4.75 mi. S of Dyerville,
including a small but good redwood flat. The name refers to foam on
the water.
- s[=a]'-boo-i-chan'-te. A big perforated rock in the river at a
+ s[=a]´-boo-i-chan´-te. A big perforated rock in the river at a
sharp bend 5.1 mi. S of Dyerville.
- kah-tah'-be. A stretch along both sides of the river 7.5 mi.
+ kah-tah´-be. A stretch along both sides of the river 7.5 mi.
S of Dyerville. It includes the State Redwood Park office building
and adjacent redwoods.
- ken'-tes-cho'-be. Myers Flat, a little over 8 mi. S of
+ ken´-tes-cho´-be. Myers Flat, a little over 8 mi. S of
Dyerville, including Myers Roadhouse. The Indians say this place
was never covered with timber.
- ses-che'-is-ke. A place 8.7 mi. S of Dyerville, above
+ ses-che´-is-ke. A place 8.7 mi. S of Dyerville, above
ken-tes-cho-be.
- s[=a]-bug'-gah-nah'. A place 9 mi. S of Dyerville where the
+ s[=a]-bug´-gah-nah´. A place 9 mi. S of Dyerville where the
river goes around rocks. [Evidently Eagle Pt.] George Burt once
lived here and his son Guy Burt was born here.
- tub'-bel-chin'-tah ch[=a]-gel-k[=o]k. A small creek 10 mi. S
+ tub´-bel-chin´-tah ch[=a]-gel-k[=o]k. A small creek 10 mi. S
of Dyerville, entering South Fork from the E just S of a bend in
the river. [Evidently Bridge Cr.]
- s[=o]l'-te-che. A place at the mouth of Elk Cr., on the E side
+ s[=o]l´-te-che. A place at the mouth of Elk Cr., on the E side
of South Fork. Includes the eastern part of Bolling Grove.
s[=o]l-te-k[=o]k. Elk Creek, entering South Fork from the E in
@@ -3579,192 +3546,192 @@ locations in tenths of miles.
sen-t[)e]^{ch}-be. A rock in the river at a small bend 11.2
mi. S of Dyerville.
- ni'-te'-t[)e] el-lah'-t[)e], "dog drowned" ... A place where a
+ ni´-te´-t[)e] el-lah´-t[)e], "dog drowned" ... A place where a
new bridge is now (1923) being built across South Fork, 12 mi. S of
Dyerville. [Evidently this refers to the bridge at Blair Grove.]
- suk'-ke-ch[=o]s kah'-me, "eagle pawn." A big flat on the W
+ suk´-ke-ch[=o]s kah´-me, "eagle pawn." A big flat on the W
side of the river 12.5 mi. S of Dyerville.
- chah'-ni-che'. Another large flat on the W side of the river,
+ chah´-ni-che´. Another large flat on the W side of the river,
13.5 mi. from Dyerville.
- sah-nah'-k[=o]k. Salmon Cr., entering South Fork from the W
+ sah-nah´-k[=o]k. Salmon Cr., entering South Fork from the W
nearly opposite Miranda.
- kahs'-cho-boo'-ah'-me. This was a small settlement in a flat
+ kahs´-cho-boo´-ah´-me. This was a small settlement in a flat
at Miranda, 14.5 mi. S of Dyerville.
- s[=a]-nan-sung' (.s[=a]-nan-tsin'-kah). Bear Butte, a
+ s[=a]-nan-sung´ (·s[=a]-nan-tsin´-kah). Bear Butte, a
conspicuous peak on the W side of South Fork, about 18 mi. S of
Dyerville.
- s[=a]'-chen-to'-te, "water against rock." A place in the river
+ s[=a]´-chen-to´-te, "water against rock." A place in the river
16 mi. S of Dyerville.
- k[)a]-kes'-k[=o]k (k[)e]-kes'-k[=o]k). Fish Cr., 16.9 mi. S of
+ k[)a]-kes´-k[=o]k (k[)e]-kes´-k[=o]k). Fish Cr., 16.9 mi. S of
Dyerville.
- kin'-tes-tah'-te. A big flat, probably a mile long and very
+ kin´-tes-tah´-te. A big flat, probably a mile long and very
broad, on the W side of the river, 17.5 mi. S of Dyerville. Just N
of Phillipsville but on the opposite side of the river.
- ket'-tin-tel'-be. A flat (now orchard and ranch) and village
+ ket´-tin-tel´-be. A flat (now orchard and ranch) and village
on the E side of South Fork, 18 mi. S of Dyerville, at a place now
called Phillipsville. It comprises a fine redwood grove and a good
camping place.
- s[)a]-be-y[)e]'. A flat on the E side of the river 0.7 mi. S
+ s[)a]-be-y[)e]´. A flat on the E side of the river 0.7 mi. S
of Phillipsville.
A mile south of Phillipsville there is a good view of Garberville Ridge,
-s[)e]-chung'-kuk, a fine ridge, part timbered and part open grassy
-hillside, which slopes west from Little Buck Mountain, n[=a]-ah-ki'-kah,
+s[)e]-chung´-kuk, a fine ridge, part timbered and part open grassy
+hillside, which slopes west from Little Buck Mountain, n[=a]-ah-ki´-kah,
the highest point, some distance back on the east.
to-be-y[)e], "prairie under." A small flat on the W side of
the river 1 mi. S of Phillipsville.
- yen-nes'-be. A place 1.6 mi. S of Phillipsville.
+ yen-nes´-be. A place 1.6 mi. S of Phillipsville.
- chig-gel'-e-yes'-ke. A place 1.9 mi. S of Phillipsville.
+ chig-gel´-e-yes´-ke. A place 1.9 mi. S of Phillipsville.
- s[)e]'-chin-k[=o]k'. A small stream probably 1.2 mi. S of
+ s[)e]´-chin-k[=o]k´. A small stream probably 1.2 mi. S of
Phillipsville. A possibility of error here. If the location is
correct, the stream is probably Ohman Cr.
- s[)e]^{hl}-ki'-k[=o]k. A creek 2.1 mi. S of Phillipsville. The
+ s[)e]^{hl}-ki´-k[=o]k. A creek 2.1 mi. S of Phillipsville. The
preceding location is probably an error and this is Ohman Cr.
- s[)e]-ki'-ke. The land S of s[)e]^{hl}-ki'-k[=o]k Creek,
+ s[)e]-ki´-ke. The land S of s[)e]^{hl}-ki´-k[=o]k Creek,
reaching to 2.5 mi. S of Phillipsville.
- s[)e]-tes'-k[=o]k, "hard rock creek." Rocky Glen Cr., 2.5 mi.
+ s[)e]-tes´-k[=o]k, "hard rock creek." Rocky Glen Cr., 2.5 mi.
S of Phillipsville.
- ki-tes'-be, "hard brush." A place 2.9 mi. S of Phillipsville.
+ ki-tes´-be, "hard brush." A place 2.9 mi. S of Phillipsville.
There is a small ranch and orchard there now (1923).
- chan-tan-che'. A place a little more than 3 mi. S of
+ chan-tan-che´. A place a little more than 3 mi. S of
Phillipsville. There are two big rocks and a creek there.
- s[)e]-to'-be. A big rock facing a high bluff 4.3 mi. S of
+ s[)e]-to´-be. A big rock facing a high bluff 4.3 mi. S of
Phillipsville.
- s[=a]-ken-nes', "talking rock." A big rock on a creek on the W
+ s[=a]-ken-nes´, "talking rock." A big rock on a creek on the W
side of the river, 5.6 mi. S of Phillipsville.
- tuk'-ke-tahk. A beautiful open and partly wooded hill on the W
+ tuk´-ke-tahk. A beautiful open and partly wooded hill on the W
side of the river 6 mi. S of Phillipsville.
- tuk'-[)a]-tah'-be. A place on the E side of the river 6 mi. S
- of Phillipsville. Named from tuk'-ke-tahk hill.
+ tuk´-[)a]-tah´-be. A place on the E side of the river 6 mi. S
+ of Phillipsville. Named from tuk´-ke-tahk hill.
- tahs-ki'-k[=o]k, "white flag creek." Dean Canyon Cr., 6.4 mi.
+ tahs-ki´-k[=o]k, "white flag creek." Dean Canyon Cr., 6.4 mi.
S of Phillipsville.
- tahs-ki'-ke. Village at the mouth of tahs-ki'-k[=o]k creek. It
- belongs to the To-kub'-be tribe.
+ tahs-ki´-ke. Village at the mouth of tahs-ki´-k[=o]k creek. It
+ belongs to the To-kub´-be tribe.
- to'-che-be. A flat on the W side of the river 7.8 mi. S of
+ to´-che-be. A flat on the W side of the river 7.8 mi. S of
Phillipsville.
- bus'-ken-nes', "cliff talking." A cliff or bluff opposite
- to'-che-be.
+ bus´-ken-nes´, "cliff talking." A cliff or bluff opposite
+ to´-che-be.
- stuk'-kan-no'-be. A big semicircular grassy flat on the E side
+ stuk´-kan-no´-be. A big semicircular grassy flat on the E side
of the river beginning about 8 mi. S of Phillipsville. The present
town of Redway.
- ahn'-chin-tah'-k[=o]k. Redwood Cr.
+ ahn´-chin-tah´-k[=o]k. Redwood Cr.
- se'-ken-t[)e]^{ch}-t[)e]. A place 9.5 mi. S of Phillipsville.
+ se´-ken-t[)e]^{ch}-t[)e]. A place 9.5 mi. S of Phillipsville.
- sah-nah'-che-chel'-le. A place and creek 9.7 mi. S of
+ sah-nah´-che-chel´-le. A place and creek 9.7 mi. S of
Phillipsville.
- bus-ki'-cho. A white bluff on the road 10 mi. S of
+ bus-ki´-cho. A white bluff on the road 10 mi. S of
Phillipsville.
- k[=o]s-kun-tes'-kah. A sloping, grassy, open flat 10.3 mi. S
- of Phillipsville. There was a To-kub'-be village here.
+ k[=o]s-kun-tes´-kah. A sloping, grassy, open flat 10.3 mi. S
+ of Phillipsville. There was a To-kub´-be village here.
- ko'-se-che'. The area on both sides of the river 10.6 mi. S of
+ ko´-se-che´. The area on both sides of the river 10.6 mi. S of
Phillipsville. Just N of the Garberville bridge across Bear Canyon.
- s[=a]-g[)e]'-ch[)e], "egg rock." A bold upright rock at the
+ s[=a]-g[)e]´-ch[)e], "egg rock." A bold upright rock at the
N end of the Garberville bridge across Bear Canyon; 10.6 mi. S of
Phillipsville.
- ken-tes'-che tahng-ah'-te. A beautiful deep valley on South
+ ken-tes´-che tahng-ah´-te. A beautiful deep valley on South
Fork just SW of Garberville. The bridge across the river on the way
to Briceland is in this valley.
- si-cho'-kuk. A large village of the To-kub'-be near the site
+ si-cho´-kuk. A large village of the To-kub´-be near the site
of the bridge across South Fork on the way from Garberville to
Briceland.
- nahs-lin'-che. An area and village in a loop of South Fork a
+ nahs-lin´-che. An area and village in a loop of South Fork a
few miles S or SW of Garberville.
- ken'-nahl-lag'-gah-k[=o]k (kan'-no-lig'-ah-k[=o]k). East
+ ken´-nahl-lag´-gah-k[=o]k (kan´-no-lig´-ah-k[=o]k). East
Branch of the South Fork of the Eel R.
- n[=a]-yahn'-kah. A hill on the W side of South Fork near the
+ n[=a]-yahn´-kah. A hill on the W side of South Fork near the
bridge over East Branch.
- kahs'-cho-so'-be. A place and village on South Fork about 4
+ kahs´-cho-so´-be. A place and village on South Fork about 4
mi. S of Garberville and 3 or 4 mi. from the highway. Not in sight
from the highway.
- kahs'-cho so'-ning-i'-be. A large redwood flat (Richardson
+ kahs´-cho so´-ning-i´-be. A large redwood flat (Richardson
Grove) on the W side of South Fork on the Humboldt side of the
Humboldt-Mendocino County line.
_West of South Fork Eel_
Bear Buttes sa-nan-sin-kah
- Bear River chahn'-k[=o]k
- Briceland to-cho'-be
- Elk Ridge chi-chin'-kah
- Mattole River mouth tah'-che
- North Fork Mattole nahn-tsin-tah'-k[=o]k
- Rainbow Peak tsa-che-be, tsa-bahng'-um
+ Bear River chahn´-k[=o]k
+ Briceland to-cho´-be
+ Elk Ridge chi-chin´-kah
+ Mattole River mouth tah´-che
+ North Fork Mattole nahn-tsin-tah´-k[=o]k
+ Rainbow Peak tsa-che-be, tsa-bahng´-um
Rainbow Ridge tsa-bung-ah
- Taylor Peak nahn-tsin'-kah
- Upper Mattole kun-sah'-ke
+ Taylor Peak nahn-tsin´-kah
+ Upper Mattole kun-sah´-ke
_On or near the Van Duzen River_
- Alton chen'-n[)a]-che
- Bald Jesse Mt. k[=o]ng-kel-tel'-kah
- Bridgeville ahn'-sin-tah'-che-be'
- Buck Mt. nahn'-tsin'-kah
- Carlotta yah-hlahn'-che
- Chalk Mt. s[=a]-til-bi'
- Chalk Mt. Ridge n[)e]-chin'-tuk-kah,
- n[=a]-chin'-t[)a]-kah
+ Alton chen´-n[)a]-che
+ Bald Jesse Mt. k[=o]ng-kel-tel´-kah
+ Bridgeville ahn´-sin-tah´-che-be´
+ Buck Mt. nahn´-tsin´-kah
+ Carlotta yah-hlahn´-che
+ Chalk Mt. s[=a]-til-bi´
+ Chalk Mt. Ridge n[)e]-chin´-tuk-kah,
+ n[=a]-chin´-t[)a]-kah
Fort Baker s[=a]-sh[=a]-be
- Iaqua region k[=o]ng-tel-kil'-k[=o]k
- Iaqua Buttes s[)e]^{hl}-kus'-[)a]-kuk
+ Iaqua region k[=o]ng-tel-kil´-k[=o]k
+ Iaqua Buttes s[)e]^{hl}-kus´-[)a]-kuk
("two points")
- Larabee Buttes yah-kah'-nik-kah
- (t[)a]'-che-kah)
- Larabee Cr. slahn'-ko
- Lawrence Cr. yah-tlahn'-k[=o]k
- (ye-tah'-nah-ling'-k[=o]k)
- Lassik Buttes tse'-nahn-tsin'-kah
- Lassik Pk. ki'-chil-kahn-kah
- Little Larabee Cr. so'-k[=o]k
- Metropolitan yah-hlahn'-kuk
- Rohnerville to-ti'-kah
- Rio Dell ken-tel-cho' (kin-tel'-te)
- Scotia kahs-cho ken-tel'-te
+ Larabee Buttes yah-kah´-nik-kah
+ (t[)a]´-che-kah)
+ Larabee Cr. slahn´-ko
+ Lawrence Cr. yah-tlahn´-k[=o]k
+ (ye-tah´-nah-ling´-k[=o]k)
+ Lassik Buttes tse´-nahn-tsin´-kah
+ Lassik Pk. ki´-chil-kahn-kah
+ Little Larabee Cr. so´-k[=o]k
+ Metropolitan yah-hlahn´-kuk
+ Rohnerville to-ti´-kah
+ Rio Dell ken-tel-cho´ (kin-tel´-te)
+ Scotia kahs-cho ken-tel´-te
Showers Pass s[=a]-ch[)a]-be
- Van Duzen R. chin'-ne-kok (ken'-ne-kok)
- Van Duzen R. mouth kin'-ne-ke
- Yager Cr. yah-'hlahn'-k[=o]k
- Yagerville chis-sis'-ahn'-tah
+ Van Duzen R. chin´-ne-kok (ken´-ne-kok)
+ Van Duzen R. mouth kin´-ne-ke
+ Yager Cr. yah-'hlahn´-k[=o]k
+ Yagerville chis-sis´-ahn´-tah
ETHNOGRAPHIC NOTES
@@ -3773,20 +3740,20 @@ _Lolangkok Sinkyone._--The following notes on the Lolangkok Sinkyone are
taken verbatim from Merriam's notes. The informant was George Burt.
The Lolahnkok did not fight much with other tribes but were
- sometimes attacked by the Ch[)e]-teg'-ge-kah of the region north of
+ sometimes attacked by the Ch[)e]-teg´-ge-kah of the region north of
Round Valley [Pitch Wailaki]; and they think the Long Valley people
also used to make raids on them to steal women.
Chief Lassik, whose name is often used in a tribal sense,
- belonged to the Kittel' tribe--a tribe reaching from Iaqua south to
+ belonged to the Kittel´ tribe--a tribe reaching from Iaqua south to
Dobbyn Creek [Nongatl].
Chalk Mountain was only a few miles east of the boundary
- between the Kittel' and the Lolahnkok, and the Lolahnkok were
+ between the Kittel´ and the Lolahnkok, and the Lolahnkok were
permitted to hunt there.
_Shelter Cove Sinkyone._--Trees are felled by means of elkhorn
- chisels called beh-cho, and stone mauls called s[=a]'tah--a very
+ chisels called beh-cho, and stone mauls called s[=a]´tah--a very
tedious and laborious operation. When the tree has fallen, the logs
are cut in lengths by the same process. Planks are split off from
these logs by driving the elkhorn wedges into the ends of the logs.
@@ -3809,11 +3776,11 @@ taken verbatim from Merriam's notes. The informant was George Burt.
places and the people planted the seeds in ashes, usually on a
burned place.
- Buckeye nuts, called lah-s[)e]', were cooked in a basket with
+ Buckeye nuts, called lah-s[)e]´, were cooked in a basket with
hot stones after the manner of acorns. They were then mashed and
kneaded into dough, which was buried for a while in fine sand.
- Wild Ginger (_Asarum_ sp.) is called tan-nas-bos'. It is good
+ Wild Ginger (_Asarum_ sp.) is called tan-nas-bos´. It is good
medicine for pain in the stomach. The leaves are pounded and soaked
in cold water. The sick person drinks plenty of this water and
vomits. After a little while he gets well and is hungry and eats.
@@ -3823,7 +3790,7 @@ taken verbatim from Merriam's notes. The informant was George Burt.
she will give in. S[=o]l is strong medicine.
An aromatic _Umbellifer_ (species not identified) is called
- s[=o]l'-che-but-tah'; the root, s[=o]l'-che. It is used for
+ s[=o]l´-che-but-tah´; the root, s[=o]l´-che. It is used for
purification and as a disinfectant. The root is burned and the
smoke wafted around to make the house more plentiful. It does not
grow on Bull Creek or South Fork Eel River but grows on Rainbow
@@ -3831,26 +3798,26 @@ taken verbatim from Merriam's notes. The informant was George Burt.
prized.
The Spotted Owl (_Strix occidentalis caurina_) is called
- kah-ko'. He is a bad bird. If he flies close to a person, the
+ kah-ko´. He is a bad bird. If he flies close to a person, the
person will faint.
- The Dove (_Zenaidura_) is called bi'-yu. His grandmother was
- burned to death. Bi'-yu was asked to gamble and replied, "I'll
+ The Dove (_Zenaidura_) is called bi´-yu. His grandmother was
+ burned to death. Bi´-yu was asked to gamble and replied, "I'll
gamble every winter; in spring and summer I'll cry." Now we always
hear the Dove cry in summer.
The Red-shafted Flicker (_Colaptes cafer_) is called
- mun'-chis-bul. He makes a rattling noise in the spring. He was told
+ mun´-chis-bul. He makes a rattling noise in the spring. He was told
that by doing this he would make the horns of the deer grow. He was
told also that when the deer became fat he would grow fat, but the
people fooled him for he did not grow fat.
The Yellow-bird (_Astragalinus tristis_) is called
- sin-sun-s[)e]-gahng-ti-ne tahs'-che, "to take away pain." If the
+ sin-sun-s[)e]-gahng-ti-ne tahs´-che, "to take away pain." If the
old folks were suffering, they would get him to sing to take the
pain away.
- The Kildeer (_Oxyechus vociferus_) is called ni'-til-yi'-che
+ The Kildeer (_Oxyechus vociferus_) is called ni´-til-yi´-che
from the necklace, ni-tal-yah, on its throat. In the long ago time
the water was very high and rough; big waves were coming in and
the people were afraid to cross in their canoes, so they got the
@@ -3859,8 +3826,8 @@ taken verbatim from Merriam's notes. The informant was George Burt.
talked about him and said he was the best and the only one to get
them across. So he took them across and saved them.
- The Coyote (_Canis latrans_), called sh[)u]'-b[)e], and the
- Shrewmole (_Neuerotrichus_ sp.), called ske'-cho, made the world and
+ The Coyote (_Canis latrans_), called sh[)u]´-b[)e], and the
+ Shrewmole (_Neürotrichus_ sp.), called ske´-cho, made the world and
the people. The Coyote had a number of children. The Shrewmole said
that when people died they should come back to live again. Coyote
said, "No, there would be too many people; when they die they had
@@ -3870,30 +3837,30 @@ taken verbatim from Merriam's notes. The informant was George Burt.
people and you wanted dead people to stay dead, so your children
cannot come back." Then Coyote cried.
- The Raccoon (_Procyon lotor_) is called nah'-ke-gis'-chah.
+ The Raccoon (_Procyon lotor_) is called nah´-ke-gis´-chah.
A long time ago he was a doctor. He was able to talk to persons
suffering severe pains and could draw the pain out. He would dance
and sing and pull out the pains and fall back. One time he took a
flint out of a sick person.
In the olden time the people tried to make the Elk (_Cervus
- roosevelti_), called y[=e]s'-cho, out of the Cottontail Rabbit
+ roosevelti_), called y[=e]s´-cho, out of the Cottontail Rabbit
(_Sylvilagus_ sp.). They put horns on his head and sent him into
the brush, but the horns stuck in the bushes and he could not move.
- Then the people called him sti'-che and told him he must always
+ Then the people called him sti´-che and told him he must always
stay in the brush.
- The Bat is called nah'-t[)a]-bahn'-se. He wears a robe of bear
+ The Bat is called nah´-t[)a]-bahn´-se. He wears a robe of bear
hide over his shoulders. A long time ago when the First People were
at war they wanted the Bat to make peace and they hired him to make
peace. The people told him to fix up good. He did so and said, "I
- am the one who can talk big." He sang ho-w[=a]'-nah han'-nah. The
+ am the one who can talk big." He sang ho-w[=a]´-nah han´-nah. The
enemy agreed, and peace was made.
Our people have songs for the Elk, Deer, Coon, Otter, Mink,
Bat, and some other animals.
- Slugs (_Arion columbianus_) are called nah'-tos. To prepare
+ Slugs (_Arion columbianus_) are called nah´-tos. To prepare
[them] for eating, a slender stick is thrust through the head to
hold the animal easily. It is then cut open lengthwise on the belly
and the dark insides removed, after which it is dried. When wanted,
@@ -3961,8 +3928,8 @@ Indian Joe Duncan, who is said to have lived at the mouth of the Mattole
River below Petrolia. Merriam seems to have visited the area in 1923.
His statement on these people, taken verbatim from his notes, follows.
- The Bett[=o]l' or Pet'-t[=o]l', as they call themselves,
- (commonly called Matt[=o]l'), inhabit the coast region from Davis
+ The Bett[=o]l´ or Pet´-t[=o]l´, as they call themselves,
+ (commonly called Matt[=o]l´), inhabit the coast region from Davis
Creek, about six miles south of Bear River, southerly to Spanish
Flat, which is about 12 miles below the mouth of Mattole River.
Their center of distribution appears to have been the Valley of
@@ -3974,24 +3941,24 @@ His statement on these people, taken verbatim from his notes, follows.
Their southern boundary, Spanish Flat, is the northern
boundary of the Shelter Cove tribe, which reached thence southerly
- to or beyond Bear Harbor. The Matt[=o]l' say that the Shelter Cove
+ to or beyond Bear Harbor. The Matt[=o]l´ say that the Shelter Cove
language is materially different from their own, and different also
from that of the Briceland Tribe, and that the Briceland language
is very hard to speak or understand. They declined to give the name
of either of these tribes.
- The eastern boundary of the Matt[=o]l' I was unable to locate
+ The eastern boundary of the Matt[=o]l´ I was unable to locate
exactly. They gave it as along or near the west base of Elk
Mountain Ridge, including the Valley of Upper North Fork Mattole
River. At the same time they gave the names of two 'tribes' or
bands as inhabiting the Rainbow Ridge and Elk Ridge region. The
Elk Ridge tribe they call S[)a]-bahng-kahng, the Rainbow Ridge
- people S[)e]-tso'-ik (from S[)e]-tso-[=e]k, Rainbow Peak). There is
+ people S[)e]-tso´-ik (from S[)e]-tso-[=e]k, Rainbow Peak). There is
uncertainty as to the relations and geographic locations of these
bands.
The tribe inhabiting the coast at Needle Rock they call
- E'-l[)e]-tung. It is the same as the Shelter Cove tribe.
+ E´-l[)e]-tung. It is the same as the Shelter Cove tribe.
TRIBELETS
@@ -4028,7 +3995,7 @@ Merriam's by (M).
This village stood in the middle of a 2-mi. stretch of sandy beach,
which reaches from gotxenin to a mile N of this village.
- 4. sedjildaxdin (G). Close up under the hill. The wind has
+ 4. sedjildaxdiñ (G). Close up under the hill. The wind has
carried away the soil, leaving a great pile of shells. Just S, a
stream comes down the hillside with only a gulch [La Rue Gulch], no
valley.
@@ -4057,7 +4024,7 @@ Merriam's by (M).
Joe. The burying place is 100 yds. N on a separate bench of the
same mountainside.
- s[)a]-be'-ah (M). On the ocean beach 1 mi. N of the mouth of
+ s[)a]-be´-ah (M). On the ocean beach 1 mi. N of the mouth of
the Mattole.
Goddard and Merriam do not give quite the same location for
@@ -4066,23 +4033,23 @@ Merriam's by (M).
[Illustration: Map 14. Villages and tribelets of the Mattole.]
- 8. beken[=o]'adin (G). This was 300 yds. S of the mouth of
+ 8. beken[=o]'adiñ (G). This was 300 yds. S of the mouth of
the Mattole R. and 100 yds E of the present surf line. There is an
elevation of broken shells and other refuse on the sandy beach. Joe
Duncan remembers seeing the village when it was inhabited.
- 9. lasaiduk (G). On the sand of the beach 1/3 mi. S of the
+ 9. lasaidûk (G). On the sand of the beach 1/3 mi. S of the
mouth of Mattole R., the second village S of there. The wind has
blown the sand and soil away exposing the shell fragments.
- 10. dzindin (G). By the mouth of a small stream 3/4 mi. S of
+ 10. dzindiñ (G). By the mouth of a small stream 3/4 mi. S of
the mouth of the Mattole R.
- 11. sastecdin (G). On a small bench N of a little stream a
+ 11. sastecdiñ (G). On a small bench N of a little stream a
mile S of the mouth of the Mattole R. Fragments of shells were to
be seen.
- 12. senalindin (G). About a mile and a half S of the mouth of
+ 12. senalindiñ (G). About a mile and a half S of the mouth of
the Mattole R.; on a small flat with a point of land S of it and a
rocky bluff to the E. Broken shells are to be seen. There are now a
hut and corral on this flat. The point S, a part of Punta Gorda, is
@@ -4139,7 +4106,7 @@ Merriam's by (M).
part of the village site. This flat was plowed for the Indians in
186..(?). There is water in a gulch W (Jim Goff Gulch).
- nes-te'-be (M). On the present Goff Ranch on a bench on the N
+ nes-te´-be (M). On the present Goff Ranch on a bench on the N
side of the Mattole R., about 3 mi. upstream from the ocean.
The names are different but the locations are identical, so
@@ -4149,7 +4116,7 @@ Merriam's by (M).
Petrolia, on the S side of the river. It was here that the Indians
settled when they came back from the reservation.
- seb'-bin-ne bug'-gah-be (M). An acorn camp on the S side of
+ seb´-bin-ne bug´-gah-be (M). An acorn camp on the S side of
the Mattole R. a little below the present Hanson place, 3 mi. from
the mouth of the river.
@@ -4172,7 +4139,7 @@ Merriam's by (M).
house, on a higher flat near the creek, has been burned. It was
here the Indian village stood.
- 25. djetxenin (G). On the N side of the North Fork of the
+ 25. djetxeniñ (G). On the N side of the North Fork of the
Mattole just W of a creek flowing into it from the N. It is at the
western end of a long crooked canyon. Under a point were five very
large distinct pits. There were evidences of occupation on the
@@ -4182,8 +4149,8 @@ Merriam's by (M).
McNutt Gulch. The inhabitants of sitc[=i]cb[=i] (no. 1) camped here
in summer to hunt. Timber and brush.
- 27. djibbedaxtukkab[=i]^{=e=} (G). On a point on the S side of
- North Fork of Mattole R. Opposite djetxenin. Joe saw people living
+ 27. djibbedaxtûkkab[=i]^{=e=} (G). On a point on the S side of
+ North Fork of Mattole R. Opposite djetxeniñ. Joe saw people living
here when he ran away from the white man who was taking him away
for a slave.
@@ -4197,7 +4164,7 @@ Merriam's by (M).
the N and two pits on the N side of the main stream 1/4 mi. below
the junction.
- 29. sedjegunk[=o][-l]din, "right angle" (?) (G). On a flat on
+ 29. sedjegûnk[=o][-l]diñ, "right angle" (?) (G). On a flat on
the N side of the Mattole R. E of the bridge. It is now occupied by
John Evarts.
@@ -4205,7 +4172,7 @@ Merriam's by (M).
flowing into the Mattole R. from the N, 3/4 mi. W of the county
bridge SE of Petrolia (Conklin Cr.).
- 31. da[-l]oidin, "wild grape place" (?) (G). At the mouth of
+ 31. da[-l]oidiñ, "wild grape place" (?) (G). At the mouth of
a creek (Indian Cr.) flowing into the Mattole R. from the SE at
the northern end of a flat nearly a mile long. Saw what may have
been pits, one on each side of the road by the duck pond near the
@@ -4216,7 +4183,7 @@ Merriam's by (M).
wide on the E side of Mattole R., which here flows N. It is at the
ford.
- 33. saiq[=o]tLundin (G). On a long flat bordering the eastern
+ 33. saiq[=o]tLûndiñ (G). On a long flat bordering the eastern
side of the Mattole R. Joe said the village was at the southern end
of the flat, which is now owned by Lee Minor.
@@ -4237,7 +4204,7 @@ Merriam's by (M).
R. The river is here no distance from the road. "Joe got very angry
when I wanted to look for pits."
- 38. [=i]kedin, "foot place" (G). On the N side of a small
+ 38. [=i]kediñ, "foot place" (G). On the N side of a small
stream flowing into the Mattole R. from the E, at the SE side of
a flat. There are two deep pits and several, less deep, on the E
side of the wagon road. A large group of buildings are on a higher
@@ -4245,7 +4212,7 @@ Merriam's by (M).
whites killed all of the inhabitants while they were fishing for
eels.
- 39. [-l][=i]gucLundin, "snakes many place" (G). Probably on
+ 39. [-l][=i]gûcLûndiñ, "snakes many place" (G). Probably on
the W side of the river where there is a large flat around which
the river flows, keeping near the high bank on the E. The road runs
along the eastern side of the river and climbs a considerable grade
@@ -4255,10 +4222,10 @@ Merriam's by (M).
end of a flat on the E side of the Mattole R. Fifteen Indians were
killed here by white people.
- 41. n[=o]wilkedin (gacdulyaidin, "like a necktie") (G). Said
+ 41. n[=o]wilkediñ (gacdûlyaidiñ, "like a necktie") (G). Said
to be situated between the Upper North Fork and the Mattole R.
- 42. djegullindin (G). On the W side of the stream coming into
+ 42. djegûllindiñ (G). On the W side of the stream coming into
Mattole R. from the S close to the Humboldt Meridian (Honeydew
Cr.). Indians may also have lived on the E side of this stream. The
application of this name is uncertain.
@@ -4290,28 +4257,28 @@ imperfect map, hence they must be used only with the greatest care.
Mattole R. at Upper Mattole. Perhaps de'kok is Squaw Cr., mentioned
in the Elk and Coyote stories. NW 1/4, sec. 30, T. 2 S., R. 1 W.
- ne'nunyadun. On the E side of the river 3 mi. above de'tci'.
+ ne'nûnyadûñ. On the E side of the river 3 mi. above de'tci'.
There are two creeks there. This may be the village, and de'tci'
the whole Upper Mattole flat. Notes say 3 mi. from Mattole, which
is Charlie's name for Petrolia.
- k'atinta'. Above ne'nunyadun on the Mattole R. at the mouth of
+ k'atinta'. Above ne'nûnyadûñ on the Mattole R. at the mouth of
kutsai'kok. NE 1/4, sec. 33, T. 2 S., R. 1 W.
- tculgunnak'e'. Some distance above k'acinta' on Mattole R.
+ tcûlgûnnak'e'. Some distance above k'acinta' on Mattole R.
- tcintcusk[=o]dun. On a hill on the E side of Mattole R.
+ tcintcûsk[=o]dûñ. On a hill on the E side of Mattole R.
- tcust[=i]m[=i]'. On the W side of the Mattole R. on a big
- flat, S of tcintcusk[=o]dun. No creek empties there.
+ tcûst[=i]m[=i]'. On the W side of the Mattole R. on a big
+ flat, S of tcintcûsk[=o]dûñ. No creek empties there.
- istannaladun. On a large flat on the Mattole R. No creek
+ istannaladûñ. On a large flat on the Mattole R. No creek
empties there.
- setugguttc[=i]'. On the E side of the Mattole R. at the mouth
+ setûggûttc[=i]'. On the E side of the Mattole R. at the mouth
of setuggukkok. Sec. 14, T. 3 S., R. 1 E.
- tcelink[=i]'. On both sides of a small creek which enters
+ tceliñk[=i]'. On both sides of a small creek which enters
a larger stream near the latter's junction from the E with the
Mattole R. The valley of the river is wide at this point. A large
group of buildings is now standing on this site. "I rode to this
@@ -4328,20 +4295,20 @@ locations. No doubt each of them corresponds to one of Goddard's, since
both men used the same informant, but I have been unable to identify the
villages either by location or name.
- tah-tah'-ke-ke. On a small flat on the S side of the Mattole
+ tah-tah´-ke-ke. On a small flat on the S side of the Mattole
R. about 1/4 mi. back from the ocean.
- tahn'-hr[=a]'-lah-be. At the mouth of the Mattole R. (on a
+ tahn'-hr[=a]´-lah-be. At the mouth of the Mattole R. (on a
lagoon near Indian Joe Duncan's place).
- yes-s[)a]-cheb'-be. On or near the site of an old barn S of
+ yes-s[)a]-cheb´-be. On or near the site of an old barn S of
the junction of the North Fork with the main Mattole R., near
Petrolia.
- e-nah-sal-li'-be. On a flat on Mattole R., 1/2 or 3/4 mi. S of
+ e-nah-sal-li´-be. On a flat on Mattole R., 1/2 or 3/4 mi. S of
Petrolia.
- choo-wil^{ch}'-kah-be. On the North Fork of the Mattole R. at
+ choo-wil^{ch}´-kah-be. On the North Fork of the Mattole R. at
Petrolia. The name tek-ko-li-be is also given for a village on the
site of present Petrolia.
@@ -4369,10 +4336,10 @@ to visit her granddaughter, Ethel Hecker, at Scotia.
Merriam gives the following brief note about these people.
- Nek'-an-ni' ... Athapaskan coast tribe formerly inhabiting
+ Nek´-an-ni´ ... Athapaskan coast tribe formerly inhabiting
Cape Mendocino and adjacent region from Bear River Hills southward
to Mattole River, and reaching inland (easterly) to the headwaters
- of the Bear River. [Nek'-an-ni' was] their own name for themselves.
+ of the Bear River. [Nek´-an-ni´ was] their own name for themselves.
TRIBELETS
@@ -4390,14 +4357,14 @@ VILLAGES
Some villages are given by Merriam (M), Nomland (1938) (N), and Goddard
(1929) (G), but most of the locations are not very certain.
- 1. chal-ko'-chah (M). Name of the village N of the mouth of
+ 1. chal-ko´-chah (M). Name of the village N of the mouth of
Bear R., used for both the place and the village.
- tc'alko' (N). Largest and most western village in the area. It
+ tc'alko´ (N). Largest and most western village in the area. It
included the flat at the mouth of Bear R.
Goddard mentions two villages as being on the ocean N of the
- mouth of Bear R. -- [-l]'adAlk'AsdAn and goldElco'dAn. He gives the
+ mouth of Bear R. -- [-l]'adAlk'AsdAñ and goldElco'dAñ. He gives the
word tc'alko as the word for Bear R. In Nomland's personal copy
of Goddard's paper (1929) she has written the word "tchankok" as
the word for Bear R. She gives the following explanation of the
@@ -4408,10 +4375,10 @@ Some villages are given by Merriam (M), Nomland (1938) (N), and Goddard
that her uncle preferred to speak Mattole. I checked Peter's words
with Isaac Duncan, my Mattole informant, and found this to be true."
- 2. s[=a]-cho-tung (s[)e]-cho'-tah) (M). On the ocean on the S
+ 2. s[=a]-cho-tung (s[)e]-cho´-tah) (M). On the ocean on the S
side of the mouth of Bear R.
- setcodAn, "rock big" (G). By the lighthouse, a populous place.
+ setcodAñ, "rock big" (G). By the lighthouse, a populous place.
The present-day lighthouse stands about 2 mi. S of the mouth of
Bear R.
@@ -4423,7 +4390,7 @@ Some villages are given by Merriam (M), Nomland (1938) (N), and Goddard
4. chil-en-ch[)e] (N). Near the present Morrison Ranch.
- chul'-l[)o]-ko (M). This was the name of the village at
+ chul´-l[)o]-ko (M). This was the name of the village at
Morrison's, 5 or 6 mi. above the mouth of Bear R.
5. sels-che'o-ch (N). About 3 or 4 mi. up the river from the
@@ -4431,9 +4398,9 @@ Some villages are given by Merriam (M), Nomland (1938) (N), and Goddard
correspond to Goddard's sEtcixEbi, "rock stand in the water", which
is not located.
- 6. seht-la (N). About 7 mi. up Bear R. from Capetown.
+ 6. seht-lá (N). About 7 mi. up Bear R. from Capetown.
- 7. ko-stah-che' (k[=o]s-tah-che') (M). Name of the camp on Oil
+ 7. ko-stah-che´ (k[=o]s-tah-che´) (M). Name of the camp on Oil
Cr.
Each author gives some additional villages, which cannot be located.
@@ -4443,11 +4410,11 @@ Each author gives some additional villages, which cannot be located.
IstE=g=nadaibi', "madrone stands place" (G).
- klaht-el-k[=o]s'-tah (M). Name of the village near the head of
+ klaht-el-k[=o]s´-tah (M). Name of the village near the head of
Bear R. (at least 15 or 20 mi. upstream). It was a large town with
a big dance house.
- [-l]'adAlk'AsdAn (G). Where a schoolhouse stands on Bear R.
+ [-l]'adAlk'AsdAñ (G). Where a schoolhouse stands on Bear R.
tlanko (N). Above chil-sheck.
@@ -4490,13 +4457,13 @@ the produce of rivers, and this fact is reflected in the placement of
their villages.
Merriam has left a relatively complete record of his visits to the group
-which I am calling Whilkut and which he called Hoil'-kut or How'-wil-kut
-and M[=a]'-we-n[)o]k. (Merriam uses various spellings.) His first visit
+which I am calling Whilkut and which he called Hoil´-kut or How´-wil-kut
+and M[=a]´-we-n[)o]k. (Merriam uses various spellings.) His first visit
to these people was in 1910. The following account is taken from his
California Journals for September 15, 1910.
Talked with several Indians at Blue Lake. The boundary between
- the Pah-te-waht [Wiyot] of Lower Mad River, and the 'Hoil'-kut or
+ the Pah-te-waht [Wiyot] of Lower Mad River, and the 'Hoil´-kut or
Ho-il-let-ha of Redwood Valley lies along North Fork of Mad River
near its mouth, between Korbel and Blue Lake. The Pah-te-waht I saw
today live on Mad River at Blue Lake (on south edge of town), while
@@ -4513,7 +4480,7 @@ from the California Journals for August 11, 1918.
proper at all. Returned to Eureka in afternoon.
Went particularly to get additional material from the Redwood
- Creek Indians ('How'-wil-kut'-ka or 'HWilkut tribe) who were living
+ Creek Indians ('How´-wil-kut´-ka or 'HWilkut tribe) who were living
in this region when I was here in September 1910 (see Calif.
Journals, Vol. 1, 90-93, Sept. 15, 1910). Tried to find O'Haniel
Bailey and John Stevens of Redwood Creek, and Stevens' daughter
@@ -4523,9 +4490,9 @@ from the California Journals for August 11, 1918.
and that his daughter Laura is married to a white man.
But after a while I found two old men of the same tribe, who
- were born and raised at the Blue Lake rancheria 'Ko-tin'-net, the
- westernmost village of the H[)a]-whil'-kut-k[=a] tribe. They call
- themselves and their language by the same name, 'Ho-tin'-net [North
+ were born and raised at the Blue Lake rancheria 'Ko-tin´-net, the
+ westernmost village of the H[)a]-whil´-kut-k[=a] tribe. They call
+ themselves and their language by the same name, 'Ho-tin´-net [North
Fork Whilkut]. One is blind and both are old. The blind man's name
is Nelinjak; the other's Denbrook. They were eating breakfast of
fried potatoes, dried fish, and coffee in their poor old shack.
@@ -4542,7 +4509,7 @@ Merriam's third visit to this group was in 1920. The following account
is from his notes.
About the middle of September, 1920, I visited the site of the
- old Hoilkut rancheria called T'chil-kahn'-ting (or T'ch-kahn'-ting)
+ old Hoilkut rancheria called T'chil-kahn´-ting (or T'ch-kahn´-ting)
on the east side of Redwood Creek near the Berry ranch, about a
quarter of a mile below the highway bridge on the road from Arcata
to Willow Creek and Hoopa. It was then abandoned, the Indians
@@ -4605,16 +4572,16 @@ Also of interest are Merriam's ideas about the position of the Whilkut
groups. The following excerpt, taken from his notes, is dated 1939, but
refers to a trip he made to Blue Lake in September, 1910.
- M[=a]'-we-n[)o]k [Mad River Whilkut] ... An Athapascan
+ M[=a]´-we-n[)o]k [Mad River Whilkut] ... An Athapascan
tribe on Mad River, reaching from the junction of North Fork
with main Mad River near Korbel (where they came in contact with
- the Pah'-te'waht of Lower Mad River [a Wiyot subgroup] and the
+ the Pah´-te´waht of Lower Mad River [a Wiyot subgroup] and the
h'Whilkut of North Fork and Redwood Valley) upstream (southward)
for many miles to the ranch of a white man named John Ahlgren,
where their territory ended. This is on or near Bug Creek.
- It was told me by a h'Whilkut ('Hoilet'-hah) who stated
- further that the M[=a]'-we-n[)o]k spoke a language so similar to
+ It was told me by a h'Whilkut ('Hoilet´-hah) who stated
+ further that the M[=a]´-we-n[)o]k spoke a language so similar to
his own that he could understand most of their talk.
The statement in the last paragraph comes from an informant Merriam had
@@ -4624,7 +4591,7 @@ the village list given for that group is derived from the second visit.
Merriam discusses the other Whilkut groups as follows.
- The Hoil'-kut or Redwood Creek Indians (commonly called
+ The Hoil´-kut or Redwood Creek Indians (commonly called
Chilula, Hwilkut, or Whilkut) were until recent years one of the
dominant Athapaskan tribes of Humboldt County in northwestern
California.
@@ -4636,17 +4603,17 @@ Merriam discusses the other Whilkut groups as follows.
the north side of the main Mad River between Blue Lake and Korbel.
Their proper tribal name as spoken by themselves is
- Hoi^{ch}-let'-kah or Ho-[=e]^{ch}-kut-k[)a], usually slurred
- to Hoil'-kut. They also call themselves Ho-[=e]^{ch}-kut
- kew-yahn'-ne-ahm, meaning Redwood Acorn eaters.
+ Hoi^{ch}-let´-kah or Ho-[=e]^{ch}-kut-k[)a], usually slurred
+ to Hoil´-kut. They also call themselves Ho-[=e]^{ch}-kut
+ kew-yahn´-ne-ahm, meaning Redwood Acorn eaters.
There are three divisions or subtribes, more or less distinct
according to the point of view: Upper Redwood, Lower Redwood, and
Blue Lakes or North Fork Mad River Indians. In their own language
they are:
- 1. The Ho-[=e]^{ch}-ke-e'-te (from Ho-[=e]^{ch}-kut,
- "Redwood", and e'-te, "north"), the Northern or Lower Redwood
+ 1. The Ho-[=e]^{ch}-ke-e´-te (from Ho-[=e]^{ch}-kut,
+ "Redwood", and e´-te, "north"), the Northern or Lower Redwood
Indians [Chilula Whilkut], inhabiting the valleys and adjacent
slopes of Redwood Creek from its mouth upstream about 12 miles to
the Tom Blair Ranch at the junction of Minor Creek--a distance in
@@ -4656,27 +4623,27 @@ Merriam discusses the other Whilkut groups as follows.
however apply it in a wider sense to both upper and lower divisions
of the Redwood Creek tribe.
- 2. The Ho-[=e]^{ch}-ki'-e-nok (from Ho-[=e]^{ch}-kut,
- "Redwood", and e'-nok, "south"), the Upper or Southern Redwoods
+ 2. The Ho-[=e]^{ch}-ki´-e-nok (from Ho-[=e]^{ch}-kut,
+ "Redwood", and e´-nok, "south"), the Upper or Southern Redwoods
[Kloki Whilkut], inhabiting the valley of Redwood Creek from Minor
Creek (Tom Blair Ranch) up southerly to the head of the river, near
Chaparral Mountain--a distance in an air line of nearly 20 miles.
- They also call themselves 'Klo-ke Ching'-ching-e'-nok, meaning
+ They also call themselves 'Klo-ke Ching´-ching-e´-nok, meaning
"Prairie place south."
- 3. The 'Ho^{ch}-tin'-net (or 'Ko-tin'-net), the Blue Lake and
+ 3. The 'Ho^{ch}-tin´-net (or 'Ko-tin´-net), the Blue Lake and
North Fork Mad River Indians [North Fork Whilkut], inhabiting the
valley of North Fork Mad River from its head to Korbel and Blue
Lake, and separated from the other divisions by a continuous lofty
ridge 2,000 to 4,000 feet in altitude. At Blue Lake they had a
- large village called Kaw-cho'-sish-tin-tang.
+ large village called Kaw-cho´-sish-tin-tang.
- South of the 'Ho^{ch}-tin'-net are the M[=a]'-we-nok [Mad
+ South of the 'Ho^{ch}-tin´-net are the M[=a]´-we-nok [Mad
R. Whilkut], a related Athapaskan tribe inhabiting the valley of
Mad River from the junction of North Fork near Korbel, southerly
(upstream) to the Algrehn Ranch on Bug Creek--a distance in a
- straight line of about 21 miles. The 'Ho^{ch}-tin'-net and the
- M[=a]'-we-nok say that their languages are so similar that either
+ straight line of about 21 miles. The 'Ho^{ch}-tin´-net and the
+ M[=a]´-we-nok say that their languages are so similar that either
can understand most of the words of the other.
The Hoilkut do not reach the coast, being separated from it by
@@ -4694,14 +4661,14 @@ Merriam discusses the other Whilkut groups as follows.
agrees with what I have been told by members of these tribes.
The Hoilkut state that their lowermost (northernmost)
- villages, Ha-wung'-ah-kut and No-l[)e]'-tin, were ten or twelve
+ villages, Ha-wung´-ah-kut and No-l[)e]´-tin, were ten or twelve
miles up from the mouth of the river. Below these they claim no
territory. Above, they had twenty-three permanent villages.
The language is uniform throughout Redwood Creek Valley except
for one or two slight differences of pronunciation. Thus the first
syllable of the tribal name as spoken by the Upper Redwoods is
- Hoi'^{ch}; by the Lower Redwoods, Ho-[=e]^{ch}.
+ Hoi´^{ch}; by the Lower Redwoods, Ho-[=e]^{ch}.
VILLAGES
@@ -4714,7 +4681,7 @@ _Mad River Whilkut villages._--All the names in this list were recorded
by either Merriam or Loud (1918), respectively designated by (M) and
(L). (See map 16.)
- 1. ti-keo-tchun'-tin (M). Village on the site of present
+ 1. ti-keo-tchun´-tin (M). Village on the site of present
Riverside.
mis-ken[=e]'huten, "bluff-?-place" (L).
@@ -4729,22 +4696,22 @@ by either Merriam or Loud (1918), respectively designated by (M) and
4. dj'[=e]ndj[=e]e-ten, dj'[=e]ndj[=e]-whot (L). Name said to
refer to a strong sweep of the wind at that place.
- 5. me'-kaw^{ch}-ting, me-ke'-aw^{ch}-ting (M). Village at Jim
+ 5. me´-kaw^{ch}-ting, me-ke´-aw^{ch}-ting (M). Village at Jim
Anderson's place about 3 mi. S of Korbel.
6. [=a]rtes-slandj[=e][=o]lin-tin, "grasshopper-?-place" (L).
Village at the mouth of Dry Cr.
7. ka-tahs-lah-ting, 'ke-ah-tahs-lah-ting (M). Village on the
- S side of Canon Cr. (in air line about 3.5 mi. S of Korbel).
+ S side of Cañon Cr. (in air line about 3.5 mi. S of Korbel).
- who'nt[=a], "houses" (L). Village at the mouth of Canon Cr.
+ who'nt[=a], "houses" (L). Village at the mouth of Cañon Cr.
8. whotsdj[=o]t[=a]che-tin (L). Name said to refer to a low
prairie. The village is 3 or 4 mi. below Maple Cr., just below
Foster Cr. There were three houses there.
- 9. ts[=a]'-te-tis'-ting (M). Camp on Mad R. at Fala ranch, 10
+ 9. ts[=a]´-te-tis´-ting (M). Camp on Mad R. at Fala ranch, 10
or 12 mi. S of Korbel. It was a camp for catching eels.
ts[=e]-didis-ten (L). Village about 2 mi. below Maple Cr.
@@ -4753,7 +4720,7 @@ by either Merriam or Loud (1918), respectively designated by (M) and
10. til-chwah-hew'-a-kut, til-tchwa-h[)u]-ut (M). Village on
Maple Cr. about 14 mi. (9 in air line) S of Korbel. Large village.
- tilch[=e]h[=u]erkut, dilcherh[=u][=e]rkut (L). Village at the
+ tilch[=e]h[=u]ërkut, dilchërh[=u][=e]rkut (L). Village at the
mouth of Maple Cr.
11. hotint[=e]lime (L). Village at the mouth of Black
@@ -4764,17 +4731,17 @@ by either Merriam or Loud (1918), respectively designated by (M) and
Cr. Merriam also lists a village at this place but he does not give
its name or other information about it.
- 13. me'-m[)e]h (M). Village at Three Cabins on Mad R. about 3
+ 13. me´-m[)e]h (M). Village at Three Cabins on Mad R. about 3
mi. above Maple Cr. On Tom Blair's Mad R. place.
14. Village near Mountain View, about 3.5 mi. S of Three
Cabins.
- 15. tseng-nah'-neng-ahl'-ting, tseng-nah'-neng-ah-ten, "rocks
+ 15. tseng-nah´-neng-ahl´-ting, tseng-nah´-neng-ah-ten, "rocks
across the river" (M). Large village at John Ahlgren's place on or
near Bug Cr. [This may be the village site shown in pl. 10, _b_.]
- 16. ituke-n[=o]le'-tin, "up-waterfall-place" (L). Village on
+ 16. ituke-n[=o]le´-tin, "up-waterfall-place" (L). Village on
Foster Cr. The same name also given to a prairie half a mile up the
creek from its mouth; ituk means "up," also "east."
@@ -4787,10 +4754,10 @@ combined work. (See map 15.)
[Illustration: Map 15. Villages of the Chilula Whilkut, North Fork
Whilkut, and Kloki Whilkut (see also map 16).]
- 1. ho-wung'-ah-kut (M). In the Bald Hills N of Redwood Cr.
+ 1. ho-wung´-ah-kut (M). In the Bald Hills N of Redwood Cr.
Northernmost and lowest village.
- x[=o]wunnakut (G). Village probably situated about a mile
+ x[=o]wûnnakût (G). Village probably situated about a mile
E of Redwood Cr. on a small flat S of a ridge along which the
Trinidad trail used to run. A small creek a short distance S,
entering Redwood Cr. from the E, would have furnished excellent
@@ -4799,10 +4766,10 @@ Whilkut, and Kloki Whilkut (see also map 16).]
this village, which was deserted many years ago, probably because
of its nearness to the trail.
- 2. no-l[)e]h'-ting (M). Village on Redwood Cr. about 12 mi.
+ 2. no-l[)e]h´-ting (M). Village on Redwood Cr. about 12 mi.
from the coast. The name means "falls."
- n[=o]ledin, "waterfall place" (G). This former large village
+ n[=o]lediñ, "waterfall place" (G). This former large village
remained occupied until 1888, when the Hill family left it and
moved to Hoopa V. The site is at the foot of a long glade which
slopes toward the creek nearly a half-mile distant. A spring N of
@@ -4821,40 +4788,40 @@ Whilkut, and Kloki Whilkut (see also map 16).]
excellent. Since the village has been abandoned, several of these
boulders have been displaced so a fall of only 3 ft. remains.
- 3. y[=i]tsinneakuttcin, "down hill on" (G). Camp site W of
- n[=o]ledin, about halfway up the ridge W of Redwood Cr. The Indians
- from n[=o]ledin used to camp there to gather the acorns of the tan
+ 3. y[=i]tsinneakûttciñ, "down hill on" (G). Camp site W of
+ n[=o]lediñ, about halfway up the ridge W of Redwood Cr. The Indians
+ from n[=o]lediñ used to camp there to gather the acorns of the tan
oak, which are plentiful among the redwood trees.
- 4. L[=o]tsx[=o]tdawillindin, "prairie water flows down place"
- (G). Summer camp about 1-1/2 mi. E of n[=o]ledin and 1/2 mi. W of
+ 4. L[=o]tsx[=o]tdawillindiñ, "prairie water flows down place"
+ (G). Summer camp about 1-1/2 mi. E of n[=o]lediñ and 1/2 mi. W of
the crest of the ridge. A hollow redwood tree used to be used as a
camping place.
- 5. tcitdeelyedin, "dancing place" (G). Glade on a ridge
+ 5. tcitdeelyediñ, "dancing place" (G). Glade on a ridge
running toward the E near a branch of Roach Cr., a tributary of the
Klamath. This camp was pointed out from a distance and its exact
location is therefore uncertain. The Indians used to go there from
- n[=o]ledin in the summer to gather seeds and in the fall for acorns.
+ n[=o]lediñ in the summer to gather seeds and in the fall for acorns.
- 6. klo-tshim'-m[)e]y (M). Camp on Redwood Cr. 1 mi. above
- no-l[)e]h'-ting.
+ 6. klo-tshim´-m[)e]y (M). Camp on Redwood Cr. 1 mi. above
+ no-l[)e]h´-ting.
L[=o]tcimme, "small glade in" (G). A former village about a
- mile upstream from n[=o]ledin and 75 yds. E of Redwood Cr., where
+ mile upstream from n[=o]lediñ and 75 yds. E of Redwood Cr., where
it stood in an opening of about an acre. Obscure depressions like
house pits were seen on the N side of the glade near a stream
which provided drinking-water. A weir for lamprey eels used to be
built in Redwood Cr. near by.
- 7. ho^{ch}-tahn-ho-lah'-ting (M). On the E side of Redwood Cr.
- above klo-tshim'-m[)e]y. There is some doubt as to its location.
+ 7. ho^{ch}-tahn-ho-lah´-ting (M). On the E side of Redwood Cr.
+ above klo-tshim´-m[)e]y. There is some doubt as to its location.
- 8. king-keo'-'hli (king-keo'-h[)e]-l[=a]) (M). Summer camp on
+ 8. king-keo´-'hli (king-keo´-h[)e]-l[=a]) (M). Summer camp on
top of the hill or ridge in Bald Hills about a mile E of Jonathan
Lyon's ranch house.
- kinky[=o]lai, "big timber point" (G). Large and important
+ kiñky[=o]lai, "big timber point" (G). Large and important
former village situated on the eastern end of a ridge above
Jonathan Lyon's ranch house and about a mile E of it. There is
timber on the northern slope of the ridge. At the edge of the
@@ -4866,69 +4833,69 @@ Whilkut, and Kloki Whilkut (see also map 16).]
His name was KiLtcil, "crazy." His wife was a Hupa woman and
perhaps for that reason the family moved to Hoopa V.
- 9. senalmatsdin, "stone round place" (G). Summer camp for
+ 9. senalmatsdiñ, "stone round place" (G). Summer camp for
gathering seeds in the glade on the S side of the main ridge E of
- kinky[=o]lai.
+ kiñky[=o]lai.
10. tesaikut, "projects to water" (G). Camp ground frequented
in the fall of the year for gathering tanoak acorns and hunting
- deer by the Indians living at n[=o]ledin and kinky[=o]lai. It is on
+ deer by the Indians living at n[=o]lediñ and kiñky[=o]lai. It is on
the NE slope of the ridge W of Tully Cr.
- 11. king-y[)e]-ke'-ke-ah-mung'-ah (king'-ke-kaw'-mung'-ah)
+ 11. king-y[)e]-ke´-ke-ah-mung´-ah (king´-ke-kaw´-mung´-ah)
(M). Village on the E side of Redwood Cr. at the mouth of Coyote
- Cr. a little above ho^{ch}-tahn-ho-lah'-ting, and a little above
+ Cr. a little above ho^{ch}-tahn-ho-lah´-ting, and a little above
Lyon's place.
- kinyukky[=o]muna, "big timber near" (G). This site was not
+ kiñyûkky[=o]mûña, "big timber near" (G). This site was not
visited. It is said to be on the N side of Coyote Cr. below a large
rock. There are said to be house pits there. Tom Hill said this
- was the village where the people who lived at kinky[=o]lai spent
+ was the village where the people who lived at kiñky[=o]lai spent
the colder months of the winter. It is unlikely that two permanent
villages were maintained by the same families. Perhaps the site of
- kinky[=o]lai is the more recent and it was formerly only a summer
+ kiñky[=o]lai is the more recent and it was formerly only a summer
camping place.
- 12. kitdiLwissakut, "fire drill on" (G). Camp used in the fall
+ 12. kitdiLwissakût, "fire drill on" (G). Camp used in the fall
for gathering acorns and hunting. Situated near the corner of the
Hoopa reservation in a glade sloping toward the S, near a spring.
- 13. new-wil-tso'-me-ah, "coyote camp" (M). Spring and summer
+ 13. new-wil-tso´-me-ah, "coyote camp" (M). Spring and summer
camp on Bald Hills Ridge.
n[=u]wils[=o]lm[=i]ye, "ground in billows under" (G).
Summer camping ground near a cold spring at the head of one of
the branches of Coyote Cr. The Indians used to come here from
- n[=o]ledin.
+ n[=o]lediñ.
- 14. ye-sin'-ning'-i-kut (e-tsin'-ning'-i-kut) (M).
+ 14. ye-sin´-ning´-i-kut (e-tsin´-ning´-i-kut) (M).
- y[=i]sinnin^{=e=} aikut, "down hill ridge runs on" (G). Site
+ y[=i]sinniñ^{=e=} aikût, "down hill ridge runs on" (G). Site
of a former village 1/2 mi. E of Redwood Cr. and about 500 ft.
higher than the creek. It is S of the main ridge S of Coyote Cr.,
at the western edge of a glade near a dry gulch. One pit was found.
It is said that Tom Hill's father lived at this village and that it
was not occupied at the time the white people came.
- 15. tsin'-tse-lah'-ting (M). Village below Stoffer's and below
- ho'-tach-ting.
+ 15. tsin´-tse-lah´-ting (M). Village below Stoffer's and below
+ ho´-tach-ting.
- tsinsilladin, "bones lie place" (G). Former village not far
+ tsinsilladiñ, "bones lie place" (G). Former village not far
from Redwood Cr. on a small flat where the ground shows signs of
having slid. Little Henry's family are said to have lived at this
village.
- 16. kittc[=u]namedin, "its ear swimming place" (G). Summer
+ 16. kittc[=u]namediñ, "its ear swimming place" (G). Summer
camp on the W side of the main ridge, about 200 ft. below its
junction with the E-W ridge N of Lacks Cr. There is a spring by a
Douglas spruce which stands by itself.
- 17. t[=o]'n-t[)e]-nahn'-ting (t[=o]n-din-nun-ting) (M). Old
+ 17. t[=o]'n-t[)e]-nahn´-ting (t[=o]n-din-nun-ting) (M). Old
village on the E side of Redwood Cr. Ned Woodward, who was born
here, tells me the village was on a side hill at or very near
Stoffer's.
- t[=o]ndinundin, "water facing place" (G). Village site on the
+ t[=o]ndinûndiñ, "water facing place" (G). Village site on the
sloping hillside about 700 yds. E of Redwood Cr. and 400 yds. N of
Lacks Cr. Seven house pits were found here. The guide, Dan Hill,
did not know of these pits, but located a village of this name
@@ -4936,20 +4903,20 @@ Whilkut, and Kloki Whilkut (see also map 16).]
first settlement in this region, is just S of this village, on a
flat between Redwood Cr. and Lacks Cr.
- 18. tcwunxaladin, "dung stands up place" (G). On the western
+ 18. tcwûñxaladiñ, "dung stands up place" (G). On the western
side of the main ridge near its crest. There is a spring in a small
flat.
- 19. ming'-kah'-te-k[)e]' (mung-kut'-te-k[)e]) (M). At Fort
- Camp at the mouth of ho-tah'^{ch}-ting Cr. (Lacks Cr.), between
+ 19. ming´-kah´-te-k[)e]´ (mung-kut´-te-k[)e]) (M). At Fort
+ Camp at the mouth of ho-tah´^{ch}-ting Cr. (Lacks Cr.), between
Lyon's and Stoffer's.
- minkutdekeyimantcintcin, "lake opposite side" (G). Summer
+ miñkûtdekeyimantcintciñ, "lake opposite side" (G). Summer
camp among the redwood trees across the creek from Albers' place,
opposite the mouth of Lacks Cr.
- 20. ho-tah'^{ch}-tin'-nek (ho'-nah^{ch}-tin-[)a]-k[)e] or
- ho-nah^{ch}-t[)e]-n[=a]'-k[)e]h), (M). Large village or summer
+ 20. ho-tah´^{ch}-tin´-nek (ho´-nah^{ch}-tin-[)a]-k[)e] or
+ ho-nah^{ch}-t[)e]-n[=a]´-k[)e]h), (M). Large village or summer
camp right at Stoffer's on the ridge about a mile above (S of)
t[=o]s-kahtch-ting (Cold Spring) and approximately midway between
Bair's and Berry's. At Stoffer's, formerly Hooker's, there is
@@ -4957,19 +4924,19 @@ Whilkut, and Kloki Whilkut (see also map 16).]
meaning "between the alders," but it appears to be a place name
only.
- 21. e-nok'-k[)a]-no'-mit-s[)a] (M). Former village on the
+ 21. e-nok´-k[)a]-no´-mit-s[)a] (M). Former village on the
Howard place.
- y[=i]nukan[=o]mittsedin, "south door place" (G). Former large
+ y[=i]nûkan[=o]mittsediñ, "south door place" (G). Former large
and important village, often mentioned in myths and tales by both
the Hupa and the Chilula. Pits were found on a flat near the creek
about 1/8 mi. SW of the Howard ranch buildings. Other pits were
said to have been obliterated near the middle of this flat.
- 22. tl[=o]^{ch}-t[=i]'k-hah-lah'-ting (M). Camp at an old
- schoolhouse 1 mi. S of e-nok'-k[)a]-no'-mit-s[)a].
+ 22. tl[=o]^{ch}-t[=i]'k-hah-lah´-ting (M). Camp at an old
+ schoolhouse 1 mi. S of e-nok´-k[)a]-no´-mit-s[)a].
- 23. h[=o]n-t[)e]^{chl}-m[)e]' (M). Camp on the E side of
+ 23. h[=o]n-t[)e]^{chl}-m[)e]´ (M). Camp on the E side of
Redwood Cr. above Lacks Cr.
x[=o]nteLme, "flat in" (G). Former village situated on a large
@@ -4984,69 +4951,69 @@ Whilkut, and Kloki Whilkut (see also map 16).]
side of Redwood Cr. near the stream. House pits were seen on the W
side of the wagon road.
- 25. klitch'-hoo-[)e]-nah'^{ch}-ting
+ 25. klitch´-hoo-[)e]-nah´^{ch}-ting
('hlit-choo-[=a]-nah^{ch}-ten; sit-choo-[)e]-nah^{ch}-ting) (M).
Former village about 3 mi. above Beaver's on the W side of Redwood
Cr. above Lacks Cr.
- Littc[=u][w=]innau[w=]din, "dust flies place" (G). Site of a
+ Littc[=u][w=]innau[w=]diñ, "dust flies place" (G). Site of a
former village on a long flat on the W side of the creek. It is
surrounded by timber, but receives the sun from the S. Little Henry
was living on the E side of the creek at the time, and said it was
his father's home.
- 26. ki'-loo^{ch}-tah^{ch}-ting (M). Camp on
+ 26. ki´-loo^{ch}-tah^{ch}-ting (M). Camp on
the E side of Redwood Cr. about 1 mi. or less S of
- klitch'-hoo-[)e]-nah'^{ch}-ting, but on the opposite bank.
+ klitch'-hoo-[)e]-nah´^{ch}-ting, but on the opposite bank.
- kail[=u][w=]ta'din, "willows among place" (G). Said to have
+ kail[=u][w=]ta'diñ, "willows among place" (G). Said to have
been a large village on a small flat about 1/4 mi. S of the last
mentioned village. There were indications of 3 or 4 house pits.
Molasses' wife said there was once a round dance house in this
village, probably the same type as in the Upper Redwood and Mad
River country.
- 27. kuff-keo'-m[)e] (M). Camp on the W side of Redwood Cr.
+ 27. kuff-keo´-m[)e] (M). Camp on the W side of Redwood Cr.
across from k[=i]'-loo^{ch}-tah^{ch}-ting.
- 28. kail[=u][w=]tceneLdin, "willows project place" (G). Former
+ 28. kail[=u][w=]tceñeLdiñ, "willows project place" (G). Former
village, which stood at the northern end of a long flat. Two plain
house pits, one of them containing stone implements, were seen.
- 29. sik'-king'-choo-ma-tah'^{ch}-ting (M). Given as about 2
+ 29. sik´-king´-choo-ma-tah´^{ch}-ting (M). Given as about 2
mi. below Tom Bair's place on the E side of Redwood Cr. Merriam
says he could not find anyone who knew of it.
- sikkintcwunmitta'din (G). Village occupied in 1914. At the
+ sikkiñtcwûñmitta'diñ (G). Village occupied in 1914. At the
time of Goddard's visit, it was the home of Tom, a famous blind
medicine man.
- 30. h[=o]s-t[)a]'-ch[)e]-m[)e] (M). Village or camp on the W
- side of Redwood Cr. about 2 mi. above k[=i]'-loo^{ch}-tah^{ch}-ting.
+ 30. h[=o]s-t[)a]´-ch[)e]-m[)e] (M). Village or camp on the W
+ side of Redwood Cr. about 2 mi. above k[=i]´-loo^{ch}-tah^{ch}-ting.
- 31. ke'-nah'-hung-tah'^{ch}-ting (M). Former big village on
+ 31. ke´-nah´-hung-tah´^{ch}-ting (M). Former big village on
the E side of Redwood Cr. just below Minor Cr.
- kinnax[=o]nta'din, "Yurok village place" (G). Important former
+ kinnax[=o]nta'diñ, "Yurok village place" (G). Important former
village on a flat bordering Redwood Cr. on the E, about 1/4 mi. N
of Tom Bair's ranch house. Four shallow pits were found. A fight
with the volunteer soldiers occurred at this village, in which one
Indian was killed.
- 32. ke-tan-nah'-tah^{ch}-ting (M). Former village on the site
+ 32. ke-tan-nah´-tah^{ch}-ting (M). Former village on the site
of Tom Bair's place.
- 33. ho-un'-kut (M). Former village on the W side of Redwood
- Cr. about 1/2 mi. from ke-tan-nah'-tah^{ch}-ting but on the
+ 33. ho-un´-kut (M). Former village on the W side of Redwood
+ Cr. about 1/2 mi. from ke-tan-nah´-tah^{ch}-ting but on the
opposite side of the creek. The name is nearly the same as that of
the lowermost village of the tribelet.
- 34. tah^{ch}-ch[=a]-nahl'-ting (M). Large village on the E
+ 34. tah^{ch}-ch[=a]-nahl´-ting (M). Large village on the E
side of Redwood Cr. just below Tom Bair's, near the big barn and
sheep corral.
- 35. tahs-ung'-ch[=a]-kut (tah^{ch}-sahn-che-ting) (M). Former
- village about 200 yds. above tah^{ch}-ch[=a]-nahl'-ting on the E
+ 35. tahs-ung´-ch[=a]-kut (tah^{ch}-sahn-che-ting) (M). Former
+ village about 200 yds. above tah^{ch}-ch[=a]-nahl´-ting on the E
side of the creek.
There are also a number of villages for which the locations are
@@ -5058,16 +5025,16 @@ and 16.
kahtch-wahn-to-ting. Summer camp.
- ke-wah'-ahn-tis-ting. Camp on the ridge at the line fence
+ ke-wah´-ahn-tis-ting. Camp on the ridge at the line fence
between Lyon's and Stoffer's ranches.
- tos-kahtch'-ting. Camp on the ridge at Cold Spring 1/2 mi.
- above ke-wah'-ahn-tis-ting.
+ tos-kahtch´-ting. Camp on the ridge at Cold Spring 1/2 mi.
+ above ke-wah´-ahn-tis-ting.
- tah^{ch}mah-no-ah'-ting. Summer camp on Bald Hills Ridge.
+ tah^{ch}mah-no-ah´-ting. Summer camp on Bald Hills Ridge.
One more village is given by both Merriam and Goddard, transcribed
-dah'-sun'-chah-kut by the former and dasuntcakut by the latter. They
+dah´-sun´-chah-kut by the former and dasûntcakût by the latter. They
both say that it was supposed to have been near village no. 31. Goddard
thinks that it was a separate name for a part of village 31 "as is
customary in this region."
@@ -5082,55 +5049,55 @@ information. Goddard's Chilula Texts (1914_b_) mentions a few villages
of this group but no locations are given, so they have not been
included. (See maps 15 and 16.)
- 36. mis'-m[)e]h (M). Former village on the E side of Redwood
- Cr. 1-1/2 mi. below kah'-kus-tah^{ch}-ting.
+ 36. mis´-m[)e]h (M). Former village on the E side of Redwood
+ Cr. 1-1/2 mi. below kah´-kus-tah^{ch}-ting.
misme, "slide in" (G). Former village situated near the creek
on the E side. Many Indians were killed here by the white people.
Perhaps that is why this village was not mentioned by some of the
informants.
- 37. kah'-kus-tah^{ch}-ting (M). Former village on Redwood Cr.
+ 37. kah´-kus-tah^{ch}-ting (M). Former village on Redwood Cr.
at the junction of Sweathouse Cr., whose name it bears. About 2 mi.
below Berry Bridge.
- kaxusta'din, "Philadelphus among place" (G). Former village of
+ kaxûsta'diñ, "Philadelphus among place" (G). Former village of
importance on a flat of about 2 ac., near the creek level on the E
side. Four house pits were found on the N side of the flat and four
others in a row about midway of the flat. Two other pits, one of
them near the creek, were probably sweathouses. The flat is called
"Sweathouse Flat" by white people. This village is considered by
- the Hupa the last of the villages of the x[=o]ilkuty[=i]dexoi,
+ the Hupa the last of the villages of the x[=o]ilkûty[=i]dexoi,
or Chilula. It was the last toward the S from which Indians were
allowed to witness the Hupa dances. The Chilula also seem to accept
this as their boundary.
- 38. t'chil-kahn'-ting (t'ch^{[-l]}-kahn'-ting;
- chis-kahn'-ting) (M). Village on the E side of Redwood Cr. just
+ 38. t'chil-kahn´-ting (t'ch^{[-l]}-kahn´-ting;
+ chis-kahn´-ting) (M). Village on the E side of Redwood Cr. just
under the Berry ranch and about 1/4 mi. below the old covered
bridge near Berry's. The village is now moved to a higher point on
the high slope 1/2 mi. farther S.
- 39. e-nuk'-k[)a]-cheng'-tish-ting (M). Former village where
+ 39. e-nuk´-k[)a]-cheng´-tish-ting (M). Former village where
the Berry ranch house now stands, on the high ground E of Redwood
Cr. Bridge.
- 40. es-tish'-chem'-m[)e]h (M). Former village on the E side of
+ 40. es-tish´-chem´-m[)e]h (M). Former village on the E side of
Redwood Cr. about 4 mi. above Berry Bridge.
- 41. tsin'-tes-'ki'-m[)e]h (M). Village on the E side of
- Redwood Cr. a little below mes-t[)a]-tim'-teng.
+ 41. tsin´-tes-'ki´-m[)e]h (M). Village on the E side of
+ Redwood Cr. a little below mes-t[)a]-tim´-teng.
- 42. mes-t[)a]-tim'-teng (M). Former village on the E side of
- Redwood Cr. above es-tish'-chem'-m[)e]h.
+ 42. mes-t[)a]-tim´-teng (M). Former village on the E side of
+ Redwood Cr. above es-tish´-chem´-m[)e]h.
- 43. tah-nah'-nah-kut (M). Village on the E side back from the
- creek and above mes-t[)a]-tim'-teng.
+ 43. tah-nah´-nah-kut (M). Village on the E side back from the
+ creek and above mes-t[)a]-tim´-teng.
- 44. chim-mah'-non'-ah-kut (M). Former village on the E side of
+ 44. chim-mah´-non´-ah-kut (M). Former village on the E side of
Redwood Cr. at Bonny Cragan's ranch.
- 45. ni'-is-'kwahl'-l[)a]-kut (M). Former village at the head
+ 45. ni´-is-'kwahl´-l[)a]-kut (M). Former village at the head
of Redwood Cr. The last and southernmost village of the group. A
view of the territory here is shown in pl. 10, _d_.
@@ -5138,19 +5105,19 @@ Merriam lists for this group five other villages, which could not be
located. Presumably they are in correct sequence between village no. 44
and village no. 45.
- ts[=a]'-nah-ti'-[)a]-kut. Village on the E side of Redwood Cr.
+ ts[=a]´-nah-ti´-[)a]-kut. Village on the E side of Redwood Cr.
far up, near Chaparral Mt.
- 'klesh-mah'-kut. Former village on the ridge on the E side of
+ 'klesh-mah´-kut. Former village on the ridge on the E side of
Redwood Cr.
- m[=a]'-m[=a]-[)a]-kut. Former big village on m[=a]'-ma-kut
+ m[=a]´-m[=a]-[)a]-kut. Former big village on m[=a]´-ma-kut
creek.
'klew-taw-m[)e]-ting. Former village on the E side of Redwood
Cr.
- nahs-kah'-nah-kut. Former village high up on Redwood Cr.
+ nahs-kah´-nah-kut. Former village high up on Redwood Cr.
_North Fork villages._--The information on this group comes from
Merriam's notes (M) and from Loud (1918) (L). (See map 15.)
@@ -5162,7 +5129,7 @@ Hupa, and Kloki Whilkut. (See also maps 15 and 17).]
47. kaw-cho'-sish-tin-tang (M). Large village at Blue L.
- 48. me-k[=a]'-t[)a]-met (M). Village on North Fork Mad R.
+ 48. me-k[=a]´-t[)a]-met (M). Village on North Fork Mad R.
between Korbel and Riverside (nearer Riverside).
mik[=e]time (L). Name said to refer to being behind North Fork
@@ -5174,7 +5141,7 @@ Hupa, and Kloki Whilkut. (See also maps 15 and 17).]
50. hoo-tso'-e-choo'-kah (M). Village (or camp) on the site of
the present store at Korbel.
- 51. ki'loo-whit'-teng (M). Fishing camp on North Fork Mad R.
+ 51. ki'loo-whit´-teng (M). Fishing camp on North Fork Mad R.
1/4 or 1/2 mi. above Korbel (where gum trees are, just below picnic
ground).
@@ -5184,7 +5151,7 @@ Hupa, and Kloki Whilkut. (See also maps 15 and 17).]
gestAkAt (L). Name said to refer to a deep fishing hole.
- 53. noo-l[)e]h'-m[)e]h (M). Fishing camp at falls about 1/2
+ 53. noo-l[)e]h´-m[)e]h (M). Fishing camp at falls about 1/2
mi. above Korbel picnic ground. Only one kind of salmon can get up
these falls.
@@ -5246,8 +5213,8 @@ fact may well have been due to the double salmon run.
Merriam's estimate of the position of the Hupa, given below, is taken
verbatim from his notes.
- _The Tin'-nung-hen-n[=a]'-o or Hoopah._--The Hoopah proper,
- who call themselves not Hoopah but Tin'-nung-hen-n[=a]'-o, occupy
+ _The Tin´-nung-hen-n[=a]´-o or Hoopah._--The Hoopah proper,
+ who call themselves not Hoopah but Tin´-nung-hen-n[=a]´-o, occupy
the lower part of Trinity River and tributary streams from the
mouth of South Fork Trinity northerly to Bull Creek--a distance of
about 20 miles. On the west they extend to the summit of the long
@@ -5270,19 +5237,19 @@ verbatim from his notes.
of Trinity River, and a few grassy slopes on some of the ridges;
elsewhere the forest is continuous.
- The Tin'-nung-hen-n[=a]'-o are in contact with five tribes
- belonging to three linguistic stocks, namely: the Po-lik'-lah
- (often called "Yurok") on the north; the Kar'ok on the northeast;
- the Athapaskan E'-tahk-n[)a]-lin'-n[)a]-kah on the east [I have
+ The Tin´-nung-hen-n[=a]´-o are in contact with five tribes
+ belonging to three linguistic stocks, namely: the Po-lik´-lah
+ (often called "Yurok") on the north; the Kar´ok on the northeast;
+ the Athapaskan E´-tahk-n[)a]-lin´-n[)a]-kah on the east [I have
not been able to identify this group. According to Merriam's
map and according to his own testimony (Merriam, 1930) the Hupa
are bordered on the east by the Shastan Tlo-hom-tah-hoi; the
- Athapaskan Ts'[)a]-nung-wh[)a] [Southern Hupa] on the south, and
+ Athapaskan Ts´[)a]-nung-wh[)a] [Southern Hupa] on the south, and
the Athapaskan 'Hwilkut [Chilula] on the west.]
- _The Ts'[)a]-nung-wh[)a]._--(An Athapaskan tribe closely
- related to the Hoopah.) The territory of the Ts'[)a]-nung-wh[)a]
- lies directly south of the Tin'-nung-hen-n[=a]'-o or Hoopah proper,
+ _The Ts´[)a]-nung-wh[)a]._--(An Athapaskan tribe closely
+ related to the Hoopah.) The territory of the Ts´[)a]-nung-wh[)a]
+ lies directly south of the Tin´-nung-hen-n[=a]´-o or Hoopah proper,
embracing the drainage basin of South Fork Trinity River from
Grouse Creek to the junction of South Fork with the main Trinity,
and including also the rather narrow strip between South Fork
@@ -5290,8 +5257,8 @@ verbatim from his notes.
Flat. At the mouth of South Fork they crossed the main Trinity
and claimed a narrow strip two or three miles in length on the
north side of the canyon where two of their villages were located,
- Ti'-koo-et-sil'-lah-kut on the high bench opposite the mouth of
- South Fork, and Me'-m[)e]h, on the site of the present Fountain
+ Ti´-koo-et-sil´-lah-kut on the high bench opposite the mouth of
+ South Fork, and Me´-m[)e]h, on the site of the present Fountain
Ranch about 1-1/2 miles east of the other. Their western boundary
was the divide between the tributaries of South Fork Trinity and
those of Redwood Creek (a little west of the courses of Madden
@@ -5301,7 +5268,7 @@ verbatim from his notes.
northeasterly and following Mill Creek to the main Trinity at Cedar
Flat--thus including the Burnt Ranch country.
- The land of the Ts'[)a]-nung-wh[)a] is mountainous and
+ The land of the Ts´[)a]-nung-wh[)a] is mountainous and
forested, and the principal streams flow in deep canyons. It is
roughly circular in outline, and of small extent, measuring in
an air line hardly 15 miles in either direction--north-south or
@@ -5312,10 +5279,10 @@ verbatim from his notes.
Their language differs only slightly from that of the Hoopah.
The Tsa-nung-wha were in contact with four tribes:
- the Tin'-nung-hen-n[=a]'-o or Hoopah on the north,
- E'-tahk-n[)a]-lin'-n[)a]-kah [Tlo-hom-tah-hoi] and Che-ma-re'-ko
- [Chimariko] on the northeast, the Che-ma-re'-ko on the east and
- south, the 'Hwi'l-kut [Chilula] on the west.
+ the Tin´-nung-hen-n[=a]´-o or Hoopah on the north,
+ E´-tahk-n[)a]-lin´-n[)a]-kah [Tlo-hom-tah-hoi] and Che-ma-re´-ko
+ [Chimariko] on the northeast, the Che-ma-re´-ko on the east and
+ south, the 'Hwi´l-kut [Chilula] on the west.
The following account of Merriam's first visit to the Hoopa Indian
Reservation is taken from his California Journal, Vol. 2, September 5,
@@ -5398,7 +5365,7 @@ _Natinuwhe Villages (map 17)_
1. hon-sah-tung (M). Former village on the E bank of the
Trinity R. at the N end of Hoopa V.
- xonsadin (G), "deep water place." Near the beginning of the
+ xonsadiñ (G), "deep water place." Near the beginning of the
canyon on the right bank at the N end of the valley.
honsading, "deep pool place" (C). On the E bank of the Trinity
@@ -5411,8 +5378,8 @@ _Natinuwhe Villages (map 17)_
[Illustration: Map 17. Villages of the Hupa and South Fork
Hupa (see also map 16).]
- 2. dakisxankut (G). On the opposite side of the Trinity R.
- from xonsadin at the base of Bald Hill was a village, the site of
+ 2. dakisxankût (G). On the opposite side of the Trinity R.
+ from xonsadiñ at the base of Bald Hill was a village, the site of
which is now entirely grown up to trees and brush. Goddard shows 7
houses here.
@@ -5421,7 +5388,7 @@ _Natinuwhe Villages (map 17)_
3. kin-choo-whu-kut (M). On the E side of the Trinity near the
N end of Hoopa V. and just below the mouth of Mill Cr.
- kintc[=u]whwikut, "on a nose" (G). This village occupies a
+ kintc[=u]whwikût, "on a nose" (G). This village occupies a
point of land on the E bank just below the mouth of Mill Cr. Eight
houses are shown at this village.
@@ -5433,8 +5400,8 @@ _Natinuwhe Villages (map 17)_
4. cha-en-ta-ko-ting, "flopped out" (M). Former village on the
W bank of the Trinity R. a little above Socktish Cr.
- tceindeqotdin, "place where he was dug up" (G). This village
- was a short distance below meskut. Its name refers to a well-known
+ tceindeqotdiñ, "place where he was dug up" (G). This village
+ was a short distance below meskût. Its name refers to a well-known
myth (see Goddard, 1904). Goddard shows 12 houses at this village.
cheindekhoting (C), "dug out place." On the W bank between
@@ -5445,8 +5412,8 @@ _Natinuwhe Villages (map 17)_
5. mis-kut (M). On the E side below Hostler Cr.
- meskut (G). This village was on the E side of the river and
- about a mile below takimiLdin. It "shows signs of once having been
+ meskût (G). This village was on the E side of the river and
+ about a mile below takimiLdiñ. It "shows signs of once having been
occupied by many houses." Nine of them are shown.
miskut, "bluff upon" (C). On the E bank on a bluff midway
@@ -5460,7 +5427,7 @@ _Natinuwhe Villages (map 17)_
situated on the E bank of the Trinity a little above Hostler Cr.
Contained a large ceremonial house.
- takimiLdin, "place of the acorn feast" (G). A short distance
+ takimiLdiñ, "place of the acorn feast" (G). A short distance
below Tsewenaldin on the E bank. It is known as the Hostler Ranch.
This is the religious center for the whole valley. Here there
still stand the xonta nikyao, "house big," and the taikuw nakyao,
@@ -5490,7 +5457,7 @@ _Natinuwhe Villages (map 17)_
7. tsa-wun-al-mit-tung (M). Former village on the E side of
the Trinity in the middle of the valley.
- tsewenaldin (G). This was a large settlement on the E bank
+ tseweñaldiñ (G). This was a large settlement on the E bank
about a mile below toLtsasdin. It is translated by English tongues
into Senalton. There are many traces of houses here, but the people
were all killed or scattered in the troubled times of the 'sixties.
@@ -5508,7 +5475,7 @@ _Tinuheneu Villages (map 17)_
8. tol-skots-a-tung (M). Former village on the W side of the
Trinity S of the mouth of Supply Cr.
- t[=o]Ltsasdin (G). There are evidences of this village on
+ t[=o]Ltsasdiñ (G). There are evidences of this village on
the left bank a little S of the mouth of Supply Cr. It has long
been deserted. A prison camp was maintained near this site by the
military.
@@ -5524,10 +5491,10 @@ _Tinuheneu Villages (map 17)_
head town, ma-til-le-tung was the big boat ranch of the Hupa and
was named for ma-til, dugout canoe.
- medildin, "place of boats" (G). Just below xowunkut the river
+ medildiñ, "place of boats" (G). Just below xowûñkût the river
swings back to the W, meets a spur of the mountain, and then
swings back to the E, forming a peninsula. Here, cut off from the
- rest of the valley, is medildin (Matilton Ranch). This village,
+ rest of the valley, is medildiñ (Matilton Ranch). This village,
with those to the S, forms the southern division of the Hupa
people. This division manifests itself especially in religious
matters.
@@ -5547,7 +5514,7 @@ _Tinuheneu Villages (map 17)_
ma-til-le-tung and 1 mi. from the S end of the valley on the W bank
of the river.
- xowunkut (G). About a mile downstream from Tish-Tang-A-Tang
+ xowûñkût (G). About a mile downstream from Tish-Tang-A-Tang
Cr. on the W bank of the river. Goddard shows 14 houses at this
village. The site is now called Kentuck Ranch.
@@ -5560,7 +5527,7 @@ _Tinuheneu Villages (map 17)_
11. tish-tahng-ah-tung (M). On the E bank of the Trinity R. at
the S end of Hoopa V. proper.
- djictanadin (G). At the S end of the valley where the river
+ djictañadiñ (G). At the S end of the valley where the river
emerges from the canyon is a point of land on the E side. This
village, known locally as tish-tang-a-tang, was situated on this
point. Just above this village Tish-Tang-A-Tang Cr. from the
@@ -5578,7 +5545,7 @@ _Tinuheneu Villages (map 17)_
above Hoopa V. proper. This is the uppermost village classed as
Hupa.
- xaslindin (G). About 3 mi. S of the valley proper on the E
+ xaslindiñ (G). About 3 mi. S of the valley proper on the E
bank of the river at the mouth of a creek of the same name (Horse
Linto Cr.). Nine houses are shown at this village.
@@ -5656,18 +5623,18 @@ ETHNOGRAPHIC NOTES
The following ethnographic data are taken verbatim from Merriam's notes.
According to the Hoopah, as told me by James Chesbro of Burnt
- Ranch, the First People are called Kit-tung'-whi or Devil People.
+ Ranch, the First People are called Kit-tung´-whi or Devil People.
They used to fight and kill and eat one another. Later they turned
into animals. After the Flood real (Indian) people came.
In early days the Indians used to get drunk from inhaling
- the fumes of Indian tobacco (Min'-t[=a] itch'-wah) which by deep
+ the fumes of Indian tobacco (Min´-t[=a] itch´-wah) which by deep
breathing they would take into the lungs. Their word for drunk is
Ho-n[=a]^{ch}-w[)i]h^{ch}. The expression for "many people drunk"
is Yah, ho-n[=a]^{ch}-w[)e]^{ch}.
- The word for an old person is Kis'-te-ahn; for an old object,
- Tah'-ne.
+ The word for an old person is Kis´-te-ahn; for an old object,
+ Tah´-ne.
There are two words for good: Chung-whoom for a good or kind
person; and Noo-wh[=o]m for a good thing or object. A bad person is
@@ -5675,17 +5642,17 @@ The following ethnographic data are taken verbatim from Merriam's notes.
is To noo^{ch}-k[=o]m, "not good thing."
Chin-tahs, "slow", is said to mean also "heavy"; but the word
- given me for heavy is Nit-tahs'.
+ given me for heavy is Nit-tahs´.
- The word Ho'-chit, meaning real or genuine, occurs frequently:
- Thus, deerskin tanned with the hair on is called Ho'-chit te,
+ The word Ho´-chit, meaning real or genuine, occurs frequently:
+ Thus, deerskin tanned with the hair on is called Ho´-chit te,
te being any blanket or toga. Similarly, the ordinary woman's
- apron made of pine nuts and braided grass is Ho'-che ke'-ah; the
- woman's hat, H[=o]-che k[=o]s'-tahn, or real hat; moccasins, Hoch
- y[=a]'-che-tahl; the bow, H[=o]-ch[)e] tsitch-ting; the stone
+ apron made of pine nuts and braided grass is Ho´-che ke´-ah; the
+ woman's hat, H[=o]-che k[=o]s´-tahn, or real hat; moccasins, Hoch
+ y[=a]´-che-tahl; the bow, H[=o]-ch[)e] tsitch-ting; the stone
arrow-point, H[=o]-ch[)e] tin-ti; Indian or wild tobacco, H[=o]-che
- Min'-t[=a]-itch'-wah; the elkhorn box or purse for valuables
- H[=o]'-che kin'-chah.
+ Min´-t[=a]-itch´-wah; the elkhorn box or purse for valuables
+ H[=o]´-che kin´-chah.
The Hoopah say that their people did not use the nose-bone or
nose-stick, but had a name for it, which is Hun-choo whang-i. They
@@ -5693,16 +5660,16 @@ The following ethnographic data are taken verbatim from Merriam's notes.
The women tattooed the chin, usually in three broad vertical
bands similar to those of the Klamath River tribes. Tattoo marks
- are called Wil'-tahch'.
+ are called Wil´-tahch´.
Place names: All place names along the rivers were at one time
the sites of villages or rancherias. The village always takes the
name of the place.
- The name for house is H[=o]n'-tah or Hun'-tow; the ceremonial
- house, M[=a]'-min sin-til; the sweathouse, Tah'-'keo; the menstrual
- lodge, Mintch'; the brush wickiup, M[=a]'-nah-si; the brush blind
- or hut for concealing the hunter Kew'-wong wil'-min.
+ The name for house is H[=o]n´-tah or Hun´-tow; the ceremonial
+ house, M[=a]´-min sin-til; the sweathouse, Tah´-'keo; the menstrual
+ lodge, Mintch'; the brush wickiup, M[=a]´-nah-si; the brush blind
+ or hut for concealing the hunter Kew´-wong wil´-min.
They say that they never burned the dead, but buried them
in graves dug exactly knee-deep by measure. The grave was called
@@ -5713,7 +5680,7 @@ The following ethnographic data are taken verbatim from Merriam's notes.
While they do not burn the bodies, they burn clothing and
other belongings. But the Chemareko of Hyampom burn their dead.
- They believed in an evil spirit or Devil called Kit-tung' hwoi.
+ They believed in an evil spirit or Devil called Kit-tung´ hwoi.
A peculiar custom was practised in extending a certain
courtesy to an enemy who wanted to cross the river but had no boat.
@@ -5740,7 +5707,7 @@ The following ethnographic data are taken verbatim from Merriam's notes.
Small hailstones are called Klew-hahn min-nah from Klew-hahn,
"an eel," and min-nah, "eyes," from the resemblance of small
hailstones to the white eyes of the eel. Big hailstones are
- Ke'-lo-ung-hot.
+ Ke´-lo-ung-hot.
An earthquake is Nin mah-ah tin-n[)i]^{ch}-chwit, meaning
"turns over on edge of world."
@@ -5748,7 +5715,7 @@ The following ethnographic data are taken verbatim from Merriam's notes.
Money: The unit of value, which we call "money," consisted
of the valuable kind of dentalium shells, long specimens of which
reached from the base of the finger to the base of the terminal
- joint. This was called Ho'-che naht-te-ow or "real money." Small or
+ joint. This was called Ho´-che naht-te-ow or "real money." Small or
broken dentalium shells, from half an inch to an inch in length,
were called Mit-tatch, and were used for beads.
@@ -5759,15 +5726,15 @@ The following ethnographic data are taken verbatim from Merriam's notes.
_Names of mammals and birds._--The Grizzly Bear had two names:
M[)e]-ch[=a]-e-sahn and Me-kwo ah.
- The Mountain Lion or Cougar is called Min'-ning m[)i]^{ch}
+ The Mountain Lion or Cougar is called Min´-ning m[)i]^{ch}
'hl[=a]-til-loo, meaning "kills with his face."
- They speak of a spotted Panther of large size called Kit-sah',
+ They speak of a spotted Panther of large size called Kit-sah´,
which has not been seen for a number of years. It used to make a
great noise.
They speak also of a Water Panther (mythical) called
- Ho-tsi'-tow, said to live in holes close to the water of lakes and
+ Ho-tsi´-tow, said to live in holes close to the water of lakes and
pools, never in rivers or on land. Its head and shoulders were
heavy and covered with long shaggy hair, but the hinder parts were
nearly naked.
@@ -5779,7 +5746,7 @@ The following ethnographic data are taken verbatim from Merriam's notes.
Klew^{ch}-m[)u]-hung, meaning "snake's husband"--a term doubtless
suggested by its snake-like form and actions.
- The Mole is called Min-ni' [)e]-ting, meaning "eyeless"; the
+ The Mole is called Min-ni´ [)e]-ting, meaning "eyeless"; the
Bat Haht-la nah-mut, "night flyer."
The Porcupine is 'K'yo. Its quills, usually dyed yellow, were
@@ -5831,20 +5798,20 @@ The following ethnographic data are taken verbatim from Merriam's notes.
world and he would start from the other. They did this and met in
the middle where they danced.
- _Notes on adjacent tribes._--Yin'-nah'-chin ("South People,"
- Chemar'eko). Extended from Hyampom northerly to Cedar Flat,
+ _Notes on adjacent tribes._--Yin´-nah´-chin ("South People,"
+ Chemar´eko). Extended from Hyampom northerly to Cedar Flat,
easterly along main Trinity to Canyon Creek; and northerly between
the high mountains that form the divide between French Creek and
North Fork Trinity River on the west to Canyon Creek on the east,
as far north as Rattlesnake Creek. (Previously learned from the
- Nor'-rel-muk of Hay Fork, a Wintoon Tribe, that the dividing line
+ Nor´-rel-muk of Hay Fork, a Wintoon Tribe, that the dividing line
on the west between themselves and the Chemareko, called by them
Hyembos, lay along Minor Creek.) Language wholly different from
Hoopah. The Hoopah say that the presence of this tribe on Trinity
River west of Cedar Bar, and on lower New River, is a comparatively
recent intrusion.
- Klo'-m[)e]-tah'-wha ... Salmon River Indians. Ranges south
+ Klo´-m[)e]-tah´-wha ... Salmon River Indians. Ranges south
over summit to Grizzly Creek and headwaters New River. Language
wholly different.
@@ -6040,11 +6007,11 @@ thousand.
_Pitch Wailaki._--Goddard (1924) records 33 villages for the Pitch
Wailaki. For two of the four tribelets, the count is virtually complete.
-For a third tribelet, the T'odannankiyahan, Goddard lists 6 villages and
+For a third tribelet, the T'odannañkiyahañ, Goddard lists 6 villages and
indicates that there were probably more (1924, p. 225). If, to allow for
these possible villages, we add 5 to the total above, we get a total of
38 villages for three tribelets, or an average of 12.7 per tribelet.
-Although the fourth tribelet, the Tchokotkiyahan, had a poorer habitat
+Although the fourth tribelet, the Tchokotkiyahañ, had a poorer habitat
than the other three (Goddard, 1924, p. 222), we may assume that it had
at least 8 villages, an estimate which is probably conservative in view
of its extensive territory. We then get a total of 46 villages for the
@@ -6602,7 +6569,7 @@ the estimate of b is (Bennett and Franklin, 1954, p. 224)
and of a is
- a = [=Y] - [^b][=X]
+ â = [=Y] - [^b][=X]
where X_{i} = ln A for each group with known population and Y_{i} = P
for each known group.
@@ -6615,7 +6582,7 @@ Similarly the estimate of b' is
and of a' is
- a' = [=Y] - [^b]'[=X]
+ â' = [=Y] - [^b]'[=X]
where X_i = ln F for each known group and Y_i = P for each known group.
These calculations are shown in table 4.
@@ -6675,7 +6642,7 @@ Franklin, 1954, p. 229).
_______________________
{1 (X_o - [=X])^2 }
- 1.02 X_o - 4.06 +- t_[oc]S_a x [Sqrt]{- + -----------------}
+ 1.02 X_o - 4.06 ± t_[oc]S_a × [Sqrt]{- + -----------------}
{6 =S=(X_i - [=X])^2}
where the symbols have the following values and meanings:
@@ -6694,7 +6661,7 @@ where the symbols have the following values and meanings:
_________________________________
{1 }
- S_a = [Sqrt]{- x =S=(Y_i + 4.06 - 1.02X_i)^2}
+ S_a = [Sqrt]{- × =S=(Y_i + 4.06 - 1.02X_i)^2}
{4 }
where Y_i is the population of each of the groups for which
@@ -6757,7 +6724,7 @@ _Calculation of Confidence Intervals for Area_
___________________________
{1 (X_{o} - [=X])^2 }
- E = t_{.2}S_{a} x Sqrt{- + ---------------------}
+ E = t_{.2}S_{a} × Sqrt{- + ---------------------}
{6 =S=((X_{i} - [=X])^2)}
===========================================================
@@ -6794,7 +6761,7 @@ Calculation of Fishing-Mile Estimates
___________________________
{1 (X_{o} - [=X])^2 }
- E = t_{.2}S_{f} x Sqrt{- + ---------------------}
+ E = t_{.2}S_{f} × Sqrt{- + ---------------------}
{6 =S=((X_{i} - [=X])^2)}
===========================================================
@@ -6823,11 +6790,11 @@ _Population Estimates and Confidence Intervals_
Fishing-mile Area
Tribe Estimate Estimate
---------------------|-------------------|-------------
- Kato |1,523 +- 267 | 1,470 +- 263
- Bear River |1,276 +- 353 | 840 +- 556
- Lassik |1,411 +- 300 | 2,020 +- 291
- Nongatl |2,325 +- 462 | 2,830 +- 692
- Shelter Cove Sinkyone|2,145 +- 374 | 1,920 +- 257
+ Kato |1,523 ± 267 | 1,470 ± 263
+ Bear River |1,276 ± 353 | 840 ± 556
+ Lassik |1,411 ± 300 | 2,020 ± 291
+ Nongatl |2,325 ± 462 | 2,830 ± 692
+ Shelter Cove Sinkyone|2,145 ± 374 | 1,920 ± 257
---------------------|-------------------|-------------
The question of whether the fishing-mile estimates yield shorter
@@ -6974,18 +6941,18 @@ and Lopez' father at the Mouth of Smith River, Del Norte County, Sept.
_Name._--The tribe as a whole had no distinctive name for themselves
except Huss, the word for people. But they had definite names for
village areas. Those living at the mouth of Smith River call themselves
-Hah'-wun-kwut; those at Burnt Ranch, about three miles south of
-the mouth of Smith River, Yahnk'-tah-kut; those at Crescent City
-Tah-ah'-ten--and so on.
+Hah´-wun-kwut; those at Burnt Ranch, about three miles south of
+the mouth of Smith River, Yahnk´-tah-kut; those at Crescent City
+Tah-ah´-ten--and so on.
_Location, boundaries, and neighbors._--The territory of the tribe
-as a whole extends from Winchuk River (Um-sahng'-ten) on the
+as a whole extends from Winchuk River (Um-sahng´-ten) on the
California-Oregon boundary south to Wilson Creek (Tah-ges^{hl}-ten)
about eight miles north of the mouth of Klamath River.
The coast tribe immediately north (on the Oregon side of the line) is
-called Cheet or Che'-te. Their language differs materially from that of
-the Hah'-wun-kwut, though most of the words could be understood. Only a
+called Cheet or Che´-te. Their language differs materially from that of
+the Hah´-wun-kwut, though most of the words could be understood. Only a
single woman survives.
The tribe on the south, from Wilson Creek to Klamath River, is called
@@ -6996,7 +6963,7 @@ California-Oregon boundary is called Ka-Ka-sha. Another name, Choo-ne,
also was given but I am in doubt as to whether or not the same tribe
was meant. The Ka-ka-sha live near Waldo on the north side of the
Siskiyou Mountains and speak a language widely different from that of
-the Hah'-wun-kwut. They are said to be lighter in color than the coast
+the Hah´-wun-kwut. They are said to be lighter in color than the coast
Indians.
_Dress and ornament._--The people used deer skin blankets called
@@ -7007,7 +6974,7 @@ and tat-es-tat. Moccasins, Kus-ki-a, of elk hide were worn by rich men.
The women wore a front apron called Sahng; and on dress occasions an
ornamented cloak-like skirt (Chah) that extended all the way around and
-lapped over in front. They also wore basket hats, called Ki'-e-traht'
+lapped over in front. They also wore basket hats, called Ki´-e-traht´
and necklaces, the general term for which is Ni-ta-kle-ah. On occasions
they wore ear pendants, Bus-shra-mes-lah, of elk or deer bone. Nose
bones or shells, Mish-mes-lah, were sometimes worn; those of rich
@@ -7017,65 +6984,65 @@ tattooed with three narrow vertical lines called Tah-ah rut^{hl}-tes.
_Houses._--The houses (Munt) were square and were built of planks or
slabs hewn from redwood trees and stood up vertically, as in the case
of those of the Klamath River Indians. The ceremonial houses are called
-N[=a]'-stahs-m[=a]'-ne. They are square and have a ridge roof. During
+N[=a]´-stahs-m[=a]´-ne. They are square and have a ridge roof. During
important dances the front side is removed. The sweat house is called
-Shes'-kl[)e] and is large enough to hold twenty people. It is square or
+Shes´-kl[)e] and is large enough to hold twenty people. It is square or
rectangular, and the ground floor is excavated to a depth of about four
feet. The roof is of hewn planks covered with earth.
_Money._--The ordinary medium of exchange or "money" (Trut) consisted
of shells of _Dentalium_, of which the valuable long ones are called
-T[=a]'-tos, the commoner short ones Kle'-ah. Clam shell disks or buttons
-are called Nah'-set.
+T[=a]´-tos, the commoner short ones Kle´-ah. Clam shell disks or buttons
+are called Nah´-set.
-_Treatment of dead._--The dead are buried in a grave (Ch[)e]'-slo). The
+_Treatment of dead._--The dead are buried in a grave (Ch[)e]´-slo). The
people assert that they never burned their dead. They say that a spirit
-or ghost, called Nah-who'-tlan, goes out of the body after death and
+or ghost, called Nah-who´-tlan, goes out of the body after death and
becomes a ghost.
-_Ceremonial dances._--Dances are called N[=a]'-stahs or Nesh-stahsh. A
-puberty dance, Chahs'-stah w[=a]'-nish tahs, was held for the girls.
+_Ceremonial dances._--Dances are called N[=a]´-stahs or Nesh-stahsh. A
+puberty dance, Chahs´-stah w[=a]´-nish tahs, was held for the girls.
Other important dances are held. Some last 5 days; others last 10 days.
-The ceremonial drums Hah'-et-sah differ radically from those of any
+The ceremonial drums Hah´-et-sah differ radically from those of any
other California Indians known to me. They are large cooking baskets
about two feet in diameter. Only new baskets are used in order that they
may stand the drumming.
-Rattles called Chah-p[=a]t'-chah are made of the small hoofs of deer.
+Rattles called Chah-p[=a]t´-chah are made of the small hoofs of deer.
Cocoon rattles were not used.
-Whistles, called Tut'-tle-nik are made of large quill feathers of birds,
+Whistles, called Tut´-tle-nik are made of large quill feathers of birds,
not of bone.
_The stick game._--The stick game is a feature of the people, as in most
California tribes. It consists of a number of slender sticks called
-Not-tr[=a]'-le, of which one, called Chah-when', is marked. The counters
-are called Chun'; the man who keeps count, Chun-ting. A dressed buckskin
+Not-tr[=a]´-le, of which one, called Chah-when´, is marked. The counters
+are called Chun´; the man who keeps count, Chun-ting. A dressed buckskin
is stretched tightly on the ground between the players, and when the
game is called, the sticks are thrown down upon it.
_Baskets._--The basketry is of twined weave called Chet-too. The big
storehouse baskets, called Hawsh-tan, are closely woven and have a
shallow saucer-shape lid. The large open work burden basket is called
-Tus, the large cooking basket, Met-too'-sil^{ch}, the small mush bowl
-Hah'-tsah, the large shallow meal tray Mes-chet'-te-gah', the large
-open work shallow bowl Tre-kwahs'-tuk, the small open work plate or
-platter Kah'-se, the subglobular choke-mouth trinket basket Net'-tah,
-the milling basket Ki'-e-sut, the baby basket Kah'-yu, its shade
-Ne'-whats-tah, the women's basket hat Ki'-e-traht'. There is also a
-subglobular openwork basket called I'-[)a]-loo' with an arched handle
+Tus, the large cooking basket, Met-too´-sil^{ch}, the small mush bowl
+Hah´-tsah, the large shallow meal tray Mes-chet´-te-gah´, the large
+open work shallow bowl Tre-kwahs´-tuk, the small open work plate or
+platter Kah´-se, the subglobular choke-mouth trinket basket Net´-tah,
+the milling basket Ki´-e-sut, the baby basket Kah´-yu, its shade
+Ne´-whats-tah, the women's basket hat Ki´-e-traht´. There is also a
+subglobular openwork basket called I´-[)a]-loo´ with an arched handle
for carrying on the arm.
The cooking bowls, mush baskets, and other small baskets are made
-of spruce roots, 'Hre', more or less covered with an overlay of
+of spruce roots, 'Hre´, more or less covered with an overlay of
bear grass (_Xerophyllum_, called Too-t[)e]^{chl}) and maiden hair
-fern (_Adiantum_) called Ke'-tsi-shah'-te, meaning Blue-jay knees,
+fern (_Adiantum_) called Ke´-tsi-shah´-te, meaning Blue-jay knees,
because of the slender form and black color. The roots used in the
carrying baskets, baby baskets, and other coarse baskets are of hazel,
called 'Kun. The common black design in ordinary baskets consists
of Spruce roots that have been buried in dark mud and are called
-Tah'-che-gut-kle-ah. They are ordinarily used in connection with the
+Tah´-che-gut-kle-ah. They are ordinarily used in connection with the
bear grass (_Xerophyllum_).
_Fragments of Hahwunkwut myths._--Skum, Coyote man, made the world.
@@ -7084,13 +7051,13 @@ When the sun dropped down the Coon caught it up and it was hot, and
blackened the insides of his hands.
When the world first floated there was just one big white Redwood tree
-called Kus-choo'-ke. A big Eagle was sitting on the tree and was king of
+called Kus-choo´-ke. A big Eagle was sitting on the tree and was king of
the world.
-The Falcon (Tah'-tes) won the battle for the people.
+The Falcon (Tah´-tes) won the battle for the people.
_Hahwunkwut foods._--A large variety of foods are eaten: meat
-(Ch[=a]'-sun) of elk and deer, both fresh and dried, salmon and
+(Ch[=a]´-sun) of elk and deer, both fresh and dried, salmon and
other fish, fresh and dried, marrow, tallow, salmon eggs (usually
smoke-dried), clams of several kinds, mussels, fish milt both dried and
fresh, acorn mush and bread, and a number of roots, berries, and other
@@ -7104,7 +7071,7 @@ eggs.
Two kinds of kelp are eaten.
-Root masses of the brake fern (_Pteris aquilina_, called Tah'-sohn-ki)
+Root masses of the brake fern (_Pteris aquilina_, called Tah´-sohn-ki)
are cooked in the ground oven. They are said to be like milk and have a
fine flavor.
@@ -7114,39 +7081,39 @@ Wild tobacco is called Yahn-s[)e]^{ch} yah-we and S[)e]^{ch}-yu. The
pipe is straight and is called A-chah.
_Hahwunkwut plant notes._--The Tree Maple (_Acer macrophyllum_) is
-called Ch[=a]'-she. Its inner bark is used for the ordinary everyday
+called Ch[=a]´-she. Its inner bark is used for the ordinary everyday
dress for women.
The Tanbark Oak is the dominant species in the northwest coast region
-and its acorns (Sohng'-cheng) are largely eaten by the people. Acorn
+and its acorns (Sohng´-cheng) are largely eaten by the people. Acorn
meal before leaching is called Rut-ta-gaht. If it is allowed to become
mouldy, the bitter taste disappears so that it does not have to be
leached. Acorn bread cooked on hot ashes is called Ses^{hl}-te. The
ordinary mush is called Ma-guts-kush.
_Hahwunkwut animal notes._--The Bobcat (_Lynx rufus_) is called
-Ne'-ti-us ah'-n[=a]. Its name is never mentioned in the presence of a
+Ne´-ti-us ah´-n[=a]. Its name is never mentioned in the presence of a
baby. If the mother sees one before the baby is born, the baby will have
fits and die.
-The falcon or Duck Hawk (Tah'-tes) was a high personage among the First
+The falcon or Duck Hawk (Tah´-tes) was a high personage among the First
People. He won the first battle for the Indians, standing on the first
Redwood Tree.
-The California Condor (T[=a]-long-yi'-chah) is so big and powerful that
+The California Condor (T[=a]-long-yi´-chah) is so big and powerful that
he can lift a whale. His name shows this as it is from the name of the
-whale (T[=a]'-lah) and means "whale lifter."
+whale (T[=a]´-lah) and means "whale lifter."
-The Dove (Sroo'-e-gun'-sah) cries for his grandmother, especially in the
+The Dove (Sroo´-e-gun´-sah) cries for his grandmother, especially in the
spring of the year.
-The Purple Finch is called Klah'-nis-me'-tit-le, meaning "many
+The Purple Finch is called Klah´-nis-me´-tit-le, meaning "many
brothers," because the birds go together in small flocks.
-The Night Heron (Nah-gah' che yahs'-se) is known as the "sickness bird."
+The Night Heron (Nah-gah´ che yahs´-se) is known as the "sickness bird."
_Hahwunkwut pits for catching elk and deer._--The Smith River
-Hah-wun-kwut used to catch elk and deer in pits, called Song'-kit, dug
+Hah-wun-kwut used to catch elk and deer in pits, called Song´-kit, dug
in the ground along the runways. These pits differ materially from those
of the Pit River Indians, being much shallower. No effort was made to
make them deep enough to prevent the captured animals from jumping out,
@@ -7175,12 +7142,12 @@ _Massacres of Huss Indians by the whites._--There were three notable
killings by the whites.
The first killing took place at Burnt Ranch, three miles south of
-the mouth of Smith River, at the rancheria called Yahnk-tah'-kut,
+the mouth of Smith River, at the rancheria called Yahnk-tah´-kut,
a name perpetuated by the district school house name. Here a large
number of Indians were caught during a ceremonial dance and ruthlessly
slaughtered. The Indians say this was the first killing.
-The second killing was at the rancheria of [=A]'-choo-lik on the big
+The second killing was at the rancheria of [=A]´-choo-lik on the big
lagoon known as Lake Earl about three miles north of Crescent City [cf.
Drucker's etculet in Drucker, 1937, map 3]. The Indians were engaged in
gambling at the time.
@@ -7189,15 +7156,15 @@ The third killing was at the large village of Hah-wun-kwut [Xawun hwut,
Drucker, 1937, map 3] at the mouth of Smith River.
At the time of the Indian troubles in northwestern California Chief
-Ki'-lis (named for Ki-o-lus the Willow tree) was chief of the
-Hah'-wun-kwut tribe.
+Ki´-lis (named for Ki-o-lus the Willow tree) was chief of the
+Hah´-wun-kwut tribe.
Three young men of the tribe were active in resenting the aggressions of
the whites and were said to have killed several of the early settlers.
They were very clever and neither the settlers nor the soldiers were
able to capture them. Finally the officer in charge of the troops at
Fort Dick (a log fort on Smith River, about three miles from the present
-settlement called Smith River Corners) told Chief Ki'-lis that he would
+settlement called Smith River Corners) told Chief Ki´-lis that he would
be hung by the soldiers unless he captured the three young men in
question.
@@ -7228,7 +7195,7 @@ also some blankets. This ended the "Indian war" in that region.
There is a small island called Stun-tahs ahn-kot (50 acres or more in
extent) in the lower part of Smith River, half or three-quarters of a
-mile from its mouth. On some of the early maps it bears the name Ta'-les
+mile from its mouth. On some of the early maps it bears the name Ta´-les
after the chief. This island the officer gave to the Indians in the name
of the Government, telling them it would always be theirs, and gave the
chief a paper stating that it was given in return for killing the three
@@ -7236,7 +7203,7 @@ outlaw boys. Sometime afterward this paper was burned.
After the Indians had been driven to the Hoopa Reservation and had
come back, they were not allowed to go to their former rancheria
-Hah'-wun-kwut, but were told to go to this island. Later the whites
+Hah´-wun-kwut, but were told to go to this island. Later the whites
claimed the island and did not let the Indians have it.
The present Indian settlement, a mile or two north of the mouth of
@@ -7257,67 +7224,67 @@ YUKI "TRIBES"
The following data were got from Eben Tillotson at Hulls Valley, north
of Round Valley, on July 12, 1938.
-A. Eben said he was a Wi.t'u.kno'm Yuki. This was a "tribe" speaking
+A. Eben said he was a Wi·t'u·knó'm Yuki. This was a "tribe" speaking
a uniform dialect, having uniform customs, but embracing several
"tribelets." Their general territory was along main (or middle) Eel R.
where this runs from E to W, on both sides of it, and S of Round V. They
-also owned Okla.[)c] and Punki.nipi.[t.] ("wormwood hole"), Poonkiny.
+also owned Oklá·[)c] and Púnki·nipi·[t.] ("wormwood hole"), Poonkiny.
The subdivisions or tribelets were:
- [10.6] 1. U[)s]i.[)c]lAlhotno'm
+ [10.6] 1. U[)s]i·[)c]lAlhótno'm
("crayfish-creek-large-people") on Salt Cr., S of Middle Eel.
- 2. Olkatno'm, at Henley or Hop ranch in S part of Round V.,
+ 2. Olkátno'm, at Henley or Hop ranch in S part of Round V.,
where the road enters the flat of the valley. They owned S to the
Middle Eel and down it to Dos Rios confluence.
- 3. Alniuk'i.no'm, at W edge of Round V.
+ 3. Alniuk'í·no'm, at W edge of Round V.
- 4. Ontitno'm, E of Henley ranch in Round V.; also Eden V. to S.
+ 4. Ontítno'm, E of Henley ranch in Round V.; also Eden V. to S.
B. The following were not grouped together by the informant, but agree
in having a southerly range:
- [10.6] 5. LAlku.tno'm, around Outlet Cr.
+ [10.6] 5. LAlkú·tno'm, around Outlet Cr.
- 6. Ti.tAmno'm, eastward, across (S of Middle) Eel R., toward
+ 6. Tí·tAmno'm, eastward, across (S of Middle) Eel R., toward
Sanhedrin Mt., W of the ridge which runs W of Gravelly V. Mountain
people, without villages of size. Dixie Duncan was half of this
group.
- 7. Ki.[)c]ilu.kam is Gravelly V. The Huchnom roamed in that.
+ 7. Ki·[)c]ilú·kam is Gravelly V. The Huchnom roamed in that.
C. East of Hull's V., extending nearly to Hammerhorn Mt., but this was
Nomlaki.
- [10.6] 8. [vS]ipimA'lno'm, on a creek running from W into
+ [10.6] 8. [vS]ipimA´lno'm, on a creek running from W into
(S-flowing) Eel R.
- 9. I.'mpti.tAmno'm, at an opening in the range--i.'mp is a
+ 9. I·'mptí·tAmno'm, at an opening in the range--i·'mp is a
gap. They were across the Eel, on its E side.
- 10. Pi.lilno'm, beyond (farther E or SE?), at Kumpi.t, "salt
+ 10. Pi·lílno'm, beyond (farther E or SE?), at Kumpí·t, "salt
hole," where salt was got, also at Snow Mt. These were Yuki, but
"talked something like" Nomlaki Wintun (who adjoined them, across
the main Coast Range watershed). Their language was about as
different from Yuki as was Huchnom. They were "half Stony Creek"
(along which lived Salt Pomo, then Hill Patwin, then Nomlaki).
- 11. U.k'i.[)c]no'm (added later by informant), in Williams V.,
+ 11. U·k'í·[)c]no'm (added later by informant), in Williams V.,
"E" of Hull's V.
12. A Yuki group at Twin Rock Cr.--Eben had forgotten their
name.
D. The real Yuki, centering in Round V., and coming N into the foothills
-only about as far as Ebley's Flat. To the N were the Onaino'm, Pitch
+only about as far as Ebley's Flat. To the N were the Onainó'm, Pitch
Indians, Athabascans, who owned Hull V. ("here") and adjoined the
[vS]ipimAlno'm (no. 8).
- [10.6] 13. Hakno'm, in Round V., around Agency, in the N side
+ [10.6] 13. Hákno'm, in Round V., around Agency, in the N side
of the valley.
- 14. Ukomno'm, in middle of the valley. They did not own up
+ 14. Ukomnó'm, in middle of the valley. They did not own up
into the mountains.
15. At TotimAl, W of Covelo, were a people whose name Eben had
@@ -7339,9 +7306,9 @@ _Orthography Used_
[vS] sh
[)c] ch
k' etc. glottalized
- . long
+ · long
[-l] surd l, Athabascan only
- =e= ng Athabascan
+ =ê= ng Athabascan
[Illustration: Map 18. Yuki "Tribes" according to Eben Tillotson.]
@@ -7350,11 +7317,11 @@ ATHABASCAN DATA
DATA FROM EBEN TILLOTSON
-Onaino'm were the Pitch Indians, a people of the rugged mountains,
-adjoining the [vS]ipimA'lno'm Yuki, and with Hull's Valley in their
+Onainó'm were the Pitch Indians, a people of the rugged mountains,
+adjoining the [vS]ipimA´lno'm Yuki, and with Hull's Valley in their
range. They were "half Yuki and half Wailaki," and spoke both languages.
-The TA'no'm were at Spy Rock on main Eel R. They were also half Yuki and
+The TA´no'm were at Spy Rock on main Eel R. They were also half Yuki and
half Wailaki and bilingual. [But other Yuki cite them as Yuki who also
knew Wailaki.] TAno'm were: Nancy Dobie, Sally Duncan, and Tip.
@@ -7374,7 +7341,7 @@ Valley on July 13, 1938. Lucy Young, the informant, was born on Eel
River at Tseye[)s]ente[-l], opposite Alder Point. Though listed by the
Government as a Wailaki, she is actually what ethnologists call Lassik.
Her father was born 3 mi. from Alder Pt.; her mother, at Soldier Basin,
-22 mi. NE. Her mother's first cousin was T'a.su's, known to the whites
+22 mi. NE. Her mother's first cousin was T'a·su's, known to the whites
as Lassik, from his Wintun name Lasek. He was chief for Alder Pt.,
Soldier Basin, (upper) Mad River. Mary Major, informant's contemporary,
is from Soldier Basin and of the same tribe.
@@ -7386,24 +7353,24 @@ them may be place names.
Nal[)s]a, "eat each other," downstream, around Fort Seward.
- Ko[)s]o-ya=e=, "soaproot eaters," farther downstream and on
+ Ko[)s]o-ya=ê=, "soaproot eaters," farther downstream and on
Van Duzen R.
- Tena=e=-keya, Mad R. Indians.
+ Tena=ê=-keya, Mad R. Indians.
- Kentet[-l]a(=e=), Kettenchow V., a flat with roots.
+ Kentet[-l]a(=ê=), Kettenchow V., a flat with roots.
Se[)c]([-l])enden-keya, at Zenia.
- Ka.snol-keya, S of Zenia, called Kikawake in Hayfork [Wintun].
+ Ka·snol-keya, S of Zenia, called Kikawake in Hayfork [Wintun].
Tok'(a)-keya, South Fork of Eel Indians [Sinkyone].
- Saya=e=, "lamprey eel eaters," the Spy Rock
+ Saya=ê=, "lamprey eel eaters," the Spy Rock
Wailaki [the Ko'il of Tillotson].
- Djeh-ya=e=, "pinenut eaters," the Pitch Wailaki, on North Fork
+ Djeh-ya=ê=, "pinenut eaters," the Pitch Wailaki, on North Fork
Eel R.
[The outlook seems to have been chiefly downstream and inland.]
@@ -7412,14 +7379,14 @@ _Non-Athabascans_
[)C]iyin[)c]e, Yuki.
- Baikiha=e=, Hayfork Wintu.
+ Baikiha=ê=, Hayfork Wintu.
- Ya=e=-keya, the Wintu from Weaverville to Redding; their own
- name was Poibos. The same name Ya=e=-keya was applied also to the
+ Ya=ê=-keya, the Wintu from Weaverville to Redding; their own
+ name was Poibos. The same name Ya=ê=-keya was applied also to the
Cottonwood Creek Wintun, whom the Lassik met at Yolla Bolly Mt. to
trade salt. [Wintu and Wintun were treated as one language.]
- Yita.kena, people of lowest Eel R., the Wiyot.
+ Yitá·kena, people of lowest Eel R., the Wiyot.
@@ -7679,365 +7646,4 @@ of Hupa villages. Map by George Gibbs, 1852.]
End of Project Gutenberg's California Athabascan Groups, by Martin A. Baumhoff
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK CALIFORNIA ATHABASCAN GROUPS ***
-
-***** This file should be named 43876.txt or 43876.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/4/3/8/7/43876/
-
-Produced by Colin Bell, Richard Tonsing, Joseph Cooper and
-the Online Distributed Proofreading Team at
-http://www.pgdp.net
-
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
-will be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
-one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
-(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
-permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
-set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
-copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
-protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
-Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
-charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
-do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
-rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
-such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
-research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
-practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
-subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
-redistribution.
-
-
-
-*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
-Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
-http://gutenberg.org/license).
-
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
-all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
-If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
-terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
-entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
-and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
-or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
-collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
-individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
-located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
-copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
-works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
-are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
-Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
-freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
-this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
-the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
-keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
-Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
-a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
-the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
-before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
-creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
-Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
-the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
-States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
-access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
-whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
-copied or distributed:
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
-almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
-re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
-with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org/license
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
-from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
-posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
-and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
-or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
-with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
-work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
-through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
-Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
-1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
-terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
-to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
-permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
-word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
-distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
-"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
-posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
-you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
-copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
-request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
-form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
-that
-
-- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
- owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
- has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
- Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
- must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
- prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
- returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
- sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
- address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
- the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or
- destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
- and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
- Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
- money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
- of receipt of the work.
-
-- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
-forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
-both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
-Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
-Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
-collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
-"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
-corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
-property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
-computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
-your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
-your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
-the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
-refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
-providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
-receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
-is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
-opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
-WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
-WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
-If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
-law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
-interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
-the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
-provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
-with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
-promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
-harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
-that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
-or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
-work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
-Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
-
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
-including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
-because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
-people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need, are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
-To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
-and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
-and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org.
-
-
-Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
-Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
-http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
-permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
-Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
-throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
-809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
-business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
-information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
-page at http://pglaf.org
-
-For additional contact information:
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
-SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
-particular state visit http://pglaf.org
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
-To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate
-
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
-with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
-Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
-
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
-unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
-keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
-
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
-
- http://www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 43876 ***
diff --git a/43876-8.txt b/43876-8.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index f117f37..0000000
--- a/43876-8.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,8043 +0,0 @@
-Project Gutenberg's California Athabascan Groups, by Martin A. Baumhoff
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
-almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
-re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
-with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org/license
-
-
-Title: California Athabascan Groups
-
-Author: Martin A. Baumhoff
-
-Release Date: October 3, 2013 [EBook #43876]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK CALIFORNIA ATHABASCAN GROUPS ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by Colin Bell, Richard Tonsing, Joseph Cooper and
-the Online Distributed Proofreading Team at
-http://www.pgdp.net
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-CALIFORNIA ATHABASCAN
-GROUPS
-
-BY
-
-MARTIN A. BAUMHOFF
-
-
-ANTHROPOLOGICAL RECORDS
-
-Vol. 16, No. 5
-
-UNIVERSITY OF CALIFORNIA PUBLICATIONS
-
-ANTHROPOLOGICAL RECORDS
-
-Editors (Berkeley): J. H. Rowe, R. F. Heizer, R. F. Murphy, E. Norbeck
-Volume 16, No. 5, pp. 157-238, plates 9-11, 2 figures in text, 18 maps
-
-Submitted by editors May 6, 1957
-Issued August 1, 1958
-Price, $1.50
-
-University of California Press
-Berkeley and Los Angeles
-California
-
-Cambridge University Press
-London, England
-
-Manufactured in the United States of America
-
-
-
-
-PREFACE
-
-
-In March, 1950, the University of California assumed custodianship of
-an extensive collection of original and secondary data referring to
-California Indian ethnology, made by Dr. C. Hart Merriam and originally
-deposited with the Smithsonian Institution. Since that time the Merriam
-collection has been consulted by qualified persons interested in
-linguistics, ethnogeography, and other specialized subjects. Some of
-the data have been published, the most substantial publication being a
-book, Studies of California Indians (1955), which comprises essays and
-original records written or collected by Dr. Merriam.
-
-The selection and editing of the material for the Studies volume made
-us aware of the extent of the detailed information on ethnogeography
-which a thorough survey of the Merriam data would provide. We therefore
-approached Dr. Leonard Carmichael, Secretary of the Smithsonian
-Institution, with the proposal that a qualified graduate student be
-appointed as research assistant to study and prepare for publication
-a discrete amount of Merriam record material, remuneration for this
-work to be paid from the E. H. Harriman fund, administered by the
-Smithsonian Institution for preparation and publication of Dr. Merriam's
-ethnological data. This proposal was approved, and Mr. Martin Baumhoff
-began his one year of investigation on September 15, 1955.
-
-After discussion, we agreed that the area where tribal distributions,
-village locations, and aboriginal population numbers were least
-certainly known--and also a field where the Merriam data were fairly
-abundant--was the territory of the several Athabascan tribes of
-Northwestern California. Under our direction, Baumhoff patiently
-assembled all the available material on these tribes, producing what is
-certainly the most definitive study yet made of their distribution and
-numbers.
-
-In this monograph the importance of the Merriam data is central,
-although they are compounded with information collected by other
-students of the California Athabascans. We believe that the maps showing
-group distribution represent the closest possible approximation to the
-aboriginal situation that can now be arrived at.
-
-The Department of Anthropology hopes to be able to continue the work of
-studying and publishing the Merriam data on tribal distributions. It
-takes this opportunity to express its appreciation of the coöperation of
-the Smithsonian Institution in this undertaking.
-
- A. L. Kroeber
-
- R. F. Heizer
-
-
-
-
-CONTENTS
-
-
- Page
-
- Preface iii
-
- Introduction 157
- Athabascan culture 158
-
- Athabascan boundaries 160
- Exterior boundaries 160
- Interior boundaries 161
-
- Groups 166
- Kato 166
- Wailaki 167
- Pitch Wailaki 176
- Lassik 178
- Nongatl 181
- Sinkyone 184
- Mattole 195
- Bear River 200
- Whilkut 201
- Hupa 209
-
- Population 216
- Sources 216
- Estimates based on village counts 216
- Estimates based on fish resources 218
- Gross estimate 220
-
- Appendixes
- I. The Tolowa: Data from Notes of C. Hart Merriam 225
- II. Notes of Upper Eel River Indians, by A. L. Kroeber 227
-
- Bibliography 230
-
- Plates 233
-
-
-MAPS
-
- 1. Athabascan Boundaries--Kroeber vs. Baumhoff 162
- 2. Athabascan Boundaries--Baumhoff 162
- 3. Athabascan Boundaries--Merriam vs. Baumhoff 163
- 4. Athabascan Boundaries--Various authors vs. Baumhoff 163
- 5. Villages and Tribelets of the Eel Wailaki and the North Fork
- Wailaki 168
- 6. Villages and Tribelets of the Pitch Wailaki 177
- 7. Presumed Nongatl Villages in the Bridgeville Region 180
- 8. Lassik Villages in the Alder Point Region 180
- 9. Nongatl Villages on Yager Creek 182
- 10. Nongatl Villages in the Blocksburg Region 182
- 11. Villages of the Lolangkok Sinkyone 186
- 12. Villages of the Shelter Cove Sinkyone 190
- 13. Place Names of the Lolangkok Sinkyone 192
- 14. Villages and Tribelets of the Mattole 197
- 15. Villages of the Chilula Whilkut,
- North Fork Whilkut, and Kloki Whilkut 204
- 16. Villages of the Mad River
- Whilkut, the South Fork Hupa, and Kloki Whilkut 208
- 17. Villages of the Hupa and South Fork Hupa 211
- 18. Yuki "Tribes," according to Eben Tillotson (App. II) 228
-
-CALIFORNIA ATHABASCAN
-GROUPS
-
-BY
-
-MARTIN A. BAUMHOFF
-
-
-
-
-INTRODUCTION
-
-In 1910 C. Hart Merriam, already well known as a naturalist, came to
-California and began the study of California ethnography which was to
-occupy him for the rest of his life. Almost every year from then until
-his death in 1942 Merriam spent about six months in the field, talking
-to Indians and recording their memories of aboriginal times. All this
-field work resulted in an immense collection of data on the California
-Indians, most of which has never been published (see Merriam's
-bibliography in Merriam, 1955, pp. 227-229).
-
-In 1950 the greater part of Merriam's field notes was deposited at the
-University of California, with the intention of making them available
-for study and publication. One volume of papers has already appeared
-(Merriam, 1955), and the present study is part of a continuing program.
-
-The California Athabascans were selected as the first group for study at
-the suggestion of A. L. Kroeber, the reason being that the Athabascans
-have been and still remain one of the least known aboriginal groups
-in the State. This is not because they were conquered early and their
-culture dissipated, as is true of the Mission Indians; there were
-scarcely any whites in the California Athabascan area before the 1850's.
-Indeed, as late as the 1920's and '30's there were many good Athabascan
-informants still available. The reason for the hiatus in our knowledge
-lies in an accident in the history of ethnology rather than in the
-history of California.
-
-The early work among the California Athabascans was done by Pliny Earle
-Goddard. Goddard began his studies of the Athabascans in 1897 at the
-Hoopa Indian Reservation, where he was a lay missionary. He stayed
-there until 1900, when he went to Berkeley to work for his doctorate
-in linguistics under Benjamin Ide Wheeler, President of the University
-of California. Between 1900 and 1909 Goddard was associated with the
-University as student and professor and during this time he visited the
-Athabascans periodically, until he had worked with virtually all the
-groups considered in this paper.
-
-During this same period A. L. Kroeber was engaged in gathering material
-for his classic Handbook of California Indians. Because of the scarcity
-of ethnographers in those years Kroeber could not afford the time to
-work in the Athabascan area and duplicate Goddard's investigations.
-Kroeber did study the Hupa and the Kato at either end of the Athabascan
-area but, except for a hurried trip through the region in 1902, he
-did not work with the other groups, and the responsibility for the
-ethnographic field work therefore devolved upon Goddard.
-
-Goddard, however, was not primarily an ethnographer but a linguist,
-and he directed his chief efforts toward linguistic investigations. He
-has published an impressive body of Athabascan texts and linguistic
-analyses but, except for his Life and Culture of the Hupa (1903_a_),
-almost nothing on the culture of the Athabascans.
-
-The net result is that the California Athabascans are virtually unknown,
-and Merriam's fresh data provide an opportunity to piece together the
-available evidence.
-
-The Merriam files, deposited at the Department of Anthropology of the
-University of California, contain information on each of the tribes of
-California, some of it being information gathered by Merriam himself,
-the rest clippings and quotations from various historic and ethnographic
-sources. The primary and secondary materials are easily distinguished,
-since Merriam gave scrupulous citations to his sources.
-
-Merriam's own data consist of word lists, ethnogeographical material,
-and random notes on various aspects of native culture. I have not used
-his word lists, since their usefulness is primarily linguistic and I am
-not competent to perform the necessary linguistic analysis, but all the
-random ethnographic notes which he recorded for the Athabascan groups
-are here included under the discussion of the appropriate tribes.
-
-Most of the Merriam Athabascan material is geographic, consisting
-of lists of villages and place names, of descriptions and lengthy
-discussions of tribal boundaries. Obviously Merriam attempted to
-gather a complete file of this sort of information, and he was largely
-successful. His work provides a good basis for establishing boundaries
-and for locating tribelets and villages.
-
-Another important source of information, serving the same purpose, is
-the Goddard material. Evidently Goddard very much enjoyed the long
-horseback trips he made with an informant, who could point out the
-village sites, landmarks, and other points of interest of his native
-territory. This information, carefully recorded by Goddard, has proved
-extremely valuable in the present work, the more so since it represents
-firsthand observation.
-
-Goddard's ethnogeographic work for three of the California Athabascan
-groups has already been published (1914_a_; 1923_a_; 1924). Besides
-this, the present writer has been fortunate enough to have access to
-Goddard's unpublished notes, which contain information on several
-hundred additional villages in the area. These notes were in the
-possession of Dr. Elsie Clews Parsons, Goddard's literary executor,
-and on her death they were sent to the University of California by
-Dr. Gladys Reichard. They remained in the files of the University of
-California Museum of Anthropology until their use in the present work.
-
-This unpublished material of Goddard's consists of a group of file
-cards, on each of which is typed the name, location, and any other
-pertinent data for a single village. Some of the lists are accompanied
-by maps, showing precise location of the villages. In the lists for
-which there are no maps but only verbal descriptions of the sites,
-the township, range, and quarter section coördinates are given. The
-township and range coördinates have been changed since Goddard's time,
-in accordance with the more accurate surveys of the last thirty years,
-but county maps of the appropriate period provide a perfectly adequate
-way of locating Goddard's sites within a few hundred yards.
-
-It is clear, on the basis of internal evidence, that there is or was
-more Goddard material than is now accessible to the present author. For
-the Kato, for instance, Goddard says that he recorded more than fifty
-villages (Goddard, 1909, p. 67); all that remain in his notes are two
-village cards numbered 51 and 52 respectively. There may also be some
-data, once recorded but now lost, from the Lassik, Nongatl, and Shelter
-Cove Sinkyone. I have communicated with the American Museum of Natural
-History, where Goddard was a member of the staff, and with Indiana
-University, where some of his manuscripts are deposited, but neither of
-these institutions has any knowledge of the material in question.
-
-The Merriam and Goddard material, taken together, provides a fair amount
-of information on the geography of the California Athabascan groups. We
-are now in the position of knowing a great deal about the location of
-the tribes, tribelets, and villages of these people, while we know very
-little about their way of life, except what can be gained by inference
-from the surrounding groups.
-
-The author's thanks are due to Dr. A. L. Kroeber and Dr. R. F. Heizer,
-who gave their full coöperation throughout the preparation of the
-present paper. Dr. Henry Sheffé was kind enough to advise on the
-statistics used in the section on population.
-
-
-ATHABASCAN CULTURE
-
-The following sketch of Athabascan culture attempts to provide some
-background for the later discussion of the various groups. In this
-sketch I have not used the material from the Hupa, since they are
-virtually identical with the Yurok and not at all typical of the more
-southern Athabascans.
-
-_Subsistence._--For information on Athabascan economy I have relied
-heavily on Essene's account of the Lassik (1942, p. 84). There was, no
-doubt, variation among the different groups, but for the most part, they
-must have followed a similar pattern.
-
-The most difficult time in the annual cycle of food production was
-winter. There were then few fish and almost no game animals or crops for
-gathering. From late November to early March people had to rely on food
-that had been stored the previous year. Essene's informant said that
-about every four or five years there would be a hard winter, but she
-could remember only one when people actually starved to death.
-
-In February or March the spring salmon run began, and after that the
-danger of starvation was past. At about this time the grass began to
-grow again, and the first clover was eaten ravenously because of the
-dearth of greens during the winter.
-
-The herb-gathering and salmon-fishing activity lasted until the spring
-rains ended in April or May, when the people left their villages on the
-salmon streams and scattered out into the hills for the summer. Usually
-only a few families would stay together during the summer, while the men
-hunted deer, squirrels, and other animals and the women gathered clover,
-seeds, roots, and nuts. Food was most plentiful at this season, and
-the places visited varied with the abundance of different crops. If a
-certain crop was good, the Indians would spend more time that summer in
-the area where the crop grew best. The next year they might go somewhere
-else. The vegetation of the Athabascan habitat is not well enough mapped
-to permit a precise delineation of these various summer camping grounds.
-
-In September or October, when the acorns were ripe, the Indians would
-return to their winter villages and smoke meat for storing and probably
-store the acorns. Each family built a new house to protect it from the
-heavy winter rains. After the first rain in the fall the salmon run
-again in some of the streams of the region and were caught and smoked
-for winter storage.
-
-It is evident that the crucial factor in the economy was the amount
-of food stored for winter and that this food supply was a controlling
-influence on the size of the population, since, in bad years, people
-starved. At least, this was so for the Lassik, and it was no doubt true
-among the other groups as well. Salmon, meat, and acorns were doubtless
-the chief foods stored, and thus population size would have responded
-quite sensitively to the quantity and condition of the salmon, deer, and
-oak trees.
-
-_Social organization._--For social organization I have had to rely
-mostly on Nomland's accounts of the Sinkyone and Bear River groups
-(1935, 1938). The primary social unit among the California Athabascans
-was the simple family, including a man, his wife, and his children.
-Although polygyny was known, at least among some groups, it was rare,
-and the possessor of two wives was reckoned a rich man. Most marriage
-was by purchase; the levirate and sororate were common. Divorce was also
-common and might be obtained by a man because of his wife's barrenness,
-laziness, or infidelity.
-
-The next social group, larger than the family, was the tribelet. Kroeber
-(1932, p. 258) has defined the tribelet as follows.
-
- Each of these [tribelets] seemed to possess a small territory
- usually definable in terms of drainage; a principal town or
- settlement, often with a chief recognized by the whole group;
- normally, minor settlements which might or might not be occupied
- permanently; and sometimes a specific name, but more often none
- other than the designation of the principal town. Each group acted
- as a homogeneous unit in matters of land ownership, trespass, war,
- major ceremonies, and the entertainment entailed by them.
-
-This definition, given for the Pomo, fits the Athabascan area very well.
-Merriam usually refers to these groups as "bands," while Goddard calls
-them "subtribes." In the body of this paper I use the word "band" when
-quoting or paraphrasing Merriam, otherwise I call them "tribelets."
-
-The tribelet was the largest corporate group in the area. A
-larger group, which I call the tribe, has been identified by most
-ethnographers. This latter group ordinarily had no corporate
-functions, unless it happened to be coterminous with, and therefore
-indistinguishable from, the tribelet. The tribe, as the term is used
-here, was a group of two or more tribelets--or occasionally one single
-group--with a single speech dialect, different from that of their
-neighbors. The tribe was also culturally uniform, but not necessarily
-distinct from its neighbors in this respect. The similarity between
-people of a single tribe evidently gave them a feeling of community but
-had no further effect on their social or political organization.
-
-The following tribes have been identified in the Athabascan area, each
-including several tribelets, except for the Bear River tribe, which
-consists of one single tribelet.
-
- Kato: The Kato probably included at least 2 tribelets, but we
- have no information on this point.
-
- Eel River Wailaki: 9 tribelets.
-
- North Fork Wailaki: 6 tribelets.
-
- Pitch Wailaki: 4 tribelets.
-
- Lassik: Probably several tribelets, but there is no
- information.
-
- Nongatl: There is evidence of 6 subgroups of the Nongatl. Some
- of these may be dialect divisions, that is, tribes. The information
- is not sufficient to permit definition and they have therefore been
- grouped under Nongatl. The extent of Nongatl territory indicates
- that there must have been several tribelets.
-
- Lolangkok Sinkyone: There were at least 2, and possibly more,
- tribelets.
-
- Shelter Cove Sinkyone: There were at least 4 tribelets.
-
- Mattole: 2 tribelets.
-
- Bear River: The Bear River tribe consists of a single tribelet.
-
- Whilkut: The 4 subdivisions of the Whilkut--Chilula Whilkut,
- Kloki Whilkut, Mad River Whilkut, and North Fork Whilkut--all
- appear to be tribelets. It is possible that the Mad River Whilkut
- spoke a different dialect than the other groups and, if so, they
- should be given tribal status. The evidence is not clear on this
- point and I have therefore included them simply as a Whilkut
- tribelet.
-
- Hupa: 2 tribelets are to be distinguished for the Hupa
- proper. In addition, Merriam distinguishes the South Fork Hupa
- as a distinct dialect division. The linguistic separation is not
- supported by Goddard or Kroeber and I have therefore included the
- South Fork Hupa under the Hupa proper, but as a separate tribelet.
- This gives a total of 3 tribelets for the Hupa.
-
-In general, it may be stated that the California Athabascans did not
-have the strong local organization characteristic of Central California.
-Emphasis on wealth, although present, was less strongly developed than
-among the Yurok and therefore did not lead to the fragmented villages
-and tight family organization of that group. This statement, of course,
-does not apply to the Hupa, and probably not to the Whilkut, both of
-which were more like the Yurok.
-
-_Religion and the supernatural._--The clearest account of the religious
-practices of the Athabascans is given by Nomland (1938, pp. 93-98),
-who obtained her information from the Bear River woman, Nora Coonskin,
-herself a shaman. The account, however, may not be representative of the
-Athabascans as a whole.
-
-The Athabascans thought that each person had a spirit which, leaving him
-when he died, might come back to earth as a small creature about two
-feet high. This returned spirit could communicate with shamans. When a
-person had a fainting spell, the spirit departed from the body and a
-shaman had to be called in order to get the patient's spirit back. If
-the shaman failed, the patient died. Shamans' spirits went to a special
-afterworld and were accompanied only by the spirits of other shamans.
-
-Shamans were important among the Bear River people and probably among
-the other Athabascans as well. They might be either men or women; most
-often they were women, men being thought less powerful. The first
-signs of a shaman's power came in childhood, the visible signs being,
-for example, excessive drooling in sleep. If the childhood omens were
-proper, the training began about the age of twelve, under the direction
-of an older shaman, the main ceremony being a series of dances performed
-on five successive nights. Other ceremonies followed; then the girl
-was a full-fledged shaman. She was not supposed to use her power for a
-period of two to five years or it would harm her. The fee for training
-the initiate was large, 200 to 300 dollars in Indian money (perhaps a
-6-8 ft. string of dentalia shells).
-
-There were two types of shamans--curing shamans and sucking shamans. The
-curing shaman sang and danced for two nights while her spirit searched
-for the spirit of the patient. A shaman's fee was from five to ten
-dollars per night; if the patient died within two months, the fee had to
-be returned.
-
-The sucking shamans could suck out pains which were causing illness.
-These shamans were paid more because they were more powerful; having
-greater power, they were in greater danger and had a shorter life
-expectancy.
-
-_Connections with other groups._--The foregoing account of economy,
-social organization, and religious practices does not by any means make
-up a complete picture of Athabascan life, but it illustrates certain
-salient factors. In particular, the connections with Northwestern
-California are clear. So far as influence from Northwestern California
-is concerned the Athabascans may be divided into three groups: the
-Hupa and Whilkut on the north are an integral part of the northwestern
-culture center; the Wailaki and Kato on the south are essentially
-Central Californian; and the groups in between are transitional, but
-more northern than southern in their outlook.
-
-
-
-
-ATHABASCAN BOUNDARIES
-
-
-In evaluating boundaries I have relied most heavily on the information
-of Merriam (map 3) and Kroeber (map 1). Merriam's data are contained in
-a 1:500,000 map of California, together with a descriptive text. The
-map and the description were made up by Dr. Merriam's daughter, Mrs.
-Zenaida Merriam Talbot, during the years 1939 to 1946, from information
-in Merriam's notes and journals, the latter of which are not accessible
-to this writer. Often, where Merriam's boundaries disagree with those of
-Kroeber or other authors, Merriam's line will follow a stream, whereas
-the alternative follows a ridge or drainage diversion. When the evidence
-is inconclusive, I have usually followed Kroeber's method and chosen the
-ridge rather than the stream as the boundary. In this area the streams
-are small and easily crossed during most of the year and therefore would
-not constitute a barrier sufficient for the divergence of dialects. On
-the other hand, the hills were visited only briefly for hunting and
-gathering; the population depended to a great extent on the products of
-streams for its subsistence, and consequently all the permanent villages
-were in the lowlands and canyons. For this reason, the ridges rather
-than the streams would tend to be boundaries. Kroeber has discussed this
-point more generally (1939, p. 216) and also in greater detail (1925_a_,
-p. 160).
-
-
-EXTERIOR BOUNDARIES
-
-The southern boundary of the Athabascans begins at Usal Creek on the
-coast and goes eastward for a few miles before swinging south to include
-the drainages of Hollow Tree Creek and the South Fork of the Eel in
-Kato territory. It turns north to enclose the headwaters of South Fork
-and proceeds along the ridge dividing Ten Mile Creek from the main Eel
-until it reaches the drainage of Blue Rock Creek; it then passes around
-north of the creek and crosses the Eel near the mouth of the creek. From
-this point it runs in an easterly direction around the drainage of Hulls
-Creek.
-
-Kroeber's map in the Handbook shows the southern boundary beginning a
-few miles south of Usal Creek, but Merriam and Nomland both maintain
-that the creek itself is the boundary and Gifford (1939, p. 304) says
-that both Sinkyone and Yuki were spoken in the village situated at the
-mouth of the creek. The information of all four authors came from either
-Sally or Tom Bell, wife and husband, who are respectively Shelter Cove
-Sinkyone and Coast Yuki. I have accepted Merriam's boundary, since it
-agrees with Nomland's.
-
-Merriam maintains that the western boundary of the Kato runs along the
-South Fork of the Eel and he is partly supported in this by Barrett
-(1908, map), whose boundary includes the drainage of South Fork but
-not the drainage of Hollow Tree Creek. Barrett, however, disavows
-any certainty on this particular boundary. Kroeber's line, which
-does include the drainage of Hollow Tree Creek in Kato territory, is
-supported by a specific statement from Gifford (1939, p. 296) that
-"Hollow Tree Creek did not belong to the Coast Yuki although they fished
-there." I have therefore accepted Kroeber's version.
-
-All authorities agree on the southern and eastern boundaries of the
-Kato as far north as the drainage of Blue Rock Creek. Merriam claims
-this drainage for the Wailaki, whereas both Kroeber and Foster claim it
-for the ta'no'm tribelet of the Yuki. It is evident that this territory
-was disputed, for it was the scene of several of the wars involving the
-Wailaki, the Kato, and the Yuki (Kroeber, 1925_a_, p. 165; 1925_b_).
-Kroeber obtained a detailed list of place names in this area from a
-ta'no'm Yuki, whereas Merriam's Wailaki information is only of a most
-general nature. For this reason I have given the territory to the Yuki.
-
-All the authorities, except Foster, agree on the rest of the southern
-boundary of the Athabascans. Foster has the Yuki-Wailaki line cross
-Hulls Creek about five miles from its mouth instead of passing south of
-its drainage. Both Kroeber and Merriam favor the more southern line, and
-Goddard (1924, p. 224) says that the Wailaki claimed a fishing spot in
-the disputed area, so I have accepted this version.
-
-The eastern boundary of the Athabascans runs north along the ridge
-separating the drainages of the North Fork and Middle Fork of the Eel
-until it reaches the headwaters of the Mad River. Thence it runs in a
-northern direction along the ridge that separates the drainage of the
-Mad River from that of the South Fork of the Trinity until it reaches
-Grouse Creek, where it turns eastward to cross the South Fork of the
-Trinity at the mouth of the creek. It continues north on the east side
-of South Fork, following the crest until it crosses the main Trinity
-about five miles above its confluence with South Fork, and then follows
-around the headwaters of Horse Linto Creek and Mill Creek.
-
-Merriam's eastern Athabascan boundary conflicts with the one drawn by
-Kroeber, Foster, and Goddard in assigning the northern part of the
-drainage of the Middle Fork of the Eel to the Pitch Wailaki instead of
-to the Yuki. Merriam is almost certainly wrong here, for Goddard (1924)
-definitely does not include this area within Wailaki territory and his
-information in this region appears to have been especially reliable.
-Moreover, Merriam got his information from natives of the main Eel
-River, who were evidently not on good terms with their relatives to the
-east and knew little about them. I have therefore accepted the Kroeber
-boundary.
-
-The next conflict is to the north of this, where Kroeber's boundary
-runs up the ridge separating the Mad River from the South Fork of the
-Trinity, whereas Merriam's runs along South Fork itself in the twenty
-miles from Yolla Bolly Mountain northwest to Ruth. Essene (1942) agrees
-with Merriam on this point, but his data add nothing to the argument,
-since he worked with the same Lassik informant as Merriam. I have
-accepted Kroeber's version because it is corroborated by both Goddard
-(1907) and Du Bois (1935, map 1), who agree in assigning the valley of
-the South Fork of the Trinity to the Wintun.
-
-Kroeber and Merriam agree on the line running north of Ruth as far as
-a point about fifteen miles south of Grouse Creek, where Merriam's
-line drifts westward to follow the north-south channel of Grouse Creek
-for a short distance, whereas Kroeber's line follows due north along
-the drainage pattern. Essene supports Kroeber, but his informant did
-not come from this region so her testimony perhaps cannot be relied on
-heavily. I have accepted Kroeber's line because it follows the drainage
-pattern.
-
-Kroeber's boundary also conflicts with Merriam's on the east side of
-South Fork. Kroeber's line runs along the ridge separating South Fork
-from the main Trinity whereas Merriam's runs along the Trinity itself.
-The testimony of Dixon on the Chimariko (1910, pp. 295-296) supports
-Kroeber, so I have accepted the latter's line.
-
-The northern boundary of the Athabascans runs west, parallel to Mill
-Creek, crossing the Trinity a few miles south of its confluence with
-the Klamath, and then continues west until it reaches Bald Hills Ridge,
-which separates Redwood Creek drainage from Klamath River drainage. It
-continues north along this ridge and then turns east to cross Redwood
-Creek about ten miles southeast of Orick.
-
-Goddard (1914_a_, pl. 38) indicates three Athabascan summer camps on the
-Yurok side of the dividing ridge. This may mean that some Athabascan
-territory was included in the Klamath drainage, but if so, it would
-contradict the testimony of the Yurok (Kroeber, 1925_a_, fig. 1;
-Waterman, 1920, map 2). However, the land away from the Klamath was
-little used by the Yurok (Kroeber, 1925_a_, p. 8), so it may be that
-this territory was claimed by both groups. I have accepted Kroeber's
-boundary here. Otherwise there are no conflicts on the northern boundary.
-
-The western boundary of the Athabascans runs due south from Redwood
-Creek, following the 124th Meridian, crossing the North Fork of the Mad
-River at Blue Lake and crossing the main Mad River a few miles above
-the mouth of North Fork. From here the line follows south around the
-drainage of Humboldt Bay until it crosses the Eel River at the mouth
-of the Van Duzen, whence it runs south to Bear River Ridge, which it
-follows west to the ocean.
-
-A major conflict in the western boundary of the Athabascans involves
-the drainage of the North Fork of the Mad River. Kroeber and Loud
-both assign this area to the Wiyot, whereas Merriam assigns it to the
-Athabascans. Neither Kroeber nor Loud gives specific data in support of
-his contention; thus Merriam's specific local information quoted below,
-renders his line preferable.
-
- Sunday, August 11, 1918.... I found two old men of the
- same tribe, who were born and reared at the Blue Lake rancheria
- 'Ko-tin-net--the westernmost village of the Ha-whil-kut-ka tribe.
-
-I have therefore accepted Merriam's boundary.
-
-From the Mad River south to the Eel there is general agreement except
-that, as usual, Merriam's lines tend to follow the streams, whereas
-those of Kroeber and Loud follow the ridges. Another conflict comes
-at the crossing of the Eel River. Curtis (1924, 13:67) says the line
-crosses at the mouth of the Van Duzen. Nomland (1938, map 1), Loud,
-and Merriam all agree with this. Powers (1877, p. 101) and Kroeber
-both locate the line a few miles up the river from this point at Eagle
-Prairie, while Nomland's Wiyot informant (Nomland and Kroeber, 1936, map
-1) places the line even farther south at the mouth of Larabee Creek. The
-weight of evidence indicates that the line was probably near the mouth
-of the Van Duzen; Goddard (1929, p. 292) states that there was a Bear
-River village near there.
-
-There is also some disagreement on the northern boundary of the Bear
-River group. Nomland says that it is at Fleener Creek, about five miles
-north of Bear River Ridge, whereas Kroeber indicates a line about two
-miles north of Bear River Ridge. Loud, Merriam, and Goddard, on the
-other hand, all indicate that the boundary is Bear River Ridge itself.
-Nomland's boundary is almost certainly in error, since Loud gives Wiyot
-villages occurring south of that line. Most of the evidence points to
-Bear River Ridge as the line, and this version has been accepted.
-
-
-INTERIOR BOUNDARIES
-
-There is no disagreement on the western boundary of the Hupa. It
-runs north and south along Bald Hills Ridge, dividing the drainages
-of Redwood Creek and the Trinity River. Merriam gives the Hupa
-two divisions--the Tin-nung-hen-na-o, or Hupa proper, and the
-Ts´[)a]-nung-wh[)a], or Southern Hupa. The line dividing these two
-groups lies just north of the main Trinity to the east of South Fork and
-along Madden Creek to the west of South Fork. Kroeber (1925_a_, p. 129)
-and Goddard (1903_a_, p. 7) do not give any support for a linguistic
-division, as indicated by Merriam, but there does seem to have been some
-cultural difference.
-
-In the division of the territory west of the Hupa Merriam differs
-radically from Kroeber and Goddard, although all three scholars divide
-the area between two groups. Kroeber and Goddard call the northernmost
-group Chilula, an anglicization of the Yurok word tsulu-la meaning "Bald
-Hills people," and the southern, Whilkut, from the Hupa word hoilkut-hoi
-meaning "Redwood Creek people" or "upper Redwood Creek people."
-
-Merriam calls the first of his two divisions Hoilkut and says that they
-lived on Redwood Creek and on the North Fork of the Mad. This group he
-further subdivides into three parts: one, living on lower Redwood Creek,
-corresponds to the Chilula of Kroeber and Goddard; another, on upper
-Redwood Creek, corresponds to part of Kroeber's Whilkut; and a third, on
-the North Fork of the Mad River, corresponds to a part of Loud's Wiyot.
-
-Merriam calls his second division Ma-we-nok. They live in the drainage
-of the main Mad River and correspond to a part of Kroeber's Whilkut.
-
-It would appear that, except for Goddard's Chilula information (Goddard,
-1914_a_), Merriam's data are the most detailed and therefore preferable.
-He had informants from lower Redwood Creek, from the North Fork of the
-Mad River, and from the main Mad River. For this reason I have accepted
-his boundaries. I therefore propose that all the peoples previously
-included under the terms Whilkut or Chilula be called Whilkut. This
-seems justified by Merriam's statements, on the one hand, that the
-Mad River Ma-we-nok differed but little in speach from their Whilkut
-neighbors, and, on the other hand, that the other groups in the area
-called themselves hoilkut or terms related to this.
-
-[Illustration: Map 1. Athabascan boundaries: Kroeber vs. Baumhoff.]
-
-[Illustration: Map 2. Athabascan boundaries: Baumhoff.]
-
-[Illustration: Map 3. Athabascan boundaries: Merriam vs. Baumhoff.]
-
-[Illustration: Map 4. Athabascan boundaries: various authors vs.
-Baumhoff.]
-
-If this proposal is accepted, the Whilkut may then be divided into
-four subgroups--the Chilula Whilkut, the Kloki Whilkut, the Mad River
-Whilkut, and the North Fork Whilkut. The Chilula Whilkut would occupy
-essentially the territory assigned to the Chilula by Goddard and
-Kroeber--the drainage of Redwood Creek from about ten miles southeast
-of Orick to about a mile above the mouth of Minor Creek. Above them are
-the Kloki Whilkut, occupying the upper drainage of Redwood Creek. The
-name Kloki Whilkut means "prairie" Whilkut, a name used by these people
-for themselves, according to Merriam, and derived from the prairies that
-occur on upper Redwood Creek. The Mad River Whilkut would be the group
-in the drainage of Mad River from the mouth of North Fork as far up as
-Bug Creek above Iaqua Buttes. The North Fork Whilkut would then be the
-group in the entire drainage of the North Fork of the Mad River.
-
-The northern boundary of the Nongatl begins in the west near Kneeland
-at the Wiyot boundary and runs southeast around Iaqua Buttes and the
-drainage of the Mad River, then northeast to Grouse Creek. Kroeber and
-Merriam agree on this boundary east of Iaqua Buttes, but west of that
-landmark Merriam's line takes a northeast-southwest direction whereas
-Kroeber's line runs due east-west. I have accepted Merriam's line here
-because he has more detailed information than Kroeber on the neighboring
-Whilkut. Neither has much information on the Nongatl themselves.
-
-One of the main interior lines of the Athabascans is the one which,
-running north and south along the South Fork of the Eel, divides the
-coastal groups on the west from the interior peoples to the east. It
-begins at the mouth of the Van Duzen on the main Eel and runs south
-along the Eel as far as Scotia, dividing the Nongatl from the Bear
-River group. At Scotia it coincides with the Sinkyone-Nongatl boundary
-and then continues in a southerly direction but, instead of lying
-immediately on the river, it drifts slightly to the east to include also
-the land adjacent to the stream. It continues thus near to, but off, the
-main Eel until it crosses the river at about McCann, a few miles above
-the mouth of South Fork. After crossing the main Eel, the line goes
-south, including the immediate river valley of the South Fork of the Eel
-in Sinkyone territory, until it turns west to cross South Fork at the
-mouth of Hollow Tree Creek, continuing to the coast at Usal Creek.
-
-This section of the Athabascan boundary has been much disputed. It seems
-certain that the western side of the Eel from the mouth of the Van Duzen
-to Scotia was Bear River territory. This distribution is attested by
-Powers (1877, p. 107), who says that the Bear River group owned as far
-south as the mouth of South Fork, by Nomland's Bear River informant
-(1938, map 1), by Kroeber, and by Goddard, who says (1929, p. 291),
-"There was, however, one village at the mouth of Van Duzen creek which
-was allied to Bear River both in its dialect and politically." This
-evidence is fully in accordance with that of Merriam.
-
-The eastern side of the river along this stretch goes to the Nongatl by
-default. Kroeber claims it for the Bear River people and Nomland's Wiyot
-informant claimed it for the Wiyot (Nomland and Kroeber, 1936, map 1)
-but except for these sources possession is denied by Wiyot, Bear River,
-and Sinkyone alike.
-
-South of Scotia the area is also in dispute. Nomland and Kroeber claim
-that the eastern side of the Eel from Scotia to the mouth of South Fork
-is Nongatl. They say (1936, p. 40):
-
- In any event, Eel river from Scotia to Larrabee was not
- Mattole, as Kroeber has it in map 1 of his Handbook, nor was it
- Sinkyone. Nomland's Bear River, Mattole, and Sinkyone informants
- were positive on the point. If Athabascan, the stretch in question
- belonged to the Nongatl (Saia). Otherwise it was Wiyot.
-
-Merriam, on the contrary claims that this territory was definitely
-Sinkyone.
-
-We must evaluate the statements of the informants involved before
-reaching a decision on this point. Nomland's Bear River informant was
-evidently not particularly accurate on boundaries, for she placed
-the northern boundary of the Bear River group at Fleener Creek when
-it was almost certainly at Bear River Ridge (see p. 163). Therefore
-her testimony may be questioned on the present point also. Nomland's
-Sinkyone informants were from the Shelter Cove Sinkyone of the Briceland
-area to the south, and furthermore only one of them was said to be
-reliable. Merriam, however, presents detailed evidence in the form
-of place names obtained from George Burt, a very good informant who
-was born and raised among the northern Sinkyone at Bull Creek. I have
-therefore accepted the evidence of George Burt via Merriam, even though
-several of Nomland's informants deny it.
-
-Actually, I have accepted Merriam's line as far south as Phillipsville
-on the South Fork of the Eel, even though it conflicts somewhat with the
-lines of Nomland and Kroeber. Merriam's information for this stretch of
-South Fork is supported in detail by Goddard's village lists. South of
-Phillipsville, Merriam's line runs along South Fork itself instead of
-lying slightly east of it. This line is contradicted by Goddard, whose
-informant, a native of the region, gave Goddard village names on both
-sides of the river as far south as Garberville. I have accepted the line
-indicated by Goddard's information along this stretch.
-
-South of Garberville I have relied heavily on Nomland. She had three
-informants from the Shelter Cove Sinkyone--Sally Bell, Tom Bell, and
-Jack Woodman, of whom she considered only the last reliable. Merriam
-seems to have relied entirely on Sally Bell for information about this
-group and his information should therefore be somewhat discounted.
-
-The Bear River-Mattole boundary is not disputed. Merriam and Nomland
-agree that it begins on the coast at Davis Creek and then follows the
-ridge east to the headwaters of Bear River. The two authors do not agree
-on the Bear River-Sinkyone line. Nomland's boundary goes due east from
-Bear River headwaters to strike the South Fork of the Eel a few miles
-above its mouth. Merriam's line instead goes north to intercept the main
-Eel at Scotia. I have accepted Merriam's version on the basis of George
-Burt's evidence, even though Kroeber agrees with Nomland.
-
-The Mattole-Sinkyone boundary begins at Spanish Flat on the coast
-and goes northeast from there, crossing the Mattole River just above
-the mouth of Upper North Fork, Mattole River, and continuing in that
-direction to the headwaters of the Bear River. I have altered Merriam's
-map on this point. It shows the Mattole-Sinkyone line reaching the
-coast at Big Flat, a point about six miles down the coast from Spanish
-Flat. Merriam's notes say, however, that the line ends at Spanish Flat.
-Merriam's line crosses the Mattole River near the town of Upper Mattole
-about five miles below the mouth of Upper North Fork, but Goddard's
-Mattole informant gave him villages as far up as the mouth of Upper
-North Fork and I have considered this fact to be decisive. Nomland's
-Mattole-Sinkyone line reaches the coast at Four Mile Creek, about five
-miles up the coast from Merriam's line at Spanish Flat. This line of
-Nomland's is probably a tribelet boundary, which Merriam and Goddard
-give as occurring at about that point (see Mattole Tribelets). Otherwise
-Nomland's boundary agrees with that of Merriam.
-
-Merriam's line dividing the northern or Lolangkok Sinkyone from the
-southern or Shelter Cove Sinkyone begins in the east on South Fork Eel
-about a mile or two above the mouth of Salmon Creek, runs west from
-there through Kings Peak, and crosses the Mattole River just north of
-Ettersberg, intersecting the Mattole line a few miles from the coast.
-This line as given is the same as Merriam's, except that his begins in
-the east at Redwood Creek instead of at Salmon Creek. The change here is
-based on Goddard's village list, which indicates the present line.
-
-The Lassik-Nongatl line begins in the east just below Ruth on the Mad
-River. It goes west from there around the headwaters of the Van Duzen
-River until it crosses the Eel at the mouth of Dobbyn Creek and thence
-west to the Sinkyone line. Kroeber and Merriam agree on the eastern
-part of this line but Essene disagrees with them, including a much
-larger portion of the drainage of the Mad and Van Duzen rivers in Lassik
-territory. I am at a loss to explain this version, since Essene's
-informant from the Lassik was the same one consulted by Merriam. It is
-not clear that Essene's boundaries were obtained from his informants,
-and this fact may explain the discrepancy. I have accepted the
-Kroeber-Merriam line here. To the west of this, Kroeber's line, instead
-of crossing the Eel, follows the river toward the northwest, so none
-of the main Eel River valley falls in Nongatl territory. Goddard gives
-villages on the main Eel which are said to be allied with others in the
-Blocksburg region, so the Nongatl must have claimed at least a small
-section of the Eel. I have therefore accepted the Merriam version.
-
-The Wailaki-Lassik boundary begins in the east at the head of the Mad
-River and runs west to the North Fork of the Eel, which it crosses at
-the mouth of Salt Creek. It follows Salt Creek for a short way and
-then goes west to Kekawaka Creek, which it follows to its mouth on the
-main Eel. It crosses the Eel here and then goes west to intersect the
-Sinkyone boundary at the East Branch of the South Fork of the Eel. The
-boundary as given here is identical with the one given by Merriam,
-except that he includes part of the drainage of the Mad within Wailaki
-territory whereas Kroeber does not. I have accepted Kroeber's version,
-because it is supported in a negative way by Goddard (1924), who fails
-to include any Mad River drainage in Pitch Wailaki territory.
-
-West of this area, Kroeber's boundary runs considerably north of
-Merriam's and of the boundary I have accepted. Merriam's line seems
-preferable because it is supported by Goddard and because Merriam's
-information is more specific than Kroeber's.
-
-According to the information of Merriam and Goddard, the Wailaki may
-be divided into three groups--the Eel River Wailaki, the North Fork
-Wailaki, and the Pitch Wailaki. The eastern group, the Pitch Wailaki,
-occupy the drainage of North Fork Eel River above Asbill Creek, Hulls
-Creek, and Casoose Creek. Their western boundary begins in the north
-on Salt Creek near its confluence with North Fork Eel. It runs south
-from this point along Salt Creek and beyond it, crossing the North Fork
-of the Eel just above the mouth of Asbill Creek and intersecting the
-Yuki-Wailaki line near Summit Valley. The northern border of the North
-Fork Wailaki begins in the west on the main Eel River at the mouth of
-Cottonwood Creek, about three miles north of the mouth of North Fork
-Eel, and runs from there eastward for about six miles, where it hits the
-western boundary of the Pitch Wailaki. The western boundary of the North
-Fork Wailaki is the main Eel River from the mouth of Cottonwood Creek
-south to the Yuki line near Bell Springs Railroad Station.
-
-The Kato-Wailaki line runs from the head of Blue Rock Creek in the
-east to the mouth of Hollow Tree Creek on the South Fork of the Eel in
-the west. This is Kroeber's version of the boundary. Merriam's version
-places the line somewhat south of this, beginning at Rattlesnake Creek
-in the west and going eastward south of Blue Rock Creek. Since I have
-ceded the drainage of Blue Rock Creek to the Yuki (see p. 160) in
-accordance with the views of Kroeber, I must, as a corollary, accept the
-northern boundary of the Kato as given by him.
-
-The net result of the foregoing discussion is that the line surrounding
-the Athabascan peoples of Northwestern California remains much the
-same as Kroeber showed it in 1925, whereas the tribal boundaries are
-considerably changed. In the north, the Chilula and Whilkut occupy
-almost entirely different areas and the Hupa have been divided into two
-subgroups. On the coast, the Bear River and Mattole are divided, but
-this division had been shown by Goddard and Nomland previously. The
-Sinkyone have been divided into two subgroups and the Wailaki into three.
-
-A really major difference is the accretion of territory by the Nongatl.
-This group is one about which least is known and this may be the reason
-why the map shows their territory as so extensive. It is very likely
-that data from a few good informants would show that the Nongatl
-actually comprise several distinct groups. There is a hint of this in
-Essene's account of Lassik war stories (1942, p. 91). He notes that
-the Nai'aitci, centering near the town of Bridgeville, were distinct
-from the Blocksburg people. Both of these groups are placed within the
-Nongatl area. No doubt more detailed information than we possess would
-show that the area which we have labeled Nongatl was actually occupied
-by two, three, or even more distinct groups.
-
-
-
-
-GROUPS
-
-
-KATO
-
-The Kato are the southernmost of the California Athabascans (see pl. 11,
-_e_ for a view of Kato territory). They are surrounded on three sides
-by Yukian peoples and consequently resemble culturally the peoples of
-Central California rather than those of Northwestern California. The
-name Kato appears to be of Pomo origin and it was first thought that
-the Kato language was a dialect of Pomo (Powers, 1877, p. 147). It was
-not until 1903 that Goddard showed their Athabascan affinity (Goddard,
-1903_b_).
-
-Information on the ethnogeography of the Kato is derived from several
-sources. Merriam's notes contain some information, which seems to have
-come from a man named Bill Ray, who was living near Laytonville on
-August 16, 1922. This man had been Goddard's informant in 1906, when Ray
-was already between sixty and sixty-five years old (Goddard, 1909, p.
-68, pl. 9) and he served also as Kroeber's informant in 1923 (Kroeber,
-1925_b_).
-
-The Merriam notes contain, in addition to several village names, a few
-place and tribal names which I present herewith.
-
- Kato: to-chil´-pe ke´-ah-hahng
-
- Jackson V. people (inc. Branscom): sin´-k[=o]k ke´-ah-hahng
-
- Wailaki: we´-tah^ch
-
- Yuki of Round V.: chinch´
-
- Coast Yuki: bahng´-ke´-ah-hahng
-
- Southern Sinkyone: ketch´-ing ke´-ah-hahng
-
- Tribe on the N side of Rattlesnake Cr. and E of South Fork Eel
- division of Wailaki (?): tek´ ke´-ah-hahng
-
- Long V.: kin-t[)e]^{hl}-pe
-
- Laytonville: ten-tah^{ch}-tung
-
- Cahto Pond (now drained): to-chil´-pa
-
- Long V. Cr.: shah´-nah
-
- South Fork Eel R.: nahs-ling´-che
-
- Rattlesnake Cr.: tal-tl[=o]l´-kwit
-
- Main Eel R.: tah-ke´-kwit
-
- Blue Rock: seng-chah´-tung
-
- Bell Springs: s[)e]^{ch}-pis
-
- Round V.: kun-tel-ch[=o]-pe
-
- Jackson V.: kus´-cho-che´-pe; kas-tos´ cheek´-be
-
- Branscomb Mt.: k[=i]k; ch[=i]s´-naw
-
-
-VILLAGES
-
-The villages of this group are mostly taken from Barrett (1908, pp.
-280-283) indicated below by (B). Those taken from Merriam's notes are
-distinguished by (M). The information given with each of the villages is
-sometimes a direct quotation but most often is paraphrased.
-
- 1. netce'l[=i]gût (B). At a point about 9 mi. nearly due W of
- the town of Laytonville and about 3 mi. SE of the confluence of the
- E fork of the South Fork of Eel R. with the South Fork of Eel R.
- This village is on top of the ridge separating these two streams
- and is on the property of Mr. Jacob Lamb.
-
- 2. yictciLti'ñkût, "wolf something-lying-down creek" (B). On
- the S bank of Ten Mile Cr. at a point about 5 mi. WNW of the town
- of Laytonville.
-
- 3. sentca'[=u]kût, "rock big creek"; or kave'mato (Northern
- Pomo dialect name), "rock big" (B). On Big Rock Cr. at a point
- about 1-1/2 mi. from its confluence with Ten Mile Cr., or about
- 5-1/2 mi. nearly due W of the town of Laytonville.
-
- sen-chow´-ten (M). Kato name for their village at Big Rock,
- about 4 mi. N of their present rancheria in Long V.
-
- 4. ka'ibi, "nuts in" (B). On the NE bank of Ten Mile Cr. at a
- point about 3 mi. downstream from the town of Laytonville.
-
- 5. neb[=o]'c[=e]gût, "ground hump on-top" (B). On what is
- known as the Wilson ranch at a point about 1 mi. W of Laytonville.
-
- 6. seLgaitceli'nda, "rock white run-out" (B). About 300 yds. E
- of the house on what is known as the "old" John Reed ranch about 1
- mi. N of Laytonville.
-
- 7. bûntcn[=o]ndi'lyi, "fly settle-upon under" (B). Just NW of
- Laytonville and but a short distance from the place now occupied by
- the Indians near Laytonville.
-
- 8. ko'cbi, "blackberry there" (B). About 1-1/2 mi. WSW of
- Laytonville and on the SW bank of the Ten Mile Cr.
-
- 9. tc[=i]b[=e]'takût, "fir tips creek" (B). About a mile SW of
- the town of Laytonville and about 1/2 mi. up the creek which drains
- Cahto V. from its confluence with Ten Mile Cr.
-
- che-pa-tah-kut (M). A former village in the northern part of
- Long V. on the James White place.
-
- 10. dist[=e]gû'ts[=i][=u], "madrona crooked under" (B). On the
- western side of Long V. at a point about 2 mi. SSE of Laytonville.
-
- 11. t[=o]dji'Lbi, "water? ... in" (B). At the site now
- occupied by the Indians at Cahto. This site is on the W bank of the
- small creek running from Cahto into Ten Mile Cr.
-
- 12. bûntcten[=o]ndi'lkût, "fly low settle-upon creek" (B). On
- the N bank of the northern branch of the head of the South Fork of
- the Eel R. at a point about a mile SSW of Cahto.
-
- 13. kûcy[=i]'[=u]yet[=o]kût, "alder under water creek" (B). On
- the N bank of the South Fork of Eel R. at a point about 3 mi. SW of
- Cahto. This site is about 1/2 mi. E of the ranch house on the Clark
- ranch.
-
- 14. ne'[=i]yi, "ground under" (B), probably signifying that
- the village was situated under a projecting ridge. On the S bank of
- the South Fork of Eel R. at a point about 3 mi. S of Branscomb.
-
- 15. s[=e]ne'tckût, "rock gravel creek" (B). On the NW bank
- of the small stream known as Mud Springs Cr., which is tributary
- to the South Fork of Eel R. This site is about 3 mi. a little S
- of E of Branscomb. There are on this creek, and not far from this
- village site, several springs which flow a very thin blueish mud,
- thus giving the creek its name.
-
- 16. tontce'kût, "water bad creek" (B). About 1/4 mi. W of the
- South Fork of Eel R. and about 1 mi. SW of Branscomb.
-
- 17. senansa'^{n}kût, "rock hang-down creek" (B). On the E bank
- of the South Fork of Eel R. at a point about 1-1/2 mi. downstream
- from Branscomb.
-
-In addition to this list, there are two other sources of information on
-villages. First, Curtis (1924, 14:184) presents a list of six villages,
-almost all of which it is impossible to locate. None of the names
-corresponds to any given by either Barrett or Merriam, and they are
-therefore suspect as village names, though they may be valid place names
-and are certainly good Athabascan. In the list below Curtis' orthography
-has been changed slightly. The changes follow the pattern set by Curtis
-in his Hupa village lists (Curtis, 1924, Vol. 13).
-
-_Curtis List (1924, 14:184)_
-
- chunsandung, "tree 1-1/2 mi. W of Laytonville
- prostrate place" on the site of the cemetery
-
- tsetandung, "trail emerges At the foot of the mountain
- place" W of Laytonville
-
- totakut, "water center" N of tsetandung. On a knoll
- down which water flowed
- on two sides
-
- chekselgindun, "they N tsetandung
- killed woman place"
-
-yitsche Ltindung, "they found wolf place"
-
-seyuhuchetsdung, "old stone house place"
-
-The second source is the notes of Goddard, who did extensive work in
-the area in 1906 (Goddard, 1909), though mostly on language and myth.
-His notes contain information on two villages, neither of which can be
-located because the township and range coördinates have been changed
-since the time of recording and also because the name of the creek
-mentioned does not appear on maps in my possession. The two cards
-bearing the information have the penciled notations 51 and 52 written
-on their corners. This indicates that Goddard had recorded at least 50
-other sites for the Kato, a conclusion which is further corroborated
-by his own statement (Goddard, 1909, p. 67). Our information on Kato
-villages is therefore correspondingly incomplete.
-
-_Goddard List (Goddard, Notes)_
-
- ne^{=e=}[-l]soki, "ground blue tail" SW sec. 26, T. 22 N.,
- R. 15 W. On a flat 200 yds. N of Blue Hill Cr. and 150 yds. W of
- the river. There are 3 deep pits on the eastern edge of the higher
- flat. Bill thought there were 3 others 100 yds. S where a white
- man's house had stood, ne'^{[-l]}s[=o]k[=i] k[=i]yahûn.
-
- t'un[-l]tcintcki, "leaves black tail" W sec. 26, T. 22 N., R.
- 15 W. On the higher bank 50 yds. N of tûn[-l]tcintckw[=o]t, the
- next creek N of Blue Hill Cr. and 400 yds. W of the river. There is
- timber W. Dr. Wilson used to live there. The site has been plowed.
- Bill counted six places where he thought houses had been.
-
-
-WAILAKI
-
-The Wailaki, the southernmost group of Athabascans on the Eel River,
-are as little chronicled as most of the Athabascan groups. As far as
-geography and language are concerned we have very good information
-(Goddard, 1923_a_; 1923_b_), but there is very little general
-ethnography. Kroeber was able to devote to them only a little more than
-three pages in the Handbook (1925, pp. 151-154), and we know scarcely
-more today.
-
-The territory of the Wailaki lies for the most part outside the redwood
-forest (pls. 11_b_, _c_) and for that reason they had access to a more
-abundant supply of the food, particularly acorns, used by the interior
-peoples than did most of the Athabascan groups. Perhaps for this reason,
-or perhaps simply because of proximity, the culture of the Wailaki
-shows considerable affinity with the culture of Central California and
-correspondingly less with that of Northwestern California. This affinity
-is particularly evident in their tribelet organization, which obtrudes
-itself in the accounts of both Goddard and Merriam. In the groups
-farther north such organization receives little attention.
-
-Merriam's information on the Wailaki consists for the most part of
-ethnogeography, including villages, tribelets, and place names. His
-informants in this group were Fred Major and Wylakki Tip. I have been
-able to find out nothing about Fred Major, but Merriam gives the
-following statement on Wylakki Tip.
-
- My informant, known as Wylakki Tip, a full blood Tsennahkennes
- [Eel R. Wailaki, but see Kroeber's data, p. 229], whose father and
- mother were born and lived at Bell Springs, tells me that they
- belonged to the Bell Springs Canyon band known as Tsi-to-ting
- ke-ah, named from the neighboring mountain tsi-to-ting. He adds
- that from the mouth of Blue Rock Creek northward the Tsennahkennes
- owned the country to the main Eel, and that the present location of
- Bell Springs Station, on the west side of the river, is in their
- territory but that the east side of the river from Bell Springs
- Station to the mouth of Blue Rock Creek was held by a so-called
- Yukean tribe.
-
-In Merriam's notes there is no general statement on the Bahneko or North
-Fork Wailaki; he was evidently somewhat undecided whether they were
-truly a distinct group. However, he comments on the Tsennahkennes, or
-Eel River Wailaki, as follows.
-
-[Illustration: Map 5. Villages and tribelets of the Eel Wailaki and the
-North Fork Wailaki. Roman numerals indicate tribelets, arabic numerals
-village sites.]
-
-Tsennahkennes ... A Nung-gah^{hl} Athabascan tribe in north-central
-Mendocino County, California, occupying the greater part of the
-mountainous country on both sides of main Eel River from Red Mountain
-and the upper waters of East Branch South Fork Eel easterly to Salt
-Creek, and from a few miles south of Harris southerly to Rattlesnake
-Creek. Their territory thus includes the major part of Elkhorn Creek,
-the headwaters of East Branch South Fork Eel, Milk Ranch Creek, and Red
-Mountain Creek, practically all of Cedar Creek, and the whole of Bell
-Springs and Blue Rock Creeks. The old stage road from Cummings north to
-Harris, passing Blue Rock and Bell Springs, traverses their territory.
-
-
-WAILAKI PHONOLOGY
-
-It is clear that in recording Wailaki words Merriam followed the same
-principles that guided him in his published works on other Californian
-languages. In transcribing the Achomawi language he said (1928, p. vi),
-"All Indian words are written in simple phonetic English, the vowels
-having their normal alphabetic sounds." For a more precise determination
-I have made a comparison of words recorded by both Merriam and Goddard.
-The values of the symbols used by Goddard are taken from a list he
-gives in his Wailaki Texts (1923_b_, p. 77) together with Phonetic
-Transcription of American Indian Languages (Amer. Anthro. Assoc., 1916),
-a report which Goddard helped prepare.
-
-A total of twenty-eight words recorded by both Merriam and Goddard were
-found. Although the discrepancies seem great, this is because Merriam
-used Webster's English orthography whereas Goddard used a technical one
-modified from the old Smithsonian system. Whatever the limitations of
-Merriam's orthography for considerations of grammar (which he did not
-try to obtain), his recordings consistently check Goddard's independent
-information and serve as complete identifications of places and
-ethnographic facts.
-
-_Goddard's Wailaki Phonology_
-
- -------------+--------------------+--------+--------+--------+--------
- | | Labial | Apical | Frontal| Dorsal
- -------------+--------------------+--------+--------+--------+--------
- | fully voiced | g
- | +-----------------------------------
- | medium voiced | b d G
- +--------------------+-----------------------------------
- Stops | voiceless |
- | non-glottalized | t k
- | +-----------------------------------
- | voiceless |
- | glottalized | t' k'
- -------------+--------------------+-----------------------------------
- | non-glottalized | ts tc
- Affricates +--------------------+-----------------------------------
- | glottalized | ts' tc'
- -------------+--------------------+-----------------------------------
- | voiceless | s c
- Spirants +--------------------+-----------------------------------
- | voiced |
- -------------+--------------------+-----------------------------------
- Nasals | | n ñ
- -------------+--------------------+-----------------------------------
- Semivowels | | w y
- -------------+--------------------+-----------------------------------
- | voiced | l
- Laterals +--------------------+-----------------------------------
- | voiceless | [-l]
- -------------+--------------------+-----------------------------------
-
-Goddard gives the following vowels.
-
- i as in pique (written with an iota by Goddard)
- e as a in fate
- E as in met (written with an epsilon by Goddard)
- a as in father
- A as u in but (written with an alpha by Goddard)
- o as in note
-
-Following is a rough correspondence between Goddard's and Merriam's
-orthographies.
-
-_Comparison of Orthographies_
-
- _Goddard_ _Merriam_
- a ah (occasionally a or e)
- A ah, e, u, i (in order of frequency)
- ai a, i
- Ai i
- b b
- c s (once sh)
- d d, t
- e e
- E e, [=a]
- g [-l]g written as sk
- G does not occur
- h h
- i [=e], [)e] (oi written i)
- I i, u
- k k (ky written ch)
- k' k
- l does not occur
- [-l] kl, often not recorded at all ([-l] written sk)
- m n (Goddard says n sometimes becomes m by assimilation.
- Evidently it is n phonemically)
- n n (occasionally ng, once not recorded at all)
- ñ ng (occasionally n, twice not recorded at all)
- o o (occasionally u)
- s s
- t t
- t' does not occur
- tc ch (once tch)
- tc' does not occur
- ts does not occur
- ts' does not occur
- u does not occur
- w does not occur
- y y, ky written ch, kiyah always written ke-ah or ka-ah
-
-
-TRIBELETS
-
-The subgroups of the Wailaki (map 5) are called bands by Merriam and
-subtribes by Goddard but it is clear that they correspond precisely to
-the definition of tribelet given by Kroeber (1932, pp. 258-259), a fact
-which Kroeber noted at the time (p. 257). Goddard says (1923_a_, p. 95):
-
- [They] had definite boundaries on the river as well as
- delimited hunting grounds on an adjoining ridge. In the summer
- and fall they appear to have been under the control of one chief,
- and to have camped together for gathering nuts and seeds and for
- community hunting. In winter they lived in villages and were
- further subdivided.
-
-I. There is close agreement on the boundaries of the northernmost
-Wailaki tribelet on the western side of the Eel. Merriam gives the
-names kun-nun´-dung ke´-ah-hahng, ki´-kot-ke-ah-hahng, ki-ketch-e
-k[=a]-ah-hahng, and ki-ke´-che ke´-ah-hahng as designations for the
-group. He says the territory of this group runs from Chamise Creek
-in the north to Pine Creek in the south. Goddard gives the same name
-(rendered kaikitcEkaiya) and the same boundaries for the group.
-
-The territory north of Chamise Creek on the west side of the river is
-assigned by Merriam to the taht´-so ke´ah tribelet of the Lassik. This
-attribution would seem to indicate that Merriam has put his northern
-Wailaki boundary too far north, that it should hit the Eel at Chamise
-Creek rather than at Kekawaka Creek. Goddard calls these people the
-da[-l]sokaiya, "blue ground people," which no doubt corresponds to
-taht´-so ke´ah. He says, "It is doubtful that they should be counted as
-Wailaki, but they were not Lassik and probably spoke the same dialect as
-the Wailaki."
-
-II. This tribelet is called s[)e]-tah´-be ke´-ah-hahng or
-s[=a]-tah´-ke-ahng by Merriam. In one place his notes say that the
-territory includes land on both sides of the Eel, running south of
-Indian Creek on the western side. This is clearly not so, for he refers
-several times to a different tribelet occupying that area. That the
-tribelet was confined to the east side of the river is further indicated
-by Goddard, who gives Pine Creek on the north and Natoikot Creek on the
-south as the boundaries. Goddard's name for the tribelet is sEtakaiya.
-
-III. Goddard says that there was a tribelet on the west side of the Eel
-whose territory was bounded on the north by Natoikot Creek and extended
-south to a point opposite the mouth of North Fork. His name for this
-group is taticcokaiya. Merriam's name for the group in this general area
-is tah-chis´-tin ke-ah-hahng. He does not give any boundaries for them.
-
-IV. and V. Merriam gives the following names for the tribelet occupying
-the territory around Blue Rock and Bell Springs Creeks: tsi-to´-ting
-ke´-ah, from the name of Bell Springs Mountain; sen-chah´-ke´-ah;
-s[)e]-so ke´-ah-hahng, "Blue Rock Band"; then´-chah-tung k[=a]´-ah,
-"Blue Rock Band." On the other hand, he gives the following names for
-the people who occupied the west bank of the Eel for a mile or more
-south of the mouth of North Fork: nin-ken-n[=e]tch k[=a]-ah-hahng;
-nung-ken-ne-tse´ ke´-ah; n[)e]-tahs´ ke-ah-hahng. Goddard says that the
-entire stretch from the mouth of North Fork south to Blue Rock Creek
-on the west bank of the river was occupied by a single tribelet called
-nIñkannitckaiya, a name clearly corresponding to Merriam's names for the
-people on the west bank of the Eel, south of North Fork. I am inclined
-to think that Merriam is correct and that there were two tribelets in
-this area. Merriam's notes include five different references to the
-southern tribelet as a separate group, so there is a distinct impression
-of autonomy. If Merriam is correct in separating the two groups, the
-division line no doubt falls a mile or two north of Bell Springs Creek.
-
-VI. On the eastern side of the river Merriam gives two names for the
-tribelet holding the land south from Kekawaka Creek. He says the
-yu-e-yet´-te ke´-ah was the tribelet north of Chamise Creek. Their
-southernmost village, called sko´-teng, was on the east side of the
-river a half-mile or a mile south of Kekawaka Creek. The sko´-den ke´-ah
-Merriam gives as the name of the tribelet on the east side of the Eel
-River and about a half-mile south of Kekawaka Creek. Goddard gives
-i[-l]kodAñkaiya, corresponding to Merriam's sko´-den ke´-ah, as the
-name of the group extending from about two miles south of the mouth of
-Chamise Creek nearly to the mouth of Kekawaka Creek. Both Merriam and
-Goddard indicate some doubt whether these people were Wailaki.
-
-VII. Merriam gives the names ch[=e]s-kot k[=e]-ah-hahng,
-chis´-ko-ke´-ah, and t[=o]s-ahng´-kut for the tribelet living in
-Horseshoe Bend. The first two names come from the word chis-kot, the
-name for Copper Mine Creek. Goddard also gives these last two names for
-the group (written tciskokaiya and tosAñkaiya, "water stands people"),
-and he says their territory includes the land between Copper Mine Creek
-on the south and a point a mile or two south of Chamise Creek on the
-north.
-
-VIII. Goddard says that a tribelet named slakaiya or sEyadAñkaiya
-occupied the territory between Copper Mine Creek in the north and Willow
-Creek in the south. Merriam gives the name nung-ken-ne-tse´ ke´-ah to
-this group, which he locates on the east side of the Eel River at Island
-Mountain. He gives no boundaries for the group.
-
-IX. Merriam gives two names for the tribelet occupying the Indian Creek
-region. The chen-nes´-no-ke´-ah was the band on chen-nes-no´-kot Creek
-(Indian Cr.) from Lake Mountain to the Eel River; he also writes this
-name ken-nis-no-kut ke-ah-hahng. His other name for the group has the
-variants bas-k[=a]´-ah-hahng, bas-ki´-yah, bus-k[=a]-ah-hahng. This
-group is said to have been on the east side of the Eel River a mile
-or two north of Indian Creek (in the Fenton Range country). Goddard
-gives the name bAskaiya, "slide people," corresponding to the last of
-Merriam's names, for the tribelet from Willow Creek south to Cottonwood
-Creek. The name refers to a hillside, usually of clay, which has broken
-loose and has slid down.
-
-X. Merriam identifies no group as occupying the land from Cottonwood
-Creek south to the mouth of North Fork. Goddard says the region was
-occupied by a tribelet called sE[-l]tchikyokaiya, "rock red large
-people."
-
-XI. Merriam says the s[=a]´-tan-do´-che ke´-ah-hahng was the name of
-a tribelet on the north side of North Fork and about a half-mile from
-its junction with the main Eel. The name means "rock reaching into the
-water." Goddard's name for this same group is sEtandoñkiyahAñ, a clear
-correspondence, and he indicates that their land was on about the last
-mile of North Fork.
-
-XII. According to Merriam the next group up North Fork was named
-s[)e]-cho ke´-ah-hahng. Its land was on the north side of North Fork a
-mile or more above its mouth. Goddard has the same name for the group,
-sEtcokiyahAñ; he says the people occupied both the north and south sides
-of a one-mile stretch of North Fork beginning a little way below the
-mouth of Wilson Creek and extending downstream from there.
-
-XIII. Merriam says ki´-ye ke´-ah-hahng was the name of the tribelet on
-both sides of North Fork at the mouth of Wilson Creek. This is in accord
-with Goddard's data. He gives the name as kAiyEkiyahAñ. Neither Goddard
-nor Merriam gives the limits of this group up North Fork. Presumably
-they coincide with the tribal boundary.
-
-XIV. According to Goddard a tribelet called nE[-l]tcikyokaiya was in
-possession of the territory on the east bank of the Eel from McDonald
-Creek northward to the mouth of North Fork. Merriam does not record this
-group.
-
-XV. The southernmost tribelet on the eastern side of the Eel is called
-sE[-l]gAikyokaiya, "rock white large people," by Goddard. They are said
-to have occupied the territory from McDonald Creek south to Big Bend
-Creek. This group is not recorded by Merriam.
-
-
-VILLAGES
-
-The list of villages which follows includes all those contained in
-Merriam's notes and also all those given by Goddard (1923_a_) that could
-be located with accuracy (map 5). Occasionally there is a conflict
-between Merriam and Goddard and then it has usually seemed best to
-accept Goddard's information, since he actually visited the sites of
-most of the villages he mentions.
-
-All the data are either from Merriam or Goddard, as indicated by (M)
-or (G). Ancillary comment by myself is placed in square brackets. The
-notations (Tip) and (Maj) refer to Merriam's informants (see p. 167).
-The arabic numbers correspond with those on map 5, indicating separate
-villages. These run consecutively from north to south, first on the west
-side of the Eel (1-22) and then on the east side (23-67).
-
-_Villages on West Side of the Eel_
-
- 1. The main village of the ki-ketch-e tribelet is said to have
- been on the S side of the mouth of Chamise Cr. (M).
-
- kAntEltcEk'At, "valley small on" (G). The most northern
- village of the kaikitcEkaiya, whose northern boundary was Chamise
- Cr.
-
- [Both Merriam and Goddard give this as the native village
- of the wife of Wylakki Tip so there is no doubt that they are
- referring to the same village.]
-
- 2. kun-tes-che´-kut (M). Said to have been a Wailaki village
- on the W side of the Eel R. a half-mile N of Horseshoe Bend Tunnel,
- probably nearly opposite Horseshoe Bend Cr. (Tip).
-
- [Horseshoe Bend Tunnel cuts out the meander of Horseshoe
- Bend. Horseshoe Bend Cr. appears to enter the Eel from the E about
- a mile S of Boulder Cr. If Goddard's kAntEltcEk'At is really
- kAntE[-l]tcEk'At, with the bar on the "l" dropped in error, then
- these names are nearly the same. If so, kun-tes-che´-kut might
- be the name of village no. 1 even though the location differs
- slightly.]
-
- 3. basEtcE[-l]galk'At, "throw stone outside on" (G). On the
- western side of the Eel, just N of the mouth of Pine Cr.
-
- 4. sEdAkk'añdAñ, "rock ridge place" (G). On the point of the
- ridge around which the Eel turns toward the W at Horseshoe Bend.
-
- 5. kit-te-ken-n[)e]´-din (Tip), kit-ken-n[)e]-tung (Maj) (M).
- At or near the S end of Horseshoe Bend Tunnel. It was the biggest
- village of the tribelet and was said to have been the native
- village of the father of Wylakki Tip.
-
- s[)e]-tah´-be (M). A large village on the W side of the Eel
- River just S of Horseshoe Bend Tunnel near Island Mt. Station. It
- was nearly opposite the mouth of Copper Mine Cr.
-
- tcInnagañtcEdai, "eye closed door" (G). At the base of the
- ridge described in no. 4. It was said to have been the home of
- Captain Jim.
-
- [These names may or may not refer to the same village. If
- they do, it is likely that Merriam's kit-te-ken-n[)e]´-din is the
- correct one. His s[)e]-tah´-be evidently refers to the name of
- the tribelet, sEtakaiya, given by both him and Goddard. Goddard's
- designation looks as though it might very well refer to the tunnel
- and thus would be very modern.]
-
- 6. lacE[-l]kotcEdAñ, "buckeye small hole place" (G). This
- seems to have been only a few hundred yards S of Horseshoe Bend.
-
- 7. kaigAntcik'At, "wind blows up on" (G). A big winter camp
- about 1/4 mi. S of Horseshoe Bend.
-
- 8. sait'otcEdadAñ, "sand point on" (G). Also about 1/4 mi. S
- of Horseshoe Bend but was about 500 ft. above the river near a big
- spring.
-
- 9. tcIbbEtcEki, "gather grass tall" (G). A little more than
- a mile S of Horseshoe Bend a very small stream runs into the Eel
- from the W. On the N side of the mouth of this stream was this
- house site where Captain Jim's father used to build his house some
- winters and live by himself.
-
- 10. sEnanaitAnnik'At, "stone trail across on" (G). About a
- mile S of Horseshoe Bend.
-
- 11. Isgaikyoki (G). About 1-1/2 mi. S of Horseshoe Bend a
- small creek called Isgaikyokot enters the Eel from the W. The
- village with this name was situated on the N side of the mouth of
- this creek. It was the home of the father of the wife of Wylakki
- Tip.
-
- 12. IsgaidadAbbIñlai (G). N of the creek mentioned in no. 11
- but on higher ground away from the river.
-
- 13. [-l]tAgtcEbi', "black oaks in" (G). About a mile N of
- Natoikot Cr. on a flat above the river.
-
- 14. sEnagatcEdAñ, "stones walk around place" (G). About 200
- yds. N of no. 15.
-
- 15. sE[-l]sokyok'At, "stone blue large on" (G). About 1/2 mi.
- N of the mouth of Natoikot Cr. There was said to have been a pond
- here.
-
- 16. [-l]tcicsEyEbi', "ashes rock shelter in" (G). This shelter
- was under a large rock which stood on the hillside a short distance
- downstream from no. 17. Two or three families used to spend the
- winter in it.
-
- 17. bantcEki, "war [ghosts] cry" (G). On the W side of the Eel
- a little more than a mile N of the mouth of North Fork and opposite
- the mouth of Cottonwood Cr. It was close to a fishing place that
- the tribelet shared with the bAskaiya tribelet.
-
- 18. tah-t[=e]s-cho´-tung, tah-t[=e]s-cho´-ting, tah-chis´-ting
- (M). 1/2 mi. or more N of the mouth of North Fork on the W side of
- the main Eel.
-
- taticcodAñ (G). In a grove of oaks about 1/4 mi. downstream
- from the mouth of North Fork on the W side of the Eel.
-
- 19. ne´-tahs, ning-ken-ne´-tset (M). Ne´-tahs is the name of
- the town on a rocky stretch of the river. The town ran for a mile
- or more S of the mouth of North Fork (Maj). Ning-ken-ne´-tset was
- the name of the village which was at the fishing place opposite the
- mouth of North Fork and extending S. It was also called "fishtown."
- Tip's mother lived there (Tip).
-
- nEtacbi', "land slide in" (G). About a mile S of the mouth
- of North Fork on the W side of the Eel. It was a noted fishing
- place. Goddard says: "There is no mention in the notes of a village
- at this point, but several Wailaki were spoken of at times as
- belonging to the nEtacbi'."
-
- 20. sE[-l]tcabi' (G). Nearly opposite the mouth of McDonald
- Cr. It was named for the large rock beneath which it stood.
-
- 21. tco[-l]Attcik'At, "graveyard on" (G). A large village on
- the western side of the river a few hundred yards downstream from
- the mouth of djoñkot.
-
- [The stream that Goddard calls djoñkot seems to be the one
- that appears on the modern maps as Cinch Cr.; that is the only one
- in the vicinity. On his map it is shown entering the Eel about
- a mile downstream from the mouth of Bell Springs Cr. but it is
- actually a tributary of Bell Springs Cr., joining that stream a
- scant hundred yards from its mouth. On the assumption that Cinch
- Cr. is, in fact, the stream that Goddard meant to indicate I have
- moved the village about a mile to the S.]
-
- 22. sa'kAntE[-l]dAñ, "beaver valley place" (G). About midway
- between the mouth of Blue Rock Cr. and Bell Springs Cr. on a fine
- large flat.
-
-_Villages on East Side of the Eel_
-
- 23. sE[-l]kaibi, "make a noise in the throat" (G). Opposite
- the mouth of Chamise Cr.
-
- 24. tcadEtokInnEdAñ (G). Located only approximately--in
- Horseshoe Bend at the point where the river turns toward the NE.
-
- 25. k'AcsAndAñ, "alder stands place" (G). About a mile
- downstream from the point where the river turns W at Horseshoe Bend.
-
- 26. sEtcokInnEdAñ, "rock large its base place" (G). About 1/2
- mi. downstream from the point where the river turns toward the W at
- Horseshoe Bend.
-
- 27. nEtcEdEtcAñk'At, "ground rolling on" (G). A short distance
- W of the mouth of Copper Mine Cr. (Tunnel Cr.).
-
- 28. dAndaitcAmbi, "flint hole in" (G). On the downstream side
- of the mouth of Copper Mine Cr. (Tunnel Cr.).
-
- 29. taht-aht (M). On the E side of the Eel R. at Horseshoe
- Bend and opposite s[)e]-tah´-be. It was a big town (Tip).
-
- kaitcIlIñtadAñ, "Christmas berries among place" (G). There
- was a graveyard about 1/4 mi. N of the village and just beyond the
- graveyard was Copper Mine Cr.
-
- 30. to-ch[)e]´-ting (M). A big village on the E side of the
- Eel R. at Horseshoe Bend (opposite s[)e]-tah´-be), only a short
- distance S of taht-aht (Tip). It was probably less than 1/4 mi. S
- of Island Mt. Station on the opposite side of the river.
-
- kaslInkyodAñ. "spring large place" (G). On the E bank of the
- river about 300 yds. S of kaitcIlIñtadAñ, or about 1/2 mi. S of
- Copper Mine Cr.
-
- [The names of these two villages are not the same at all and
- since Goddard gives many villages in the near vicinity the chances
- are good that the names do not represent the same village.]
-
- 31. kaslInkyobi, "spring large in" (G). A rock shelter near
- Goddard's kaslInkyodAñ. A family used to spend the winter here.
- Captain Jim's father-in-law was left here to die after he had been
- wounded by the whites.
-
- 32. skEtcE[-l]kascanAñ, "mush thrown away sunny place" (G).
- Evidently situated about a mile S of Copper Mine Cr., where the
- river makes a slight turn toward the N. Here there is a flat 50 ft.
- higher than the river and 150 ft. from it, in which 17 house pits
- were counted. This village was just upstream from a rock called
- skEtcE[-l]kaiyE. Each spring a mush-like substance appears on the
- face of this rock and is washed away each winter. The thickness of
- the deposit is supposed to indicate the abundance of the year's
- acorn crop.
-
- 33. ah-chahng´-ket (M). On the E side of the Eel a mile or two
- S of Horseshoe Bend. It was more than a mile S of to-che-ting (Tip).
-
- akyañk'At, "right here on" (G). Some distance N of Willow Cr.
- and on the river.
-
- [These two names doubtless represent the same village but
- neither Merriam nor Goddard gives a very exact location for it.]
-
- 34. slAsyanbi', "squirrels they eat in" (G). Only a
- short distance S of Willow Cr. and back from the river near
- nE[-l]tcAñk'At. slAsyañkot was an alternate name for Willow Cr. and
- the name of the village was derived from this.
-
- 35. n[)e]-chung-ket´ (M). On the E side of the river about
- 1/2 mi. S of ah-chahng´-ket (Tip). The inhabitants were called
- n[)e]´-chung ke-ah-hahng (Maj and Tip).
-
- nE[-l]tcAñk'At, "ground black on" (G). Said to have been the
- second one S of Willow Cr.
-
- [It is evident that both Merriam and Goddard have the same
- name here. Goddard's location is more precise and thus has been
- accepted.]
-
- 36. dabAstci'Añdañ, "ants' nest place" (G). A little way S
- of the mouth of Willow Cr. The name comes from the name of Willow
- Cr.--dabActci'Añkot.
-
- 37. dAstatcElai, "string (?) point" (G). Evidently only a
- short distance above Indian Cr. It was said to have been a large
- winter camp.
-
- 38. tcA[-l]sAl (G). Just N of the mouth of Indian Cr. was a
- sharp rock with this name; the Indians camped near this in the
- springtime.
-
- 39. tA[-l]djInlai, "water clayey point" (G). On the S side of
- Indian Cr. The large village appears to have stood just a little E
- of the NW corner of sec. 36, T. 5 S., R 6 E. Its inhabitants were
- exterminated by mixed bands of white men and Kekawaka Indians.
-
- 40. tah-bus-che-sahng´-tung (M). A small village in the hills
- 1 mi. E of the Eel R. and 1 mile S of Indian Cr. (Maj).
-
- 41. sE[-l]tcikyok'At, "red rock large on" (G). 1/4 mi. N of
- the first creek downstream from North Fork on the E bank of the
- main Eel.
-
- 42. chug´-ge´-tah (M). A small village on the E side of the
- Eel N of the mouth of North Fork (Maj). It was about 2 mi. S of
- Indian Cr.
-
- sEtatcikaiya (G). A tall rock is situated N of the mouth of
- the first creek N of the mouth of North Fork. The village was just
- to the W of this rock and was named for it.
-
- [The villages given by Merriam and Goddard are in about the
- same place but Merriam's location is so indefinite that their
- identity is uncertain.]
-
- 43. kai[-l]tcitadAñ, "redbud place" (G). A short distance N
- of the mouth of North Fork a ridge runs down to the river. On the
- northern side of the ridge a village was situated.
-
- 44. t[=o]n-klan´-be-ko-cho´-be (M). On the E side of the Eel
- on the northern side of the mouth of North Fork (Tip).
-
- ton[-l]Embi', "streams come together in" (G). Situated on a
- terrace N of the mouth of North Fork and on the E side of the main
- Eel. In the summer of 1922 10 house pits were counted there, 4 of
- them being large and deep.
-
- [These two sites are evidently the same, since both the names
- and the locations match.]
-
- 45. s[=a]´-tan-do´-che ke´-ah-hahng (M). In a rocky stretch on
- the N side of the North Fork about 1/2 mi. above its junction with
- the main Eel. The name means "rock reaching into water."
-
- sEtandoñtci, "rock runs to the water" (G). On the N bank of
- North Fork about 1/2 mi. above the mouth.
-
- 46. sEntciyE, "rock large under" (G). About 3/4 mi. above the
- mouth of North Fork. The rock for which it was named, with a large
- spruce tree, stands opposite the village site, on the S side of the
- stream.
-
- 47. s[)e]-cho-ke´-ah-hahng (M). A village and band at
- s[)e]-cho, "big rock," on the N side of the North Fork of the Eel
- a mile or more above its mouth. "Thousands of Indians killed here"
- (Maj).
-
- sEtcolai, "rock large point" (G). On the N side of North Fork
- a little more than a mile above its mouth.
-
- 48. lacEnadailai, "horse chestnut stand point" (G). About 60
- yds. upstream from no. 47. A house pit 4-1/2 ft. deep was seen
- there.
-
- [This site was no doubt included under no. 47 by Merriam's
- informant.]
-
- 49. About halfway between the main Eel and Wilson Cr. a small
- stream enters North Fork from the S (G). Near this there was a
- village before the whites came. An incident there is said to have
- occurred at a time when the informant's grandmother's grandmother
- was small.
-
- 50. stAstcok'At, "rope large on it" (G). Somewhat farther
- upstream than no. 49 and back a way from the bank of the stream,
- also on the S side. The village is said to have been a large one
- when the white people came to this region. In 1906 there was still
- a house on the site.
-
- 51. totAkk'At, "between water" (G). Summer camp a little way
- below the mouth of Wilson Cr. on the N side of North Fork.
-
- 52. se[-l]tcidadAñ, "stone red mouth place" (G). An old
- village, occupied before the whites came. It stood between no. 11
- and the mouth of Wilson Cr.
-
- 53. nolEtcotadAñ, "water falls large among" (G). On the N side
- of North Fork about 1/2 mi. below Wilson Cr. It was on two levels;
- one near the stream, the other on a terrace some yards N.
-
- 54. ki´-ye ke´-ah-hahng (M). On North Fork at the mouth of
- Wilson Cr. and covering both sides of North Fork and Wilson Cr.
- (Maj).
-
- [This name is evidently the same as Goddard's name for the
- tribelet on North Fork above Wilson Cr.--kAiyEkiyahAñ.]
-
- 55. sEnEsbInnAñkai, "rock tall its slope" (G). On the northern
- side of North Fork and about midway E and W of sec. 12, T. 24
- N., R. 14 W. is a tall rock called sEnEs. Just W of this was the
- village.
-
- 56. k'asolEtcobi', "arrowwood rotten flat" (G). On the S side
- of North Fork opposite the tall rock mentioned in no. 55. The
- informant said his uncle remembered the building of the dance house
- when he was a small boy.
-
- 57. s[=a]´-yahs kun´-dung (M). A fishing camp for drying
- salmon at Fishtown Spring or Upgraff fishery on North Fork about 5
- mi. up, "march till creek dries up."
-
- [Upgraff must be an error for Updegraff; the latter is a local
- place name whereas the former is not, so far as I can see.]
-
- 58. sEnEstconatAñkai, "rock tall large crossing" (G). A small
- stream comes into North Fork about 1-1/2 mi. above Wilson Cr. The
- village of this name was situated 1/2 mi. S of North Fork and just
- to the W of this tributary. The village had not been occupied in
- the memory of the informants.
-
- 59. Another village not occupied in historic times was
- situated on the S side of North Fork just above the mouth of the
- stream mentioned in no. 58 (G).
-
- 60. s[=a]h-gah´-ket, se-kah´-ke-ah-ahng, se-ki´-ah-hahng (M).
- A rancheria on the E side of the Eel R. on the S side of the mouth
- of North Fork (named for s[=a]-gah-nah´-ting, the name of the land
- on the S side of the mouth of North Fork in the angle between the
- two rivers) (Tip).
-
- kai[-l]tcitadAñ, "redbud place" (G). This was apparently near
- Merriam's s[=a]h-gah´-ket.
-
- [These different names may not represent the same village. If
- these were two villages, they were very close together. Goddard
- gives kai[-l]tcitadAñ as the name of another village N of North
- Fork (no. 43) so it may be an error here (see pl. 11, b for a view
- of this region).]
-
- 61. tsEgolkAllinseyE (G). A rock shelter situated back from
- the river a short distance above McDonald Cr. The Indians lived
- here in the winter.
-
- 62. ne-che´-cho-ket (M). On the E side of the Eel about a mile
- S of the mouth of North Fork. It was apparently opposite part of
- the elongate village ning-ken-ne´-tset (no. 19). "Salmon stop here;
- great fishing; rocky place; Red Hill ground" (Tip).
-
- nE[-l]tcikyok'at, "ground red large on" (G). On a point of
- land running down to the river on the E side just above nEtacbi',
- the fishing place of the region.
-
- [Goddard adds some information which explains the statement
- of Merriam's informant. He says, "About two-thirds of a mile below
- the mouth of McDonald Creek a number of large rocks lie in the bed
- of the river. This place is called nEtacbi', 'land slide in,' and
- seems to have been a noted fishing place."]
-
- 63. sah-nah´-chung-kut, sah-nah-chin´-che ke´-ah-hahng (M).
- On the E side of the Eel R. 1-1/2 or 2 mi. S of the mouth of North
- Fork and near McDonald Cr. (Tip).
-
- 64. sel-di´-kot (M). On the E side of the Eel R. S of Bell
- Springs Cr. (Maj).
-
- 65. s[)e]-ski´-cho-ding (M). Claimed as a Wailaki village
- on the E side of the Eel R. at White Rock near Big Bend. On the
- opposite side of the river from Bell Springs Station (Tip).
-
- se[-l]GaitcodAñ (G). On a flat on the E side of the river.
- "The east and west section line dividing sections 84 and 85 of T.
- 24 N., R. 14 W. was noted as passing through this flat."
-
- [These two names doubtless represent the same village; the
- names are similar and the locations are the same.]
-
- 66. chin-to´-bin-nung (M). On the upper part of McDonald Cr.,
- about 3 mi. up from the Eel (Maj).
-
- 67. chus-nah-teg-gul-lah chen-ne-tung (M). An old village
- about 2 mi. S of North Fork and 3 mi. E of the Eel.
-
-
-PLACE NAMES
-
-The following list includes ethnogeographic information taken from
-Merriam's notes in addition to information on creeks from Goddard
-(1923_a_), the latter being especially important because most villages
-are located with respect to streams. All streams and rivers may be found
-on map 5. Locations of other features have been given after consulting
-the appropriate United States Geological Survey (USGS) quadrangle
-but they are not shown on the map. For this area the quadrangles are
-Alderpoint (1951), Hoaglin (1935), Leggett (1952), and Spyrock (1952).
-
- Asbill Cr.--djoñot (G).
-
- Bell Springs Cr.--sAlt´okot (G).
-
- Bell Springs Mt.--tsi-to´-ting; si-to´-ting (M). This is the
- mountain cut through by Bell Springs Cr.
-
- Bell Springs Station (native name for the site of the
- station)--sah´-ten´-t[)e]´-te; sah-ten-t[)e]^{hl}-t[)e] (M). Bell
- Springs Station is on the W side of the Eel about halfway between
- Blue Rock Cr. and Bell Springs Cr., about the same place as village
- 22. In fact, Merriam's names for this site may correspond to
- Goddard's name for village 22, sa'kAntE[-l]dAñ.
-
- Big Bend Cr.--dAndaikot (G).
-
- Blue Rock--sen-chah´-tung (M). Evidently this is near Blue
- Rock Cr.
-
- Chamise Cr.--sah-nah´-ting; shah-nah-ting (M); canAndAñkot (G).
-
- Chamise Cr. crossing--ses-ki´-be (M).
-
- Chamise Cr., mouth of--sun-ti´-che, soon-di´-che (M).
-
- Cinch Cr.--djoñkot (G). Goddard evidently has this creek
- placed incorrectly on his map. If I understand his description, it
- should be a tributary of Bell Springs Cr. rather than of the Eel R.
- directly.
-
- Copper Mine Cr. (Tunnel Cr. on the more recent
- maps)--chis´-kot, ch[=e]s-kot (M); tciskot (G). Both Merriam and
- Goddard say that this name refers to red paint and was probably
- suggested by the color of the water in the creek. This is also
- responsible for the English name.
-
- Cottonwood Cr.--tgActcEkot (G). The English name is a
- translation of the Wailaki name. The creek is unnamed on USGS maps.
-
- Dawson Flat--choo´-e-kun-tes´-te (M). This flat was W of Lake
- Mt. between Horse Ranch and Fenton Ranch.
-
- Eel R.--tan´-cho-kut (M). Eel R. valley--bus´-be (M). This
- name refers to a part of the valley of the main Eel R., especially
- the E side, between Horseshoe Bend and North Fork.
-
- Eel R., E branch of South Fork--to-k[=a]-kut (M).
-
- Eel R., Middle Fork--tahng-cho-skus (M). The junction of the
- Middle Fork with the main Eel was called t[=o]s-kahs-k[=a].
-
- Eel R., North Fork--bah´-ne-kut (M); banikot (G).
-
- Eel R.-North Fork junction--ch[=a]-lin´-ding, kl[=a]-lin-ding
- (M).
-
- Harris region--tah-sahn-ting´, tahs-ahng (M). Harris is a
- small town about 8 mi. W of the main Eel R. in the territory of the
- Lassik (according to Merriam's boundaries).
-
- Hettenshaw Valley--ken-tes´-tung (M). This valley is in Lassik
- territory about 12 mi. N of the Wailaki boundary. It lies between
- the headwaters of the North Fork of the Eel and the headwaters of
- the Van Duzen R.
-
- Horse Ranch Cr.--kus´-ken-tes´-be (M); canAñtcakot (G). These
- are clearly not the same names but sometimes streams have alternate
- names. Cf. Willow Cr. below.
-
- Horseshoe Bend--ch[=e]s (M). The bend is named for the red
- copper spring of Copper Mine Cr. ki´-ke-che (M) is the name for
- the western part of the loop of Horseshoe Bend, to-sahng´-kut,
- t[=o]s-ahng-kut (M) is the name of the part of Horseshoe Bend N of
- Island Mt. Horseshoe Bend is the big switchback curve in the Eel R.
- about 6 mi. N of the mouth of North Fork.
-
- Indian Cr.--chen-nes-no´-kut, ken´-nis-no´-kut (M). The name
- Indian Cr. does not appear on any of the USGS maps but it is the
- name used by Merriam.
-
- Island Mt.--bahng-kut, bahn-kut (M); bañk'At (G). Island Mt.
- is a range of hills bordered on the E by the Eel R. and extending
- from the mouth of North Fork in the S to beyond Horseshoe Bend in
- the N.
-
- Jewett Cr.--sel-di´-kot (M); dAsk'Ekot (G).
-
- Kekawaka Cr.--kas-n[=a]´-kot, kahs´-ne-kot (M); kasnaikot (G).
-
- Lake Mt.--s[=a]-kahn-den, se-kahn´-ting (M). Lake Mt. is about
- 3 mi. E of the Eel and 3 mi. N of North Fork.
-
- McDonald Cr.--sah´-nah-chin-che (M); canAñtcIntci (G).
-
- Middle Trail--be-ten-na´-be (M). This trail was in the hills E
- of the Eel R. about a mile south of Indian Cr.
-
- Mina--to-les´ cho´-be (M). Mina is a modern place name for a
- town about 2 mi. N of North Fork and 5 mi. E of the main Eel R.
-
- Natoikot Cr.--no-toi´-kut (M); natoikot (G). I have given this
- creek its Wailaki name because it has no English name and is not,
- in fact, located on modern maps. It is said to have run into the
- Eel R. about 1-1/2 mi. S of Island Mt. Station, which is on the
- southern side of Horseshoe Bend. It has been placed on the map in
- accordance with the topography shown on USGS Hoaglin Quadrangle.
-
- Pine Cr.--ten-di´-kot (M); lacEtcikot (G). Merriam was not
- certain that his name was correct.
-
- Pipe Cr.--taht-so´-kut (M).
-
- Poonkinny Ridge--nel-kis´-te (M). Merriam says this is the
- name of the open ridge between the main Eel R. and the northern
- part of Round V. That area is marked Poonkinny Ridge on the USGS
- Spyrock Quadrangle. It is in Yuki territory.
-
- Rattlesnake Cr.--to-nah´-ling (M). This creek is a tributary
- of the South Fork of the Eel R. and forms a part of the southern
- boundary of the Eel River Wailaki, according to Merriam.
-
- Rockpile Mt.--sen´-ning ah´-kut (M). This mountain is said to
- be on the E side of the Eel R. S of Alder Point, but the name does
- not appear on modern maps.
-
- Round V.--ken´-tes-cho´-be (M). The inhabitants of Round V.
- were called ken´-tes cho´-be ke´-ah, a locative rather than a
- tribal name.
-
- Summit V.--ken-tes´[-l]-be (M). Summit V. lies about 2 mi. SE
- of the bend of North Fork and seems to have marked the southeastern
- limit of North Fork Wailaki territory. It is said that there was
- once much camass there.
-
- Willow Cr.--dabActci'Añkot, slAsyañkot (G). The latter was
- used occasionally for the stream.
-
- Wilson Cr.--dat'olkot (G).
-
-
-ETHNOZOÖLOGY AND ETHNOBOTANY
-
-The following notes are from Merriam's records.
-
- Badger is called ye-ku-gus-cho, "he pulls into his hole."
-
- The Steller Crested Jay is called chi-cho, while the
- California Jay is chi-che. In speaking of related species the
- Indians often indicate the larger by the suffix _cho_, the smaller
- by _che_.
-
- The Owl is called bis-chil-lo-che if it is small, the Great
- Grey Owl is bis-chil-lo-cho.
-
- The Crow is kah-chan-che, the Raven is kah-chan-cho.
-
- The Meadow Lark sings in the daytime; the Yellow-breasted Chit
- sings at night.
-
- The Bluebird is a dangerous bird. If a person throws a stone
- at it, he should shout first to attract its attention, otherwise it
- will throw a pain to him.
-
- The Junco is a great rustler, always busy hunting for food.
-
- The Chewink, or Towhee, called Nahl-tse, was instrumental in
- procuring the first fire. In the very early days his parents threw
- him out. He located the fire and Coyote-man went and got it.
-
- The Kildeer Plover is called nah-til yah-che, "necklace
- wearing."
-
- The Toad is Rough Frog.
-
- The Cicada is used as a remedy for headache. The live insect
- is pushed up into the nose, where, by kicking around, it makes the
- nose bleed, thus curing the headache.
-
- The Dragonfly feeds rattlesnakes.
-
- Oak galls, called kim-mos, are excellent for sore eyes, and
- also for suppression of urine in children. For weak eyes, the fresh
- juice of a green gall is dropped into the eye. (It is astringent
- and an excellent remedy and is a common eye drop among many
- California tribes.)
-
- Oak mistletoe is used as a medicinal tea, also as a head-wash,
- and sometimes for bathing the entire body.
-
- The thick creamy juice of the milkweed is called "snake milk."
-
-
-ETHNOGRAPHY
-
-Each tribelet had its own chief and its own hunting, fishing, acorn,
-and seed grounds. In winter the families of each band were scattered
-along the river in small rancherias, each consisting of from four to
-seven families, mostly blood relations, living together in two or three
-houses. Usually there were seven or eight people in each house.
-
-The winter houses were of split pine slabs, standing upright or sloping
-in at the top to form a conical house (pl. 11, _a_).
-
-People dying at home were buried. Those dying at a distance were burned
-(cremated) and their burned bones were wrapped in buckskin, carried home
-in a pack-basket, and then buried.
-
-
-PITCH WAILAKI
-
-The Pitch Wailaki are close relatives of the Eel River Wailaki. They
-live in the drainage of the North Fork of the Eel above Asbill Creek.
-Virtually nothing is known of this group except their villages and
-tribelets, which were recorded by Goddard (1924). Presumably they are
-similar in culture to the Eel River Wailaki and the Round Valley Yuki.
-
-Merriam's notes contain very little information concerning the Pitch
-Wailaki. He apparently was never in contact with any informants from
-that group and what information he gives is derived from the Eel River
-Wailaki. The following summary is presented verbatim from his notes.
-
-_The Che-teg-ge-kay._--The most southeasterly of the southern
-Athabaskan tribes of California and consequently the southernmost of
-the Nung-gah^{hl} division. They call themselves Che-teg-ge-kah (Pitch
-Indians) and are nicknamed Si-yahng (sand-eaters). Neighboring tribes
-call them Che-teg-gah-ahng and Wylakke.
-
-Beginning on the northwest just below the junction of Salt Creek with
-North Fork Eel River (a short distance southeast of Hoaglin Valley)
-their northern boundary extends from Salt Creek northeasterly along the
-south side of Rock Creek and of Van Horn Creek to its junction with Mad
-River, where it turns easterly, crossing the long ridge known as South
-Fork Trinity Mountain immediately south of Kelsey Peak, and continuing
-easterly to the upper waters of South Fork Trinity River, the west bank
-of which it follows upstream to the southwest of North Yolla Bolla
-Mountain, where it ends. From North Yolla Bolla the eastern boundary
-follows the crest of the high divide southerly past Hammerhorn Peak to
-Buck Rock (4 or 5 mi. north of Anthony Pk.) where it turns westerly.
-From this point the southern boundary runs west-northwest to North Fork
-Eel River, passing just south of Blue Nose Mountain and Hulls Valley
-to the northern part of Summit Valley just south of Bald Mountain, and
-crossing North Fork Eel River a few miles south of Mina. Salt Creek
-forms the principal part of the western boundary.
-
-They had many summer camps but only two principal winter villages:
-To-nis-cho-be (named for an unidentified blue flower), a large village
-with a roundhouse situated on the site of Mina on what is now known
-as the Charley Moore place; and Uk-ki, situated on Hulls Creek at the
-southeast base of Bald Mountain. They always wintered on Bald Mountain
-Ridge.
-
-They had also a permanent summer fishing camp called Ko-sen-ten, known
-to the whites as Fishtown, located on Fishtown Creek, a small tributary
-rising on Buck Rock and emptying into North Fork of Middle Fork Eel
-River directly east of Leach Lake Mountain.
-
-Their houses were of bark and conical in form.
-
-Among the enemies of the Che-teg-ge-kah was a related Athapaskan
-tribe which they called Theng-tah-hahn (called Then-chah-tung by the
-Settenbiden) vaguely described as on the main Eel River between Island
-Mountain and Bell Springs.
-
-
-TRIBELETS
-
-The rest of the information on the Pitch Wailaki presented here concerns
-tribelet and village organization and is taken from Goddard (1924). He
-lists four tribelets among the Pitch Wailaki (Roman numerals, map 6).:
-I, t'odAnnAñ kiyahAñ; II, t'okya kiyahAñ; III, tc'i'añkot kiyahAñ; IV,
-tcokot kiyahAñ.
-
-
-VILLAGES
-
-The villages belonging to each of these tribelets are listed below
-(Arabic number, map 6). All are from Goddard's lists.
-
-I. _t'odAnnAñ kiyahAñ_
-
- 1. t'otcadAñ. On the N side of North Fork not far below the
- mouth of Hulls Creek. The site was sheltered by ridges on the E and
- W and by the main mountainside on the N. Four pits were counted.
-
- This was the only site visited but the names of other villages
- of the group were obtained. In their order downstream from Hulls
- Creek they are AntcAnyacbAnnAñ, "pepperwood slope;" sEtcAmmi';
- nE[-l]=g=indAñ; lawasonk'ait; t'AntcankyodAñ. At this last there
- is said to have been a large conical earth-covered lodge and many
- dwellings.
-
-II. _t'okya kiyahAñ_
-
- 2. [-l]Eliñkyobi', "streams flow together large in." On the
- W side of North Fork just upstream from the mouth of Hulls Creek,
- situated close to the hillside on a bench about 50 ft. higher than
- the river. The site is divided by a gulch on the upstream side of
- which, it was said, there had once been houses. Four distinct pits
- and 3 less distinct ones were seen there.
-
- 3. tAntcInyasbAnnAñ. Nearly opposite nando'ndAñ on a point
- of land running toward the SW. About 75 ft. above the stream 2
- pits, one above the other, were seen. No more could well have been
- accommodated.
-
- 4. nando'ndAñ. On the E side of the river and about 1/4 mi.
- above the mouth of Hulls Creek, 30 ft. above the bed of North Fork.
- Four house pits were counted there, one of which was 15 ft. in
- diameter and 5 ft. deep. This was the village of Goodboy Jack's
- father.
-
- 5. kAllata. Named for a big jagged rock standing N of the
- village site. It was on the W side of the river 1/4 mi. N of
- tAntcInyasbAnnAñ and 300 ft. higher than the river. A grove of oaks
- stands on a rounded point where 3 house pits were seen. A gulch on
- the southern side furnished water in winter.
-
- 6. tco'Ammi'. On the W side of the river about 1/4 mi.
- upstream from kAllata. The site is on a wide point of land covered
- with oaks and pepperwood trees. There is a sheer rock on the
- opposite side of the river. Three pits were seen here.
-
- 7. tAltcAskIñ. Named from a knoll, tAltcAs. Situated on the
- slope of a large ridge around the end of which North Fork swings,
- from flowing SE, to S. It was about 500 ft. higher than the stream
- and distant from it about 1/8 mi. Here once stood an earth lodge,
- the pit of which was 30 ft. in diameter. The center post was said
- to have been 18 ft. high. The doorway was toward the N. Goodboy
- Jack remembered going into this house when he was a small boy.
- Messengers had been sent out to invite people from a distance of
- two days' travel and Indians from the main Eel R. and from the
- north were present.
-
- 8. sAñ'AnyE. Named from a very large rock standing on the
- E side of the river. The village was on the W side a little
- downstream from this rock. On a bench 30 ft. above the river bed
- were seen 5 house pits and above were 6 more, one above the other,
- on the slope. In this village lived tAntcAnyacta', who had charge
- of the earth lodge at tAltcAskIñ, and si'idonta, who was "boss" of
- all the villages of the t'okya kiyahAñ, especially when they camped
- together in summertime.
-
- [Illustration: Map 6. Villages and tribelets of the Pitch
- Wailaki. Roman numerals indicate tribelets according to Goddard
- (1929); arabic numerals mark village sites.]
-
- 9. t'AntcAntantE[-l]dAñ, "pepperwood flat." About 100 yds. S
- of the large rock called kai[-l]tsotci on a small bench on the
- mountainside about 1,000 ft. above North Fork. Three pits were
- found. A rock shelter higher on the hillside and to the S was
- pointed out. At this village, shortly before the coming of white
- people, lived dA=g=a'tco, "large beard," chief of this village
- and of annEnE'tcAñ, of all the t'okya kiyahAñ, in fact. He was
- succeeded by his son kissEkE', who was killed by the whites.
-
- 10. kai[-l]tsotci canAndAñ. Named for the large rock
- kai[-l]tsotci, under the shelter of which the village stood. Four
- pits were seen here and N of a small ridge were 3 others.
-
- 11. annEnE'tcAñ. On the NE side of the river stand two huge
- rocks, the upstream one called sE[-l]tcAnnAñ, the downstream one
- sAnAn. Between these two rocks flows a creek and on its N side, 75
- ft. below the summit of the rocks, were 3 house pits in a hollow.
- A little S and 100 ft. higher were found in succession 3, 2, and 5
- pits.
-
- 12. mAntc'aik'At. On the mountainside N of a large rough
- ravine and about 900 ft. higher than the bed of North Fork. Four
- pits were found.
-
- 13. mIstco'ca'nAndAñ. Up the hill from no. 12. It was not
- visited.
-
- 14. sE[-l]tcAnnAnt'a. Named for a high rock, sE[-l]tcAnnAñ, on
- the S side of which there are 5 pits and, 100 yds. below, 6 more.
- The site is about 700 ft. above North Fork and has a wonderful
- outlook on the valley of that stream.
-
- 15. k'AckAntE[-l]dAñ, "alder flat." On the W side of the river
- on a curving bench. Two pits were found close to the hillside, and
- 2 nearer to the stream. Downstream on a little bench there were
- also 2 indistinct ones, said by Jack to have been used long ago.
-
- 16. sE[-l]tcAnnAñ yE. At the base of the rock mentioned in no.
- 14. Three pits were found on a small bench.
-
-III. _tc'i'añkot kiyahAñ_
-
- 17. lonbAstEdAñ. On a flat on the S side of Casoose Cr. a
- short way above its mouth. There were some unoccupied buildings
- there at the time of Goddard's visit. The place was seen from the
- trail on the N side of the creek.
-
- 18. sE[-l]kantcilai'. Mentioned as situated on the E side of
- the creek below no. 25.
-
- 19. Goddard gives no name or other information for this
- village but it is shown on his map.
-
- 20. sEttcitcikItdatdAñ, Named for a rock, settci. It was at
- the base of a mountain on the N side of the creek and just above
- the flood waters. It had a good SE exposure. Three pits in a row
- were found.
-
- 21. yIctAnnEbi', "wolf's road in." About 300 yds. below the
- large butte mentioned in no. 23. It was across an open knoll and
- back from the creek somewhat, so the sun reaches the spot. There
- are 2 pits there. Steelhead salmon are able to come up the creek
- this far.
-
- 22. kIlkokyodAn. On the S side of the butte mentioned in no.
- 23 and about 100 yds. distant. Four large pits were noticed.
-
- 23. kIkokyokInnEdAñ. Named for the bushy butte at the base of
- which the village stood. The site is 100 ft. higher than the creek,
- on its NW side just below a canyon. Three pits were seen.
-
- 24. mAñk'AtdAñ. Named from a small pond, near which are
- deserted buildings and an old orchard. A hundred yards NE of this
- pond, back against the hill, 4 pits were found in a row, 2 more
- above them, and 2 others near by, making 8 altogether. The last
- chief of this village was named tcAsnainIñaita'.
-
- 25. I[-l]t'Aktcibi'. Named from black oaks. It is nearer the
- creek than no. 24. The number of pits was not recorded but signs of
- a village there were unmistakable.
-
- 26. t'AntcigIt'tcAñ. On the W side of the creek nearly
- opposite no. 27. It was N of a small creek with running water and
- of a ridge which runs down to the main creek and terminates in a
- great, nearly sheer cliff. The village site is about 500 ft. higher
- than the stream. Eight pits in two rows were counted.
-
- 27. k'aickontE[-l]dAñ. On the E side of Casoose Cr. on a flat
- 100 ft. higher than the creek, which flows just below it. The
- village site is near a post which marked the old boundary between
- Trinity and Mendocino counties. Two pits were seen.
-
- 28. tc'iañmiyE. On the E side of and 100 ft. higher than
- Casoose Cr. It was 100 yds. downstream from the beginning of the
- canyon. Five pits were counted.
-
-IV. _tcokot kiyahAñ_
-
-The winter villages of this group were on Red Mountain Cr. Goodboy Jack
-said that he did not know the village names. The impression had been
-received that Salt Creek V. was inhabited but Jack said it was too cold
-to live there in the winter. Presumably it was the hunting ground of the
-tcokot kiyahAñ.
-
-
-LASSIK
-
-The Lassik occupied the drainage of the main Eel River between the
-mouths of Dobbyn and Kekawaka creeks and the territory east of there
-to the crest of the Coast Range. There is almost no ethnographic
-information on this group in the literature except a few notes gathered
-by Essene (1942) when he was compiling a Culture Element List for the
-area. Even the geographic information on this group is weak. Merriam
-does not seem to have spent much time among them. Goddard may have
-recorded their villages but, if so, I have been able to find only a
-small part of his data. What there is I give below.
-
-Merriam records only random notes on the Lassik. His informant from that
-group was Lucy Young, the same woman Essene worked with so effectively
-(Essene, 1942; see also Kroeber's data, App. II). According to Merriam,
-she lived with her daughter, Mrs. William Clark, on a ranch about two
-miles south of Zenia; Mrs. Clark's husband came originally from Hyampom.
-Merriam seems to have visited Lucy Young in 1922. His only statement on
-the group follows.
-
- Sit-ten-biden keah ... Main Eel River from Fort Seward region
- on north, southerly to Harris and Kekawaka Creek; westerly to South
- Fork Eel River; easterly to Forest Glen and South Fork Trinity
- River near Kelsey Peak.
-
-
-TRIBELETS
-
-Merriam's notes contain no systematic information on the tribelets of
-this group but do give the following miscellaneous data.
-
-Kos-kah-tun-den ka-ah is the Settenbiden name for a related tribelet in
-the Blocksburg region [the territory E of Alder Pt.], now extinct. Their
-language is the same as that of the Bridgeville group but with many
-words different from Settenbiden.
-
-Sa-tahl-che-cho-be is the Settenbiden name for the band on the east
-side of the Main Eel River just below the mouth of Kekawaka Creek.
-This tribelet is the "sko-den ke-ah" of the Eel River Wailaki. Neither
-Merriam nor Goddard was sure whether the group ought not more properly
-to be included in the Lassik or the Wailaki.
-
-Taht-so keah is the name of a tribelet to the north of the Eel River
-Wailaki which the latter said was related to them. This group, together
-with the sa-tahl-che-cho-be, is said to constitute the then-chah-tung
-tribelet of the Lassik.
-
-
-VILLAGES
-
-For the most part the Lassik villages recorded by Merriam (and listed
-below) cannot be located, hence they have not been placed on the map.
-
- Kahsh-bahn. A Lassik village on the W side of the main Eel R.
- about 2 mi. above (S of) the mouth of Jewett Cr. This was a big
- town and there were lots of acorns near there.
-
- Kes-tah-che. On the E side of the main Eel R. nearly opposite
- (a little above) the mouth of Jewett Cr.
-
- 'Ki-che-be. On the site of the present (1923) store at Ruth on
- the Mad R. This was a big town with many houses and a sweathouse.
- There were lots of deer, bear, and acorns in this area. During
- the cold weather, usually in January, a dance, which lasted three
- nights, was held in this village.
-
- Sa-cho-yeh. A large village on the E side of the main Eel R.
- about 2-1/2 mi. S of Alder Pt.
-
- Sa-tahl-che-cho-be. The name means "red rocks." On the E side
- of the main Eel R. about 1/2 mi. or a mile below the mouth of
- Kekawaka Cr. There were falls and a whirlpool there.
-
- Tah-kah-ta-cho-be. On the E side of the Mad R. on a flat near
- the Hay place about 10 mi. above Ruth. It was a big town with a
- sweathouse.
-
- Taht-so. On the Underhill ranch, which was owned by Glenn or
- Green at the time Merriam was in the area (1920's). Evidently it
- was somewhere in the Harris region W of the main Eel R.
-
- Tha-cho-yeh. On the main Eel R. on a flat under a high
- standing rock. The rock is now called Cain Rock. It is on the E
- side of the river about 3 mi. S of Alder Pt.
-
- Tha-ken-nes-ten. The name means "talking rock." The village
- was on the E side of the main Eel R. near a big rock which stood at
- a bend of the river at the Johnson place (near a big white house).
- It was a big town with a sweathouse.
-
- Tha-tah-che. A large winter village in Soldier Basin on the
- North Fork of the Eel (near present Gilman place). This was a big
- town but had no sweathouse. In the winter they hunted deer and bear
- here.
-
- To-be-se-a-tung. On the E side of the Mad R. above the Bushman
- place. It was about a mile above the river.
-
- To-sos-ten. On the E side of the main Eel R. a mile or two
- above Alder Pt.
-
-There is some ambiguity in Merriam's notes on the status of the Lassik
-living in the western part of their territory near the South Fork of
-the Eel. The Sinkyone George Burt told Merriam that a group called the
-To-kub´-be ke´ah or To´-kah-be held the land on the east side of South
-Fork from Rocky Glen Creek south to above Garberville. This tribe was
-said to be centered on the east branch of South Fork and in the Harris
-region and to be a different tribe from the one on the main Eel River
-at Alder Point and Kekawaka Creek, but Merriam himself has refused to
-accept this assertion.
-
-Goddard's information indicates that the east bank of South Fork was
-owned by the Sinkyone, and it is so detailed that it has been accepted
-here (see p. 164).
-
-Goddard's unpublished material on the Lassik consists of a single map
-(here reproduced as map 8), which apparently shows the locations of 27
-villages. A list of what are presumably the village names accompanies
-it, but Goddard changed the numbers on his map. Hence on our map the
-correct name may not be assigned to each site.
-
-_Goddard's Lassik Villages_
-
- 1. gastc[=i]kdûñ
- 2. k[=o]nte^{l}tc[=i]dûñ
- 3. satcin[=i]tc[=i]dûñ
- 4. naslintce
- 5. ist'etatc[=i]dûñ
- 6. t[=o]kseye
- 7. kiñk'ûtek[=o]nte^{l}dûñ
- 8. k'ûct[=o]t[=o]dûñ
- 9. d[=i]y[=i]ckûk
- 10. nûndûkkatûndûñ
- 11. k[=o]nte^{l}tc[=i]dûñ
- 12. g[=o]sn[=o]lindûñ
- 13. t[=o]tcadûñ
- 14. sait[=o]tc[=i]
- 15. nûnsûn^{l}tc[=i]kkinne^{=e=}dûñ
- 16. y[=i]stcûttcadûñ
- 17. tois[=i]b[=i]
- 18. lesbatc[=i]tdûñ
- 19. k'ûstc[=i]kdûñ
- 20. tcûggûstatc[=i]^{=e=}
- 21. lesbaitc[=i]^{=e=}
- 22. setatc[=i]^{=e=}
- 23. kast[=o]ntc[=i]^{=e=}dûñ
-
-Goddard lists other names, presumably for the Lassik villages, as
-follows: sekû[-l]ne, tectatalindûñ, dûltc[=i]kyacdûñ, t'o-todûñ,
-k'ûsnesdûñ, ne ga b[=i], kûttantc[=i]tc[=o]dûñ. The sites corresponding
-to these names cannot be located.
-
-[Illustration: Map 7. Presumed Nongatl villages in the Bridgeville
-region.]
-
-[Illustration: Map 8. Lassik villages in the Alder Point region.]
-
-
-NONGATL
-
-The Nongatl are almost entirely confined to the drainages of the Van
-Duzen River and upper Mad River. Their culture is the least known of
-any group in northwestern California. Merriam evidently did not work
-in their area although he recorded a few of their words given him by
-George Burt's wife. George Burt was a Sinkyone, but his wife was born
-and raised near Bridgeville. Goddard recorded some villages for this
-group, whose names are given below. Nomland worked with someone from the
-Nongatl in 1928 (Nomland, 1938, p. 9), but her results have not been
-published.
-
-The territory of the Nongatl lies, for the most part, east of the main
-redwood belt. It is therefore no doubt well supplied with oaks, and
-plant foods are thus readily available. Salmon are abundant in the Van
-Duzen River (pl. 10, _c_) and Yager Creek but not in the Mad River
-in eastern Nongatl territory. In much of their territory then, the
-subsistence patterns of the Nongatl must have differed from those of
-most of northwestern California, where fishing was of primary importance.
-
-According to Merriam (1923) the word Nung-kah^{hl} is "a general or
-blanket name used by themselves for all the southern Athapaskan tribes,
-from Iaqua and Yager Creek on the north to the northern border of
-Round Valley on the south, thus including the Athapaskan Wilakke." In
-anthropological literature, however, especially in the work of Kroeber
-and Goddard, this name has come to be used for the group living between
-Iaqua Buttes and Mad River on the north and Dobbyn Creek on the south.
-Merriam's name for this group is Kit-tel´. He does not seem to have
-obtained any information from them although one of his notes mentions
-the fact that the wife of George Burt, his Lolangkok Sinkyone informant,
-was a Kit-tel´ woman.
-
-At times Merriam seems to have confused the Nongatl with the Lassik. In
-his general statement on the Nongatl, which follows, he lists them as
-Lassik although the area in which he places them marks them as Kit-tel´
-or Nongatl.
-
- Las´sik ... Name (from Chief Lassik, now dead) in common use
- for a Non-ga´h^{hl} tribe occupying a rather large area, extending
- from Iaqua Butte in the latitude of the mouth of Eel River,
- southerly to Dobbyn Creek and to the head of Van Duzen River, and
- from the eastern boundary of the Lolahnkok of Bull Creek and South
- Fork Eel River easterly to Mad River and the crest of the long
- ridge known as South Fork Mountain, and southerly to within about
- two miles of Ruth on Mad River; to the headwaters of Van Duzen
- River (but not reaching Kettenshaw Valley), and to Dobbyn Creek on
- the main Eel; thus including the entire course and drainage area of
- Larrabee Creek.
-
- There is doubt as to the northern boundary of the so-called
- Las´sik for the reason that I have not been able to obtain the
- necessary vocabularies for comparison. Goddard's information points
- to a division south of the Bridgeville region but I have been told
- by both the Nek´-kan-ni´ of Bear River and the Lolahnk[=o]k of Bull
- Creek and South Fork Eel that the language is exactly the same from
- Iaqua Butte southerly and that the languages of the Nek´-kan-ni´
- and Lo-lahn-k[=o]k do not differ essentially from that of the
- Larrabee Creek region.
-
- The Indians over whom Chief Lassik held sway had no common
- tribal name but consisted of a number of bands or subtribes, now
- mostly or quite extinct, said to have spoken the same or closely
- allied dialects.
-
- However, since the entire drainage basin of Larrabee Creek is
- included in their territory, it may be desirable to adopt the term
- Kos´-ten ke´-ah, by which term the Larrabee Creek band was known to
- neighbors on the south--the Set-ten-bi´-den ke-ah.
-
-
-SUBGROUPS
-
-There is evidence of several subgroups among the Nongatl, but it is not
-known whether these were tribelets or dialect divisions. Essene (1942,
-pp. 90-92) got information from the Lassik woman Lucy Young indicating
-that there was a distinct group around Blocksburg, which the Lassik
-called Kuskatundun, and another group around Bridgeville they called
-Nai'aitci. This latter group is said to have been a roving band which
-preyed on all the neighboring peoples.
-
-Goddard's village data indicate six other groups but do not give
-boundaries. These were as follows.
-
- bûsk[=o]tk[=i]ya. In the neighborhood of Indian Cr. in the
- upper part of the drainage of Yager Cr. (map 9).
-
- tcillûndûñ. On the upper reaches of North Yager Cr. (map 9).
-
- bûstc[=o]b[=i]k[=i]ya. In the vicinity of the junction of
- North and Middle Yager creeks. The language of this group was said
- to be the same as that of the tcittelk[=i]ya (map 9).
-
- senûñka. On upper Larabee Cr. in the vicinity of Blocksburg
- (pl. 10, _e_, _f_). This no doubt is the same as Essene's
- Kuskatundun, which was the Lassik name for the group (map 10).
-
- tcittelk[=i]ya. On the Van Duzen R. above Bridgeville. Appears
- to be the same name as Merriam's Kit-tel´.
-
- na'aitcik[=i]ya. On the Van Duzen above the tcittelk[=i]ya
- group. This name appears on the Goddard map from which map 1 was
- taken but is not otherwise recorded. This is evidently the same as
- Essene's Nai'aitci.
-
- k[=o]sdûñk[=i]ya. On the South Fork of the Van Duzen,
- including Larabee V.
-
-
-VILLAGES
-
-The Nongatl villages recorded below are all taken from Goddard's
-unpublished notes (maps 7, 9, 10). This is evidently far from a complete
-count but it is clear that there were about as many villages in the area
-covered by these maps as in other parts of the Athabascan area.
-
-_bûsk[=o]tk[=i]ya group (1-7, map 9)_
-
- 1. In the swag of a large ridge running toward the SSE to the
- junction of the main components of Indian Cr., perhaps a mile from
- it. There is one deep pit. There is a flowing creek 200 yds. E.
-
- 2. A single pit found by Pete E of a small stream flowing
- south into Indian Cr. from the lowest place in the ridge at Big
- Bend of the Mad R. Nearly 1/2 mi. from Indian Cr. W of a hill above
- which the wagon road passes. This is where Goddard camped in 1906.
- He hunted all around here without finding other pits.
-
- [Illustration: Map 9. Nongatl villages on Yager Creek.]
-
- [Illustration: Map 10. Nongatl villages in the Blocksburg
- region.]
-
- 3. k'onûseb[=i]'. On a point running down SSW toward Indian
- Cr. There were two pits near the creek and two more 200 ft. up the
- hill. A few large and small oaks were growing there. Water was to
- be had a few yards E. Pete saw a house there when he was a boy.
-
- 4. W of a small stream flowing into Indian Cr. from the N, and
- E of a large flat. There was a flat place with dirt thrown out in
- front of it but with no pit. About 1/8 mi. E on the round end of a
- ridge was a fairly evident pit and a sekal.
-
- 5. About 200 yds. E of the small stream mentioned in no. 4
- were a few small pits.
-
- 6. One pit was on the W bank of a S-flowing branch of Indian
- Cr. Small ridges N and S of it form a small basin, giving it
- protection from the winds. Madrone and black oaks are growing
- there. It is possible that a depression on the southern ridge is
- also a house pit.
-
- 7. On a small ridge on the E side of the branch of Indian Cr.,
- which flows from the S past Fork Baker ranch buildings. About 1-1/2
- mi. north of these buildings Pete found 3 pits. He said there were
- small streams N and S of the ridge. Goddard did not visit the place
- but it was pointed out by Pete as W of a big Douglas spruce tree
- and a large rock. Goddard described it as above.
-
-_tcillûndûñ group (8-12, map 9)_
-
- 8. On the slope N of North Yager Cr. close to the county road
- and about 100 yds. from the bridge. There are 2 pits close to the
- wagon road and 1 or 2 a little farther N. The site is 65 ft. higher
- than the bridge.
-
- 9. kactc[=o]tc[=i]b[=i]', "redwoods..?.. in." On the N side
- of North Yager Cr. at the W end of a flat of about an acre. There
- are a few redwoods on the opposite side of the creek. Six pits were
- found about 100 yds. back from the creek. Pete had heard of the
- flat but not that Indians lived there. A hunter told Goddard of the
- Indians being killed there by whites.
-
- 10. About 1/4 mi. up a branch which flows into North Yager Cr.
- from the north. On the W side of the creek on a rounded ridge were
- 3 pits, 2 of which were very distinct.
-
- 11. On a small flat on the N side of Yager Cr. and close to it
- Pete saw 2 large deep pits. They were about 1/4 mi. downstream from
- the branch where village 10 was found.
-
- 12. tse'dûttc^{l}bûtta'dûñ. A half-mile N of North Yager Cr.
- at the edge of Douglas spruce and tanbark oak timber. Stones used
- by the Indians were lying near the water and 2 pits were found
- there. To the W, on the crest of the ridge, there were 5 pits at
- the S end of the timber. A cabin stands there.
-
-Goddard lists five more sites found in this vicinity on North Yager
-Creek but they are not named and their locations are indefinite so they
-will not be given here.
-
-_bûstc[=o]b[=i]k[=i]ya group (13-18, map 9)_
-
- 13. senindûsc[=i]m[=i]. On the W bank of North Yager Cr. 1/4
- mi. below a waterfall of the same name. Two pits were located 100
- ft. above the creek in brush and timber. On the same side of the
- creek but 1/4 mi. downstream were 4 more pits, in one of which a
- sekal lay.
-
- 14. nakat[=o]dûñ. On the E side of North Yager Cr., on a flat
- now covered with huckleberry brush. Pete found 2 pits here. On the
- W side of the creek, a little downstream, were 2 more pits. The
- flat had been badly washed away by freshets.
-
- 15. Two pits were found among the redwoods and thick brush at
- the junction of North and Middle Yager creeks.
-
- 16. ist'egab[=i]', "madrones in." Just at the eastern edge of
- the timber on a point running down toward Middle Yager Cr. were 4
- pits.
-
- 17. k[=o]ntc[=o]wetc[=i]kinnedûñ. About 1/4 mi. N of Middle
- Yager Cr. On a small flat on a hillside, facing SW in open timber
- above a small stream. There were 7 pits here. Pete had heard that
- there used to be a village so situated.
-
- 18. An overhanging rock on the N side of Middle Yager Cr.
- shows signs of occupation and there is a pit near by.
-
-_senûñka group (19-35, map 10)_
-
- 19. On a little point 200 yds. N of Curless' house. There is
- one pit. Charlie Taylor's grandmother was born here, according to
- Curless, who showed the site to Goddard. This was the most northern
- village of the senûñka on Larabee Cr.
-
- 20. t'[=o]kintcab[=i]'. On the hillside on either side of the
- stream which crosses the road about a mile S of Curless' place.
- It is nearly a mile from Larabee Cr. and is close to the timber.
- The village was in a line of Douglas spruce south of an oat-field.
- There were 7 large pits on the W side of the stream and 5 on the E
- side. With one exception these were N of the fence; others may have
- been filled by plowing.
-
- 21. t'[=o]kintcab[=i]'. On the E side of Larabee Cr. a
- good-sized stream flows across the county road by a group of farm
- buildings. On the E side of the road close to the N side of this
- stream are from 4 to 6 pits. Douglas spruce and tanbark timber with
- brush obscured them. On the W side of the road is a large sheep
- barn. W of this barn are 4 pits, some quite uncertain because the
- ground has been cleared of large Douglas spruce timber. There is a
- large plowed flat 1/4 mi. W, near Larabee Cr. Andrew's wife told
- Pete of such a place where there used to be many Indians.
-
- 22. k'ûcna'aidûñ (?). In a swag on the W side of a gulch lined
- with Douglas spruce and tanbark oak timber with exposure toward the
- S. There are 5 distinct pits.
-
- 23. On a point 200 yds. N of the junction of the two main
- components of Larabee Cr., W of a small stream. There were 4 pits,
- only one of which was large. The end of a pestle was lying in this
- one.
-
- 24. On the E side of Larabee Cr., between it and the county
- road, on the S side of a small stream. There was one pit. The
- building of the road may have destroyed others.
-
- 25. On a large flat N of the junction of the two components of
- Larabee Cr. and a little to the E. There were 10 pits. There is a
- cabin and a corral here and many pits may have been filled in.
-
- 26. On the hillside N of the eastern component of Larabee Cr.
- Pete thought there were 3 pits. There had been slides there and
- Goddard was not sure of them.
-
- 27. On the N side of a large branch of Larabee Cr. from the E,
- 200 yds. N of where it is joined by a stream from the N. The stream
- from the E is bûstadûñk[=o]t. There were 3 pits among the Douglas
- spruce and black oaks.
-
- 28. On the E side of the Eel R. about 3/4 mi. N of the mouth
- of Coleman Cr. at the edge of timber on a small bench. There were 2
- small house pits.
-
- 29. On the E side Of the Eel about 300 yds. N of the mouth of
- Coleman Cr., 75 yds. back from the river and 40 ft. above it. There
- were 2 large deep pits. The exposure is SW.
-
- 30. canak[=i]', "creek tail." On the E side of the Eel R. S of
- the mouth of Coleman Cr. There were 3 pits close to the creek but
- high above it on the bank, 2 on a flat 25 yds. S, and 2 more near a
- dry gulch 200 yds. S of the creek. Near the creek the brakes were
- so thick that many pits may have been overlooked. This place was
- mentioned by Charlie in 1908.
-
- 31. On the E side of the Eel R. about 500 yds. S of the mouth
- of Coleman Cr. on a flat close to the S side of a gulch lined with
- maple and peppernut trees. There were 8 pits here and 7 or 8 more
- from 50 to 75 yds. S.
-
- 32. N of the knoll which is just below the forks of Coleman
- Cr. There was 1 pit.
-
- 33. On the E side of the Eel R. about 300 yds. N of the mouth
- of Mill Cr. on a brushy point. There were 5 pits.
-
- 34. On the E side of the Eel R. N of the mouth of Mill Cr.
- just S of a big rock. There were 2 pits.
-
- 35. nadaitcûñ. This name was supplied by Charlie in 1908 as
- belonging to the village at the mouth of a large creek on the E
- side of the Eel R. above Coleman Cr.
-
-
-SINKYONE
-
-The Sinkyone occupied the territory on the west side of the South Fork
-of the Eel from Scotia south to Hollow Tree Creek. From the Mattole
-boundary at Spanish Flat south to the Coast Yuki line at Usal Creek they
-held the coast.
-
-We have more ethnographic information about the Sinkyone than about
-most of the Athabascan groups. Merriam's material and Goddard's data
-combined provide a virtually complete village list for the northern,
-or Lolangkok, Sinkyone and a few villages for the southern, or Shelter
-Cove, Sinkyone. Kroeber's Handbook (1925_a_, pp. 145-150) gives a fair
-amount of general ethnography and this is well augmented by Nomland's
-paper (Nomland, 1935).
-
-Sinkyone territory is in the redwood coastal zone and this location no
-doubt reduced somewhat the supply of vegetal food. The Sinkyone were,
-however, well supplied with fish products by the Eel River, which not
-only had an excellent salmon run but also provided quantities of lamprey
-eel.
-
-On the basis of Merriam's linguistic evidence the Sinkyone have been
-divided into a northern group, called Lolangkok after the native
-name for Bull Creek, and a southern group, called Shelter Cove after
-a sheltered spot on the coast midway between the Mattole and Yuki
-boundaries. This division is rendered somewhat questionable by the
-unreliability of Sally Bell, Merriam's Shelter Cove Sinkyone informant.
-It is doubtful, however, whether Sally Bell's linguistic information
-could be falsified. In any case, the separation is partly verified by
-Goddard's data and I have therefore accepted it.
-
-The Merriam notes contain a comparatively large amount of material on
-the Lolangkok Sinkyone. The following general statement on that group is
-taken verbatim from that source.
-
- The Lo-lahn´-k[=o]k. Information is from George Burt, a member
- of the tribe, who was raised on Bull Creek at the rancheria called
- Kahs-cho´-chin-net´-tah about seven miles upstream from Dyerville,
- at a place now known as Schoolhouse Flat, and who now lives near
- Fortuna (1922).
-
- The territory of the Lo-lahn´-k[=o]k began on the north at
- Shively and covered a narrow strip on the east side of the main Eel
- River to Dyerville, and a much broader area on the west side, and
- continued southerly on the west side of South Fork Eel River nearly
- to Garberville. On the west it not only covered the South Fork
- drainage, but continued over Elk Ridge to the head waters of Upper
- Mattole River.
-
- The southern boundary ran a little north of Ettersburg,
- Briceland, and Garberville.
-
- Informant states that on the east side of South Fork Eel River
- their territory included only the immediate river valley.
-
-Merriam's informant from the Southern Sinkyone was Sally Bell. She had
-evidently lived at Briceland for more than thirty years when she was
-interviewed in 1923. Nomland (1935, p. 149) says of her that she was
-"born Needle Rock; reared from childhood by white settlers, married
-Coast Yuki, Tom Bell; blind, senile, sees spirits in rafters, etc."
-(See fig. 1, _d_.) This group Merriam describes only in a brief general
-statement, summarized as follows.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 1. Athabascan tattooing noted by C. Hart Merriam.
-_a_, _b_. Whilkut women, _c_. Bear River woman from a sketch made by
-Merriam in 1921. _d_. From a sketch made by Merriam of the Shelter Cove
-woman named Sally Bell.]
-
- To´-cho´-be ke´ah is their own name and the Lolahnkok name
- for the tribe (and village) in the Briceland region (between the
- South Fork of the Eel and the coast). It is used also in a larger
- sense for all bands speaking the same dialect from the west side of
- the South Fork of the Eel River (in the Garberville region) to the
- coast. The Set´tenbi´den [Lassik] call this group Yis-sing´-kun-ne.
- The name of the group is pronounced To-cho´-be ke´ah by the
- Lolahn´k[=o]k and Taw-chaw´-be-ke´ah by themselves.
-
-
-TRIBELETS
-
-None of the tribelets of the Sinkyone is described or located
-specifically enough to permit the drawing of boundaries. Hence they are
-merely listed here, with available location data. Nomland (1935, p.
-151) says: "Two informants always gave names of land areas in place of
-village names." These names are no doubt those of tribelets.
-
- chi-chin-kah ke-ah (Merriam). This is the name for the
- tribelet between the upper waters of Bull Cr. and Elk Ridge.
- Nomland gives the name chacingu´k for the group in the ridge N of
- Briceland, which is evidently Elk Ridge.
-
- yese'kuk (Nomland). This is given as the Mattole R. area,
- possibly a tribelet designation.
-
- The two tribelets listed above are the only ones noted in the
- area of the Bull Creek or Lolangkok Sinkyone. The following, all
- from Merriam except where noted, are in the area of the Shelter
- Cove Sinkyone.
-
- to-cho-be ke-ah (taw-chaw-be keah). Name for the tribelet and
- village in the Briceland region between the South Fork of the Eel
- and the coast. Used in the larger sense for all the tribelets from
- Briceland south to Usal Cr. totro'b[=e] (Nomland, 1935). This was
- the name of the Briceland area.
-
- nahs-lin-che-ke-ah. This was the name of the tribelet on South
- Fork S of Garberville. senke'kut (Nomland). This is given as the
- area "to the South Fork from Garberville."
-
- tahng-ah-ting keah. This was the Bull Creek Sinkyone name
- for the Shelter Cove and Point Delgada tribelet. They were called
- tahng-i-keah by themselves and by the Briceland Sinkyone. Kroeber
- (1925, p. 145) gives tangating as the place name for Shelter Cove.
-
- Usal (Yosawl). This is the southernmost tribelet of the
- Briceland Sinkyone, said to extend from Usal Cr. to Shelter Cove.
- According to Kroeber (1925, p. 145) "This word seems to be from
- Pomo Yoshol, denoting either the Coast Yuki or the Mankya, both of
- whom are north of the Pomo; but yo is 'south' and shol 'eastward'
- in that language."
-
-The following names are given by Nomland for Sinkyone areas. They do not
-correspond to Merriam's tribelets and are probably just place names.
-
- anse'ntakuk The land south of Briceland
-
- cusacic'ha The region north of Garberville
-
- yenekuk The area southeast of Briceland
-
- yese' The coast area to the Mattole boundary at Four Mile Cr.
-
-
-VILLAGES
-
-Most of the Sinkyone villages given here are taken from Goddard's notes.
-A few are also given by Merriam. In the list the source is indicated
-by (G) for Goddard, (M) for Merriam. Merriam's notes contain, besides
-the village names, a list of place names on the Eel and on South Fork,
-running from Scotia to south of Garberville (see pp. 191-193, map 13).
-In areas where Merriam's material can be compared with Goddard's these
-place names nearly all turn out to be village names. It seems likely
-therefore that, in other areas also, nearly all are village names. In
-calculating population (see p. 216), I have occasionally used these to
-augment the village count.
-
-_Lolangkok Sinkyone villages on the main Eel (map 11)._--Of the
-following villages, the two north of the mouth of South Fork are from
-Merriam's notes, for which George Burt was the informant. Merriam also
-gives several place names for the area below the mouth of South Fork,
-and it seems probable that most, if not all, of these were actually
-villages rather than mere landmarks; this was certainly so farther south
-on South Fork.
-
-[Illustration: Map 11. Villages of the Lolangkok Sinkyone.]
-
-Above the mouth of South Fork the villages are from Goddard's notes; the
-informant was Charlie and the information was gathered in 1903 and 1908.
-It is possible that these villages are not Sinkyone. However, there is
-no specific evidence for attributing this region to the Nongatl and it
-is known that Charlie was a Lolangkok Sinkyone, so I have placed them in
-this latter group. Goddard has given the section, township, and range
-locations as he did for the preceding villages. These have been helpful
-in locating the sites, but I have omitted his notations because they
-are no longer accurate; the maps have been changed since the time of
-Goddard's original work.
-
- 1. lah-s[=a]-se´-te (M). At Shively on the main Eel R.
-
- 2. kah´-li-cho´-be, "growing flat" (M). At a place now called
- Englewood, a small settlement 9 mi. E of Scotia bridge. The name is
- said to refer to things growing up there.
-
- 3. seûstcelindûñ (G). On the S bank of the main Eel not far
- downstream from Dyerville.
-
- 4. t[=o]nesdadûñ (G). On the NE bank of the Eel directly
- across from seûstcelindûñ.
-
- 5. tetcinne (G). On the E side of the Eel upstream from
- t[=o]nesdadûñ. A big rock, pointing downstream, is said to project
- into the river there.
-
- 6. tûggûstc[=o] dasañke (G). On the E side of the Eel S of
- tetcinne. A large rancheria in an open place.
-
- 7. naltcûñka (G). On the W side of Eel R. S of tûggûstc[=o]
- dasañke. There is a big slide there. It is below Camp Grant on the
- S side, according to Charlie, 1903.
-
- nahl-tsin´-kah (M). Camp Grant.
-
- 8. t[=o][-l]tciñyasta' (G). On the E side of the Eel about 1
- mi. above naltcûñka. A large rock stands back of the village site.
-
- 9. tadûttc[=i]' (G). On the E side of the Eel not far above
- t[=o][-l]tciñyasta', at the mouth of a large creek in which salmon
- run (tadak[=o]k, Thompson Cr.?). Above Camp Grant.
-
- 10. tcillûñdûñ (G). On the E side of the Eel 1/4 mi.
- above tadûttc[=i]'. An open place without a creek. (Given as
- k[=i]lûndûñk[=i]a by Charlie in 1903.)
-
- 11. ne'gakak, "moss"? (G). On the W side of the Eel opposite
- tcillûñdûñ.
-
- 12. ne'tcink[=o]k (G). At the mouth of a creek on the W side
- of the Eel some way above ne'gakak.
-
- 13. gactc[=o]bi', "redwoods in" (G). In a large open flat
- among the redwoods on the E side of the Eel above ne'tcink[=o]k.
- Given by Charlie in 1903 as kûctc[=o]bek[=i]a on the S side.
-
- 14. On the E side of the Eel just S of a creek which flows
- down a steep rough bed on a rather high bench are 4 pits. The
- ground is black with refuse and cooking stones lie about. The river
- enters a canyon N of this creek. A round timbered butte is close to
- the mouth of the creek on the N. A great timbered butte seems to
- occupy the E bank of the river for several miles.
-
- 15. seda'dûn, "rock mouth place" (G). On the E side (W also?),
- where the river flows out between rocks. A small creek is there.
- About 2 mi. above gactc[=o]bi'.
-
-_Lolangkok Sinkyone villages on South Fork (map 11)._--
-
- 16. [-l]tcûnta'dûñ (G). Said to have been on the W side of
- South Fork and the S side of the Eel R., where the store and saloon
- of Dyerville now stand.
-
- chin-tah´-tah (M). The flat occupied by Dyerville; this is no
- doubt the same as the name given by Goddard.
-
- 17. kahs-cho´-chin-net´-tah (M). A large village on Bull Cr.
- about 7 mi. upstream from Dyerville. The place is now known as
- Schoolhouse Flat.
-
- 18. [-l][=o]lûñk[=i]' (G). On the S bank of Bull Cr. at its
- mouth, in large redwood timber. There were 10 pits along the bank
- of South Fork and the pit of a yitco', 8 paces across, about 200
- yds. W of the mouth of Bull Cr. A large redwood, hollowed by
- fire, had fallen, the floor being 4 ft. below the ground. Charlie
- remembered seeing Indians living in it. Charlie thought there used
- to be three or four houses on the S side of the creek, but we found
- no evidence of them. Three men were once killed here by whites, and
- a woman was shot through the hips; she lay here a day or two and
- died. One of the white men, named Steve, cut a piece from the arm
- of one of the Indians, built a fire, cooked it, and ate it. The
- best man of the Indians escaped.
-
- lo-lahn´-k[=o]k (M). Bull Cr. Merriam does not mention a
- village at its mouth.
-
- 19. [-l][=o]lûñk[=o]k y[=i]bañ (G). On the E bank of South
- Fork opposite and N of the mouth of Bull Cr. Two pits were seen
- directly across from Bull Cr. and 2 about 100 yds. downstream. They
- are in heavy redwood timber, but receive a good deal of sun because
- they are close to the river, which flows NW at this point.
-
- 20. s[=o]snoibûndûñ (G). On the E bank of South Fork about a
- mile S of the mouth of Bull Cr. Five pits were counted in small
- redwood timber, where there is a spring which supplied the village.
- There used to be a yitco' here, in which Charlie remembered dancing
- when he was a small boy.
-
- 21. nûnsûntc[=o]tc[=i]', "butte large mouth" (G). On both
- sides of the mouth of Brush Cr. (Canoe Cr.) in large redwood
- timber. On the N side are 6 pits, 5 of them in a row back about 30
- yds. There are seven pits on the S side of the creek, some of them
- much plainer than others. The father of Albert's wife, Sally, came
- from this village.
-
- nahn´-sin-cho´-ke (M). See Place Names.
-
- 22. sedj[=o]cb[=i]' (G). On the E bank of South Fork, which
- flows toward the W at this point. A stream from the E (Feese Cr.)
- flows in a little above the village. There are many tanbark oaks
- growing near by, which Charlie suggested were the reason for the
- village's being located here. Seven pits could be distinguished;
- the clearing away of timber may have obscured some others. The name
- setc[=o]sdiñ was also given by Charlie. Tc[=o]s means vagina, "what
- woman has."
-
- s[=a]-ch[=o]s-te (M). See Place Names.
-
- 23. gûtta'bûndûñ, named from a deep hole in the stream (G). On
- the W side of South Fork, where it flows toward the NE just below
- Myer's. The site has been completely washed away. Charlie's father
- belonged here and Charlie lived here when a boy. Jack, Charlie's
- half-brother, was born at this village. There used to be a yitco'
- and a large hollow tree in which a family used to spend the winter.
-
- kah-tah´-be (M). See Place Names.
-
- 24. tantañaik[=i]' bûndûñ (G). On the E side of South Fork.
- A creek, along which are many tanbark oaks, flows into South Fork
- on the opposite side and a little above. The name of the creek is
- tantañaik[=o]k (Coon Cr.). The site is just below a garden. The
- place was so grown up with brakes it was impossible to count the
- pits.
-
- 25. t[=o]dûnni', "water sings" (G). On the NW corner of Myer's
- Flat on the right bank of South Fork, where it completes its course
- toward the W and turns toward the NE. The site has been washed
- away. There used to be large peppernut trees growing there. A few
- are still left. The name of Myer's Flat is kûnteltc[=o]b[=i]. It is
- also mentioned as kontelky[=o]b[=i].
-
- ken´-tes-cho´-be (M). See Place Names.
-
- 26. sestcicbandûñ (G). On the right bank of South Fork on a
- narrow bench between the hill and that stream. There is an eddy
- in the river just above, which furnished good fishing, and many
- oaks are on the hills. The site received plenty of sun because the
- river flows W at this point. Four pits were seen. Also given as
- sûstc[=i]cb[=i], "rough like a rasp."
-
- ses-che´-is-ke (M). See Place Names.
-
- 27. sebûggûnna', "rock around" (G). On the right side and
- close to South Fork just downstream from a rocky point around which
- the river changes its direction from S to NW. Fourteen or fifteen
- pits could be distinguished, most of them quite distinct.
-
- s[=a]-bug´-gah-nah´ (M). See Place Names.
-
- 28. sek[=o]ntc[=o]bandûñ (G). On the left side of South Fork
- nearly opposite sebûggûnna'. The sandy bench is covered with
- brakes. Five pits were made out. Charlie lived here for four
- years after he came back from the reservation. Also mentioned as
- tañaib[=i].
-
- 29. s[=o]ldek[=o]k bûkk[=i]'d[=u]ñ (G). On a small flat
- covered with large redwood timber on the N side of South Fork and
- on the W side of Elk Creek (s[=o]ldek[=o]k), which flows into it
- from the N. Seven pits were counted along the banks of the river
- and the creek.
-
- s[=o]l´-te-che (M). See Place Names.
-
- 30. sente[-l]tcelindûñ, "rock flat flows out place" (G).
- Close to the W bank of South Fork near a deep fishing place. There
- are three pits between the county road and the river. Also called
- sentelduñ.
-
- sen-t[)e]^{ch}-be (M). See Place Names.
-
- 31. ca'nak[=i]', "creek trail" (G). On the W bank of South
- Fork 100 yds. N of the mouth of Salmon Cr., in large redwoods.
- The river has washed the soil away so no evidence of occupation
- remains. Willow brush is now growing there. Also called
- natonank[=o]k bûttc[=i]'dûñ.
-
- sah-nah´-k[=o]k (M). Name for Salmon Cr. See Place Names.
-
- 32. tc[=i]stc[=i]bi' (G). On the E bank of South Fork opposite
- the mouth of Salmon Cr. It is on the end of a ridge. Charlie had a
- ne'y[=i]k' here after returning from the reservation (village site
- not visited). This village was mentioned by Sam as his birthplace.
- His mother may have been from here. Also referred to by Charlie as
- canak[=i]' and tcûstc[=e]k[=o]ok.
-
- 33. nant'[=o]' (G). On the N side of Salmon Cr. in a bend.
- Large redwoods fill the valley of the creek as well as the
- particular site of this village. Five deep, distinct pits were
- seen. There are said to be one or two on the south side of the
- creek.
-
- 34. k[=o]nte[-l]b[=i], "flat in" (G). On a large flat, through
- which Salmon Cr. flows. The village was on the N side of the creek
- near where Tomlinson's barn now stands. There is a spring there
- near a pepperwood tree. This flat is now in peach orchard.
-
- 35. kaslintc[=o]'dûñ, "riffle large place" (G). On the N side
- of Salmon Cr. about 400 yds. upstream from k[=o]nte[-l]b[=i]'.
-
- 36. setcinnabatse tcelindûn (G). On the N side of Salmon Cr.
- in a basin-like flat. Four pits were seen near the creek and 4 in a
- row back about 50 yds. against the base of the hill. There were 2
- more pits in front of the last 4, making 10 in all. There is heavy
- Douglas spruce and tanbark oak timber on the southern side of the
- creek. About 200 yds. upstream is a waterfall, which provided fine
- fishing, since large salmon could not jump the falls.
-
- 37. bandûñ (G). On the end of a ridge, W of a small run lined
- with peppernut trees. About 200 yds. NE of se[-l]tcindûñ. There
- were 5 pits, 2 of which were very large.
-
- 38. setcinnabatse (G). On a flattened end of the ridge E of
- se[-l]tcindûñ, 300 yds. S and a little W of it. Two pits were
- certain.
-
- 39. se[-l]tcindûñ (G). On the E side of a gulch, in which
- there was flowing water in July, about 300 yds. N of Salmon Cr.
- There were 4 or 5 pits. The ground is strewn with black stones.
-
- 40. tcebanedûñ (G). On the flattened portion of a ridge, with
- southern exposure. Black oaks and buckeyes are growing there.
- Seven pits were to be seen with black stones lying in them. Great
- broken rocks lie in a gulch to the west. About 350 yds. NNW of
- se[-l]tcindûñ.
-
- 41. setc[=o]'seye (G). A large rock, with the overhanging side
- facing SE. A rim of earth showed where the house wall used to be on
- the W. The E was left open. About 1/4 mi. W of the falls of Salmon
- Cr.
-
- 42. t[=o][-l]elindûñ, "water flows together place" (G). On the
- flat W of Salmon Cr. and W of a large creek flowing into it from
- the S (South Fork Salmon Cr.). Four pits are close to the bank of
- Salmon Cr. and a fifth was partly caved in. One was seen on the
- lower part of the flat to the S.
-
- 43. nesdai'dûñ (G). Said to be on a side hill.
-
- 44. to[-l]elindûñ, "water comes together place" (G). Said to
- be where three creeks join, forming the South Fork of Salmon Cr.,
- about 5 mi. from its mouth. Distinguished from the village at the
- mouth of the same creek by being called "small."
-
- 45. ses[=o]sye' (G). At the end of a ridge running down to
- Salmon Cr. from the E. So close to the bank of the stream that
- one pit has been undermined. Four remain. About 1/2 mi. NW of
- to[-l]elindûñ.
-
- 46. ne'kañk[=i]' (G). In the saucer-shaped end of a ridge,
- close to the E bank of Salmon Cr. and facing a little S of W.
- Opposite, a large creek, called ne'kañk[=o]k, flows in from the W.
- There are 9 pits, which may still be seen. Five of them, situated
- close to the base of the hill, are very large and deep. Black oaks
- grow there.
-
- 47. ne'i[-l]ga[-l]dûñ, "land shinny-playing place" (G). On a
- flat close to the E side of Salmon Cr., which swings around it. A
- gulch heads in the cedar grove N of the Hunter ranch buildings.
- Twelve or 13 pits were counted, 5 of which were quite distinct.
-
- 48. seistc[=i]' (G). About 1/2 mi. E of Salmon Cr. on the
- flattened southern slope of a ridge about 100 yds. from its crest.
- There are 8 pits in a row and 1 other, not in line with them. There
- is a gulch 100 ft. S of the row of pits. Cedars, black oaks, and
- buckeyes grow there. A small pond of water is E of the site.
-
- 49. mûñkkasaik[=o]k (G). On the W side of a branch of Salmon
- Cr. which flows from the N about 1/2 mi. W of the Burnell ranch
- house. Two pits are close to the stream and 4 or 5 are 10 or 15
- ft. higher. The higher ones have good sun in the winter. The trail
- crosses the creek at this place.
-
- 50. setc'ûnt[=o]dûñ (G). On the W side of the South Fork of
- the Eel about 1/4 mi. above the mouth of Butte Cr. (nûnsûnk[=o]k),
- which provided desirable fishing. A large rock stands there close
- to the river. There are said to have been four houses. This site
- was not visited. It was mentioned by Charlie as sesuñt[=o]; he said
- it was the most southerly village of his people. Sam called it
- senûns[=i]mkûk and said it belonged in Charlie's territory.
-
- The first name given by Goddard is evidently related to
- Merriam's s[=a]´-chen-to´-te, "water against rock," which was said
- to be a place in the river near Goddard's setc'ûnt[=o]dûñ. See
- Place Names.
-
-_Shelter Cove Sinkyone villages (map 12)._--The following list of
-villages comes almost entirely from Goddard's notes (G); relevant
-comments by Merriam are noted (M). Goddard's informants were Sam,
-Albert, and Charlie, of whom the first two were Shelter Cove Sinkyone,
-the last Lolangkok Sinkyone.
-
- 1. ke'kestc[=i]' (G). Close to South Fork on the E side about
- 1/8 mi. S of the mouth of Fish Cr. (kekek[=o]k). A large house with
- a garden is just below. A deep place in the river provided fishing,
- in addition to the creek. Three pits and a grinding stone were
- found. Plowing had probably filled in other pits. The first store
- of Phillipsville stood here. According to Sam (1903), this was the
- most northern village of his people.
-
- k[)a]-kes´-k[=o]k (M). Fish Cr.
-
- 2. kûtdûntelb[=i]', "flat in" (G). At the NW part of the
- Phillipsville flat. It is said to have been a large village. There
- is fishing in an eddy just upstream. The site has been washed away
- and therefore was not visited.
-
- ket´-tin-tel´-be (M). At a place called Phillipsville, 18 mi.
- S of Dyerville. The site is in an orchard on a ranch and has a fine
- redwood grove and a good camping place.
-
- 3. seb[=i]ye, "at base of rock" (G). On the E side of South
- Fork at the upper end of the Phillipsville flat. The site has been
- plowed and was in fruit and garden when visited. One pit could
- still be seen. The river flows nearly W, hence the village has
- southern sun. Large redwoods occupy the left bank of the stream. A
- deep place here provided fishing.
-
- s[)a]-be-y[)e]´ (M). The flat on the E side of South Fork, S
- of Phillipsville. See Place Names.
-
- 4. tcingûlge[-l]dûñ (name of a tree) (G). On the right bank
- of South Fork just below a turn to the E. Between the road and the
- river two pits were seen. There is a schoolhouse on the E side of
- the road. Many eels were caught near this village.
-
- chig-gel´-e-yes´-ke (M). A place 1.9 mi. S of Phillipsville.
- See Place Names.
-
- 5. da[-l]tcimmûndûñ (G). On the right (S) bank of South Fork,
- where it flows W around a long ridge sloping down from the E.
- Seven pits were counted between the county road and the river,
- which may have carried others away. A large creek, seyekok (Rocky
- Glen Cr.), empties N of this place. This village was mentioned as
- t'altcimmûndûñ by Albert in 1907.
-
- [Illustration: Map 12. Villages of the Shelter Cove Sinkyone.]
-
- s[)e]-tes´-k[=o]k (M). Rocky Glen Cr. See Place Names.
-
- 6. tca'lûñk[=i]' (G). On the E bank of South Fork. A small
- stream flows down from the E. Three pits were found on the N side
- of it and two on the S side. The place had been plowed. Charlie
- said there used to be many houses there. This village was given by
- Albert as tca'lûntc[=i].
-
- 7. da[-l]kaik[=o]k (G). On a flat 50 yds. E of the county
- bridge across Buhne Cr. (now called Dean Cr.), along both sides of
- the stream. Seven pits were found on the S side of the creek and
- two on the N side. The road and plowed fields may have reduced the
- number. This village was mentioned by Sam in 1903 as a settlement
- of his people.
-
- tahs-ki´-ke (M). Merriam attributes this village to the
- to-kub´-be people, who ranged E from here.
-
- 8. da[-l]kaik[=i]' (G). On the W side of South Fork, opposite
- the mouth of Dean Cr. Albert said there used to be a village there.
-
- This is evidently the village Merriam refers to in the
- paragraph above on village 7.
-
- 9. [-l]tûggan[=o]b[=i]' (G). On a flat on the E side of South
- Fork about 1/4 mi. above the mouth of Redwood Cr. Goddard noted
- that the place had a favorable location, but did not find the pits.
- Albert said there used to be a village there.
-
- stuk´-kan-no´-be (M). Name for the flat at this place. See
- Place Names.
-
- 10. k[=o]sc[=i]k[=i] (G). A short way below Garberville,
- according to Sam (1903). Charlie said it was named k[=o]ssetc[=i]'
- or k[=o]setc[=i]' and that it was just below Garberville on the E
- side of the river. There used to be a store there.
-
- 11. seb[=i]yedadûñ, "rocks under..?... place" (G). A village
- at Garberville.
-
- 12. kûnte[-l]tc[=o]b[=i]', "flat large in" (G). On a flat
- above Garberville.
-
- ken-tes´-che tahng-ah´-te (M). A beautiful deep valley on
- South Fork just SW of Garberville.
-
- 13. Usal (not necessarily the native name). Not mentioned by
- Goddard, Merriam, or Nomland, but Gifford (1939, p. 304) says that
- both Coast Yuki and Sinkyone were spoken here (pl. 11, _d_).
-
-Following are a number of Shelter Cove Sinkyone villages which I have
-not been able to locate precisely.
-
- kahs´-cho-so´-be (M). A village of the Briceland Sinkyone
- on South Fork about 4 mi. S of Garberville and not in sight from
- the present highway. It may not actually be one of the Briceland
- Sinkyone villages.
-
- kaicañkûk (G). On a ridge below Garberville. Information from
- Sam, 1903.
-
- [-l]tc[=i]kûk (G). On a ridge below seyadûñ on South Fork.
- Information from Sam, 1903.
-
- t[=o]kûbb[=i] (G). On a ridge above Garberville. Information
- from Sam, 1903. seya(e)dûñ (G). On a ridge on the E side of South
- Fork, probably below Garberville.
-
-
-PLACE NAMES
-
-The first list of place names below was taken by Merriam from George
-Burt in 1923. (See map 13.) It starts at Scotia, runs upstream to the
-confluence of the Eel and South Fork, and then runs up South Fork as
-far as Garberville. Many of the places indicated cannot be located
-from maps and it would even be difficult to identify them on the spot.
-Merriam seems to have driven by auto from Scotia to Garberville, marking
-locations in tenths of miles.
-
- tah´-cho. Main Eel R.
-
- hah´-tin cho´-be. A stretch of land on the S side of the main
- Eel extending from Scotia Bridge E at least to Brown's Mill, and S
- from the river to the top of the ridge.
-
- kahn-so´-ti-y[)e]´, "under maple trees." A big loop of the
- river 2 mi. E from Scotia Bridge.
-
- hah´-ting-k[=o]k. Jordan Cr., 2.2 mi. E of Scotia Bridge.
-
- hah´-tin cho´-be. The prairie on top of the ridge S of Jordan
- Cr. An old Indian trail goes up there. [Harrow Prairie. Merriam
- gives the same name for the prairie and the stretch of land above.
- The stretch of land is probably a village named for the prairie.]
-
- ahn´-sin ken-tes´-be, "Pepperwood Flat." A flat on the S side
- of the Eel, 3 mi. E of Scotia Bridge. [Pepperwood.]
-
- lah´-sa tal´-k[=o]k, "Buckeye Creek." Bear Cr., nearly 6 mi. E
- of Scotia Bridge. "Used to be lots of salmon there."
-
- lah-s[=a]-se´-te. The present town of Shively.
-
- bis´-kahl chum´-me. A bluff on Eel R. where the river makes a
- loop to the S. About 6.3 mi. from Scotia Bridge.
-
- s[=a]-tahs´ ch[=a]-lin´-te. An extensive gravel flat on the N
- side of the Eel in the curve of a big loop in the river, 6.5 mi.
- from Scotia Bridge.
-
- s[=a]-tahs´-be. A bluff on the N side of the Eel at the
- railroad tunnel 6-3/4 or 7 mi. E from Scotia Bridge. Said to be a
- rough place.
-
- ahn-sin´-tah´-be, "Pepperwood Flat." A flat on the S side of
- the river 7.5 mi. E from Scotia Bridge. Place now called Pepperwood.
-
- ahn-sin-tah´-k[=o]k, "Pepperwood Creek." A small creek closely
- followed by the highway, about 7.5 to 8 mi. E from Scotia Bridge.
- [Evidently Chadd Cr.]
-
- kahs-tes´-be. Holmes' lumber camp, on S side of Eel about 7.5
- mi. E of Scotia Bridge.
-
- slahn´-k[=o]. Larabee Creek, entering the Eel from the E.
-
- kah´-li-cho´-be, "growing flat." At a place called Englewood,
- a small settlement 9 mi. E of Scotia Bridge and continuing to
- Englewood Roadhouse at 9.8 mi. The name is said to refer to things
- "growing up" there.
-
- tan´-k[=o]s tah´-te (tan´-k[=o]s means _Equisitum_). A long
- ford 10.5 mi. E of Scotia Bridge. It is a long gravel bar on the
- N side of the river. It is named for the abundance of Horsetail
- (_Equisitum_) found there.
-
- s[=a]´ cho´-te (sa means "rock"). A big rock projecting into
- the river from the S side, 11.5 mi. from Scotia Bridge. [It appears
- to be what is now called High Rock.]
-
- s[=a]-tah´-ting. A redwood forest and flat near the rock sa
- cho-te and named for that rock.
-
- chin-tah´-tah. An extensive flat on the S side of the Eel from
- the mouth of South Fork W, including Dyerville, 13 mi. from Scotia
- Bridge.
-
- ts[)a]-vel´-be. An area on the S side of the Eel immediately W
- of and adjoining chin-tah´-tah.
-
- lel´-lin teg´-o-be. The junction of South Fork with the main
- Eel R.
-
- sin´-ke-k[=o]k. The South Fork of the Eel R.
-
- tah´-tung-i´-kut. South Fork railroad station.
-
- nahl-tsin´-kah (nahl-tsuk´-kah). Old Camp Grant.
-
- ·hles-yah´-kah (les-yah´-kah). Fruitland in Elk Prairie.
-
- s[=a]-tah´-be. Eel Rock, about 12 mi. up the Eel from its
- junction with South Fork.
-
- tah´-cho. The main Eel R.
-
- nah-tah´-ting i-k[=a]. Dyerville Redwood Flat in the point
- between the main Eel and South Fork. The name means "pointed out,"
- a descriptive term suggested by the geographical feature.
-
- lo-lahn´-k[=o]k. Bull Cr.
-
- kahs-cho´ chi-net´-tah. Schoolhouse Flat, 7 mi. up Bull Cr.
-
- s[=a]´-es-ch[=a]-lin´-te, "rock run out." On the E side of
- South Fork 1/2 or 3/4 mi. S of Dyerville.
-
- sit´-se-tahl´-ko. A small creek on the W side of South Fork
- about 1/2 mi. S of Bull Cr. [Evidently Decker Cr.]
-
- s[=a]´-es´-kuk, "on top rock." A hill on the E side of South
- Fork 0.9 mi. S of Dyerville.
-
- lah´-s[=a]-cho´-te. A straight shoot of South Fork beginning
- at s[=a]´-es´-kuk Hill 0.9 mi. S of Dyerville. Lots of eels there
- in the spring.
-
- to-be´-ah. Schelling Camp Flat (lumber camp, garden, and
- orchard) on the E side of South Fork beginning 2.2 mi. and
- extending about 1/2 mi. to the S. [Evidently this is the present
- town of Weott.]
-
- [Illustration: Map 13. Place names of the Lolangkok Sinkyone.]
-
- nahn´-sin-cho´-ke. The big hill to be seen on the E side of
- South Fork 3 mi. S of Dyerville.
-
- s[=a]-ch[=o]s-te (s[=a]-cho-st[)a]), "vulva rock." A long
- gravel bar along both sides of the river and including a redwood
- flat 4 mi. S of Dyerville. Named for a mark on a rock resembling a
- woman's vulva, cho´-s[=a].
-
- che-[=o]s-cho´-te. A stretch of river 4.75 mi. S of Dyerville,
- including a small but good redwood flat. The name refers to foam on
- the water.
-
- s[=a]´-boo-i-chan´-te. A big perforated rock in the river at a
- sharp bend 5.1 mi. S of Dyerville.
-
- kah-tah´-be. A stretch along both sides of the river 7.5 mi.
- S of Dyerville. It includes the State Redwood Park office building
- and adjacent redwoods.
-
- ken´-tes-cho´-be. Myers Flat, a little over 8 mi. S of
- Dyerville, including Myers Roadhouse. The Indians say this place
- was never covered with timber.
-
- ses-che´-is-ke. A place 8.7 mi. S of Dyerville, above
- ken-tes-cho-be.
-
- s[=a]-bug´-gah-nah´. A place 9 mi. S of Dyerville where the
- river goes around rocks. [Evidently Eagle Pt.] George Burt once
- lived here and his son Guy Burt was born here.
-
- tub´-bel-chin´-tah ch[=a]-gel-k[=o]k. A small creek 10 mi. S
- of Dyerville, entering South Fork from the E just S of a bend in
- the river. [Evidently Bridge Cr.]
-
- s[=o]l´-te-che. A place at the mouth of Elk Cr., on the E side
- of South Fork. Includes the eastern part of Bolling Grove.
-
- s[=o]l-te-k[=o]k. Elk Creek, entering South Fork from the E in
- Bolling Grove, 10.3 mi. S of Dyerville.
-
- sen-t[)e]^{ch}-be. A rock in the river at a small bend 11.2
- mi. S of Dyerville.
-
- ni´-te´-t[)e] el-lah´-t[)e], "dog drowned" ... A place where a
- new bridge is now (1923) being built across South Fork, 12 mi. S of
- Dyerville. [Evidently this refers to the bridge at Blair Grove.]
-
- suk´-ke-ch[=o]s kah´-me, "eagle pawn." A big flat on the W
- side of the river 12.5 mi. S of Dyerville.
-
- chah´-ni-che´. Another large flat on the W side of the river,
- 13.5 mi. from Dyerville.
-
- sah-nah´-k[=o]k. Salmon Cr., entering South Fork from the W
- nearly opposite Miranda.
-
- kahs´-cho-boo´-ah´-me. This was a small settlement in a flat
- at Miranda, 14.5 mi. S of Dyerville.
-
- s[=a]-nan-sung´ (·s[=a]-nan-tsin´-kah). Bear Butte, a
- conspicuous peak on the W side of South Fork, about 18 mi. S of
- Dyerville.
-
- s[=a]´-chen-to´-te, "water against rock." A place in the river
- 16 mi. S of Dyerville.
-
- k[)a]-kes´-k[=o]k (k[)e]-kes´-k[=o]k). Fish Cr., 16.9 mi. S of
- Dyerville.
-
- kin´-tes-tah´-te. A big flat, probably a mile long and very
- broad, on the W side of the river, 17.5 mi. S of Dyerville. Just N
- of Phillipsville but on the opposite side of the river.
-
- ket´-tin-tel´-be. A flat (now orchard and ranch) and village
- on the E side of South Fork, 18 mi. S of Dyerville, at a place now
- called Phillipsville. It comprises a fine redwood grove and a good
- camping place.
-
- s[)a]-be-y[)e]´. A flat on the E side of the river 0.7 mi. S
- of Phillipsville.
-
-A mile south of Phillipsville there is a good view of Garberville Ridge,
-s[)e]-chung´-kuk, a fine ridge, part timbered and part open grassy
-hillside, which slopes west from Little Buck Mountain, n[=a]-ah-ki´-kah,
-the highest point, some distance back on the east.
-
- to-be-y[)e], "prairie under." A small flat on the W side of
- the river 1 mi. S of Phillipsville.
-
- yen-nes´-be. A place 1.6 mi. S of Phillipsville.
-
- chig-gel´-e-yes´-ke. A place 1.9 mi. S of Phillipsville.
-
- s[)e]´-chin-k[=o]k´. A small stream probably 1.2 mi. S of
- Phillipsville. A possibility of error here. If the location is
- correct, the stream is probably Ohman Cr.
-
- s[)e]^{hl}-ki´-k[=o]k. A creek 2.1 mi. S of Phillipsville. The
- preceding location is probably an error and this is Ohman Cr.
-
- s[)e]-ki´-ke. The land S of s[)e]^{hl}-ki´-k[=o]k Creek,
- reaching to 2.5 mi. S of Phillipsville.
-
- s[)e]-tes´-k[=o]k, "hard rock creek." Rocky Glen Cr., 2.5 mi.
- S of Phillipsville.
-
- ki-tes´-be, "hard brush." A place 2.9 mi. S of Phillipsville.
- There is a small ranch and orchard there now (1923).
-
- chan-tan-che´. A place a little more than 3 mi. S of
- Phillipsville. There are two big rocks and a creek there.
-
- s[)e]-to´-be. A big rock facing a high bluff 4.3 mi. S of
- Phillipsville.
-
- s[=a]-ken-nes´, "talking rock." A big rock on a creek on the W
- side of the river, 5.6 mi. S of Phillipsville.
-
- tuk´-ke-tahk. A beautiful open and partly wooded hill on the W
- side of the river 6 mi. S of Phillipsville.
-
- tuk´-[)a]-tah´-be. A place on the E side of the river 6 mi. S
- of Phillipsville. Named from tuk´-ke-tahk hill.
-
- tahs-ki´-k[=o]k, "white flag creek." Dean Canyon Cr., 6.4 mi.
- S of Phillipsville.
-
- tahs-ki´-ke. Village at the mouth of tahs-ki´-k[=o]k creek. It
- belongs to the To-kub´-be tribe.
-
- to´-che-be. A flat on the W side of the river 7.8 mi. S of
- Phillipsville.
-
- bus´-ken-nes´, "cliff talking." A cliff or bluff opposite
- to´-che-be.
-
- stuk´-kan-no´-be. A big semicircular grassy flat on the E side
- of the river beginning about 8 mi. S of Phillipsville. The present
- town of Redway.
-
- ahn´-chin-tah´-k[=o]k. Redwood Cr.
-
- se´-ken-t[)e]^{ch}-t[)e]. A place 9.5 mi. S of Phillipsville.
-
- sah-nah´-che-chel´-le. A place and creek 9.7 mi. S of
- Phillipsville.
-
- bus-ki´-cho. A white bluff on the road 10 mi. S of
- Phillipsville.
-
- k[=o]s-kun-tes´-kah. A sloping, grassy, open flat 10.3 mi. S
- of Phillipsville. There was a To-kub´-be village here.
-
- ko´-se-che´. The area on both sides of the river 10.6 mi. S of
- Phillipsville. Just N of the Garberville bridge across Bear Canyon.
-
- s[=a]-g[)e]´-ch[)e], "egg rock." A bold upright rock at the
- N end of the Garberville bridge across Bear Canyon; 10.6 mi. S of
- Phillipsville.
-
- ken-tes´-che tahng-ah´-te. A beautiful deep valley on South
- Fork just SW of Garberville. The bridge across the river on the way
- to Briceland is in this valley.
-
- si-cho´-kuk. A large village of the To-kub´-be near the site
- of the bridge across South Fork on the way from Garberville to
- Briceland.
-
- nahs-lin´-che. An area and village in a loop of South Fork a
- few miles S or SW of Garberville.
-
- ken´-nahl-lag´-gah-k[=o]k (kan´-no-lig´-ah-k[=o]k). East
- Branch of the South Fork of the Eel R.
-
- n[=a]-yahn´-kah. A hill on the W side of South Fork near the
- bridge over East Branch.
-
- kahs´-cho-so´-be. A place and village on South Fork about 4
- mi. S of Garberville and 3 or 4 mi. from the highway. Not in sight
- from the highway.
-
- kahs´-cho so´-ning-i´-be. A large redwood flat (Richardson
- Grove) on the W side of South Fork on the Humboldt side of the
- Humboldt-Mendocino County line.
-
-_West of South Fork Eel_
-
- Bear Buttes sa-nan-sin-kah
- Bear River chahn´-k[=o]k
- Briceland to-cho´-be
- Elk Ridge chi-chin´-kah
- Mattole River mouth tah´-che
- North Fork Mattole nahn-tsin-tah´-k[=o]k
- Rainbow Peak tsa-che-be, tsa-bahng´-um
- Rainbow Ridge tsa-bung-ah
- Taylor Peak nahn-tsin´-kah
- Upper Mattole kun-sah´-ke
-
-_On or near the Van Duzen River_
-
- Alton chen´-n[)a]-che
- Bald Jesse Mt. k[=o]ng-kel-tel´-kah
- Bridgeville ahn´-sin-tah´-che-be´
- Buck Mt. nahn´-tsin´-kah
- Carlotta yah-hlahn´-che
- Chalk Mt. s[=a]-til-bi´
- Chalk Mt. Ridge n[)e]-chin´-tuk-kah,
- n[=a]-chin´-t[)a]-kah
- Fort Baker s[=a]-sh[=a]-be
- Iaqua region k[=o]ng-tel-kil´-k[=o]k
- Iaqua Buttes s[)e]^{hl}-kus´-[)a]-kuk
- ("two points")
- Larabee Buttes yah-kah´-nik-kah
- (t[)a]´-che-kah)
- Larabee Cr. slahn´-ko
- Lawrence Cr. yah-tlahn´-k[=o]k
- (ye-tah´-nah-ling´-k[=o]k)
- Lassik Buttes tse´-nahn-tsin´-kah
- Lassik Pk. ki´-chil-kahn-kah
- Little Larabee Cr. so´-k[=o]k
- Metropolitan yah-hlahn´-kuk
- Rohnerville to-ti´-kah
- Rio Dell ken-tel-cho´ (kin-tel´-te)
- Scotia kahs-cho ken-tel´-te
- Showers Pass s[=a]-ch[)a]-be
- Van Duzen R. chin´-ne-kok (ken´-ne-kok)
- Van Duzen R. mouth kin´-ne-ke
- Yager Cr. yah-'hlahn´-k[=o]k
- Yagerville chis-sis´-ahn´-tah
-
-
-ETHNOGRAPHIC NOTES
-
-_Lolangkok Sinkyone._--The following notes on the Lolangkok Sinkyone are
-taken verbatim from Merriam's notes. The informant was George Burt.
-
- The Lolahnkok did not fight much with other tribes but were
- sometimes attacked by the Ch[)e]-teg´-ge-kah of the region north of
- Round Valley [Pitch Wailaki]; and they think the Long Valley people
- also used to make raids on them to steal women.
-
- Chief Lassik, whose name is often used in a tribal sense,
- belonged to the Kittel´ tribe--a tribe reaching from Iaqua south to
- Dobbyn Creek [Nongatl].
-
- Chalk Mountain was only a few miles east of the boundary
- between the Kittel´ and the Lolahnkok, and the Lolahnkok were
- permitted to hunt there.
-
- _Shelter Cove Sinkyone._--Trees are felled by means of elkhorn
- chisels called beh-cho, and stone mauls called s[=a]´tah--a very
- tedious and laborious operation. When the tree has fallen, the logs
- are cut in lengths by the same process. Planks are split off from
- these logs by driving the elkhorn wedges into the ends of the logs.
- After several planks have been split off, one below the other,
- another set is started at right angles to the first.
-
- The dugout canoes are made of redwood logs dug out by means
- of the elkhorn chisels. After the greater part of the inside has
- been removed, fires are used to char the wood, which is then
- scraped away by the chisels. This is continued until the walls of
- the dugout are sufficiently thin. The fires are spread out thin in
- order not to burn too deeply at any one place.
-
- Buckskin is tanned with deer brains, rubbed on with a stick
- rolled in ashes, after which the hide is placed on warm ashes
- until dried. It is then soaked and rubbed until soft.
-
- Wild tobacco (_Nicotiana bigelovi_) was always used by the
- Bull Creek Sinkyone. It was originally found growing on burned-over
- places and the people planted the seeds in ashes, usually on a
- burned place.
-
- Buckeye nuts, called lah-s[)e]´, were cooked in a basket with
- hot stones after the manner of acorns. They were then mashed and
- kneaded into dough, which was buried for a while in fine sand.
-
- Wild Ginger (_Asarum_ sp.) is called tan-nas-bos´. It is good
- medicine for pain in the stomach. The leaves are pounded and soaked
- in cold water. The sick person drinks plenty of this water and
- vomits. After a little while he gets well and is hungry and eats.
-
- A species of _Angelica_ is called s[=o]l. If a girl holds off,
- rub s[=o]l on your hands, and if you get a chance rub her neck and
- she will give in. S[=o]l is strong medicine.
-
- An aromatic _Umbellifer_ (species not identified) is called
- s[=o]l´-che-but-tah´; the root, s[=o]l´-che. It is used for
- purification and as a disinfectant. The root is burned and the
- smoke wafted around to make the house more plentiful. It does not
- grow on Bull Creek or South Fork Eel River but grows on Rainbow
- Mountain and some of the other high ridges. The root is highly
- prized.
-
- The Spotted Owl (_Strix occidentalis caurina_) is called
- kah-ko´. He is a bad bird. If he flies close to a person, the
- person will faint.
-
- The Dove (_Zenaidura_) is called bi´-yu. His grandmother was
- burned to death. Bi´-yu was asked to gamble and replied, "I'll
- gamble every winter; in spring and summer I'll cry." Now we always
- hear the Dove cry in summer.
-
- The Red-shafted Flicker (_Colaptes cafer_) is called
- mun´-chis-bul. He makes a rattling noise in the spring. He was told
- that by doing this he would make the horns of the deer grow. He was
- told also that when the deer became fat he would grow fat, but the
- people fooled him for he did not grow fat.
-
- The Yellow-bird (_Astragalinus tristis_) is called
- sin-sun-s[)e]-gahng-ti-ne tahs´-che, "to take away pain." If the
- old folks were suffering, they would get him to sing to take the
- pain away.
-
- The Kildeer (_Oxyechus vociferus_) is called ni´-til-yi´-che
- from the necklace, ni-tal-yah, on its throat. In the long ago time
- the water was very high and rough; big waves were coming in and
- the people were afraid to cross in their canoes, so they got the
- Kildeer to take them. He was a high person among the Water People
- and could handle a boat better than any of the others. The people
- talked about him and said he was the best and the only one to get
- them across. So he took them across and saved them.
-
- The Coyote (_Canis latrans_), called sh[)u]´-b[)e], and the
- Shrewmole (_Neürotrichus_ sp.), called ske´-cho, made the world and
- the people. The Coyote had a number of children. The Shrewmole said
- that when people died they should come back to live again. Coyote
- said, "No, there would be too many people; when they die they had
- better stay dead." The Shrewmole agreed. After a while Coyote's
- children took sick and died. He wanted them to come back to life,
- but the Shrewmole said, "No; you said there would be too many
- people and you wanted dead people to stay dead, so your children
- cannot come back." Then Coyote cried.
-
- The Raccoon (_Procyon lotor_) is called nah´-ke-gis´-chah.
- A long time ago he was a doctor. He was able to talk to persons
- suffering severe pains and could draw the pain out. He would dance
- and sing and pull out the pains and fall back. One time he took a
- flint out of a sick person.
-
- In the olden time the people tried to make the Elk (_Cervus
- roosevelti_), called y[=e]s´-cho, out of the Cottontail Rabbit
- (_Sylvilagus_ sp.). They put horns on his head and sent him into
- the brush, but the horns stuck in the bushes and he could not move.
- Then the people called him sti´-che and told him he must always
- stay in the brush.
-
- The Bat is called nah´-t[)a]-bahn´-se. He wears a robe of bear
- hide over his shoulders. A long time ago when the First People were
- at war they wanted the Bat to make peace and they hired him to make
- peace. The people told him to fix up good. He did so and said, "I
- am the one who can talk big." He sang ho-w[=a]´-nah han´-nah. The
- enemy agreed, and peace was made.
-
- Our people have songs for the Elk, Deer, Coon, Otter, Mink,
- Bat, and some other animals.
-
- Slugs (_Arion columbianus_) are called nah´-tos. To prepare
- [them] for eating, a slender stick is thrust through the head to
- hold the animal easily. It is then cut open lengthwise on the belly
- and the dark insides removed, after which it is dried. When wanted,
- it is roasted in hot ashes and eaten.
-
-
-BOTANICAL NOTES
-
-_Shelter Cove Sinkyone._--These notes are from Sally Bell of the
-Briceland-Shelter Cove region.
-
- Acorns of the tanoak (_Lithocarpus densiflora_) form the
- principal vegetable food. Hazel nuts also are eaten.
-
- Among the berries used for food are those of the Elder,
- Manzanita, Blackberry, Thimbleberry, Strawberry, Huckleberry,
- Salal, wild Currant and Gooseberry.
-
- The sprouts of a species of _Angelica_ are eaten raw in spring
- and early summer.
-
- The bulb of the large red Tiger Lily is cooked and said to be
- very good. The same is true of the handsome _Brodiaea_ sp.
-
- The seeds of the Manroot (_Echinocystis_) are roasted and
- eaten. The seeds of _Godetia amoena_ are used for making pinole.
-
- Wild Tobacco does not grow along the coast and is not used.
-
- The Wood Sorrel (_Oxalis_) is used for poultices.
-
- Leaves of the narrow-leaf Iris (_Iris macrosiphon_) are used
- for cord and nets and are much better than the leaves of the
- broad-leaf species.
-
-
-MATTOLE
-
-The Mattole occupied the drainage of the Mattole River below the mouth
-of Upper North Fork and the coast from Davis Creek south to Spanish Flat.
-
-The village lists of Merriam and Goddard provide a complete picture of
-the Mattole settlements but almost nothing is known of them aside from
-this. In the Handbook Kroeber reported (1925_a_, p. 142) that "not a
-single item of concrete ethnology is on record regarding the Mattole,
-other than the statement that they burned their dead." Almost nothing
-has been learned since that time, but Nomland (1938) has published a
-monograph on the neighboring Bear River group and the culture of the two
-groups was no doubt much the same.
-
-The territory of the Mattole lies wholly within the cold coastal
-belt and consequently plant food was less abundant and no doubt less
-important. The products of the rivers, when taken together with sea
-mammals and other creatures caught in the ocean, provided an ample food
-supply.
-
-When Kroeber published the Handbook (1925_a_), he lumped the Mattole
-proper with the Bear River group. Nomland (1938) and Goddard (1929)
-showed that these two groups were distinct. This division is supported
-by Merriam's data and I have therefore retained it.
-
-Merriam appears to have spent a comparatively brief time among the
-Mattole. The only informant mentioned for this group is a man called
-Indian Joe Duncan, who is said to have lived at the mouth of the Mattole
-River below Petrolia. Merriam seems to have visited the area in 1923.
-His statement on these people, taken verbatim from his notes, follows.
-
- The Bett[=o]l´ or Pet´-t[=o]l´, as they call themselves,
- (commonly called Matt[=o]l´), inhabit the coast region from Davis
- Creek, about six miles south of Bear River, southerly to Spanish
- Flat, which is about 12 miles below the mouth of Mattole River.
- Their center of distribution appears to have been the Valley of
- Mattole River, at whose mouth the four or five survivors still
- reside.
-
- They say that before the Whites came they numbered between 300
- and 500 persons.
-
- Their southern boundary, Spanish Flat, is the northern
- boundary of the Shelter Cove tribe, which reached thence southerly
- to or beyond Bear Harbor. The Matt[=o]l´ say that the Shelter Cove
- language is materially different from their own, and different also
- from that of the Briceland Tribe, and that the Briceland language
- is very hard to speak or understand. They declined to give the name
- of either of these tribes.
-
- The eastern boundary of the Matt[=o]l´ I was unable to locate
- exactly. They gave it as along or near the west base of Elk
- Mountain Ridge, including the Valley of Upper North Fork Mattole
- River. At the same time they gave the names of two 'tribes' or
- bands as inhabiting the Rainbow Ridge and Elk Ridge region. The
- Elk Ridge tribe they call S[)a]-bahng-kahng, the Rainbow Ridge
- people S[)e]-tso´-ik (from S[)e]-tso-[=e]k, Rainbow Peak). There is
- uncertainty as to the relations and geographic locations of these
- bands.
-
- The tribe inhabiting the coast at Needle Rock they call
- E´-l[)e]-tung. It is the same as the Shelter Cove tribe.
-
-
-TRIBELETS
-
-According to Merriam's data, the people at Cooskie Creek in the southern
-part of Mattole territory form a distinct band. This agrees with
-Goddard's village data, and Goddard also assigns to this group some
-of the villages on the upper Mattole. There is no evidence of further
-subdivision.
-
-
-VILLAGES
-
-Most of the information on villages of the Mattole is taken from
-Goddard's notes. (See map 14.). In addition, there are a few data
-recorded by Merriam. Below, Goddard's information is indicated by (G),
-Merriam's by (M).
-
- 1. sitc[=i]b[=i]' (named from sand bar?) (G). On the S side of
- Domingo Cr. nearly a mile from the surf. The county road leaves the
- coast at this point. Plenty of signs of occupation but no definite
- pits.
-
- 2. sesnoik[=o]', "rocks stand up creek" (G). About 1/2 mi. E
- of the line of the surf, close to the hill through which the stream
- in McNutt Gulch comes from the SE. A large quantity of cooking
- stones and shells have been exposed by the blowing away of the
- soil. Salmon run in the creek.
-
- 3. sesn[=o]t, "rocks stand up" (G). N of a large rock which
- is 30 or 50 ft. higher than the surrounding sand. Another large
- rock stands 300 yds. W, with a chain of rocks and ledge running
- out into the surf. Many shells and stones mark the village site.
- This village stood in the middle of a 2-mi. stretch of sandy beach,
- which reaches from gotxenin to a mile N of this village.
-
- 4. sedjildaxdiñ (G). Close up under the hill. The wind has
- carried away the soil, leaving a great pile of shells. Just S, a
- stream comes down the hillside with only a gulch [La Rue Gulch], no
- valley.
-
- 5. gotxenin (G). Known to white people as Mussel Rancheria. On
- a bench with Peter B. Gulch at the southern end and La Rue Gulch in
- the middle. A great quantity of shells were to be seen but no pits.
- Joe said the houses were scattered along for nearly a mile. Many
- rocks are in the surf.
-
- 6. ne'bitt'a, "earth fold" (G). On a bench 1/2 mi. long in a
- cove a mile N of the mouth of Mattole R. There is a creek at the S
- end, a small gulch in the middle, and a larger one at the N end.
- These probably furnished water in winter. Joe said the houses were
- scattered along the whole length of the bench. [It is likely that
- this is part of no. 5.] Between 500 and 800 yds. from the shore is
- a large flat rock (tciyatcise) occupied by sea lions. The Indians
- used to swim to it and club the sea lions to death. They kept a
- fire going near a rock on shore to warm themselves afterward.
-
- 7. seb[=i]ye (G). Perched on the steep mountainside just N of
- the mouth of the Mattole R. At the southern end two pits could be
- made out in the weeds. Slides had covered or taken away most of the
- evidences of occupation. The trail was evident and pieces of lumber
- were still lying about. The village was not burned, according to
- Joe. The burying place is 100 yds. N on a separate bench of the
- same mountainside.
-
- s[)a]-be´-ah (M). On the ocean beach 1 mi. N of the mouth of
- the Mattole.
-
- Goddard and Merriam do not give quite the same location for
- these villages but Merriam's description is vague and the names are
- evidently the same.
-
- [Illustration: Map 14. Villages and tribelets of the Mattole.]
-
- 8. beken[=o]'adiñ (G). This was 300 yds. S of the mouth of
- the Mattole R. and 100 yds E of the present surf line. There is an
- elevation of broken shells and other refuse on the sandy beach. Joe
- Duncan remembers seeing the village when it was inhabited.
-
- 9. lasaidûk (G). On the sand of the beach 1/3 mi. S of the
- mouth of Mattole R., the second village S of there. The wind has
- blown the sand and soil away exposing the shell fragments.
-
- 10. dzindiñ (G). By the mouth of a small stream 3/4 mi. S of
- the mouth of the Mattole R.
-
- 11. sastecdiñ (G). On a small bench N of a little stream a
- mile S of the mouth of the Mattole R. Fragments of shells were to
- be seen.
-
- 12. senalindiñ (G). About a mile and a half S of the mouth of
- the Mattole R.; on a small flat with a point of land S of it and a
- rocky bluff to the E. Broken shells are to be seen. There are now a
- hut and corral on this flat. The point S, a part of Punta Gorda, is
- called "Windy Point"; sevinnagintcidin is the Indian name.
-
- 13. kailistc[=i] (G). A flat of 3 or 4 ac. immediately N of
- the mouth of Four-mile Cr., about 2-1/2 mi. S of the mouth of the
- Mattole R.
-
- 14. saitc[=i]bi^{=e=} (G). On a bench on the coast S of a bold
- headland. A small stream here [Lion Gulch] has a large delta of
- gravel. This was the southernmost of the villages of the Mattole R.
- tribelet. A house and barn said to belong to John Mackey are on a
- higher bench.
-
- 15. bitc[=i]b[=i]' (G). On the N side of Cooskie Cr. (called
- k[=u]sk[=i]c by the Indians), 1/4 mi. from its mouth. Unlike
- most such streams, this one has something of a valley behind the
- bordering sea wall, through a gap in which it reaches the ocean.
- Salmon enter it. This was the northernmost village of the Cooskie
- tribelet.
-
- koos-ke (ko^{ch}kshe) (M). A very large band and village
- ("hundreds of people") formerly on Cooskie Cr. on or near the coast
- 2-1/2 mi. SE of Punta Gorda Lighthouse. Joe Duncan said these were
- the most warlike people of the region.
-
- 16. dec[=i] (G). On a large flat in a cove on the coast,
- immediately N of Spanish Flat. A row of shallow but evident pits
- are to be seen 200 yds. S of the northern end of the flat.
-
- 17. y[=i]nak[=i] (y[=i]natc[=i]) (G). On a flat, called
- Spanish Flat, 3/4 mi. long and 300 yds. wide between the ocean and
- the terrace. It has a creek at its southern end (Spanish Cr.),
- with a large deposit of gravel which has almost entirely buried a
- group of buildings. Plenty of evidence of Indian occupation but no
- decided pits. It is said to have been a very large village. The
- men of this village were killed by a band of white men who came
- down from the mouth of the Mattole R., which they had likewise
- occupied. An Indian ran down the coast to give warning but arrived
- too late. The women also were killed some years later.
-
- 18. seyetc[=i] (G). On a bench at the W end of a flat on the N
- side of the Mattole R. about a mile from its mouth.
-
- 19. sedanadaaib[=i]^{=e=} (G). On the E end of the same flat
- on which seyetc[=i] is situated. The site is now said to have been
- washed away.
-
- 20. daxdeginkatik (G). On a rocky timbered point which is an
- extension of the hills N of the Mattole R. This point is 25 ft.
- higher than the main flat, called nestik. Several indistinct pits
- are still to be seen. The Goff buildings are close by and occupy
- part of the village site. This flat was plowed for the Indians in
- 186..(?). There is water in a gulch W (Jim Goff Gulch).
-
- nes-te´-be (M). On the present Goff Ranch on a bench on the N
- side of the Mattole R., about 3 mi. upstream from the ocean.
-
- The names are different but the locations are identical, so
- these are no doubt the same village.
-
- 21. daaib[=i]^{=e=} (G). On the SW part of the large flat W of
- Petrolia, on the S side of the river. It was here that the Indians
- settled when they came back from the reservation.
-
- seb´-bin-ne bug´-gah-be (M). An acorn camp on the S side of
- the Mattole R. a little below the present Hanson place, 3 mi. from
- the mouth of the river.
-
- The locations for these two villages are the same but the
- descriptions are obviously different. It may be that this was
- an acorn camp in pre-white times and was subsequently used as a
- village site when the preferred land had been taken by the settlers.
-
- 22. bisyet'ob[=i]^{=e=}, "slide place" (G). On a point on the
- N side of the Mattole R. W of Petrolia, overlooking Wright's place.
- Buckeye and peppernut trees are growing there. It has fine exposure
- toward the S. There are pits still to be seen.
-
- 23. tcegiltcexb[=i]^{=e=} (G). On the E bank of the North
- Fork of the Mattole R.; the site is now included in the village of
- Petrolia. It is said to have been a large village.
-
- 24. s[=o]Lkaiye (G). On a large flat on the W side of the
- North Fork of the Mattole, E of the road to Ferndale. A white man's
- house, on a higher flat near the creek, has been burned. It was
- here the Indian village stood.
-
- 25. djetxeniñ (G). On the N side of the North Fork of the
- Mattole just W of a creek flowing into it from the N. It is at the
- western end of a long crooked canyon. Under a point were five very
- large distinct pits. There were evidences of occupation on the
- point above (the creek is called Wild Goose Cr.?).
-
- 26. djinsibbai, "elbow" (G). In the bed of the North Fork of
- McNutt Gulch. The inhabitants of sitc[=i]cb[=i] (no. 1) camped here
- in summer to hunt. Timber and brush.
-
- 27. djibbedaxtûkkab[=i]^{=e=} (G). On a point on the S side of
- North Fork of Mattole R. Opposite djetxeniñ. Joe saw people living
- here when he ran away from the white man who was taking him away
- for a slave.
-
- 28. natsinnadaat (G). At the junction of two streams which
- make up the North Fork of the Mattole (North Fork Mattole and East
- Branch, North Fork Mattole). The stream valleys are wide. The
- northern one (North Fork Mattole) is badly washed out, as is also
- the main valley of the combined streams. A group of ranch buildings
- belonging to Si Minor now occupies the village site, and Billy Wood
- once lived there. There was a pit on the W side of the stream from
- the N and two pits on the N side of the main stream 1/4 mi. below
- the junction.
-
- 29. sedjegûnk[=o][-l]diñ, "right angle" (?) (G). On a flat on
- the N side of the Mattole R. E of the bridge. It is now occupied by
- John Evarts.
-
- 30. djegaslinab[=i]^{=e=} (G). At the mouth of the creek
- flowing into the Mattole R. from the N, 3/4 mi. W of the county
- bridge SE of Petrolia (Conklin Cr.).
-
- 31. da[-l]oidiñ, "wild grape place" (?) (G). At the mouth of
- a creek (Indian Cr.) flowing into the Mattole R. from the SE at
- the northern end of a flat nearly a mile long. Saw what may have
- been pits, one on each side of the road by the duck pond near the
- buildings belonging to Cummings. This was the northernmost village
- of the Cooskie tribelet.
-
- 32. djan[=o]ldin (G). On a bench 1/8 mi. long and 200 yds.
- wide on the E side of Mattole R., which here flows N. It is at the
- ford.
-
- 33. saiq[=o]tLûndiñ (G). On a long flat bordering the eastern
- side of the Mattole R. Joe said the village was at the southern end
- of the flat, which is now owned by Lee Minor.
-
- 34. g[=o]danindjaib[=i] (G). Just E of the mouth of Squaw Cr.,
- a large stream flowing into the Mattole R. from the S. The regular
- inhabitants were joined by others, who camped here to gather acorns.
-
- 35. n[=o]willeneb[=i] (G). On a large flat on the E side of
- Mattole R. upstream from the mouth of Squaw Cr. Exact location of
- village uncertain. The name may be that of the section, not of the
- particular village.
-
- 36. g[=o]nsakke (G). A large flat through which the Mattole R.
- flows toward the NW. Roscoe lives on the N side. Exact location of
- the village is uncertain.
-
- 37. L[=o]itsiske (G). On a flat on the E side of the Mattole
- R. The river is here no distance from the road. "Joe got very angry
- when I wanted to look for pits."
-
- 38. [=i]kediñ, "foot place" (G). On the N side of a small
- stream flowing into the Mattole R. from the E, at the SE side of
- a flat. There are two deep pits and several, less deep, on the E
- side of the wagon road. A large group of buildings are on a higher
- flat SE. There is a large flat on the W side of the river also. The
- whites killed all of the inhabitants while they were fishing for
- eels.
-
- 39. [-l][=i]gûcLûndiñ, "snakes many place" (G). Probably on
- the W side of the river where there is a large flat around which
- the river flows, keeping near the high bank on the E. The road runs
- along the eastern side of the river and climbs a considerable grade
- at the N.
-
- 40. [-l][=o]n[=i]tc[=i], "middle of prairie" (G). On the S
- end of a flat on the E side of the Mattole R. Fifteen Indians were
- killed here by white people.
-
- 41. n[=o]wilkediñ (gacdûlyaidiñ, "like a necktie") (G). Said
- to be situated between the Upper North Fork and the Mattole R.
-
- 42. djegûllindiñ (G). On the W side of the stream coming into
- Mattole R. from the S close to the Humboldt Meridian (Honeydew
- Cr.). Indians may also have lived on the E side of this stream. The
- application of this name is uncertain.
-
-Goddard also gives the following summer camps of the Mattole, which I
-have not been able to locate.
-
- djindillegaxye. A flat on the S side of Mattole R., near its
- mouth.
-
- innaslaibi. A long level bench crossed by the county road N
- from Petrolia, 1-1/12 mi. from that place. Indians used to camp
- here to gather tarweeds. An Indian battleground.
-
- kuntcegilcannebi. Sec. 32, T. 1 S., R. 2 W. On the E side
- of the county road. The section lines given by Goddard are not
- reliable.
-
- sekexge. A sloping place on one of the branches of McNutt
- Gulch.
-
-_Upper Mattole villages._--The following village locations were given
-to Goddard in 1908 by the Sinkyone named Charlie. Goddard did not
-visit them so they cannot be accurately located. I am giving Goddard's
-township and range locations, but these were made by guess from an
-imperfect map, hence they must be used only with the greatest care.
-
- de'tci'. At the mouth of a big creek (de'kok) flowing into
- Mattole R. at Upper Mattole. Perhaps de'kok is Squaw Cr., mentioned
- in the Elk and Coyote stories. NW 1/4, sec. 30, T. 2 S., R. 1 W.
-
- ne'nûnyadûñ. On the E side of the river 3 mi. above de'tci'.
- There are two creeks there. This may be the village, and de'tci'
- the whole Upper Mattole flat. Notes say 3 mi. from Mattole, which
- is Charlie's name for Petrolia.
-
- k'atinta'. Above ne'nûnyadûñ on the Mattole R. at the mouth of
- kutsai'kok. NE 1/4, sec. 33, T. 2 S., R. 1 W.
-
- tcûlgûnnak'e'. Some distance above k'acinta' on Mattole R.
-
- tcintcûsk[=o]dûñ. On a hill on the E side of Mattole R.
-
- tcûst[=i]m[=i]'. On the W side of the Mattole R. on a big
- flat, S of tcintcûsk[=o]dûñ. No creek empties there.
-
- istannaladûñ. On a large flat on the Mattole R. No creek
- empties there.
-
- setûggûttc[=i]'. On the E side of the Mattole R. at the mouth
- of setuggukkok. Sec. 14, T. 3 S., R. 1 E.
-
- tceliñk[=i]'. On both sides of a small creek which enters
- a larger stream near the latter's junction from the E with the
- Mattole R. The valley of the river is wide at this point. A large
- group of buildings is now standing on this site. "I rode to this
- place in July, 1908, when hunting for Jack's place. The name was
- supplied by Charlie from my description." Sec. 31, T. 3 S., R. 2 E.
-
- Lenill[=i]mi', "flow together in." At the junction of two
- streams on the W side of the Mattole R. There were formerly many
- grizzlies there, and the Indians were afraid of them. This was the
- last village S of the Mattole R. Sec. 7. T. 4 S., R. 2 E.
-
-Merriam gives a number of other village names with rather vague
-locations. No doubt each of them corresponds to one of Goddard's, since
-both men used the same informant, but I have been unable to identify the
-villages either by location or name.
-
- tah-tah´-ke-ke. On a small flat on the S side of the Mattole
- R. about 1/4 mi. back from the ocean.
-
- tahn'-hr[=a]´-lah-be. At the mouth of the Mattole R. (on a
- lagoon near Indian Joe Duncan's place).
-
- yes-s[)a]-cheb´-be. On or near the site of an old barn S of
- the junction of the North Fork with the main Mattole R., near
- Petrolia.
-
- e-nah-sal-li´-be. On a flat on Mattole R., 1/2 or 3/4 mi. S of
- Petrolia.
-
- choo-wil^{ch}´-kah-be. On the North Fork of the Mattole R. at
- Petrolia. The name tek-ko-li-be is also given for a village on the
- site of present Petrolia.
-
-
-BEAR RIVER
-
-This small group, occupying the entire drainage of Bear River and the
-coast near its mouth, has been fairly well documented by ethnographers.
-Aside from linguistic material, our chief source, a paper by Nomland
-(1938), gives as complete an account as could be obtained at such a late
-date. Although some villages are noted by Goddard (1929), Nomland, and
-Merriam, they do not appear to have been recorded by any of the scholars
-in a systematic fashion. The village count therefore is probably not
-complete.
-
-The resources of the Bear River group are substantially the same as
-those of the Mattole, except that the salmon run is smaller.
-
-Merriam's information on the Bear River tribe is limited but it helps to
-augment the data now in print (Nomland, 1938; Goddard, 1929). Merriam's
-informant among these people was an old woman named Mrs. Prince. She
-came from Bear River, but at the time Merriam spoke to her (July and
-September, 1921) she was living at the Rohnerville Reservation. She used
-to visit her granddaughter, Ethel Hecker, at Scotia.
-
-Merriam gives the following brief note about these people.
-
- Nek´-an-ni´ ... Athapaskan coast tribe formerly inhabiting
- Cape Mendocino and adjacent region from Bear River Hills southward
- to Mattole River, and reaching inland (easterly) to the headwaters
- of the Bear River. [Nek´-an-ni´ was] their own name for themselves.
-
-
-TRIBELETS
-
-All evidence would seem to indicate that the Bear River people
-constitute a single tribelet as well as a single dialect group. Even the
-village on Oil Creek (village no. 7) was evidently in the same political
-division; Goddard (1929, p. 291) says: "There was, however, one village
-at the mouth of Van Duzen creek which was allied to Bear river both in
-its dialect and politically."
-
-
-VILLAGES
-
-Some villages are given by Merriam (M), Nomland (1938) (N), and Goddard
-(1929) (G), but most of the locations are not very certain.
-
- 1. chal-ko´-chah (M). Name of the village N of the mouth of
- Bear R., used for both the place and the village.
-
- tc'alko´ (N). Largest and most western village in the area. It
- included the flat at the mouth of Bear R.
-
- Goddard mentions two villages as being on the ocean N of the
- mouth of Bear R. -- [-l]'adAlk'AsdAñ and goldElco'dAñ. He gives the
- word tc'alko as the word for Bear R. In Nomland's personal copy
- of Goddard's paper (1929) she has written the word "tchankok" as
- the word for Bear R. She gives the following explanation of the
- discrepancy (1938, p. 92): "In checking words given by Goddard with
- my Bear River informant, Nora Coonskin, it developed that most
- of his information (gotten from Nora's uncle, Peter) was not in
- accordance with hers. Upon close questioning, the latter told me
- that her uncle preferred to speak Mattole. I checked Peter's words
- with Isaac Duncan, my Mattole informant, and found this to be true."
-
- 2. s[=a]-cho-tung (s[)e]-cho´-tah) (M). On the ocean on the S
- side of the mouth of Bear R.
-
- setcodAñ, "rock big" (G). By the lighthouse, a populous place.
- The present-day lighthouse stands about 2 mi. S of the mouth of
- Bear R.
-
- 3. chil-sh[)e]ck (N). On the site of the present town of
- Capetown.
-
- atcAnco'xEbi' (G). Said to have been where the store and hotel
- are at the town of Capetown.
-
- 4. chil-en-ch[)e] (N). Near the present Morrison Ranch.
-
- chul´-l[)o]-ko (M). This was the name of the village at
- Morrison's, 5 or 6 mi. above the mouth of Bear R.
-
- 5. sels-che'o-ch (N). About 3 or 4 mi. up the river from the
- Morrison place. The site is now marked by a large red rock. It may
- correspond to Goddard's sEtcixEbi, "rock stand in the water", which
- is not located.
-
- 6. seht-lá (N). About 7 mi. up Bear R. from Capetown.
-
- 7. ko-stah-che´ (k[=o]s-tah-che´) (M). Name of the camp on Oil
- Cr.
-
-Each author gives some additional villages, which cannot be located.
-
- esta-kana (N). On the largest flat in the upper valley, Gear's
- place.
-
- IstE=g=nadaibi', "madrone stands place" (G).
-
- klaht-el-k[=o]s´-tah (M). Name of the village near the head of
- Bear R. (at least 15 or 20 mi. upstream). It was a large town with
- a big dance house.
-
- [-l]'adAlk'AsdAñ (G). Where a schoolhouse stands on Bear R.
-
- tlanko (N). Above chil-sheck.
-
-
-ETHNOGRAPHIC NOTES
-
-At low tide in the spring the Bear River people waded out to lighthouse
-rock to gather the eggs of seabirds--gulls, shags, and others. They
-would climb up a sort of stairs in the steep rock, wrap the eggs in
-buckskin, and let them down with long ropes.
-
-The illustration (fig. 1, _c_) is of an old woman, about ninety years
-old, from Bear River, sketched in the fall of 1921.
-
-
-WHILKUT
-
-As stated earlier in the discussion of boundaries (p. 164) I have,
-following Merriam's data, assigned the Whilkut different territory than
-has heretofore been customary. In the present scheme they occupy the
-drainage of Mad River from the mouth of North Fork Mad River to the
-mouth of Bug Creek, the drainage of North Fork Mad River, and all the
-drainage of Redwood Creek above the lower ten miles. The subdivisions of
-the Whilkut are: Chilula Whilkut (Kroeber's Chilula) on lower Redwood
-Creek, Kloki Whilkut (part of Kroeber's Whilkut) on upper Redwood Creek,
-Mad River Whilkut (part of Kroeber's Whilkut) on Mad River above the
-mouth of North Fork, and North Fork Whilkut (part of Kroeber's Wiyot) in
-the drainage of North Fork Mad River.
-
-Goddard (1914_a_) and Merriam together give a fairly complete picture of
-the organization of villages and subgroups of the Whilkut but aside from
-this we have next to nothing in the way of ethnographic information.
-They were evidently closely akin to the Hupa in both language and
-culture. With the Hupa they form a dialect group as against the Tolowa
-on the north and the other California Athabascan groups on the south.
-
-The territory of the Whilkut lies in the dense redwood forest of the
-northern coast of California. Thus their economy was based primarily on
-the produce of rivers, and this fact is reflected in the placement of
-their villages.
-
-Merriam has left a relatively complete record of his visits to the group
-which I am calling Whilkut and which he called Hoil´-kut or How´-wil-kut
-and M[=a]´-we-n[)o]k. (Merriam uses various spellings.) His first visit
-to these people was in 1910. The following account is taken from his
-California Journals for September 15, 1910.
-
- Talked with several Indians at Blue Lake. The boundary between
- the Pah-te-waht [Wiyot] of Lower Mad River, and the 'Hoil´-kut or
- Ho-il-let-ha of Redwood Valley lies along North Fork of Mad River
- near its mouth, between Korbel and Blue Lake. The Pah-te-waht I saw
- today live on Mad River at Blue Lake (on south edge of town), while
- the Hoi-let'ha live on the extreme northeast beyond the town and
- cemetery.
-
-Merriam's second visit there was in 1918 and the following quotation is
-from the California Journals for August 11, 1918.
-
- Sunday, August 11, 1918 was foggy and misty in the forenoon;
- partly clear P.M. Took the early morning auto stage from Eureka
- to Korbel, but got off between Blue Lake and Korbel and went on
- an Indian hunt, landing back at Blue Lake without entering Korbel
- proper at all. Returned to Eureka in afternoon.
-
- Went particularly to get additional material from the Redwood
- Creek Indians ('How´-wil-kut´-ka or 'HWilkut tribe) who were living
- in this region when I was here in September 1910 (see Calif.
- Journals, Vol. 1, 90-93, Sept. 15, 1910). Tried to find O'Haniel
- Bailey and John Stevens of Redwood Creek, and Stevens' daughter
- Laura, from whom I got much information before. After a fruitless
- search over the old ground, learned that O'Haniel Bailey died
- several years ago; that John Steven is visiting in Hoopa Valley,
- and that his daughter Laura is married to a white man.
-
- But after a while I found two old men of the same tribe, who
- were born and raised at the Blue Lake rancheria 'Ko-tin´-net, the
- westernmost village of the H[)a]-whil´-kut-k[=a] tribe. They call
- themselves and their language by the same name, 'Ho-tin´-net [North
- Fork Whilkut]. One is blind and both are old. The blind man's name
- is Nelinjak; the other's Denbrook. They were eating breakfast of
- fried potatoes, dried fish, and coffee in their poor old shack.
- I got some good material from them and after some persuasion took
- their photographs.
-
- The blind one said he dreamed last night that a white man with
- a book was coming to see them.
-
- I got from them the names of some Pah-te-waht [Wiyot] villages
- on lower Mad River and about Arcata.
-
-Merriam's third visit to this group was in 1920. The following account
-is from his notes.
-
- About the middle of September, 1920, I visited the site of the
- old Hoilkut rancheria called T'chil-kahn´-ting (or T'ch-kahn´-ting)
- on the east side of Redwood Creek near the Berry ranch, about a
- quarter of a mile below the highway bridge on the road from Arcata
- to Willow Creek and Hoopa. It was then abandoned, the Indians
- having established another village on higher ground about a mile
- below, and like the old one, on the east side of the river.
-
- The old site is on an open sand and gravel bar or flat a
- little above high water mark and very near the river. The living
- houses were square--never round. The house excavations were
- about two feet deep. The excavation for the ceremonial house
- ("sweathouse") was sixteen or eighteen feet across and deeper than
- the others, averaging about three feet below the surface. The
- ground floor within was covered with large flattish pebbles. The
- building had fallen but I was told that it had a low gabled roof,
- with entrance toward the river (on the west side). Under the north
- end and still plainly visible was a ditch or flume to supply air
- and for a draft when starting the fire. The fireplace was in the
- middle.
-
- The graveyard is on the downstream end of the same flat.
-
- The flat is in a forest of Douglas spruce, black and white
- oaks, maples, tree alders, and dogwood, with a dense undergrowth
- of hazel, spirea (_Spirea douglasii_), syringa (_Philadelphus
- lewisii_), huckleberry (_Vaccinium ovatum_), and the wild lilac
- (_Ceanothus integerrimus_). The "three-leaf" or "deer-foot"
- also called "sweet after death" (_Achlys triphylla_) is common
- throughout the shady forest.
-
- In the immediate neighborhood the large gray tree squirrel
- (_Sciurus griseus_) was common, the big gray ground-squirrel
- (_Citellus beecheyi_) was abundant, and a few red squirrels and
- chipmunks were running about.
-
- Ruffed grouse, mountain quail, and many pigeons were seen;
- also crested jays, robins, and flickers.
-
- A few days later I visited the modern inhabited rancheria,
- nearly two miles below the bridge. It is on a rather steep slope
- about 500 feet above the river.
-
- Among the Indians present were two very old men, the Wilson
- brothers, and a half-breed named Ned Woodward from Blue Lake, and
- his wife, the former widow of Nathaniel Bailey--with all of whom I
- had worked in previous years. With their help I checked my former
- vocabularies and added many words.
-
- At Blue Lake during the latter part of October of the same
- year I found a number of Indians, mainly Hoilkut, and obtained
- additional material, including village names from Ned Woodward.
- Worked also with others, especially the Hoilkut Chief, Frank Lowry,
- and his wife. She is a full blood with the characteristic chin
- tattooing consisting of three broad vertical bars with a narrow one
- on each side between the middle and outer ones. [See fig. 1, _a_,
- _b_ for different styles.] A married daughter had three children, a
- tiny girl and two boys--one of three and the other five, both big
- for their age.
-
-Also of interest are Merriam's ideas about the position of the Whilkut
-groups. The following excerpt, taken from his notes, is dated 1939, but
-refers to a trip he made to Blue Lake in September, 1910.
-
- M[=a]´-we-n[)o]k [Mad River Whilkut] ... An Athapascan
- tribe on Mad River, reaching from the junction of North Fork
- with main Mad River near Korbel (where they came in contact with
- the Pah´-te´waht of Lower Mad River [a Wiyot subgroup] and the
- h'Whilkut of North Fork and Redwood Valley) upstream (southward)
- for many miles to the ranch of a white man named John Ahlgren,
- where their territory ended. This is on or near Bug Creek.
-
- It was told me by a h'Whilkut ('Hoilet´-hah) who stated
- further that the M[=a]´-we-n[)o]k spoke a language so similar to
- his own that he could understand most of their talk.
-
-The statement in the last paragraph comes from an informant Merriam had
-in Blue Lake in 1910. Merriam returned to the region in 1920 and at that
-time spoke to a member of the Mad River Whilkut group itself. Presumably
-the village list given for that group is derived from the second visit.
-
-Merriam discusses the other Whilkut groups as follows.
-
- The Hoil´-kut or Redwood Creek Indians (commonly called
- Chilula, Hwilkut, or Whilkut) were until recent years one of the
- dominant Athapaskan tribes of Humboldt County in northwestern
- California.
-
- Their territory consisted of the whole valley of Redwood Creek
- and the adjacent mountains from a point on the creek 10 or 12 miles
- above its mouth to Chaparral Mountain at the head of the creek, and
- included also the North Fork of Mad River and a short stretch on
- the north side of the main Mad River between Blue Lake and Korbel.
-
- Their proper tribal name as spoken by themselves is
- Hoi^{ch}-let´-kah or Ho-[=e]^{ch}-kut-k[)a], usually slurred
- to Hoil´-kut. They also call themselves Ho-[=e]^{ch}-kut
- kew-yahn´-ne-ahm, meaning Redwood Acorn eaters.
-
- There are three divisions or subtribes, more or less distinct
- according to the point of view: Upper Redwood, Lower Redwood, and
- Blue Lakes or North Fork Mad River Indians. In their own language
- they are:
-
- 1. The Ho-[=e]^{ch}-ke-e´-te (from Ho-[=e]^{ch}-kut,
- "Redwood", and e´-te, "north"), the Northern or Lower Redwood
- Indians [Chilula Whilkut], inhabiting the valleys and adjacent
- slopes of Redwood Creek from its mouth upstream about 12 miles to
- the Tom Blair Ranch at the junction of Minor Creek--a distance in
- an air line of about 17.5 miles. Goddard thought this division was
- the whole tribe and called it Chilula, adopting the term from the
- Hoopa, Polikla [Yurok], and Nererner [Coast Yurok] Indians, who
- however apply it in a wider sense to both upper and lower divisions
- of the Redwood Creek tribe.
-
- 2. The Ho-[=e]^{ch}-ki´-e-nok (from Ho-[=e]^{ch}-kut,
- "Redwood", and e´-nok, "south"), the Upper or Southern Redwoods
- [Kloki Whilkut], inhabiting the valley of Redwood Creek from Minor
- Creek (Tom Blair Ranch) up southerly to the head of the river, near
- Chaparral Mountain--a distance in an air line of nearly 20 miles.
- They also call themselves 'Klo-ke Ching´-ching-e´-nok, meaning
- "Prairie place south."
-
- 3. The 'Ho^{ch}-tin´-net (or 'Ko-tin´-net), the Blue Lake and
- North Fork Mad River Indians [North Fork Whilkut], inhabiting the
- valley of North Fork Mad River from its head to Korbel and Blue
- Lake, and separated from the other divisions by a continuous lofty
- ridge 2,000 to 4,000 feet in altitude. At Blue Lake they had a
- large village called Kaw-cho´-sish-tin-tang.
-
- South of the 'Ho^{ch}-tin´-net are the M[=a]´-we-nok [Mad
- R. Whilkut], a related Athapaskan tribe inhabiting the valley of
- Mad River from the junction of North Fork near Korbel, southerly
- (upstream) to the Algrehn Ranch on Bug Creek--a distance in a
- straight line of about 21 miles. The 'Ho^{ch}-tin´-net and the
- M[=a]´-we-nok say that their languages are so similar that either
- can understand most of the words of the other.
-
- The Hoilkut do not reach the coast, being separated from it by
- a long mountain ridge, on the west side of which dwell two tribes
- belonging to widely different linguistic stocks--the Nererner (the
- southwestern division of the Polikla or Yurok) and the Pahtewaht
- (the northern division of the Humboldt Bay Soolahteluk [Wiyot]).
-
- The Hoilkut say that the coast tribe they call Teswan (the
- Nererner) owned the land fronting the ocean from Orick at the mouth
- of Redwood Creek south to Trinidad and extending up Redwood Creek
- for ten or twelve miles; and that farther south the Pahtewaht
- of the coast and lower Mad River owned the country up to Blue
- Lake--possibly to the mouth of North Fork Mad River--all of which
- agrees with what I have been told by members of these tribes.
-
- The Hoilkut state that their lowermost (northernmost)
- villages, Ha-wung´-ah-kut and No-l[)e]´-tin, were ten or twelve
- miles up from the mouth of the river. Below these they claim no
- territory. Above, they had twenty-three permanent villages.
-
- The language is uniform throughout Redwood Creek Valley except
- for one or two slight differences of pronunciation. Thus the first
- syllable of the tribal name as spoken by the Upper Redwoods is
- Hoi´^{ch}; by the Lower Redwoods, Ho-[=e]^{ch}.
-
-
-VILLAGES
-
-Most of the village names in the lists following were recorded by
-Merriam or Loud; some Chilula and Kloki Whilkut data from Goddard's
-works are added.
-
-_Mad River Whilkut villages._--All the names in this list were recorded
-by either Merriam or Loud (1918), respectively designated by (M) and
-(L). (See map 16.)
-
- 1. ti-keo-tchun´-tin (M). Village on the site of present
- Riverside.
-
- mis-ken[=e]'huten, "bluff-?-place" (L).
-
- The names are quite different but the locations are identical.
- One of them may be in error.
-
- 2. djin[=a]kh[=o]e-ten (L). Name said to refer to a prairie.
-
- 3. tolkai'e-ten (L). Name said to refer to shining gravel.
-
- 4. dj'[=e]ndj[=e]e-ten, dj'[=e]ndj[=e]-whot (L). Name said to
- refer to a strong sweep of the wind at that place.
-
- 5. me´-kaw^{ch}-ting, me-ke´-aw^{ch}-ting (M). Village at Jim
- Anderson's place about 3 mi. S of Korbel.
-
- 6. [=a]rtes-slandj[=e][=o]lin-tin, "grasshopper-?-place" (L).
- Village at the mouth of Dry Cr.
-
- 7. ka-tahs-lah-ting, 'ke-ah-tahs-lah-ting (M). Village on the
- S side of Cañon Cr. (in air line about 3.5 mi. S of Korbel).
-
- who'nt[=a], "houses" (L). Village at the mouth of Cañon Cr.
-
- 8. whotsdj[=o]t[=a]che-tin (L). Name said to refer to a low
- prairie. The village is 3 or 4 mi. below Maple Cr., just below
- Foster Cr. There were three houses there.
-
- 9. ts[=a]´-te-tis´-ting (M). Camp on Mad R. at Fala ranch, 10
- or 12 mi. S of Korbel. It was a camp for catching eels.
-
- ts[=e]-didis-ten (L). Village about 2 mi. below Maple Cr.
- There were ten or more houses there.
-
- 10. til-chwah-hew'-a-kut, til-tchwa-h[)u]-ut (M). Village on
- Maple Cr. about 14 mi. (9 in air line) S of Korbel. Large village.
-
- tilch[=e]h[=u]ërkut, dilchërh[=u][=e]rkut (L). Village at the
- mouth of Maple Cr.
-
- 11. hotint[=e]lime (L). Village at the mouth of Black
- Cr. The name is said to refer to a prairie near by, known as
- hinukerchenditen.
-
- 12. yin[=a]lin[=o]whot (L). Village at the mouth of Boulder
- Cr. Merriam also lists a village at this place but he does not give
- its name or other information about it.
-
- 13. me´-m[)e]h (M). Village at Three Cabins on Mad R. about 3
- mi. above Maple Cr. On Tom Blair's Mad R. place.
-
- 14. Village near Mountain View, about 3.5 mi. S of Three
- Cabins.
-
- 15. tseng-nah´-neng-ahl´-ting, tseng-nah´-neng-ah-ten, "rocks
- across the river" (M). Large village at John Ahlgren's place on or
- near Bug Cr. [This may be the village site shown in pl. 10, _b_.]
-
- 16. ituke-n[=o]le´-tin, "up-waterfall-place" (L). Village on
- Foster Cr. The same name also given to a prairie half a mile up the
- creek from its mouth; ituk means "up," also "east."
-
-_Chilula Whilkut villages._--The information on the villages and camps
-of the Chilula Whilkut comes from Merriam's notes and from Goddard's
-published material (1914). It appears that Merriam made a systematic
-effort to check Goddard's material, thereby enhancing the value of their
-combined work. (See map 15.)
-
-[Illustration: Map 15. Villages of the Chilula Whilkut, North Fork
-Whilkut, and Kloki Whilkut (see also map 16).]
-
- 1. ho-wung´-ah-kut (M). In the Bald Hills N of Redwood Cr.
- Northernmost and lowest village.
-
- x[=o]wûnnakût (G). Village probably situated about a mile
- E of Redwood Cr. on a small flat S of a ridge along which the
- Trinidad trail used to run. A small creek a short distance S,
- entering Redwood Cr. from the E, would have furnished excellent
- salmon fishing. A depression resembling those characteristic of
- sweathouses was seen. Tom Hill's oldest brother used to live at
- this village, which was deserted many years ago, probably because
- of its nearness to the trail.
-
- 2. no-l[)e]h´-ting (M). Village on Redwood Cr. about 12 mi.
- from the coast. The name means "falls."
-
- n[=o]lediñ, "waterfall place" (G). This former large village
- remained occupied until 1888, when the Hill family left it and
- moved to Hoopa V. The site is at the foot of a long glade which
- slopes toward the creek nearly a half-mile distant. A spring N of
- the village site supplies water. In the edge of the timber, which
- approaches the village site within a few yards on the N, are two
- large redwood trees, hollow, with large openings toward the S. In
- these trees families used to spend the winter. During our visit in
- 1906 we spent a rainy afternoon in one of them in which a fire was
- maintained, the smoke escaping through the high opening in the side.
-
- The village derived its name and perhaps its existence from
- a hole, or waterfall, a short distance up the stream. The creek
- bed was formerly choked with huge boulders, causing a fall, which
- was jumped by the salmon with difficulty. The fishing for both
- salmon and lamprey eels, carried on with nets below the fall, was
- excellent. Since the village has been abandoned, several of these
- boulders have been displaced so a fall of only 3 ft. remains.
-
- 3. y[=i]tsinneakûttciñ, "down hill on" (G). Camp site W of
- n[=o]lediñ, about halfway up the ridge W of Redwood Cr. The Indians
- from n[=o]lediñ used to camp there to gather the acorns of the tan
- oak, which are plentiful among the redwood trees.
-
- 4. L[=o]tsx[=o]tdawillindiñ, "prairie water flows down place"
- (G). Summer camp about 1-1/2 mi. E of n[=o]lediñ and 1/2 mi. W of
- the crest of the ridge. A hollow redwood tree used to be used as a
- camping place.
-
- 5. tcitdeelyediñ, "dancing place" (G). Glade on a ridge
- running toward the E near a branch of Roach Cr., a tributary of the
- Klamath. This camp was pointed out from a distance and its exact
- location is therefore uncertain. The Indians used to go there from
- n[=o]lediñ in the summer to gather seeds and in the fall for acorns.
-
- 6. klo-tshim´-m[)e]y (M). Camp on Redwood Cr. 1 mi. above
- no-l[)e]h´-ting.
-
- L[=o]tcimme, "small glade in" (G). A former village about a
- mile upstream from n[=o]lediñ and 75 yds. E of Redwood Cr., where
- it stood in an opening of about an acre. Obscure depressions like
- house pits were seen on the N side of the glade near a stream
- which provided drinking-water. A weir for lamprey eels used to be
- built in Redwood Cr. near by.
-
- 7. ho^{ch}-tahn-ho-lah´-ting (M). On the E side of Redwood Cr.
- above klo-tshim´-m[)e]y. There is some doubt as to its location.
-
- 8. king-keo´-'hli (king-keo´-h[)e]-l[=a]) (M). Summer camp on
- top of the hill or ridge in Bald Hills about a mile E of Jonathan
- Lyon's ranch house.
-
- kiñky[=o]lai, "big timber point" (G). Large and important
- former village situated on the eastern end of a ridge above
- Jonathan Lyon's ranch house and about a mile E of it. There is
- timber on the northern slope of the ridge. At the edge of the
- timber is a spring which supplied the village with water. Besides
- the sweathouse site, seventeen house pits were counted. This
- village was the home of the Socktish family, many of whom are now
- living with the Hupa. The head of the family at the time of the
- coming of white people was a man of influence and a noted warrior.
- His name was KiLtcil, "crazy." His wife was a Hupa woman and
- perhaps for that reason the family moved to Hoopa V.
-
- 9. senalmatsdiñ, "stone round place" (G). Summer camp for
- gathering seeds in the glade on the S side of the main ridge E of
- kiñky[=o]lai.
-
- 10. tesaikut, "projects to water" (G). Camp ground frequented
- in the fall of the year for gathering tanoak acorns and hunting
- deer by the Indians living at n[=o]lediñ and kiñky[=o]lai. It is on
- the NE slope of the ridge W of Tully Cr.
-
- 11. king-y[)e]-ke´-ke-ah-mung´-ah (king´-ke-kaw´-mung´-ah)
- (M). Village on the E side of Redwood Cr. at the mouth of Coyote
- Cr. a little above ho^{ch}-tahn-ho-lah´-ting, and a little above
- Lyon's place.
-
- kiñyûkky[=o]mûña, "big timber near" (G). This site was not
- visited. It is said to be on the N side of Coyote Cr. below a large
- rock. There are said to be house pits there. Tom Hill said this
- was the village where the people who lived at kiñky[=o]lai spent
- the colder months of the winter. It is unlikely that two permanent
- villages were maintained by the same families. Perhaps the site of
- kiñky[=o]lai is the more recent and it was formerly only a summer
- camping place.
-
- 12. kitdiLwissakût, "fire drill on" (G). Camp used in the fall
- for gathering acorns and hunting. Situated near the corner of the
- Hoopa reservation in a glade sloping toward the S, near a spring.
-
- 13. new-wil-tso´-me-ah, "coyote camp" (M). Spring and summer
- camp on Bald Hills Ridge.
-
- n[=u]wils[=o]lm[=i]ye, "ground in billows under" (G).
- Summer camping ground near a cold spring at the head of one of
- the branches of Coyote Cr. The Indians used to come here from
- n[=o]lediñ.
-
- 14. ye-sin´-ning´-i-kut (e-tsin´-ning´-i-kut) (M).
-
- y[=i]sinniñ^{=e=} aikût, "down hill ridge runs on" (G). Site
- of a former village 1/2 mi. E of Redwood Cr. and about 500 ft.
- higher than the creek. It is S of the main ridge S of Coyote Cr.,
- at the western edge of a glade near a dry gulch. One pit was found.
- It is said that Tom Hill's father lived at this village and that it
- was not occupied at the time the white people came.
-
- 15. tsin´-tse-lah´-ting (M). Village below Stoffer's and below
- ho´-tach-ting.
-
- tsinsilladiñ, "bones lie place" (G). Former village not far
- from Redwood Cr. on a small flat where the ground shows signs of
- having slid. Little Henry's family are said to have lived at this
- village.
-
- 16. kittc[=u]namediñ, "its ear swimming place" (G). Summer
- camp on the W side of the main ridge, about 200 ft. below its
- junction with the E-W ridge N of Lacks Cr. There is a spring by a
- Douglas spruce which stands by itself.
-
- 17. t[=o]'n-t[)e]-nahn´-ting (t[=o]n-din-nun-ting) (M). Old
- village on the E side of Redwood Cr. Ned Woodward, who was born
- here, tells me the village was on a side hill at or very near
- Stoffer's.
-
- t[=o]ndinûndiñ, "water facing place" (G). Village site on the
- sloping hillside about 700 yds. E of Redwood Cr. and 400 yds. N of
- Lacks Cr. Seven house pits were found here. The guide, Dan Hill,
- did not know of these pits, but located a village of this name
- considerably nearer Redwood Cr. The Albers place, probably the
- first settlement in this region, is just S of this village, on a
- flat between Redwood Cr. and Lacks Cr.
-
- 18. tcwûñxaladiñ, "dung stands up place" (G). On the western
- side of the main ridge near its crest. There is a spring in a small
- flat.
-
- 19. ming´-kah´-te-k[)e]´ (mung-kut´-te-k[)e]) (M). At Fort
- Camp at the mouth of ho-tah´^{ch}-ting Cr. (Lacks Cr.), between
- Lyon's and Stoffer's.
-
- miñkûtdekeyimantcintciñ, "lake opposite side" (G). Summer
- camp among the redwood trees across the creek from Albers' place,
- opposite the mouth of Lacks Cr.
-
- 20. ho-tah´^{ch}-tin´-nek (ho´-nah^{ch}-tin-[)a]-k[)e] or
- ho-nah^{ch}-t[)e]-n[=a]´-k[)e]h), (M). Large village or summer
- camp right at Stoffer's on the ridge about a mile above (S of)
- t[=o]s-kahtch-ting (Cold Spring) and approximately midway between
- Bair's and Berry's. At Stoffer's, formerly Hooker's, there is
- a place called koo^{ch}-mit-tah^{ch} or kew^{ch}-mit-tah^{ch},
- meaning "between the alders," but it appears to be a place name
- only.
-
- 21. e-nok´-k[)a]-no´-mit-s[)a] (M). Former village on the
- Howard place.
-
- y[=i]nûkan[=o]mittsediñ, "south door place" (G). Former large
- and important village, often mentioned in myths and tales by both
- the Hupa and the Chilula. Pits were found on a flat near the creek
- about 1/8 mi. SW of the Howard ranch buildings. Other pits were
- said to have been obliterated near the middle of this flat.
-
- 22. tl[=o]^{ch}-t[=i]'k-hah-lah´-ting (M). Camp at an old
- schoolhouse 1 mi. S of e-nok´-k[)a]-no´-mit-s[)a].
-
- 23. h[=o]n-t[)e]^{chl}-m[)e]´ (M). Camp on the E side of
- Redwood Cr. above Lacks Cr.
-
- x[=o]nteLme, "flat in" (G). Former village situated on a large
- flat on the E side of Redwood Cr. The village is said to have stood
- where the farm buildings formerly belonging to Beaver are located.
- Because this flat had been cultivated a long time no pits were
- visible.
-
- 24. klo-ch[)e]-k[=a] (M). Village on the E side of Redwood Cr.
-
- L[=o]tceke (G). Village which stood midway in a flat on the E
- side of Redwood Cr. near the stream. House pits were seen on the W
- side of the wagon road.
-
- 25. klitch´-hoo-[)e]-nah´^{ch}-ting
- ('hlit-choo-[=a]-nah^{ch}-ten; sit-choo-[)e]-nah^{ch}-ting) (M).
- Former village about 3 mi. above Beaver's on the W side of Redwood
- Cr. above Lacks Cr.
-
- Littc[=u][w=]innau[w=]diñ, "dust flies place" (G). Site of a
- former village on a long flat on the W side of the creek. It is
- surrounded by timber, but receives the sun from the S. Little Henry
- was living on the E side of the creek at the time, and said it was
- his father's home.
-
- 26. ki´-loo^{ch}-tah^{ch}-ting (M). Camp on
- the E side of Redwood Cr. about 1 mi. or less S of
- klitch'-hoo-[)e]-nah´^{ch}-ting, but on the opposite bank.
-
- kail[=u][w=]ta'diñ, "willows among place" (G). Said to have
- been a large village on a small flat about 1/4 mi. S of the last
- mentioned village. There were indications of 3 or 4 house pits.
- Molasses' wife said there was once a round dance house in this
- village, probably the same type as in the Upper Redwood and Mad
- River country.
-
- 27. kuff-keo´-m[)e] (M). Camp on the W side of Redwood Cr.
- across from k[=i]'-loo^{ch}-tah^{ch}-ting.
-
- 28. kail[=u][w=]tceñeLdiñ, "willows project place" (G). Former
- village, which stood at the northern end of a long flat. Two plain
- house pits, one of them containing stone implements, were seen.
-
- 29. sik´-king´-choo-ma-tah´^{ch}-ting (M). Given as about 2
- mi. below Tom Bair's place on the E side of Redwood Cr. Merriam
- says he could not find anyone who knew of it.
-
- sikkiñtcwûñmitta'diñ (G). Village occupied in 1914. At the
- time of Goddard's visit, it was the home of Tom, a famous blind
- medicine man.
-
- 30. h[=o]s-t[)a]´-ch[)e]-m[)e] (M). Village or camp on the W
- side of Redwood Cr. about 2 mi. above k[=i]´-loo^{ch}-tah^{ch}-ting.
-
- 31. ke´-nah´-hung-tah´^{ch}-ting (M). Former big village on
- the E side of Redwood Cr. just below Minor Cr.
-
- kinnax[=o]nta'diñ, "Yurok village place" (G). Important former
- village on a flat bordering Redwood Cr. on the E, about 1/4 mi. N
- of Tom Bair's ranch house. Four shallow pits were found. A fight
- with the volunteer soldiers occurred at this village, in which one
- Indian was killed.
-
- 32. ke-tan-nah´-tah^{ch}-ting (M). Former village on the site
- of Tom Bair's place.
-
- 33. ho-un´-kut (M). Former village on the W side of Redwood
- Cr. about 1/2 mi. from ke-tan-nah´-tah^{ch}-ting but on the
- opposite side of the creek. The name is nearly the same as that of
- the lowermost village of the tribelet.
-
- 34. tah^{ch}-ch[=a]-nahl´-ting (M). Large village on the E
- side of Redwood Cr. just below Tom Bair's, near the big barn and
- sheep corral.
-
- 35. tahs-ung´-ch[=a]-kut (tah^{ch}-sahn-che-ting) (M). Former
- village about 200 yds. above tah^{ch}-ch[=a]-nahl´-ting on the E
- side of the creek.
-
-There are also a number of villages for which the locations are
-uncertain. The following names are from Merriam's notes, and the
-villages are situated on or near the Bald Hills Ridge between villages 9
-and 16.
-
- tahnch-wing-es-hon-ting.
-
- kahtch-wahn-to-ting. Summer camp.
-
- ke-wah´-ahn-tis-ting. Camp on the ridge at the line fence
- between Lyon's and Stoffer's ranches.
-
- tos-kahtch´-ting. Camp on the ridge at Cold Spring 1/2 mi.
- above ke-wah´-ahn-tis-ting.
-
- tah^{ch}mah-no-ah´-ting. Summer camp on Bald Hills Ridge.
-
-One more village is given by both Merriam and Goddard, transcribed
-dah´-sun´-chah-kut by the former and dasûntcakût by the latter. They
-both say that it was supposed to have been near village no. 31. Goddard
-thinks that it was a separate name for a part of village 31 "as is
-customary in this region."
-
-_Kloki Whilkut villages._--Most of the information on this group
-comes from Merriam's notes. Goddard's account of the Chilula Indians
-of Northeastern California (1914_a_) goes only as far as the first
-two villages, which he maintains are part of the Lower Redwood group.
-Merriam claims they belong to the Upper Redwood group. I have accepted
-Merriam's version and these groups are rearranged on the basis of his
-information. Goddard's Chilula Texts (1914_b_) mentions a few villages
-of this group but no locations are given, so they have not been
-included. (See maps 15 and 16.)
-
- 36. mis´-m[)e]h (M). Former village on the E side of Redwood
- Cr. 1-1/2 mi. below kah´-kus-tah^{ch}-ting.
-
- misme, "slide in" (G). Former village situated near the creek
- on the E side. Many Indians were killed here by the white people.
- Perhaps that is why this village was not mentioned by some of the
- informants.
-
- 37. kah´-kus-tah^{ch}-ting (M). Former village on Redwood Cr.
- at the junction of Sweathouse Cr., whose name it bears. About 2 mi.
- below Berry Bridge.
-
- kaxûsta'diñ, "Philadelphus among place" (G). Former village of
- importance on a flat of about 2 ac., near the creek level on the E
- side. Four house pits were found on the N side of the flat and four
- others in a row about midway of the flat. Two other pits, one of
- them near the creek, were probably sweathouses. The flat is called
- "Sweathouse Flat" by white people. This village is considered by
- the Hupa the last of the villages of the x[=o]ilkûty[=i]dexoi,
- or Chilula. It was the last toward the S from which Indians were
- allowed to witness the Hupa dances. The Chilula also seem to accept
- this as their boundary.
-
- 38. t'chil-kahn´-ting (t'ch^{[-l]}-kahn´-ting;
- chis-kahn´-ting) (M). Village on the E side of Redwood Cr. just
- under the Berry ranch and about 1/4 mi. below the old covered
- bridge near Berry's. The village is now moved to a higher point on
- the high slope 1/2 mi. farther S.
-
- 39. e-nuk´-k[)a]-cheng´-tish-ting (M). Former village where
- the Berry ranch house now stands, on the high ground E of Redwood
- Cr. Bridge.
-
- 40. es-tish´-chem´-m[)e]h (M). Former village on the E side of
- Redwood Cr. about 4 mi. above Berry Bridge.
-
- 41. tsin´-tes-'ki´-m[)e]h (M). Village on the E side of
- Redwood Cr. a little below mes-t[)a]-tim´-teng.
-
- 42. mes-t[)a]-tim´-teng (M). Former village on the E side of
- Redwood Cr. above es-tish´-chem´-m[)e]h.
-
- 43. tah-nah´-nah-kut (M). Village on the E side back from the
- creek and above mes-t[)a]-tim´-teng.
-
- 44. chim-mah´-non´-ah-kut (M). Former village on the E side of
- Redwood Cr. at Bonny Cragan's ranch.
-
- 45. ni´-is-'kwahl´-l[)a]-kut (M). Former village at the head
- of Redwood Cr. The last and southernmost village of the group. A
- view of the territory here is shown in pl. 10, _d_.
-
-Merriam lists for this group five other villages, which could not be
-located. Presumably they are in correct sequence between village no. 44
-and village no. 45.
-
- ts[=a]´-nah-ti´-[)a]-kut. Village on the E side of Redwood Cr.
- far up, near Chaparral Mt.
-
- 'klesh-mah´-kut. Former village on the ridge on the E side of
- Redwood Cr.
-
- m[=a]´-m[=a]-[)a]-kut. Former big village on m[=a]´-ma-kut
- creek.
-
- 'klew-taw-m[)e]-ting. Former village on the E side of Redwood
- Cr.
-
- nahs-kah´-nah-kut. Former village high up on Redwood Cr.
-
-_North Fork villages._--The information on this group comes from
-Merriam's notes (M) and from Loud (1918) (L). (See map 15.)
-
-[Illustration: Map 16. Villages of the Mad River Whilkut, the South Fork
-Hupa, and Kloki Whilkut. (See also maps 15 and 17).]
-
- 46. klokeche (L).
-
- 47. kaw-cho'-sish-tin-tang (M). Large village at Blue L.
-
- 48. me-k[=a]´-t[)a]-met (M). Village on North Fork Mad R.
- between Korbel and Riverside (nearer Riverside).
-
- mik[=e]time (L). Name said to refer to being behind North Fork
- of Mad R.
-
- 49. k[=a]-tsi'-[)a]-too (M). Camp just below Big Rock at
- Korbel.
-
- 50. hoo-tso'-e-choo'-kah (M). Village (or camp) on the site of
- the present store at Korbel.
-
- 51. ki'loo-whit´-teng (M). Fishing camp on North Fork Mad R.
- 1/4 or 1/2 mi. above Korbel (where gum trees are, just below picnic
- ground).
-
- 52. kis-t[=a]'-[)a]-kut (M). Camp for winter fishing on North
- Fork Mad R. at Korbel picnic ground (Camp Bar) about 1 mi. above
- Korbel.
-
- gestAkAt (L). Name said to refer to a deep fishing hole.
-
- 53. noo-l[)e]h´-m[)e]h (M). Fishing camp at falls about 1/2
- mi. above Korbel picnic ground. Only one kind of salmon can get up
- these falls.
-
- 54. ts[=e]-in[=a]t[=u]lwo-ten (L). tse, "sticks," which were
- left there after a prayer.
-
- 55. khaiyame (L). Name said to refer to an eddy at the base of
- a waterfall.
-
-
-ETHNOGRAPHIC NOTES
-
-The following note is taken verbatim from the Merriam files.
-
- The Nose Stick: The Redwood Hoi-let'-hah tell me that their
- tribe never perforated the nose during life, but when a person died
- they charred a piece of poison oak to make it strong, and sharpened
- it and bored a hole with it through the septum of the dead person's
- nose and then put handsome Dentalium shell money in the hole before
- burying the person.
-
- The Tol-lo-wah of Crescent City and Karok of Upper Klamath
- River (Orleans Bar to Happy Camp) were the only Indians the
- Redwoods knew who dared wear the nose shell when alive--the other
- tribes were afraid to do so.
-
-
-HUPA
-
-The Hupa are the best known of the California Athabascan groups. They
-live in the drainage area of the Trinity River from a short distance
-above its mouth to a little above the mouth of South Fork Trinity and in
-the drainage area of the South Fork Trinity up to the mouth of Grouse
-Creek (pl. 10, _a_).
-
-There have been a number of papers published on a variety of aspects
-of Hupa life but the main sources of general ethnography are Goddard's
-paper (1903_a_) and Kroeber's Hupa section in the Handbook (1925_a_,
-pp. 128-137). The Hupa are the same, in many ways, as the Yurok, so the
-sizable literature on that group is also useful.
-
-The territory occupied by the Hupa differs in several respects from
-that of the other Athabascan tribes. The elevation of their lands is
-everywhere over 2,000 feet and in places rises to 4,000 or 5,000 feet.
-Because of the elevation there is a good deal of snow in the mountains
-surrounding the valley and this fact may have somewhat isolated the Hupa
-from their Athabascan neighbors during the winter months, although it is
-known that they were in close contact with some of the Whilkut.
-
-The fish resources of the Hupa territory also constituted an important
-distinction. The Trinity is the only river in the Athabascan area in
-which there is both a spring and a fall run of salmon. This resource
-must have been very important to the Hupa. It is significant that in the
-many intensive studies of the Hupa there is no report of any summer camp
-away from the river. The Hupa were evidently even more firmly attached
-to their riverine environment than were the other Athabascans, and this
-fact may well have been due to the double salmon run.
-
-Merriam's estimate of the position of the Hupa, given below, is taken
-verbatim from his notes.
-
- _The Tin´-nung-hen-n[=a]´-o or Hoopah._--The Hoopah proper,
- who call themselves not Hoopah but Tin´-nung-hen-n[=a]´-o, occupy
- the lower part of Trinity River and tributary streams from the
- mouth of South Fork Trinity northerly to Bull Creek--a distance of
- about 20 miles. On the west they extend to the summit of the long
- high mountain range known as The Bald Hills (altitude 4,000 ft.),
- which separates their territory from that of the Redwood Creek
- tribe, the 'Hwilkut [Chilula]. On the east they reach to the lofty
- mountain ridge culminating in Trinity Summit (altitude 6,500 ft.),
- the northern part of which separates the drainage area of Mill
- Creek from that of Redcap Creek; the southern part, the waters of
- Horse-Linto and Cedar creeks from those of the westerly branches of
- New River.
-
- Their territory, therefore, is difficult of access, being
- protected in all directions by ranges of mountains or deep canyons,
- while its western border is about 20 miles from the coast, easterly
- from Trinidad. The entire region, except the beautiful Hoopa
- Valley, 6 miles in length and a mile or two in breadth, where most
- of the villages are located, is mountainous and most of it densely
- forested. There are one or two small open stretches on other parts
- of Trinity River, and a few grassy slopes on some of the ridges;
- elsewhere the forest is continuous.
-
- The Tin´-nung-hen-n[=a]´-o are in contact with five tribes
- belonging to three linguistic stocks, namely: the Po-lik´-lah
- (often called "Yurok") on the north; the Kar´ok on the northeast;
- the Athapaskan E´-tahk-n[)a]-lin´-n[)a]-kah on the east [I have
- not been able to identify this group. According to Merriam's
- map and according to his own testimony (Merriam, 1930) the Hupa
- are bordered on the east by the Shastan Tlo-hom-tah-hoi; the
- Athapaskan Ts´[)a]-nung-wh[)a] [Southern Hupa] on the south, and
- the Athapaskan 'Hwilkut [Chilula] on the west.]
-
- _The Ts´[)a]-nung-wh[)a]._--(An Athapaskan tribe closely
- related to the Hoopah.) The territory of the Ts´[)a]-nung-wh[)a]
- lies directly south of the Tin´-nung-hen-n[=a]´-o or Hoopah proper,
- embracing the drainage basin of South Fork Trinity River from
- Grouse Creek to the junction of South Fork with the main Trinity,
- and including also the rather narrow strip between South Fork
- on the west and the main Trinity on the east as far up as Cedar
- Flat. At the mouth of South Fork they crossed the main Trinity
- and claimed a narrow strip two or three miles in length on the
- north side of the canyon where two of their villages were located,
- Ti´-koo-et-sil´-lah-kut on the high bench opposite the mouth of
- South Fork, and Me´-m[)e]h, on the site of the present Fountain
- Ranch about 1-1/2 miles east of the other. Their western boundary
- was the divide between the tributaries of South Fork Trinity and
- those of Redwood Creek (a little west of the courses of Madden
- Creek and Mosquito Creek). The eastern boundary was the deep canyon
- of Trinity River from the mouth of South Fork to Cedar Flat; the
- southern boundary, Grouse Creek and a line running from its mouth
- northeasterly and following Mill Creek to the main Trinity at Cedar
- Flat--thus including the Burnt Ranch country.
-
- The land of the Ts´[)a]-nung-wh[)a] is mountainous and
- forested, and the principal streams flow in deep canyons. It is
- roughly circular in outline, and of small extent, measuring in
- an air line hardly 15 miles in either direction--north-south or
- east-west. Nevertheless it seems to have been rather well populated
- for there were at least a dozen villages--all situated on high
- benches overlooking the canyons.
-
- Their language differs only slightly from that of the Hoopah.
-
- The Tsa-nung-wha were in contact with four tribes:
- the Tin´-nung-hen-n[=a]´-o or Hoopah on the north,
- E´-tahk-n[)a]-lin´-n[)a]-kah [Tlo-hom-tah-hoi] and Che-ma-re´-ko
- [Chimariko] on the northeast, the Che-ma-re´-ko on the east and
- south, the 'Hwi´l-kut [Chilula] on the west.
-
-The following account of Merriam's first visit to the Hoopa Indian
-Reservation is taken from his California Journal, Vol. 2, September 5,
-1898.
-
- The present Hoopa Valley Indian Reservation Agency is built
- around a hollow square, formerly old Fort Gaston. In order to reach
- the agency we had to ford Trinity River, here more than a hundred
- feet broad, the agency being on the west or coast side. Purchased a
- number of sahah baskets.
-
- The night before coming down into Hoopah Valley we camped on
- Trinity Mountain where we found a colony of _Aplodontia_ [Mountain
- beaver], the Hoopah name of which is Nea't-saas.
-
- The range west of Hoopah Valley between Supply Creek canyon
- and Redwood Creek is 3,400 feet in altitude; in other words, 3,000
- feet above Hoopah Valley. This range is covered with a rather dense
- forest mainly of Douglas Fir, more or less mixed on the warmer
- slope with Ponderosa and Sugar Pines and Black, White, and Live
- Oaks, among which Madrones, Chinquapins, and Cedars occur.
-
- On the slope east of Hoopah Valley the splendid _Rhododendron
- californicum_ occurs. Here also two species of _Cornus_,
- _nuttalli_ and the black-berried _sessilis_, were seen, and in a
- gulch nearby we found the rather rare Lawson Cypress. On this range
- at an altitude of 3,250 feet is a stone pile around a post said to
- mark the west boundary of Hoopah Reservation.
-
- On this same range the coast Plume Fern is common and
- the ground over a considerable area is carpeted with delicate
- _Vancouveria hexandra_.
-
- At Redwood Creek we saw the beautiful ringed tail of a
- _Bassariscus_, which animal is said to be common here.
-
- The Redwood (_Sequoia sempervirens_) common along the coast
- pushes up Redwood River to a point about two miles below the Bair
- ranch. The man at the ranch, W. F. Boyce, told me that during
- the previous year he had trapped in the region 32 Black Bear, 21
- Coyotes, numerous Wildcats, 3 Panthers, and one Badger, besides
- killing any number of deer. Other mammals said to occur here in
- addition to Deer are Gray Fox, Otter, Fisher, Marten, Mink, big
- and little Skunks (_Mephitis_ and _Spilogale_) in addition to the
- Ring-tail _Bassariscus_, here called kil-how'^{ch}.
-
- One of the commonest trees in Redwood Valley is the Tan Oak
- (_Lithocarpus densiflora_), the bark of which is used for tanning.
- Madrones also are common, many of them four feet or more in
- diameter.
-
- The rare Cypress (_Chamaecyparis lawsoniana_) also occurs here
- but Douglas Fir is not only the dominant tree but grows to large
- size, thousands of them reaching diameters of five to seven feet.
-
-
-VILLAGES
-
-Although the information on Hupa villages comes from extremely diverse
-sources, there appears to be fair agreement among them. The basic
-material comes from Goddard (1903), and this is for the most part
-confirmed by Merriam and Curtis (1924, Vol. 13). In fact, Curtis' data
-coincide so closely with Goddard's that they may have been derived from
-Goddard's report. However, a few of Curtis' facts do not appear in
-Goddard's work so we are probably justified in considering them primary.
-
-Besides these sources, there is a list of village names by Powers (1877)
-and also a manuscript map prepared by Gibbs in 1852, reproduced here as
-pl. 9; the original is in the Bureau of American Ethnology. Although
-this map is not particularly accurate and although the village names are
-given in Yurok rather than in Hupa, it still has special value since the
-number of houses is given for each village and we therefore have a check
-on the data presented by Goddard.
-
-In the following lists the sources are thus indicated: Merriam (M),
-Goddard (G), and Curtis, 1924, Vol. 13, (C).
-
-_Natinuwhe Villages (map 17)_
-
- 1. hon-sah-tung (M). Former village on the E bank of the
- Trinity R. at the N end of Hoopa V.
-
- xonsadiñ (G), "deep water place." Near the beginning of the
- canyon on the right bank at the N end of the valley.
-
- honsading, "deep pool place" (C). On the E bank of the Trinity
- R. at the N end of Hoopa V.
-
- Powers (1877) gives hun-sa-tung and Gibbs gives okenope,
- corresponding to oknutl, the Yurok name. Gibbs says there were 9
- houses in the village while Goddard shows 11 houses.
-
- [Illustration: Map 17. Villages of the Hupa and South Fork
- Hupa (see also map 16).]
-
- 2. dakisxankût (G). On the opposite side of the Trinity R.
- from xonsadiñ at the base of Bald Hill was a village, the site of
- which is now entirely grown up to trees and brush. Goddard shows 7
- houses here.
-
- takyishankut (C). On the W bank, opposite honsading.
-
- 3. kin-choo-whu-kut (M). On the E side of the Trinity near the
- N end of Hoopa V. and just below the mouth of Mill Cr.
-
- kintc[=u]whwikût, "on a nose" (G). This village occupies a
- point of land on the E bank just below the mouth of Mill Cr. Eight
- houses are shown at this village.
-
- kinchuwhikut, "its nose upon" (C). On the E bank just below
- the mouth of Mill Cr.
-
- The Yurok name for this village is merpernertl (Kroeber, 1925).
-
- 4. cha-en-ta-ko-ting, "flopped out" (M). Former village on the
- W bank of the Trinity R. a little above Socktish Cr.
-
- tceindeqotdiñ, "place where he was dug up" (G). This village
- was a short distance below meskût. Its name refers to a well-known
- myth (see Goddard, 1904). Goddard shows 12 houses at this village.
-
- cheindekhoting (C), "dug out place." On the W bank between
- miskut and the mouth of Socktish Cr.
-
- Powers (1877) gives the name chan-ta-ko-da for this village
- and its Yurok name is said to be kererwer (Kroeber, 1925).
-
- 5. mis-kut (M). On the E side below Hostler Cr.
-
- meskût (G). This village was on the E side of the river and
- about a mile below takimiLdiñ. It "shows signs of once having been
- occupied by many houses." Nine of them are shown.
-
- miskut, "bluff upon" (C). On the E bank on a bluff midway
- between Mill Cr. and Hostler Cr.
-
- Powers (1877) gives mis-kut as the name of this village and
- Gibbs gives eh-grertsh, corresponding to the Yurok ergerits, and
- says that there were 6 houses here.
-
- 6. tah-kah-mil-ting (M). The head village of the tribe,
- situated on the E bank of the Trinity a little above Hostler Cr.
- Contained a large ceremonial house.
-
- takimiLdiñ, "place of the acorn feast" (G). A short distance
- below Tsewenaldin on the E bank. It is known as the Hostler Ranch.
- This is the religious center for the whole valley. Here there
- still stand the xonta nikyao, "house big," and the taikuw nakyao,
- "sweathouse big." These are said to have been built by the people
- of long ago and to have sheltered the first dwellers in the valley;
- but inasmuch as they were burned by a party of Yurok in the early
- part of the last century, the statement is to be interpreted
- as applying to the foundations only. At this village were held
- the acorn feast and two of the important dances, and it was the
- starting-point for the third (cf. Goldschmidt and Driver, 1940).
- Goddard shows 14 houses in this village.
-
- takimilding, "cook-acorns place" (C). On the E bank a short
- distance above Hostler Cr. At the beginning of the acorn season the
- people of this village would gather a small quantity of nuts and
- prepare a feast of mush and salmon, which all the Hupa attended.
- The remnants of the feast were cast into the fire and the cooking
- stones were added to the accumulated heap of previous years. This
- is the present residence of the northern division of the Hupa,
- known as Hostler Ranch, and the ceremonial feast is still observed.
- A fishing weir was built in a long riffle near here.
-
- Powers (1877) gives hos-ler as the name of this village and
- Gibbs gives ople-goh, corresponding to Yurok oplego (Kroeber,
- 1925), and says that there are 20 houses here.
-
- 7. tsa-wun-al-mit-tung (M). Former village on the E side of
- the Trinity in the middle of the valley.
-
- tseweñaldiñ (G). This was a large settlement on the E bank
- about a mile below toLtsasdin. It is translated by English tongues
- into Senalton. There are many traces of houses here, but the people
- were all killed or scattered in the troubled times of the 'sixties.
- Six houses are shown here.
-
- tsewenalding, "rock inverted place" (C). This was on the E
- bank about 1/4 mi. above takimilding. The locality is now known as
- the Senalton Ranch.
-
- Gibbs gives the name olle-potl for this village, corresponding
- to the Yurok olepotl (Kroeber, 1925) and says there were 10 houses.
-
-_Tinuheneu Villages (map 17)_
-
- 8. tol-skots-a-tung (M). Former village on the W side of the
- Trinity S of the mouth of Supply Cr.
-
- t[=o]Ltsasdiñ (G). There are evidences of this village on
- the left bank a little S of the mouth of Supply Cr. It has long
- been deserted. A prison camp was maintained near this site by the
- military.
-
- toltsasding (C). At the N side of the mouth of Supply Cr. It
- was inhabited until about the time of the military occupancy.
-
- The Yurok name for this village is erlern (Kroeber, 1925).
-
- 9. ma-til-le-tung (M). In the upper part of Hoopa V. on the E
- side of the Trinity, 2 mi. from the S end of the valley. It was the
- largest village but not the head village, tah-ka-mil-ting being the
- head town, ma-til-le-tung was the big boat ranch of the Hupa and
- was named for ma-til, dugout canoe.
-
- medildiñ, "place of boats" (G). Just below xowûñkût the river
- swings back to the W, meets a spur of the mountain, and then
- swings back to the E, forming a peninsula. Here, cut off from the
- rest of the valley, is medildiñ (Matilton Ranch). This village,
- with those to the S, forms the southern division of the Hupa
- people. This division manifests itself especially in religious
- matters.
-
- medilding, "canoe place" (C). On the E bank of the Trinity R.
- about midway between Supply Cr. and Campbell Cr. It is the present
- settlement of the southern division and is known as the Matilton
- Ranch. The southern division fish weir is built in the river near
- here.
-
- mi-til-ti is the name attributed to this village by Powers
- (1877) and Gibbs gives the name kahtetl, which is its Yurok name
- (Kroeber, 1925). Gibbs says it had 28 houses whereas Goddard shows
- 22.
-
- 10. ho-wung-kut (M). A village of the southern division, S of
- ma-til-le-tung and 1 mi. from the S end of the valley on the W bank
- of the river.
-
- xowûñkût (G). About a mile downstream from Tish-Tang-A-Tang
- Cr. on the W bank of the river. Goddard shows 14 houses at this
- village. The site is now called Kentuck Ranch.
-
- howungkut (C). On the W bank about 1 mi. below Campbell Cr.
-
- This place is locally known as Kentuck Ranch. This appears to
- be the village called wang-kat by Powers (1877). Its Yurok name is
- pia'getl (Kroeber, 1925).
-
- 11. tish-tahng-ah-tung (M). On the E bank of the Trinity R. at
- the S end of Hoopa V. proper.
-
- djictañadiñ (G). At the S end of the valley where the river
- emerges from the canyon is a point of land on the E side. This
- village, known locally as tish-tang-a-tang, was situated on this
- point. Just above this village Tish-Tang-A-Tang Cr. from the
- mountains on the E empties into the Trinity.
-
- djishtangading, "promontory place" (C). On the E bank opposite
- Campbell Cr.
-
- Powers (1877) calls this village Tish-tan-a-tan. According to
- Merriam's notes the Yurok name for it is Peht-sau-an and this is
- the name Gibbs uses for it. Gibbs says there are 9 houses here,
- whereas Goddard shows 13.
-
- 12. 'has-lin-ting (M). On the E bank of lower Trinity R. 3 mi.
- above Hoopa V. proper. This is the uppermost village classed as
- Hupa.
-
- xaslindiñ (G). About 3 mi. S of the valley proper on the E
- bank of the river at the mouth of a creek of the same name (Horse
- Linto Cr.). Nine houses are shown at this village.
-
- haslinding, "waterfall place" (C). On the E bank about 3 mi.
- above djishtangading and the same distance beyond the limits of the
- valley. The name is preserved in Horse Linto Cr.
-
- Powers (1877) calls this village hass-lin-tung. According to
- Kroeber (1925, p. 129), the Yurok name for this village is yati but
- Waterman (1920, p. 188) gives wo'xtoi. This last would correspond
- to Gibbs's wauch-ta, which is shown with an approximately correct
- location except that it is on the wrong side of the river. This
- village is said to have had six houses.
-
- 13. seh-ach-pe-ya (Gibbs' map, pl. 9). This is no doubt a
- Yurok name, as are all those given by Gibbs, but no one else has
- recorded it. There are said to have been four houses here.
-
- 14. wang-ulle-watl (Gibbs' map, pl. 9). Again this is probably
- a Yurok name. There are said to have been three houses.
-
- 15. wang-ulle-wutle-kauh (Gibbs' map, pl. 9). This is probably
- a Yurok name. There is said to have been one house here. Kauh is a
- Yurok suffix meaning "opposite."
-
-Gibbs also gives a town called weitspek on the W side of the Trinity
-just below the mouth of South Fork. There are said to have been three
-houses here. Merriam asked about this village and its existence was
-denied by his informants.
-
-_South Fork Hupa Villages (maps 16, 17)_
-
- 16. hlah-tung (M). On both sides of the mouth of South Fork
- Trinity on high bench ground.
-
- 17. til-tswetch-a-ki (M). On the W side of South Fork at the
- mouth of Madden Cr. An old important town. About a mile below
- chil^{ch}-tal-tung.
-
- 18. chil^{ch}-tal-tung (M). On the E side of South Fork 1-1/2
- mi. above its mouth.
-
- 19. os-tahn-tung (M). On the E side of South Fork 2-1/2 mi.
- above its mouth.
-
- 20. 'hlit-choo^{ch}-tung (M). On the E side of South Fork 5 or
- 6 mi. above its mouth.
-
- 21. klo-kum-me (M). On the E side of South Fork about 8 mi.
- above its mouth (two above 'hlit-choo^{ch}-tung).
-
- 22. tah-choo^{ch}-tung (M). On the E side of South Fork about
- 10 or 12 mi. above its mouth.
-
- 23. ti-koo-et-sil-la-kut (M). On the N side of the main
- Trinity on a bench opposite the mouth of South Fork, about 1-1/2
- mi. below Fountain Ranch.
-
- 24. me-meh; me-a-meh (M). On the N side of the main Trinity on
- the site of the present Fountain Ranch about 1-1/2 mi. above the
- mouth of South Fork but on the opposite side of the river.
-
- 25. hoi-ti sah-ahn-me (M). At Hennessy Ranch, Burnt Ranch
- (Post Office in 1921).
-
- 26. e-nuk-kut-te-nan-tung (M). At McDonnell Ranch, Burnt
- Ranch. Name means "south slope place."
-
- 27. tin-noo^{ch}-tung (M). At Cedar Flat. Easternmost village
- of the tribe, near or adjoining the territory of the Chimariko.
-
-
-ETHNOGRAPHIC NOTES
-
-The following ethnographic data are taken verbatim from Merriam's notes.
-
- According to the Hoopah, as told me by James Chesbro of Burnt
- Ranch, the First People are called Kit-tung´-whi or Devil People.
- They used to fight and kill and eat one another. Later they turned
- into animals. After the Flood real (Indian) people came.
-
- In early days the Indians used to get drunk from inhaling
- the fumes of Indian tobacco (Min´-t[=a] itch´-wah) which by deep
- breathing they would take into the lungs. Their word for drunk is
- Ho-n[=a]^{ch}-w[)i]h^{ch}. The expression for "many people drunk"
- is Yah, ho-n[=a]^{ch}-w[)e]^{ch}.
-
- The word for an old person is Kis´-te-ahn; for an old object,
- Tah´-ne.
-
- There are two words for good: Chung-whoom for a good or kind
- person; and Noo-wh[=o]m for a good thing or object. A bad person is
- To choong-k[=o]m, "not good person"; while a thing that is not good
- is To noo^{ch}-k[=o]m, "not good thing."
-
- Chin-tahs, "slow", is said to mean also "heavy"; but the word
- given me for heavy is Nit-tahs´.
-
- The word Ho´-chit, meaning real or genuine, occurs frequently:
- Thus, deerskin tanned with the hair on is called Ho´-chit te,
- te being any blanket or toga. Similarly, the ordinary woman's
- apron made of pine nuts and braided grass is Ho´-che ke´-ah; the
- woman's hat, H[=o]-che k[=o]s´-tahn, or real hat; moccasins, Hoch
- y[=a]´-che-tahl; the bow, H[=o]-ch[)e] tsitch-ting; the stone
- arrow-point, H[=o]-ch[)e] tin-ti; Indian or wild tobacco, H[=o]-che
- Min´-t[=a]-itch´-wah; the elkhorn box or purse for valuables
- H[=o]´-che kin´-chah.
-
- The Hoopah say that their people did not use the nose-bone or
- nose-stick, but had a name for it, which is Hun-choo whang-i. They
- say these were worn by the Indians farther north.
-
- The women tattooed the chin, usually in three broad vertical
- bands similar to those of the Klamath River tribes. Tattoo marks
- are called Wil´-tahch´.
-
- Place names: All place names along the rivers were at one time
- the sites of villages or rancherias. The village always takes the
- name of the place.
-
- The name for house is H[=o]n´-tah or Hun´-tow; the ceremonial
- house, M[=a]´-min sin-til; the sweathouse, Tah´-'keo; the menstrual
- lodge, Mintch'; the brush wickiup, M[=a]´-nah-si; the brush blind
- or hut for concealing the hunter Kew´-wong wil´-min.
-
- They say that they never burned the dead, but buried them
- in graves dug exactly knee-deep by measure. The grave was called
- Hot-yung ho-sin. The body was fastened to a slab of wood of the
- proper length, and when laid in the grave was covered with the
- belongings of the dead person and then with earth.
-
- While they do not burn the bodies, they burn clothing and
- other belongings. But the Chemareko of Hyampom burn their dead.
-
- They believed in an evil spirit or Devil called Kit-tung´ hwoi.
-
- A peculiar custom was practised in extending a certain
- courtesy to an enemy who wanted to cross the river but had no boat.
- If a person having a canoe crossed the river, and his personal
- enemy found the canoe, he would go and sit down near it and await
- the return of the owner. When the owner came, he would back out
- into the stream and then push the bow ashore at the nearest point
- to his enemy, and the enemy would step in and sit down, neither
- speaking a word. The owner would then paddle across the stream to
- his own side, and the enemy would jump out and proceed without
- remark.
-
- There were two kinds of doctors: the real doctor or shaman,
- sometimes known as "dance doctor," called Kit-ta tow, and the
- medicine doctor, who never danced, called Kim-mow-chil^{ch}-weh.
-
- Gambling Game: the common gambling game, Ke-now-we, was
- played with a bunch of slender sticks 7 or 8 inches long, called
- Hol-che-king. One of these, Hung ("ace" or "lucky stick"), has a
- black band around the middle. The game consists in guessing in
- which hand the opponent holds the marked stick. There are eleven
- points or guesses. One stick is given up at each wrong guess.
-
- Small hailstones are called Klew-hahn min-nah from Klew-hahn,
- "an eel," and min-nah, "eyes," from the resemblance of small
- hailstones to the white eyes of the eel. Big hailstones are
- Ke´-lo-ung-hot.
-
- An earthquake is Nin mah-ah tin-n[)i]^{ch}-chwit, meaning
- "turns over on edge of world."
-
- Money: The unit of value, which we call "money," consisted
- of the valuable kind of dentalium shells, long specimens of which
- reached from the base of the finger to the base of the terminal
- joint. This was called Ho´-che naht-te-ow or "real money." Small or
- broken dentalium shells, from half an inch to an inch in length,
- were called Mit-tatch, and were used for beads.
-
- Scalps of the great pileated woodpecker or cock-of-the-woods
- (_Ceophlaeus pileatus_), called Kis^{l}-t[=a]-ke-'keo, also passed
- as money.
-
- _Names of mammals and birds._--The Grizzly Bear had two names:
- M[)e]-ch[=a]-e-sahn and Me-kwo ah.
-
- The Mountain Lion or Cougar is called Min´-ning m[)i]^{ch}
- 'hl[=a]-til-loo, meaning "kills with his face."
-
- They speak of a spotted Panther of large size called Kit-sah´,
- which has not been seen for a number of years. It used to make a
- great noise.
-
- They speak also of a Water Panther (mythical) called
- Ho-tsi´-tow, said to live in holes close to the water of lakes and
- pools, never in rivers or on land. Its head and shoulders were
- heavy and covered with long shaggy hair, but the hinder parts were
- nearly naked.
-
- The Otter is called 'Kl[=o]k-e-te-til-le, meaning "he likes
- salmon."
-
- The Weasel--and this is particularly interesting--is called
- Klew^{ch}-m[)u]-hung, meaning "snake's husband"--a term doubtless
- suggested by its snake-like form and actions.
-
- The Mole is called Min-ni´ [)e]-ting, meaning "eyeless"; the
- Bat Haht-la nah-mut, "night flyer."
-
- The Porcupine is 'K'yo. Its quills, usually dyed yellow, were
- used to ornament basket hats; and also to pierce the ears for
- earrings. When a quill was stuck lightly into the lobe of the ear,
- it would slowly work its way through.
-
- The common gray Ground Squirrel (_Citellus beecheyi_) is
- called Ts[)e] 'ket-yahng-a, meaning "rock sitting on."
-
- The Jack Rabbit, oddly enough, is called Nah^{ch}-ah-tah
- 'hits-'hlah-hahn, meaning "dry ground deer."
-
- _A Hupa ceremonial gray fox skin._--The skin was _cased_
- (opened along the hind legs, the belly not slit lengthwise). The
- front feet had been cut off but the skin of each leg was slit in
- six or seven strands or narrow ribbons about three inches long.
-
- The skin had been turned inside out and decorated in places;
- then turned and left with fur outside. The skin of the hind legs
- was painted deep red. The tail also had been slit open on the
- underside and the skin painted with the same red paint, and a tuft
- of pure white feathers four inches long was sewed to its tip.
-
- The most surprising marking was a double ring or belt band of
- red and blue painted around the inside of the skin about two inches
- above the base of the tail (and therefore hidden when the skin was
- fur-side out). The two bands, each about half an inch wide, were in
- actual contact all the way around--the anterior one deep red, the
- posterior deep blue.
-
- The skin itself is of interest as being unmistakably the dark
- northwest form of the species _Urocyon cinereoargenteus_. The upper
- parts are very dark grizzled; the dorsal stripe from neck to tip of
- tail is almost pure black and the tail is about an inch broad. The
- flanks, inner-sides of legs, and undersides of tail are fulvous,
- palest on the belly. The specimen is an adult male.
-
- _Sayings about birds._--Dove (_Zenaidura_). Called Mi-yo.
- Mi-yo, the Dove, was a great gambler. He always gambled all winter.
- Once when gambling someone told him that his grandmother was dead.
- He said there would be plenty of time to cry next summer. So he
- kept on playing. When summer came he cried for his grandmother. And
- every summer we hear him crying for his grandmother.
-
- Hummingbird. Called Ko-sos. Ko-sos, the Hummingbird, was a
- war bird. His bill was like a long needle. With it he pierced his
- enemies. Once he told another bird to start from one end of the
- world and he would start from the other. They did this and met in
- the middle where they danced.
-
- _Notes on adjacent tribes._--Yin´-nah´-chin ("South People,"
- Chemar´eko). Extended from Hyampom northerly to Cedar Flat,
- easterly along main Trinity to Canyon Creek; and northerly between
- the high mountains that form the divide between French Creek and
- North Fork Trinity River on the west to Canyon Creek on the east,
- as far north as Rattlesnake Creek. (Previously learned from the
- Nor´-rel-muk of Hay Fork, a Wintoon Tribe, that the dividing line
- on the west between themselves and the Chemareko, called by them
- Hyembos, lay along Minor Creek.) Language wholly different from
- Hoopah. The Hoopah say that the presence of this tribe on Trinity
- River west of Cedar Bar, and on lower New River, is a comparatively
- recent intrusion.
-
- Klo´-m[)e]-tah´-wha ... Salmon River Indians. Ranges south
- over summit to Grizzly Creek and headwaters New River. Language
- wholly different.
-
- Ho-ning wil-tatch (meaning "tattooed faces") ... "Yuke" of
- Covelo region. Round Valley. Also called Devils, Kit-tung-whoi--a
- name applied to the First People, who finally turned into animals.
- Language wholly different.
-
- _Geography._--There used to be a great fall in Trinity River
- at a huge rock which stood in the middle of the river at Burnt
- Ranch. Below the fall was a big pool and eddy, which at the proper
- season was full of salmon. Everybody came here to catch salmon.
-
- Indians from several tribes met here and feasted and had a
- "big time." Finally a terrible earth slide came down the side of
- the canyon and moved the rock away. This destroyed the falls.
-
- This occurred during the boyhood of my informant. He tells
- me that besides the Hoopah the Indians who used to visit the pool
- below the falls for salmon were Poliklah from Wetchpek on Klamath
- River, 'Hwilkut from Redwood Creek, and Chemareko from Hyampom.
- They used to camp a little below the falls.
-
-_Hoopa Geographic Names_
-
- Hoopa V. Nah-tin-noo
- Main Trinity R. Hahn
- Trinity R. "up and down" Hahn-nuk-ki
- Bull Cr. Mis-tes-se ah-tung
- ("sliding place")
- Mill Cr. Mis-kut e-ta-e-tuk ne-lin-na-kah
- (correct name) and Tsol-tsah muk-kah
- (nickname from rock with female
- mark)
- Socktish Cr. Chan-ta-kot ne-lin-na-kah
- Hostler Cr. Tsa-mit-tah ("between two rocks")
- Site of present settlement Toos-kahts-tung-kah
- in Hoopa V.
- Campbell Cr. Tish-tah-ah-tung mu-mahn-chung
- ne-lin-nuk-kah
- Tish Tang A Tang Cr. Tish-tahn-ah-tung ne-lin-nuk-kah
- Horse Linto Cr. Hahs-lin-nak-kak
- Raccoon Cr. Se^{ch}-ki-uk-kah ("white rock")
- Willow Cr. Ho-whah-chal-tung
- South Fork Trinity 'Hlal-tung (at junction with main
- Trinity)
- South Fork Trinity Ye-sin-ching-ki (whole river)
- Madden Cr. Tilch-wetch uk-kah
- New R. Ye-tok ne-lin-nuk-kah
- Forks of New R. Tsa-nah-ning-ah-tung
- Ironside Mt. (east of New Tsen-nen-kut
- R. mouth)
- High Rocky Ridge (northwest Ta-se-tahn-ne-kut
- of New R. mouth)
- Trinity Summit Ridge Mung-kin-ne-kow-a-kut
- Berry Summit Ho-e^{ch}-kut mit-ta-kahn
- Redwood Cr. Ho-e^{ch}-kut ne-lin-nu-kah
-
-
-
-
-POPULATION
-
-
-SOURCES
-
-The earliest serious effort to estimate the aboriginal population of
-California was made by Powers (1877, pp. 415-416), who arrived at a
-figure of 750,000 persons for the entire state. This effort was followed
-in 1905 by a more sophisticated attempt on the part of C. Hart Merriam,
-whose figure for the state was 260,000 persons. Merriam's figures were
-based on an estimate of the population of the mission strip, from
-Spanish data, and a gross extrapolation from that to the remainder of
-the state.
-
-The first attempt at population estimates in detail and with the use of
-a variety of data was made by Kroeber (1925). The figure he got for the
-whole state was 133,000 persons, and he still used that figure, although
-with some reservations, as late as 1939 (see Kroeber, 1939, pp. 178-179).
-
-The problem has recently been reopened by S. F. Cook. In 1943 he
-published an evaluation of Kroeber's estimates, based on essentially
-the same data, and the result was to increase the estimate by about
-10 per cent. In the last two years Cook has begun a more intensive
-investigation, the results thus far being new estimates for the San
-Joaquin Valley (1955) and for the Northern California coast (1956). The
-upshot of these last papers has been to double Kroeber's estimates in
-the areas under consideration. The basis of the new estimate suggested
-by Cook is a more intensive use of historical sources and readier
-acceptance of the observations found there. He says, "Evidence of
-misstatement should be looked for and, if found, should be discounted or
-discredited. Otherwise it should be admitted at face value."
-
-Kroeber has recognized the discrepancy between his estimates and those
-based on historical statements. He agrees that, if the extrapolations
-from the latter are accepted, the Merriam figure of 260,000 persons
-would probably be more accurate. The difficulty there is that "if
-we accept 260,000, one-quarter of all United States Indians were in
-California; and this seems unlikely enough. Shall we then assume that
-Mooney and practically all American anthropologists computed far too
-low?" (1939, p. 179). Kroeber leaves the question unanswered but Cook's
-recent work carries the implication that the answer is decidedly
-affirmative.
-
-The estimate in this paper of the population of the California
-Athabascans agrees with Cook's results, raising Kroeber's estimates;
-in fact, it goes even further than Cook in that direction. But the
-estimates here, with one exception, have been based on village counts
-by ethnographers rather than on historical data. The fact that the
-estimates run so high tends to bear out Cook's contention that the
-Kroeber estimates should be raised.
-
-In basing population estimates on village counts there are several
-sources of error. Among these are assumptions regarding the number of
-persons per house and the number of houses per village. I believe that
-all the assumptions I have made in this regard have been conservative
-and therefore would not result in overestimates. The number of houses
-per village can sometimes be calculated rather closely from the number
-of house pits seen in the sites. That is, the houses can be calculated
-closely if the assumption is correct that four-fifths of the number of
-house pits in a site represents the number of simultaneously occupied
-houses. Admittedly, this figure is rather speculative, but the best
-opinions I have been able to get grant that it is probably conservative.
-
-A more serious possible source of error concerns the question of which
-and how many sites were simultaneously occupied. When there is a
-complete village count, I have excluded from consideration known summer
-villages, villages not on main salmon streams, and other villages of
-doubtful status. Even so, the villages run about one per mile along the
-salmon streams and the possibility presents itself of movement from site
-to site, perhaps in response to varying fishing conditions. If this was
-the practice, then the population estimates might have to be reduced by
-half or even more. But there is no concrete evidence to support such a
-theory and it is a fact that the Goddard material gives quite complete
-information of this kind. Therefore, if the present calculation is an
-overestimate, it is not a very great one.
-
-
-ESTIMATES BASED ON VILLAGE COUNTS
-
-_Wailaki (Eel and North Fork)._--The present list gives a total of 67
-villages among the Eel River and North Fork Wailaki. For purposes of
-calculating population I have excluded 13 of them (nos. 6, 9, 16, 31,
-38, 40, 51, 57, 58, 59, 61, 66, 67) because they are summer camps in
-the hills, rock shelters used only briefly, or specialized fish-drying
-camps. These places do not seem to have been used simultaneously with
-the main villages. This list appears to be a substantially complete
-count from Horseshoe Bend south, but it is clear that neither Merriam
-nor Goddard visited the area north of this, and the village count
-suffers as a result. There are about 16 river-miles south of Horseshoe
-Bend, including both the main Eel and North Fork, and there are 49 main
-villages on this stretch, yielding an average of 3.1 per river-mile. If
-we apply this figure to the 7 river-miles above Horseshoe Bend, we get
-21.7 villages for that stretch rather than 5, as given by ethnographers.
-We may reduce this figure to 15, because this stretch of the river
-appears to offer a less desirable location (Goddard, 1923_a_, p. 107).
-
-This calculation gives a total of 69 villages for the entire group,
-considerably less than Cook's total of 87 (Cook, 1956, p. 104). The
-reason for the difference is that Cook bases his estimate on Goddard's
-data, with the territory of the Wailaki extending above Kekawaka Creek,
-whereas I have taken Kekawaka Creek as the boundary.
-
-The house count per site for this group must be extrapolated from
-Goddard's house-pit counts (1923_a_, pp. 103, 105) on the sites of
-two of the tribelets. This figure has been calculated by Cook, who
-takes Goddard's house-pit count for 20 sites as "92 pits." For two
-localities, however, Goddard specifies a certain number plus "several"
-others. "If we allow 4 to represent 'several,' in each of these, then
-the total number of pits is 100 and the average per site or village
-is 5.0" (Cook, 1956, p. 104). Cook then reduces the figure by 20 per
-cent to allow for the probability that not all the house pits represent
-simultaneously occupied houses. His average number of houses per site is
-4, which would not appear to be an overestimate. If we take this figure,
-we have a total of 276 houses for the Wailaki as against Cook's figure
-of 348, which was based on a greater area.
-
-Cook takes 6 persons per house as the average density for the Wailaki.
-This figure is arrived at in several ways. The figure of 7.5 per house
-is well established for the Yurok and sets an upper limit for the
-Wailaki area. Goddard appears to have based his population estimate on
-a mean of 4.5 persons per house, almost certainly too low, and Cook
-compromised at 6 per house. This figure is supported by independent
-observation by Foster on the Round Valley Yuki (Cook, 1956, p. 107). The
-social organization and the habitat of the Yuki and Wailaki are nearly
-identical, so the population per house should be the same for both
-groups.
-
-Accepting the figure of 6 persons per house, we get a total population
-of 1,656 for the Eel Wailaki and the North Fork Wailaki, as compared
-with Cook's figure of 2,315 and Goddard's figure of between one and two
-thousand.
-
-_Pitch Wailaki._--Goddard (1924) records 33 villages for the Pitch
-Wailaki. For two of the four tribelets, the count is virtually complete.
-For a third tribelet, the T'odannañkiyahañ, Goddard lists 6 villages and
-indicates that there were probably more (1924, p. 225). If, to allow for
-these possible villages, we add 5 to the total above, we get a total of
-38 villages for three tribelets, or an average of 12.7 per tribelet.
-Although the fourth tribelet, the Tchokotkiyahañ, had a poorer habitat
-than the other three (Goddard, 1924, p. 222), we may assume that it had
-at least 8 villages, an estimate which is probably conservative in view
-of its extensive territory. We then get a total of 46 villages for the
-Pitch Wailaki.
-
-Goddard counted house pits in 22 village sites and got an average of
-5 per site. If we reduce this to 4 to account for unoccupied pits, we
-have an estimate of 184 houses for the Pitch Wailaki, as against 172
-estimated by Cook. On the basis of 6 persons per house this gives a
-population of 1,104 as against 1,032 by Cook and between 650 and 800 by
-Goddard.
-
-For all Wailaki combined we get a total of 2,760. Cook's figure
-is 3,350, Kroeber's is 1,000, and Goddard's is between 1,650 and
-2,800--average of 2,225. The difference between the figure presented
-here and Cook's figure is mostly due to the adjustment I have made in
-the Wailaki boundary from the one used by Goddard.
-
-_Mattole._--The village lists of Merriam and Goddard give a total of 42
-villages for the Mattole. I have excluded 5 of these from calculation of
-population estimates, one because it is a summer camp and four others
-because the frequency appears too great, in places along the coast, to
-make simultaneous occupation likely. This leaves a total of 37, very
-likely a conservative estimate since Goddard gives a number of names of
-villages not located and therefore not included in our calculations.
-
-Cook estimates 6 houses per village for the Mattole on the basis of
-comparison with the Wiyot, Yurok, Tolowa, and Chilula. Goddard counted
-house pits for a few sites of the Mattole and they appear to average
-less than that. Not much reliance can be placed on this average, because
-the sample was very small. However, the number of houses per site is
-probably not as high as among the Yurok. I have compromised with a
-figure of 5.4, the same as the estimate for the Sinkyone, the eastern
-neighbors of the Mattole.
-
-Cook takes Kroeber's Yurok figure of 7.5 persons per house in
-calculating Mattole population. The social organization here is more
-nearly like that of the southern Athabascans, so I have used 6 per
-house. This figure gives a total population of 1,200 as against 840
-figured by Cook for the Mattole exclusive of Bear River. The difference
-here is due to the fact that Goddard's village lists were not available
-to Cook. If they had been, he would have obtained a figure of 1,665, or
-nearly double his actual estimate.
-
-_Lolangkok Sinkyone._--For the Sinkyone on the northern part of the
-South Fork of the Eel we have a nearly complete village count. South of
-Larabee Creek Goddard and Merriam give a total of 46 villages. North
-of Larabee Creek on the main Eel the village count is incomplete, but
-Merriam gives 8 place names. That these place names represent village
-names is clear from the Merriam place names farther south which can
-be checked against Goddard's data. Together, these give a total of 54
-villages but leave out the areas of Bull Creek and the upper Mattole
-River. We may assume 5 villages in each of these, surely a conservative
-estimate in view of the density of sites on Salmon Creek and South Fork.
-We thus have an estimate of 64 villages for the Northern Sinkyone.
-
-Goddard counted house pits in 24 of the sites he recorded. They come to
-a total of 162 or 6.7 per village. If we reduce this by 20 per cent to
-account for unoccupied pits, we get an average of 5.4 houses per site
-or a total estimate of 346 houses among the Lolangkok Sinkyone. At 6
-persons per house this estimate yields a total population of 2,076.
-
-_Hupa._--In the present village list there are 11 villages in Hoopa
-Valley and 16 above the valley on the main Trinity and on South Fork. Of
-these sixteen, three have been rejected as being in Chimariko territory
-(nos. 25, 26, 27). Cook has argued, reasonably, it appears, that the
-villages in Hoopa Valley average 11 houses, whereas the villages above
-the valley average 4.5 houses each. This average gives a total of 193
-houses for the Hupa.
-
-Cook has estimated that there is an average of 10 persons per house
-among the Hupa. This figure is arrived at by the following line of
-reasoning: according to a census taken in 1870 there was a total of 601
-persons in 7 villages at that time, of which 232 were male and 359 were
-female. This count indicates a disproportionate number of males and
-Cook therefore calculates a population of twice the number of females,
-or 718, as a more normal population. Goddard's data give the number of
-houses for these villages as 92, a figure Cook takes as representing the
-situation in 1850. This combination yields an average of 7.8 persons
-per house. Since there had certainly been a decline in population
-between 1850 and 1870, Cook proposes that the figure for the density of
-population be raised to 10 persons per house.
-
-But Goddard does not say what period his figures represent, so I
-propose to follow a line of reasoning similar to that of Cook but to
-use different figures. The number of houses for 6 villages in 1851 is
-reported by Gibbs (see map, pl. 9). We may compare these to the 1870
-population estimates as given by Kroeber (1925_a_, p. 131). If we
-adjust for male attrition by calculating population as twice the female
-population, or 640 (see table 1), we get a density per house of 7.8,
-exactly the same figure that Cook gets.
-
-
-TABLE 1
-
-_Hupa Population, 1870[1]_
-
- ===============================================
- | | |
- Village | Males | Females | Houses
- _______________|_________|___________|_________
- |
- Honsading | 25 30 9
- Miskut | 32 49 6
- Takimitlding | 51 74 20
- Tsewenalding | 14 31 10
- Medilding | 75 100 28
- Djishtangading | 14 36 9
- |_______________________________
- |
- Total | 211 320 82
- _______________|_______________________________
-
-[1] Kroeber, 1925_a_, p. 131.
-
-That there was a decline in population between 1850 and 1870 is agreed
-by all authorities. This fact makes it very attractive to accept Cook's
-proposed density of 10 persons per house for the Hupa in aboriginal
-times. But there are two objections to this procedure. For one thing,
-the population figures for 1870 may be inaccurate. In the census of
-that year, there were reported 874 Indians of all tribes on the Hoopa
-Reservation (Kroeber, 1925a, p. 131). But in the same year another
-agent reported only 649 Indians on the reservation. This is a 25 per
-cent reduction, and if we reduce the population estimate of 640 by 25
-per cent, we get 480 as the estimate for 1870 and a density per house
-of 5.9. If we raise the population of 480 to account for the 1850-1870
-reduction, we are again close to the figure 7.5 persons per house. This
-calculation is presented merely to indicate that the figures are not
-reliable.
-
-The other objection to accepting Cook's proposed figure for density is
-that the established figure for the Yurok is 7.5 persons per house.
-According to Cook, this figure was based on an underlying assumption
-that "the social family in the usual monogamous tribe included the
-father, mother, children, and occasional close relatives" (Cook, 1956,
-p. 99). As a matter of fact, Kroeber's estimate is not based on this
-assumption but is an empirical estimate based on population counts
-and house counts (Kroeber, 1925_a_, pp. 16-19), and the figure is
-accepted wholeheartedly by Cook for the Yurok (1956, p. 83). But what
-is certainly clear is that the social organization, house type, and
-environment of the Hupa was virtually the same as that of the Yurok and
-therefore the population density per house must have been the same. It
-is therefore clear that we must accept either 7.5 persons per house or
-10 persons per house as the population density for both the Hupa and the
-Yurok, and the question becomes one of comparing the reliability of the
-figures given for the Yurok with those given for the Hupa. Yurok figures
-appear to be intrinsically more reliable and are also earlier and I have
-therefore taken 7.5 persons per house as the density.
-
-The population for the Hupa then comes to 1,475 as compared to 2,000
-estimated by Cook and to less than 1,000 estimated by Kroeber.
-
-_Whilkut._--The number of permanent villages among the Whilkut has
-been estimated here at 69. This estimate excludes known summer camps
-and other villages away from the main salmon streams. For the Chilula
-Whilkut there are 23 villages. For the Kloki Whilkut there are 16
-villages, including several which are not shown on the map but which
-are listed by Merriam as being on upper Redwood Creek. Ten villages
-have been taken from the North Fork Whilkut. Twenty villages are taken
-from the Mad River Whilkut even though only 16 are given in the village
-lists. Wherever both Merriam and Goddard worked the same area the
-latter has recorded substantially more villages than the former. I have
-therefore added 4 to the village count to make up for the presumptive
-lack, thus bringing the total up to 69.
-
-House-pit counts from the Chilula Whilkut are listed for six villages
-by Kroeber (1925_a_, p. 138) as 17, 7, 4, 2, 4, 8, or an average of 7
-per village. Kroeber reduces this average by a third, on the basis of
-his estimates for the Yurok and Hupa, to arrive at a figure of 5 houses
-per village. Cook (1956, p. 84) says the reduction should be only about
-10 per cent, calculated on the basis of Waterman's study of the Yurok
-(Waterman, 1920), and he compromises, making a reduction of a seventh to
-use 6 as an average number of houses per village.
-
-The sample used by Kroeber and Cook is so small that an estimate
-based on it of the average number of house pits per village is liable
-to considerable error. If we look at the figures for some of the
-surrounding groups, we find an estimate of 11 houses per village for
-the Hupa in Hoopa Valley, 4.5 for the Hupa outside the valley, 4 for
-the Wailaki, 4.5 for the Wiyot (Cook, 1956, p. 102), and 5.4 for the
-Lolangkok Sinkyone. The Whilkut terrain and culture is certainly more
-nearly like the region outside Hoopa Valley than inside it, so we are
-scarcely justified in estimating more than 5 houses per village.
-
-On this basis we get a total of 345 houses for the Whilkut. Both Kroeber
-and Cook use the Yurok figure of 7.5 persons per house in calculating
-the population of this group. This figure may well be too high, and
-perhaps it should be more nearly the same as the estimate for the
-southern groups, but since I have no concrete evidence to support such a
-contention, I have also used the Kroeber and Cook figure. This gives a
-total population of 2,588 for the Whilkut.
-
-Cook's figures for the groups which were formerly listed under the
-Chilula and Whilkut were 800 and 1,300 making a total of 2,100.
-Kroeber's figures were 600 and 400 for a total of 1,000. The difference
-between Cook's figures and those given here is partly due to the fact
-that Cook took the group on the North Fork of the Mad to be Wiyot,
-whereas I have them as Whilkut. Also Cook made a reduction of a ninth
-in his Mad River estimates because of the poor environment there. I
-have not done this because the Mad River region does not seem to me
-noticeably poorer than that along Redwood Creek.
-
-
-ESTIMATES BASED ON FISH RESOURCES
-
-For the six tribes just discussed, the ethnographic notes at our
-disposal offer a means of estimating the population, but we have also
-another basis for our calculations. Fishery was the most important
-single factor in the California Athabascan economy, hence the fish
-resources of the region undoubtedly exerted a marked influence on
-population size. Therefore, before attempting to estimate the population
-of the remaining groups, for which we have scanty ethnographic
-information, I would like to present some data on the fish resources of
-the region.
-
-I have attempted to calculate the number of stream miles of fishing
-available and thereby to form some estimate of the economic basis of
-each of the groups. Most of my information comes from Mr. Almo J.
-Cordone, Junior Aquatic Biologist of the California Department of
-Fish and Game, who was kind enough to gather the relevant data from
-the records of that organization. I have not included material on the
-freshwater trout, which was apparently too scarce to be important, or
-on the lamprey eel, on which we do not have sufficient information,
-although it was of some importance, especially in the Eel River and its
-tributaries.
-
-The available stream miles of fishing may seem insufficient material
-on which to base estimates of fish resources and unquestionably it
-would be desirable to have some idea of the fish population per mile of
-stream in order to estimate the food value of the resources available to
-the people. On the other hand, this point may not be as crucial as it
-seems, for apparently the fish population was not a governing factor in
-the number of fish taken by the Indians. According to Rostlund (1952,
-p. 17), the aboriginal fishermen of California did not even approach
-overfishing. If this is so, then there must have been fish left uncaught
-even in the smaller salmon streams and it would therefore seem that
-one stream was nearly as good as another, if it carried salmon at all.
-An exception would be the Trinity River and its tributaries, the only
-streams in the Athabascan area with both spring and fall runs of salmon.
-In other streams there is only a fall run.
-
-The lists that follow include data, not only for the six tribes
-previously discussed (Wailaki, Pitch Wailaki, Mattole, Lolangkok
-Sinkyone, Hupa, and Whilkut), but also for the Nongatl, Kato, Shelter
-Cove Sinkyone, Lassik, and Bear River groups. The fish species is
-recorded, when it is known; when our source gives no identification of
-species, however, the generic term is used.
-
-_Available Stream Miles for Fishing in Tribal Territory_
-
-KATO 29 mi.
-
- South Fork Eel R.--19 mi. Quantities of steelhead and silver
- salmon go up at least to Branscomb and King salmon go at least to
- Ten Mile Cr. (Dept. of Fish and Game).
-
- Hollow Tree Cr.--5 mi. There was fishing on this stream
- (Gifford, 1939, p. 304). Fish not specified, probably steelhead and
- salmon.
-
- Ten Mile Cr.--5 mi. This stream appears to be large enough
- for salmon and there were villages on it. Also the Fish and Game
- information for South Fork implies fish in the stream.
-
-WAILAKI (Eel R. and North Fork Wailaki) 23 mi.
-
- Eel R.--16 mi. There are good runs of salmon as far up as Lake
- Pillsbury (Dept. of Fish and Game).
-
- North Fork Eel--7 mi. Salmon go up North Fork farther than 7
- mi. (see Pitch Wailaki).
-
-PITCH WAILAKI 15 mi.
-
- North Fork Eel--12 mi. See below.
-
- Casoose and Hulls creeks--3 mi. The Dept of Fish and Game
- states that salmon do not ascend North Fork above Asbill Cr. but
- Goddard's informant (see Pitch Wailaki Village no. 21) said that
- fish got up into Hulls and Casoose creeks, the mouths of which are
- above Asbill Cr. The Dept. of Fish and Game information may refer
- to a more recent situation.
-
-LASSIK 25 mi.
-
- Eel R.--17 mi. (See Wailaki.)
-
- Dobbyn Cr.--8 mi. There would seem to have been fish in Dobbyn
- Cr., since it is a fair-sized stream and there were many villages
- on it.
-
-SHELTER COVE SINKYONE 67 mi.
-
- South Fork Eel--39 mi. There were a good many fish in South
- Fork as far up as Branscomb (Dept. of Fish and Game).
-
- Redwood Cr.--5 mi. According to Merriam the region around
- Redwood Cr. was a center for the Shelter Cove Sinkyone; therefore
- there must have been fish in the creek.
-
- Mattole R.--11 mi. There is a partial barrier to salmon at the
- community of Thorn but some fish get up even beyond this (Dept. of
- Fish and Game).
-
- East Branch, South Fork Eel--4 mi. King salmon and silver
- salmon go up at least to Squaw Cr. (3 mi.) and steelhead go up at
- least to Rancheria Cr. (4.5 mi., according to the Dept. of Fish and
- Game).
-
- Sea Coast--8 mi. The Shelter Cove Sinkyone have 16 mi. of
- sea coast. The only reliable data on the density of sea coast
- population in relation to the riverine population are given by
- Kroeber (1925a, p. 116). According to his figures, the seashore is
- about half as productive as the rivers and I have therefore halved
- the sea coast mileage in the calculation of available fishing miles.
-
-LOLANGKOK SINKYONE 63 mi.
-
- Eel R.--27 mi. (See Wailaki.)
-
- South Fork Eel R.--16 mi. (See Kato.)
-
- Bull Cr.--6 mi. According to Merriam, there was a large
- settlement on Bull Cr. It could not have been supported without
- fish.
-
- Salmon Cr.--5 mi. Goddard mentions fishing on at least part of
- this stream.
-
- Mattole R.--10 mi. The fish go beyond this stretch at least as
- far as Thorn (Dept. of Fish and Game).
-
-MATTOLE 38.5 mi.
-
- Mattole R.--25 mi. The fish go considerably beyond here in the
- Mattole.
-
- North Fork Mattole--5 mi. North Fork is a sizable stream and
- there were several villages along it, so it probably had fish in it.
-
- Sea Coast--8.5 mi. The Mattole have 17 mi. of sea coast. This
- has been halved in accordance with the principle stated above.
-
-BEAR RIVER 21 mi.
-
- Bear R.--18 mi. This figure is rather arbitrary since the
- information is poor for this stream. It is known that silver salmon
- and steelhead are caught there and that there is a fall run of King
- salmon (Dept. of Fish and Game).
-
- Sea Coast--3 mi. The Bear River group has 6 mi. of sea coast,
- halved for present purposes.
-
-NONGATL 85 mi.
-
- Van Duzen R.--40 mi. Steelhead go up as far as Eaton Roughs
- (40 mi.). Silver salmon go up as far as Grizzly Cr. (21 mi.) and
- probably as far as Eaton Roughs. There are no data on King salmon
- but it is known that there is a fall run of them here. Information
- from Dept. of Fish and Game.
-
- Eel R.--5 mi. All 5 mi. of the Eel in Nongatl territory should
- provide excellent fishing.
-
- Larabee Cr.--20 mi. There is no direct information on this
- stream, but it is of considerable size and there were many villages
- at least 20 mi. up.
-
- Yager Cr.--20 mi. Again we have no direct information but
- there are many villages far up on this stream. Twenty miles of
- available fishing is probably a conservative estimate.
-
- Mad R.--0 mi. There is a long stretch of Mad R. in Nongatl
- territory but, according to the Dept. of Fish and Game, no fish go
- up so far.
-
-WHILKUT 70 mi.
-
- Mad R.--27 mi. There is a 12-ft. falls at Bug Cr. which
- represents a nearly complete barrier to salmon. This means that
- there are salmon in nearly all the territory of the Mad R. Whilkut.
-
- North Fork Mad R.--8 mi. According to Merriam, there were
- fishing camps nearly this far up on North Fork.
-
- Redwood Cr.--35 mi. There is no direct information on this
- stream. I have attributed salmon to nearly its whole length because
- of the size of the stream and the large number of villages along
- its upper course.
-
-HUPA 39 mi.
-
- Trinity R.--27 mi. There are fish in this whole stretch (Dept.
- of Fish and Game).
-
- South Fork Trinity--12 mi. There are known to be salmon in
- South Fork, and presumably they go up as far as the border of Hupa
- territory.
-
-
-TABLE 2
-
-_Area, Fishing Miles, and Population Estimates_
-
- =====================================================================
- | | | | |
- Tribe[2] | Pop. | Area | Ln Area | Fishing | Ln Fishing
- | Estimate | | | Miles | Miles
- ___________________|__________|______|_________|_________|___________
- | | | | |
- Wailaki | 1,656 | 296 | 5.69 | 23 | 3.14
- Pitch Wailaki | 1,104 | 182 | 5.20 | 15 | 2.71
- Mattole | 1,200 | 170 | 5.14 | 38.5 | 3.65
- Lolangkok Sinkyone | 2,076 | 294 | 5.68 | 63 | 4.14
- Hupa | 1,475 | 424 | 6.05 | 39 | 3.66
- Whilkut | 2,588 | 461 | 6.13 | 70 | 4.25
- |__________|______|_________|_________|___________
- Average | 1,683 | | 5.65 | | 3.59
- ___________________|__________|______|_________|_________|___________
-
-[2] Relatively complete village counts.
-
-
-TABLE 3
-
-_Area and Fishing Miles_
-
- =============================================================
- | | | |
- Tribe[3] | Area | Ln Area | Fishing | Ln Fishing
- | | | Miles | Miles
- ______________________|______|_________|_________|___________
- | | | |
- Kato | 225 | 5.42 | 29 | 3.37
- Bear River | 121 | 4.80 | 21 | 3.04
- Lassik | 389 | 5.96 | 25 | 3.22
- Nongatl | 855 | 6.75 | 85 | 4.44
- Shelter Cove Sinkyone | 350 | 5.86 | 67 | 4.20
- ______________________|______|_________|_________|___________
-
-[3] Incomplete village counts.
-
-
-GROSS ESTIMATE
-
-From the preceding data we have obtained population estimates for
-certain of the California Athabascan groups. If these estimates are
-judged reliable, it would be desirable to use them as a basis for
-estimating the population of the remaining groups. When a detailed
-analysis of the ecological or demographical factors involved is lacking,
-it is sometimes necessary to fall back on rather simplistic assumptions
-to attain the desired end. Cook goes rather far in this direction, using
-simply the average population density per square mile of the known
-groups to estimate the population of the unknown groups.
-
-It appears to this writer that a somewhat more satisfactory method of
-estimation would be based on simple linear regression theory. It is
-a fact that pertinent relationships in population studies can often
-be expressed in terms of simple exponential functions or in linear
-combinations of logarithms. Thus we might propose a relationship such as
-the following:
-
- population = a + b (ln area)
-
-or
-
- population = a + b (ln fishing miles)
-
-where a and b are constants to be determined and ln is the logarithm to
-the base e.
-
-Of course we would not expect these relationships to be precise.
-The lack of exactness might be due to the crudeness of the various
-measurements involved or perhaps to the fact that population depends on
-more than one such factor. To account in some way for the uncertainty,
-we might make a further assumption and propose the following
-relationships:
-
- population = a + b (ln area) + X
-
- population = a + b (ln fishing miles) + X
-
-where X has a normal probability distribution with mean = 0 and some
-unknown variance = =s=^{2}. X is then, roughly speaking, the error
-involved in each observation. That the error would be distributed
-normally is quite reasonable under the circumstances. In situations
-where the uncertainty of the observation is due to measurement error
-or to a multiplicity of factors, the distribution obtained often
-assumes a normal form or a form sufficiently normal so that the normal
-distribution can be used as an approximation.
-
-One additional assumption is necessary. We must assume that the sample
-used is taken in a random fashion from the population to be studied. In
-the present investigation, the sample is definitely not taken at random,
-since we are using all groups for which we have population estimates
-based on ethnographic information. The question is, then, whether this
-selection of groups would result in some bias. For instance, the groups
-for which we have ethnographic data might be the most numerous in the
-first place and might thus cause us overestimate the population of
-the remaining groups. On the whole, it would seem to me that there is
-no such bias and that the assumption of a random sample is therefore
-not misleading, at least in the direction of overestimation. If we now
-consider each group for which we have no ethnographic data, we can see
-whether the lack of such data is due to an initially small population or
-to mere luck.
-
- Kato: The reason Kato population is being estimated in gross
- rather than from ethnographic data is that Goddard (1909, p. 67)
- obtained a list of more than 50 villages which are not available
- for calculation.
-
- Bear River: Here the lack of information is due simply to the
- fact that it was not collected. There have been several informants
- living until recently (see Nomland, 1938).
-
- Lassik: There was at least one good informant living until
- recently (Essene, 1942), but Merriam worked with her only briefly.
- Goddard evidently recorded a number of villages from this group,
- but his notes are lost.
-
- Nongatl: Goddard seems to have worked with at least two
- informants from this group, but he spent a very brief time in the
- area and some of his notes may have been lost.
-
- Shelter Cove Sinkyone: Several informants from this group have
- been alive until recently (see Nomland, 1935). No one saw fit to
- collect the appropriate data.
-
-It is obvious from this summary that the main reason for our lack of
-information on these groups is the loss of Goddard's notes. If those
-were at hand, we would probably have complete information on the Kato,
-the Lassik, and probably the Nongatl. The absence of data on the Bear
-River and Shelter Cove Sinkyone is due to the ethnographers' oversight.
-None of these groups, therefore, seem to have been selected because of
-their small aboriginal population. If the following estimates are in
-error because the sample is not a random one, then the error is probably
-one of underestimate rather than overestimate.
-
-Given the foregoing assumptions, the least squares estimate of the
-normal regression line may be obtained with the following formula.
-
- P: population. A: area. F: fishing miles.
-
-The equations of the lines are:
-
- P = a + b (ln A)
-
- P = a' + b' (ln F)
-
-the estimate of b is (Bennett and Franklin, 1954, p. 224)
-
- =S=(X_{i} - [=X])(Y_{i} - [=Y])
- [^b] = -------------------------------
- =S=(X_{i} - X)^{2}
-
-and of a is
-
- â = [=Y] - [^b][=X]
-
-where X_{i} = ln A for each group with known population and Y_{i} = P
-for each known group.
-
-Similarly the estimate of b' is
-
- =S=(X_{i} - [=X])(Y_{i} - [=Y])
- [^b]' = -------------------------------
- =S=(X_{i} - [=X])^{2}
-
-and of a' is
-
- â' = [=Y] - [^b]'[=X]
-
-where X_i = ln F for each known group and Y_i = P for each known group.
-These calculations are shown in table 4.
-
-
-TABLE 4
-
-_Calculation of Regression Lines Shown in Figure 2_
-
- =================================================================
-
- Fishing Miles
- _________________________________________________________________
-
- (X_i - [=X]) (Y_i - [=Y]) (X_i - [=X])(Y_i - [=Y]) (X_i - [=X])^2
-
- -.452 -.027 .012 .204
- -.882 -.579 .511 .778
- .058 -.483 -.028 .003
- .548 .393 .215 .300
- .068 -.208 -.014 .005
- .658 .905 .595 .433
- ---- ---- ----- -----
- Total. 1.291 1.723
- _________________________________________________________________
-
- Area
- _________________________________________________________________
-
- (X_i - [=X]) (Y_i - [=Y]) (X_i - [=X])(Y_i - [=Y]) (X_i - [=X])^2
-
- .041 -.027 -.001 .002
- -.445 .579 .258 .198
- -.514 -.483 .248 .264
- .034 .393 .013 .001
- .400 -.208 -.083 .160
- .484 .905 .438 .234
- ---- ---- ---- ----
- Total. .873 .859
- _________________________________________________________________
-
-The results are the following equations, which are shown, together with
-the points from which they were calculated, on figure 2.
-
- P = 1.02 (ln A) - 4.06
-
- P = .75 (ln F) - 1.00
-
-Thus, given either the area of a group or the fishing miles of a group
-habitat, we may estimate its population. From the diagram in figure 2 it
-appears that the estimates based on area have greater dispersion than
-those based on fishing miles and are therefore less reliable. This fact
-can best be made precise by using the above assumptions to obtain the
-confidence intervals for each of the estimates. The confidence intervals
-for the area estimates are given by the following formula (Bennett and
-Franklin, 1954, p. 229).
-
- _______________________
- {1 (X_o - [=X])^2 }
- 1.02 X_o - 4.06 ± t_[oc]S_a × [Sqrt]{- + -----------------}
- {6 =S=(X_i - [=X])^2}
-
-where the symbols have the following values and meanings:
-
- [10.6] X_o: the log of the area of the group for which the
- population is being estimated.
-
- X_i: the log of the area of each of the groups for which the
- population is already known.
-
- [=X]: the average of the X_i.
-
- t_[oc]: the upper [oc]-point of the t-distribution (Bennett
- and Franklin, 1954, p. 696) where 1-[oc] is the confidence
- coefficient.
-
- _________________________________
- {1 }
- S_a = [Sqrt]{- × =S=(Y_i + 4.06 - 1.02X_i)^2}
- {4 }
-
- where Y_i is the population of each of the groups for which
- population is known. This is the estimated standard deviation of
- population where the estimate is made from area.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 2. Simple linear regression of population. _a_.
-Regression of population on ln area. _b_. Regression of population on ln
-fishing miles.]
-
-The confidence intervals for the fishing-mile estimates may be obtained
-in similar fashion--simply substituting the words fishing mile for area
-and S_{f} for S_{a}.
-
-For calculating the confidence intervals for area we have the following
-quantities:
-
- [=X] = 5.56
-
- t_{.2} = 1.533
-
- =S=(X_i - [=X])^2 = .859
-
- S_{a} = .3594
-
-The calculations are shown in table 5.
-
-The comparable quantities in calculating the confidence intervals for
-fishing-mile estimates are:
-
- [=X] = 3.70
-
- t_{.2} = 1.533
-
- =S=(X_{i} - [=X])^2 = .932
-
- S_{f} = .394
-
-The calculations are shown in table 6.
-
-
-TABLE 5
-
-_Calculation of Confidence Intervals for Area_
-
- Column headings:
-
- A = X_{o}
-
- B = (X_{o} - [=X])
-
- (X_{o} - [=X])^2
- C = ---------------------
- =S=((X_{i} - [=X])^2)
-
- ___________________________
- {1 (X_{o} - [=X])^2 }
- D = [Sqrt]{- + ---------------------}
- {6 =S=((X_{i} - [=X])^2)}
-
- ___________________________
- {1 (X_{o} - [=X])^2 }
- E = t_{.2}S_{a} × Sqrt{- + ---------------------}
- {6 =S=((X_{i} - [=X])^2)}
-
- ===========================================================
- |
- Tribe | [A] [B] [C] [D] [E]
- ______________________|____________________________________
- |
- Kato | 5.42 -.23 .0616 .4778 .263
- Bear River | 4.80 -.83 .8510 1.0088 .556
- Lassik | 5.96 .31 .1119 .5278 .291
- Nongatl | 6.75 1.10 1.4086 1.2551 .692
- Shelter Cove Sinkyone | 5.86 .21 .0513 .4669 .257
- ______________________|____________________________________
-
-
-TABLE 6
-
-Calculation of Fishing-Mile Estimates
-
- Column headings:
-
- A = X_{o}
-
- B = (X_{o} - [=X])
-
-
- C = ---------------------
- =S=((X_{i} - [=X])^2)
-
- ___________________________
- {1 (X_{o} - [=X])^2 }
- D = [Sqrt]{- + ---------------------}
- {6 =S=((X_{i} - [=X])^2)}
-
- ___________________________
- {1 (X_{o} - [=X])^2 }
- E = t_{.2}S_{f} × Sqrt{- + ---------------------}
- {6 =S=((X_{i} - [=X])^2)}
-
- ===========================================================
- |
- Tribe | [A] [B] [C] [D] [E]
- ______________________|____________________________________
- |
- Kato | 3.37 -.22 .0281 .4414 .267
- Bear River | 3.04 -.55 .1756 .5851 .353
- Lassik | 3.22 -.37 .0795 .4962 .300
- Nongatl | 4.44 .85 .4193 .7655 .462
- Shelter Cove Sinkyone | 4.20 .67 .2160 .6186 .374
-
-The results of the calculations are given in table 7. The figures are
-point estimates with 80 per cent confidence intervals. This means that
-under the assumptions given earlier we expect that the tabled intervals
-will contain the true population 8 times out of 10. I have accepted the
-estimates derived from fishing miles because their confidence intervals
-are a bit shorter on the average.
-
-
-TABLE 7
-
-_Population Estimates and Confidence Intervals_
-
- Fishing-mile Area
- Tribe Estimate Estimate
- ---------------------|-------------------|-------------
- Kato |1,523 ± 267 | 1,470 ± 263
- Bear River |1,276 ± 353 | 840 ± 556
- Lassik |1,411 ± 300 | 2,020 ± 291
- Nongatl |2,325 ± 462 | 2,830 ± 692
- Shelter Cove Sinkyone|2,145 ± 374 | 1,920 ± 257
- ---------------------|-------------------|-------------
-
-The question of whether the fishing-mile estimates yield shorter
-confidence intervals than the area estimates brings up an entire range
-of problems pertaining to economy, settlement pattern, and the like. The
-obvious interpretation of the shorter confidence intervals would be that
-the economy of the people in question depended more on fish and fishing
-than on the general produce over the whole range of their territory. The
-question then becomes one of quantitative expression--we would like to
-have some index of the extent of dependence on various factors in the
-economy. This might best be approached from the standpoint of analysis
-of covariance, where we would obtain the "components of variance." This
-technique is a combination of the methods of regression used in this
-paper and those of the analysis of variance. It would evidently yield
-sound indices of economic components, but it involves, for myself at
-least, certain problems of calculation and interpretation which will
-have to be resolved in the future.
-
-Another problem of this kind turns on the question of which factors
-are important in which area. Considering the State of California, for
-instance, we might want to know about such factors as deer population,
-water supply, the quantity of oak trees, etc. Any one of these factors
-or any combination of them might be important in a particular area; the
-problem of gathering the pertinent information then becomes crucial.
-Moreover, because the situation has changed since aboriginal times, we
-must combine modern information with available historic sources. S.
-F. Cook has shown that energetic and imaginative use of these sources
-yields very good results (e.g., Cook, 1955).
-
-Finally, there is the problem of the assumptions we were required to
-make in order to obtain our population estimates. Although many of
-the assumptions in the present paper are difficult to assess, the two
-which I would like to discuss here were particularly unyielding--the
-assumptions of the number of persons per house and the assumptions of
-the number of houses per village.
-
-The question of how many persons there were per house has been dealt
-with extensively by both Kroeber and Cook. There is also a great deal
-of random information in the ethnographic and historical literature. I
-believe there are enough data now at hand to provide realistic limits
-within which we could work, at least for the State of California. This
-information should be assembled and put into concise and systematic form
-so that it would be available for use in each area. It would also be of
-interest in itself from the standpoint of social anthropology.
-
-For the number of houses per village we have also a considerable body of
-information, but here we are faced with a slightly different problem.
-It often happens that we know, from ethnographic information or from
-archaeological reconnaissance, how many house pits there are in a
-village site but do not know how many of the houses which these pits
-represent were occupied simultaneously. In the present paper it has
-been assumed that four-fifths of the house pits represents the number
-of houses in the village occupied at any one time. This, however, is
-simply a guess, and one has no way of knowing how accurate a guess. The
-solution to this problem is simple but laborious. From each area of the
-State a random sample of villages with recorded house counts should be
-taken. Each of these village sites should then be visited and the house
-pits counted. A comparison of the two sets of figures would give us a
-perfectly adequate estimate, which could then be used subsequently over
-the entire area.
-
-
-TABLE 8
-
-_Population Estimates_
-
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------
- Tribe |Area |Fishing| Pop. |Area |Fishing-|Kroeber[5]| Cook[6]
- | (sq | |Esti- |Den- | | mile |
- | mi) | Miles | mate |sity |Density | Estimate |Estimate
- -------------+-----+-------+------+-----+--------+----------+--------
- Kato[4] | 225 | 29 | 1,523| 6.77| 52.5 | 500 | 1,100
- Wailaki | 296 | 23 | 1,656| 5.59| 72.0 | 600 | 2,315
- Pitch Wailaki| 182 | 15 | 1,104| 6.07| 73.6 | 400 | 1,032
- Lassik[4] | 389 | 25 | 1,411| 3.63| 56.4 | 500 | 1,500
- Shelter Cove | 350 | 67 | 2,145| 6.13| 32.0 | 375 | 1,450
- Sinkyone[4]| | | | | | |
- Lolangkok | 294 | 63 | 2,076| 7.06| 33.0 | 375 | 1,450
- Sinkyone | | | | | | |
- Mattole | 170 | 38.5 | 1,200| 7.06| 31.2 | 350 | 840
- Bear River[4]| 121 | 21 | 1,276|10.55| 60.8 | 150 | 360
- Nongatl[4] | 855 | 85 | 2,325| 2.72| 27.4 | 750 | 3,300
- Whilkut | 461 | 70 | 2,588| 5.61| 37.0 | 1,000 | 2,100
- Hupa | 424 | 39 | 1,475| 3.48| 37.8 | 1,000 | 2,000
- |-----+-------+------+-----+--------+----------+--------
- Total |3,767| 475.5 |18,779| 4.99| 39.5 | 6,000 | 17,447
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-[4] The population figures for these groups are estimated in the gross
-by the method indicated in the text.
-
-[5] Kroeber, 1925_a_, p. 883. The breakdown has been changed somewhat to
-accommodate boundary changes; the total remains the same. The population
-density, according to Kroeber's figures, is 1.6 persons per sq. mi.
-
-[6] Cook, 1956. The breakdown has been changed somewhat to accommodate
-boundary changes; the total remains the same. The population density,
-according to Cook's figures, is 4.6 persons per sq. mi.
-
-The corpus of information provided by the methods outlined above would
-be useful in two ways. First, it would clarify our definitions of the
-economic factors in the lives of hunter-gatherers. Functional hypotheses
-which postulate dependence of social factors on economy would be subject
-to objective, quantitative tests of their validity.
-
-Second, the corpus of information would afford a suitable basis for
-inference from archaeological data. If we can determine what were the
-major economic factors in the lives of a prehistoric people, then we
-can make assertions about population, settlement pattern, and the
-like. Conversely, information about population and settlement pattern
-would imply certain facts about the economy. This technique has
-already been developed to some extent. For instance, Cook and Heizer,
-depending on assumptions derived from ethnographic data (Cook and
-Treganza, 1950; Heizer, 1953; Heizer and Baumhoff, 1956), have made
-inferences concerning village populations. These methods have such great
-possibilities for the conjunctive approach in archaeology that their use
-should be extended as much as possible.
-
-
-
-
-APPENDIXES
-
-
-APPENDIX I: THE TOLOWA
-
-The Tolowa are an Athabascan group living on the coast from a
-short distance north of the mouth of the Klamath River to the
-Oregon-California boundary. Information on this group has not been
-included in the main body of the paper because the Tolowa are separated
-from the other California Athabascan groups and belong more properly
-with the Oregon Athabascans; It was thought, however, that Merriam's
-data on the Tolowa should be recorded and they have therefore been
-appended in this form. The following passages are taken verbatim from
-Merriam's notes.
-
-
-HAH-WUN-KWUT NOTES
-
-The following notes are from information given me by Sam Lopez and wife
-and Lopez' father at the Mouth of Smith River, Del Norte County, Sept.
-16-17, 1923.
-
-_Name._--The tribe as a whole had no distinctive name for themselves
-except Huss, the word for people. But they had definite names for
-village areas. Those living at the mouth of Smith River call themselves
-Hah´-wun-kwut; those at Burnt Ranch, about three miles south of
-the mouth of Smith River, Yahnk´-tah-kut; those at Crescent City
-Tah-ah´-ten--and so on.
-
-_Location, boundaries, and neighbors._--The territory of the tribe
-as a whole extends from Winchuk River (Um-sahng´-ten) on the
-California-Oregon boundary south to Wilson Creek (Tah-ges^{hl}-ten)
-about eight miles north of the mouth of Klamath River.
-
-The coast tribe immediately north (on the Oregon side of the line) is
-called Cheet or Che´-te. Their language differs materially from that of
-the Hah´-wun-kwut, though most of the words could be understood. Only a
-single woman survives.
-
-The tribe on the south, from Wilson Creek to Klamath River, is called
-Tah-che-ten-ne and Tet-le-mus (Polikla).
-
-The tribe immediately east of the Cheet on the Oregon side of the
-California-Oregon boundary is called Ka-Ka-sha. Another name, Choo-ne,
-also was given but I am in doubt as to whether or not the same tribe
-was meant. The Ka-ka-sha live near Waldo on the north side of the
-Siskiyou Mountains and speak a language widely different from that of
-the Hah´-wun-kwut. They are said to be lighter in color than the coast
-Indians.
-
-_Dress and ornament._--The people used deer skin blankets called
-Nah-hi-ne tanned with the hair on, and also blankets of rabbit skin,
-called Wa-gah hahs-nis-te. Deer skins tanned with the hair on are called
-Nah-ki-le. The breech cloth formerly worn by the men was called Rut-soo
-and tat-es-tat. Moccasins, Kus-ki-a, of elk hide were worn by rich men.
-
-The women wore a front apron called Sahng; and on dress occasions an
-ornamented cloak-like skirt (Chah) that extended all the way around and
-lapped over in front. They also wore basket hats, called Ki´-e-traht´
-and necklaces, the general term for which is Ni-ta-kle-ah. On occasions
-they wore ear pendants, Bus-shra-mes-lah, of elk or deer bone. Nose
-bones or shells, Mish-mes-lah, were sometimes worn; those of rich
-persons consisted of one of the long _Dentalium_ shells. The chin is
-tattooed with three narrow vertical lines called Tah-ah rut^{hl}-tes.
-
-_Houses._--The houses (Munt) were square and were built of planks or
-slabs hewn from redwood trees and stood up vertically, as in the case
-of those of the Klamath River Indians. The ceremonial houses are called
-N[=a]´-stahs-m[=a]´-ne. They are square and have a ridge roof. During
-important dances the front side is removed. The sweat house is called
-Shes´-kl[)e] and is large enough to hold twenty people. It is square or
-rectangular, and the ground floor is excavated to a depth of about four
-feet. The roof is of hewn planks covered with earth.
-
-_Money._--The ordinary medium of exchange or "money" (Trut) consisted
-of shells of _Dentalium_, of which the valuable long ones are called
-T[=a]´-tos, the commoner short ones Kle´-ah. Clam shell disks or buttons
-are called Nah´-set.
-
-_Treatment of dead._--The dead are buried in a grave (Ch[)e]´-slo). The
-people assert that they never burned their dead. They say that a spirit
-or ghost, called Nah-who´-tlan, goes out of the body after death and
-becomes a ghost.
-
-_Ceremonial dances._--Dances are called N[=a]´-stahs or Nesh-stahsh. A
-puberty dance, Chahs´-stah w[=a]´-nish tahs, was held for the girls.
-Other important dances are held. Some last 5 days; others last 10 days.
-
-The ceremonial drums Hah´-et-sah differ radically from those of any
-other California Indians known to me. They are large cooking baskets
-about two feet in diameter. Only new baskets are used in order that they
-may stand the drumming.
-
-Rattles called Chah-p[=a]t´-chah are made of the small hoofs of deer.
-Cocoon rattles were not used.
-
-Whistles, called Tut´-tle-nik are made of large quill feathers of birds,
-not of bone.
-
-_The stick game._--The stick game is a feature of the people, as in most
-California tribes. It consists of a number of slender sticks called
-Not-tr[=a]´-le, of which one, called Chah-when´, is marked. The counters
-are called Chun´; the man who keeps count, Chun-ting. A dressed buckskin
-is stretched tightly on the ground between the players, and when the
-game is called, the sticks are thrown down upon it.
-
-_Baskets._--The basketry is of twined weave called Chet-too. The big
-storehouse baskets, called Hawsh-tan, are closely woven and have a
-shallow saucer-shape lid. The large open work burden basket is called
-Tus, the large cooking basket, Met-too´-sil^{ch}, the small mush bowl
-Hah´-tsah, the large shallow meal tray Mes-chet´-te-gah´, the large
-open work shallow bowl Tre-kwahs´-tuk, the small open work plate or
-platter Kah´-se, the subglobular choke-mouth trinket basket Net´-tah,
-the milling basket Ki´-e-sut, the baby basket Kah´-yu, its shade
-Ne´-whats-tah, the women's basket hat Ki´-e-traht´. There is also a
-subglobular openwork basket called I´-[)a]-loo´ with an arched handle
-for carrying on the arm.
-
-The cooking bowls, mush baskets, and other small baskets are made
-of spruce roots, 'Hre´, more or less covered with an overlay of
-bear grass (_Xerophyllum_, called Too-t[)e]^{chl}) and maiden hair
-fern (_Adiantum_) called Ke´-tsi-shah´-te, meaning Blue-jay knees,
-because of the slender form and black color. The roots used in the
-carrying baskets, baby baskets, and other coarse baskets are of hazel,
-called 'Kun. The common black design in ordinary baskets consists
-of Spruce roots that have been buried in dark mud and are called
-Tah´-che-gut-kle-ah. They are ordinarily used in connection with the
-bear grass (_Xerophyllum_).
-
-_Fragments of Hahwunkwut myths._--Skum, Coyote man, made the world.
-
-When the sun dropped down the Coon caught it up and it was hot, and
-blackened the insides of his hands.
-
-When the world first floated there was just one big white Redwood tree
-called Kus-choo´-ke. A big Eagle was sitting on the tree and was king of
-the world.
-
-The Falcon (Tah´-tes) won the battle for the people.
-
-_Hahwunkwut foods._--A large variety of foods are eaten: meat
-(Ch[=a]´-sun) of elk and deer, both fresh and dried, salmon and
-other fish, fresh and dried, marrow, tallow, salmon eggs (usually
-smoke-dried), clams of several kinds, mussels, fish milt both dried and
-fresh, acorn mush and bread, and a number of roots, berries, and other
-parts of plants. Among the food berries are strawberries, blackberries,
-salmon-berries, huckleberries, salal berries, elder berries and
-manzanita berries.
-
-Elder berries are mixed with blackberries and steamed in the ground
-oven; manzanita berries are mashed and mixed with smoke-dried salmon
-eggs.
-
-Two kinds of kelp are eaten.
-
-Root masses of the brake fern (_Pteris aquilina_, called Tah´-sohn-ki)
-are cooked in the ground oven. They are said to be like milk and have a
-fine flavor.
-
-Salt is not used.
-
-Wild tobacco is called Yahn-s[)e]^{ch} yah-we and S[)e]^{ch}-yu. The
-pipe is straight and is called A-chah.
-
-_Hahwunkwut plant notes._--The Tree Maple (_Acer macrophyllum_) is
-called Ch[=a]´-she. Its inner bark is used for the ordinary everyday
-dress for women.
-
-The Tanbark Oak is the dominant species in the northwest coast region
-and its acorns (Sohng´-cheng) are largely eaten by the people. Acorn
-meal before leaching is called Rut-ta-gaht. If it is allowed to become
-mouldy, the bitter taste disappears so that it does not have to be
-leached. Acorn bread cooked on hot ashes is called Ses^{hl}-te. The
-ordinary mush is called Ma-guts-kush.
-
-_Hahwunkwut animal notes._--The Bobcat (_Lynx rufus_) is called
-Ne´-ti-us ah´-n[=a]. Its name is never mentioned in the presence of a
-baby. If the mother sees one before the baby is born, the baby will have
-fits and die.
-
-The falcon or Duck Hawk (Tah´-tes) was a high personage among the First
-People. He won the first battle for the Indians, standing on the first
-Redwood Tree.
-
-The California Condor (T[=a]-long-yi´-chah) is so big and powerful that
-he can lift a whale. His name shows this as it is from the name of the
-whale (T[=a]´-lah) and means "whale lifter."
-
-The Dove (Sroo´-e-gun´-sah) cries for his grandmother, especially in the
-spring of the year.
-
-The Purple Finch is called Klah´-nis-me´-tit-le, meaning "many
-brothers," because the birds go together in small flocks.
-
-The Night Heron (Nah-gah´ che yahs´-se) is known as the "sickness bird."
-
-_Hahwunkwut pits for catching elk and deer._--The Smith River
-Hah-wun-kwut used to catch elk and deer in pits, called Song´-kit, dug
-in the ground along the runways. These pits differ materially from those
-of the Pit River Indians, being much shallower. No effort was made to
-make them deep enough to prevent the captured animals from jumping out,
-but an ingenious device was used to prevent them from jumping. The pits
-were only a little deeper than the length of the legs of the elk, but
-poles were placed across the top so that when the animal fell through,
-the body would rest on the poles so his feet could not touch the ground.
-This of course prevented him from jumping out.
-
-When "set," the pits were lightly covered with slender sticks and
-branches and leaves, to resemble the surrounding ground, but the cover
-was so frail that an animal the size of a deer would at once break
-through.
-
-_Smelt fishery._--At Ocean Shore, Smith River, Calif., July 21, 1934.
-Vast numbers of smelt, a small surf fish, are caught in nets by the
-Hawungkwut Indians. During a "run" at high tide flocks of sea gulls
-hover over the incoming fish, thus making their approach known. The
-Indians catch them with nets. After a preliminary drying on a circular
-mat of brush called the nest, the smelt are transferred to the fish bed,
-a long flat rectangular and slightly elevated area built up of sand and
-capped with a layer of small smooth stones. On this they are left till
-thoroughly dry.
-
-_Massacres of Huss Indians by the whites._--There were three notable
-killings by the whites.
-
-The first killing took place at Burnt Ranch, three miles south of
-the mouth of Smith River, at the rancheria called Yahnk-tah´-kut,
-a name perpetuated by the district school house name. Here a large
-number of Indians were caught during a ceremonial dance and ruthlessly
-slaughtered. The Indians say this was the first killing.
-
-The second killing was at the rancheria of [=A]´-choo-lik on the big
-lagoon known as Lake Earl about three miles north of Crescent City [cf.
-Drucker's etculet in Drucker, 1937, map 3]. The Indians were engaged in
-gambling at the time.
-
-The third killing was at the large village of Hah-wun-kwut [Xawun hwut,
-Drucker, 1937, map 3] at the mouth of Smith River.
-
-At the time of the Indian troubles in northwestern California Chief
-Ki´-lis (named for Ki-o-lus the Willow tree) was chief of the
-Hah´-wun-kwut tribe.
-
-Three young men of the tribe were active in resenting the aggressions of
-the whites and were said to have killed several of the early settlers.
-They were very clever and neither the settlers nor the soldiers were
-able to capture them. Finally the officer in charge of the troops at
-Fort Dick (a log fort on Smith River, about three miles from the present
-settlement called Smith River Corners) told Chief Ki´-lis that he would
-be hung by the soldiers unless he captured the three young men in
-question.
-
-It happened that the chief had two wives, who were sisters of the three
-young men. The chief was in great trouble and called a meeting of his
-head men. They said that if the people would contribute enough blood
-money (which consists of the long Dentalium shells) they could pay the
-two sisters the price necessary to atone for the killing in accordance
-with the law of the tribe. The people agreed to this and raised the
-necessary money. The nearest male relatives of the young men were chosen
-to do the killing, but the young men could not be found.
-
-One day when one of the chief's wives was getting mussels near the
-mouth of Smith River one of the young men appeared and told her that he
-and his brothers were hungry and wanted food. She designated a place
-on the point of a nearby ridge where she said she would take food, and
-it was agreed that the three brothers would come to get it in the late
-afternoon or early evening. She then went home and told her husband,
-Chief Ki-lis, who in turn notified the nearest relatives of the young
-men; they went and concealed themselves near the spot. When the young
-men came and were looking for the food their relatives fell upon them
-and killed them. They were buried in the same place and the graves may
-be seen there to this day.
-
-The officer in charge of the troops was greatly pleased. He and his
-soldiers arranged "a big time," giving the Indians plenty to eat and
-also some blankets. This ended the "Indian war" in that region.
-
-There is a small island called Stun-tahs ahn-kot (50 acres or more in
-extent) in the lower part of Smith River, half or three-quarters of a
-mile from its mouth. On some of the early maps it bears the name Ta´-les
-after the chief. This island the officer gave to the Indians in the name
-of the Government, telling them it would always be theirs, and gave the
-chief a paper stating that it was given in return for killing the three
-outlaw boys. Sometime afterward this paper was burned.
-
-After the Indians had been driven to the Hoopa Reservation and had
-come back, they were not allowed to go to their former rancheria
-Hah´-wun-kwut, but were told to go to this island. Later the whites
-claimed the island and did not let the Indians have it.
-
-The present Indian settlement, a mile or two north of the mouth of
-Smith River, was purchased for the Indians in or about 1908 by Agent
-Kelsey of San Jose, and paid for by the Indian Office from a part of an
-appropriation made by Congress for homeless California Indians. It is
-occupied at present (1923) by ten or a dozen families.
-
-
-APPENDIX II: NOTES ON UPPER EEL RIVER INDIANS
-
-By
-
-A. L. Kroeber
-
-YUKI "TRIBES"
-
-The following data were got from Eben Tillotson at Hulls Valley, north
-of Round Valley, on July 12, 1938.
-
-A. Eben said he was a Wi·t'u·knó'm Yuki. This was a "tribe" speaking
-a uniform dialect, having uniform customs, but embracing several
-"tribelets." Their general territory was along main (or middle) Eel R.
-where this runs from E to W, on both sides of it, and S of Round V. They
-also owned Oklá·[)c] and Púnki·nipi·[t.] ("wormwood hole"), Poonkiny.
-The subdivisions or tribelets were:
-
- [10.6] 1. U[)s]i·[)c]lAlhótno'm
- ("crayfish-creek-large-people") on Salt Cr., S of Middle Eel.
-
- 2. Olkátno'm, at Henley or Hop ranch in S part of Round V.,
- where the road enters the flat of the valley. They owned S to the
- Middle Eel and down it to Dos Rios confluence.
-
- 3. Alniuk'í·no'm, at W edge of Round V.
-
- 4. Ontítno'm, E of Henley ranch in Round V.; also Eden V. to S.
-
-B. The following were not grouped together by the informant, but agree
-in having a southerly range:
-
- [10.6] 5. LAlkú·tno'm, around Outlet Cr.
-
- 6. Tí·tAmno'm, eastward, across (S of Middle) Eel R., toward
- Sanhedrin Mt., W of the ridge which runs W of Gravelly V. Mountain
- people, without villages of size. Dixie Duncan was half of this
- group.
-
- 7. Ki·[)c]ilú·kam is Gravelly V. The Huchnom roamed in that.
-
-C. East of Hull's V., extending nearly to Hammerhorn Mt., but this was
-Nomlaki.
-
- [10.6] 8. [vS]ipimA´lno'm, on a creek running from W into
- (S-flowing) Eel R.
-
- 9. I·'mptí·tAmno'm, at an opening in the range--i·'mp is a
- gap. They were across the Eel, on its E side.
-
- 10. Pi·lílno'm, beyond (farther E or SE?), at Kumpí·t, "salt
- hole," where salt was got, also at Snow Mt. These were Yuki, but
- "talked something like" Nomlaki Wintun (who adjoined them, across
- the main Coast Range watershed). Their language was about as
- different from Yuki as was Huchnom. They were "half Stony Creek"
- (along which lived Salt Pomo, then Hill Patwin, then Nomlaki).
-
- 11. U·k'í·[)c]no'm (added later by informant), in Williams V.,
- "E" of Hull's V.
-
- 12. A Yuki group at Twin Rock Cr.--Eben had forgotten their
- name.
-
-D. The real Yuki, centering in Round V., and coming N into the foothills
-only about as far as Ebley's Flat. To the N were the Onainó'm, Pitch
-Indians, Athabascans, who owned Hull V. ("here") and adjoined the
-[vS]ipimAlno'm (no. 8).
-
- [10.6] 13. Hákno'm, in Round V., around Agency, in the N side
- of the valley.
-
- 14. Ukomnó'm, in middle of the valley. They did not own up
- into the mountains.
-
- 15. At TotimAl, W of Covelo, were a people whose name Eben had
- forgotten.
-
- 16. At NW end of Round V., another group whose name he could
- not recall.
-
-It will be seen that the informant's knowledge was fullest for the part
-of Yuki territory S of Round V.
-
-He thought that all the groups mentioned made the Taikomol and Hulk'ilAl
-initiations and performances.
-
-_Orthography Used_
-
- A a mid-raised a, nasalized
- [t.] retroflex or palatal t
- [vS] sh
- [)c] ch
- k' etc. glottalized
- · long
- [-l] surd l, Athabascan only
- =ê= ng Athabascan
-
-[Illustration: Map 18. Yuki "Tribes" according to Eben Tillotson.]
-
-
-ATHABASCAN DATA
-
-DATA FROM EBEN TILLOTSON
-
-Onainó'm were the Pitch Indians, a people of the rugged mountains,
-adjoining the [vS]ipimA´lno'm Yuki, and with Hull's Valley in their
-range. They were "half Yuki and half Wailaki," and spoke both languages.
-
-The TA´no'm were at Spy Rock on main Eel R. They were also half Yuki and
-half Wailaki and bilingual. [But other Yuki cite them as Yuki who also
-knew Wailaki.] TAno'm were: Nancy Dobie, Sally Duncan, and Tip.
-
-These two groups did not make Taikomol or Hulk'ilAl rites [this agrees
-with Handbook] but, probably knew about them from having seen them
-performed.
-
-Between the Pitch people and the TAno'm, in the Horse Ranch country,
-lived the Ko'il, the Wailaki (proper). Most of the survivors of these
-spoke Yuki also.
-
-
-DATA FROM LUCY YOUNG
-
-The following notes, mainly on Athabascans, were obtained at Round
-Valley on July 13, 1938. Lucy Young, the informant, was born on Eel
-River at Tseye[)s]ente[-l], opposite Alder Point. Though listed by the
-Government as a Wailaki, she is actually what ethnologists call Lassik.
-Her father was born 3 mi. from Alder Pt.; her mother, at Soldier Basin,
-22 mi. NE. Her mother's first cousin was T'a·su's, known to the whites
-as Lassik, from his Wintun name Lasek. He was chief for Alder Pt.,
-Soldier Basin, (upper) Mad River. Mary Major, informant's contemporary,
-is from Soldier Basin and of the same tribe.
-
-The following were obtained as names of groups of people, though some of
-them may be place names.
-
- Setelbai, "yellow rock," Alder Pt., etc.
-
- Nal[)s]a, "eat each other," downstream, around Fort Seward.
-
- Ko[)s]o-ya=ê=, "soaproot eaters," farther downstream and on
- Van Duzen R.
-
- Tena=ê=-keya, Mad R. Indians.
-
- Kentet[-l]a(=ê=), Kettenchow V., a flat with roots.
-
- Se[)c]([-l])enden-keya, at Zenia.
-
- Ka·snol-keya, S of Zenia, called Kikawake in Hayfork [Wintun].
-
- Tok'(a)-keya, South Fork of Eel Indians [Sinkyone].
-
- Saya=ê=, "lamprey eel eaters," the Spy Rock
-
- Wailaki [the Ko'il of Tillotson].
-
- Djeh-ya=ê=, "pinenut eaters," the Pitch Wailaki, on North Fork
- Eel R.
-
- [The outlook seems to have been chiefly downstream and inland.]
-
-_Non-Athabascans_
-
- [)C]iyin[)c]e, Yuki.
-
- Baikiha=ê=, Hayfork Wintu.
-
- Ya=ê=-keya, the Wintu from Weaverville to Redding; their own
- name was Poibos. The same name Ya=ê=-keya was applied also to the
- Cottonwood Creek Wintun, whom the Lassik met at Yolla Bolly Mt. to
- trade salt. [Wintu and Wintun were treated as one language.]
-
- Yitá·kena, people of lowest Eel R., the Wiyot.
-
-
-
-
-BIBLIOGRAPHY
-
-
-_Abbreviations_
-
- AA American Anthropologist
- BAE-B Bureau of American Ethnology, Bulletin
- SI-MC Smithsonian Institution, Miscellaneous Collections
- UC University of California Publications
- -AR Anthropological Records
- -IA Ibero-Americana
- -PAAE American Archaeology and Ethnology
-
-American Anthropological Association
-
- 1916. Phonetic Transcription of Indian Languages, Report of
- Committee of American Anthropological Association, SI-MC, Vol. 66,
- No. 6.
-
-Barrett, S. A.
-
- 1908. The Ethno-Geography of the Pomo and Neighboring Indians.
- UC-PAAE 6:1-332.
-
-Bennett, C. A., and N. L. Franklin
-
- 1954. Statistical Analysis in Chemistry and the Chemical
- Industry. John Wiley and Sons, New York.
-
-Cook, S. F.
-
- 1943. The Conflict between the California Indian and White
- Civilization: I. UC-IA 21, pp. 161-194.
-
- 1955. The Aboriginal Population of the San Joaquin Valley,
- California. UC-AR 16:31-80.
-
- 1956. The Aboriginal Population of the North Coast of
- California. UC-AR 16:81-130.
-
-Cook, S. F., and A. E. Treganza
-
- 1950. The Quantitative Investigation of Indian Mounds. UC-PAAE
- 40:223-262.
-
-Curtis, E. S.
-
- 1924. The North American Indian. Vols. 13, 14.
-
-Dixon, Roland B.
-
- 1910. The Chimariko Indians and Language. UC-PAAE 5:293-380.
-
-Drucker, Philip
-
- 1937. The Tolowa and Their Southwest Oregon Kin. UC-PAAE
- 36:221-300.
-
-Du Bois, Cora
-
- 1935. Wintu Ethnography. UC-PAAE 36:1-148.
-
-Essene, Frank
-
- 1942. Culture Element Distributions: XXI. Round Valley. UC-AR
- 8:1-97.
-
-Foster, George M.
-
- 1944. A Summary of Yuki Culture. UC-AR 5:155-244.
-
-Gifford, E. W.
-
- 1939. The Coast Yuki. Anthropos, 34:292-375.
-
-Goddard, Pliny E.
-
- 1903_a_. Life and Culture of the Hupa. UC-PAAE 1:1-88.
-
- 1903_b_. Kato Pomo not Pomo. AA 5:375-376.
-
- 1904. Hupa Texts. UC-PAAE 1:89-377.
-
- 1907. Lassik. In Handbook of American Indians. BAE-B 30.
-
- 1909. Kato Texts. UC-PAAE 5:65-238.
-
- 1914_a_. Notes on the Chilula Indians of Northwestern
- California. UC-PAAE 10:265-268.
-
- 1914_b_. Chilula Texts. UC-PAAE 10:289-379.
-
- 1923_a_. The Habitat of the Wailaki. UC-PAAE 20:95-109.
-
- 1923_b_. Wailaki Texts. International Journal of American
- Linguistics, II:77-135.
-
- 1924. Habitat of the Pitch Indians, a Wailaki Division.
- UC-PAAE 17:217-225.
-
- 1929. The Bear River Dialect of Athapascan. UC-PAAE 24:291-324.
-
-Goldschmidt, Walter
-
- 1951. Nomlaki Ethnography. UC-PAAE 42:303-443.
-
-Goldschmidt, W. R., and H. E. Driver
-
- 1940. The Hupa White Deerskin Dance. UC-PAAE 35:103-142.
-
-Heizer, R. F., ed.
-
- 1953. The Archaeology of the Napa Region. UC-AR 12:225-358.
-
-Heizer, R. F., and M. A. Baumhoff
-
- 1956. California Settlement Patterns. _In_ Prehistoric
- Settlement Patterns in the New World. G. R. Willey, ed. Viking Fund
- Publications in Anthropology, No. 23.
-
-Jepson, W. L.
-
- 1951. A Manual of the Flowering Plants in California. Univ.
- Calif. Press, Berkeley and Los Angeles.
-
-Kroeber, A. L.
-
- 1925_a_. Handbook of the Indians of California. BAE-B 78.
-
- 1925_b_. A Kato War. Festchrift, Publication d'Hommage Offert
- au P. W. Schmidt, pp. 394-400.
-
- 1932. The Patwin and Their Neighbors. UC-PAAE 29:253-423.
-
- 1939. Cultural and Natural Areas of Native North America.
- UC-PAAE, Vol. 38.
-
-Loud, Llewellyn L.
-
- 1918. Ethnogeography and Archaeology of the Wiyot Territory.
- UC-PAAE 14:221-436.
-
-Merriam, C. Hart
-
- 1905. The Indian Population of California. AA 7:594-606.
-
- 1923. Application of the Athapaskan Term Nung-kahhl. AA
- 25:276-277.
-
- 1928. An-nik-a-del, the History of the Universe. The Stratford
- Company, Boston.
-
- 1930. The New River Indians Tlo-Hom-tah-hoi. AA 32:280-293.
-
- 1955. Studies of California Indians. Univ. Calif. Press,
- Berkeley and Los Angeles.
-
-Nomland, G. A.
-
- 1935. Sinkyoni Notes. UC-PAAE 36:149-178.
-
- 1938. Bear River Ethnography. UC-AR 2:91-124.
-
-Nomland, G. A., and A. L. Kroeber
-
- 1936. Wiyot Towns. UC-PAAE 35:39-48.
-
-Powers, Stephen
-
- 1877. Contributions to North American Ethnology, Vol. 3.
- Tribes of California. Dept. of Interior, U.S. Geographical and
- Geological Survey of the Rocky Mountain Region.
-
-Rostlund, Erhard
-
- 1952. Freshwater Fish and Fishing in Native North America.
- Univ. Calif. Publ. Geog., Vol. 9.
-
-Waterman, T. T.
-
- 1920. Yurok Geography. UC-PAAE 16:177-314.
-
-
-
-
-PLATES
-
-
-EXPLANATION OF PLATES
-
-
-PLATE 9
-
-Map showing the lower Trinity River and locations of Hupa villages. The
-map was made by George Gibbs, a member of the expedition of Colonel
-Redick McKee in 1852. The village names shown are in the Yurok language.
-
-
-PLATE 10
-
-Views of Athabascan territory. _a_. View of Hoopa Valley looking north.
-Photo by P. E. Goddard, 1901, UCMA 15-2917. _b_. Big rock on Mad River
-at Big Bend "taken from village site" (UCMA catalogue). Big Bend is in
-the southern part of Mad River Whilkut territory. There is no record of
-the site referred to. Photo by P. E. Goddard, 1906, UCMA 15-3166. _c_.
-Fishing place on Van Duzen River between Bridgeville and Old Fort Baker.
-Nongatl informant Peter is shown on the rock. This spot is somewhere
-among the villages shown on map 7. Photo by P. E. Goddard, 1906, UCMA
-15-3156. _d_. Rock on ridge of Snow Camp between Mad River and Redwood
-Creek. It is about halfway between Kloki Whilkut village no. 45 and Mad
-River Whilkut village no. 15 on map 17. Photo by P. E. Goddard, 1906,
-UCMA 15-3165. _e_. Rock on Eel River near Blocksburg in southern Nongatl
-territory. Photo by P. E. Goddard, 1906, UCMA 15-3201. _f_. Indian house
-at Blocksburg in southern Nongatl territory. Photo by P. E. Goddard,
-1903, UCMA 15-3017.
-
-
-PLATE 11
-
-Views of Athabascan territory, _a_. Model house (right) and sweathouse
-made for Goddard by the Wailaki Captain Jim. Photo by P. E. Goddard,
-1906, UCMA 15-3281. _b_. Eel River in Wailaki territory, looking from
-the west. The mouth of North Fork Eel River is shown in the lower
-right-hand corner. Photo by P. E. Goddard, 1906, UCMA 15-3264. _c_.
-Picture taken from the Blue Rock stage road to Cummings. This is the
-hinterland of the Eel River Wailaki west of the Eel River. Photo by P.
-E. Goddard, 1902, UCMA 15-3011. _d_. A view of Usal, the southernmost
-village of the Shelter Cove Sinkyone. Photo by P. E. Goddard, 1902, UCMA
-15-2922. _e_. A village site near Laytonville in Kato territory. The
-village is not known. Photo by P. E. Goddard, 1906, UCMA 15-3146.
-
-[Illustration: Plate 9. The lower Trinity River, showing the locations
-of Hupa villages. Map by George Gibbs, 1852.]
-
-[Illustration: Plate 10. Athabascan territory.]
-
-[Illustration: Plate 11. Athabascan territory.]
-
- * * * * *
-
- Transcribers Notes:
-
- Obvious spelling and grammar errors corrected.
-
- P. 23 capital L in the middle of two Indian words. Proofer
- thought typo. However, I believe it was intentional.
-
- Greek text has been transliterated and enclosed in equal signs.
-
-
-
-
-
-End of Project Gutenberg's California Athabascan Groups, by Martin A. Baumhoff
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK CALIFORNIA ATHABASCAN GROUPS ***
-
-***** This file should be named 43876-8.txt or 43876-8.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/4/3/8/7/43876/
-
-Produced by Colin Bell, Richard Tonsing, Joseph Cooper and
-the Online Distributed Proofreading Team at
-http://www.pgdp.net
-
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
-will be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
-one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
-(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
-permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
-set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
-copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
-protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
-Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
-charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
-do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
-rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
-such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
-research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
-practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
-subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
-redistribution.
-
-
-
-*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
-Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
-http://gutenberg.org/license).
-
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
-all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
-If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
-terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
-entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
-and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
-or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
-collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
-individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
-located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
-copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
-works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
-are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
-Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
-freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
-this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
-the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
-keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
-Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
-a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
-the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
-before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
-creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
-Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
-the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
-States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
-access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
-whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
-copied or distributed:
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
-almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
-re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
-with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org/license
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
-from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
-posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
-and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
-or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
-with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
-work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
-through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
-Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
-1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
-terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
-to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
-permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
-word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
-distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
-"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
-posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
-you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
-copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
-request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
-form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
-that
-
-- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
- owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
- has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
- Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
- must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
- prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
- returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
- sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
- address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
- the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or
- destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
- and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
- Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
- money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
- of receipt of the work.
-
-- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
-forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
-both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
-Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
-Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
-collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
-"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
-corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
-property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
-computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
-your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
-your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
-the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
-refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
-providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
-receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
-is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
-opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
-WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
-WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
-If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
-law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
-interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
-the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
-provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
-with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
-promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
-harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
-that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
-or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
-work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
-Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
-
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
-including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
-because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
-people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need, are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
-To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
-and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
-and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org.
-
-
-Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
-Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
-http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
-permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
-Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
-throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
-809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
-business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
-information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
-page at http://pglaf.org
-
-For additional contact information:
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
-SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
-particular state visit http://pglaf.org
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
-To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate
-
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
-with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
-Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
-
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
-unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
-keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
-
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
-
- http://www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
diff --git a/43876-8.zip b/43876-8.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index 5dd6187..0000000
--- a/43876-8.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/43876-h.zip b/43876-h.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index cdaf1b2..0000000
--- a/43876-h.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/43876-h/43876-h.htm b/43876-h/43876-h.htm
index 221064c..8369518 100644
--- a/43876-h/43876-h.htm
+++ b/43876-h/43876-h.htm
@@ -2,7 +2,7 @@
"http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en" lang="en">
<head>
- <meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=iso-8859-1" />
+ <meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=UTF-8" />
<meta http-equiv="Content-Style-Type" content="text/css" />
<title>
The Project Gutenberg eBook of California Athabascan Groups, by Martin A. Baumhoff.
@@ -109,44 +109,7 @@ div.titlepage p {
</style>
</head>
<body>
-
-
-<pre>
-
-Project Gutenberg's California Athabascan Groups, by Martin A. Baumhoff
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
-almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
-re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
-with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org/license
-
-
-Title: California Athabascan Groups
-
-Author: Martin A. Baumhoff
-
-Release Date: October 3, 2013 [EBook #43876]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK CALIFORNIA ATHABASCAN GROUPS ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by Colin Bell, Richard Tonsing, Joseph Cooper and
-the Online Distributed Proofreading Team at
-http://www.pgdp.net
-
-
-
-
-
-
-</pre>
-
+<div>*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 43876 ***</div>
<div class="titlepage">
@@ -236,7 +199,7 @@ aboriginal situation that can now be arrived at.</p>
<p>The Department of Anthropology hopes to be able to continue the work of
studying and publishing the Merriam data on tribal distributions. It
-takes this opportunity to express its appreciation of the coöperation of
+takes this opportunity to express its appreciation of the coöperation of
the Smithsonian Institution in this undertaking.</p>
<p class="right">
@@ -580,8 +543,8 @@ cards, on each of which is typed the name,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_15
pertinent data for a single village. Some of the lists are accompanied
by maps, showing precise location of the villages. In the lists for
which there are no maps but only verbal descriptions of the sites,
-the township, range, and quarter section coördinates are given. The
-township and range coördinates have been changed since Goddard's time,
+the township, range, and quarter section coördinates are given. The
+township and range coördinates have been changed since Goddard's time,
in accordance with the more accurate surveys of the last thirty years,
but county maps of the appropriate period provide a perfectly adequate
way of locating Goddard's sites within a few hundred yards.</p>
@@ -605,8 +568,8 @@ little about their way of life, except what can be gained by inference
from the surrounding groups.</p>
<p>The author's thanks are due to Dr. A. L. Kroeber and Dr. R. F. Heizer,
-who gave their full coöperation throughout the preparation of the
-present paper. Dr. Henry Sheffé was kind enough to advise on the
+who gave their full coöperation throughout the preparation of the
+present paper. Dr. Henry Sheffé was kind enough to advise on the
statistics used in the section on population.</p>
@@ -1006,7 +969,7 @@ Bear River Ridge as the line, and this version has been accepted.</p>
runs north and south along Bald Hills Ridge, dividing the drainages
of Redwood Creek and the Trinity River. Merriam gives the Hupa
two divisions&mdash;the Tin-nung-hen-na-o, or Hupa proper, and the
-Ts´a&#774;-nung-wha&#774;, or Southern Hupa. The line dividing these two
+Ts´a&#774;-nung-wha&#774;, or Southern Hupa. The line dividing these two
groups lies just north of the main Trinity to the east of South Fork and
along Madden Creek to the west of South Fork. Kroeber (1925<i>a</i>, p. 129)
and Goddard (1903<i>a</i>, p. 7) do not give any support for a linguistic
@@ -1316,44 +1279,44 @@ place and tribal names which I present herewith.</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>Kato: to-chil´-pe ke´-ah-hahng</p>
+<p>Kato: to-chil´-pe ke´-ah-hahng</p>
-<p>Jackson V. people (inc. Branscom): sin´-ko&#772;k ke´-ah-hahng</p>
+<p>Jackson V. people (inc. Branscom): sin´-ko&#772;k ke´-ah-hahng</p>
-<p>Wailaki: we´-tah<sup>c</sup>h</p>
+<p>Wailaki: we´-tah<sup>c</sup>h</p>
-<p>Yuki of Round V.: chinch´</p>
+<p>Yuki of Round V.: chinch´</p>
-<p>Coast Yuki: bahng´-ke´-ah-hahng</p>
+<p>Coast Yuki: bahng´-ke´-ah-hahng</p>
-<p>Southern Sinkyone: ketch´-ing ke´-ah-hahng</p>
+<p>Southern Sinkyone: ketch´-ing ke´-ah-hahng</p>
<p>Tribe on the N side of Rattlesnake Cr. and E of South Fork Eel
-division of Wailaki (?): tek´ ke´-ah-hahng</p>
+division of Wailaki (?): tek´ ke´-ah-hahng</p>
<p>Long V.: kin-te&#774;<sup>hl</sup>-pe</p>
<p>Laytonville: ten-tah<sup>ch</sup>-tung</p>
-<p>Cahto Pond (now drained): to-chil´-pa</p>
+<p>Cahto Pond (now drained): to-chil´-pa</p>
-<p>Long V. Cr.: shah´-nah</p>
+<p>Long V. Cr.: shah´-nah</p>
-<p>South Fork Eel R.: nahs-ling´-che</p>
+<p>South Fork Eel R.: nahs-ling´-che</p>
-<p>Rattlesnake Cr.: tal-tlo&#772;l´-kwit</p>
+<p>Rattlesnake Cr.: tal-tlo&#772;l´-kwit</p>
-<p>Main Eel R.: tah-ke´-kwit</p>
+<p>Main Eel R.: tah-ke´-kwit</p>
-<p>Blue Rock: seng-chah´-tung</p>
+<p>Blue Rock: seng-chah´-tung</p>
<p>Bell Springs: se&#774;<sup>ch</sup>-pis</p>
<p>Round V.: kun-tel-cho&#772;-pe</p>
-<p>Jackson V.: kus´-cho-che´-pe; kas-tos´ cheek´-be</p>
+<p>Jackson V.: kus´-cho-che´-pe; kas-tos´ cheek´-be</p>
-<p>Branscomb Mt.: ki&#772;k; chi&#772;s´-naw</p></blockquote>
+<p>Branscomb Mt.: ki&#772;k; chi&#772;s´-naw</p></blockquote>
<h4>VILLAGES</h4>
@@ -1365,60 +1328,60 @@ sometimes a direct quotation but most often is paraphrased.</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>1. netce'li&#772;gût (B). At a point about 9 mi. nearly due W of
+<p>1. netce'li&#772;gût (B). At a point about 9 mi. nearly due W of
the town of Laytonville and about 3 mi. SE of the confluence of the
E fork of the South Fork of Eel R. with the South Fork of Eel R.
This village is on top of the ridge separating these two streams
and is on the property of Mr. Jacob Lamb.</p>
-<p>2. yictciLti'ñkût, "wolf something-lying-down creek" (B). On
+<p>2. yictciLti'ñkût, "wolf something-lying-down creek" (B). On
the S bank of Ten Mile Cr. at a point about 5 mi. WNW of the town
of Laytonville.</p>
-<p>3. sentca'u&#772;kût, "rock big creek"; or kave'mato (Northern
+<p>3. sentca'u&#772;kût, "rock big creek"; or kave'mato (Northern
Pomo dialect name), "rock big" (B). On Big Rock Cr. at a point
about 1-1/2 mi. from its confluence with Ten Mile Cr., or about
5-1/2 mi. nearly due W of the town of Laytonville.</p>
-<p>sen-chow´-ten (M). Kato name for their village at Big Rock,
+<p>sen-chow´-ten (M). Kato name for their village at Big Rock,
about 4 mi. N of their present rancheria in Long V.</p>
<p>4. ka'ibi, "nuts in" (B). On the NE bank of Ten Mile Cr. at a
point about 3 mi. downstream from the town of Laytonville.</p>
-<p>5. nebo&#772;'ce&#772;gût, "ground hump on-top" (B). On what is
+<p>5. nebo&#772;'ce&#772;gût, "ground hump on-top" (B). On what is
known as the Wilson ranch at a point about 1 mi. W of Laytonville.</p>
<p>6. seLgaitceli'nda, "rock white run-out" (B). About 300 yds. E
of the house on what is known as the "old" John Reed ranch about 1
mi. N of Laytonville.</p>
-<p>7. bûntcno&#772;ndi'lyi, "fly settle-upon under" (B). Just NW of
+<p>7. bûntcno&#772;ndi'lyi, "fly settle-upon under" (B). Just NW of
Laytonville and but a short distance from the place now occupied by
the Indians near Laytonville.</p>
<p>8. ko'cbi, "blackberry there" (B). About 1-1/2 mi. WSW of
Laytonville and on the SW bank of the Ten Mile Cr.</p>
-<p>9. tci&#772;be&#772;'takût, "fir tips creek" (B). About a mile SW of
+<p>9. tci&#772;be&#772;'takût, "fir tips creek" (B). About a mile SW of
the town of Laytonville and about 1/2 mi. up the creek which drains
Cahto V. from its confluence with Ten Mile Cr.</p>
<p>che-pa-tah-kut (M). A former village in the northern part of
Long V. on the James White place.</p>
-<p>10. diste&#772;gû'tsi&#772;u&#772;, "madrona crooked under" (B). On the
+<p>10. diste&#772;gû'tsi&#772;u&#772;, "madrona crooked under" (B). On the
western side of Long V. at a point about 2 mi. SSE of Laytonville.</p>
<p>11. to&#772;dji'Lbi, "water? ... in" (B). At the site now
occupied by the Indians at Cahto. This site is on the W bank of the
small creek running from Cahto into Ten Mile Cr.</p>
-<p>12. bûntcteno&#772;ndi'lkût, "fly low settle-upon creek" (B). On
+<p>12. bûntcteno&#772;ndi'lkût, "fly low settle-upon creek" (B). On
the N bank of the northern branch of the head of the South Fork of
the Eel R. at a point about a mile SSW of Cahto.</p>
-<p>13. kûcyi&#772;'u&#772;yeto&#772;kût, "alder under water creek" (B). On
+<p>13. kûcyi&#772;'u&#772;yeto&#772;kût, "alder under water creek" (B). On
the N bank of the South Fork of Eel R. at a point about 3 mi. SW of
Cahto. This site is about 1/2 mi. E of the ranch house on the Clark
ranch.</p>
@@ -1427,17 +1390,17 @@ ranch.</p>
the village was situated under a projecting ridge. On the S bank of
the South Fork of Eel R. at a point about 3 mi. S of Branscomb.</p>
-<p>15. se&#772;ne'tckût, "rock gravel creek" (B). On the NW bank
+<p>15. se&#772;ne'tckût, "rock gravel creek" (B). On the NW bank
of the small stream known as Mud Springs Cr., which is tributary
to the South Fork of Eel R. This site is about 3 mi. a little S
of E of Branscomb. There are on this creek, and not far from this
village site, several springs which flow a very thin blueish mud,
thus giving the creek its name.</p>
-<p>16. tontce'kût, "water bad creek" (B). About 1/4 mi. W of the
+<p>16. tontce'kût, "water bad creek" (B). About 1/4 mi. W of the
South Fork of Eel R. and about 1 mi. SW of Branscomb.</p>
-<p>17. senansa'<sup>n</sup>kût, "rock hang-down creek" (B). On the E bank
+<p>17. senansa'<sup>n</sup>kût, "rock hang-down creek" (B). On the E bank
of the South Fork of Eel R. at a point about 1-1/2 mi. downstream
from Branscomb.</p></blockquote>
@@ -1484,7 +1447,7 @@ in his Hupa village lists (Curtis, 1924, Vol. 13).</p>
<p>The second source is the notes of Goddard, who did extensive work in
the area in 1906 (Goddard, 1909), though mostly on language and myth.
His notes contain information on two villages, neither of which can be
-located because the township and range coördinates have been changed
+located because the township and range coördinates have been changed
since the time of recording and also because the name of the creek
mentioned does not appear on maps in my possession. The two cards
bearing the information have the penciled notations 51 and 52 written
@@ -1501,10 +1464,10 @@ villages is therefore correspondingly incomplete.</p>
N., R. 15 W. On a flat 200 yds. N of Blue Hill Cr. and 150 yds.
W of the river. There are 3 deep pits on the eastern edge of the
higher flat. Bill thought there were 3 others 100 yds. S where a
-white man's house had stood, ne'<sup>&#410;</sup>so&#772;ki&#772; ki&#772;yahûn.</p>
+white man's house had stood, ne'<sup>&#410;</sup>so&#772;ki&#772; ki&#772;yahûn.</p>
<p>t'un&#410;tcintcki, "leaves black tail" W sec. 26, T. 22 N., R.
-15 W. On the higher bank 50 yds. N of tûn&#410;tcintckwo&#772;t, the
+15 W. On the higher bank 50 yds. N of tûn&#410;tcintckwo&#772;t, the
next creek N of Blue Hill Cr. and 400 yds. W of the river. There is
timber W. Dr. Wilson used to live there. The site has been plowed.
Bill counted six places where he thought houses had been.</p>
@@ -1687,7 +1650,7 @@ ethnographic facts.</p>
<td></td>
<td>n</td>
<td></td>
- <td>ñ</td>
+ <td>ñ</td>
</tr>
<tr>
@@ -1821,7 +1784,7 @@ orthographies.</p>
<td>n (occasionally ng, once not recorded at all)</td>
</tr>
<tr>
- <td>ñ </td>
+ <td>ñ </td>
<td>ng (occasionally n, twice not recorded at all)</td>
</tr>
<tr>
@@ -1890,24 +1853,24 @@ further subdivided. </p>
<p>I. There is close agreement on the boundaries of the northernmost
Wailaki tribelet on the western side of the Eel. Merriam gives the
-names kun-nun´-dung ke´-ah-hahng, ki´-kot-ke-ah-hahng, ki-ketch-e
-ka&#772;-ah-hahng, and ki-ke´-che ke´-ah-hahng as designations for the
+names kun-nun´-dung ke´-ah-hahng, ki´-kot-ke-ah-hahng, ki-ketch-e
+ka&#772;-ah-hahng, and ki-ke´-che ke´-ah-hahng as designations for the
group. He says the territory of this group runs from Chamise Creek
in the north to Pine Creek in the south. Goddard gives the same name
(rendered kaikitcEkaiya) and the same boundaries for the group.</p>
<p>The territory north of Chamise Creek on the west side of the river is
-assigned by Merriam to the taht´-so ke´ah tribelet of the Lassik. This
+assigned by Merriam to the taht´-so ke´ah tribelet of the Lassik. This
attribution would seem to indicate that Merriam has put his northern
Wailaki boundary too far north, that it should hit the Eel at Chamise
Creek rather than at Kekawaka Creek. Goddard calls these people the
da&#410;sokaiya, "blue ground people," which no doubt corresponds to
-taht´-so ke´ah. He says, "It is doubtful that they should be counted as
+taht´-so ke´ah. He says, "It is doubtful that they should be counted as
Wailaki, but they were not Lassik and probably spoke the same dialect as
the Wailaki."</p>
-<p>II. This tribelet is called se&#774;-tah´-be ke´-ah-hahng or
-sa&#772;-tah´-ke-ahng by Merriam. In one place his notes say that the
+<p>II. This tribelet is called se&#774;-tah´-be ke´-ah-hahng or
+sa&#772;-tah´-ke-ahng by Merriam. In one place his notes say that the
territory includes land on both sides of the Eel, running south of
Indian Creek on the western side. This is clearly not so, for he refers
several times to a different tribelet occupying that area. That the
@@ -1919,19 +1882,19 @@ south as the boundaries. Goddard's name for the tribelet is sEtakaiya.</p>
whose territory was bounded on the north by Natoikot Creek and extended
south to a point opposite the mouth of North Fork. His name for this
group is taticcokaiya. Merriam's name for the group in this general area
-is tah-chis´-tin ke-ah-hahng. He does not give any boundaries for them.</p>
+is tah-chis´-tin ke-ah-hahng. He does not give any boundaries for them.</p>
<p>IV. and V. Merriam gives the following names for the tribelet occupying
-the territory around Blue Rock and Bell Springs Creeks: tsi-to´-ting
-ke´-ah, from the name of Bell Springs Mountain; sen-chah´-ke´-ah;
-se&#774;-so ke´-ah-hahng, "Blue Rock Band"; then´-chah-tung ka&#772;´-ah,
+the territory around Blue Rock and Bell Springs Creeks: tsi-to´-ting
+ke´-ah, from the name of Bell Springs Mountain; sen-chah´-ke´-ah;
+se&#774;-so ke´-ah-hahng, "Blue Rock Band"; then´-chah-tung ka&#772;´-ah,
"Blue Rock Band." On the other hand, he gives the following names for
the people who occupied the west bank of the Eel for a mile or more
south of the mouth of North Fork: nin-ken-ne&#772;tch ka&#772;-ah-hahng;
-nung-ken-ne-tse´ ke´-ah; ne&#774;-tahs´ ke-ah-hahng. Goddard says that the
+nung-ken-ne-tse´ ke´-ah; ne&#774;-tahs´ ke-ah-hahng. Goddard says that the
entire stretch from the mouth of North Fork south to Blue Rock Creek
on the west bank of the river was occupied by a single tribelet called
-nIñkannitckaiya, a name clearly corresponding to Merriam's names for the
+nIñkannitckaiya, a name clearly corresponding to Merriam's names for the
people on the west bank of the Eel, south of North Fork. I am inclined
to think that Merriam is correct and that there were two tribelets in
this area. Merriam's notes include five different references to the
@@ -1941,36 +1904,36 @@ division line no doubt falls a mile or two north of Bell Springs Creek.</p>
<p>VI. On the eastern side of the river Merriam gives two names for the
tribelet holding the land south from Kekawaka Creek. He says the
-yu-e-yet´-te ke´-ah was the tribelet north of Chamise Creek. Their
-southernmost village, called sko´-teng, was on the east side of the
-river a half-mile or a mile south of Kekawaka Creek. The sko´-den ke´-ah
+yu-e-yet´-te ke´-ah was the tribelet north of Chamise Creek. Their
+southernmost village, called sko´-teng, was on the east side of the
+river a half-mile or a mile south of Kekawaka Creek. The sko´-den ke´-ah
Merriam gives as the name of the tribelet on the east side of the Eel
River and about a half-mile south of Kekawaka Creek. Goddard gives
-i&#410;kodAñkaiya, corresponding to Merriam's sko´-den ke´-ah, as the
+i&#410;kodAñkaiya, corresponding to Merriam's sko´-den ke´-ah, as the
name of the group extending from about two miles south of the mouth of
Chamise Creek nearly to the mouth of Kekawaka Creek. Both Merriam and
Goddard indicate some doubt whether these people were Wailaki.</p>
<p>VII. Merriam gives the names che&#772;s-kot ke&#772;-ah-hahng,
-chis´-ko-ke´-ah, and to&#772;s-ahng´-kut for the tribelet living in
+chis´-ko-ke´-ah, and to&#772;s-ahng´-kut for the tribelet living in
Horseshoe Bend. The first two names come from the word chis-kot, the
name for Copper Mine Creek. Goddard also gives these last two names for
-the group (written tciskokaiya and tosAñkaiya, "water stands people"),
+the group (written tciskokaiya and tosAñkaiya, "water stands people"),
and he says their territory includes the land between Copper Mine Creek
on the south and a point a mile or two south of Chamise Creek on the
north.</p>
-<p>VIII. Goddard says that a tribelet named slakaiya or sEyadAñkaiya
+<p>VIII. Goddard says that a tribelet named slakaiya or sEyadAñkaiya
occupied the territory between Copper Mine Creek in the north and Willow
-Creek in the south. Merriam gives the name nung-ken-ne-tse´ ke´-ah to
+Creek in the south. Merriam gives the name nung-ken-ne-tse´ ke´-ah to
this group, which he locates on the east side of the Eel River at Island
Mountain. He gives no boundaries for the group.</p>
<p>IX. Merriam gives two names for the tribelet occupying the Indian Creek
-region. The chen-nes´-no-ke´-ah was the band on chen-nes-no´-kot Creek
+region. The chen-nes´-no-ke´-ah was the band on chen-nes-no´-kot Creek
(Indian Cr.) from Lake Mountain to the Eel River; he also writes this
name ken-nis-no-kut ke-ah-hahng. His other name for the group has the
-variants bas-ka&#772;´-ah-hahng, bas-ki´-yah, bus-ka&#772;-ah-hahng. This
+variants bas-ka&#772;´-ah-hahng, bas-ki´-yah, bus-ka&#772;-ah-hahng. This
group is said to have been on the east side of the Eel River a mile
or two north of Indian Creek (in the Fenton Range country). Goddard
gives the name bAskaiya, "slide people," corresponding to the last of
@@ -1983,23 +1946,23 @@ Creek south to the mouth of North Fork. Goddard says the region was
occupied by a tribelet called sE&#410;tchikyokaiya, "rock red large
people."</p>
-<p>XI. Merriam says the sa&#772;´-tan-do´-che ke´-ah-hahng was the name of
+<p>XI. Merriam says the sa&#772;´-tan-do´-che ke´-ah-hahng was the name of
a tribelet on the north side of North Fork and about a half-mile from
its junction with the main Eel. The name means "rock reaching into the
-water." Goddard's name for this same group is sEtandoñkiyahAñ, a clear
+water." Goddard's name for this same group is sEtandoñkiyahAñ, a clear
correspondence, and he indicates that their land was on about the last
mile of North Fork.</p>
<p>XII. According to Merriam the next group up North Fork was named
-se&#774;-cho ke´-ah-hahng. Its land was on the north side of North Fork a
+se&#774;-cho ke´-ah-hahng. Its land was on the north side of North Fork a
mile or more above its mouth. Goddard has the same name for the group,
-sEtcokiyahAñ; he says the people occupied both the north and south sides
+sEtcokiyahAñ; he says the people occupied both the north and south sides
of a one-mile stretch of North Fork beginning a little way below the
mouth of Wilson Creek and extending downstream from there.</p>
-<p>XIII. Merriam says ki´-ye ke´-ah-hahng was the name of the tribelet on
+<p>XIII. Merriam says ki´-ye ke´-ah-hahng was the name of the tribelet on
both sides of North Fork at the mouth of Wilson Creek. This is in accord
-with Goddard's data. He gives the name as kAiyEkiyahAñ. Neither Goddard
+with Goddard's data. He gives the name as kAiyEkiyahAñ. Neither Goddard
nor Merriam gives the limits of this group up North Fork. Presumably
they coincide with the tribal boundary.</p>
@@ -2047,7 +2010,7 @@ Cr.</p>
of the wife of Wylakki Tip so there is no doubt that they are
referring to the same village.]</p>
-<p>2. kun-tes-che´-kut (M). Said to have been a Wailaki village
+<p>2. kun-tes-che´-kut (M). Said to have been a Wailaki village
on the W side of the Eel R. a half-mile N of Horseshoe Bend Tunnel,
probably nearly opposite Horseshoe Bend Cr. (Tip).</p>
@@ -2055,43 +2018,43 @@ probably nearly opposite Horseshoe Bend Cr. (Tip).</p>
Bend. Horseshoe Bend Cr. appears to enter the Eel from the E about
a mile S of Boulder Cr. If Goddard's kAntEltcEk'At is really
kAntE&#410;tcEk'At, with the bar on the "l" dropped in error, then
-these names are nearly the same. If so, kun-tes-che´-kut might
+these names are nearly the same. If so, kun-tes-che´-kut might
be the name of village no. 1 even though the location differs
slightly.]</p>
<p>3. basEtcE&#410;galk'At, "throw stone outside on" (G). On the
western side of the Eel, just N of the mouth of Pine Cr.</p>
-<p>4. sEdAkk'añdAñ, "rock ridge place" (G). On the point of the
+<p>4. sEdAkk'añdAñ, "rock ridge place" (G). On the point of the
ridge around which the Eel turns toward the W at Horseshoe Bend.</p>
-<p>5. kit-te-ken-ne&#774;´-din (Tip), kit-ken-ne&#774;-tung (Maj) (M).
+<p>5. kit-te-ken-ne&#774;´-din (Tip), kit-ken-ne&#774;-tung (Maj) (M).
At or near the S end of Horseshoe Bend Tunnel. It was the biggest
village of the tribelet and was said to have been the native
village of the father of Wylakki Tip.</p>
-<p>se&#774;-tah´-be (M). A large village on the W side of the Eel
+<p>se&#774;-tah´-be (M). A large village on the W side of the Eel
River just S of Horseshoe Bend Tunnel near Island Mt. Station. It
was nearly opposite the mouth of Copper Mine Cr.</p>
-<p>tcInnagañtcEdai, "eye closed door" (G). At the base of the
+<p>tcInnagañtcEdai, "eye closed door" (G). At the base of the
ridge described in no. 4. It was said to have been the home of
Captain Jim.</p>
<p>[These names may or may not refer to the same village. If
-they do, it is likely that Merriam's kit-te-ken-ne&#774;´-din is the
-correct one. His se&#774;-tah´-be evidently refers to the name of
+they do, it is likely that Merriam's kit-te-ken-ne&#774;´-din is the
+correct one. His se&#774;-tah´-be evidently refers to the name of
the tribelet, sEtakaiya, given by both him and Goddard. Goddard's
designation looks as though it might very well refer to the tunnel
and thus would be very modern.]</p>
-<p>6. lacE&#410;kotcEdAñ, "buckeye small hole place" (G). This
+<p>6. lacE&#410;kotcEdAñ, "buckeye small hole place" (G). This
seems to have been only a few hundred yards S of Horseshoe Bend.</p>
<p>7. kaigAntcik'At, "wind blows up on" (G). A big winter camp
about 1/4 mi. S of Horseshoe Bend.</p>
-<p>8. sait'otcEdadAñ, "sand point on" (G). Also about 1/4 mi. S
+<p>8. sait'otcEdadAñ, "sand point on" (G). Also about 1/4 mi. S
of Horseshoe Bend but was about 500 ft. above the river near a big
spring.</p>
@@ -2110,13 +2073,13 @@ village with this name was situated on the N side of the mouth of
this creek. It was the home of the father of the wife of Wylakki
Tip.</p>
-<p>12. IsgaidadAbbIñlai (G). N of the creek mentioned in no. 11
+<p>12. IsgaidadAbbIñlai (G). N of the creek mentioned in no. 11
but on higher ground away from the river.</p>
<p>13. &#410;tAgtcEbi', "black oaks in" (G). About a mile N of
Natoikot Cr. on a flat above the river.</p>
-<p>14. sEnagatcEdAñ, "stones walk around place" (G). About 200
+<p>14. sEnagatcEdAñ, "stones walk around place" (G). About 200
yds. N of no. 15.</p>
<p>15. sE&#410;sokyok'At, "stone blue large on" (G). About 1/2 mi.
@@ -2133,18 +2096,18 @@ a little more than a mile N of the mouth of North Fork and opposite
the mouth of Cottonwood Cr. It was close to a fishing place that
the tribelet shared with the bAskaiya tribelet.</p>
-<p>18. tah-te&#772;s-cho´-tung, tah-te&#772;s-cho´-ting, tah-chis´-ting
+<p>18. tah-te&#772;s-cho´-tung, tah-te&#772;s-cho´-ting, tah-chis´-ting
(M). 1/2 mi. or more N of the mouth of North Fork on the W side of
the main Eel.</p>
-<p>taticcodAñ (G). In a grove of oaks about 1/4 mi. downstream
+<p>taticcodAñ (G). In a grove of oaks about 1/4 mi. downstream
from the mouth of North Fork on the W side of the Eel.</p>
<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_172" id="Page_172">[Pg 172]</a></span></p>
-<p>19. ne´-tahs, ning-ken-ne´-tset (M). Ne´-tahs is the name of
+<p>19. ne´-tahs, ning-ken-ne´-tset (M). Ne´-tahs is the name of
the town on a rocky stretch of the river. The town ran for a mile
-or more S of the mouth of North Fork (Maj). Ning-ken-ne´-tset was
+or more S of the mouth of North Fork (Maj). Ning-ken-ne´-tset was
the name of the village which was at the fishing place opposite the
mouth of North Fork and extending S. It was also called "fishtown."
Tip's mother lived there (Tip).</p>
@@ -2160,9 +2123,9 @@ Cr. It was named for the large rock beneath which it stood.</p>
<p>21. tco&#410;Attcik'At, "graveyard on" (G). A large village on
the western side of the river a few hundred yards downstream from
-the mouth of djoñkot.</p>
+the mouth of djoñkot.</p>
-<p>[The stream that Goddard calls djoñkot seems to be the one
+<p>[The stream that Goddard calls djoñkot seems to be the one
that appears on the modern maps as Cinch Cr.; that is the only one
in the vicinity. On his map it is shown entering the Eel about
a mile downstream from the mouth of Bell Springs Cr. but it is
@@ -2171,7 +2134,7 @@ scant hundred yards from its mouth. On the assumption that Cinch
Cr. is, in fact, the stream that Goddard meant to indicate I have
moved the village about a mile to the S.]</p>
-<p>22. sa'kAntE&#410;dAñ, "beaver valley place" (G). About midway
+<p>22. sa'kAntE&#410;dAñ, "beaver valley place" (G). About midway
between the mouth of Blue Rock Cr. and Bell Springs Cr. on a fine
large flat.</p></blockquote>
@@ -2182,36 +2145,36 @@ large flat.</p></blockquote>
<p>23. sE&#410;kaibi, "make a noise in the throat" (G). Opposite
the mouth of Chamise Cr.</p>
-<p>24. tcadEtokInnEdAñ (G). Located only approximately&mdash;in
+<p>24. tcadEtokInnEdAñ (G). Located only approximately&mdash;in
Horseshoe Bend at the point where the river turns toward the NE.</p>
-<p>25. k'AcsAndAñ, "alder stands place" (G). About a mile
+<p>25. k'AcsAndAñ, "alder stands place" (G). About a mile
downstream from the point where the river turns W at Horseshoe Bend.</p>
-<p>26. sEtcokInnEdAñ, "rock large its base place" (G). About 1/2
+<p>26. sEtcokInnEdAñ, "rock large its base place" (G). About 1/2
mi. downstream from the point where the river turns toward the W at
Horseshoe Bend.</p>
-<p>27. nEtcEdEtcAñk'At, "ground rolling on" (G). A short distance
+<p>27. nEtcEdEtcAñk'At, "ground rolling on" (G). A short distance
W of the mouth of Copper Mine Cr. (Tunnel Cr.).</p>
<p>28. dAndaitcAmbi, "flint hole in" (G). On the downstream side
of the mouth of Copper Mine Cr. (Tunnel Cr.).</p>
<p>29. taht-aht (M). On the E side of the Eel R. at Horseshoe
-Bend and opposite se&#774;-tah´-be. It was a big town (Tip).</p>
+Bend and opposite se&#774;-tah´-be. It was a big town (Tip).</p>
-<p>kaitcIlIñtadAñ, "Christmas berries among place" (G). There
+<p>kaitcIlIñtadAñ, "Christmas berries among place" (G). There
was a graveyard about 1/4 mi. N of the village and just beyond the
graveyard was Copper Mine Cr.</p>
-<p>30. to-che&#774;´-ting (M). A big village on the E side of the
-Eel R. at Horseshoe Bend (opposite se&#774;-tah´-be), only a short
+<p>30. to-che&#774;´-ting (M). A big village on the E side of the
+Eel R. at Horseshoe Bend (opposite se&#774;-tah´-be), only a short
distance S of taht-aht (Tip). It was probably less than 1/4 mi. S
of Island Mt. Station on the opposite side of the river.</p>
-<p>kaslInkyodAñ. "spring large place" (G). On the E bank of the
-river about 300 yds. S of kaitcIlIñtadAñ, or about 1/2 mi. S of
+<p>kaslInkyodAñ. "spring large place" (G). On the E bank of the
+river about 300 yds. S of kaitcIlIñtadAñ, or about 1/2 mi. S of
Copper Mine Cr.</p>
<p>[The names of these two villages are not the same at all and
@@ -2219,11 +2182,11 @@ since Goddard gives many villages in the near vicinity the chances
are good that the names do not represent the same village.]</p>
<p>31. kaslInkyobi, "spring large in" (G). A rock shelter near
-Goddard's kaslInkyodAñ. A family used to spend the winter here.
+Goddard's kaslInkyodAñ. A family used to spend the winter here.
Captain Jim's father-in-law was left here to die after he had been
wounded by the whites.</p>
-<p>32. skEtcE&#410;kascanAñ, "mush thrown away sunny place" (G).
+<p>32. skEtcE&#410;kascanAñ, "mush thrown away sunny place" (G).
Evidently situated about a mile S of Copper Mine Cr., where the
river makes a slight turn toward the N. Here there is a flat 50 ft.
higher than the river and 150 ft. from it, in which 17 house pits
@@ -2233,10 +2196,10 @@ face of this rock and is washed away each winter. The thickness of
the deposit is supposed to indicate the abundance of the year's
acorn crop.</p>
-<p>33. ah-chahng´-ket (M). On the E side of the Eel a mile or two
+<p>33. ah-chahng´-ket (M). On the E side of the Eel a mile or two
S of Horseshoe Bend. It was more than a mile S of to-che-ting (Tip).</p>
-<p>akyañk'At, "right here on" (G). Some distance N of Willow Cr.
+<p>akyañk'At, "right here on" (G). Some distance N of Willow Cr.
and on the river.</p>
<p>[These two names doubtless represent the same village but
@@ -2244,23 +2207,23 @@ neither Merriam nor Goddard gives a very exact location for it.]</p>
<p>34. slAsyanbi', "squirrels they eat in" (G). Only a
short distance S of Willow Cr. and back from the river near
-nE&#410;tcAñk'At. slAsyañkot was an alternate name for Willow Cr. and
+nE&#410;tcAñk'At. slAsyañkot was an alternate name for Willow Cr. and
the name of the village was derived from this.</p>
-<p>35. ne&#774;-chung-ket´ (M). On the E side of the river about
-1/2 mi. S of ah-chahng´-ket (Tip). The inhabitants were called
-ne&#774;´-chung ke-ah-hahng (Maj and Tip).</p>
+<p>35. ne&#774;-chung-ket´ (M). On the E side of the river about
+1/2 mi. S of ah-chahng´-ket (Tip). The inhabitants were called
+ne&#774;´-chung ke-ah-hahng (Maj and Tip).</p>
-<p>nE&#410;tcAñk'At, "ground black on" (G). Said to have been the
+<p>nE&#410;tcAñk'At, "ground black on" (G). Said to have been the
second one S of Willow Cr.</p>
<p>[It is evident that both Merriam and Goddard have the same
name here. Goddard's location is more precise and thus has been
accepted.]</p>
-<p>36. dabAstci'Añdañ, "ants' nest place" (G). A little way S
+<p>36. dabAstci'Añdañ, "ants' nest place" (G). A little way S
of the mouth of Willow Cr. The name comes from the name of Willow
-Cr.&mdash;dabActci'Añkot.</p>
+Cr.&mdash;dabActci'Añkot.</p>
<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_173" id="Page_173">[Pg 173]</a></span></p>
@@ -2277,14 +2240,14 @@ Indian Cr. The large village appears to have stood just a little E
of the NW corner of sec. 36, T. 5 S., R 6 E. Its inhabitants were
exterminated by mixed bands of white men and Kekawaka Indians.</p>
-<p>40. tah-bus-che-sahng´-tung (M). A small village in the hills
+<p>40. tah-bus-che-sahng´-tung (M). A small village in the hills
1 mi. E of the Eel R. and 1 mile S of Indian Cr. (Maj).</p>
<p>41. sE&#410;tcikyok'At, "red rock large on" (G). 1/4 mi. N of
the first creek downstream from North Fork on the E bank of the
main Eel.</p>
-<p>42. chug´-ge´-tah (M). A small village on the E side of the
+<p>42. chug´-ge´-tah (M). A small village on the E side of the
Eel N of the mouth of North Fork (Maj). It was about 2 mi. S of
Indian Cr.</p>
@@ -2296,11 +2259,11 @@ to the W of this rock and was named for it.</p>
same place but Merriam's location is so indefinite that their
identity is uncertain.]</p>
-<p>43. kai&#410;tcitadAñ, "redbud place" (G). A short distance N
+<p>43. kai&#410;tcitadAñ, "redbud place" (G). A short distance N
of the mouth of North Fork a ridge runs down to the river. On the
northern side of the ridge a village was situated.</p>
-<p>44. to&#772;n-klan´-be-ko-cho´-be (M). On the E side of the Eel
+<p>44. to&#772;n-klan´-be-ko-cho´-be (M). On the E side of the Eel
on the northern side of the mouth of North Fork (Tip).</p>
<p>ton&#410;Embi', "streams come together in" (G). Situated on a
@@ -2311,11 +2274,11 @@ them being large and deep.</p>
<p>[These two sites are evidently the same, since both the names
and the locations match.]</p>
-<p>45. sa&#772;´-tan-do´-che ke´-ah-hahng (M). In a rocky stretch on
+<p>45. sa&#772;´-tan-do´-che ke´-ah-hahng (M). In a rocky stretch on
the N side of the North Fork about 1/2 mi. above its junction with
the main Eel. The name means "rock reaching into water."</p>
-<p>sEtandoñtci, "rock runs to the water" (G). On the N bank of
+<p>sEtandoñtci, "rock runs to the water" (G). On the N bank of
North Fork about 1/2 mi. above the mouth.</p>
<p>46. sEntciyE, "rock large under" (G). About 3/4 mi. above the
@@ -2323,7 +2286,7 @@ mouth of North Fork. The rock for which it was named, with a large
spruce tree, stands opposite the village site, on the S side of the
stream.</p>
-<p>47. se&#774;-cho-ke´-ah-hahng (M). A village and band at
+<p>47. se&#774;-cho-ke´-ah-hahng (M). A village and band at
se&#774;-cho, "big rock," on the N side of the North Fork of the Eel
a mile or more above its mouth. "Thousands of Indians killed here"
(Maj).</p>
@@ -2353,22 +2316,22 @@ a house on the site.</p>
<p>51. totAkk'At, "between water" (G). Summer camp a little way
below the mouth of Wilson Cr. on the N side of North Fork.</p>
-<p>52. se&#410;tcidadAñ, "stone red mouth place" (G). An old
+<p>52. se&#410;tcidadAñ, "stone red mouth place" (G). An old
village, occupied before the whites came. It stood between no. 11
and the mouth of Wilson Cr.</p>
-<p>53. nolEtcotadAñ, "water falls large among" (G). On the N side
+<p>53. nolEtcotadAñ, "water falls large among" (G). On the N side
of North Fork about 1/2 mi. below Wilson Cr. It was on two levels;
one near the stream, the other on a terrace some yards N.</p>
-<p>54. ki´-ye ke´-ah-hahng (M). On North Fork at the mouth of
+<p>54. ki´-ye ke´-ah-hahng (M). On North Fork at the mouth of
Wilson Cr. and covering both sides of North Fork and Wilson Cr.
(Maj).</p>
<p>[This name is evidently the same as Goddard's name for the
-tribelet on North Fork above Wilson Cr.&mdash;kAiyEkiyahAñ.]</p>
+tribelet on North Fork above Wilson Cr.&mdash;kAiyEkiyahAñ.]</p>
-<p>55. sEnEsbInnAñkai, "rock tall its slope" (G). On the northern
+<p>55. sEnEsbInnAñkai, "rock tall its slope" (G). On the northern
side of North Fork and about midway E and W of sec. 12, T. 24
N., R. 14 W. is a tall rock called sEnEs. Just W of this was the
village.</p>
@@ -2378,7 +2341,7 @@ of North Fork opposite the tall rock mentioned in no. 55. The
informant said his uncle remembered the building of the dance house
when he was a small boy.</p>
-<p>57. sa&#772;´-yahs kun´-dung (M). A fishing camp for drying
+<p>57. sa&#772;´-yahs kun´-dung (M). A fishing camp for drying
salmon at Fishtown Spring or Upgraff fishery on North Fork about 5
mi. up, "march till creek dries up."</p>
@@ -2387,7 +2350,7 @@ place name whereas the former is not, so far as I can see.]</p>
<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_174" id="Page_174">[Pg 174]</a></span></p>
-<p>58. sEnEstconatAñkai, "rock tall large crossing" (G). A small
+<p>58. sEnEstconatAñkai, "rock tall large crossing" (G). A small
stream comes into North Fork about 1-1/2 mi. above Wilson Cr. The
village of this name was situated 1/2 mi. S of North Fork and just
to the W of this tributary. The village had not been occupied in
@@ -2397,18 +2360,18 @@ the memory of the informants.</p>
situated on the S side of North Fork just above the mouth of the
stream mentioned in no. 58 (G).</p>
-<p>60. sa&#772;h-gah´-ket, se-kah´-ke-ah-ahng, se-ki´-ah-hahng (M).
+<p>60. sa&#772;h-gah´-ket, se-kah´-ke-ah-ahng, se-ki´-ah-hahng (M).
A rancheria on the E side of the Eel R. on the S side of the mouth
-of North Fork (named for sa&#772;-gah-nah´-ting, the name of the land
+of North Fork (named for sa&#772;-gah-nah´-ting, the name of the land
on the S side of the mouth of North Fork in the angle between the
two rivers) (Tip).</p>
-<p>kai&#410;tcitadAñ, "redbud place" (G). This was apparently near
-Merriam's sa&#772;h-gah´-ket.</p>
+<p>kai&#410;tcitadAñ, "redbud place" (G). This was apparently near
+Merriam's sa&#772;h-gah´-ket.</p>
<p>[These different names may not represent the same village. If
these were two villages, they were very close together. Goddard
-gives kai&#410;tcitadAñ as the name of another village N of North
+gives kai&#410;tcitadAñ as the name of another village N of North
Fork (no. 43) so it may be an error here (see pl. 11, b for a view
of this region).]</p>
@@ -2416,9 +2379,9 @@ of this region).]</p>
the river a short distance above McDonald Cr. The Indians lived
here in the winter.</p>
-<p>62. ne-che´-cho-ket (M). On the E side of the Eel about a mile
+<p>62. ne-che´-cho-ket (M). On the E side of the Eel about a mile
S of the mouth of North Fork. It was apparently opposite part of
-the elongate village ning-ken-ne´-tset (no. 19). "Salmon stop here;
+the elongate village ning-ken-ne´-tset (no. 19). "Salmon stop here;
great fishing; rocky place; Red Hill ground" (Tip).</p>
<p>nE&#410;tcikyok'at, "ground red large on" (G). On a point of
@@ -2431,25 +2394,25 @@ the mouth of McDonald Creek a number of large rocks lie in the bed
of the river. This place is called nEtacbi', 'land slide in,' and
seems to have been a noted fishing place."]</p>
-<p>63. sah-nah´-chung-kut, sah-nah-chin´-che ke´-ah-hahng (M).
+<p>63. sah-nah´-chung-kut, sah-nah-chin´-che ke´-ah-hahng (M).
On the E side of the Eel R. 1-1/2 or 2 mi. S of the mouth of North
Fork and near McDonald Cr. (Tip).</p>
-<p>64. sel-di´-kot (M). On the E side of the Eel R. S of Bell
+<p>64. sel-di´-kot (M). On the E side of the Eel R. S of Bell
Springs Cr. (Maj).</p>
-<p>65. se&#774;-ski´-cho-ding (M). Claimed as a Wailaki village
+<p>65. se&#774;-ski´-cho-ding (M). Claimed as a Wailaki village
on the E side of the Eel R. at White Rock near Big Bend. On the
opposite side of the river from Bell Springs Station (Tip).</p>
-<p>se&#410;GaitcodAñ (G). On a flat on the E side of the river.
+<p>se&#410;GaitcodAñ (G). On a flat on the E side of the river.
"The east and west section line dividing sections 84 and 85 of T.
24 N., R. 14 W. was noted as passing through this flat."</p>
<p>[These two names doubtless represent the same village; the
names are similar and the locations are the same.]</p>
-<p>66. chin-to´-bin-nung (M). On the upper part of McDonald Cr.,
+<p>66. chin-to´-bin-nung (M). On the upper part of McDonald Cr.,
about 3 mi. up from the Eel (Maj).</p>
<p>67. chus-nah-teg-gul-lah chen-ne-tung (M). An old village
@@ -2469,38 +2432,38 @@ Alderpoint (1951), Hoaglin (1935), Leggett (1952), and Spyrock (1952).</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>Asbill Cr.&mdash;djoñot (G).</p>
+<p>Asbill Cr.&mdash;djoñot (G).</p>
-<p>Bell Springs Cr.&mdash;sAlt´okot (G).</p>
+<p>Bell Springs Cr.&mdash;sAlt´okot (G).</p>
-<p>Bell Springs Mt.&mdash;tsi-to´-ting; si-to´-ting (M). This is the
+<p>Bell Springs Mt.&mdash;tsi-to´-ting; si-to´-ting (M). This is the
mountain cut through by Bell Springs Cr.</p>
<p>Bell Springs Station (native name for the site of the
-station)&mdash;sah´-ten´-te&#774;´-te; sah-ten-te&#774;<sup>hl</sup>-te&#774; (M). Bell
+station)&mdash;sah´-ten´-te&#774;´-te; sah-ten-te&#774;<sup>hl</sup>-te&#774; (M). Bell
Springs Station is on the W side of the Eel about halfway between
Blue Rock Cr. and Bell Springs Cr., about the same place as village
22. In fact, Merriam's names for this site may correspond to
-Goddard's name for village 22, sa'kAntE&#410;dAñ.</p>
+Goddard's name for village 22, sa'kAntE&#410;dAñ.</p>
<p>Big Bend Cr.&mdash;dAndaikot (G).</p>
-<p>Blue Rock&mdash;sen-chah´-tung (M). Evidently this is near Blue
+<p>Blue Rock&mdash;sen-chah´-tung (M). Evidently this is near Blue
Rock Cr.</p>
-<p>Chamise Cr.&mdash;sah-nah´-ting; shah-nah-ting (M); canAndAñkot (G).</p>
+<p>Chamise Cr.&mdash;sah-nah´-ting; shah-nah-ting (M); canAndAñkot (G).</p>
-<p>Chamise Cr. crossing&mdash;ses-ki´-be (M).</p>
+<p>Chamise Cr. crossing&mdash;ses-ki´-be (M).</p>
-<p>Chamise Cr., mouth of&mdash;sun-ti´-che, soon-di´-che (M).</p>
+<p>Chamise Cr., mouth of&mdash;sun-ti´-che, soon-di´-che (M).</p>
-<p>Cinch Cr.&mdash;djoñkot (G). Goddard evidently has this creek
+<p>Cinch Cr.&mdash;djoñkot (G). Goddard evidently has this creek
placed incorrectly on his map. If I understand his description, it
should be a tributary of Bell Springs Cr. rather than of the Eel R.
directly.</p>
<p>Copper Mine Cr. (Tunnel Cr. on the more recent
-maps)&mdash;chis´-kot, che&#772;s-kot (M); tciskot (G). Both Merriam and
+maps)&mdash;chis´-kot, che&#772;s-kot (M); tciskot (G). Both Merriam and
Goddard say that this name refers to red paint and was probably
suggested by the color of the water in the creek. This is also
responsible for the English name.</p>
@@ -2508,10 +2471,10 @@ responsible for the English name.</p>
<p>Cottonwood Cr.&mdash;tgActcEkot (G). The English name is a
translation of the Wailaki name. The creek is unnamed on USGS maps.</p>
-<p>Dawson Flat&mdash;choo´-e-kun-tes´-te (M). This flat was W of Lake
+<p>Dawson Flat&mdash;choo´-e-kun-tes´-te (M). This flat was W of Lake
Mt. between Horse Ranch and Fenton Ranch.</p>
-<p>Eel R.&mdash;tan´-cho-kut (M). Eel R. valley&mdash;bus´-be (M). This
+<p>Eel R.&mdash;tan´-cho-kut (M). Eel R. valley&mdash;bus´-be (M). This
name refers to a part of the valley of the main Eel R., especially
the E side, between Horseshoe Bend and North Fork.</p>
@@ -2522,96 +2485,96 @@ the E side, between Horseshoe Bend and North Fork.</p>
<p>Eel R., Middle Fork&mdash;tahng-cho-skus (M). The junction of the
Middle Fork with the main Eel was called to&#772;s-kahs-ka&#772;.</p>
-<p>Eel R., North Fork&mdash;bah´-ne-kut (M); banikot (G).</p>
+<p>Eel R., North Fork&mdash;bah´-ne-kut (M); banikot (G).</p>
-<p>Eel R.-North Fork junction&mdash;cha&#772;-lin´-ding, kla&#772;-lin-ding
+<p>Eel R.-North Fork junction&mdash;cha&#772;-lin´-ding, kla&#772;-lin-ding
(M).</p>
-<p>Harris region&mdash;tah-sahn-ting´, tahs-ahng (M). Harris is a
+<p>Harris region&mdash;tah-sahn-ting´, tahs-ahng (M). Harris is a
small town about 8 mi. W of the main Eel R. in the territory of the
Lassik (according to Merriam's boundaries).</p>
-<p>Hettenshaw Valley&mdash;ken-tes´-tung (M). This valley is in Lassik
+<p>Hettenshaw Valley&mdash;ken-tes´-tung (M). This valley is in Lassik
territory about 12 mi. N of the Wailaki boundary. It lies between
the headwaters of the North Fork of the Eel and the headwaters of
the Van Duzen R.</p>
-<p>Horse Ranch Cr.&mdash;kus´-ken-tes´-be (M); canAñtcakot (G). These
+<p>Horse Ranch Cr.&mdash;kus´-ken-tes´-be (M); canAñtcakot (G). These
are clearly not the same names but sometimes streams have alternate
names. Cf. Willow Cr. below.</p>
<p>Horseshoe Bend&mdash;che&#772;s (M). The bend is named for the red
-copper spring of Copper Mine Cr. ki´-ke-che (M) is the name for
-the western part of the loop of Horseshoe Bend, to-sahng´-kut,
+copper spring of Copper Mine Cr. ki´-ke-che (M) is the name for
+the western part of the loop of Horseshoe Bend, to-sahng´-kut,
to&#772;s-ahng-kut (M) is the name of the part of Horseshoe Bend N of
Island Mt. Horseshoe Bend is the big switchback curve in the Eel R.
about 6 mi. N of the mouth of North Fork.</p>
-<p>Indian Cr.&mdash;chen-nes-no´-kut, ken´-nis-no´-kut (M). The name
+<p>Indian Cr.&mdash;chen-nes-no´-kut, ken´-nis-no´-kut (M). The name
Indian Cr. does not appear on any of the USGS maps but it is the
name used by Merriam.</p>
-<p>Island Mt.&mdash;bahng-kut, bahn-kut (M); bañk'At (G). Island Mt.
+<p>Island Mt.&mdash;bahng-kut, bahn-kut (M); bañk'At (G). Island Mt.
is a range of hills bordered on the E by the Eel R. and extending
from the mouth of North Fork in the S to beyond Horseshoe Bend in
the N.</p>
-<p>Jewett Cr.&mdash;sel-di´-kot (M); dAsk'Ekot (G).</p>
+<p>Jewett Cr.&mdash;sel-di´-kot (M); dAsk'Ekot (G).</p>
-<p>Kekawaka Cr.&mdash;kas-na&#772;´-kot, kahs´-ne-kot (M); kasnaikot (G).</p>
+<p>Kekawaka Cr.&mdash;kas-na&#772;´-kot, kahs´-ne-kot (M); kasnaikot (G).</p>
-<p>Lake Mt.&mdash;sa&#772;-kahn-den, se-kahn´-ting (M). Lake Mt. is about
+<p>Lake Mt.&mdash;sa&#772;-kahn-den, se-kahn´-ting (M). Lake Mt. is about
3 mi. E of the Eel and 3 mi. N of North Fork.</p>
-<p>McDonald Cr.&mdash;sah´-nah-chin-che (M); canAñtcIntci (G).</p>
+<p>McDonald Cr.&mdash;sah´-nah-chin-che (M); canAñtcIntci (G).</p>
-<p>Middle Trail&mdash;be-ten-na´-be (M). This trail was in the hills E
+<p>Middle Trail&mdash;be-ten-na´-be (M). This trail was in the hills E
of the Eel R. about a mile south of Indian Cr.</p>
-<p>Mina&mdash;to-les´ cho´-be (M). Mina is a modern place name for a
+<p>Mina&mdash;to-les´ cho´-be (M). Mina is a modern place name for a
town about 2 mi. N of North Fork and 5 mi. E of the main Eel R.</p>
-<p>Natoikot Cr.&mdash;no-toi´-kut (M); natoikot (G). I have given this
+<p>Natoikot Cr.&mdash;no-toi´-kut (M); natoikot (G). I have given this
creek its Wailaki name because it has no English name and is not,
in fact, located on modern maps. It is said to have run into the
Eel R. about 1-1/2 mi. S of Island Mt. Station, which is on the
southern side of Horseshoe Bend. It has been placed on the map in
accordance with the topography shown on USGS Hoaglin Quadrangle.</p>
-<p>Pine Cr.&mdash;ten-di´-kot (M); lacEtcikot (G). Merriam was not
+<p>Pine Cr.&mdash;ten-di´-kot (M); lacEtcikot (G). Merriam was not
certain that his name was correct.</p>
-<p>Pipe Cr.&mdash;taht-so´-kut (M).</p>
+<p>Pipe Cr.&mdash;taht-so´-kut (M).</p>
-<p>Poonkinny Ridge&mdash;nel-kis´-te (M). Merriam says this is the
+<p>Poonkinny Ridge&mdash;nel-kis´-te (M). Merriam says this is the
name of the open ridge between the main Eel R. and the northern
part of Round V. That area is marked Poonkinny Ridge on the USGS
Spyrock Quadrangle. It is in Yuki territory.</p>
-<p>Rattlesnake Cr.&mdash;to-nah´-ling (M). This creek is a tributary
+<p>Rattlesnake Cr.&mdash;to-nah´-ling (M). This creek is a tributary
of the South Fork of the Eel R. and forms a part of the southern
boundary of the Eel River Wailaki, according to Merriam.</p>
-<p>Rockpile Mt.&mdash;sen´-ning ah´-kut (M). This mountain is said to
+<p>Rockpile Mt.&mdash;sen´-ning ah´-kut (M). This mountain is said to
be on the E side of the Eel R. S of Alder Point, but the name does
not appear on modern maps.</p>
-<p>Round V.&mdash;ken´-tes-cho´-be (M). The inhabitants of Round V.
-were called ken´-tes cho´-be ke´-ah, a locative rather than a
+<p>Round V.&mdash;ken´-tes-cho´-be (M). The inhabitants of Round V.
+were called ken´-tes cho´-be ke´-ah, a locative rather than a
tribal name.</p>
-<p>Summit V.&mdash;ken-tes´&#410;-be (M). Summit V. lies about 2 mi. SE
+<p>Summit V.&mdash;ken-tes´&#410;-be (M). Summit V. lies about 2 mi. SE
of the bend of North Fork and seems to have marked the southeastern
limit of North Fork Wailaki territory. It is said that there was
once much camass there.</p>
-<p>Willow Cr.&mdash;dabActci'Añkot, slAsyañkot (G). The latter was
+<p>Willow Cr.&mdash;dabActci'Añkot, slAsyañkot (G). The latter was
used occasionally for the stream.</p>
<p>Wilson Cr.&mdash;dat'olkot (G).</p></blockquote>
-<h4>ETHNOZOÖLOGY AND ETHNOBOTANY</h4>
+<h4>ETHNOZOÖLOGY AND ETHNOBOTANY</h4>
<p>The following notes are from Merriam's records.</p>
@@ -2744,8 +2707,8 @@ Mountain and Bell Springs.</p>
<p>The rest of the information on the Pitch Wailaki presented here concerns
tribelet and village organization and is taken from Goddard (1924). He
lists four tribelets among the Pitch Wailaki (Roman numerals, map 6).:
-I, t'odAnnAñ kiyahAñ; II, t'okya kiyahAñ; III, tc'i'añkot kiyahAñ; IV,
-tcokot kiyahAñ.</p>
+I, t'odAnnAñ kiyahAñ; II, t'okya kiyahAñ; III, tc'i'añkot kiyahAñ; IV,
+tcokot kiyahAñ.</p>
<h4>VILLAGES</h4>
@@ -2753,38 +2716,38 @@ tcokot kiyahAñ.</p>
<p>The villages belonging to each of these tribelets are listed below
(Arabic number, map 6). All are from Goddard's lists.</p>
-<p>I. <i>t'odAnnAñ kiyahAñ</i></p>
+<p>I. <i>t'odAnnAñ kiyahAñ</i></p>
<blockquote>
-<p>1. t'otcadAñ. On the N side of North Fork not far below the
+<p>1. t'otcadAñ. On the N side of North Fork not far below the
mouth of Hulls Creek. The site was sheltered by ridges on the E and
W and by the main mountainside on the N. Four pits were counted.</p>
<p>This was the only site visited but the names of other villages
of the group were obtained. In their order downstream from Hulls
-Creek they are AntcAnyacbAnnAñ, "pepperwood slope;" sEtcAmmi';
-nE&#410;&gamma;indAñ; lawasonk'ait; t'AntcankyodAñ. At this last
+Creek they are AntcAnyacbAnnAñ, "pepperwood slope;" sEtcAmmi';
+nE&#410;&gamma;indAñ; lawasonk'ait; t'AntcankyodAñ. At this last
there is said to have been a large conical earth-covered lodge and
many dwellings.</p></blockquote>
-<p>II. <i>t'okya kiyahAñ</i></p>
+<p>II. <i>t'okya kiyahAñ</i></p>
<blockquote>
-<p>2. &#410;Eliñkyobi', "streams flow together large in." On the
+<p>2. &#410;Eliñkyobi', "streams flow together large in." On the
W side of North Fork just upstream from the mouth of Hulls Creek,
situated close to the hillside on a bench about 50 ft. higher than
the river. The site is divided by a gulch on the upstream side of
which, it was said, there had once been houses. Four distinct pits
and 3 less distinct ones were seen there.</p>
-<p>3. tAntcInyasbAnnAñ. Nearly opposite nando'ndAñ on a point
+<p>3. tAntcInyasbAnnAñ. Nearly opposite nando'ndAñ on a point
of land running toward the SW. About 75 ft. above the stream 2
pits, one above the other, were seen. No more could well have been
accommodated.</p>
-<p>4. nando'ndAñ. On the E side of the river and about 1/4 mi.
+<p>4. nando'ndAñ. On the E side of the river and about 1/4 mi.
above the mouth of Hulls Creek, 30 ft. above the bed of North Fork.
Four house pits were counted there, one of which was 15 ft. in
diameter and 5 ft. deep. This was the village of Goodboy Jack's
@@ -2792,7 +2755,7 @@ father.</p>
<p>5. kAllata. Named for a big jagged rock standing N of the
village site. It was on the W side of the river<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_177" id="Page_177">[Pg 177]</a></span> 1/4 mi. N of
-tAntcInyasbAnnAñ and 300 ft. higher than the river. A grove of oaks
+tAntcInyasbAnnAñ and 300 ft. higher than the river. A grove of oaks
stands on a rounded point where 3 house pits were seen. A gulch on
the southern side furnished water in winter.</p>
@@ -2801,7 +2764,7 @@ upstream from kAllata. The site is on a wide point of land covered
with oaks and pepperwood trees. There is a sheer rock on the
opposite side of the river. Three pits were seen here.</p>
-<p>7. tAltcAskIñ. Named from a knoll, tAltcAs. Situated on the
+<p>7. tAltcAskIñ. Named from a knoll, tAltcAs. Situated on the
slope of a large ridge around the end of which North Fork swings,
from flowing SE, to S. It was about 500 ft. higher than the stream
and distant from it about 1/8 mi. Here once stood an earth lodge,
@@ -2812,13 +2775,13 @@ Messengers had been sent out to invite people from a distance of
two days' travel and Indians from the main Eel R. and from the
north were present.</p>
-<p>8. sAñ'AnyE. Named from a very large rock standing on the
+<p>8. sAñ'AnyE. Named from a very large rock standing on the
E side of the river. The village was on the W side a little
downstream from this rock. On a bench 30 ft. above the river bed
were seen 5 house pits and above were 6 more, one above the other,
on the slope. In this village lived tAntcAnyacta', who had charge
-of the earth lodge at tAltcAskIñ, and si'idonta, who was "boss" of
-all the villages of the t'okya kiyahAñ, especially when they camped
+of the earth lodge at tAltcAskIñ, and si'idonta, who was "boss" of
+all the villages of the t'okya kiyahAñ, especially when they camped
together in summertime.</p>
<div class="figcenter" style="width: 487px;">
@@ -2828,21 +2791,21 @@ Wailaki. Roman numerals indicate tribelets according to Goddard
(1929); arabic numerals mark village sites.</p></div>
</div>
-<p>9. t'AntcAntantE&#410;dAñ, "pepperwood flat." About 100 yds. S
+<p>9. t'AntcAntantE&#410;dAñ, "pepperwood flat." About 100 yds. S
of the large rock called kai&#410;tsotci on a small bench on the
mountainside about 1,000 ft. above North Fork. Three pits were
found. A rock shelter higher on the hillside and to the S was
pointed out. At this village, shortly before the coming of white
people, lived dA&gamma;a'tco, "large beard," chief of this
-village and of annEnE'tcAñ, of all the t'okya kiyahAñ, in fact. He
+village and of annEnE'tcAñ, of all the t'okya kiyahAñ, in fact. He
was succeeded by his son kissEkE', who was killed by the whites.</p>
-<p>10. kai&#410;tsotci canAndAñ. Named for the large rock
+<p>10. kai&#410;tsotci canAndAñ. Named for the large rock
kai&#410;tsotci, under the shelter of which the village stood. Four
pits were seen here and N of a small ridge were 3 others.</p>
-<p>11. annEnE'tcAñ. On the NE side of the river stand two huge
-rocks, the upstream one called sE&#410;tcAnnAñ, the downstream one
+<p>11. annEnE'tcAñ. On the NE side of the river stand two huge
+rocks, the upstream one called sE&#410;tcAnnAñ, the downstream one
sAnAn. Between these two rocks flows a creek and on its N side, 75
ft. below the summit of the rocks, were 3 house pits in a hollow.
A little S and 100 ft. higher were found in succession 3, 2, and 5
@@ -2852,27 +2815,27 @@ pits.</p>
ravine and about 900 ft. higher than the bed of North Fork. Four
pits were found.</p>
-<p>13. mIstco'ca'nAndAñ. Up the hill from no. 12. It was not
+<p>13. mIstco'ca'nAndAñ. Up the hill from no. 12. It was not
visited.</p>
-<p>14. sE&#410;tcAnnAnt'a. Named for a high rock, sE&#410;tcAnnAñ, on
+<p>14. sE&#410;tcAnnAnt'a. Named for a high rock, sE&#410;tcAnnAñ, on
the S side of which there are 5 pits and, 100 yds. below, 6 more.
The site is about 700 ft. above North Fork and has a wonderful
outlook on the valley of that stream.</p>
-<p>15. k'AckAntE&#410;dAñ, "alder flat." On the W side of the river
+<p>15. k'AckAntE&#410;dAñ, "alder flat." On the W side of the river
on a curving bench. Two pits were found close to the hillside, and
2 nearer to the stream. Downstream on a little bench there were
also 2 indistinct ones, said by Jack to have been used long ago.</p>
-<p>16. sE&#410;tcAnnAñ yE. At the base of the rock mentioned in no.
+<p>16. sE&#410;tcAnnAñ yE. At the base of the rock mentioned in no.
14. Three pits were found on a small bench.</p></blockquote>
-<p>III. <i>tc'i'añkot kiyahAñ</i></p>
+<p>III. <i>tc'i'añkot kiyahAñ</i></p>
<blockquote>
-<p>17. lonbAstEdAñ. On a flat on the S side of Casoose Cr. a
+<p>17. lonbAstEdAñ. On a flat on the S side of Casoose Cr. a
short way above its mouth. There were some unoccupied buildings
there at the time of Goddard's visit. The place was seen from the
trail on the N side of the creek.</p>
@@ -2883,7 +2846,7 @@ the creek below no. 25.</p>
<p>19. Goddard gives no name or other information for this
village but it is shown on his map.</p>
-<p>20. sEttcitcikItdatdAñ, Named for a rock, settci. It was at
+<p>20. sEttcitcikItdatdAñ, Named for a rock, settci. It was at
the base of a mountain on the N side of the creek and just above
the flood waters. It had a good SE exposure. Three pits in a row
were found.</p>
@@ -2897,42 +2860,42 @@ this far.</p>
<p>22. kIlkokyodAn. On the S side of the butte mentioned in no.
23 and about 100 yds. distant. Four large pits were noticed.</p>
-<p>23. kIkokyokInnEdAñ. Named for the bushy butte at the base of
+<p>23. kIkokyokInnEdAñ. Named for the bushy butte at the base of
which the village stood. The site is 100 ft. higher than the creek,
on its NW side just below a canyon. Three pits were seen.</p>
-<p>24. mAñk'AtdAñ. Named from a small pond, near which are
+<p>24. mAñk'AtdAñ. Named from a small pond, near which are
deserted buildings and an old orchard. A hundred yards NE of this
pond, back against the hill, 4 pits were found in a row, 2 more
above them, and 2 others near by, making 8 altogether. The last
-chief of this village was named tcAsnainIñaita'.</p>
+chief of this village was named tcAsnainIñaita'.</p>
<p>25. I&#410;t'Aktcibi'. Named from black oaks. It is nearer the
creek than no. 24. The number of pits was not recorded but signs of
a village there were unmistakable.</p>
-<p>26. t'AntcigIt'tcAñ. On the W side of the creek nearly
+<p>26. t'AntcigIt'tcAñ. On the W side of the creek nearly
opposite no. 27. It was N of a small creek with running water and
of a ridge which runs down to the main creek and terminates in a
great, nearly sheer cliff. The village site is about 500 ft. higher
than the stream. Eight pits in two rows were counted.</p>
-<p>27. k'aickontE&#410;dAñ. On the E side of Casoose Cr. on a flat
+<p>27. k'aickontE&#410;dAñ. On the E side of Casoose Cr. on a flat
100 ft. higher than the creek, which flows just below it. The
village site is near a post which marked the old boundary between
Trinity and Mendocino counties. Two pits were seen.</p>
-<p>28. tc'iañmiyE. On the E side of and 100 ft. higher than
+<p>28. tc'iañmiyE. On the E side of and 100 ft. higher than
Casoose Cr. It was 100 yds. downstream from the beginning of the
canyon. Five pits were counted.</p></blockquote>
-<p>IV. <i>tcokot kiyahAñ</i></p>
+<p>IV. <i>tcokot kiyahAñ</i></p>
<p>The winter villages of this group were on Red Mountain Cr. Goodboy Jack
said that he did not know the village names. The impression had been
received that Salt Creek V. was inhabited but Jack said it was too cold
to live there in the winter. Presumably it was the hunting ground of the
-tcokot kiyahAñ.</p>
+tcokot kiyahAñ.</p>
<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_178" id="Page_178">[Pg 178]</a></span></p>
@@ -3047,7 +3010,7 @@ above Alder Pt.</p></blockquote>
<p>There is some ambiguity in Merriam's notes on the status of the Lassik
living in the western part of their territory near the South Fork of
the Eel. The Sinkyone George Burt told Merriam that a group called the
-To-kub´-be ke´ah or To´-kah-be held the land on the east side of South
+To-kub´-be ke´ah or To´-kah-be held the land on the east side of South
Fork from Rocky Glen Creek south to above Garberville. This tribe was
said to be centered on the east branch of South Fork and in the Harris
region and to be a different tribe from the one on the main Eel River
@@ -3067,34 +3030,34 @@ correct name may not be assigned to each site.</p>
<h5><i>Goddard's Lassik Villages</i></h5>
<p>
-<span style="margin-left: 1.5em;">1. gastci&#772;kdûñ</span><br />
-<span style="margin-left: 1.5em;">2. ko&#772;nte<sup>l</sup>tci&#772;dûñ</span><br />
-<span style="margin-left: 1.5em;">3. satcini&#772;tci&#772;dûñ</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1.5em;">1. gastci&#772;kdûñ</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1.5em;">2. ko&#772;nte<sup>l</sup>tci&#772;dûñ</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1.5em;">3. satcini&#772;tci&#772;dûñ</span><br />
<span style="margin-left: 1.5em;">4. naslintce</span><br />
-<span style="margin-left: 1.5em;">5. ist'etatci&#772;dûñ</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1.5em;">5. ist'etatci&#772;dûñ</span><br />
<span style="margin-left: 1.5em;">6. to&#772;kseye</span><br />
-<span style="margin-left: 1.5em;">7. kiñk'ûteko&#772;nte<sup>l</sup>dûñ</span><br />
-<span style="margin-left: 1.5em;">8. k'ûcto&#772;to&#772;dûñ</span><br />
-<span style="margin-left: 1.5em;">9. di&#772;yi&#772;ckûk</span><br />
-<span style="margin-left: 1em;">10. nûndûkkatûndûñ</span><br />
-<span style="margin-left: 1em;">11. ko&#772;nte<sup>l</sup>tci&#772;dûñ</span><br />
-<span style="margin-left: 1em;">12. go&#772;sno&#772;lindûñ</span><br />
-<span style="margin-left: 1em;">13. to&#772;tcadûñ</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1.5em;">7. kiñk'ûteko&#772;nte<sup>l</sup>dûñ</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1.5em;">8. k'ûcto&#772;to&#772;dûñ</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1.5em;">9. di&#772;yi&#772;ckûk</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">10. nûndûkkatûndûñ</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">11. ko&#772;nte<sup>l</sup>tci&#772;dûñ</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">12. go&#772;sno&#772;lindûñ</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">13. to&#772;tcadûñ</span><br />
<span style="margin-left: 1em;">14. saito&#772;tci&#772;</span><br />
-<span style="margin-left: 1em;">15. nûnsûn<sup>l</sup>tci&#772;kkinne<sup>&epsilon;</sup>dûñ</span><br />
-<span style="margin-left: 1em;">16. yi&#772;stcûttcadûñ</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">15. nûnsûn<sup>l</sup>tci&#772;kkinne<sup>&epsilon;</sup>dûñ</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">16. yi&#772;stcûttcadûñ</span><br />
<span style="margin-left: 1em;">17. toisi&#772;bi&#772;</span><br />
-<span style="margin-left: 1em;">18. lesbatci&#772;tdûñ</span><br />
-<span style="margin-left: 1em;">19. k'ûstci&#772;kdûñ</span><br />
-<span style="margin-left: 1em;">20. tcûggûstatci&#772;<sup>&epsilon;</sup></span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">18. lesbatci&#772;tdûñ</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">19. k'ûstci&#772;kdûñ</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">20. tcûggûstatci&#772;<sup>&epsilon;</sup></span><br />
<span style="margin-left: 1em;">21. lesbaitci&#772;<sup>&epsilon;</sup></span><br />
<span style="margin-left: 1em;">22. setatci&#772;<sup>&epsilon;</sup></span><br />
-<span style="margin-left: 1em;">23. kasto&#772;ntci&#772;<sup>&epsilon;</sup>dûñ</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">23. kasto&#772;ntci&#772;<sup>&epsilon;</sup>dûñ</span><br />
</p>
<p>Goddard lists other names, presumably for the Lassik villages, as
-follows: sekû&#410;ne, tectatalindûñ, dûltci&#772;kyacdûñ, t'o-todûñ,
-k'ûsnesdûñ, ne ga bi&#772;, kûttantci&#772;tco&#772;dûñ. The sites corresponding
+follows: sekû&#410;ne, tectatalindûñ, dûltci&#772;kyacdûñ, t'o-todûñ,
+k'ûsnesdûñ, ne ga bi&#772;, kûttantci&#772;tco&#772;dûñ. The sites corresponding
to these names cannot be located.</p>
<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_180" id="Page_180">[Pg 180]</a></span></p>
@@ -3140,20 +3103,20 @@ Round Valley on the south, thus including the Athapaskan Wilakke." In
anthropological literature, however, especially in the work of Kroeber
and Goddard, this name has come to be used for the group living between
Iaqua Buttes and Mad River on the north and Dobbyn Creek on the south.
-Merriam's name for this group is Kit-tel´. He does not seem to have
+Merriam's name for this group is Kit-tel´. He does not seem to have
obtained any information from them although one of his notes mentions
the fact that the wife of George Burt, his Lolangkok Sinkyone informant,
-was a Kit-tel´ woman.</p>
+was a Kit-tel´ woman.</p>
<p>At times Merriam seems to have confused the Nongatl with the Lassik. In
his general statement on the Nongatl, which follows, he lists them as
-Lassik although the area in which he places them marks them as Kit-tel´
+Lassik although the area in which he places them marks them as Kit-tel´
or Nongatl.</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>Las´sik ... Name (from Chief Lassik, now dead) in common use
-for a Non-ga´h<sup>hl</sup> tribe occupying a rather large area, extending
+<p>Las´sik ... Name (from Chief Lassik, now dead) in common use
+for a Non-ga´h<sup>hl</sup> tribe occupying a rather large area, extending
from Iaqua Butte in the latitude of the mouth of Eel River,
southerly to Dobbyn Creek and to the head of Van Duzen River, and
from the eastern boundary of the Lolahnkok of Bull Creek and South
@@ -3165,12 +3128,12 @@ the main Eel; thus including the entire course and drainage area of
Larrabee Creek.</p>
<p>There is doubt as to the northern boundary of the so-called
-Las´sik for the reason that I have not been able to obtain the
+Las´sik for the reason that I have not been able to obtain the
necessary vocabularies for comparison. Goddard's information points
to a division south of the Bridgeville region but I have been told
-by both the Nek´-kan-ni´ of Bear River and the Lolahnko&#772;k of Bull
+by both the Nek´-kan-ni´ of Bear River and the Lolahnko&#772;k of Bull
Creek and South Fork Eel that the language is exactly the same from
-Iaqua Butte southerly and that the languages of the Nek´-kan-ni´
+Iaqua Butte southerly and that the languages of the Nek´-kan-ni´
and Lo-lahn-ko&#772;k do not differ essentially from that of the
Larrabee Creek region.</p>
@@ -3181,8 +3144,8 @@ allied dialects.</p>
<p>However, since the entire drainage basin of Larrabee Creek is
included in their territory, it may be desirable to adopt the term
-Kos´-ten ke´-ah, by which term the Larrabee Creek band was known to
-neighbors on the south&mdash;the Set-ten-bi´-den ke-ah.</p></blockquote>
+Kos´-ten ke´-ah, by which term the Larrabee Creek band was known to
+neighbors on the south&mdash;the Set-ten-bi´-den ke-ah.</p></blockquote>
<h4>SUBGROUPS</h4>
@@ -3200,28 +3163,28 @@ boundaries. These were as follows.</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>bûsko&#772;tki&#772;ya. In the neighborhood of Indian Cr. in the
+<p>bûsko&#772;tki&#772;ya. In the neighborhood of Indian Cr. in the
upper part of the drainage of Yager Cr. (map 9).</p>
-<p>tcillûndûñ. On the upper reaches of North Yager Cr. (map 9).</p>
+<p>tcillûndûñ. On the upper reaches of North Yager Cr. (map 9).</p>
-<p>bûstco&#772;bi&#772;ki&#772;ya. In the vicinity of the junction of
+<p>bûstco&#772;bi&#772;ki&#772;ya. In the vicinity of the junction of
North and Middle Yager creeks. The language of this group was said
to be the same as that of the tcittelki&#772;ya (map 9).</p>
-<p>senûñka. On upper Larabee Cr. in the vicinity of Blocksburg
+<p>senûñka. On upper Larabee Cr. in the vicinity of Blocksburg
(pl. 10, <i>e</i>, <i>f</i>). This no doubt is the same as Essene's
Kuskatundun, which was the Lassik name for the group (map 10).</p>
<p>tcittelki&#772;ya. On the Van Duzen R. above Bridgeville. Appears
-to be the same name as Merriam's Kit-tel´.</p>
+to be the same name as Merriam's Kit-tel´.</p>
<p>na'aitciki&#772;ya. On the Van Duzen above the tcittelki&#772;ya
group. This name appears on the Goddard map from which map 1 was
taken but is not otherwise recorded. This is evidently the same as
Essene's Nai'aitci.</p>
-<p>ko&#772;sdûñki&#772;ya. On the South Fork of the Van Duzen,
+<p>ko&#772;sdûñki&#772;ya. On the South Fork of the Van Duzen,
including Larabee V.</p></blockquote>
@@ -3232,7 +3195,7 @@ unpublished notes (maps 7, 9, 10). This is evidently far from a complete
count but it is clear that there were about as many villages in the area
covered by these maps as in other parts of the Athabascan area.</p>
-<h5><i>bûsko&#772;tki&#772;ya group (1-7, map 9)</i></h5>
+<h5><i>bûsko&#772;tki&#772;ya group (1-7, map 9)</i></h5>
<blockquote>
@@ -3259,7 +3222,7 @@ He hunted all around here without finding other pits.</p>
region.</p></div>
</div>
-<p>3. k'onûsebi&#772;'. On a point running down SSW toward Indian
+<p>3. k'onûsebi&#772;'. On a point running down SSW toward Indian
Cr. There were two pits near the creek and two more 200 ft. up the
hill. A few large and small oaks were growing there. Water was to
be had a few yards E. Pete saw a house there when he was a boy.</p>
@@ -3285,7 +3248,7 @@ small streams N and S of the ridge. Goddard did not visit the place
but it was pointed out by Pete as W of a big Douglas spruce tree
and a large rock. Goddard described it as above.</p></blockquote>
-<h5><i>tcillûndûñ group (8-12, map 9)</i></h5>
+<h5><i>tcillûndûñ group (8-12, map 9)</i></h5>
<blockquote>
@@ -3309,7 +3272,7 @@ from the north. On the W side of the creek on a rounded ridge were
Pete saw 2 large deep pits. They were about 1/4 mi. downstream from
the branch where village 10 was found.</p>
-<p>12. tse'dûttc<sup>l</sup>bûtta'dûñ. A half-mile N of North Yager Cr.
+<p>12. tse'dûttc<sup>l</sup>bûtta'dûñ. A half-mile N of North Yager Cr.
at the edge of Douglas spruce and tanbark oak timber. Stones used
by the Indians were lying near the water and 2 pits were found
there. To the W, on the crest of the ridge, there were 5 pits at
@@ -3320,17 +3283,17 @@ Creek but they are not named and their locations are indefinite so they
will not be given here.</p>
-<h5><i>bûstco&#772;bi&#772;ki&#772;ya group (13-18, map 9)</i></h5>
+<h5><i>bûstco&#772;bi&#772;ki&#772;ya group (13-18, map 9)</i></h5>
<blockquote>
-<p>13. senindûsci&#772;mi&#772;. On the W bank of North Yager Cr. 1/4
+<p>13. senindûsci&#772;mi&#772;. On the W bank of North Yager Cr. 1/4
mi. below a waterfall of the same name. Two pits were located 100
ft. above the creek in brush and timber. On the same side of the
creek but 1/4 mi. downstream were 4 more pits, in one of which a
sekal lay.</p>
-<p>14. nakato&#772;dûñ. On the E side of North Yager Cr., on a flat
+<p>14. nakato&#772;dûñ. On the E side of North Yager Cr., on a flat
now covered with huckleberry brush. Pete found 2 pits here. On the
W side of the creek, a little downstream, were 2 more pits. The
flat had been badly washed away by freshets.</p>
@@ -3342,7 +3305,7 @@ the junction of North and Middle Yager creeks.</p>
the timber on a point running down toward Middle Yager Cr. were 4
pits.</p>
-<p>17. ko&#772;ntco&#772;wetci&#772;kinnedûñ. About 1/4 mi. N of Middle
+<p>17. ko&#772;ntco&#772;wetci&#772;kinnedûñ. About 1/4 mi. N of Middle
Yager Cr. On a small flat on a hillside, facing SW in open timber
above a small stream. There were 7 pits here. Pete had heard that
there used to be a village so situated.</p>
@@ -3351,14 +3314,14 @@ there used to be a village so situated.</p>
shows signs of occupation and there is a pit near by.</p></blockquote>
-<h5><i>senûñka group (19-35, map 10)</i></h5>
+<h5><i>senûñka group (19-35, map 10)</i></h5>
<blockquote>
<p>19. On a little point 200 yds. N of Curless' house. There is
one pit. Charlie Taylor's grandmother was born here, according to
Curless, who showed the site to Goddard. This was the most northern
-village of the senûñka on Larabee Cr.</p>
+village of the senûñka on Larabee Cr.</p>
<p>20. t'o&#772;kintcabi&#772;'. On the hillside on either side of the
stream which crosses the road about a mile S of Curless' place.
@@ -3380,7 +3343,7 @@ Pete of such a place where there used to be many Indians.</p>
<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_183" id="Page_183">[Pg 183]</a></span></p>
-<p>22. k'ûcna'aidûñ (?). In a swag on the W side of a gulch lined
+<p>22. k'ûcna'aidûñ (?). In a swag on the W side of a gulch lined
with Douglas spruce and tanbark oak timber with exposure toward the
S. There are 5 distinct pits.</p>
@@ -3403,7 +3366,7 @@ Goddard was not sure of them.</p>
<p>27. On the N side of a large branch of Larabee Cr. from the E,
200 yds. N of where it is joined by a stream from the N. The stream
-from the E is bûstadûñko&#772;t. There were 3 pits among the Douglas
+from the E is bûstadûñko&#772;t. There were 3 pits among the Douglas
spruce and black oaks.</p>
<p>28. On the E side of the Eel R. about 3/4 mi. N of the mouth
@@ -3435,7 +3398,7 @@ of Mill Cr. on a brushy point. There were 5 pits.</p>
<p>34. On the E side of the Eel R. N of the mouth of Mill Cr.
just S of a big rock. There were 2 pits.</p>
-<p>35. nadaitcûñ. This name was supplied by Charlie in 1908 as
+<p>35. nadaitcûñ. This name was supplied by Charlie in 1908 as
belonging to the village at the mouth of a large creek on the E
side of the Eel R. above Coleman Cr. </p>
</blockquote>
@@ -3479,13 +3442,13 @@ taken verbatim from that source.</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>The Lo-lahn´-ko&#772;k. Information is from George Burt, a member
+<p>The Lo-lahn´-ko&#772;k. Information is from George Burt, a member
of the tribe, who was raised on Bull Creek at the rancheria called
-Kahs-cho´-chin-net´-tah about seven miles upstream from Dyerville,
+Kahs-cho´-chin-net´-tah about seven miles upstream from Dyerville,
at a place now known as Schoolhouse Flat, and who now lives near
Fortuna (1922).</p>
-<p>The territory of the Lo-lahn´-ko&#772;k began on the north at
+<p>The territory of the Lo-lahn´-ko&#772;k began on the north at
Shively and covered a narrow strip on the east side of the main Eel
River to Dyerville, and a much broader area on the west side, and
continued southerly on the west side of South Fork Eel River nearly
@@ -3517,14 +3480,14 @@ woman named Sally Bell.</p></div>
<blockquote>
-<p>To´-cho´-be ke´ah is their own name and the Lolahnkok name
+<p>To´-cho´-be ke´ah is their own name and the Lolahnkok name
for the tribe (and village) in the Briceland region (between the
South Fork of the Eel and the coast). It is used also in a larger
sense for all bands speaking the same dialect from the west side of
the South Fork of the Eel River (in the Garberville region) to the
-coast. The Set´tenbi´den [Lassik] call this group Yis-sing´-kun-ne.
-The name of the group is pronounced To-cho´-be ke´ah by the
-Lolahn´ko&#772;k and Taw-chaw´-be-ke´ah by themselves.</p></blockquote>
+coast. The Set´tenbi´den [Lassik] call this group Yis-sing´-kun-ne.
+The name of the group is pronounced To-cho´-be ke´ah by the
+Lolahn´ko&#772;k and Taw-chaw´-be-ke´ah by themselves.</p></blockquote>
<h4>TRIBELETS</h4>
@@ -3539,7 +3502,7 @@ village names." These names are no doubt those of tribelets.</p>
<p>chi-chin-kah ke-ah (Merriam). This is the name for the
tribelet between the upper waters of Bull Cr. and Elk Ridge.
-Nomland gives the name chacingu´k for the group in the ridge N of
+Nomland gives the name chacingu´k for the group in the ridge N of
Briceland, which is evidently Elk Ridge.</p>
<p>yese'kuk (Nomland). This is given as the Mattole R. area,
@@ -3638,51 +3601,51 @@ Goddard's original work.</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>1. lah-sa&#772;-se´-te (M). At Shively on the main Eel R.</p>
+<p>1. lah-sa&#772;-se´-te (M). At Shively on the main Eel R.</p>
-<p>2. kah´-li-cho´-be, "growing flat" (M). At a place now called
+<p>2. kah´-li-cho´-be, "growing flat" (M). At a place now called
Englewood, a small settlement 9 mi. E of Scotia bridge. The name is
said to refer to things growing up there.</p>
-<p>3. seûstcelindûñ (G). On the S bank of the main Eel not far
+<p>3. seûstcelindûñ (G). On the S bank of the main Eel not far
downstream from Dyerville.</p>
-<p>4. to&#772;nesdadûñ (G). On the NE bank of the Eel directly
-across from seûstcelindûñ.</p>
+<p>4. to&#772;nesdadûñ (G). On the NE bank of the Eel directly
+across from seûstcelindûñ.</p>
<p>5. tetcinne (G). On the E side of the Eel upstream from
-to&#772;nesdadûñ. A big rock, pointing downstream, is said to project
+to&#772;nesdadûñ. A big rock, pointing downstream, is said to project
into the river there.</p>
-<p>6. tûggûstco&#772; dasañke (G). On the E side of the Eel S of
+<p>6. tûggûstco&#772; dasañke (G). On the E side of the Eel S of
tetcinne. A large rancheria in an open place.</p>
-<p>7. naltcûñka (G). On the W side of Eel R. S of tûggûstco&#772;
-dasañke. There is a big slide there. It is below Camp Grant on the
+<p>7. naltcûñka (G). On the W side of Eel R. S of tûggûstco&#772;
+dasañke. There is a big slide there. It is below Camp Grant on the
S side, according to Charlie, 1903.</p>
-<p>nahl-tsin´-kah (M). Camp Grant.</p>
+<p>nahl-tsin´-kah (M). Camp Grant.</p>
-<p>8. to&#772;&#410;tciñyasta' (G). On the E side of the Eel about 1
-mi. above naltcûñka. A large rock stands back of the village site.</p>
+<p>8. to&#772;&#410;tciñyasta' (G). On the E side of the Eel about 1
+mi. above naltcûñka. A large rock stands back of the village site.</p>
-<p>9. tadûttci&#772;' (G). On the E side of the Eel not far above
-to&#772;&#410;tciñyasta', at the mouth of a large creek in which salmon
+<p>9. tadûttci&#772;' (G). On the E side of the Eel not far above
+to&#772;&#410;tciñyasta', at the mouth of a large creek in which salmon
run (tadako&#772;k, Thompson Cr.?). Above Camp Grant.</p>
-<p>10. tcillûñdûñ (G). On the E side of the Eel 1/4 mi.
-above tadûttci&#772;'. An open place without a creek. (Given as
-ki&#772;lûndûñki&#772;a by Charlie in 1903.)</p>
+<p>10. tcillûñdûñ (G). On the E side of the Eel 1/4 mi.
+above tadûttci&#772;'. An open place without a creek. (Given as
+ki&#772;lûndûñki&#772;a by Charlie in 1903.)</p>
<p>11. ne'gakak, "moss"? (G). On the W side of the Eel opposite
-tcillûñdûñ.</p>
+tcillûñdûñ.</p>
<p>12. ne'tcinko&#772;k (G). At the mouth of a creek on the W side
of the Eel some way above ne'gakak.</p>
<p>13. gactco&#772;bi', "redwoods in" (G). In a large open flat
among the redwoods on the E side of the Eel above ne'tcinko&#772;k.
-Given by Charlie in 1903 as kûctco&#772;beki&#772;a on the S side.</p>
+Given by Charlie in 1903 as kûctco&#772;beki&#772;a on the S side.</p>
<p>14. On the E side of the Eel just S of a creek which flows
down a steep rough bed on a rather high bench are 4 pits. The
@@ -3691,7 +3654,7 @@ enters a canyon N of this creek. A round timbered butte is close to
the mouth of the creek on the N. A great timbered butte seems to
occupy the E bank of the river for several miles.</p>
-<p>15. seda'dûn, "rock mouth place" (G). On the E side (W also?),
+<p>15. seda'dûn, "rock mouth place" (G). On the E side (W also?),
where the river flows out between rocks. A small creek is there.
About 2 mi. above gactco&#772;bi'.</p></blockquote>
@@ -3699,18 +3662,18 @@ About 2 mi. above gactco&#772;bi'.</p></blockquote>
<blockquote>
-<p>16. &#410;tcûnta'dûñ (G). Said to have been on the W side of
+<p>16. &#410;tcûnta'dûñ (G). Said to have been on the W side of
South Fork and the S side of the Eel R., where the store and saloon
of Dyerville now stand.</p>
-<p>chin-tah´-tah (M). The flat occupied by Dyerville; this is no
+<p>chin-tah´-tah (M). The flat occupied by Dyerville; this is no
doubt the same as the name given by Goddard.</p>
-<p>17. kahs-cho´-chin-net´-tah (M). A large village on Bull Cr.
+<p>17. kahs-cho´-chin-net´-tah (M). A large village on Bull Cr.
about 7 mi. upstream from Dyerville. The place is now known as
Schoolhouse Flat.</p>
-<p>18. &#410;o&#772;lûñki&#772;' (G). On the S bank of Bull Cr. at its
+<p>18. &#410;o&#772;lûñki&#772;' (G). On the S bank of Bull Cr. at its
mouth, in large redwood timber. There were 10 pits along the bank
of South Fork and the pit of a yitco', 8 paces across, about 200
yds. W of the mouth of Bull Cr. A large redwood, hollowed by
@@ -3723,29 +3686,29 @@ died. One of the white men, named Steve, cut a piece from the arm
of one of the Indians, built a fire, cooked it, and ate it. The
best man of the Indians escaped.</p>
-<p>lo-lahn´-ko&#772;k (M). Bull Cr. Merriam does not mention a
+<p>lo-lahn´-ko&#772;k (M). Bull Cr. Merriam does not mention a
village at its mouth.</p>
-<p>19. &#410;o&#772;lûñko&#772;k yi&#772;bañ (G). On the E bank of South
+<p>19. &#410;o&#772;lûñko&#772;k yi&#772;bañ (G). On the E bank of South
Fork opposite and N of the mouth of Bull Cr. Two pits were seen
directly across from Bull Cr. and 2 about 100 yds. downstream. They
are in heavy redwood timber, but receive a good deal of sun because
they are close to the river, which flows NW at this point.</p>
-<p>20. so&#772;snoibûndûñ (G). On the E bank of South Fork about a
+<p>20. so&#772;snoibûndûñ (G). On the E bank of South Fork about a
mile S of the mouth of Bull Cr. Five pits were counted in small
redwood timber, where there is a spring which supplied the village.
There used to be a yitco' here, in which Charlie remembered dancing
when he was a small boy.</p>
-<p>21. nûnsûntco&#772;tci&#772;', "butte large mouth" (G). On both
+<p>21. nûnsûntco&#772;tci&#772;', "butte large mouth" (G). On both
sides of the mouth of Brush Cr. (Canoe Cr.) in large redwood
timber. On the N side are 6 pits, 5 of them in a row back about 30
yds. There are seven pits on the S side of the creek, some of them
much plainer than others. The father of Albert's wife, Sally, came
from this village.</p>
-<p>nahn´-sin-cho´-ke (M). See Place Names.</p>
+<p>nahn´-sin-cho´-ke (M). See Place Names.</p>
<p>22. sedjo&#772;cbi&#772;' (G). On the E bank of South Fork, which
flows toward the W at this point. A stream from<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_188" id="Page_188">[Pg 188]</a></span> the E (Feese Cr.)
@@ -3753,70 +3716,70 @@ flows in a little above the village. There are many tanbark oaks
growing near by, which Charlie suggested were the reason for the
village's being located here. Seven pits could be distinguished;
the clearing away of timber may have obscured some others. The name
-setco&#772;sdiñ was also given by Charlie. Tco&#772;s means vagina, "what
+setco&#772;sdiñ was also given by Charlie. Tco&#772;s means vagina, "what
woman has."</p>
<p>sa&#772;-cho&#772;s-te (M). See Place Names.</p>
-<p>23. gûtta'bûndûñ, named from a deep hole in the stream (G). On
+<p>23. gûtta'bûndûñ, named from a deep hole in the stream (G). On
the W side of South Fork, where it flows toward the NE just below
Myer's. The site has been completely washed away. Charlie's father
belonged here and Charlie lived here when a boy. Jack, Charlie's
half-brother, was born at this village. There used to be a yitco'
and a large hollow tree in which a family used to spend the winter.</p>
-<p>kah-tah´-be (M). See Place Names.</p>
+<p>kah-tah´-be (M). See Place Names.</p>
-<p>24. tantañaiki&#772;' bûndûñ (G). On the E side of South Fork.
+<p>24. tantañaiki&#772;' bûndûñ (G). On the E side of South Fork.
A creek, along which are many tanbark oaks, flows into South Fork
on the opposite side and a little above. The name of the creek is
-tantañaiko&#772;k (Coon Cr.). The site is just below a garden. The
+tantañaiko&#772;k (Coon Cr.). The site is just below a garden. The
place was so grown up with brakes it was impossible to count the
pits.</p>
-<p>25. to&#772;dûnni', "water sings" (G). On the NW corner of Myer's
+<p>25. to&#772;dûnni', "water sings" (G). On the NW corner of Myer's
Flat on the right bank of South Fork, where it completes its course
toward the W and turns toward the NE. The site has been washed
away. There used to be large peppernut trees growing there. A few
-are still left. The name of Myer's Flat is kûnteltco&#772;bi&#772;. It is
+are still left. The name of Myer's Flat is kûnteltco&#772;bi&#772;. It is
also mentioned as kontelkyo&#772;bi&#772;.</p>
-<p>ken´-tes-cho´-be (M). See Place Names.</p>
+<p>ken´-tes-cho´-be (M). See Place Names.</p>
-<p>26. sestcicbandûñ (G). On the right bank of South Fork on a
+<p>26. sestcicbandûñ (G). On the right bank of South Fork on a
narrow bench between the hill and that stream. There is an eddy
in the river just above, which furnished good fishing, and many
oaks are on the hills. The site received plenty of sun because the
river flows W at this point. Four pits were seen. Also given as
-sûstci&#772;cbi&#772;, "rough like a rasp."</p>
+sûstci&#772;cbi&#772;, "rough like a rasp."</p>
-<p>ses-che´-is-ke (M). See Place Names.</p>
+<p>ses-che´-is-ke (M). See Place Names.</p>
-<p>27. sebûggûnna', "rock around" (G). On the right side and
+<p>27. sebûggûnna', "rock around" (G). On the right side and
close to South Fork just downstream from a rocky point around which
the river changes its direction from S to NW. Fourteen or fifteen
pits could be distinguished, most of them quite distinct.</p>
-<p>sa&#772;-bug´-gah-nah´ (M). See Place Names.</p>
+<p>sa&#772;-bug´-gah-nah´ (M). See Place Names.</p>
-<p>28. seko&#772;ntco&#772;bandûñ (G). On the left side of South Fork
-nearly opposite sebûggûnna'. The sandy bench is covered with
+<p>28. seko&#772;ntco&#772;bandûñ (G). On the left side of South Fork
+nearly opposite sebûggûnna'. The sandy bench is covered with
brakes. Five pits were made out. Charlie lived here for four
years after he came back from the reservation. Also mentioned as
-tañaibi&#772;.</p>
+tañaibi&#772;.</p>
-<p>29. so&#772;ldeko&#772;k bûkki&#772;'du&#772;ñ (G). On a small flat
+<p>29. so&#772;ldeko&#772;k bûkki&#772;'du&#772;ñ (G). On a small flat
covered with large redwood timber on the N side of South Fork and
on the W side of Elk Creek (so&#772;ldeko&#772;k), which flows into it
from the N. Seven pits were counted along the banks of the river
and the creek.</p>
-<p>so&#772;l´-te-che (M). See Place Names.</p>
+<p>so&#772;l´-te-che (M). See Place Names.</p>
-<p>30. sente&#410;tcelindûñ, "rock flat flows out place" (G).
+<p>30. sente&#410;tcelindûñ, "rock flat flows out place" (G).
Close to the W bank of South Fork near a deep fishing place. There
are three pits between the county road and the river. Also called
-sentelduñ.</p>
+sentelduñ.</p>
<p>sen-te&#774;<sup>ch</sup>-be (M). See Place Names.</p>
@@ -3824,16 +3787,16 @@ sentelduñ.</p>
Fork 100 yds. N of the mouth of Salmon Cr., in large redwoods.
The river has washed the soil away so no evidence of occupation
remains. Willow brush is now growing there. Also called
-natonanko&#772;k bûttci&#772;'dûñ.</p>
+natonanko&#772;k bûttci&#772;'dûñ.</p>
-<p>sah-nah´-ko&#772;k (M). Name for Salmon Cr. See Place Names.</p>
+<p>sah-nah´-ko&#772;k (M). Name for Salmon Cr. See Place Names.</p>
<p>32. tci&#772;stci&#772;bi' (G). On the E bank of South Fork opposite
the mouth of Salmon Cr. It is on the end of a ridge. Charlie had a
ne'yi&#772;k' here after returning from the reservation (village site
not visited). This village was mentioned by Sam as his birthplace.
His mother may have been from here. Also referred to by Charlie as
-canaki&#772;' and tcûstce&#772;ko&#772;ok.</p>
+canaki&#772;' and tcûstce&#772;ko&#772;ok.</p>
<p>33. nant'o&#772;' (G). On the N side of Salmon Cr. in a bend.
Large redwoods fill the valley of the creek as well as the
@@ -3846,10 +3809,10 @@ which Salmon Cr. flows. The village was on the N side of the creek
near where Tomlinson's barn now stands. There is a spring there
near a pepperwood tree. This flat is now in peach orchard.</p>
-<p>35. kaslintco&#772;'dûñ, "riffle large place" (G). On the N side
+<p>35. kaslintco&#772;'dûñ, "riffle large place" (G). On the N side
of Salmon Cr. about 400 yds. upstream from ko&#772;nte&#410;bi&#772;'.</p>
-<p>36. setcinnabatse tcelindûn (G). On the N side of Salmon Cr.
+<p>36. setcinnabatse tcelindûn (G). On the N side of Salmon Cr.
in a basin-like flat. Four pits were seen near the creek and 4 in a
row back about 50 yds. against the base of the hill. There were 2
more pits in front of the last 4, making 10 in all. There is heavy
@@ -3857,38 +3820,38 @@ Douglas spruce and tanbark oak timber on the southern side of the
creek. About 200 yds. upstream is a waterfall, which provided fine
fishing, since large salmon could not jump the falls.</p>
-<p>37. bandûñ (G). On the end of a ridge, W of a small run lined
-with peppernut trees. About 200 yds. NE of se&#410;tcindûñ. There
+<p>37. bandûñ (G). On the end of a ridge, W of a small run lined
+with peppernut trees. About 200 yds. NE of se&#410;tcindûñ. There
were 5 pits, 2 of which were very large.</p>
<p>38. setcinnabatse (G). On a flattened end of the ridge E of
-se&#410;tcindûñ, 300 yds. S and a little W of it. Two pits were
+se&#410;tcindûñ, 300 yds. S and a little W of it. Two pits were
certain.</p>
-<p>39. se&#410;tcindûñ (G). On the E side of a gulch, in which
+<p>39. se&#410;tcindûñ (G). On the E side of a gulch, in which
there was flowing water in July, about 300 yds. N<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_189" id="Page_189">[Pg 189]</a></span> of Salmon Cr.
There were 4 or 5 pits. The ground is strewn with black stones.</p>
-<p>40. tcebanedûñ (G). On the flattened portion of a ridge, with
+<p>40. tcebanedûñ (G). On the flattened portion of a ridge, with
southern exposure. Black oaks and buckeyes are growing there.
Seven pits were to be seen with black stones lying in them. Great
broken rocks lie in a gulch to the west. About 350 yds. NNW of
-se&#410;tcindûñ.</p>
+se&#410;tcindûñ.</p>
<p>41. setco&#772;'seye (G). A large rock, with the overhanging side
facing SE. A rim of earth showed where the house wall used to be on
the W. The E was left open. About 1/4 mi. W of the falls of Salmon
Cr.</p>
-<p>42. to&#772;&#410;elindûñ, "water flows together place" (G). On the
+<p>42. to&#772;&#410;elindûñ, "water flows together place" (G). On the
flat W of Salmon Cr. and W of a large creek flowing into it from
the S (South Fork Salmon Cr.). Four pits are close to the bank of
Salmon Cr. and a fifth was partly caved in. One was seen on the
lower part of the flat to the S.</p>
-<p>43. nesdai'dûñ (G). Said to be on a side hill.</p>
+<p>43. nesdai'dûñ (G). Said to be on a side hill.</p>
-<p>44. to&#410;elindûñ, "water comes together place" (G). Said to
+<p>44. to&#410;elindûñ, "water comes together place" (G). Said to
be where three creeks join, forming the South Fork of Salmon Cr.,
about 5 mi. from its mouth. Distinguished from the village at the
mouth of the same creek by being called "small."</p>
@@ -3896,16 +3859,16 @@ mouth of the same creek by being called "small."</p>
<p>45. seso&#772;sye' (G). At the end of a ridge running down to
Salmon Cr. from the E. So close to the bank of the stream that
one pit has been undermined. Four remain. About 1/2 mi. NW of
-to&#410;elindûñ.</p>
+to&#410;elindûñ.</p>
-<p>46. ne'kañki&#772;' (G). In the saucer-shaped end of a ridge,
+<p>46. ne'kañki&#772;' (G). In the saucer-shaped end of a ridge,
close to the E bank of Salmon Cr. and facing a little S of W.
-Opposite, a large creek, called ne'kañko&#772;k, flows in from the W.
+Opposite, a large creek, called ne'kañko&#772;k, flows in from the W.
There are 9 pits, which may still be seen. Five of them, situated
close to the base of the hill, are very large and deep. Black oaks
grow there.</p>
-<p>47. ne'i&#410;ga&#410;dûñ, "land shinny-playing place" (G). On a
+<p>47. ne'i&#410;ga&#410;dûñ, "land shinny-playing place" (G). On a
flat close to the E side of Salmon Cr., which swings around it. A
gulch heads in the cedar grove N of the Hunter ranch buildings.
Twelve or 13 pits were counted, 5 of which were quite distinct.</p>
@@ -3916,23 +3879,23 @@ There are 8 pits in a row and 1 other, not in line with them. There
is a gulch 100 ft. S of the row of pits. Cedars, black oaks, and
buckeyes grow there. A small pond of water is E of the site.</p>
-<p>49. mûñkkasaiko&#772;k (G). On the W side of a branch of Salmon
+<p>49. mûñkkasaiko&#772;k (G). On the W side of a branch of Salmon
Cr. which flows from the N about 1/2 mi. W of the Burnell ranch
house. Two pits are close to the stream and 4 or 5 are 10 or 15
ft. higher. The higher ones have good sun in the winter. The trail
crosses the creek at this place.</p>
-<p>50. setc'ûnto&#772;dûñ (G). On the W side of the South Fork of
-the Eel about 1/4 mi. above the mouth of Butte Cr. (nûnsûnko&#772;k),
+<p>50. setc'ûnto&#772;dûñ (G). On the W side of the South Fork of
+the Eel about 1/4 mi. above the mouth of Butte Cr. (nûnsûnko&#772;k),
which provided desirable fishing. A large rock stands there close
to the river. There are said to have been four houses. This site
-was not visited. It was mentioned by Charlie as sesuñto&#772;; he said
+was not visited. It was mentioned by Charlie as sesuñto&#772;; he said
it was the most southerly village of his people. Sam called it
-senûnsi&#772;mkûk and said it belonged in Charlie's territory.</p>
+senûnsi&#772;mkûk and said it belonged in Charlie's territory.</p>
<p>The first name given by Goddard is evidently related to
-Merriam's sa&#772;´-chen-to´-te, "water against rock," which was said
-to be a place in the river near Goddard's setc'ûnto&#772;dûñ. See
+Merriam's sa&#772;´-chen-to´-te, "water against rock," which was said
+to be a place in the river near Goddard's setc'ûnto&#772;dûñ. See
Place Names.</p></blockquote>
<p><i>Shelter Cove Sinkyone villages (map 12).</i>&mdash;The following list of
@@ -3951,14 +3914,14 @@ found. Plowing had probably filled in other pits. The first store
of Phillipsville stood here. According to Sam (1903), this was the
most northern village of his people.</p>
-<p>ka&#774;-kes´-ko&#772;k (M). Fish Cr.</p>
+<p>ka&#774;-kes´-ko&#772;k (M). Fish Cr.</p>
-<p>2. kûtdûntelbi&#772;', "flat in" (G). At the NW part of the
+<p>2. kûtdûntelbi&#772;', "flat in" (G). At the NW part of the
Phillipsville flat. It is said to have been a large village. There
is fishing in an eddy just upstream. The site has been washed away
and therefore was not visited.</p>
-<p>ket´-tin-tel´-be (M). At a place called Phillipsville, 18 mi.
+<p>ket´-tin-tel´-be (M). At a place called Phillipsville, 18 mi.
S of Dyerville. The site is in an orchard on a ranch and has a fine
redwood grove and a good camping place.</p>
@@ -3969,23 +3932,23 @@ still be seen. The river flows nearly W, hence the village has
southern sun. Large redwoods occupy the left bank of the stream. A
deep place here provided fishing.</p>
-<p>sa&#774;-be-ye&#774;´ (M). The flat on the E side of South Fork, S
+<p>sa&#774;-be-ye&#774;´ (M). The flat on the E side of South Fork, S
of Phillipsville. See Place Names.</p>
-<p>4. tcingûlge&#410;dûñ (name of a tree) (G). On the right bank
+<p>4. tcingûlge&#410;dûñ (name of a tree) (G). On the right bank
of South Fork just below a turn to the E. Between the road and the
river two pits were seen. There is a schoolhouse on the E side of
the road. Many eels were caught near this village.</p>
-<p>chig-gel´-e-yes´-ke (M). A place 1.9 mi. S of Phillipsville.
+<p>chig-gel´-e-yes´-ke (M). A place 1.9 mi. S of Phillipsville.
See Place Names.</p>
-<p>5. da&#410;tcimmûndûñ (G). On the right (S) bank of South Fork,
+<p>5. da&#410;tcimmûndûñ (G). On the right (S) bank of South Fork,
where it flows W around a long ridge sloping down from the E.
Seven pits were counted between the county road and the river,
which may have carried others away. A large creek, seyekok (Rocky
Glen Cr.), empties N of this place. This village was mentioned as
-t'altcimmûndûñ by Albert in 1907.</p>
+t'altcimmûndûñ by Albert in 1907.</p>
<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_190" id="Page_190">[Pg 190]</a></span></p>
@@ -3994,13 +3957,13 @@ t'altcimmûndûñ by Albert in 1907.</p>
<div class="caption"><p>Map 12. Villages of the Shelter Cove Sinkyone.</p></div>
</div>
-<p>se&#774;-tes´-ko&#772;k (M). Rocky Glen Cr. See Place Names.</p>
+<p>se&#774;-tes´-ko&#772;k (M). Rocky Glen Cr. See Place Names.</p>
-<p>6. tca'lûñki&#772;' (G). On the E bank of South Fork. A small
+<p>6. tca'lûñki&#772;' (G). On the E bank of South Fork. A small
stream flows down from the E. Three pits were found on the N side
of it and two on the S side. The place had been plowed. Charlie
said there used to be many houses there. This village was given by
-Albert as tca'lûntci&#772;.</p>
+Albert as tca'lûntci&#772;.</p>
<p>7. da&#410;kaiko&#772;k (G). On a flat 50 yds. E of the county
bridge across Buhne Cr. (now called Dean Cr.), along both sides of
@@ -4009,8 +3972,8 @@ two on the N side. The road and plowed fields may have reduced the
number. This village was mentioned by Sam in 1903 as a settlement
of his people.</p>
-<p>tahs-ki´-ke (M). Merriam attributes this village to the
-to-kub´-be people, who ranged E from here.</p>
+<p>tahs-ki´-ke (M). Merriam attributes this village to the
+to-kub´-be people, who ranged E from here.</p>
<p>8. da&#410;kaiki&#772;' (G). On the W side of South Fork, opposite
the mouth of Dean Cr. Albert said there used to be a village there.</p>
@@ -4018,12 +3981,12 @@ the mouth of Dean Cr. Albert said there used to be a village there.</p>
<p>This is evidently the village Merriam refers to in the
paragraph above on village 7.</p>
-<p>9. &#410;tûggano&#772;bi&#772;' (G). On a flat on the E side of South
+<p>9. &#410;tûggano&#772;bi&#772;' (G). On a flat on the E side of South
Fork about 1/4 mi. above the mouth of Redwood Cr. Goddard noted
that the place had a favorable location, but did not find the pits.
Albert said there used to be a village there.</p>
-<p>stuk´-kan-no´-be (M). Name for the flat at this place. See
+<p>stuk´-kan-no´-be (M). Name for the flat at this place. See
Place Names.</p>
<p>10. ko&#772;sci&#772;ki&#772; (G). A short way below Garberville,
@@ -4031,13 +3994,13 @@ according to Sam (1903). Charlie said it was named ko&#772;ssetci&#772;'
or ko&#772;setci&#772;' and that it was just below Garberville on the E
side of the river. There used to be a store there.</p>
-<p>11. sebi&#772;yedadûñ, "rocks under..?... place" (G). A village
+<p>11. sebi&#772;yedadûñ, "rocks under..?... place" (G). A village
at Garberville.</p>
-<p>12. kûnte&#410;tco&#772;bi&#772;', "flat large in" (G). On a flat
+<p>12. kûnte&#410;tco&#772;bi&#772;', "flat large in" (G). On a flat
above Garberville.</p>
-<p>ken-tes´-che tahng-ah´-te (M). A beautiful deep valley on
+<p>ken-tes´-che tahng-ah´-te (M). A beautiful deep valley on
South Fork just SW of Garberville.</p>
<p>13. Usal (not necessarily the native name). Not mentioned by
@@ -4049,19 +4012,19 @@ not been able to locate precisely.</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>kahs´-cho-so´-be (M). A village of the Briceland Sinkyone
+<p>kahs´-cho-so´-be (M). A village of the Briceland Sinkyone
on South Fork about 4 mi. S of Garberville and not in sight from
the present highway. It may not actually be one of the Briceland
Sinkyone villages.</p>
-<p>kaicañkûk (G). On a ridge below Garberville. Information from
+<p>kaicañkûk (G). On a ridge below Garberville. Information from
Sam, 1903.</p>
-<p>&#410;tci&#772;kûk (G). On a ridge below seyadûñ on South Fork.
+<p>&#410;tci&#772;kûk (G). On a ridge below seyadûñ on South Fork.
Information from Sam, 1903.</p>
-<p>to&#772;kûbbi&#772; (G). On a ridge above Garberville. Information
-from Sam, 1903. seya(e)dûñ (G). On a ridge on the E side of South
+<p>to&#772;kûbbi&#772; (G). On a ridge above Garberville. Information
+from Sam, 1903. seya(e)dûñ (G). On a ridge on the E side of South
Fork, probably below Garberville.</p></blockquote>
@@ -4077,117 +4040,117 @@ locations in tenths of miles.</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>tah´-cho. Main Eel R.</p>
+<p>tah´-cho. Main Eel R.</p>
-<p>hah´-tin cho´-be. A stretch of land on the S side of the main
+<p>hah´-tin cho´-be. A stretch of land on the S side of the main
Eel extending from Scotia Bridge E at least to Brown's Mill, and S
from the river to the top of the ridge.</p>
-<p>kahn-so´-ti-ye&#774;´, "under maple trees." A big loop of the
+<p>kahn-so´-ti-ye&#774;´, "under maple trees." A big loop of the
river 2 mi. E from Scotia Bridge.</p>
-<p>hah´-ting-ko&#772;k. Jordan Cr., 2.2 mi. E of Scotia Bridge.</p>
+<p>hah´-ting-ko&#772;k. Jordan Cr., 2.2 mi. E of Scotia Bridge.</p>
-<p>hah´-tin cho´-be. The prairie on top of the ridge S of Jordan
+<p>hah´-tin cho´-be. The prairie on top of the ridge S of Jordan
Cr. An old Indian trail goes up there. [Harrow Prairie. Merriam
gives the same name for the prairie and the stretch of land above.
The stretch of land is probably a village named for the prairie.]</p>
-<p>ahn´-sin ken-tes´-be, "Pepperwood Flat." A flat on the S side
+<p>ahn´-sin ken-tes´-be, "Pepperwood Flat." A flat on the S side
of the Eel, 3 mi. E of Scotia Bridge. [Pepperwood.]</p>
-<p>lah´-sa tal´-ko&#772;k, "Buckeye Creek." Bear Cr., nearly 6 mi. E
+<p>lah´-sa tal´-ko&#772;k, "Buckeye Creek." Bear Cr., nearly 6 mi. E
of Scotia Bridge. "Used to be lots of salmon there."</p>
-<p>lah-sa&#772;-se´-te. The present town of Shively.</p>
+<p>lah-sa&#772;-se´-te. The present town of Shively.</p>
-<p>bis´-kahl chum´-me. A bluff on Eel R. where the river makes a
+<p>bis´-kahl chum´-me. A bluff on Eel R. where the river makes a
loop to the S. About 6.3 mi. from Scotia Bridge.</p>
-<p>sa&#772;-tahs´ cha&#772;-lin´-te. An extensive gravel flat on the N
+<p>sa&#772;-tahs´ cha&#772;-lin´-te. An extensive gravel flat on the N
side of the Eel in the curve of a big loop in the river, 6.5 mi.
from Scotia Bridge.</p>
-<p>sa&#772;-tahs´-be. A bluff on the N side of the Eel at the
+<p>sa&#772;-tahs´-be. A bluff on the N side of the Eel at the
railroad tunnel 6-3/4 or 7 mi. E from Scotia Bridge. Said to be a
rough place.</p>
-<p>ahn-sin´-tah´-be, "Pepperwood Flat." A flat on the S side of
+<p>ahn-sin´-tah´-be, "Pepperwood Flat." A flat on the S side of
the river 7.5 mi. E from Scotia Bridge. Place now called Pepperwood.</p>
-<p>ahn-sin-tah´-ko&#772;k, "Pepperwood Creek." A small creek closely
+<p>ahn-sin-tah´-ko&#772;k, "Pepperwood Creek." A small creek closely
followed by the highway, about 7.5 to 8 mi. E from Scotia Bridge.
[Evidently Chadd Cr.]</p>
-<p>kahs-tes´-be. Holmes' lumber camp, on S side of Eel about 7.5
+<p>kahs-tes´-be. Holmes' lumber camp, on S side of Eel about 7.5
mi. E of Scotia Bridge.</p>
-<p>slahn´-ko&#772;. Larabee Creek, entering the Eel from the E.</p>
+<p>slahn´-ko&#772;. Larabee Creek, entering the Eel from the E.</p>
<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_191" id="Page_191">[Pg 191]</a></span></p>
-<p>kah´-li-cho´-be, "growing flat." At a place called Englewood,
+<p>kah´-li-cho´-be, "growing flat." At a place called Englewood,
a small settlement 9 mi. E of Scotia Bridge and continuing to
Englewood Roadhouse at 9.8 mi. The name is said to refer to things
"growing up" there.</p>
-<p>tan´-ko&#772;s tah´-te (tan´-ko&#772;s means <i>Equisitum</i>). A long
+<p>tan´-ko&#772;s tah´-te (tan´-ko&#772;s means <i>Equisitum</i>). A long
ford 10.5 mi. E of Scotia Bridge. It is a long gravel bar on the
N side of the river. It is named for the abundance of Horsetail
(<i>Equisitum</i>) found there.</p>
-<p>sa&#772;´ cho´-te (sa means "rock"). A big rock projecting into
+<p>sa&#772;´ cho´-te (sa means "rock"). A big rock projecting into
the river from the S side, 11.5 mi. from Scotia Bridge. [It appears
to be what is now called High Rock.]</p>
-<p>sa&#772;-tah´-ting. A redwood forest and flat near the rock sa
+<p>sa&#772;-tah´-ting. A redwood forest and flat near the rock sa
cho-te and named for that rock.</p>
-<p>chin-tah´-tah. An extensive flat on the S side of the Eel from
+<p>chin-tah´-tah. An extensive flat on the S side of the Eel from
the mouth of South Fork W, including Dyerville, 13 mi. from Scotia
Bridge.</p>
-<p>tsa&#774;-vel´-be. An area on the S side of the Eel immediately W
-of and adjoining chin-tah´-tah.</p>
+<p>tsa&#774;-vel´-be. An area on the S side of the Eel immediately W
+of and adjoining chin-tah´-tah.</p>
-<p>lel´-lin teg´-o-be. The junction of South Fork with the main
+<p>lel´-lin teg´-o-be. The junction of South Fork with the main
Eel R.</p>
-<p>sin´-ke-ko&#772;k. The South Fork of the Eel R.</p>
+<p>sin´-ke-ko&#772;k. The South Fork of the Eel R.</p>
-<p>tah´-tung-i´-kut. South Fork railroad station.</p>
+<p>tah´-tung-i´-kut. South Fork railroad station.</p>
-<p>nahl-tsin´-kah (nahl-tsuk´-kah). Old Camp Grant.</p>
+<p>nahl-tsin´-kah (nahl-tsuk´-kah). Old Camp Grant.</p>
-<p>·hles-yah´-kah (les-yah´-kah). Fruitland in Elk Prairie.</p>
+<p>·hles-yah´-kah (les-yah´-kah). Fruitland in Elk Prairie.</p>
-<p>sa&#772;-tah´-be. Eel Rock, about 12 mi. up the Eel from its
+<p>sa&#772;-tah´-be. Eel Rock, about 12 mi. up the Eel from its
junction with South Fork.</p>
-<p>tah´-cho. The main Eel R.</p>
+<p>tah´-cho. The main Eel R.</p>
-<p>nah-tah´-ting i-ka&#772;. Dyerville Redwood Flat in the point
+<p>nah-tah´-ting i-ka&#772;. Dyerville Redwood Flat in the point
between the main Eel and South Fork. The name means "pointed out,"
a descriptive term suggested by the geographical feature.</p>
-<p>lo-lahn´-ko&#772;k. Bull Cr.</p>
+<p>lo-lahn´-ko&#772;k. Bull Cr.</p>
-<p>kahs-cho´ chi-net´-tah. Schoolhouse Flat, 7 mi. up Bull Cr.</p>
+<p>kahs-cho´ chi-net´-tah. Schoolhouse Flat, 7 mi. up Bull Cr.</p>
-<p>sa&#772;´-es-cha&#772;-lin´-te, "rock run out." On the E side of
+<p>sa&#772;´-es-cha&#772;-lin´-te, "rock run out." On the E side of
South Fork 1/2 or 3/4 mi. S of Dyerville.</p>
-<p>sit´-se-tahl´-ko. A small creek on the W side of South Fork
+<p>sit´-se-tahl´-ko. A small creek on the W side of South Fork
about 1/2 mi. S of Bull Cr. [Evidently Decker Cr.]</p>
-<p>sa&#772;´-es´-kuk, "on top rock." A hill on the E side of South
+<p>sa&#772;´-es´-kuk, "on top rock." A hill on the E side of South
Fork 0.9 mi. S of Dyerville.</p>
-<p>lah´-sa&#772;-cho´-te. A straight shoot of South Fork beginning
-at sa&#772;´-es´-kuk Hill 0.9 mi. S of Dyerville. Lots of eels there
+<p>lah´-sa&#772;-cho´-te. A straight shoot of South Fork beginning
+at sa&#772;´-es´-kuk Hill 0.9 mi. S of Dyerville. Lots of eels there
in the spring.</p>
-<p>to-be´-ah. Schelling Camp Flat (lumber camp, garden, and
+<p>to-be´-ah. Schelling Camp Flat (lumber camp, garden, and
orchard) on the E side of South Fork beginning 2.2 mi. and
extending about 1/2 mi. to the S. [Evidently this is the present
town of Weott.]</p>
@@ -4201,41 +4164,41 @@ town of Weott.]</p>
<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_193" id="Page_193">[Pg 193]</a></span></p>
-<p>nahn´-sin-cho´-ke. The big hill to be seen on the E side of
+<p>nahn´-sin-cho´-ke. The big hill to be seen on the E side of
South Fork 3 mi. S of Dyerville.</p>
<p>sa&#772;-cho&#772;s-te (sa&#772;-cho-sta&#774;), "vulva rock." A long
gravel bar along both sides of the river and including a redwood
flat 4 mi. S of Dyerville. Named for a mark on a rock resembling a
-woman's vulva, cho´-sa&#772;.</p>
+woman's vulva, cho´-sa&#772;.</p>
-<p>che-o&#772;s-cho´-te. A stretch of river 4.75 mi. S of Dyerville,
+<p>che-o&#772;s-cho´-te. A stretch of river 4.75 mi. S of Dyerville,
including a small but good redwood flat. The name refers to foam on
the water.</p>
-<p>sa&#772;´-boo-i-chan´-te. A big perforated rock in the river at a
+<p>sa&#772;´-boo-i-chan´-te. A big perforated rock in the river at a
sharp bend 5.1 mi. S of Dyerville.</p>
-<p>kah-tah´-be. A stretch along both sides of the river 7.5 mi.
+<p>kah-tah´-be. A stretch along both sides of the river 7.5 mi.
S of Dyerville. It includes the State Redwood Park office building
and adjacent redwoods.</p>
-<p>ken´-tes-cho´-be. Myers Flat, a little over 8 mi. S of
+<p>ken´-tes-cho´-be. Myers Flat, a little over 8 mi. S of
Dyerville, including Myers Roadhouse. The Indians say this place
was never covered with timber.</p>
-<p>ses-che´-is-ke. A place 8.7 mi. S of Dyerville, above
+<p>ses-che´-is-ke. A place 8.7 mi. S of Dyerville, above
ken-tes-cho-be.</p>
-<p>sa&#772;-bug´-gah-nah´. A place 9 mi. S of Dyerville where the
+<p>sa&#772;-bug´-gah-nah´. A place 9 mi. S of Dyerville where the
river goes around rocks. [Evidently Eagle Pt.] George Burt once
lived here and his son Guy Burt was born here.</p>
-<p>tub´-bel-chin´-tah cha&#772;-gel-ko&#772;k. A small creek 10 mi. S
+<p>tub´-bel-chin´-tah cha&#772;-gel-ko&#772;k. A small creek 10 mi. S
of Dyerville, entering South Fork from the E just S of a bend in
the river. [Evidently Bridge Cr.]</p>
-<p>so&#772;l´-te-che. A place at the mouth of Elk Cr., on the E side
+<p>so&#772;l´-te-che. A place at the mouth of Elk Cr., on the E side
of South Fork. Includes the eastern part of Bolling Grove.</p>
<p>so&#772;l-te-ko&#772;k. Elk Creek, entering South Fork from the E in
@@ -4244,47 +4207,47 @@ Bolling Grove, 10.3 mi. S of Dyerville.</p>
<p>sen-te&#774;<sup>ch</sup>-be. A rock in the river at a small bend 11.2
mi. S of Dyerville.</p>
-<p>ni´-te´-te&#774; el-lah´-te&#774;, "dog drowned" ... A place where a
+<p>ni´-te´-te&#774; el-lah´-te&#774;, "dog drowned" ... A place where a
new bridge is now (1923) being built across South Fork, 12 mi. S of
Dyerville. [Evidently this refers to the bridge at Blair Grove.]</p>
-<p>suk´-ke-cho&#772;s kah´-me, "eagle pawn." A big flat on the W
+<p>suk´-ke-cho&#772;s kah´-me, "eagle pawn." A big flat on the W
side of the river 12.5 mi. S of Dyerville.</p>
-<p>chah´-ni-che´. Another large flat on the W side of the river,
+<p>chah´-ni-che´. Another large flat on the W side of the river,
13.5 mi. from Dyerville.</p>
-<p>sah-nah´-ko&#772;k. Salmon Cr., entering South Fork from the W
+<p>sah-nah´-ko&#772;k. Salmon Cr., entering South Fork from the W
nearly opposite Miranda.</p>
-<p>kahs´-cho-boo´-ah´-me. This was a small settlement in a flat
+<p>kahs´-cho-boo´-ah´-me. This was a small settlement in a flat
at Miranda, 14.5 mi. S of Dyerville.</p>
-<p>sa&#772;-nan-sung´ (·sa&#772;-nan-tsin´-kah). Bear Butte, a
+<p>sa&#772;-nan-sung´ (·sa&#772;-nan-tsin´-kah). Bear Butte, a
conspicuous peak on the W side of South Fork, about 18 mi. S of
Dyerville.</p>
-<p>sa&#772;´-chen-to´-te, "water against rock." A place in the river
+<p>sa&#772;´-chen-to´-te, "water against rock." A place in the river
16 mi. S of Dyerville.</p>
-<p>ka&#774;-kes´-ko&#772;k (ke&#774;-kes´-ko&#772;k). Fish Cr., 16.9 mi. S of
+<p>ka&#774;-kes´-ko&#772;k (ke&#774;-kes´-ko&#772;k). Fish Cr., 16.9 mi. S of
Dyerville.</p>
-<p>kin´-tes-tah´-te. A big flat, probably a mile long and very
+<p>kin´-tes-tah´-te. A big flat, probably a mile long and very
broad, on the W side of the river, 17.5 mi. S of Dyerville. Just N
of Phillipsville but on the opposite side of the river.</p>
-<p>ket´-tin-tel´-be. A flat (now orchard and ranch) and village
+<p>ket´-tin-tel´-be. A flat (now orchard and ranch) and village
on the E side of South Fork, 18 mi. S of Dyerville, at a place now
called Phillipsville. It comprises a fine redwood grove and a good
camping place.</p>
-<p>sa&#774;-be-ye&#774;´. A flat on the E side of the river 0.7 mi. S
+<p>sa&#774;-be-ye&#774;´. A flat on the E side of the river 0.7 mi. S
of Phillipsville.</p></blockquote>
<p>A mile south of Phillipsville there is a good view of Garberville Ridge,
-se&#774;-chung´-kuk, a fine ridge, part timbered and part open grassy
-hillside, which slopes west from Little Buck Mountain, na&#772;-ah-ki´-kah,
+se&#774;-chung´-kuk, a fine ridge, part timbered and part open grassy
+hillside, which slopes west from Little Buck Mountain, na&#772;-ah-ki´-kah,
the highest point, some distance back on the east.</p>
<blockquote>
@@ -4292,101 +4255,101 @@ the highest point, some distance back on the east.</p>
<p>to-be-ye&#774;, "prairie under." A small flat on the W side of
the river 1 mi. S of Phillipsville.</p>
-<p>yen-nes´-be. A place 1.6 mi. S of Phillipsville.</p>
+<p>yen-nes´-be. A place 1.6 mi. S of Phillipsville.</p>
-<p>chig-gel´-e-yes´-ke. A place 1.9 mi. S of Phillipsville.</p>
+<p>chig-gel´-e-yes´-ke. A place 1.9 mi. S of Phillipsville.</p>
-<p>se&#774;´-chin-ko&#772;k´. A small stream probably 1.2 mi. S of
+<p>se&#774;´-chin-ko&#772;k´. A small stream probably 1.2 mi. S of
Phillipsville. A possibility of error here. If the location is
correct, the stream is probably Ohman Cr.</p>
-<p>se&#774;<sup>hl</sup>-ki´-ko&#772;k. A creek 2.1 mi. S of Phillipsville. The
+<p>se&#774;<sup>hl</sup>-ki´-ko&#772;k. A creek 2.1 mi. S of Phillipsville. The
preceding location is probably an error and this is Ohman Cr.</p>
-<p>se&#774;-ki´-ke. The land S of se&#774;<sup>hl</sup>-ki´-ko&#772;k Creek,
+<p>se&#774;-ki´-ke. The land S of se&#774;<sup>hl</sup>-ki´-ko&#772;k Creek,
reaching to 2.5 mi. S of Phillipsville.</p>
-<p>se&#774;-tes´-ko&#772;k, "hard rock creek." Rocky Glen Cr., 2.5 mi.
+<p>se&#774;-tes´-ko&#772;k, "hard rock creek." Rocky Glen Cr., 2.5 mi.
S of Phillipsville.</p>
-<p>ki-tes´-be, "hard brush." A place 2.9 mi. S of Phillipsville.
+<p>ki-tes´-be, "hard brush." A place 2.9 mi. S of Phillipsville.
There is a small ranch and orchard there now (1923).</p>
-<p>chan-tan-che´. A place a little more than 3 mi. S of
+<p>chan-tan-che´. A place a little more than 3 mi. S of
Phillipsville. There are two big rocks and a creek there.</p>
-<p>se&#774;-to´-be. A big rock facing a high bluff 4.3 mi. S of
+<p>se&#774;-to´-be. A big rock facing a high bluff 4.3 mi. S of
Phillipsville.</p>
-<p>sa&#772;-ken-nes´, "talking rock." A big rock on a creek on the W
+<p>sa&#772;-ken-nes´, "talking rock." A big rock on a creek on the W
side of the river, 5.6 mi. S of Phillipsville.</p>
-<p>tuk´-ke-tahk. A beautiful open and partly wooded hill on the W
+<p>tuk´-ke-tahk. A beautiful open and partly wooded hill on the W
side of the river 6 mi. S of Phillipsville.</p>
-<p>tuk´-a&#774;-tah´-be. A place on the E side of the river 6 mi. S
-of Phillipsville. Named from tuk´-ke-tahk hill.</p>
+<p>tuk´-a&#774;-tah´-be. A place on the E side of the river 6 mi. S
+of Phillipsville. Named from tuk´-ke-tahk hill.</p>
-<p>tahs-ki´-ko&#772;k, "white flag creek." Dean Canyon Cr., 6.4 mi.
+<p>tahs-ki´-ko&#772;k, "white flag creek." Dean Canyon Cr., 6.4 mi.
S of Phillipsville.</p>
-<p>tahs-ki´-ke. Village at the mouth of tahs-ki´-ko&#772;k creek. It
-belongs to the To-kub´-be tribe.</p>
+<p>tahs-ki´-ke. Village at the mouth of tahs-ki´-ko&#772;k creek. It
+belongs to the To-kub´-be tribe.</p>
<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_194" id="Page_194">[Pg 194]</a></span></p>
-<p>to´-che-be. A flat on the W side of the river 7.8 mi. S of
+<p>to´-che-be. A flat on the W side of the river 7.8 mi. S of
Phillipsville.</p>
-<p>bus´-ken-nes´, "cliff talking." A cliff or bluff opposite
-to´-che-be.</p>
+<p>bus´-ken-nes´, "cliff talking." A cliff or bluff opposite
+to´-che-be.</p>
-<p>stuk´-kan-no´-be. A big semicircular grassy flat on the E side
+<p>stuk´-kan-no´-be. A big semicircular grassy flat on the E side
of the river beginning about 8 mi. S of Phillipsville. The present
town of Redway.</p>
-<p>ahn´-chin-tah´-ko&#772;k. Redwood Cr.</p>
+<p>ahn´-chin-tah´-ko&#772;k. Redwood Cr.</p>
-<p>se´-ken-te&#774;<sup>ch</sup>-te&#774;. A place 9.5 mi. S of Phillipsville.</p>
+<p>se´-ken-te&#774;<sup>ch</sup>-te&#774;. A place 9.5 mi. S of Phillipsville.</p>
-<p>sah-nah´-che-chel´-le. A place and creek 9.7 mi. S of
+<p>sah-nah´-che-chel´-le. A place and creek 9.7 mi. S of
Phillipsville.</p>
-<p>bus-ki´-cho. A white bluff on the road 10 mi. S of
+<p>bus-ki´-cho. A white bluff on the road 10 mi. S of
Phillipsville.</p>
-<p>ko&#772;s-kun-tes´-kah. A sloping, grassy, open flat 10.3 mi. S
-of Phillipsville. There was a To-kub´-be village here.</p>
+<p>ko&#772;s-kun-tes´-kah. A sloping, grassy, open flat 10.3 mi. S
+of Phillipsville. There was a To-kub´-be village here.</p>
-<p>ko´-se-che´. The area on both sides of the river 10.6 mi. S of
+<p>ko´-se-che´. The area on both sides of the river 10.6 mi. S of
Phillipsville. Just N of the Garberville bridge across Bear Canyon.</p>
-<p>sa&#772;-ge&#774;´-che&#774;, "egg rock." A bold upright rock at the
+<p>sa&#772;-ge&#774;´-che&#774;, "egg rock." A bold upright rock at the
N end of the Garberville bridge across Bear Canyon; 10.6 mi. S of
Phillipsville.</p>
-<p>ken-tes´-che tahng-ah´-te. A beautiful deep valley on South
+<p>ken-tes´-che tahng-ah´-te. A beautiful deep valley on South
Fork just SW of Garberville. The bridge across the river on the way
to Briceland is in this valley.</p>
-<p>si-cho´-kuk. A large village of the To-kub´-be near the site
+<p>si-cho´-kuk. A large village of the To-kub´-be near the site
of the bridge across South Fork on the way from Garberville to
Briceland.</p>
-<p>nahs-lin´-che. An area and village in a loop of South Fork a
+<p>nahs-lin´-che. An area and village in a loop of South Fork a
few miles S or SW of Garberville.</p>
-<p>ken´-nahl-lag´-gah-ko&#772;k (kan´-no-lig´-ah-ko&#772;k). East
+<p>ken´-nahl-lag´-gah-ko&#772;k (kan´-no-lig´-ah-ko&#772;k). East
Branch of the South Fork of the Eel R.</p>
-<p>na&#772;-yahn´-kah. A hill on the W side of South Fork near the
+<p>na&#772;-yahn´-kah. A hill on the W side of South Fork near the
bridge over East Branch.</p>
-<p>kahs´-cho-so´-be. A place and village on South Fork about 4
+<p>kahs´-cho-so´-be. A place and village on South Fork about 4
mi. S of Garberville and 3 or 4 mi. from the highway. Not in sight
from the highway.</p>
-<p>kahs´-cho so´-ning-i´-be. A large redwood flat (Richardson
+<p>kahs´-cho so´-ning-i´-be. A large redwood flat (Richardson
Grove) on the W side of South Fork on the Humboldt side of the
Humboldt-Mendocino County line.</p></blockquote>
@@ -4404,32 +4367,32 @@ Humboldt-Mendocino County line.</p></blockquote>
<tr>
<td>Bear River</td>
- <td>chahn´-ko&#772;k</td>
+ <td>chahn´-ko&#772;k</td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td>Briceland</td>
- <td>to-cho´-be</td>
+ <td>to-cho´-be</td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td>Elk Ridge</td>
- <td>chi-chin´-kah</td>
+ <td>chi-chin´-kah</td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td>Mattole River mouth</td>
- <td>tah´-che</td>
+ <td>tah´-che</td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td>North Fork Mattole</td>
- <td>nahn-tsin-tah´-ko&#772;k</td>
+ <td>nahn-tsin-tah´-ko&#772;k</td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td>Rainbow Peak</td>
- <td>tsa-che-be, tsa-bahng´-um</td>
+ <td>tsa-che-be, tsa-bahng´-um</td>
</tr>
<tr>
@@ -4439,12 +4402,12 @@ Humboldt-Mendocino County line.</p></blockquote>
<tr>
<td>Taylor Peak</td>
- <td>nahn-tsin´-kah</td>
+ <td>nahn-tsin´-kah</td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td>Upper Mattole</td>
- <td>kun-sah´-ke</td>
+ <td>kun-sah´-ke</td>
</tr>
</table></div>
@@ -4455,79 +4418,79 @@ Humboldt-Mendocino County line.</p></blockquote>
<table border="0" cellpadding="4" cellspacing="0" summary="On or near the Van Duzen River">
<tr>
<td>Alton</td>
- <td>chen´-na&#774;-che</td></tr>
+ <td>chen´-na&#774;-che</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Bald Jesse Mt.</td>
- <td>ko&#772;ng-kel-tel´-kah</td></tr>
+ <td>ko&#772;ng-kel-tel´-kah</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Bridgeville</td>
- <td>ahn´-sin-tah´-che-be´</td></tr>
+ <td>ahn´-sin-tah´-che-be´</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Buck Mt.</td>
- <td>nahn´-tsin´-kah</td></tr>
+ <td>nahn´-tsin´-kah</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Carlotta</td>
- <td>yah-hlahn´-che</td></tr>
+ <td>yah-hlahn´-che</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Chalk Mt.</td>
- <td>sa&#772;-til-bi´</td></tr>
+ <td>sa&#772;-til-bi´</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Chalk Mt. Ridge</td>
- <td>ne&#774;-chin´-tuk-kah, na&#772;-chin´-ta&#774;-kah</td></tr>
+ <td>ne&#774;-chin´-tuk-kah, na&#772;-chin´-ta&#774;-kah</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Fort Baker</td>
<td>sa&#772;-sha&#772;-be</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Iaqua region</td>
- <td>ko&#772;ng-tel-kil´-ko&#772;k</td></tr>
+ <td>ko&#772;ng-tel-kil´-ko&#772;k</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Iaqua Buttes</td>
- <td>se&#774;hl-kus´-a&#774;-kuk ("two points")</td></tr>
+ <td>se&#774;hl-kus´-a&#774;-kuk ("two points")</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Larabee Buttes</td>
- <td>yah-kah´-nik-kah (ta&#774;´-che-kah)</td></tr>
+ <td>yah-kah´-nik-kah (ta&#774;´-che-kah)</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Larabee Cr.</td>
- <td>slahn´-ko</td></tr>
+ <td>slahn´-ko</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Lawrence Cr.</td>
- <td>yah-tlahn´-ko&#772;k (ye-tah´-nah-ling´-ko&#772;k)</td></tr>
+ <td>yah-tlahn´-ko&#772;k (ye-tah´-nah-ling´-ko&#772;k)</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Lassik Buttes</td>
- <td>tse´-nahn-tsin´-kah</td></tr>
+ <td>tse´-nahn-tsin´-kah</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Lassik Pk.</td>
- <td>ki´-chil-kahn-kah</td></tr>
+ <td>ki´-chil-kahn-kah</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Little Larabee Cr.</td>
- <td>so´-ko&#772;k</td></tr>
+ <td>so´-ko&#772;k</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Metropolitan</td>
- <td>yah-hlahn´-kuk</td></tr>
+ <td>yah-hlahn´-kuk</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Rohnerville</td>
- <td>to-ti´-kah</td></tr>
+ <td>to-ti´-kah</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Rio Dell</td>
- <td>ken-tel-cho´ (kin-tel´-te)</td></tr>
+ <td>ken-tel-cho´ (kin-tel´-te)</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Scotia</td>
- <td>kahs-cho ken-tel´-te</td></tr>
+ <td>kahs-cho ken-tel´-te</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Showers Pass</td>
<td>sa&#772;-cha&#774;-be</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Van Duzen R.</td>
- <td>chin´-ne-kok (ken´-ne-kok)</td></tr>
+ <td>chin´-ne-kok (ken´-ne-kok)</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Van Duzen R. mouth</td>
- <td>kin´-ne-ke</td></tr>
+ <td>kin´-ne-ke</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Yager Cr.</td>
- <td>yah-'hlahn´-ko&#772;k</td></tr>
+ <td>yah-'hlahn´-ko&#772;k</td></tr>
<tr>
<td>Yagerville</td>
- <td>chis-sis´-ahn´-tah</td></tr>
+ <td>chis-sis´-ahn´-tah</td></tr>
</table></div>
<h4>ETHNOGRAPHIC NOTES</h4>
@@ -4538,20 +4501,20 @@ taken verbatim from Merriam's notes. The informant was George Burt.</p>
<blockquote>
<p>The Lolahnkok did not fight much with other tribes but were
-sometimes attacked by the Che&#774;-teg´-ge-kah of the region north of
+sometimes attacked by the Che&#774;-teg´-ge-kah of the region north of
Round Valley [Pitch Wailaki]; and they think the Long Valley people
also used to make raids on them to steal women.</p>
<p>Chief Lassik, whose name is often used in a tribal sense,
-belonged to the Kittel´ tribe&mdash;a tribe reaching from Iaqua south to
+belonged to the Kittel´ tribe&mdash;a tribe reaching from Iaqua south to
Dobbyn Creek [Nongatl].</p>
<p>Chalk Mountain was only a few miles east of the boundary
-between the Kittel´ and the Lolahnkok, and the Lolahnkok were
+between the Kittel´ and the Lolahnkok, and the Lolahnkok were
permitted to hunt there.</p>
<p><i>Shelter Cove Sinkyone.</i>&mdash;Trees are felled by means of elkhorn
-chisels called beh-cho, and stone mauls called sa&#772;´tah&mdash;a very
+chisels called beh-cho, and stone mauls called sa&#772;´tah&mdash;a very
tedious and laborious operation. When the tree has fallen, the logs
are cut in lengths by the same process. Planks are split off from
these logs by driving the elkhorn wedges into the ends of the logs.
@@ -4574,11 +4537,11 @@ Bull Creek Sinkyone. It was originally found growing on burned-over
places and the people planted the seeds in ashes, usually on a
burned place.</p>
-<p>Buckeye nuts, called lah-se&#774;´, were cooked in a basket with
+<p>Buckeye nuts, called lah-se&#774;´, were cooked in a basket with
hot stones after the manner of acorns. They were then mashed and
kneaded into dough, which was buried for a while in fine sand.</p>
-<p>Wild Ginger (<i>Asarum</i> sp.) is called tan-nas-bos´. It is good
+<p>Wild Ginger (<i>Asarum</i> sp.) is called tan-nas-bos´. It is good
medicine for pain in the stomach. The leaves are pounded and soaked
in cold water. The sick person drinks plenty of this water and
vomits. After a little while he gets well and is hungry and eats.</p>
@@ -4588,7 +4551,7 @@ rub so&#772;l on your hands, and if you get a chance rub her neck and
she will give in. So&#772;l is strong medicine.</p>
<p>An aromatic <i>Umbellifer</i> (species not identified) is called
-so&#772;l´-che-but-tah´; the root, so&#772;l´-che. It is used for
+so&#772;l´-che-but-tah´; the root, so&#772;l´-che. It is used for
purification and as a disinfectant. The root is burned and the
smoke wafted around to make the house more plentiful. It does not
grow on Bull Creek or South Fork Eel River but grows on Rainbow
@@ -4596,26 +4559,26 @@ Mountain and some of the other high ridges. The root is highly
prized.</p>
<p>The Spotted Owl (<i>Strix occidentalis caurina</i>) is called
-kah-ko´. He is a bad bird. If he flies close to a person, the
+kah-ko´. He is a bad bird. If he flies close to a person, the
person will faint.</p>
-<p>The Dove (<i>Zenaidura</i>) is called bi´-yu. His grandmother was
-burned to death. Bi´-yu was asked to gamble and replied, "I'll
+<p>The Dove (<i>Zenaidura</i>) is called bi´-yu. His grandmother was
+burned to death. Bi´-yu was asked to gamble and replied, "I'll
gamble every winter; in spring and summer I'll cry." Now we always
hear the Dove cry in summer.</p>
<p>The Red-shafted Flicker (<i>Colaptes cafer</i>) is called
-mun´-chis-bul. He makes a rattling noise in the spring. He was told
+mun´-chis-bul. He makes a rattling noise in the spring. He was told
that by doing this he would make the horns of the deer grow. He was
told also that when the deer became fat he would grow fat, but the
people fooled him for he did not grow fat.</p>
<p>The Yellow-bird (<i>Astragalinus tristis</i>) is called
-sin-sun-se&#774;-gahng-ti-ne tahs´-che, "to take away pain." If the
+sin-sun-se&#774;-gahng-ti-ne tahs´-che, "to take away pain." If the
old folks were suffering, they would get him to sing to take the
pain away.</p>
-<p>The Kildeer (<i>Oxyechus vociferus</i>) is called ni´-til-yi´-che
+<p>The Kildeer (<i>Oxyechus vociferus</i>) is called ni´-til-yi´-che
from the necklace, ni-tal-yah, on its throat. In the long ago time
the water was very high and rough; big waves were coming in and
the people were afraid to cross in their canoes, so they got the
@@ -4624,8 +4587,8 @@ and could handle a boat better than any of the others. The people
talked about him and said he was the best and the only one to get
them across. So he took them across and saved them.</p>
-<p>The Coyote (<i>Canis latrans</i>), called shu&#774;´-be&#774;, and the
-Shrewmole (<i>Neürotrichus</i> sp.), called ske´-cho, made the world and
+<p>The Coyote (<i>Canis latrans</i>), called shu&#774;´-be&#774;, and the
+Shrewmole (<i>Neürotrichus</i> sp.), called ske´-cho, made the world and
the people. The Coyote had a number of children. The Shrewmole said
that when people died they should come back to live again. Coyote
said, "No, there would be too many people; when they die they had
@@ -4635,30 +4598,30 @@ but the Shrewmole said, "No; you said there would be too many
people and you wanted dead people to stay dead, so your children
cannot come back." Then Coyote cried.</p>
-<p>The Raccoon (<i>Procyon lotor</i>) is called nah´-ke-gis´-chah.
+<p>The Raccoon (<i>Procyon lotor</i>) is called nah´-ke-gis´-chah.
A long time ago he was a doctor. He was able to talk to persons
suffering severe pains and could draw the pain out. He would dance
and sing and pull out the pains and fall back. One time he took a
flint out of a sick person.</p>
<p>In the olden time the people tried to make the Elk (<i>Cervus
-roosevelti</i>), called ye&#772;s´-cho, out of the Cottontail Rabbit
+roosevelti</i>), called ye&#772;s´-cho, out of the Cottontail Rabbit
(<i>Sylvilagus</i> sp.). They put horns on his head and sent him into
the brush, but the horns stuck in the bushes and he could not move.
-Then the people called him sti´-che and told him he must always
+Then the people called him sti´-che and told him he must always
stay in the brush.</p>
-<p>The Bat is called nah´-ta&#774;-bahn´-se. He wears a robe of bear
+<p>The Bat is called nah´-ta&#774;-bahn´-se. He wears a robe of bear
hide over his shoulders. A long time ago when the First People were
at war they wanted the Bat to make peace and they hired him to make
peace. The people told him to fix up good. He did so and said, "I
-am the one who can talk big." He sang ho-wa&#772;´-nah han´-nah. The
+am the one who can talk big." He sang ho-wa&#772;´-nah han´-nah. The
enemy agreed, and peace was made.</p>
<p>Our people have songs for the Elk, Deer, Coon, Otter, Mink,
Bat, and some other animals.</p>
-<p>Slugs (<i>Arion columbianus</i>) are called nah´-tos. To prepare
+<p>Slugs (<i>Arion columbianus</i>) are called nah´-tos. To prepare
[them] for eating, a slender stick is thrust through the head to
hold the animal easily. It is then cut open lengthwise on the belly
and the dark insides removed, after which it is dried. When wanted,
@@ -4730,8 +4693,8 @@ His statement on these people, taken verbatim from his notes, follows.</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>The Betto&#772;l´ or Pet´-to&#772;l´, as they call themselves,
-(commonly called Matto&#772;l´), inhabit the coast region from Davis
+<p>The Betto&#772;l´ or Pet´-to&#772;l´, as they call themselves,
+(commonly called Matto&#772;l´), inhabit the coast region from Davis
Creek, about six miles south of Bear River, southerly to Spanish
Flat, which is about 12 miles below the mouth of Mattole River.
Their center of distribution appears to have been the Valley of
@@ -4743,24 +4706,24 @@ and 500 persons.</p>
<p>Their southern boundary, Spanish Flat, is the northern
boundary of the Shelter Cove tribe, which reached thence southerly
-to or beyond Bear Harbor. The Matto&#772;l´ say that the Shelter Cove
+to or beyond Bear Harbor. The Matto&#772;l´ say that the Shelter Cove
language is materially different from their own, and different also
from that of the Briceland Tribe, and that the Briceland language
is very hard to speak or understand. They declined to give the name
of either of these tribes.</p>
-<p>The eastern boundary of the Matto&#772;l´ I was unable to locate
+<p>The eastern boundary of the Matto&#772;l´ I was unable to locate
exactly. They gave it as along or near the west base of Elk
Mountain Ridge, including the Valley of Upper North Fork Mattole
River. At the same time they gave the names of two 'tribes' or
bands as inhabiting the Rainbow Ridge and Elk Ridge region. The
Elk Ridge tribe they call Sa&#774;-bahng-kahng, the Rainbow Ridge
-people Se&#774;-tso´-ik (from Se&#774;-tso-e&#772;k, Rainbow Peak). There is
+people Se&#774;-tso´-ik (from Se&#774;-tso-e&#772;k, Rainbow Peak). There is
uncertainty as to the relations and geographic locations of these
bands.</p>
<p>The tribe inhabiting the coast at Needle Rock they call
-E´-le&#774;-tung. It is the same as the Shelter Cove tribe.</p></blockquote>
+E´-le&#774;-tung. It is the same as the Shelter Cove tribe.</p></blockquote>
<h4>TRIBELETS</h4>
@@ -4801,7 +4764,7 @@ out into the surf. Many shells and stones mark the village site.
This village stood in the middle of a 2-mi. stretch of sandy beach,
which reaches from gotxenin to a mile N of this village.</p>
-<p>4. sedjildaxdiñ (G). Close up under the hill. The wind has
+<p>4. sedjildaxdiñ (G). Close up under the hill. The wind has
carried away the soil, leaving a great pile of shells. Just S, a
stream comes down the hillside with only a gulch [La Rue Gulch], no
valley.</p>
@@ -4830,7 +4793,7 @@ were still lying about. The village was not burned, according to
Joe. The burying place is 100 yds. N on a separate bench of the
same mountainside.</p>
-<p>sa&#774;-be´-ah (M). On the ocean beach 1 mi. N of the mouth of
+<p>sa&#774;-be´-ah (M). On the ocean beach 1 mi. N of the mouth of
the Mattole.</p>
<p>Goddard and Merriam do not give quite the same location for
@@ -4846,23 +4809,23 @@ evidently the same.</p>
<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_198" id="Page_198">[Pg 198]</a></span></p>
-<p>8. bekeno&#772;'adiñ (G). This was 300 yds. S of the mouth of
+<p>8. bekeno&#772;'adiñ (G). This was 300 yds. S of the mouth of
the Mattole R. and 100 yds E of the present surf line. There is an
elevation of broken shells and other refuse on the sandy beach. Joe
Duncan remembers seeing the village when it was inhabited.</p>
-<p>9. lasaidûk (G). On the sand of the beach 1/3 mi. S of the
+<p>9. lasaidûk (G). On the sand of the beach 1/3 mi. S of the
mouth of Mattole R., the second village S of there. The wind has
blown the sand and soil away exposing the shell fragments.</p>
-<p>10. dzindiñ (G). By the mouth of a small stream 3/4 mi. S of
+<p>10. dzindiñ (G). By the mouth of a small stream 3/4 mi. S of
the mouth of the Mattole R.</p>
-<p>11. sastecdiñ (G). On a small bench N of a little stream a
+<p>11. sastecdiñ (G). On a small bench N of a little stream a
mile S of the mouth of the Mattole R. Fragments of shells were to
be seen.</p>
-<p>12. senalindiñ (G). About a mile and a half S of the mouth of
+<p>12. senalindiñ (G). About a mile and a half S of the mouth of
the Mattole R.; on a small flat with a point of land S of it and a
rocky bluff to the E. Broken shells are to be seen. There are now a
hut and corral on this flat. The point S, a part of Punta Gorda, is
@@ -4919,7 +4882,7 @@ are still to be seen. The Goff buildings are close by and occupy
part of the village site. This flat was plowed for the Indians in
186..(?). There is water in a gulch W (Jim Goff Gulch).</p>
-<p>nes-te´-be (M). On the present Goff Ranch on a bench on the N
+<p>nes-te´-be (M). On the present Goff Ranch on a bench on the N
side of the Mattole R., about 3 mi. upstream from the ocean.</p>
<p>The names are different but the locations are identical, so
@@ -4929,7 +4892,7 @@ these are no doubt the same village.</p>
flat W of Petrolia, on the S side of the river. It was here that
the Indians settled when they came back from the reservation.</p>
-<p>seb´-bin-ne bug´-gah-be (M). An acorn camp on the S side of
+<p>seb´-bin-ne bug´-gah-be (M). An acorn camp on the S side of
the Mattole R. a little below the present Hanson place, 3 mi. from
the mouth of the river.</p>
@@ -4952,7 +4915,7 @@ North Fork of the Mattole, E of the road to Ferndale. A white man's
house, on a higher flat near the creek, has been burned. It was
here the Indian village stood.</p>
-<p>25. djetxeniñ (G). On the N side of the North Fork of the
+<p>25. djetxeniñ (G). On the N side of the North Fork of the
Mattole just W of a creek flowing into it from the N. It is at the
western end of a long crooked canyon. Under a point were five very
large distinct pits. There were evidences of occupation on the
@@ -4964,8 +4927,8 @@ point above (the creek is called Wild Goose Cr.?).</p>
McNutt Gulch. The inhabitants of sitci&#772;cbi&#772; (no. 1) camped here
in summer to hunt. Timber and brush.</p>
-<p>27. djibbedaxtûkkabi&#772;<sup>&epsilon;</sup> (G). On a point on the S
-side of North Fork of Mattole R. Opposite djetxeniñ. Joe saw people
+<p>27. djibbedaxtûkkabi&#772;<sup>&epsilon;</sup> (G). On a point on the S
+side of North Fork of Mattole R. Opposite djetxeniñ. Joe saw people
living here when he ran away from the white man who was taking him
away for a slave.</p>
@@ -4979,7 +4942,7 @@ once lived there. There was a pit on the W side of the stream from
the N and two pits on the N side of the main stream 1/4 mi. below
the junction.</p>
-<p>29. sedjegûnko&#772;&#410;diñ, "right angle" (?) (G). On a flat on
+<p>29. sedjegûnko&#772;&#410;diñ, "right angle" (?) (G). On a flat on
the N side of the Mattole R. E of the bridge. It is now occupied by
John Evarts.</p>
@@ -4987,7 +4950,7 @@ John Evarts.</p>
creek flowing into the Mattole R. from the N, 3/4 mi. W of the
county bridge SE of Petrolia (Conklin Cr.).</p>
-<p>31. da&#410;oidiñ, "wild grape place" (?) (G). At the mouth of
+<p>31. da&#410;oidiñ, "wild grape place" (?) (G). At the mouth of
a creek (Indian Cr.) flowing into the Mattole R. from the SE at
the northern end of a flat nearly a mile long. Saw what may have
been pits, one on each side of the road by the duck pond near the
@@ -4998,7 +4961,7 @@ of the Cooskie tribelet.</p>
wide on the E side of Mattole R., which here flows N. It is at the
ford.</p>
-<p>33. saiqo&#772;tLûndiñ (G). On a long flat bordering the eastern
+<p>33. saiqo&#772;tLûndiñ (G). On a long flat bordering the eastern
side of the Mattole R. Joe said the village was at the southern end
of the flat, which is now owned by Lee Minor.</p>
@@ -5019,7 +4982,7 @@ the village is uncertain.</p>
R. The river is here no distance from the road. "Joe got very angry
when I wanted to look for pits."</p>
-<p>38. i&#772;kediñ, "foot place" (G). On the N side of a small
+<p>38. i&#772;kediñ, "foot place" (G). On the N side of a small
stream flowing into the Mattole R. from the E, at the SE side of
a flat. There are two deep pits and several, less deep, on the E
side of the wagon road. A large group of buildings are on a higher
@@ -5027,7 +4990,7 @@ flat SE. There is a large flat on the W side of the river also. The
whites killed all of the inhabitants while they were fishing for
eels.</p>
-<p>39. &#410;i&#772;gûcLûndiñ, "snakes many place" (G). Probably on
+<p>39. &#410;i&#772;gûcLûndiñ, "snakes many place" (G). Probably on
the W side of the river where there is a large flat around which
the river flows, keeping near the high bank on the E. The road runs
along the eastern side of the river and climbs a considerable grade
@@ -5037,10 +5000,10 @@ at the N.</p>
end of a flat on the E side of the Mattole R. Fifteen Indians were
killed here by white people.</p>
-<p>41. no&#772;wilkediñ (gacdûlyaidiñ, "like a necktie") (G). Said
+<p>41. no&#772;wilkediñ (gacdûlyaidiñ, "like a necktie") (G). Said
to be situated between the Upper North Fork and the Mattole R.</p>
-<p>42. djegûllindiñ (G). On the W side of the stream coming into
+<p>42. djegûllindiñ (G). On the W side of the stream coming into
Mattole R. from the S close to the Humboldt Meridian (Honeydew
Cr.). Indians may also have lived on the E side of this stream. The
application of this name is uncertain.</p></blockquote>
@@ -5076,30 +5039,30 @@ imperfect map, hence they must be used only with the greatest care.</p>
Mattole R. at Upper Mattole. Perhaps de'kok is Squaw Cr., mentioned
in the Elk and Coyote stories. NW 1/4, sec. 30, T. 2 S., R. 1 W.</p>
-<p>ne'nûnyadûñ. On the E side of the river 3 mi. above de'tci'.
+<p>ne'nûnyadûñ. On the E side of the river 3 mi. above de'tci'.
There are two creeks there. This may be the village, and de'tci'
the whole Upper Mattole flat. Notes say 3 mi. from Mattole, which
is Charlie's name for Petrolia.</p>
-<p>k'atinta'. Above ne'nûnyadûñ on the Mattole R. at the mouth of
+<p>k'atinta'. Above ne'nûnyadûñ on the Mattole R. at the mouth of
kutsai'kok. NE 1/4, sec. 33, T. 2 S., R. 1 W.</p>
-<p>tcûlgûnnak'e'. Some distance above k'acinta' on Mattole R.</p>
+<p>tcûlgûnnak'e'. Some distance above k'acinta' on Mattole R.</p>
<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_200" id="Page_200">[Pg 200]</a></span></p>
-<p>tcintcûsko&#772;dûñ. On a hill on the E side of Mattole R.</p>
+<p>tcintcûsko&#772;dûñ. On a hill on the E side of Mattole R.</p>
-<p>tcûsti&#772;mi&#772;'. On the W side of the Mattole R. on a big
-flat, S of tcintcûsko&#772;dûñ. No creek empties there.</p>
+<p>tcûsti&#772;mi&#772;'. On the W side of the Mattole R. on a big
+flat, S of tcintcûsko&#772;dûñ. No creek empties there.</p>
-<p>istannaladûñ. On a large flat on the Mattole R. No creek
+<p>istannaladûñ. On a large flat on the Mattole R. No creek
empties there.</p>
-<p>setûggûttci&#772;'. On the E side of the Mattole R. at the mouth
+<p>setûggûttci&#772;'. On the E side of the Mattole R. at the mouth
of setuggukkok. Sec. 14, T. 3 S., R. 1 E.</p>
-<p>tceliñki&#772;'. On both sides of a small creek which enters
+<p>tceliñki&#772;'. On both sides of a small creek which enters
a larger stream near the latter's junction from the E with the
Mattole R. The valley of the river is wide at this point. A large
group of buildings is now standing on this site. "I rode to this
@@ -5118,20 +5081,20 @@ villages either by location or name.</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>tah-tah´-ke-ke. On a small flat on the S side of the Mattole
+<p>tah-tah´-ke-ke. On a small flat on the S side of the Mattole
R. about 1/4 mi. back from the ocean.</p>
-<p>tahn'-hra&#772;´-lah-be. At the mouth of the Mattole R. (on a
+<p>tahn'-hra&#772;´-lah-be. At the mouth of the Mattole R. (on a
lagoon near Indian Joe Duncan's place).</p>
-<p>yes-sa&#774;-cheb´-be. On or near the site of an old barn S of
+<p>yes-sa&#774;-cheb´-be. On or near the site of an old barn S of
the junction of the North Fork with the main Mattole R., near
Petrolia.</p>
-<p>e-nah-sal-li´-be. On a flat on Mattole R., 1/2 or 3/4 mi. S of
+<p>e-nah-sal-li´-be. On a flat on Mattole R., 1/2 or 3/4 mi. S of
Petrolia.</p>
-<p>choo-wil<sup>ch</sup>´-kah-be. On the North Fork of the Mattole R. at
+<p>choo-wil<sup>ch</sup>´-kah-be. On the North Fork of the Mattole R. at
Petrolia. The name tek-ko-li-be is also given for a village on the
site of present Petrolia.</p></blockquote>
@@ -5161,10 +5124,10 @@ to visit her granddaughter, Ethel Hecker, at Scotia.</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>Nek´-an-ni´ ... Athapaskan coast tribe formerly inhabiting
+<p>Nek´-an-ni´ ... Athapaskan coast tribe formerly inhabiting
Cape Mendocino and adjacent region from Bear River Hills southward
to Mattole River, and reaching inland (easterly) to the headwaters
-of the Bear River. [Nek´-an-ni´ was] their own name for themselves.</p></blockquote>
+of the Bear River. [Nek´-an-ni´ was] their own name for themselves.</p></blockquote>
<h4>TRIBELETS</h4>
@@ -5184,14 +5147,14 @@ its dialect and politically."</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>1. chal-ko´-chah (M). Name of the village N of the mouth of
+<p>1. chal-ko´-chah (M). Name of the village N of the mouth of
Bear R., used for both the place and the village.</p>
-<p>tc'alko´ (N). Largest and most western village in the area. It
+<p>tc'alko´ (N). Largest and most western village in the area. It
included the flat at the mouth of Bear R.</p>
<p>Goddard mentions two villages as being on the ocean N of the
-mouth of Bear R. &mdash; &#410;'adAlk'AsdAñ and goldElco'dAñ. He gives the
+mouth of Bear R. &mdash; &#410;'adAlk'AsdAñ and goldElco'dAñ. He gives the
word tc'alko as the word for Bear R. In Nomland's personal copy
of Goddard's paper (1929) she has written the word "tchankok" as
the word for Bear R. She gives the following explanation of the
@@ -5202,12 +5165,12 @@ accordance with hers. Upon close questioning, the latter told me
that her uncle preferred to speak Mattole. I checked Peter's words
with Isaac Duncan, my Mattole informant, and found this to be true."</p>
-<p>2. sa&#772;-cho-tung (se&#774;-cho´-tah) (M). On the ocean on the S
+<p>2. sa&#772;-cho-tung (se&#774;-cho´-tah) (M). On the ocean on the S
side of the mouth of Bear R.</p>
<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_201" id="Page_201">[Pg 201]</a></span></p>
-<p>setcodAñ, "rock big" (G). By the lighthouse, a populous place.
+<p>setcodAñ, "rock big" (G). By the lighthouse, a populous place.
The present-day lighthouse stands about 2 mi. S of the mouth of
Bear R.</p>
@@ -5219,7 +5182,7 @@ are at the town of Capetown.</p>
<p>4. chil-en-che&#774; (N). Near the present Morrison Ranch.</p>
-<p>chul´-lo&#774;-ko (M). This was the name of the village at
+<p>chul´-lo&#774;-ko (M). This was the name of the village at
Morrison's, 5 or 6 mi. above the mouth of Bear R.</p>
<p>5. sels-che'o-ch (N). About 3 or 4 mi. up the river from the
@@ -5227,9 +5190,9 @@ Morrison place. The site is now marked by a large red rock. It may
correspond to Goddard's sEtcixEbi, "rock stand in the water", which
is not located.</p>
-<p>6. seht-lá (N). About 7 mi. up Bear R. from Capetown.</p>
+<p>6. seht-lá (N). About 7 mi. up Bear R. from Capetown.</p>
-<p>7. ko-stah-che´ (ko&#772;s-tah-che´) (M). Name of the camp on Oil
+<p>7. ko-stah-che´ (ko&#772;s-tah-che´) (M). Name of the camp on Oil
Cr.</p></blockquote>
<p>Each author gives some additional villages, which cannot be located.</p>
@@ -5241,11 +5204,11 @@ place.</p>
<p>IstE&gamma;nadaibi', "madrone stands place" (G).</p>
-<p>klaht-el-ko&#772;s´-tah (M). Name of the village near the head of
+<p>klaht-el-ko&#772;s´-tah (M). Name of the village near the head of
Bear R. (at least 15 or 20 mi. upstream). It was a large town with
a big dance house.</p>
-<p>&#410;'adAlk'AsdAñ (G). Where a schoolhouse stands on Bear R.</p>
+<p>&#410;'adAlk'AsdAñ (G). Where a schoolhouse stands on Bear R.</p>
<p>tlanko (N). Above chil-sheck.</p></blockquote>
@@ -5288,15 +5251,15 @@ the produce of rivers, and this fact is reflected in the placement of
their villages.</p>
<p>Merriam has left a relatively complete record of his visits to the group
-which I am calling Whilkut and which he called Hoil´-kut or How´-wil-kut
-and Ma&#772;´-we-no&#774;k. (Merriam uses various spellings.) His first visit
+which I am calling Whilkut and which he called Hoil´-kut or How´-wil-kut
+and Ma&#772;´-we-no&#774;k. (Merriam uses various spellings.) His first visit
to these people was in 1910. The following account is taken from his
California Journals for September 15, 1910.</p>
<blockquote>
<p>Talked with several Indians at Blue Lake. The boundary between
-the Pah-te-waht [Wiyot] of Lower Mad River, and the 'Hoil´-kut or
+the Pah-te-waht [Wiyot] of Lower Mad River, and the 'Hoil´-kut or
Ho-il-let-ha of Redwood Valley lies along North Fork of Mad River
near its mouth, between Korbel and Blue Lake. The Pah-te-waht I saw
today live on Mad River at Blue Lake (on south edge of town), while
@@ -5315,7 +5278,7 @@ an Indian hunt, landing back at Blue Lake without entering Korbel
proper at all. Returned to Eureka in afternoon.</p>
<p>Went particularly to get additional material from the Redwood
-Creek Indians ('How´-wil-kut´-ka or 'HWilkut tribe) who were living
+Creek Indians ('How´-wil-kut´-ka or 'HWilkut tribe) who were living
in this region when I was here in September 1910 (see Calif.
Journals, Vol. 1, 90-93, Sept. 15, 1910). Tried to find O'Haniel
Bailey and John Stevens of Redwood Creek, and Stevens' daughter
@@ -5325,9 +5288,9 @@ several years ago; that John Steven is visiting in Hoopa Valley,
and that his daughter Laura is married to a white man.</p>
<p>But after a while I found two old men of the same tribe, who
-were born and raised at the Blue Lake rancheria 'Ko-tin´-net, the
-westernmost village of the Ha&#774;-whil´-kut-ka&#772; tribe. They call
-themselves and their language by the same name, 'Ho-tin´-net [North
+were born and raised at the Blue Lake rancheria 'Ko-tin´-net, the
+westernmost village of the Ha&#774;-whil´-kut-ka&#772; tribe. They call
+themselves and their language by the same name, 'Ho-tin´-net [North
Fork Whilkut]. One is blind and both are old. The blind man's name
is Nelinjak; the other's Denbrook. They were eating breakfast of
fried<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_202" id="Page_202">[Pg 202]</a></span> potatoes, dried fish, and coffee in their poor old shack.
@@ -5346,7 +5309,7 @@ is from his notes.</p>
<blockquote>
<p>About the middle of September, 1920, I visited the site of the
-old Hoilkut rancheria called T'chil-kahn´-ting (or T'ch-kahn´-ting)
+old Hoilkut rancheria called T'chil-kahn´-ting (or T'ch-kahn´-ting)
on the east side of Redwood Creek near the Berry ranch, about a
quarter of a mile below the highway bridge on the road from Arcata
to Willow Creek and Hoopa. It was then abandoned, the Indians
@@ -5411,16 +5374,16 @@ refers to a trip he made to Blue Lake in September, 1910.</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>Ma&#772;´-we-no&#774;k [Mad River Whilkut] ... An Athapascan
+<p>Ma&#772;´-we-no&#774;k [Mad River Whilkut] ... An Athapascan
tribe on Mad River, reaching from the junction of North Fork
with main Mad River near Korbel (where they came in contact with
-the Pah´-te´waht of Lower Mad River [a Wiyot subgroup] and the
+the Pah´-te´waht of Lower Mad River [a Wiyot subgroup] and the
h'Whilkut of North Fork and Redwood Valley) upstream (southward)
for many miles to the ranch of a white man named John Ahlgren,
where their territory ended. This is on or near Bug Creek.</p>
-<p>It was told me by a h'Whilkut ('Hoilet´-hah) who stated
-further that the Ma&#772;´-we-no&#774;k spoke a language so similar to
+<p>It was told me by a h'Whilkut ('Hoilet´-hah) who stated
+further that the Ma&#772;´-we-no&#774;k spoke a language so similar to
his own that he could understand most of their talk.</p></blockquote>
<p>The statement in the last paragraph comes from an informant Merriam had
@@ -5432,7 +5395,7 @@ the village list given for that group is derived from the second visit.</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>The Hoil´-kut or Redwood Creek Indians (commonly called
+<p>The Hoil´-kut or Redwood Creek Indians (commonly called
Chilula, Hwilkut, or Whilkut) were until recent years one of the
dominant Athapaskan tribes of Humboldt County in northwestern
California.</p>
@@ -5444,17 +5407,17 @@ included also the North Fork of Mad River and a short stretch on
the north side of the main Mad River between Blue Lake and Korbel.</p>
<p>Their proper tribal name as spoken by themselves is
-Hoi<sup>ch</sup>-let´-kah or Ho-e&#772;<sup>ch</sup>-kut-ka&#774;, usually slurred
-to Hoil´-kut. They also call themselves Ho-e&#772;<sup>ch</sup>-kut
-kew-yahn´-ne-ahm, meaning Redwood Acorn eaters.</p>
+Hoi<sup>ch</sup>-let´-kah or Ho-e&#772;<sup>ch</sup>-kut-ka&#774;, usually slurred
+to Hoil´-kut. They also call themselves Ho-e&#772;<sup>ch</sup>-kut
+kew-yahn´-ne-ahm, meaning Redwood Acorn eaters.</p>
<p>There are three divisions or subtribes, more or less distinct
according to the point of view: Upper Redwood, Lower Redwood, and
Blue Lakes or North Fork Mad River Indians. In their own language
they are:</p>
-<p>1. The Ho-e&#772;<sup>ch</sup>-ke-e´-te (from Ho-e&#772;<sup>ch</sup>-kut,
-"Redwood", and e´-te, "north"), the Northern or Lower Redwood
+<p>1. The Ho-e&#772;<sup>ch</sup>-ke-e´-te (from Ho-e&#772;<sup>ch</sup>-kut,
+"Redwood", and e´-te, "north"), the Northern or Lower Redwood
Indians [Chilula Whilkut], inhabiting the valleys and adjacent
slopes of Redwood Creek from its mouth upstream about 12 miles to
the Tom Blair Ranch at the junction of Minor Creek&mdash;a distance in
@@ -5464,27 +5427,27 @@ Hoopa, Polikla [Yurok], and Nererner [Coast Yurok] Indians, who
however apply it in a wider sense to both upper and lower divisions
of the Redwood Creek tribe.</p>
-<p>2. The Ho-e&#772;<sup>ch</sup>-ki´-e-nok (from Ho-e&#772;<sup>ch</sup>-kut,
-"Redwood", and e´-nok, "south"), the Upper or<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_203" id="Page_203">[Pg 203]</a></span> Southern Redwoods
+<p>2. The Ho-e&#772;<sup>ch</sup>-ki´-e-nok (from Ho-e&#772;<sup>ch</sup>-kut,
+"Redwood", and e´-nok, "south"), the Upper or<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_203" id="Page_203">[Pg 203]</a></span> Southern Redwoods
[Kloki Whilkut], inhabiting the valley of Redwood Creek from Minor
Creek (Tom Blair Ranch) up southerly to the head of the river, near
Chaparral Mountain&mdash;a distance in an air line of nearly 20 miles.
-They also call themselves 'Klo-ke Ching´-ching-e´-nok, meaning
+They also call themselves 'Klo-ke Ching´-ching-e´-nok, meaning
"Prairie place south."</p>
-<p>3. The 'Ho<sup>ch</sup>-tin´-net (or 'Ko-tin´-net), the Blue Lake and
+<p>3. The 'Ho<sup>ch</sup>-tin´-net (or 'Ko-tin´-net), the Blue Lake and
North Fork Mad River Indians [North Fork Whilkut], inhabiting the
valley of North Fork Mad River from its head to Korbel and Blue
Lake, and separated from the other divisions by a continuous lofty
ridge 2,000 to 4,000 feet in altitude. At Blue Lake they had a
-large village called Kaw-cho´-sish-tin-tang.</p>
+large village called Kaw-cho´-sish-tin-tang.</p>
-<p>South of the 'Ho<sup>ch</sup>-tin´-net are the Ma&#772;´-we-nok [Mad
+<p>South of the 'Ho<sup>ch</sup>-tin´-net are the Ma&#772;´-we-nok [Mad
R. Whilkut], a related Athapaskan tribe inhabiting the valley of
Mad River from the junction of North Fork near Korbel, southerly
(upstream) to the Algrehn Ranch on Bug Creek&mdash;a distance in a
-straight line of about 21 miles. The 'Ho<sup>ch</sup>-tin´-net and the
-Ma&#772;´-we-nok say that their languages are so similar that either
+straight line of about 21 miles. The 'Ho<sup>ch</sup>-tin´-net and the
+Ma&#772;´-we-nok say that their languages are so similar that either
can understand most of the words of the other.</p>
<p>The Hoilkut do not reach the coast, being separated from it by
@@ -5502,14 +5465,14 @@ Lake&mdash;possibly to the mouth of North Fork Mad River&mdash;all of which
agrees with what I have been told by members of these tribes.</p>
<p>The Hoilkut state that their lowermost (northernmost)
-villages, Ha-wung´-ah-kut and No-le&#774;´-tin, were ten or twelve
+villages, Ha-wung´-ah-kut and No-le&#774;´-tin, were ten or twelve
miles up from the mouth of the river. Below these they claim no
territory. Above, they had twenty-three permanent villages.</p>
<p>The language is uniform throughout Redwood Creek Valley except
for one or two slight differences of pronunciation. Thus the first
syllable of the tribal name as spoken by the Upper Redwoods is
-Hoi´<sup>ch</sup>; by the Lower Redwoods, Ho-e&#772;<sup>ch</sup>.</p></blockquote>
+Hoi´<sup>ch</sup>; by the Lower Redwoods, Ho-e&#772;<sup>ch</sup>.</p></blockquote>
<h4>VILLAGES</h4>
@@ -5524,7 +5487,7 @@ by either Merriam or Loud (1918), respectively designated by (M) and
<blockquote>
-<p>1. ti-keo-tchun´-tin (M). Village on the site of present
+<p>1. ti-keo-tchun´-tin (M). Village on the site of present
Riverside.</p>
<p>mis-kene&#772;'huten, "bluff-?-place" (L).</p>
@@ -5539,22 +5502,22 @@ One of them may be in error.</p>
<p>4. dj'e&#772;ndje&#772;e-ten, dj'e&#772;ndje&#772;-whot (L). Name said to
refer to a strong sweep of the wind at that place.</p>
-<p>5. me´-kaw<sup>ch</sup>-ting, me-ke´-aw<sup>ch</sup>-ting (M). Village at Jim
+<p>5. me´-kaw<sup>ch</sup>-ting, me-ke´-aw<sup>ch</sup>-ting (M). Village at Jim
Anderson's place about 3 mi. S of Korbel.</p>
<p>6. a&#772;rtes-slandje&#772;o&#772;lin-tin, "grasshopper-?-place" (L).
Village at the mouth of Dry Cr.</p>
<p>7. ka-tahs-lah-ting, 'ke-ah-tahs-lah-ting (M). Village on the
-S side of Cañon Cr. (in air line about 3.5 mi. S of Korbel).</p>
+S side of Cañon Cr. (in air line about 3.5 mi. S of Korbel).</p>
-<p>who'nta&#772;, "houses" (L). Village at the mouth of Cañon Cr.</p>
+<p>who'nta&#772;, "houses" (L). Village at the mouth of Cañon Cr.</p>
<p>8. whotsdjo&#772;ta&#772;che-tin (L). Name said to refer to a low
prairie. The village is 3 or 4 mi. below Maple Cr., just below
Foster Cr. There were three houses there.</p>
-<p>9. tsa&#772;´-te-tis´-ting (M). Camp on Mad R. at Fala ranch, 10
+<p>9. tsa&#772;´-te-tis´-ting (M). Camp on Mad R. at Fala ranch, 10
or 12 mi. S of Korbel. It was a camp for catching eels.</p>
<p>tse&#772;-didis-ten (L). Village about 2 mi. below Maple Cr.
@@ -5563,7 +5526,7 @@ There were ten or more houses there.</p>
<p>10. til-chwah-hew'-a-kut, til-tchwa-hu&#774;-ut (M). Village on
Maple Cr. about 14 mi. (9 in air line) S of Korbel. Large village.</p>
-<p>tilche&#772;hu&#772;ërkut, dilchërhu&#772;e&#772;rkut (L). Village at the
+<p>tilche&#772;hu&#772;ërkut, dilchërhu&#772;e&#772;rkut (L). Village at the
mouth of Maple Cr.</p>
<p>11. hotinte&#772;lime (L). Village at the mouth of Black
@@ -5574,17 +5537,17 @@ hinukerchenditen.</p>
Cr. Merriam also lists a village at this place but he does not give
its name or other information about it.</p>
-<p>13. me´-me&#774;h (M). Village at Three Cabins on Mad R. about 3
+<p>13. me´-me&#774;h (M). Village at Three Cabins on Mad R. about 3
mi. above Maple Cr. On Tom Blair's Mad R. place.</p>
<p>14. Village near Mountain View, about 3.5 mi. S of Three
Cabins.</p>
-<p>15. tseng-nah´-neng-ahl´-ting, tseng-nah´-neng-ah-ten, "rocks
+<p>15. tseng-nah´-neng-ahl´-ting, tseng-nah´-neng-ah-ten, "rocks
across the river" (M). Large village at John Ahlgren's place on or
near Bug Cr. [This may be the village site shown in pl. 10, <i>b</i>.]</p>
-<p>16. ituke-no&#772;le´-tin, "up-waterfall-place" (L). Village on
+<p>16. ituke-no&#772;le´-tin, "up-waterfall-place" (L). Village on
Foster Cr. The same name also given to a prairie half a mile up the
creek from its mouth; ituk means "up," also "east."</p></blockquote>
@@ -5606,10 +5569,10 @@ Whilkut, and Kloki Whilkut (see also map 16).</p></div>
<blockquote>
-<p>1. ho-wung´-ah-kut (M). In the Bald Hills N of Redwood Cr.
+<p>1. ho-wung´-ah-kut (M). In the Bald Hills N of Redwood Cr.
Northernmost and lowest village.</p>
-<p>xo&#772;wûnnakût (G). Village probably situated about a mile
+<p>xo&#772;wûnnakût (G). Village probably situated about a mile
E of Redwood Cr. on a small flat S of a ridge along which the
Trinidad trail used to run. A small creek a short distance S,
entering Redwood Cr. from the E, would have furnished excellent
@@ -5618,10 +5581,10 @@ sweathouses was seen. Tom Hill's oldest brother used to live at
this village, which was deserted many years ago, probably because
of its nearness to the trail.</p>
-<p>2. no-le&#774;h´-ting (M). Village on Redwood Cr. about 12 mi.
+<p>2. no-le&#774;h´-ting (M). Village on Redwood Cr. about 12 mi.
from the coast. The name means "falls."</p>
-<p>no&#772;lediñ, "waterfall place" (G). This former large village
+<p>no&#772;lediñ, "waterfall place" (G). This former large village
remained occupied until 1888, when the Hill family left it and
moved to Hoopa V. The site is at the foot of a long glade which
slopes toward the creek nearly a half-mile distant. A spring N of
@@ -5640,40 +5603,40 @@ salmon and lamprey eels, carried on with nets below the fall, was
excellent. Since the village has been abandoned, several of these
boulders have been displaced so a fall of only 3 ft. remains.</p>
-<p>3. yi&#772;tsinneakûttciñ, "down hill on" (G). Camp site W of
-no&#772;lediñ, about halfway up the ridge W of Redwood Cr. The Indians
-from no&#772;lediñ used to camp there to gather the acorns of the tan
+<p>3. yi&#772;tsinneakûttciñ, "down hill on" (G). Camp site W of
+no&#772;lediñ, about halfway up the ridge W of Redwood Cr. The Indians
+from no&#772;lediñ used to camp there to gather the acorns of the tan
oak, which are plentiful among the redwood trees.</p>
-<p>4. Lo&#772;tsxo&#772;tdawillindiñ, "prairie water flows down place"
-(G). Summer camp about 1-1/2 mi. E of no&#772;lediñ and 1/2 mi. W of
+<p>4. Lo&#772;tsxo&#772;tdawillindiñ, "prairie water flows down place"
+(G). Summer camp about 1-1/2 mi. E of no&#772;lediñ and 1/2 mi. W of
the crest of the ridge. A hollow redwood tree used to be used as a
camping place.</p>
-<p>5. tcitdeelyediñ, "dancing place" (G). Glade on a ridge
+<p>5. tcitdeelyediñ, "dancing place" (G). Glade on a ridge
running toward the E near a branch of Roach Cr., a tributary of the
Klamath. This camp was pointed out from a distance and its exact
location is therefore uncertain. The Indians used to go there from
-no&#772;lediñ in the summer to gather seeds and in the fall for acorns.</p>
+no&#772;lediñ in the summer to gather seeds and in the fall for acorns.</p>
-<p>6. klo-tshim´-me&#774;y (M). Camp on Redwood Cr. 1 mi. above
-no-le&#774;h´-ting.</p>
+<p>6. klo-tshim´-me&#774;y (M). Camp on Redwood Cr. 1 mi. above
+no-le&#774;h´-ting.</p>
<p>Lo&#772;tcimme, "small glade in" (G). A former village about a
-mile upstream from no&#772;lediñ and 75 yds. E of Redwood Cr., where
+mile upstream from no&#772;lediñ and 75 yds. E of Redwood Cr., where
it stood in an opening of about an acre. Obscure depressions like
house pits were seen on the N side of the glade near a stream
which provided drinking-water. A weir for lamprey eels used to be
built in Redwood Cr. near by.</p>
-<p>7. ho<sup>ch</sup>-tahn-ho-lah´-ting (M). On the E side of Redwood Cr.
-above klo-tshim´-me&#774;y. There is some doubt as to its location.</p>
+<p>7. ho<sup>ch</sup>-tahn-ho-lah´-ting (M). On the E side of Redwood Cr.
+above klo-tshim´-me&#774;y. There is some doubt as to its location.</p>
-<p>8. king-keo´-'hli (king-keo´-he&#774;-la&#772;) (M). Summer camp on
+<p>8. king-keo´-'hli (king-keo´-he&#774;-la&#772;) (M). Summer camp on
top of the hill or ridge in Bald Hills about a mile E of Jonathan
Lyon's ranch house.</p>
-<p>kiñkyo&#772;lai, "big timber point" (G). Large and important
+<p>kiñkyo&#772;lai, "big timber point" (G). Large and important
former village situated on the eastern end of a ridge above
Jonathan Lyon's ranch house and about a mile E of it. There is
timber on the northern slope of the ridge. At the edge of the
@@ -5685,69 +5648,69 @@ coming of white people was a man of influence and a noted warrior.
His name was KiLtcil, "crazy." His wife was a Hupa woman and
perhaps for that reason the family moved to Hoopa V.</p>
-<p>9. senalmatsdiñ, "stone round place" (G). Summer camp for
+<p>9. senalmatsdiñ, "stone round place" (G). Summer camp for
gathering seeds in the glade on the S side of the main ridge E of
-kiñkyo&#772;lai.</p>
+kiñkyo&#772;lai.</p>
<p>10. tesaikut, "projects to water" (G). Camp ground frequented
in the fall of the year for gathering tanoak acorns and hunting
-deer by the Indians living at no&#772;lediñ and kiñkyo&#772;lai. It is on
+deer by the Indians living at no&#772;lediñ and kiñkyo&#772;lai. It is on
the NE slope of the ridge W of Tully Cr.</p>
-<p>11. king-ye&#774;-ke´-ke-ah-mung´-ah (king´-ke-kaw´-mung´-ah)
+<p>11. king-ye&#774;-ke´-ke-ah-mung´-ah (king´-ke-kaw´-mung´-ah)
(M). Village on the E side of Redwood Cr. at the mouth of Coyote
-Cr. a little above ho<sup>ch</sup>-tahn-ho-lah´-ting, and a little above
+Cr. a little above ho<sup>ch</sup>-tahn-ho-lah´-ting, and a little above
Lyon's place.</p>
-<p>kiñyûkkyo&#772;mûña, "big timber near" (G). This site was not
+<p>kiñyûkkyo&#772;mûña, "big timber near" (G). This site was not
visited. It is said to be on the N side of Coyote Cr. below a large
rock. There are said to be house pits there. Tom Hill said this
-was the village where the people who lived at kiñkyo&#772;lai spent
+was the village where the people who lived at kiñkyo&#772;lai spent
the colder months of the winter. It is unlikely that two permanent
villages were maintained by the same families. Perhaps the site of
-kiñkyo&#772;lai is the more recent and it was formerly only a summer
+kiñkyo&#772;lai is the more recent and it was formerly only a summer
camping place.</p>
-<p>12. kitdiLwissakût, "fire drill on" (G). Camp used in the fall
+<p>12. kitdiLwissakût, "fire drill on" (G). Camp used in the fall
for gathering acorns and hunting. Situated near the corner of the
Hoopa reservation in a glade sloping toward the S, near a spring.</p>
-<p>13. new-wil-tso´-me-ah, "coyote camp" (M). Spring and summer
+<p>13. new-wil-tso´-me-ah, "coyote camp" (M). Spring and summer
camp on Bald Hills Ridge.</p>
<p>nu&#772;wilso&#772;lmi&#772;ye, "ground in billows under" (G).
Summer camping ground near a cold spring at the head of one of
the branches of Coyote Cr. The Indians used to come here from
-no&#772;lediñ.</p>
+no&#772;lediñ.</p>
-<p>14. ye-sin´-ning´-i-kut (e-tsin´-ning´-i-kut) (M).</p>
+<p>14. ye-sin´-ning´-i-kut (e-tsin´-ning´-i-kut) (M).</p>
-<p>yi&#772;sinniñ<sup>&epsilon;</sup> aikût, "down hill ridge runs on" (G).
+<p>yi&#772;sinniñ<sup>&epsilon;</sup> aikût, "down hill ridge runs on" (G).
Site of a former village 1/2 mi. E of Redwood Cr. and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_206" id="Page_206">[Pg 206]</a></span> about 500
ft. higher than the creek. It is S of the main ridge S of Coyote
Cr., at the western edge of a glade near a dry gulch. One pit was
found. It is said that Tom Hill's father lived at this village and
that it was not occupied at the time the white people came.</p>
-<p>15. tsin´-tse-lah´-ting (M). Village below Stoffer's and below
-ho´-tach-ting.</p>
+<p>15. tsin´-tse-lah´-ting (M). Village below Stoffer's and below
+ho´-tach-ting.</p>
-<p>tsinsilladiñ, "bones lie place" (G). Former village not far
+<p>tsinsilladiñ, "bones lie place" (G). Former village not far
from Redwood Cr. on a small flat where the ground shows signs of
having slid. Little Henry's family are said to have lived at this
village.</p>
-<p>16. kittcu&#772;namediñ, "its ear swimming place" (G). Summer
+<p>16. kittcu&#772;namediñ, "its ear swimming place" (G). Summer
camp on the W side of the main ridge, about 200 ft. below its
junction with the E-W ridge N of Lacks Cr. There is a spring by a
Douglas spruce which stands by itself.</p>
-<p>17. to&#772;'n-te&#774;-nahn´-ting (to&#772;n-din-nun-ting) (M). Old
+<p>17. to&#772;'n-te&#774;-nahn´-ting (to&#772;n-din-nun-ting) (M). Old
village on the E side of Redwood Cr. Ned Woodward, who was born
here, tells me the village was on a side hill at or very near
Stoffer's.</p>
-<p>to&#772;ndinûndiñ, "water facing place" (G). Village site on the
+<p>to&#772;ndinûndiñ, "water facing place" (G). Village site on the
sloping hillside about 700 yds. E of Redwood Cr. and 400 yds. N of
Lacks Cr. Seven house pits were found here. The guide, Dan Hill,
did not know of these pits, but located a village of this name
@@ -5755,20 +5718,20 @@ considerably nearer Redwood Cr. The Albers place, probably the
first settlement in this region, is just S of this village, on a
flat between Redwood Cr. and Lacks Cr.</p>
-<p>18. tcwûñxaladiñ, "dung stands up place" (G). On the western
+<p>18. tcwûñxaladiñ, "dung stands up place" (G). On the western
side of the main ridge near its crest. There is a spring in a small
flat.</p>
-<p>19. ming´-kah´-te-ke&#774;´ (mung-kut´-te-ke&#774;) (M). At Fort
-Camp at the mouth of ho-tah´<sup>ch</sup>-ting Cr. (Lacks Cr.), between
+<p>19. ming´-kah´-te-ke&#774;´ (mung-kut´-te-ke&#774;) (M). At Fort
+Camp at the mouth of ho-tah´<sup>ch</sup>-ting Cr. (Lacks Cr.), between
Lyon's and Stoffer's.</p>
-<p>miñkûtdekeyimantcintciñ, "lake opposite side" (G). Summer
+<p>miñkûtdekeyimantcintciñ, "lake opposite side" (G). Summer
camp among the redwood trees across the creek from Albers' place,
opposite the mouth of Lacks Cr.</p>
-<p>20. ho-tah´<sup>ch</sup>-tin´-nek (ho´-nah<sup>ch</sup>-tin-a&#774;-ke&#774; or
-ho-nah<sup>ch</sup>-te&#774;-na&#772;´-ke&#774;h), (M). Large village or summer
+<p>20. ho-tah´<sup>ch</sup>-tin´-nek (ho´-nah<sup>ch</sup>-tin-a&#774;-ke&#774; or
+ho-nah<sup>ch</sup>-te&#774;-na&#772;´-ke&#774;h), (M). Large village or summer
camp right at Stoffer's on the ridge about a mile above (S of)
to&#772;s-kahtch-ting (Cold Spring) and approximately midway between
Bair's and Berry's. At Stoffer's, formerly Hooker's, there is
@@ -5776,19 +5739,19 @@ a place called koo<sup>ch</sup>-mit-tah<sup>ch</sup> or kew<sup>ch</sup>-mit-tah
meaning "between the alders," but it appears to be a place name
only.</p>
-<p>21. e-nok´-ka&#774;-no´-mit-sa&#774; (M). Former village on the
+<p>21. e-nok´-ka&#774;-no´-mit-sa&#774; (M). Former village on the
Howard place.</p>
-<p>yi&#772;nûkano&#772;mittsediñ, "south door place" (G). Former large
+<p>yi&#772;nûkano&#772;mittsediñ, "south door place" (G). Former large
and important village, often mentioned in myths and tales by both
the Hupa and the Chilula. Pits were found on a flat near the creek
about 1/8 mi. SW of the Howard ranch buildings. Other pits were
said to have been obliterated near the middle of this flat.</p>
-<p>22. tlo&#772;<sup>ch</sup>-ti&#772;'k-hah-lah´-ting (M). Camp at an old
-schoolhouse 1 mi. S of e-nok´-ka&#774;-no´-mit-sa&#774;.</p>
+<p>22. tlo&#772;<sup>ch</sup>-ti&#772;'k-hah-lah´-ting (M). Camp at an old
+schoolhouse 1 mi. S of e-nok´-ka&#774;-no´-mit-sa&#774;.</p>
-<p>23. ho&#772;n-te&#774;<sup>chl</sup>-me&#774;´ (M). Camp on the E side of
+<p>23. ho&#772;n-te&#774;<sup>chl</sup>-me&#774;´ (M). Camp on the E side of
Redwood Cr. above Lacks Cr.</p>
<p>xo&#772;nteLme, "flat in" (G). Former village situated on a large
@@ -5803,69 +5766,69 @@ visible.</p>
side of Redwood Cr. near the stream. House pits were seen on the W
side of the wagon road.</p>
-<p>25. klitch´-hoo-e&#774;-nah´<sup>ch</sup>-ting
+<p>25. klitch´-hoo-e&#774;-nah´<sup>ch</sup>-ting
('hlit-choo-a&#772;-nah<sup>ch</sup>-ten; sit-choo-e&#774;-nah<sup>ch</sup>-ting) (M).
Former village about 3 mi. above Beaver's on the W side of Redwood
Cr. above Lacks Cr.</p>
-<p>Littcu&#772;w&#817;innauw&#817;diñ, "dust flies place" (G). Site of a
+<p>Littcu&#772;w&#817;innauw&#817;diñ, "dust flies place" (G). Site of a
former village on a long flat on the W side of the creek. It is
surrounded by timber, but receives the sun from the S. Little Henry
was living on the E side of the creek at the time, and said it was
his father's home.</p>
-<p>26. ki´-loo<sup>ch</sup>-tah<sup>ch</sup>-ting (M). Camp on
+<p>26. ki´-loo<sup>ch</sup>-tah<sup>ch</sup>-ting (M). Camp on
the E side of Redwood Cr. about 1 mi. or less S of
-klitch'-hoo-e&#774;-nah´<sup>ch</sup>-ting, but on the opposite bank.</p>
+klitch'-hoo-e&#774;-nah´<sup>ch</sup>-ting, but on the opposite bank.</p>
-<p>kailu&#772;w&#817;ta'diñ, "willows among place" (G). Said to have
+<p>kailu&#772;w&#817;ta'diñ, "willows among place" (G). Said to have
been a large village on a small flat about 1/4 mi. S of the last
mentioned village. There were indications of 3 or 4 house pits.
Molasses' wife said there was once a round dance house in this
village, probably the same type as in the Upper Redwood and Mad
River country.</p>
-<p>27. kuff-keo´-me&#774; (M). Camp on the W side of Redwood Cr.
+<p>27. kuff-keo´-me&#774; (M). Camp on the W side of Redwood Cr.
across from ki&#772;'-loo<sup>ch</sup>-tah<sup>ch</sup>-ting.</p>
-<p>28. kailu&#772;w&#817;tceñeLdiñ, "willows project place" (G). Former
+<p>28. kailu&#772;w&#817;tceñeLdiñ, "willows project place" (G). Former
village, which stood at the northern end of a long flat. Two plain
house pits, one of them containing stone implements, were seen.</p>
-<p>29. sik´-king´-choo-ma-tah´<sup>ch</sup>-ting (M). Given as about 2
+<p>29. sik´-king´-choo-ma-tah´<sup>ch</sup>-ting (M). Given as about 2
mi. below Tom Bair's place on the E side of Redwood Cr. Merriam
says he could not find anyone who knew of it.</p>
-<p>sikkiñtcwûñmitta'diñ (G). Village occupied in 1914. At the
+<p>sikkiñtcwûñmitta'diñ (G). Village occupied in 1914. At the
time of Goddard's visit, it was the home of Tom, a famous blind
medicine man.</p>
-<p>30. ho&#772;s-ta&#774;´-che&#774;-me&#774; (M). Village or camp on the W
-side of Redwood Cr. about 2 mi. above ki&#772;´-loo<sup>ch</sup>-tah<sup>ch</sup>-ting.</p>
+<p>30. ho&#772;s-ta&#774;´-che&#774;-me&#774; (M). Village or camp on the W
+side of Redwood Cr. about 2 mi. above ki&#772;´-loo<sup>ch</sup>-tah<sup>ch</sup>-ting.</p>
-<p>31. ke´-nah´-hung-tah´<sup>ch</sup>-ting (M). Former big village on
+<p>31. ke´-nah´-hung-tah´<sup>ch</sup>-ting (M). Former big village on
the E side of Redwood Cr. just below Minor Cr.</p>
-<p>kinnaxo&#772;nta'diñ, "Yurok village place" (G). Important former
+<p>kinnaxo&#772;nta'diñ, "Yurok village place" (G). Important former
village on a flat bordering Redwood Cr. on the E, about 1/4 mi. N
of Tom Bair's ranch<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_207" id="Page_207">[Pg 207]</a></span> house. Four shallow pits were found. A fight
with the volunteer soldiers occurred at this village, in which one
Indian was killed.</p>
-<p>32. ke-tan-nah´-tah<sup>ch</sup>-ting (M). Former village on the site
+<p>32. ke-tan-nah´-tah<sup>ch</sup>-ting (M). Former village on the site
of Tom Bair's place.</p>
-<p>33. ho-un´-kut (M). Former village on the W side of Redwood
-Cr. about 1/2 mi. from ke-tan-nah´-tah<sup>ch</sup>-ting but on the
+<p>33. ho-un´-kut (M). Former village on the W side of Redwood
+Cr. about 1/2 mi. from ke-tan-nah´-tah<sup>ch</sup>-ting but on the
opposite side of the creek. The name is nearly the same as that of
the lowermost village of the tribelet.</p>
-<p>34. tah<sup>ch</sup>-cha&#772;-nahl´-ting (M). Large village on the E
+<p>34. tah<sup>ch</sup>-cha&#772;-nahl´-ting (M). Large village on the E
side of Redwood Cr. just below Tom Bair's, near the big barn and
sheep corral.</p>
-<p>35. tahs-ung´-cha&#772;-kut (tah<sup>ch</sup>-sahn-che-ting) (M). Former
-village about 200 yds. above tah<sup>ch</sup>-cha&#772;-nahl´-ting on the E
+<p>35. tahs-ung´-cha&#772;-kut (tah<sup>ch</sup>-sahn-che-ting) (M). Former
+village about 200 yds. above tah<sup>ch</sup>-cha&#772;-nahl´-ting on the E
side of the creek.</p></blockquote>
<p>There are also a number of villages for which the locations are
@@ -5879,16 +5842,16 @@ and 16.</p>
<p>kahtch-wahn-to-ting. Summer camp.</p>
-<p>ke-wah´-ahn-tis-ting. Camp on the ridge at the line fence
+<p>ke-wah´-ahn-tis-ting. Camp on the ridge at the line fence
between Lyon's and Stoffer's ranches.</p>
-<p>tos-kahtch´-ting. Camp on the ridge at Cold Spring 1/2 mi.
-above ke-wah´-ahn-tis-ting.</p>
+<p>tos-kahtch´-ting. Camp on the ridge at Cold Spring 1/2 mi.
+above ke-wah´-ahn-tis-ting.</p>
-<p>tah<sup>ch</sup>mah-no-ah´-ting. Summer camp on Bald Hills Ridge.</p></blockquote>
+<p>tah<sup>ch</sup>mah-no-ah´-ting. Summer camp on Bald Hills Ridge.</p></blockquote>
<p>One more village is given by both Merriam and Goddard, transcribed
-dah´-sun´-chah-kut by the former and dasûntcakût by the latter. They
+dah´-sun´-chah-kut by the former and dasûntcakût by the latter. They
both say that it was supposed to have been near village no. 31. Goddard
thinks that it was a separate name for a part of village 31 "as is
customary in this region."</p>
@@ -5905,55 +5868,55 @@ included. (See maps 15 and 16.)</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>36. mis´-me&#774;h (M). Former village on the E side of Redwood
-Cr. 1-1/2 mi. below kah´-kus-tah<sup>ch</sup>-ting.</p>
+<p>36. mis´-me&#774;h (M). Former village on the E side of Redwood
+Cr. 1-1/2 mi. below kah´-kus-tah<sup>ch</sup>-ting.</p>
<p>misme, "slide in" (G). Former village situated near the creek
on the E side. Many Indians were killed here by the white people.
Perhaps that is why this village was not mentioned by some of the
informants.</p>
-<p>37. kah´-kus-tah<sup>ch</sup>-ting (M). Former village on Redwood Cr.
+<p>37. kah´-kus-tah<sup>ch</sup>-ting (M). Former village on Redwood Cr.
at the junction of Sweathouse Cr., whose name it bears. About 2 mi.
below Berry Bridge.</p>
-<p>kaxûsta'diñ, "Philadelphus among place" (G). Former village of
+<p>kaxûsta'diñ, "Philadelphus among place" (G). Former village of
importance on a flat of about 2 ac., near the creek level on the E
side. Four house pits were found on the N side of the flat and four
others in a row about midway of the flat. Two other pits, one of
them near the creek, were probably sweathouses. The flat is called
"Sweathouse Flat" by white people. This village is considered by
-the Hupa the last of the villages of the xo&#772;ilkûtyi&#772;dexoi,
+the Hupa the last of the villages of the xo&#772;ilkûtyi&#772;dexoi,
or Chilula. It was the last toward the S from which Indians were
allowed to witness the Hupa dances. The Chilula also seem to accept
this as their boundary.</p>
-<p>38. t'chil-kahn´-ting (t'ch<sup>&#410;</sup>-kahn´-ting;
-chis-kahn´-ting) (M). Village on the E side of Redwood Cr. just
+<p>38. t'chil-kahn´-ting (t'ch<sup>&#410;</sup>-kahn´-ting;
+chis-kahn´-ting) (M). Village on the E side of Redwood Cr. just
under the Berry ranch and about 1/4 mi. below the old covered
bridge near Berry's. The village is now moved to a higher point on
the high slope 1/2 mi. farther S.</p>
-<p>39. e-nuk´-ka&#774;-cheng´-tish-ting (M). Former village where
+<p>39. e-nuk´-ka&#774;-cheng´-tish-ting (M). Former village where
the Berry ranch house now stands, on the high ground E of Redwood
Cr. Bridge.</p>
-<p>40. es-tish´-chem´-me&#774;h (M). Former village on the E side of
+<p>40. es-tish´-chem´-me&#774;h (M). Former village on the E side of
Redwood Cr. about 4 mi. above Berry Bridge.</p>
-<p>41. tsin´-tes-'ki´-me&#774;h (M). Village on the E side of
-Redwood Cr. a little below mes-ta&#774;-tim´-teng.</p>
+<p>41. tsin´-tes-'ki´-me&#774;h (M). Village on the E side of
+Redwood Cr. a little below mes-ta&#774;-tim´-teng.</p>
-<p>42. mes-ta&#774;-tim´-teng (M). Former village on the E side of
-Redwood Cr. above es-tish´-chem´-me&#774;h.</p>
+<p>42. mes-ta&#774;-tim´-teng (M). Former village on the E side of
+Redwood Cr. above es-tish´-chem´-me&#774;h.</p>
-<p>43. tah-nah´-nah-kut (M). Village on the E side back from the
-creek and above mes-ta&#774;-tim´-teng.</p>
+<p>43. tah-nah´-nah-kut (M). Village on the E side back from the
+creek and above mes-ta&#774;-tim´-teng.</p>
-<p>44. chim-mah´-non´-ah-kut (M). Former village on the E side of
+<p>44. chim-mah´-non´-ah-kut (M). Former village on the E side of
Redwood Cr. at Bonny Cragan's ranch.</p>
-<p>45. ni´-is-'kwahl´-la&#774;-kut (M). Former village at the head
+<p>45. ni´-is-'kwahl´-la&#774;-kut (M). Former village at the head
of Redwood Cr. The last and southernmost village of the group. A
view of the territory here is shown in pl. 10, <i>d</i>.</p></blockquote>
@@ -5963,19 +5926,19 @@ and village no. 45.</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>tsa&#772;´-nah-ti´-a&#774;-kut. Village on the E side of Redwood Cr.
+<p>tsa&#772;´-nah-ti´-a&#774;-kut. Village on the E side of Redwood Cr.
far up, near Chaparral Mt.</p>
-<p>'klesh-mah´-kut. Former village on the ridge on the E side of
+<p>'klesh-mah´-kut. Former village on the ridge on the E side of
Redwood Cr.</p>
-<p>ma&#772;´-ma&#772;-a&#774;-kut. Former big village on ma&#772;´-ma-kut
+<p>ma&#772;´-ma&#772;-a&#774;-kut. Former big village on ma&#772;´-ma-kut
creek.</p>
<p>'klew-taw-me&#774;-ting. Former village on the E side of Redwood
Cr.</p>
-<p>nahs-kah´-nah-kut. Former village high up on Redwood Cr.</p></blockquote>
+<p>nahs-kah´-nah-kut. Former village high up on Redwood Cr.</p></blockquote>
<p><i>North Fork villages.</i>&mdash;The information on this group comes from
Merriam's notes (M) and from Loud (1918) (L). (See map 15.)</p>
@@ -5996,7 +5959,7 @@ Hupa, and Kloki Whilkut. (See also maps 15 and 17).</p></div>
<p>47. kaw-cho'-sish-tin-tang (M). Large village at Blue L.</p>
-<p>48. me-ka&#772;´-ta&#774;-met (M). Village on North Fork Mad R.
+<p>48. me-ka&#772;´-ta&#774;-met (M). Village on North Fork Mad R.
between Korbel and Riverside (nearer Riverside).</p>
<p>mike&#772;time (L). Name said to refer to being behind North Fork
@@ -6008,7 +5971,7 @@ Korbel.</p>
<p>50. hoo-tso'-e-choo'-kah (M). Village (or camp) on the site of
the present store at Korbel.</p>
-<p>51. ki'loo-whit´-teng (M). Fishing camp on North Fork Mad R.
+<p>51. ki'loo-whit´-teng (M). Fishing camp on North Fork Mad R.
1/4 or 1/2 mi. above Korbel (where gum trees are, just below picnic
ground).</p>
@@ -6018,7 +5981,7 @@ Korbel.</p>
<p>gestAkAt (L). Name said to refer to a deep fishing hole.</p>
-<p>53. noo-le&#774;h´-me&#774;h (M). Fishing camp at falls about 1/2
+<p>53. noo-le&#774;h´-me&#774;h (M). Fishing camp at falls about 1/2
mi. above Korbel picnic ground. Only one kind of salmon can get up
these falls.</p>
@@ -6084,8 +6047,8 @@ verbatim from his notes.</p>
<blockquote>
-<p><i>The Tin´-nung-hen-na&#772;´-o or Hoopah.</i>&mdash;The Hoopah proper,
-who call themselves not Hoopah but Tin´-nung-hen-na&#772;´-o, occupy
+<p><i>The Tin´-nung-hen-na&#772;´-o or Hoopah.</i>&mdash;The Hoopah proper,
+who call themselves not Hoopah but Tin´-nung-hen-na&#772;´-o, occupy
the lower part of Trinity River and tributary streams from the
mouth of South Fork Trinity northerly to Bull Creek&mdash;a distance of
about 20 miles. On the west they extend to the summit of the long
@@ -6108,19 +6071,19 @@ forested. There are one or two small open stretches on other parts
of Trinity River, and a few grassy slopes on some of the ridges;
elsewhere the forest is continuous.</p>
-<p>The Tin´-nung-hen-na&#772;´-o are in contact with five tribes
-belonging to three linguistic stocks, namely: the Po-lik´-lah
-(often called "Yurok") on the north; the Kar´ok on the northeast;
-the Athapaskan E´-tahk-na&#774;-lin´-na&#774;-kah on the east [I have
+<p>The Tin´-nung-hen-na&#772;´-o are in contact with five tribes
+belonging to three linguistic stocks, namely: the Po-lik´-lah
+(often called "Yurok") on the north; the Kar´ok on the northeast;
+the Athapaskan E´-tahk-na&#774;-lin´-na&#774;-kah on the east [I have
not been able to identify this group. According to Merriam's
map and according to his own testimony (Merriam, 1930) the Hupa
are bordered on the east by the Shastan Tlo-hom-tah-hoi; the
-Athapaskan Ts´a&#774;-nung-wha&#774; [Southern Hupa] on the south, and
+Athapaskan Ts´a&#774;-nung-wha&#774; [Southern Hupa] on the south, and
the Athapaskan 'Hwilkut [Chilula] on the west.]</p>
-<p><i>The Ts´a&#774;-nung-wha&#774;.</i>&mdash;(An Athapaskan tribe closely
-related to the Hoopah.) The territory of the Ts´a&#774;-nung-wha&#774;
-lies directly south of the Tin´-nung-hen-na&#772;´-o or Hoopah proper,
+<p><i>The Ts´a&#774;-nung-wha&#774;.</i>&mdash;(An Athapaskan tribe closely
+related to the Hoopah.) The territory of the Ts´a&#774;-nung-wha&#774;
+lies directly south of the Tin´-nung-hen-na&#772;´-o or Hoopah proper,
embracing the drainage basin of South Fork Trinity River from
Grouse Creek to the junction of South Fork with the main Trinity,
and including also the rather narrow strip between South Fork
@@ -6128,8 +6091,8 @@ on the west and the main Trinity on the east as far up as Cedar
Flat. At the mouth of South Fork they crossed the main Trinity
and claimed a narrow strip two or three miles in length on the
north side of the canyon where two of their villages were located,
-Ti´-koo-et-sil´-lah-kut on the high bench opposite the mouth of
-South Fork, and Me´-me&#774;h, on the site of the present Fountain
+Ti´-koo-et-sil´-lah-kut on the high bench opposite the mouth of
+South Fork, and Me´-me&#774;h, on the site of the present Fountain
Ranch about 1-1/2 miles east of the other. Their western boundary
was the divide between the tributaries of South Fork Trinity and
those of Redwood Creek (a little west of the courses of Madden
@@ -6139,7 +6102,7 @@ southern boundary, Grouse Creek and a line running from its mouth
northeasterly and following Mill Creek to the main Trinity at Cedar
Flat&mdash;thus including the Burnt Ranch country.</p>
-<p>The land of the Ts´a&#774;-nung-wha&#774; is mountainous and
+<p>The land of the Ts´a&#774;-nung-wha&#774; is mountainous and
forested, and the principal streams flow in deep canyons. It is
roughly circular in outline, and of small extent, measuring in
an air line hardly 15 miles in either direction&mdash;north-south or
@@ -6150,10 +6113,10 @@ benches overlooking the canyons.</p>
<p>Their language differs only slightly from that of the Hoopah.</p>
<p>The Tsa-nung-wha were in contact with four tribes:
-the Tin´-nung-hen-na&#772;´-o or Hoopah on the north,
-E´-tahk-na&#774;-lin´-na&#774;-kah [Tlo-hom-tah-hoi] and Che-ma-re´-ko
-[Chimariko] on the northeast, the Che-ma-re´-ko on the east and
-south, the 'Hwi´l-kut [Chilula] on the west.</p></blockquote>
+the Tin´-nung-hen-na&#772;´-o or Hoopah on the north,
+E´-tahk-na&#774;-lin´-na&#774;-kah [Tlo-hom-tah-hoi] and Che-ma-re´-ko
+[Chimariko] on the northeast, the Che-ma-re´-ko on the east and
+south, the 'Hwi´l-kut [Chilula] on the west.</p></blockquote>
<p>The following account of Merriam's first visit to the Hoopa Indian
Reservation is taken from his California Journal, Vol. 2, September 5,
@@ -6240,7 +6203,7 @@ Goddard (G), and Curtis, 1924, Vol. 13, (C).</p>
<p>1. hon-sah-tung (M). Former village on the E bank of the
Trinity R. at the N end of Hoopa V.</p>
-<p>xonsadiñ (G), "deep water place." Near the beginning of the
+<p>xonsadiñ (G), "deep water place." Near the beginning of the
canyon on the right bank at the N end of the valley.</p>
<p>honsading, "deep pool place" (C). On the E bank of the Trinity
@@ -6260,8 +6223,8 @@ Hupa (see also map 16).</p></div>
<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_212" id="Page_212">[Pg 212]</a></span></p>
-<p>2. dakisxankût (G). On the opposite side of the Trinity R.
-from xonsadiñ at the base of Bald Hill was a village, the site of
+<p>2. dakisxankût (G). On the opposite side of the Trinity R.
+from xonsadiñ at the base of Bald Hill was a village, the site of
which is now entirely grown up to trees and brush. Goddard shows 7
houses here.</p>
@@ -6270,7 +6233,7 @@ houses here.</p>
<p>3. kin-choo-whu-kut (M). On the E side of the Trinity near the
N end of Hoopa V. and just below the mouth of Mill Cr.</p>
-<p>kintcu&#772;whwikût, "on a nose" (G). This village occupies a
+<p>kintcu&#772;whwikût, "on a nose" (G). This village occupies a
point of land on the E bank just below the mouth of Mill Cr. Eight
houses are shown at this village.</p>
@@ -6282,8 +6245,8 @@ the mouth of Mill Cr.</p>
<p>4. cha-en-ta-ko-ting, "flopped out" (M). Former village on the
W bank of the Trinity R. a little above Socktish Cr.</p>
-<p>tceindeqotdiñ, "place where he was dug up" (G). This village
-was a short distance below meskût. Its name refers to a well-known
+<p>tceindeqotdiñ, "place where he was dug up" (G). This village
+was a short distance below meskût. Its name refers to a well-known
myth (see Goddard, 1904). Goddard shows 12 houses at this village.</p>
<p>cheindekhoting (C), "dug out place." On the W bank between
@@ -6298,8 +6261,8 @@ and its Yurok name is said to be kererwer (Kroeber, 1925).</p></blockquote>
<p>5. mis-kut (M). On the E side below Hostler Cr.</p>
-<p>meskût (G). This village was on the E side of the river and
-about a mile below takimiLdiñ. It "shows signs of once having been
+<p>meskût (G). This village was on the E side of the river and
+about a mile below takimiLdiñ. It "shows signs of once having been
occupied by many houses." Nine of them are shown.</p>
<p>miskut, "bluff upon" (C). On the E bank on a bluff midway
@@ -6317,7 +6280,7 @@ says that there were 6 houses here.</p></blockquote>
situated on the E bank of the Trinity a little above Hostler Cr.
Contained a large ceremonial house.</p>
-<p>takimiLdiñ, "place of the acorn feast" (G). A short distance
+<p>takimiLdiñ, "place of the acorn feast" (G). A short distance
below Tsewenaldin on the E bank. It is known as the Hostler Ranch.
This is the religious center for the whole valley. Here there
still stand the xonta nikyao, "house big," and the taikuw nakyao,
@@ -6347,7 +6310,7 @@ Gibbs gives ople-goh, corresponding to Yurok oplego (Kroeber,
<p>7. tsa-wun-al-mit-tung (M). Former village on the E side of
the Trinity in the middle of the valley.</p>
-<p>tseweñaldiñ (G). This was a large settlement on the E bank
+<p>tseweñaldiñ (G). This was a large settlement on the E bank
about a mile below toLtsasdin. It is translated by English tongues
into Senalton. There are many traces of houses here, but the people
were all killed or scattered in the troubled times of the 'sixties.
@@ -6367,7 +6330,7 @@ to the Yurok olepotl (Kroeber, 1925) and says there were 10 houses.</p></blockqu
<p>8. tol-skots-a-tung (M). Former village on the W side of the
Trinity S of the mouth of Supply Cr.</p>
-<p>to&#772;Ltsasdiñ (G). There are evidences of this village on
+<p>to&#772;Ltsasdiñ (G). There are evidences of this village on
the left bank a little S of the mouth of Supply Cr. It has long
been deserted. A prison camp was maintained near this site by the
military.</p>
@@ -6383,10 +6346,10 @@ largest village but not the head village, tah-ka-mil-ting being the
head town, ma-til-le-tung was the big boat ranch of the Hupa and
was named for ma-til, dugout canoe.</p>
-<p>medildiñ, "place of boats" (G). Just below xowûñkût the river
+<p>medildiñ, "place of boats" (G). Just below xowûñkût the river
swings back to the W, meets a spur of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_213" id="Page_213">[Pg 213]</a></span> the mountain, and then
swings back to the E, forming a peninsula. Here, cut off from the
-rest of the valley, is medildiñ (Matilton Ranch). This village,
+rest of the valley, is medildiñ (Matilton Ranch). This village,
with those to the S, forms the southern division of the Hupa
people. This division manifests itself especially in religious
matters.</p>
@@ -6406,7 +6369,7 @@ here.</p>
ma-til-le-tung and 1 mi. from the S end of the valley on the W bank
of the river.</p>
-<p>xowûñkût (G). About a mile downstream from Tish-Tang-A-Tang
+<p>xowûñkût (G). About a mile downstream from Tish-Tang-A-Tang
Cr. on the W bank of the river. Goddard shows 14 houses at this
village. The site is now called Kentuck Ranch.</p>
@@ -6419,7 +6382,7 @@ pia'getl (Kroeber, 1925).</p>
<p>11. tish-tahng-ah-tung (M). On the E bank of the Trinity R. at
the S end of Hoopa V. proper.</p>
-<p>djictañadiñ (G). At the S end of the valley where the river
+<p>djictañadiñ (G). At the S end of the valley where the river
emerges from the canyon is a point of land on the E side. This
village, known locally as tish-tang-a-tang, was situated on this
point. Just above this village Tish-Tang-A-Tang Cr. from the
@@ -6437,7 +6400,7 @@ whereas Goddard shows 13.</p>
above Hoopa V. proper. This is the uppermost village classed as
Hupa.</p>
-<p>xaslindiñ (G). About 3 mi. S of the valley proper on the E
+<p>xaslindiñ (G). About 3 mi. S of the valley proper on the E
bank of the river at the mouth of a creek of the same name (Horse
Linto Cr.). Nine houses are shown at this village.</p>
@@ -6521,18 +6484,18 @@ of the tribe, near or adjoining the territory of the Chimariko.</p></blockquote>
<blockquote>
<p>According to the Hoopah, as told me by James Chesbro of Burnt
-Ranch, the First People are called Kit-tung´-whi or Devil People.
+Ranch, the First People are called Kit-tung´-whi or Devil People.
They used to fight and kill and eat one another. Later they turned
into animals. After the Flood real (Indian) people came.</p>
<p>In early days the Indians used to get drunk from inhaling
-the fumes of Indian tobacco (Min´-ta&#772; itch´-wah) which by deep
+the fumes of Indian tobacco (Min´-ta&#772; itch´-wah) which by deep
breathing they would take into the lungs. Their word for drunk is
Ho-na&#772;<sup>ch</sup>-wi&#774;h<sup>ch</sup>. The expression for "many people drunk"
is Yah, ho-na&#772;<sup>ch</sup>-we&#774;<sup>ch</sup>.</p>
-<p>The word for an old person is Kis´-te-ahn; for an old object,
-Tah´-ne.</p>
+<p>The word for an old person is Kis´-te-ahn; for an old object,
+Tah´-ne.</p>
<p>There are two words for good: Chung-whoom for a good or kind
person; and Noo-who&#772;m for a good thing or object. A bad person is
@@ -6540,17 +6503,17 @@ To choong-ko&#772;m, "not good person"; while a thing that is not good
is To noo<sup>ch</sup>-ko&#772;m, "not good thing."</p>
<p>Chin-tahs, "slow", is said to mean also "heavy"; but the word
-given me for heavy is Nit-tahs´.</p>
+given me for heavy is Nit-tahs´.</p>
-<p>The word Ho´-chit, meaning real or genuine, occurs frequently:
-Thus, deerskin tanned with the hair on is called Ho´-chit te,
+<p>The word Ho´-chit, meaning real or genuine, occurs frequently:
+Thus, deerskin tanned with the hair on is called Ho´-chit te,
te being any blanket or toga. Similarly, the ordinary woman's
-apron made of pine nuts and braided grass is Ho´-che ke´-ah; the
-woman's hat, Ho&#772;-che ko&#772;s´-tahn, or real hat; moccasins, Hoch
-ya&#772;´-che-tahl; the bow, Ho&#772;-che&#774; tsitch-ting; the stone
+apron made of pine nuts and braided grass is Ho´-che ke´-ah; the
+woman's hat, Ho&#772;-che ko&#772;s´-tahn, or real hat; moccasins, Hoch
+ya&#772;´-che-tahl; the bow, Ho&#772;-che&#774; tsitch-ting; the stone
arrow-point, Ho&#772;-che&#774; tin-ti; Indian or wild tobacco, Ho&#772;-che
-Min´-ta&#772;-itch´-wah; the elkhorn box or purse for valuables
-Ho&#772;´-che kin´-chah.</p>
+Min´-ta&#772;-itch´-wah; the elkhorn box or purse for valuables
+Ho&#772;´-che kin´-chah.</p>
<p>The Hoopah say that their people did not use the nose-bone or
nose-stick, but had a name for it, which is Hun-choo whang-i. They
@@ -6558,16 +6521,16 @@ say these were worn by the Indians farther north.</p>
<p>The women tattooed the chin, usually in three broad vertical
bands similar to those of the Klamath River tribes. Tattoo marks
-are called Wil´-tahch´.</p>
+are called Wil´-tahch´.</p>
<p>Place names: All place names along the rivers were at one time
the sites of villages or rancherias. The village always takes the
name of the place.</p>
-<p>The name for house is Ho&#772;n´-tah or Hun´-tow; the ceremonial
-house, Ma&#772;´-min sin-til; the sweathouse, Tah´-'keo; the menstrual
-lodge, Mintch'; the brush wickiup, Ma&#772;´-nah-si; the brush blind
-or hut for concealing the hunter Kew´-wong wil´-min.</p>
+<p>The name for house is Ho&#772;n´-tah or Hun´-tow; the ceremonial
+house, Ma&#772;´-min sin-til; the sweathouse, Tah´-'keo; the menstrual
+lodge, Mintch'; the brush wickiup, Ma&#772;´-nah-si; the brush blind
+or hut for concealing the hunter Kew´-wong wil´-min.</p>
<p>They say that they never burned the dead, but buried them
in graves dug exactly knee-deep by measure. The grave was called
@@ -6578,7 +6541,7 @@ belongings of the dead person and then with earth.</p>
<p>While they do not burn the bodies, they burn clothing and
other belongings. But the Chemareko of Hyampom burn their dead.</p>
-<p>They believed in an evil spirit or Devil called Kit-tung´ hwoi.</p>
+<p>They believed in an evil spirit or Devil called Kit-tung´ hwoi.</p>
<p>A peculiar custom was practised in extending a certain
courtesy to an enemy who wanted to cross the river but had no boat.
@@ -6605,7 +6568,7 @@ points or guesses. One stick is given up at each wrong guess.</p>
<p>Small hailstones are called Klew-hahn min-nah from Klew-hahn,
"an eel," and min-nah, "eyes," from the resemblance of small
hailstones to the white eyes of the eel. Big hailstones are
-Ke´-lo-ung-hot.</p>
+Ke´-lo-ung-hot.</p>
<p>An earthquake is Nin mah-ah tin-ni&#774;<sup>ch</sup>-chwit, meaning
"turns over on edge of world."</p>
@@ -6613,7 +6576,7 @@ Ke´-lo-ung-hot.</p>
<p>Money: The unit of value, which we call "money," consisted
of the valuable kind of dentalium shells, long specimens of which
reached from the base of the finger to the base of the terminal
-joint. This was called Ho´-che naht-te-ow or "real money." Small or
+joint. This was called Ho´-che naht-te-ow or "real money." Small or
broken dentalium shells, from half an inch to an inch in length,
were called Mit-tatch, and were used for beads.</p>
@@ -6624,15 +6587,15 @@ as money.</p>
<p><i>Names of mammals and birds.</i>&mdash;The Grizzly Bear had two names:
Me&#774;-cha&#772;-e-sahn and Me-kwo ah.</p>
-<p>The Mountain Lion or Cougar is called Min´-ning mi&#774;<sup>ch</sup>
+<p>The Mountain Lion or Cougar is called Min´-ning mi&#774;<sup>ch</sup>
'hla&#772;-til-loo, meaning "kills with his face."</p>
-<p>They speak of a spotted Panther of large size called Kit-sah´,
+<p>They speak of a spotted Panther of large size called Kit-sah´,
which has not been seen for a number of years. It used to make a
great noise.</p>
<p>They speak also of a Water Panther (mythical) called
-Ho-tsi´-tow, said to live in holes close to the water of lakes and
+Ho-tsi´-tow, said to live in holes close to the water of lakes and
pools, never in rivers or on land. Its head and shoulders were
heavy and covered with long shaggy hair, but the hinder parts were
nearly naked.</p>
@@ -6644,7 +6607,7 @@ salmon."</p>
Klew<sup>ch</sup>-mu&#774;-hung, meaning "snake's husband"&mdash;a term doubtless
suggested by its snake-like form and actions.</p>
-<p>The Mole is called Min-ni´ e&#774;-ting, meaning "eyeless"; the
+<p>The Mole is called Min-ni´ e&#774;-ting, meaning "eyeless"; the
Bat Haht-la nah-mut, "night flyer."</p>
<p>The Porcupine is 'K'yo. Its quills, usually dyed yellow, were
@@ -6698,20 +6661,20 @@ enemies. Once he told another bird to start from one end of the
world and he would start from the other. They did this and met in
the middle where they danced.</p>
-<p><i>Notes on adjacent tribes.</i>&mdash;Yin´-nah´-chin ("South People,"
-Chemar´eko). Extended from Hyampom northerly to Cedar Flat,
+<p><i>Notes on adjacent tribes.</i>&mdash;Yin´-nah´-chin ("South People,"
+Chemar´eko). Extended from Hyampom northerly to Cedar Flat,
easterly along main Trinity to Canyon Creek; and northerly between
the high mountains that form the divide between French Creek and
North Fork Trinity River on the west to Canyon Creek on the east,
as far north as Rattlesnake Creek. (Previously learned from the
-Nor´-rel-muk of Hay Fork, a Wintoon Tribe, that the dividing line
+Nor´-rel-muk of Hay Fork, a Wintoon Tribe, that the dividing line
on the west between themselves and the Chemareko, called by them
Hyembos, lay along Minor Creek.) Language wholly different from
Hoopah. The Hoopah say that the presence of this tribe on Trinity
River west of Cedar Bar, and on lower New River, is a comparatively
recent intrusion.</p>
-<p>Klo´-me&#774;-tah´-wha ... Salmon River Indians. Ranges south
+<p>Klo´-me&#774;-tah´-wha ... Salmon River Indians. Ranges south
over summit to Grizzly Creek and headwaters New River. Language
wholly different.</p>
@@ -6997,11 +6960,11 @@ thousand.</p>
<p><i>Pitch Wailaki.</i>&mdash;Goddard (1924) records 33 villages for the Pitch
Wailaki. For two of the four tribelets, the count is virtually complete.
-For a third tribelet, the T'odannañkiyahañ, Goddard lists 6 villages and
+For a third tribelet, the T'odannañkiyahañ, Goddard lists 6 villages and
indicates that there were probably more (1924, p. 225). If, to allow for
these possible villages, we add 5 to the total above, we get a total of
38 villages for three tribelets, or an average of 12.7 per tribelet.
-Although the fourth tribelet, the Tchokotkiyahañ, had a poorer habitat
+Although the fourth tribelet, the Tchokotkiyahañ, had a poorer habitat
than the other three (Goddard, 1924, p. 222), we may assume that it had
at least 8 villages, an estimate which is probably conservative in view
of its extensive territory. We then get a total of 46 villages for the
@@ -7736,7 +7699,7 @@ normal regression line may be obtained with the following formula.</p>
<p>and of a is</p>
<p>
-<span style="margin-left: 1em;">â = Y&#773; &minus; b&#770;X&#773;</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">â = Y&#773; &minus; b&#770;X&#773;</span><br />
</p>
<p>where X<sub>i</sub> = ln A for each group with known population and Y<sub>i</sub> = P
@@ -7753,7 +7716,7 @@ for each known group.</p>
<p>and of a' is</p>
<p>
-<span style="margin-left: 1em;">â' = Y&#773; &minus; b&#770;'X&#773;</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">â' = Y&#773; &minus; b&#770;'X&#773;</span><br />
</p>
<p>where X<sub>i</sub> = ln F for each known group and Y<sub>i</sub> = P for each known group.
@@ -7775,7 +7738,7 @@ These calculations are shown in table 4.</p>
<td rowspan="7"></td>
<td class="tdc">(X<sub>i</sub> &minus; X&#773;)</td>
<td class="tdc">(Y<sub>i</sub> &minus; Y&#773;)</td>
- <td class="tdc">(X<sub>i</sub> &minus; X&#773;)·(Y<sub>i</sub> &minus; Y&#773;)</td>
+ <td class="tdc">(X<sub>i</sub> &minus; X&#773;)·(Y<sub>i</sub> &minus; Y&#773;)</td>
<td class="tdc">(X<sub>i</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup></td>
</tr>
<tr>
@@ -7831,7 +7794,7 @@ These calculations are shown in table 4.</p>
<td rowspan="7"></td>
<td class="tdc">(X<sub>i</sub> &minus; X&#773;)</td>
<td class="tdc">(Y<sub>i</sub> &minus; Y&#773;)</td>
- <td class="tdc">(X<sub>i</sub> &minus; X&#773;)·(Y<sub>i</sub> &minus; Y&#773;)</td>
+ <td class="tdc">(X<sub>i</sub> &minus; X&#773;)·(Y<sub>i</sub> &minus; Y&#773;)</td>
<td class="tdc">(X<sub>i</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup></td>
</tr>
<tr>
@@ -7901,7 +7864,7 @@ Franklin, 1954, p. 229).</p>
<pre>
{1 (X<sub>o</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup> }
- 1.02 X<sub>o</sub> &minus; 4.06 ± t<sub>&prop;</sub>S<sub>a</sub> × &radic;{- + -----------}
+ 1.02 X<sub>o</sub> &minus; 4.06 ± t<sub>&prop;</sub>S<sub>a</sub> × &radic;{- + -----------}
{6 &Sigma;(X<sub>i</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup>}
</pre>
@@ -7923,7 +7886,7 @@ confidence coefficient.</p>
<pre>
{1 }
- S<sub>a</sub> = &radic;{- × &Sigma;(Y<sub>i</sub> + 4.06 &minus; 1.02X<sub>i</sub>)<sup>2</sup>}
+ S<sub>a</sub> = &radic;{- × &Sigma;(Y<sub>i</sub> + 4.06 &minus; 1.02X<sub>i</sub>)<sup>2</sup>}
{4 }
<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_222" id="Page_222">[Pg 222]</a></span></pre>
@@ -7987,7 +7950,7 @@ fishing-mile estimates are:</p>
<td>(X<sub>o</sub> &minus; X&#773;)</td>
<td>(X<sub>o</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup><br />---------------<br />&Sigma;((X<sub>i</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup>)</td>
<td>{&nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; (X<sub>o</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup>}<br />&radic;{1/6 + ----------------}<br />{&nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp;&Sigma;((X<sub>i</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup>)}</td>
- <td>{&nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; (X<sub>o</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup>}<br />t<sub>.2</sub>S<sub>a</sub> × &radic;{1/6 + ----------------}<br />{&nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp;&Sigma;((X<sub>i</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup>)}</td>
+ <td>{&nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; (X<sub>o</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup>}<br />t<sub>.2</sub>S<sub>a</sub> × &radic;{1/6 + ----------------}<br />{&nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp;&Sigma;((X<sub>i</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup>)}</td>
</tr>
<tr>
@@ -8047,7 +8010,7 @@ fishing-mile estimates are:</p>
<td>(X<sub>o</sub> &minus; X&#773;)</td>
<td>(X<sub>o</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup><br />---------------<br />&Sigma;((X<sub>i</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup>)</td>
<td>{&nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; (X<sub>o</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup>}<br />&radic;{1/6 + ----------------}<br />{&nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp;&Sigma;((X<sub>i</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup>)}</td>
- <td>{&nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; (X<sub>o</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup>}<br />t<sub>.2</sub>S<sub>f</sub> × &radic;{1/6 + ----------------}<br />{&nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp;&Sigma;((X<sub>i</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup>)}</td>
+ <td>{&nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; (X<sub>o</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup>}<br />t<sub>.2</sub>S<sub>f</sub> × &radic;{1/6 + ----------------}<br />{&nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp;&Sigma;((X<sub>i</sub> &minus; X&#773;)<sup>2</sup>)}</td>
</tr>
<tr>
@@ -8096,28 +8059,28 @@ are a bit shorter on the average.</p>
</tr>
<tr>
<td class="tdl">Kato</td>
- <td>1,523 ± 267</td>
- <td>1,470 ± 263</td>
+ <td>1,523 ± 267</td>
+ <td>1,470 ± 263</td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td class="tdl">Bear River</td>
- <td>1,276 ± 353</td>
- <td>840 ± 556</td>
+ <td>1,276 ± 353</td>
+ <td>840 ± 556</td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td class="tdl">Lassik</td>
- <td>1,411 ± 300</td>
- <td>2,020 ± 291</td>
+ <td>1,411 ± 300</td>
+ <td>2,020 ± 291</td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td class="tdl">Nongatl</td>
- <td>2,325 ± 462</td>
- <td>2,830 ± 692</td>
+ <td>2,325 ± 462</td>
+ <td>2,830 ± 692</td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td class="tdl">Shelter Cove Sinkyone</td>
- <td>2,145 ± 374</td>
- <td>1,920 ± 257</td>
+ <td>2,145 ± 374</td>
+ <td>1,920 ± 257</td>
</tr>
</table></div>
@@ -8390,18 +8353,18 @@ and Lopez' father at the Mouth of Smith River, Del Norte County, Sept.
<p><i>Name.</i>&mdash;The tribe as a whole had no distinctive name for themselves
except Huss, the word for people. But they had definite names for
village areas. Those living at the mouth of Smith River call themselves
-Hah´-wun-kwut; those at Burnt Ranch, about three miles south of
-the mouth of Smith River, Yahnk´-tah-kut; those at Crescent City
-Tah-ah´-ten&mdash;and so on.</p>
+Hah´-wun-kwut; those at Burnt Ranch, about three miles south of
+the mouth of Smith River, Yahnk´-tah-kut; those at Crescent City
+Tah-ah´-ten&mdash;and so on.</p>
<p><i>Location, boundaries, and neighbors.</i>&mdash;The territory of the tribe
-as a whole extends from Winchuk River (Um-sahng´-ten) on the
+as a whole extends from Winchuk River (Um-sahng´-ten) on the
California-Oregon boundary south to Wilson Creek (Tah-ges<sup>hl</sup>-ten)
about eight miles north of the mouth of Klamath River.</p>
<p>The coast tribe immediately north (on the Oregon side of the line) is
-called Cheet or Che´-te. Their language differs materially from that of
-the Hah´-wun-kwut, though most of the words could be understood. Only a
+called Cheet or Che´-te. Their language differs materially from that of
+the Hah´-wun-kwut, though most of the words could be understood. Only a
single woman survives.</p>
<p>The tribe on the south, from Wilson Creek to Klamath River, is called
@@ -8412,7 +8375,7 @@ California-Oregon boundary is called Ka-Ka-sha. Another name, Choo-ne,
also was given but I am in doubt as to whether or not the same tribe
was meant. The Ka-ka-sha live near Waldo on the north side of the
Siskiyou Mountains and speak a language widely different from that of
-the Hah´-wun-kwut. They are said to be lighter in color than the coast
+the Hah´-wun-kwut. They are said to be lighter in color than the coast
Indians.</p>
<p><i>Dress and ornament.</i>&mdash;The people used deer skin blankets called
@@ -8423,7 +8386,7 @@ and tat-es-tat. Moccasins, Kus-ki-a, of elk hide were worn by rich men.</p>
<p>The women wore a front apron called Sahng; and on dress occasions an
ornamented cloak-like skirt (Chah) that extended all the way around and
-lapped over in front. They also wore basket hats, called Ki´-e-traht´
+lapped over in front. They also wore basket hats, called Ki´-e-traht´
and necklaces, the general term for which is Ni-ta-kle-ah. On occasions
they wore ear pendants, Bus-shra-mes-lah, of elk or deer bone. Nose
bones or shells, Mish-mes-lah, were sometimes worn; those of rich
@@ -8433,65 +8396,65 @@ tattooed with three narrow vertical lines called Tah-ah rut<sup>hl</sup>-tes.</p
<p><i>Houses.</i>&mdash;The houses (Munt) were square and were built of planks or
slabs hewn from redwood trees and stood up vertically, as in the case
of those of the Klamath River Indians. The ceremonial houses are called
-Na&#772;´-stahs-ma&#772;´-ne. They are square and have a ridge roof. During
+Na&#772;´-stahs-ma&#772;´-ne. They are square and have a ridge roof. During
important dances the front side is removed. The sweat house is called
-Shes´-kle&#774; and is large enough to hold twenty people. It is square or
+Shes´-kle&#774; and is large enough to hold twenty people. It is square or
rectangular, and the ground floor is excavated to a depth of about four
feet. The roof is of hewn planks covered with earth.</p>
<p><i>Money.</i>&mdash;The ordinary medium of exchange or "money" (Trut) consisted
of shells of <i>Dentalium</i>, of which the valuable long ones are called
-Ta&#772;´-tos, the commoner short ones Kle´-ah. Clam shell disks or buttons
-are called Nah´-set.</p>
+Ta&#772;´-tos, the commoner short ones Kle´-ah. Clam shell disks or buttons
+are called Nah´-set.</p>
-<p><i>Treatment of dead.</i>&mdash;The dead are buried in a grave (Che&#774;´-slo). The
+<p><i>Treatment of dead.</i>&mdash;The dead are buried in a grave (Che&#774;´-slo). The
people assert that they never burned their dead. They say that a spirit
-or ghost, called Nah-who´-tlan, goes out of the body after death and
+or ghost, called Nah-who´-tlan, goes out of the body after death and
becomes a ghost.</p>
-<p><i>Ceremonial dances.</i>&mdash;Dances are called Na&#772;´-stahs or Nesh-stahsh. A
-puberty dance, Chahs´-stah wa&#772;´-nish tahs, was held for the girls.
+<p><i>Ceremonial dances.</i>&mdash;Dances are called Na&#772;´-stahs or Nesh-stahsh. A
+puberty dance, Chahs´-stah wa&#772;´-nish tahs, was held for the girls.
Other important dances are held. Some last 5 days; others last 10 days.</p>
-<p>The ceremonial drums Hah´-et-sah differ radically from those of any
+<p>The ceremonial drums Hah´-et-sah differ radically from those of any
other California Indians known to me. They are large cooking baskets
about two feet in diameter. Only new baskets are used in order that they
may stand the drumming.</p>
-<p>Rattles called Chah-pa&#772;t´-chah are made of the small hoofs of deer.
+<p>Rattles called Chah-pa&#772;t´-chah are made of the small hoofs of deer.
Cocoon rattles were not used.</p>
-<p>Whistles, called Tut´-tle-nik are made of large quill feathers of birds,
+<p>Whistles, called Tut´-tle-nik are made of large quill feathers of birds,
not of bone.</p>
<p><i>The stick game.</i>&mdash;The stick game is a feature of the people, as in most
California tribes. It consists of a number of slender sticks called
-Not-tra&#772;´-le, of which one, called Chah-when´, is marked. The counters
-are called Chun´; the man who keeps count, Chun-ting. A dressed buckskin
+Not-tra&#772;´-le, of which one, called Chah-when´, is marked. The counters
+are called Chun´; the man who keeps count, Chun-ting. A dressed buckskin
is stretched tightly on the ground between the players, and when the
game is called, the sticks are thrown down upon it.</p>
<p><i>Baskets.</i>&mdash;The basketry is of twined weave called Chet-too. The big
storehouse baskets, called Hawsh-tan, are closely woven and have a
shallow saucer-shape lid. The large open work burden basket is called
-Tus, the large cooking basket, Met-too´-sil<sup>ch</sup>, the small mush bowl
-Hah´-tsah, the large shallow meal tray Mes-chet´-te-gah´, the large
-open work shallow bowl Tre-kwahs´-tuk, the small open work plate or
-platter Kah´-se, the subglobular choke-mouth trinket basket Net´-tah,
-the milling basket Ki´-e-sut, the baby basket Kah´-yu, its shade
-Ne´-whats-tah, the women's basket hat Ki´-e-traht´. There is also a
-subglobular openwork basket called I´-a&#774;-loo´ with an arched handle
+Tus, the large cooking basket, Met-too´-sil<sup>ch</sup>, the small mush bowl
+Hah´-tsah, the large shallow meal tray Mes-chet´-te-gah´, the large
+open work shallow bowl Tre-kwahs´-tuk, the small open work plate or
+platter Kah´-se, the subglobular choke-mouth trinket basket Net´-tah,
+the milling basket Ki´-e-sut, the baby basket Kah´-yu, its shade
+Ne´-whats-tah, the women's basket hat Ki´-e-traht´. There is also a
+subglobular openwork basket called I´-a&#774;-loo´ with an arched handle
for carrying on the arm.</p>
<p>The cooking bowls, mush baskets, and other small baskets are made
-of spruce roots, 'Hre´, more or less covered with an overlay of
+of spruce roots, 'Hre´, more or less covered with an overlay of
<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_226" id="Page_226">[Pg 226]</a></span>bear grass (<i>Xerophyllum</i>, called Too-te&#774;<sup>chl</sup>) and maiden hair
-fern (<i>Adiantum</i>) called Ke´-tsi-shah´-te, meaning Blue-jay knees,
+fern (<i>Adiantum</i>) called Ke´-tsi-shah´-te, meaning Blue-jay knees,
because of the slender form and black color. The roots used in the
carrying baskets, baby baskets, and other coarse baskets are of hazel,
called 'Kun. The common black design in ordinary baskets consists
of Spruce roots that have been buried in dark mud and are called
-Tah´-che-gut-kle-ah. They are ordinarily used in connection with the
+Tah´-che-gut-kle-ah. They are ordinarily used in connection with the
bear grass (<i>Xerophyllum</i>).</p>
<p><i>Fragments of Hahwunkwut myths.</i>&mdash;Skum, Coyote man, made the world.</p>
@@ -8500,13 +8463,13 @@ bear grass (<i>Xerophyllum</i>).</p>
blackened the insides of his hands.</p>
<p>When the world first floated there was just one big white Redwood tree
-called Kus-choo´-ke. A big Eagle was sitting on the tree and was king of
+called Kus-choo´-ke. A big Eagle was sitting on the tree and was king of
the world.</p>
-<p>The Falcon (Tah´-tes) won the battle for the people.</p>
+<p>The Falcon (Tah´-tes) won the battle for the people.</p>
<p><i>Hahwunkwut foods.</i>&mdash;A large variety of foods are eaten: meat
-(Cha&#772;´-sun) of elk and deer, both fresh and dried, salmon and
+(Cha&#772;´-sun) of elk and deer, both fresh and dried, salmon and
other fish, fresh and dried, marrow, tallow, salmon eggs (usually
smoke-dried), clams of several kinds, mussels, fish milt both dried and
fresh, acorn mush and bread, and a number of roots, berries, and other
@@ -8520,7 +8483,7 @@ eggs.</p>
<p>Two kinds of kelp are eaten.</p>
-<p>Root masses of the brake fern (<i>Pteris aquilina</i>, called Tah´-sohn-ki)
+<p>Root masses of the brake fern (<i>Pteris aquilina</i>, called Tah´-sohn-ki)
are cooked in the ground oven. They are said to be like milk and have a
fine flavor.</p>
@@ -8530,39 +8493,39 @@ fine flavor.</p>
pipe is straight and is called A-chah.</p>
<p><i>Hahwunkwut plant notes.</i>&mdash;The Tree Maple (<i>Acer macrophyllum</i>) is
-called Cha&#772;´-she. Its inner bark is used for the ordinary everyday
+called Cha&#772;´-she. Its inner bark is used for the ordinary everyday
dress for women.</p>
<p>The Tanbark Oak is the dominant species in the northwest coast region
-and its acorns (Sohng´-cheng) are largely eaten by the people. Acorn
+and its acorns (Sohng´-cheng) are largely eaten by the people. Acorn
meal before leaching is called Rut-ta-gaht. If it is allowed to become
mouldy, the bitter taste disappears so that it does not have to be
leached. Acorn bread cooked on hot ashes is called Ses<sup>hl</sup>-te. The
ordinary mush is called Ma-guts-kush.</p>
<p><i>Hahwunkwut animal notes.</i>&mdash;The Bobcat (<i>Lynx rufus</i>) is called
-Ne´-ti-us ah´-na&#772;. Its name is never mentioned in the presence of a
+Ne´-ti-us ah´-na&#772;. Its name is never mentioned in the presence of a
baby. If the mother sees one before the baby is born, the baby will have
fits and die.</p>
-<p>The falcon or Duck Hawk (Tah´-tes) was a high personage among the First
+<p>The falcon or Duck Hawk (Tah´-tes) was a high personage among the First
People. He won the first battle for the Indians, standing on the first
Redwood Tree.</p>
-<p>The California Condor (Ta&#772;-long-yi´-chah) is so big and powerful that
+<p>The California Condor (Ta&#772;-long-yi´-chah) is so big and powerful that
he can lift a whale. His name shows this as it is from the name of the
-whale (Ta&#772;´-lah) and means "whale lifter."</p>
+whale (Ta&#772;´-lah) and means "whale lifter."</p>
-<p>The Dove (Sroo´-e-gun´-sah) cries for his grandmother, especially in the
+<p>The Dove (Sroo´-e-gun´-sah) cries for his grandmother, especially in the
spring of the year.</p>
-<p>The Purple Finch is called Klah´-nis-me´-tit-le, meaning "many
+<p>The Purple Finch is called Klah´-nis-me´-tit-le, meaning "many
brothers," because the birds go together in small flocks.</p>
-<p>The Night Heron (Nah-gah´ che yahs´-se) is known as the "sickness bird."</p>
+<p>The Night Heron (Nah-gah´ che yahs´-se) is known as the "sickness bird."</p>
<p><i>Hahwunkwut pits for catching elk and deer.</i>&mdash;The Smith River
-Hah-wun-kwut used to catch elk and deer in pits, called Song´-kit, dug
+Hah-wun-kwut used to catch elk and deer in pits, called Song´-kit, dug
in the ground along the runways. These pits differ materially from those
of the Pit River Indians, being much shallower. No effort was made to
make them deep enough to prevent the captured animals from jumping out,
@@ -8591,12 +8554,12 @@ thoroughly dry.</p>
killings by the whites.</p>
<p>The first killing took place at Burnt Ranch, three miles south of
-the mouth of Smith River, at the rancheria called Yahnk-tah´-kut,
+the mouth of Smith River, at the rancheria called Yahnk-tah´-kut,
a name perpetuated by the district school house name. Here a large
number of Indians were caught during a ceremonial dance and ruthlessly
slaughtered. The Indians say this was the first killing.</p>
-<p>The second killing was at the rancheria of A&#772;´-choo-lik on the big
+<p>The second killing was at the rancheria of A&#772;´-choo-lik on the big
lagoon known as Lake Earl about three miles north of Crescent City [cf.
Drucker's etculet in Drucker, 1937, map 3]. The Indians were engaged in
gambling at the time.</p>
@@ -8605,15 +8568,15 @@ gambling at the time.</p>
Drucker, 1937, map 3] at the mouth of Smith River.</p>
<p>At the time of the Indian troubles in northwestern California Chief
-Ki´-lis (named for Ki-o-lus the Willow tree) was chief of the
-Hah´-wun-kwut tribe.</p>
+Ki´-lis (named for Ki-o-lus the Willow tree) was chief of the
+Hah´-wun-kwut tribe.</p>
<p>Three young men of the tribe were active in resenting the aggressions of
the whites and were said to have killed several of the early settlers.
They were very clever and neither the settlers nor the soldiers were
able to capture them. Finally the officer in charge of the troops at
Fort Dick (a log fort on Smith River, about three miles from the present
-settlement called Smith River Corners) told Chief Ki´-lis that he would
+settlement called Smith River Corners) told Chief Ki´-lis that he would
be hung by the soldiers unless he captured the three young men in
question.</p>
@@ -8644,7 +8607,7 @@ also some blankets. This ended the "Indian war" in that region.</p>
<p>There is a small island called Stun-tahs ahn-kot (50 acres or more in
extent) in the lower part of Smith River, half or three-quarters of a
-mile from its mouth. On some of the early maps it bears the name Ta´-les
+mile from its mouth. On some of the early maps it bears the name Ta´-les
after the chief. This island the officer gave to the Indians in the name
of the Government, telling them it would always be theirs, and gave the
chief a paper stating that it was given in return for killing the three
@@ -8652,7 +8615,7 @@ outlaw boys. Sometime afterward this paper was burned.</p>
<p>After the Indians had been driven to the Hoopa Reservation and had
come back, they were not allowed to go to their former rancheria
-Hah´-wun-kwut, but were told to go to this island. Later the whites
+Hah´-wun-kwut, but were told to go to this island. Later the whites
claimed the island and did not let the Indians have it.</p>
<p>The present Indian settlement, a mile or two north of the mouth of
@@ -8673,25 +8636,25 @@ occupied at present (1923) by ten or a dozen families.</p>
<p>The following data were got from Eben Tillotson at Hulls Valley, north
of Round Valley, on July 12, 1938.</p>
-<p>A. Eben said he was a Wi·t'u·knó'm Yuki. This was a "tribe" speaking
+<p>A. Eben said he was a Wi·t'u·knó'm Yuki. This was a "tribe" speaking
a uniform dialect, having uniform customs, but embracing several
"tribelets." Their general territory was along main (or middle) Eel R.
where this runs from E to W, on both sides of it, and S of Round V. They
-also owned Oklá·c&#774; and Púnki·nipi·t&#803; ("wormwood hole"), Poonkiny.
+also owned Oklá·c&#774; and Púnki·nipi·t&#803; ("wormwood hole"), Poonkiny.
The subdivisions or tribelets were:</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>[10.6] 1. Us&#774;i·c&#774;lAlhótno'm
+<p>[10.6] 1. Us&#774;i·c&#774;lAlhótno'm
("crayfish-creek-large-people") on Salt Cr., S of Middle Eel.</p>
-<p>2. Olkátno'm, at Henley or Hop ranch in S part of Round
+<p>2. Olkátno'm, at Henley or Hop ranch in S part of Round
V., where the road enters the flat of the valley. They owned S
to the Middle Eel and down it to Dos Rios confluence.</p>
-<p>3. Alniuk'í·no'm, at W edge of Round V.</p>
+<p>3. Alniuk'í·no'm, at W edge of Round V.</p>
-<p>4. Ontítno'm, E of Henley ranch in Round V.; also Eden
+<p>4. Ontítno'm, E of Henley ranch in Round V.; also Eden
V. to S.</p></blockquote>
<p>B. The following were not grouped together by the informant, but agree
@@ -8699,14 +8662,14 @@ in having a southerly range:</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>[10.6] 5. LAlkú·tno'm, around Outlet Cr.</p>
+<p>[10.6] 5. LAlkú·tno'm, around Outlet Cr.</p>
-<p>6. Tí·tAmno'm, eastward, across (S of Middle) Eel R.,
+<p>6. Tí·tAmno'm, eastward, across (S of Middle) Eel R.,
toward Sanhedrin Mt., W of the ridge which runs W of Gravelly
V. Mountain people, without villages of size. Dixie Duncan was
half of this group.</p>
-<p>7. Ki·c&#774;ilú·kam is Gravelly V. The Huchnom roamed in
+<p>7. Ki·c&#774;ilú·kam is Gravelly V. The Huchnom roamed in
that.</p></blockquote>
<p>C. East of Hull's V., extending nearly to Hammerhorn Mt., but this was
@@ -8714,13 +8677,13 @@ Nomlaki.</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>[10.6] 8. S&#780;ipimA´lno'm, on a creek running from W
+<p>[10.6] 8. S&#780;ipimA´lno'm, on a creek running from W
into (S-flowing) Eel R.</p>
-<p>9. I·'mptí·tAmno'm, at an opening in the range&mdash;i·'mp is
+<p>9. I·'mptí·tAmno'm, at an opening in the range&mdash;i·'mp is
a gap. They were across the Eel, on its E side.</p>
-<p>10. Pi·lílno'm, beyond (farther E or SE?), at Kumpí·t,
+<p>10. Pi·lílno'm, beyond (farther E or SE?), at Kumpí·t,
"salt hole," where salt was got, also at Snow Mt. These were
Yuki, but "talked something like" Nomlaki Wintun (who adjoined
them, across the main Coast Range watershed). Their language
@@ -8728,23 +8691,23 @@ was about as different from Yuki as was Huchnom. They were
"half Stony Creek" (along which lived Salt Pomo, then Hill
Patwin, then Nomlaki).</p>
-<p>11. U·k'í·c&#774;no'm (added later by informant), in
+<p>11. U·k'í·c&#774;no'm (added later by informant), in
Williams V., "E" of Hull's V.</p>
<p>12. A Yuki group at Twin Rock Cr.&mdash;Eben had forgotten
their name.</p></blockquote>
<p>D. The real Yuki, centering in Round V., and coming N into the foothills
-only about as far as Ebley's Flat. To the N were the Onainó'm, Pitch
+only about as far as Ebley's Flat. To the N were the Onainó'm, Pitch
Indians, Athabascans, who owned Hull V. ("here") and adjoined the
S&#780;ipimAlno'm (no. 8).</p>
<blockquote>
-<p>[10.6] 13. Hákno'm, in Round V., around Agency, in the N
+<p>[10.6] 13. Hákno'm, in Round V., around Agency, in the N
side of the valley.</p>
-<p>14. Ukomnó'm, in middle of the valley. They did not own
+<p>14. Ukomnó'm, in middle of the valley. They did not own
up into the mountains.</p>
<p>15. At TotimAl, W of Covelo, were a people whose name
@@ -8790,7 +8753,7 @@ initiations and performances.</p>
</tr>
<tr>
- <td>·</td>
+ <td>·</td>
<td>long</td>
</tr>
<tr>
@@ -8818,11 +8781,11 @@ initiations and performances.</p>
<h4>DATA FROM EBEN TILLOTSON</h4>
-<p>Onainó'm were the Pitch Indians, a people of the rugged mountains,
-adjoining the S&#780;ipimA´lno'm Yuki, and with Hull's Valley in their
+<p>Onainó'm were the Pitch Indians, a people of the rugged mountains,
+adjoining the S&#780;ipimA´lno'm Yuki, and with Hull's Valley in their
range. They were "half Yuki and half Wailaki," and spoke both languages.</p>
-<p>The TA´no'm were at Spy Rock on main Eel R. They were also half Yuki and
+<p>The TA´no'm were at Spy Rock on main Eel R. They were also half Yuki and
half Wailaki and bilingual. [But other Yuki cite them as Yuki who also
knew Wailaki.] TAno'm were: Nancy Dobie, Sally Duncan, and Tip.</p>
@@ -8842,7 +8805,7 @@ Valley on July 13, 1938. Lucy Young, the informant, was born on Eel
River at Tseyes&#774;ente&#410;, opposite Alder Point. Though listed by the
Government as a Wailaki, she is actually what ethnologists call Lassik.
Her father was born 3 mi. from Alder Pt.; her mother, at Soldier Basin,
-22 mi. NE. Her mother's first cousin was T'a·su's, known to the whites
+22 mi. NE. Her mother's first cousin was T'a·su's, known to the whites
as Lassik, from his Wintun name Lasek. He was chief for Alder Pt.,
Soldier Basin, (upper) Mad River. Mary Major, informant's contemporary,
is from Soldier Basin and of the same tribe.</p>
@@ -8865,7 +8828,7 @@ and on Van Duzen R.</p>
<p>Sec&#774;(&#410;)enden-keya, at Zenia.</p>
-<p>Ka·snol-keya, S of Zenia, called Kikawake in Hayfork [Wintun].</p>
+<p>Ka·snol-keya, S of Zenia, called Kikawake in Hayfork [Wintun].</p>
<p>Tok'(a)-keya, South Fork of Eel Indians [Sinkyone].</p>
@@ -8892,7 +8855,7 @@ applied also to the Cottonwood Creek Wintun, whom the Lassik met at
Yolla Bolly Mt. to trade salt. [Wintu and Wintun were treated as
one language.]</p>
-<p>Yitá·kena, people of lowest Eel R., the Wiyot.</p>
+<p>Yitá·kena, people of lowest Eel R., the Wiyot.</p>
</blockquote>
<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_230" id="Page_230">[Pg 230]</a></span></p>
<hr class="chap" />
@@ -9222,385 +9185,6 @@ of Hupa villages. Map by George Gibbs, 1852.</p></div>
<p>P. 23 capital L in the middle of two Indian words may be intentional.</p>
</div>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-<pre>
-
-
-
-
-
-End of Project Gutenberg's California Athabascan Groups, by Martin A. Baumhoff
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK CALIFORNIA ATHABASCAN GROUPS ***
-
-***** This file should be named 43876-h.htm or 43876-h.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/4/3/8/7/43876/
-
-Produced by Colin Bell, Richard Tonsing, Joseph Cooper and
-the Online Distributed Proofreading Team at
-http://www.pgdp.net
-
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
-will be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
-one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
-(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
-permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
-set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
-copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
-protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
-Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
-charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
-do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
-rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
-such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
-research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
-practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
-subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
-redistribution.
-
-
-
-*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
-Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
-http://gutenberg.org/license).
-
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
-all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
-If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
-terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
-entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
-and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
-or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
-collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
-individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
-located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
-copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
-works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
-are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
-Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
-freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
-this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
-the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
-keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
-Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
-a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
-the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
-before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
-creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
-Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
-the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
-States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
-access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
-whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
-copied or distributed:
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
-almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
-re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
-with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org/license
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
-from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
-posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
-and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
-or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
-with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
-work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
-through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
-Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
-1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
-terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
-to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
-permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
-word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
-distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
-"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
-posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
-you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
-copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
-request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
-form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
-that
-
-- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
- owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
- has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
- Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
- must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
- prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
- returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
- sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
- address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
- the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or
- destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
- and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
- Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
- money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
- of receipt of the work.
-
-- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
-forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
-both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
-Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
-Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
-collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
-"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
-corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
-property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
-computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
-your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
-your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
-the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
-refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
-providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
-receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
-is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
-opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
-WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
-WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
-If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
-law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
-interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
-the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
-provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
-with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
-promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
-harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
-that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
-or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
-work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
-Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
-
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
-including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
-because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
-people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need, are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
-To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
-and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
-and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org.
-
-
-Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
-Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
-http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
-permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
-Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
-throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
-809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
-business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
-information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
-page at http://pglaf.org
-
-For additional contact information:
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
-SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
-particular state visit http://pglaf.org
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
-To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate
-
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
-with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
-Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
-
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
-unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
-keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
-
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
-
- http://www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
-
-
-</pre>
-
+<div>*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 43876 ***</div>
</body>
</html>
diff --git a/43876.zip b/43876.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index 7b8a6d6..0000000
--- a/43876.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ